summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 04:53:07 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 04:53:07 -0700
commit6f97f02e87d0560fac55f6b73e691bfefc740f1f (patch)
treee7a547109d95ee2192f28bb166bbe8e0f56158a7
initial commit of ebook 18349HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--18349-h.zipbin0 -> 267329 bytes
-rw-r--r--18349-h/18349-h.htm12512
-rw-r--r--18349.txt14726
-rw-r--r--18349.zipbin0 -> 264059 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
7 files changed, 27254 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/18349-h.zip b/18349-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..10a2619
--- /dev/null
+++ b/18349-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/18349-h/18349-h.htm b/18349-h/18349-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..482b239
--- /dev/null
+++ b/18349-h/18349-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,12512 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Transitional//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-transitional.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+<head>
+<meta name="generator" content=
+"HTML Tidy for Cygwin (vers 1st September 2004), see www.w3.org" />
+<meta http-equiv="CONTENT-TYPE" content=
+"text/html; charset=us-ascii" />
+<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of In the Irish Brigade, by G. A. Henty</title>
+
+<style type="text/css">
+/*<![CDATA[*/
+ body {background:#ffffff;
+ color:black;
+ font-family: "Times New Roman", serif;
+ font-size:14pt;
+ margin-top:70px;
+ margin-left:10%;
+ margin-right:10%;
+ text-align:justify}
+ caption { font-weight: bold; letter-spacing: 0.04em; font-family: "Arial";
+ text-transform: uppercase; font-size: 18pt; }
+ div {text-align: center}
+ em {font-style: italic}
+ h1 {text-align: center; text-transform: uppercase; letter-spacing: 0.05em}
+ h2 {text-align: center; letter-spacing: 0.04em}
+ h3 {text-align: center; letter-spacing: 0.04em}
+ hr {height: 5px}
+ p {text-indent: 4% }
+ pre {margin-left: 10%; font-size: 10pt;}
+ strong {font-weight: bold}
+ table {text-align: center}
+ td { font-family: "Arial";}
+ td.ltoc { letter-spacing: 0.04em; font-weight: bold; font-size: 18pt;
+ text-transform: uppercase; text-align: right; vertical-align: top }
+ td.rtoc { font-weight: bold; font-size: 18pt; text-align: left}
+ thead { font-weight: bold;}
+/*]]>*/
+</style>
+
+<style type="text/css">
+/*<![CDATA[*/
+ div.c1 {text-align: center}
+/*]]>*/
+</style>
+</head>
+<body>
+
+
+<pre>
+
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of In the Irish Brigade, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: In the Irish Brigade
+ A Tale of War in Flanders and Spain
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Illustrator: Charles M. Sheldon
+
+Release Date: May 8, 2006 [EBook #18349]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE IRISH BRIGADE ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+<h1>In the Irish Brigade:</h1>
+<h2>A Tale of War in Flanders and Spain<br />
+By G. A. Henty.</h2>
+<hr />
+<div class="c1">
+<table summary="Table of Contents">
+<caption>Contents</caption>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"></td>
+<td class="rtoc"><a href="#Preface">Preface</a>.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch1">Chapter 1</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Fresh from Ireland.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch2">Chapter 2</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">A Valiant Band.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch3">Chapter 3</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">A Strange Adventure.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch4">Chapter 4</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">At Versailles.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch5">Chapter 5</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">A New Friend.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch6">Chapter 6</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">An Ambuscade.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch7">Chapter 7</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">In Paris Again.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch8">Chapter 8</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">To Scotland.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch9">Chapter 9</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">An Escape From Newgate.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch10">Chapter 10</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Kidnapping A Minister.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch11">Chapter 11</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">On the Frontier.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch12">Chapter 12</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Oudenarde.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch13">Chapter 13</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Convalescent.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch14">Chapter 14</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">A Mission.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch15">Chapter 15</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Treachery.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch16">Chapter 16</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Captured.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch17">Chapter 17</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">An Old Friend.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch18">Chapter 18</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">War.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch19">Chapter 19</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">In Search of a Family.</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class="ltoc"><a href="#Ch20">Chapter 20</a>:</td>
+<td class="rtoc">Gerald O'Carroll.</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+</div>
+<h2><a name="Preface" id="Preface">Preface</a>.</h2>
+<p>The evils arising from religious persecution, sectarian hatred,
+ill government, and oppression were never more strongly illustrated
+than by the fact that, for a century, Ireland, which has since that
+time furnished us with a large proportion of our best soldiers,
+should have been among our bitterest and most formidable foes, and
+her sons fought in the ranks of our greatest continental enemy. It
+was not because they were adherents of the house of Stuart that
+Irishmen left their native country to take service abroad, but
+because life in Ireland was rendered well-nigh intolerable for
+Catholics, on account of the nature and severity of the laws
+against them, and the bitterness with which those laws were carried
+into effect.</p>
+<p>An Irish Catholic had no prospects of employment or advancement
+at home. He could hold no civil appointment of any kind. He could
+not serve as an officer, nor even enlist as a private, in the army.
+He could not hold land. He was subject to imprisonment, and even
+death, on the most trifling and frivolous accusations brought
+against him by the satellites of the Irish Government. Not only
+could he not sit in the parliament of Dublin, but he could not even
+vote at elections. It was because they believed that the return of
+the Stuarts would mean relief, from at least some of their
+disabilities, and liberty to carry out the offices of their
+religion openly, and to dwell in peace, free from denunciation and
+persecution, that the Irish remained so long faithful to the
+Jacobite cause.</p>
+<p>It was not, indeed, until 1774 that the Catholics in Ireland
+were admitted to qualify themselves as subjects of the crown, and
+not until the following year that they were permitted to enlist in
+the army. Irish regiments had enlisted in France, previous to the
+Convention of Limerick; but it was the Irish army that defended
+that town, and, having been defeated, passed over to France, that
+raised the Irish Brigade to the position of an important factor in
+the French army, which it held for nearly a hundred years, bearing
+a prominent part in every siege and battle in Flanders, Germany,
+Italy, and Spain. A long succession of French marshals and generals
+have testified to the extraordinary bravery of these troops, and to
+their good conduct under all circumstances. Not only in France did
+Irishmen play a prominent part in military matters, but they were
+conspicuous in every continental army, and their descendants are
+still to be found bearing honoured names throughout Europe.</p>
+<p>Happily, those days are past, and for over a hundred years the
+courage and military capacity of Irishmen have been employed in the
+service of Great Britain. For records of the doings of some of the
+regiments of the Irish Brigade, during the years 1706-1710, I am
+indebted to the painstaking account of the Irish Brigade in the
+service of France, by J. C. O'Callaghan; while the accounts of the
+war in Spain are drawn from the official report, given in Boyer's
+Annals of the Reign of Queen Anne, which contains a mine of
+information of the military and civil events of the time.</p>
+<p>G. A. Henty.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch1" id="Ch1">Chapter 1</a>: Fresh from Ireland.</h2>
+<p>A number of officers of O'Brien's regiment of foot, forming a
+part of the Irish Brigade in the service of France, were gathered
+in a handsome apartment in the Rue des Fosses, on the 20th of June,
+1701, when the door opened, and their colonel entered with a young
+officer in the uniform of the regiment.</p>
+<p>"I have asked you here, gentlemen all," he said, "to present to
+you a new comrade, Desmond Kennedy, who, through the good offices
+of the Marshal de Noailles, has been appointed, by His Gracious
+Majesty, to a cornetcy in our regiment.</p>
+<p>"Now, gentlemen, I have known, and doubtless you can all of you
+recall, instances where the harmony of a regiment has been
+grievously disturbed, and bad blood caused, owing to the want of a
+clear understanding upon matters connected with a family; which
+might have been avoided, had proper explanations been given at the
+commencement. I have spoken frankly to Mr. Kennedy, and he has
+stated to me certain particulars, and has not only authorized me,
+but requested me to repeat them to you, feeling that you had a
+right to know who it was that had come among you, and so to avoid
+questioning on matters that are, of all others, prone to lead to
+trouble among gentlemen.</p>
+<p>"Beyond the fact that he is a Kennedy, and that his father had
+to fly from Ireland, two years after the siege of Limerick, owing
+to a participation in some plot to bring about a fresh rising in
+favour of King James, he is unacquainted with his family history.
+He has never heard from his father, and only knows that he made for
+France after throwing the usurper's spies off his track, and there
+can be little doubt that it was his intention to take service in
+this brigade. There have been several Kennedys in the service, and
+I have little doubt that this young gentleman's father was the
+Murroch Kennedy who joined the third regiment, about that time, and
+was killed a few months afterwards at the battle of Breda. His
+death would account for the fact that his son never received a
+letter from him. At the time when he left Ireland, the child was
+some two years old, and, as communication was difficult, and the
+boy so young, Murroch might very well have put off writing until
+the boy grew older, not thinking that death might intervene, as it
+did, to prevent his doing so.</p>
+<p>"This is all simple and straightforward enough, and you will, I
+am sure, have no hesitation in extending the hand of friendship to
+the son of a gallant Irishman, who died fighting in the ranks of
+the Irish Brigade, exiled, like the rest of us, for loyalty to our
+king.</p>
+<p>"Still, gentlemen, you might, perhaps, wonder how it is that he
+knows no more of his family, and it was that this question might be
+disposed of, once for all, that I am making this statement to you
+on his behalf. He was not brought up, as you might expect, with
+some of his father's connections. Whether the family were so
+scattered that there was no one to whom he could safely entrust the
+child, I know not, but, in point of fact, he sent him to one of the
+last houses where a loyal gentleman would wish his son to be
+brought up. We all know by name and reputation--I and your majors
+knew him personally--the gallant James O'Carroll, who died,
+fighting bravely, at the siege of Limerick. He was succeeded in his
+estate by his brother John, one of the few Irishmen of good family
+who turned traitor to his king, and who secured the succession to
+his brother's possessions by becoming an ardent supporter of the
+usurper, and by changing his religion.</p>
+<p>"Why Murroch Kennedy should have chosen such a man as the
+guardian of his son is a mystery. Whether they had been great
+friends in earlier times, when John O'Carroll professed as warm an
+attachment to the Stuart cause as did his brother James, or whether
+Kennedy possessed such knowledge of O'Carroll's traitorous dealings
+with the Dutchman as would, if generally known, have rendered him
+so hateful to all loyal men that he could no longer have remained
+in the country, and so had a hold over him, Mr. Kennedy can tell us
+nothing. He was brought by his nurse to Castle Kilkargan, and was
+left with John O'Carroll. It is clear that the latter accepted the
+charge unwillingly, for he sent the child to a farm, where he
+remained until he was eight years old, and then placed him with the
+parish priest, who educated him. The lad visited at the houses of
+the neighbouring gentry, shot and rowed and fished with their sons.
+O'Carroll, however, beyond paying for his maintenance, all but
+ignored his existence, showing no interest whatever in him, up to
+the time when he furnished him with a letter of introduction to de
+Noailles, except that he made him a present of a gun, as soon as he
+became of an age to use one. He never attempted to tamper with his
+loyalty to King James, and in fact, until he sent for him to ask
+what profession he would choose, he never exchanged ten words with
+him, from the time that he was brought to the castle.</p>
+<p>"We can each form our own theory as to the cause of such strange
+conduct. He may have given a pledge, to Murroch, that the boy
+should be brought up a loyalist, and a true son of the church. It
+may have been that the loyalty of the boy's father formed so
+unpleasant a contrast to his own disloyalty, and apostasy, that he
+disliked the sight of him. However, these theories can make no
+difference in our reception of Desmond Kennedy, as a gentleman of a
+good family, and as the son of a loyal adherent of the king; and as
+such, I think that I can, from what I have already seen of him,
+assert that he is one who will be a good comrade, a pleasant
+companion, and a credit to the regiment."</p>
+<p>The subject of these remarks was a tall and handsome young
+fellow, some sixteen years of age. He was already broad at the
+shoulders, and promised to become an exceedingly powerful man. He
+had stood somewhat behind the colonel, watching calmly the effect
+of his words on those whose comrade he was to be, for he knew how
+punctilious were his countrymen, on the subject of family, placing
+as much or even more value than did the Scots, on points of
+genealogy, and of descent from the old families. His frank open
+face, his bearing and manner, did as much to smooth his way as did
+the speech of his colonel, who, when he had been introduced to him,
+two days before, had questioned him very closely on the subject of
+his family. It had almost been a matter of satisfaction to Desmond
+when he heard, from the colonel, that the officer who had fallen at
+Breda was probably the father of whom he had no remembrance; for,
+from the time he attained the age of boyhood, it had been a grief
+and pain that he should never have heard from his father, who, it
+now appeared, had been prevented by death from ever communicating
+with him.</p>
+<p>The officers received him cordially. They had little doubt that
+he was the son of the Murroch Kennedy, of Dillon's regiment,
+although, after they separated, some wonder was expressed as to the
+reason why the latter had committed his son to the care of so
+notorious a traitor as John O'Carroll.</p>
+<p>Desmond had been specially introduced to two of the young
+lieutenants, Patrick O'Neil and Phelim O'Sullivan, and these took
+him off with them to their quarters.</p>
+<p>"And what is the last news from Ireland? I suppose that the
+confiscations have ceased, for the excellent reason that they have
+seized the estates of every loyal gentleman in the country?"</p>
+<p>"That was done long ago, in the neighbourhood of Kilkargan, and,
+so far as I know, everywhere the feeling is as bitter as ever,
+among those who have been dispossessed, and also among the tenants
+and peasantry, who have found themselves handed over to the mercies
+of Dutchmen, or other followers of William. At Kilkargan there was
+not that grievance; but, although they had still one of the old
+family as their master, they could not forgive him for deserting to
+the side of the usurper, nor for changing his religion in order to
+do pleasure to William. Certainly, he can have derived but little
+satisfaction from the estates. He seldom showed himself out of
+doors, never without two or three armed servants, all of whom were
+strangers from the north, and he was often away, for months
+together, at Dublin."</p>
+<p>"And what did you do with yourself?"</p>
+<p>"I fished, shot, and rode. I had many friends among the gentry
+of the neighbourhood, who would, doubtless, have shown less
+kindness than they did, had it not been for the neglect with which
+O'Carroll treated me. His unpopularity was all in my favour.</p>
+<p>"However, I have one good reason for being obliged to him, since
+it was through him that I obtained my commission. He told me that,
+in his young days, he had been at a French college with the duke.
+They had been great friends there, and he thought that, in memory
+of this, de Noailles would procure me a commission."</p>
+<p>"I suppose the real fact was, Kennedy, that he was glad to get
+rid of you altogether?"</p>
+<p>"I think that is likely enough. He certainly raised no
+objection, whatever, to my going abroad, and seemed to think it
+natural that I should choose the Irish Brigade, here, in preference
+to the British service. He said something unpleasant about its not
+being singular that I should be a rebel, when I always associated
+with rebels, to which I replied that it seemed to me that I could
+hardly be blamed for that, seeing that my father had been what he
+called a rebel, and that I had little choice in the matter of my
+associates; and that if I had been educated at a school in England,
+instead of by good Father O'Leary, I might have had other
+sentiments. He replied that my sentiments were nothing to him, one
+way or the other. He was glad to wash his hands of me altogether;
+and, at any rate, if I went to France, I could drink the health of
+King James every day without his being involved in my treason."</p>
+<p>"It almost looked as if he wished you to grow up a rebel,
+Kennedy, or he would hardly have placed you in the charge of a
+priest. He may have reckoned that if there was another rising, you
+might join it, and so be taken off his hands, altogether."</p>
+<p>"Whatever the reason was, I have certainly cause for
+satisfaction that he removed me from the care of the farmer's wife,
+with whom he at first placed me, and arranged with the priest to
+take charge of me altogether. O'Leary himself had been educated at
+Saint Omer, and was a splendid fellow. He was very popular on the
+countryside, and it was owing to my being with him that I was
+admitted to the houses of the gentry around, whereas, had I
+remained in the farmhouse in which O'Carroll first placed me, I
+should only have associated with the sons of other tenants."</p>
+<p>"It looked, at any rate, as if he wished to make a gentleman of
+you, Kennedy."</p>
+<p>"Yes, I suppose my father had asked him to do so. At any rate, I
+was infinitely better off than I should have been if he had taken
+me in at Kilkargan, for in that case I should have had no
+associates, whatever. As it was, I scarcely ever exchanged a word
+with him, until that last meeting. He sent down, by one of his
+servants, the letter to the Duc de Noailles, and a bag containing
+money for my outfit here, and for the purchase of a horse, together
+with a line saying that he had done his duty by me, and had no
+desire to hear from me in the future. I was inclined to send the
+money back to him, but Father O'Leary persuaded me not to do so,
+saying that I must be in a position to buy these things, if I
+obtained a commission; and that, no doubt, the money had been given
+me, not for my own sake, but because he felt that he owed it to me,
+for some service rendered to him by my father."</p>
+<p>"It was an ungracious way of doing it," O'Sullivan said, "but,
+in your circumstances, I should have taken the money had it come
+from the old one himself. It is, perhaps, as well that it should
+have been done in such a manner that you may well feel you owe no
+great gratitude towards such a man."</p>
+<p>"And how did you get over here?"</p>
+<p>"There was no great difficulty about that. In spite of the
+activity of the English cruisers, constant communication is kept up
+between Ireland and France, and fortunately I had, a short time
+before, made the acquaintance of one of your officers, who was over
+there, in disguise, gathering recruits for the Brigade."</p>
+<p>"Yes, there are a good many agents in Ireland engaged in that
+work. There is no difficulty in obtaining recruits, for there is
+scarcely a young Irishman who does not long to be with his
+countrymen, who have won such credit out here, and many abstain
+from joining only because they do not know how to set about it. The
+work of the agents, then, is principally to arrange means for their
+crossing the channel. It is well that the supply is steadily kept
+up, for, I can assure you, every battle fought makes very heavy
+gaps in our ranks; but in spite of that, three fresh regiments have
+been raised, in the last year, partly by fresh comers from Ireland,
+and partly by Irish deserters from Marlborough's regiments.</p>
+<p>"But I am interrupting your story."</p>
+<p>"Well, after leaving Mr. O'Carroll, and making my preparations,
+I paid a visit to the cottage where the officer was staying, in
+disguise, and told him that I wanted to cross. He gave instructions
+as to how to proceed. I was to go to a certain street in Cork, and
+knock at a certain door. When it was opened, I was to say, 'The sea
+is calm and the sky is bright'.</p>
+<p>"'Then', he said, 'you will be taken in hand, and put on board
+one of the craft engaged in the work of carrying our recruits
+across the water. You will be landed at Saint Malo, where there is
+an agent of the Brigade, who gives instructions to the recruits as
+to how they are to proceed, supplies them with money enough for the
+journey, and a man to accompany each party, and act as interpreter
+on the way.</p>
+<p>"I carried out his instructions, crossed the channel in a lugger
+with thirty young peasants, bound also for Paris, and, on landing
+at Saint Malo, took my place in the diligence for Paris; having,
+fortunately, no need for an interpreter. On my presenting my letter
+to the Marquis de Noailles, he received me with great kindness, and
+treated me as a guest, until he had obtained me a commission in
+your regiment.</p>
+<p>"Now, when are we likely to go on active service?"</p>
+<p>"Soon, I expect," O'Neil said; "but whether we shall be sent to
+the Peninsula, or to Flanders, no one knows. In fact, it is likely
+enough that we shall, for the present, remain here; until it is
+seen how matters go, and where reinforcements will be most
+required. It is but ten months since we came into garrison, in
+Paris, and we may therefore expect to be one of the last regiments
+ordered off.</p>
+<p>"For my part, I am in no particular hurry to exchange
+comfortable quarters, and good living, and such adventures as may
+fall to the lot of a humble subaltern, for roughing it in the
+field; where, as has been the case ever since the Brigade was
+formed, we get a good deal more than our fair share of hard work
+and fighting."</p>
+<p>"I should have thought that you would all have liked that,"
+Desmond said, in some surprise.</p>
+<p>"Enough is as good as a feast," the other said; "and when you
+have done a few weeks' work in trenches, before a town you are
+besieging; stood knee deep for hours in mud, soaked to the skin
+with rain, and with the enemy's shot coming through the parapet
+every half minute or so; you will see that it is not all fun and
+glory.</p>
+<p>"Then, too, you see, we have no particular interest in the
+quarrels between France and Germany. When we fight, we fight rather
+for the honour of the Irish Brigade, than for the glory of France.
+We have a grudge against the Dutch, and fight them as interested
+parties, seeing that it was by his Dutch troops that William
+conquered Ireland. As to the English troops, we have no particular
+enmity against them. Cromwell's business is an old story, and I
+don't suppose that the English soldier feels any particular love
+for Queen Anne, or any animosity against us. And after all, we are
+nearer in blood to them than we are to the Germans, Austrians, or
+Spaniards, for there are few, even of our oldest families, who have
+not, many times since the days of Strongbow, intermarried with the
+English settlers. At any rate, there are still plenty of adherents
+of King James in England and Scotland. We speak the same language,
+and form part of the same nation, and I own that I would rather
+fight against any foreign foe than against them."</p>
+<p>"So would I," Desmond said heartily. "Our only point of
+difference is that we don't agree as to who should be king. We want
+a Catholic king, and the majority of the English want a Protestant
+king. We have fought on the subject, and been beaten. Next time, we
+hope that we may succeed. If the king were to land in England
+again, I would fight heart and soul in his cause; but whether the
+French beat the English, in the present war, or the English beat
+the French, will not, as far as I can see, make much difference to
+King James; who, Father O'Leary tells me, is, in his opinion,
+supported here by the French king from no great love for himself,
+but because, so long as James has adherents in Ireland, Scotland,
+and England, he is able to play him off against the English
+Government."</p>
+<p>The other young men laughed.</p>
+<p>"For heaven's sake, Kennedy, keep such sentiments as these to
+yourself. It is a matter of faith, in our brigade, that we are
+fighting in the cause of King James, as against the English
+usurper. Now that William is dead, and James's daughter on the
+throne, matters are complicated somewhat; and if the Parliament had
+settled the succession, after Anne, on her brother, there might
+have been an end of the quarrel altogether. But now that they have
+settled it on Sophia of Hanover, granddaughter of James the 1st,
+and her descendants, subject to the restriction that they shall be
+Protestants, the quarrel does not seem likely to be healed."</p>
+<p>"This priest of yours must be a dangerous man," O'Sullivan
+said.</p>
+<p>"Not at all. I can assure you, he is devoted to the king; but,
+as he told me, there is no use in Irishmen always closing their
+eyes to the true state of things. He says that we must rely upon
+ourselves, and our loyal friends in Scotland and England, but that
+he is sure the king will never be placed on his throne by French
+bayonets. A small auxiliary force may be sent over, but, in all
+these years, Louis has made no real effort to assist him; and even
+if, for his own purposes, he sent a great army to England, and
+placed him on the throne, he would not be able to maintain himself
+there for a month after the French had withdrawn, for even a
+rightful king would be hated by the people upon whom he had been
+forced, by a foreign power, especially a power that had, for
+centuries, been regarded as their chief enemy. If he had been in
+earnest, Louis would have sent over a great army, instead of a few
+thousand men, to Ireland, when such a diversion would have turned
+the scale in our favour. As he did not do so then, he is not likely
+to do so in the future. The king is useful to him, here, by keeping
+up an agitation that must, to some extent, cripple the strength of
+England; but, were a Stuart on the throne, he would have to listen
+to the wishes of the majority of his people, and France would gain
+nothing by placing him there. Moreover, she would lose the services
+of twenty thousand of her best soldiers, for naturally the exiles
+would all return home, and what is now the most valuable force in
+the French service, might then become an equally important one in
+the service of Britain."</p>
+<p>"I am glad that this priest of yours remains quietly in
+Kilkargan, for, if he were to come here, and expound his views
+among our regiments, he might cause quite a defection among them.
+At any rate, Kennedy, I should advise you not to take to
+propagating his views in the regiment. It would not add to your
+comfort, or ours, and there are a good many hot-headed men who
+would take up the idea that you had been infected by O'Carroll's
+principles."</p>
+<p>"It would not be well for anyone to say as much to my face,"
+Desmond said. "Father O'Leary is loyal to the backbone, although he
+has his own ideas as to the hopelessness of our obtaining any
+efficient help from Louis. He thinks that it will be far better to
+trust to our friends at home, and that, even did Louis carry out
+his promises, it would in the long run harm rather than benefit
+King James."</p>
+<p>"I am not saying that his view may not be correct, Kennedy. I am
+only saying that the view would be a very unpopular one, among the
+Brigade. We are fighting for France because we believe that France,
+in turn, will aid in placing our rightful king on the throne, and
+if we once entertained the notion that Louis was deceiving us, that
+he had no intention of helping us, and that, if he did place James
+on the throne, he would alienate all his sympathizers at home, we
+should ask ourselves of what use was it, spending our blood in
+fighting the battles of France."</p>
+<p>"At any rate, I will take your advice, O'Sullivan, and will keep
+my lips sealed, as to Father O'Leary's views. As you see, by my
+presence here, he has not convinced me, and as long as there is a
+hope that, by the aid of a French army, we may yet see our king
+come to his own again, I shall do my best to prove myself a
+faithful soldier of France. I have chosen my career with my eyes
+open. A loyal Irishman cannot obtain employment, still less
+military employment, in his own country, and accordingly, we are to
+be found fighting as soldiers of fortune in every country in
+Europe. At least there is some chance that we may be benefiting the
+royal cause by fighting for the country that gave King James
+shelter, and rendered him armed assistance in his struggle with the
+usurper, and will probably give aid, more or less efficient, when
+the next attempt is made. In other countries we are but soldiers of
+fortune. In France we may regard ourselves as serving our own king
+by serving King Louis."</p>
+<p>"Do you speak French well, Kennedy?" O'Neil said, changing the
+conversation abruptly.</p>
+<p>"Yes. Father O'Leary took care of that, for I always said that I
+should take service abroad, as there was clearly nothing else to do
+for a living, and, consequently, he generally talked to me in that
+language, and I speak it as well as I do English or Irish."</p>
+<p>"You have not had much practice with the sword, I suppose?"</p>
+<p>"Not so much as I could wish, though I never lost an opportunity
+of practising. There were several of the tenants who served in the
+regiment James O'Carroll raised. I used to practise with them, but
+I shall lose no time in getting the best instruction I can,
+here."</p>
+<p>"You may want it, Kennedy. We are not particularly liked by the
+French officers, because we are generally chosen to lead an
+assault, or for other desperate service. Duelling is, of course,
+forbidden, but that in no way prevents duels from being frequent.
+As for fighting in action, as far as I have seen or heard,
+swordsmanship does not go for a great deal. If you press on hard
+enough, and there are men following you, the enemy give way,
+generally, before it comes to hand-to-hand fighting. If, on the
+other hand, they are the more numerous, and hold their position in
+the breach, it is the musketry that settles it. It is only when two
+officers happen to meet, in a fierce fight, that swordsmanship
+becomes of importance.</p>
+<p>"We have a good school in the regiment, and there are several
+famous masters of fence in the town, so I should advise you to give
+a couple of hours a day, for a time, to making yourself a
+first-rate swordsman. I have just left off. Our <em>maitre
+d'armes</em> tells me I am too hotheaded ever to make a fine blade;
+but I should fancy, from the way you have been arguing, that you
+are likely to be cooler than most of us in a fencing bout. It is
+the fault with us all that we are apt to lose our tempers, and
+indeed Maitre Maupert, who is the best teacher here, declines
+absolutely to take any of us as pupils, saying that, while we may
+do excellently well in battle, he can never hope to make
+first-class fencers of men who cannot be relied upon to keep their
+heads cool, and to fight with pointed weapons as calmly as they
+might fence with a friend in a saloon."</p>
+<p>"Well, I shall work hard to become a fair swordsman," Desmond
+said, with a laugh. "I suppose there is plenty of time to
+spare."</p>
+<p>"Plenty. We have a couple of hours' drill in the morning, and
+after that, except when you are officer of the day, you can spend
+your time as you like. The colonel and two of his officers attend
+at the king's levees, when he is in Paris, but, as he spends the
+greater portion of his time at Versailles, we are seldom called
+upon for that duty."</p>
+<p>A few days after Desmond's arrival, the colonel took him with
+him to Saint Germain, where James the 3rd, as his supporters called
+him, held a miniature court. The colonel presented Desmond as a
+loyal subject of His Majesty, and a newly-joined cornet in his
+regiment.</p>
+<p>The young prince was a lad of eighteen. He was surrounded by a
+group of courtiers, who had accompanied or followed his father into
+exile, and whose insistence upon treating him with the respect due
+to a monarch was in no slight degree galling to him, for, as he
+often declared to the few friends he had about his own age, he had
+all the disadvantages of being a king, without any of the
+advantages.</p>
+<p>He was at once taken with the appearance of Desmond Kennedy.</p>
+<p>"Ah, Monsieur Kennedy," he said, after the ceremony of
+presentation had been completed; "I wish that I had all my faithful
+subjects, of the Irish Brigade, across the water with me; and that
+I could put on a uniform like yours, and fight at their head for my
+rights."</p>
+<p>"I would that you had, Sire. It would be a good day for us all;
+and believe me, that either in Ireland or Scotland you would soon
+find yourself at the head of an army, many times more numerous than
+our brigade."</p>
+<p>"They all tell me that I must wait," the young prince said, with
+a sigh, "but I have been waiting a long time now, and it seems no
+nearer than when I was a child. However, the King of France has
+promised me that it cannot be much longer; and that, when
+Marlborough is defeated, and his army driven back across the sea,
+he will send a fleet and an army to place me on my throne."</p>
+<p>"We shall all rejoice, indeed, when that time comes, Sire; and I
+am sure there is not a man in the Irish Brigade who will not follow
+you to the death, and serve you as faithfully as many of them did
+your royal father."</p>
+<p>"I hope you will come here often, Monsieur Kennedy. I am sure
+that I shall like you very much, and I think that you would always
+say what you thought, and tell me the real truth about things."</p>
+<p>"Sire!" one of the older men exclaimed, reproachfully.</p>
+<p>"I mean no reflection on anyone, Dillon. You all say what I am
+sure you feel, but you have grown accustomed to waiting, and all
+think of what is politic, and complain that I speak too frankly.
+Monsieur Kennedy comes straight from Ireland, and he is not old
+enough, yet, to have learned to measure his words, and will not be
+always afraid that anything he may say will be carried to the
+king.</p>
+<p>"How I wish that the king would send me with Marshal
+Tallard!"</p>
+<p>"That would never do, Sire. The English are your subjects, and
+they would never forgive you, if you were to appear in the field
+with a French army, fighting against them."</p>
+<p>"But the Irish Brigade fight, Dillon?"</p>
+<p>"Yes, Your Majesty, but they are in the service of France, and,
+by the terms of the treaty of Limerick, were allowed to expatriate
+themselves, and to enter the French service. We have, in fact,
+renounced our nationality, with the consent of the English, and, if
+taken prisoners, could only be treated as captured foes, and not as
+traitors. Of course, when Your Majesty ascends the throne, we shall
+again become British subjects."</p>
+<p>"I trust that that may come soon, Dillon, and for your sake,
+rather than my own. When the time comes, you will not find me
+backward, but this weary waiting tries me sorely, and, were it not
+for those who have remained faithful to our cause, I would gladly
+resign such chances as I have of succeeding to the throne of
+England, and take a commission in the Irish Brigade."</p>
+<p>Dillon and some of the elder men shook their heads.</p>
+<p>"Can you wonder?" the young prince said, passionately. "Here is
+Master Kennedy, who is younger than myself, though a free life and
+exercise have made him a man, in comparison to me. He has his life
+before him. He will bear his part in many a pitched battle, and,
+doubtless, in many a private adventure. He is his own master, and,
+as long as he does his duty, there are none to say, 'you must not
+do that; you must not say that; you must preserve your dignity; you
+must speak softly and discreetly; you must wait patiently.'</p>
+<p>"I envy you, Master Kennedy. I envy you, from the bottom of my
+heart! Come often to see me. You will always be welcome;" and,
+turning abruptly away, he left the chamber hurriedly, to conceal
+the tears which filled his eyes.</p>
+<p>His counsellors shook their heads solemnly, but Colonel O'Brien
+said, warmly:</p>
+<p>"What the king says is natural, for a man of his age; and, for
+my part, it has increased my respect for him. I say it without
+offence, but what could be duller than the life this lad leads
+here? He has been brought up, literally, without a pleasure. His
+late Majesty, heaven rest his soul! was absorbed in his religious
+exercises, and nothing could have been more trying, to a boy, than
+a court in which the priests and confessors were practically
+supreme. Since his father's death, things have been but little
+better, and now I see that, at heart, the young king has plenty of
+spirit and energy, I can feel that his life has been that of a
+caged hawk, and I am not surprised that he occasionally breaks out
+into revolt against it. It would, methinks, do him a world of good,
+had he a few companions about his own age, like Ensign Kennedy. I
+would even say that, although I can quite understand that, as King
+of England, he could not well take a commission in one of our
+regiments, he might at least be placed with one of our most
+experienced and honoured colonels, in order to learn military
+exercises, and to mix with the officers as any other nobleman might
+do, when attached to the regiment."</p>
+<p>Murmurs of dissent arose among the counsellors.</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen," the colonel went on, "I have no desire to
+interfere with your functions, but, in my opinion, it is good that
+a king should also be a general. Did anyone think any the worse of
+Dutch William, that he was able to command his army, personally?
+None of us can believe that King James will ever succeed to the
+inheritance of his fathers, without fighting; and it would be well,
+indeed, that he should not appear as a puppet, but as one qualified
+to command. It was the fault, or rather the misfortune, of his
+father, that he was unfit to lead his troops in the field. Had he
+been able to do so, he would, in all probability, have died King of
+England, instead of as a fugitive and a pensioner of King Louis. In
+one way, it grieves me to see that the young king feels his
+position acutely; but, on the other hand, I am rejoiced to see that
+he is in no way lacking in spirit, and that he longs to be out of
+his cage, and to try his wings for himself.</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen, having had my say, I will take my leave of
+you, as duty calls me back to my regiment. I trust that the
+frankness with which I have spoken will not be misunderstood."</p>
+<p>So saying, with a bow to the courtiers he left the room,
+followed by Kennedy.</p>
+<p>"They mean well," he said, after they had mounted, and ridden
+off at a gallop; "but it is a pity that these gentlemen, all loyal
+and honourable men as they are, should surround the young king.
+They suited, well enough, to the mood of his father, who was always
+wanting in spirit, and was broken down, not only by the loss of his
+kingdom, but by the conduct of his daughters; and, what with that,
+and his devotion to religion, he was rather a monk than a monarch.
+He believed--but most mistakenly--that he had a genius for
+politics, and was constantly intriguing with his adherents at home,
+notably Marlborough and other lords, from whom he obtained fair
+words and promises of support, but nothing else. But though he
+could plan, he did not possess a spark of energy, and was one of
+the most undecided of men, though, like most undecided men, he
+could be extremely obstinate; and, unfortunately, the more wrong he
+was, the more obstinately he held to his course.</p>
+<p>"However, all this can make no difference in our devotion to the
+Stuart cause. But I hail, with satisfaction, the prospect that, in
+his son, we may have one to whom we may feel personally loyal; for
+there can be no doubt that men will fight with more vigour, for a
+person to whom they are attached, than for an abstract idea."</p>
+<p>"I have heard Father O'Leary say the same, sir. His opinion was
+that, had the late king possessed the qualities that commanded the
+personal admiration and fidelity of his followers, and excited
+something like enthusiasm among the people at large, he would never
+have lost his throne; nor, could he have led his armies, as did
+Gustavus or Charles the 12th of Sweden, would William of Orange
+ever have ventured to cross to England."</p>
+<p>"It was a bad business, altogether, lad. His cause was
+practically lost, from the day that William set foot upon English
+soil. He had, in reality, no personal friends; and those who would
+have remained faithful to the cause, were paralysed by his
+indecision and feebleness. Charles the Martyr made many mistakes,
+but he had the passionate adherence of his followers. His
+personality, and his noble appearance, did as much for him as the
+goodness of his cause; while his son, James, repelled rather than
+attracted personal devotion. I trust that his grandson will inherit
+some of his qualities. His outburst, today, gave me hope that he
+will do so; but one must not build too much on that. It may have
+been only the pettishness of a young man, sick of the constant
+tutelage to which he is subjected, and the ennui of the life he
+leads, rather than the earnestness of a noble spirit.</p>
+<p>"Of course, Kennedy, I need not tell you that it would be well
+to make no mention, to anyone, of the scene that you have
+witnessed."</p>
+<p>"I shall certainly make no mention of it to anyone, sir. I am
+sorry, indeed, for the young king. His life must be a dreadful one,
+conscious of the impossibility of breaking the bonds in which he is
+held, and knowing that his every word and action will be reported,
+by spies, to the King of France."</p>
+<p>For three months, Desmond Kennedy worked hard at drill and sword
+exercise. He became a general favourite in the regiment, owing to
+his good temper, high spirits, and readiness to join in everything
+that was going on.</p>
+<p>He went over, several times, to Saint Germain. At first, the
+king's counsellors looked but coldly upon him, and he would have
+ceased to come there, had it not been for the unaffected pleasure
+shown by the king at his visits. In time, however, two of the
+principal men at the little court requested him to have a
+conversation with them, before going into the king's chamber.</p>
+<p>"You will understand, Mr. Kennedy," one of them said, when they
+had seated themselves in a quiet spot in the garden; "that we,
+standing in the position of His Majesty's counsellors, are in a
+position of great responsibility. His Majesty, as we admit is but
+natural, chafes over the inaction to which he is condemned by
+circumstances; and is apt, at times, to express his desire for
+action in terms which, if they came to the ears of King Louis, as
+we have every reason to believe is sometimes the case, would do him
+and the cause serious injury. Naturally, we should be glad for him
+to have companions of his own age, but it behoves us to be most
+careful that such companionship should not add to our difficulties
+in this direction; and we should view with satisfaction a
+friendship between the young king and one who, like yourself, is
+nearly of his own age and, as we can see, full of spirit and
+energy. In these matters the king is deficient; but it would be
+better that he should, for the present, remain as he is, rather
+than that he should, in acquiring more manly habits, grow still
+more impatient and discontented with his position.</p>
+<p>"We have naturally taken some little trouble in finding out how
+you stand in your regiment, and we hear nothing but good of you.
+You are much liked by your comrades, pay the greatest attention to
+your military exercises, and are regarded as one who will, some
+day, do much credit to the regiment; and we feel that, in most
+respects, your influence could not but be advantageous to the young
+king; but the good that this might do him would be more than
+balanced, were you to render him still more impatient than he is
+for action. You may well suppose that we, exiles as we have been
+for so many years from our country, are not less impatient than he
+for the day of action; but we know that such action must depend
+upon the King of France, and not upon ourselves. We would gladly
+risk all, in an effort to place him on the throne of England, to
+repair past injustices and cruel wrongs; but, were we to move
+without the assistance of Louis, instead of achieving that object
+we might only bring fresh ruin, confiscations, and death upon the
+royalists of England, Scotland, and Ireland. Are you of our
+opinion?"</p>
+<p>"Completely so, sir. Of course, I know but little of what is
+passing, save in the neighbourhood where I have been brought up;
+but I know that there, even among the king's most devoted
+adherents, there is a feeling that nothing can possibly be done
+until France lends her aid, in earnest. The English army is far
+stronger than it was when we were last in arms, and when William
+had to rely, almost entirely, upon his Dutch troops and Dutch
+generals; while the friends of the Stuarts are almost without arms,
+without leaders, and without organization."</p>
+<p>"That is good, Mr. Kennedy; and, if we were to sanction King
+James's forming an intimacy with you, can I understand that we
+could rely upon your not using your influence to add to his
+impatience for action, and discontent with his present
+position?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly, sir. Being so recently from Ireland, I could assure
+him that even his most devoted adherents, there, are of opinion
+that no rising could be attended with success, unless backed by
+French arms, and especially by the aid of the Irish Brigade, which
+has already won such renown for itself, and whose appearance would
+excite the greatest enthusiasm among all Irishmen."</p>
+<p>"In that case, Mr. Kennedy, so far from throwing any
+difficulties in the way of His Majesty seeking your companionship,
+we shall encourage him, and shall be glad to see you here, as often
+as your military duties will permit."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch2" id="Ch2">Chapter 2</a>: A Valiant Band.</h2>
+<p>The permission was not attended with the result that the young
+prince's counsellors had hoped. For a time, James showed a lively
+pleasure when Desmond rode over to Saint Germain, walked with him
+in the gardens, and talked to him alone in his private apartments,
+and professed a warm friendship for him; but Desmond was not long
+in discovering that his first estimate of the prince's character
+had been wholly erroneous, and that his outburst at their first
+meeting had been the result of pique and irritation, rather than
+any real desire to lead a more active life. Upon the contrary, he
+was constitutionally indolent and lethargic. There were horses at
+his command, but it was seldom, indeed, that he would take the
+trouble to cross the saddle, although walking was distasteful to
+him. Even when speaking of his hopes of ascending the throne of
+England, he spoke without enthusiasm, and said one day:</p>
+<p>"It is a pity that it cannot be managed without fuss and
+trouble. I hate trouble."</p>
+<p>"Nothing can be done worth doing, without trouble, Your
+Majesty," Desmond said sturdily. "It almost seems to me that, if
+everything could be had without trouble, it would not be worth
+having."</p>
+<p>"How do you mean, Mr. Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"I may illustrate it by saying, Sire, that no true fisherman
+would care about angling in a pond, close to his house, and so full
+of fish, that he had but to drop a baited hook into the water to
+bring up one immediately. The pleasure of fishing consists largely
+in the hard work that it demands. It is, perhaps, miles to a stream
+across the hills, and a long day's work may produce but a half
+dozen fish; but these the angler prizes in proportion to the
+trouble he has had to get them. I think that, were I born heir to a
+throne, I would rather that it should cost me hardship, toil, and
+danger to obtain it, than walk into a cathedral, a few days after
+my father's death, and there be crowned."</p>
+<p>"I do not agree with you, at all," James said, shortly. "If
+anything could not be had without toil, hardship, and danger, as
+you say, I would willingly go without it."</p>
+<p>"Then, Sire, I can only hope that the toil and danger may be
+borne by your devoted followers, and that you may be spared them,
+personally."</p>
+<p>James looked sharply up at his companion, to gather whether the
+words were spoken sarcastically, but Desmond's face, though
+flushed, was calm and serious. Nevertheless, indolent as he was,
+James felt that the words were a reproof; that, although he had at
+first liked him, there was in reality little in common between him
+and this energetic young fellow; and the next time he came, he
+received him with much less cordiality than before; while Desmond,
+who was beginning to tire of the companionship of one who lacked,
+alike, the fun and humour, and the restless activity of his
+comrades, Patrick and Phelim; and who saw that the professions of
+James's friendship were but short lived, came over to Saint Germain
+less frequently, until, at last, he only rode over with his
+colonel, or when some duty called him there.</p>
+<p>"So you have been a failure, Master Kennedy," the counsellor who
+had first spoken to him said, one day, when the change in the
+king's manner became evident to them all.</p>
+<p>"I am afraid so, sir," Desmond replied with a smile. "I have no
+doubt that it was my fault. Perhaps I was not patient enough with
+him; but, indeed, my efforts to rouse him to take exercise, to
+practise in arms, and so on, were so ill received, that I felt I
+was doing more harm than good."</p>
+<p>"I was afraid that it would be so," the other said, regretfully.
+"You see, during his later years, his father gave up his time
+almost entirely to religious observances; and, consequently, the
+lad's life was very dull and monotonous. Constitutionally, he
+undoubtedly takes after his father, who, with all his virtues, was
+at once indolent and undecided. We have observed, with regret, his
+disinclination to bestir himself in any way. Seeing that we, who
+were his father's companions, are too old, or too much
+disheartened, to be lively companions for him, we had hoped that
+the talk of one of spirit, and of his own age, might have roused
+him to make some exertions to overcome his disinclination for
+anything like active exercise. I think now, however, that we were
+wrong; that the tonic was too strong; that he could not but feel
+that your abundance of spirits, and life, were too much for him;
+and that the companion he needs is one who could, to some extent,
+sympathize with him, and who could, perhaps, make more allowance
+for the manner in which he has been brought up.</p>
+<p>"We do not blame you at all. I am sure that you have done your
+best. But it is evident that the contrast between you and himself
+has been too strong a one; and that, feeling he cannot hope to
+emulate your soldierly activity, he has come to resent it, as a
+sort of reflection upon himself."</p>
+<p>Desmond was, by no means, sorry at being relieved of the
+necessity of paying frequent visits to Saint Germain. In the first
+place, he begrudged the time that was taken from his fencing
+lessons, at which he had worked enthusiastically; and in the next,
+he had felt, after two or three visits, that between himself and
+the young king there was really nothing in common. Full of life and
+spirits himself, it seemed to him nothing short of disgraceful that
+one, who aspired to rule, should take no pains whatever to fit
+himself for a throne, or to cultivate qualities that would render
+himself popular among a high-spirited people. And, as he came to
+understand James more thoroughly, he had found his visits
+increasingly irksome, all the more so, as he felt their
+inutility.</p>
+<p>"Thank goodness," he said, to his two friends, when he went home
+that day, "I have done with Saint Germain. I am as warm an adherent
+as ever of the cause of the Stuarts, and should be perfectly ready,
+when the time comes, to fight my hardest for them; but I would
+vastly rather fight for the king, than converse with him."</p>
+<p>"I suppose, by what I have seen of him, that he must be somewhat
+wearisome," Phelim O'Sullivan said, with a laugh. "Fortunately, wit
+and gaiety are not essential qualities on the part of a monarch;
+but I must own that, treasonable as it may sound, I fear His
+Majesty is lacking in other qualities, far more essential in a
+monarch. I should say that he is kindly and well disposed, he
+wishes to be fair and just, and may turn out a wise ruler; but he
+is altogether deficient in energy. I suppose there is no occasion
+for a king, safely seated upon a throne, to be energetic; but a
+prince in exile should possess the qualities that excite
+enthusiasm, and bind men to him. Possibly, the qualities King James
+possesses would be highly valued by the Scotch, but they would
+certainly fail to inspire our people."</p>
+<p>"Yes," Patrick O'Neil agreed. "His father did more to ruin his
+cause, in Ireland, than all William's Dutch generals and troops,
+together. It was disheartening to be risking life and possessions
+for a man who would do nothing for himself, whose indecision
+paralysed our leaders, and who, the moment a reverse came, sought
+safety in flight, instead of taking his place among the men who
+were devoted to his cause. I can understand that, in England, where
+the majority of those who professed to be devoted to him were
+betraying him, and were in secret communication with William, he
+should be by turns obstinate and vacillating; but in Ireland, where
+every man who surrounded him was risking his life in his cause, he
+should have shown absolute confidence in them, listened to their
+advice, set an example of personal gallantry and courage, and, at
+least, remained among them until all was definitely lost. It was
+the desertion of James, rather than the loss of the battle of the
+Boyne, that ruined his cause.</p>
+<p>"Well, I am glad you are out of it, for it was a pity that you
+should be going without your work at the <em>salle d'armes</em>,
+when you were making such progress that, the master reported, in a
+few months you would become one of the best swordsmen in the
+regiment."</p>
+<p>There were, in Paris, many Irish officers besides those
+belonging to Colonel O'Brien's regiment. These were, for the most
+part, men who had been severely wounded in the preceding campaign,
+and who now remained in the capital with the depots of their
+regiments. These were constantly recruited by fresh arrivals from
+Ireland, by which means the Irish Brigade was not only kept up to
+their original strength, in spite of the heavy losses they
+suffered, in the engagements in which they had taken part, but
+largely increased its force, new regiments being constantly formed.
+Naturally, O'Brien's corps, being the only complete regiment in
+Paris, at the time, was regarded as the headquarters and general
+meeting place of all the Irish officers there; and, as some of
+these had campaigned in Flanders, in Italy, and in Spain, Desmond
+learned, from their talk and anecdotes, far more of the doings of
+the Brigade than he had hitherto known. From the first they had, by
+their reckless bravery, in almost every engagement that had taken
+place, so distinguished themselves that they received the highest
+commendation from the French generals, and were almost invariably
+selected for specially dangerous service.</p>
+<p>"I think the hottest affair I was ever engaged in," a major, who
+had served in Burke's regiment, said one evening, when some ten or
+twelve of his companions had gathered, at the room which was the
+general meeting place of the officers of the corps, "was at the
+attack on Cremona by Eugene. You have all heard how our regiment,
+and that of Dillon, distinguished themselves there, but you may not
+have heard particulars. The place was a strong one, and it was
+garrisoned by some 4000 men--all French, with the exception of our
+two regiments. Marshal Villeroy was himself in command; an
+excellent officer, but, as is often the case in the French army,
+very badly served by his subordinates.</p>
+<p>"Here, as you know, almost everything goes by influence; and the
+generals are surrounded by men who have been forced upon them by
+powerful persons, whom they cannot afford to disoblige. The
+consequence was that, relying upon the strength of the place, no
+proper watch was set. There were guards, indeed, at the gates, but
+with no communication with each other; no soldiers on the ramparts;
+no patrols were sent out beyond the town, or maintained in the
+streets.</p>
+<p>"No harm might have come of this, had it not been that treachery
+was at work. There was a scoundrel, who was brother of the priest
+of one of the parishes near the wall, and both were in favour of
+the enemy. The priest's residence was near a sewer, which
+communicated with the moat outside the walls. The entrance was
+closed by an iron grating. Were this removed, troops could enter,
+by the sewer, into the priest's wine cellar.</p>
+<p>"The priest, being promised a large sum of money, set to work.
+First, he laid a complaint before the governor that the sewer was
+choked with filth, which might be a source of disease to the town
+unless removed; and to do this, it was necessary that the grating
+should be taken down. Being altogether unsuspicious of evil, the
+governor granted his request.</p>
+<p>"As soon as the grating was removed, Eugene despatched eight
+miners, who crossed the moat at night, made their way up the sewer,
+and opened a communication between it and the priest's house. When
+all was ready, four or five hundred picked grenadiers entered, and
+were concealed in the house of the priest, and other adherents of
+the emperor.</p>
+<p>"Eugene set two strong bodies of picked troops in motion. The
+one was to enter by the Saint Margaret gate, which would be seized
+by the force already in the city. This column consisted of five
+thousand men. The second force, of two thousand infantry and three
+thousand cavalry, under the Prince de Vaudemont, was to cross the
+river by a bridge of boats.</p>
+<p>"We slept like stupid dogs. Such watchmen as there were on the
+walls gave no alarm. The gate of All Saints was seized, its guard
+being instantly overpowered, and a party of engineers broke down
+the gate of Saint Margaret, which had been walled up; and at
+daylight Eugene rode into the town, followed by his troops and one
+thousand cavalry; while another mounted force watched the gate, and
+the country round, to prevent the escape of fugitives.</p>
+<p>"Before any alarm was given, Eugene had established himself at
+the Hotel de Ville, was master of the great street that separated
+half the garrison from the other half, had taken possession of the
+cathedral; and, in fact, the place was captured without a shot
+being fired.</p>
+<p>"Then the uproar began. Parties of troops, led by natives of the
+town, seized a large number of officers at their lodgings; and as
+the alarm spread, the troops seized their muskets and rushed out,
+only to be sabred and trodden down by the enemy's cavalry. I was
+asleep, and dreaming, when my servant rushed into my room, and
+said:</p>
+<p>"'The Germans are in possession of the town, Captain.'</p>
+<p>"'You are a blathering idiot,' I said.</p>
+<p>"'It's true, your honour. Get up and listen.'</p>
+<p>"Very unwillingly, I got out of bed and opened the window, and,
+by the holy poker, I found that Pat was right. There was a sound of
+firing, shouting, and screaming, and I heard the gallop of a heavy
+body of horsemen, and, directly afterwards, a squadron of German
+cuirassiers came galloping down the street.</p>
+<p>"'It is time for us to be out of this, Pat,' I said, and jumped
+into my clothes, quicker than I had ever done before.</p>
+<p>"We went downstairs, and I borrowed two overcoats that we found
+hanging there, and put them on over our uniforms. Then we went out,
+by the back door, and ran as hard as we could, keeping through
+narrow lanes, to the barracks.</p>
+<p>"On my way, I had to pass a barrier near a toll gate. Here there
+were thirty-six of our men under a sergeant. Not knowing where the
+enemy were, or whether they were between me and the barracks, I
+thought it best to stay there, and of course took the command. Just
+as I had done so, I heard the tramping of cavalry, and had the gate
+shut. We were just in time, for two hundred and fifty cuirassiers
+came galloping along.</p>
+<p>"Their leader, Baron de Mercy, as soon as the troops began to
+enter Saint Margaret's gate, was ordered to dash round and capture
+the Po gate, through which Vaudemont's corps would, after crossing
+the bridge, enter the town. He shouted to me to surrender,
+promising us our lives. I told him that if he wanted the place, he
+would have to come and take it. He used language which I need not
+repeat, but he did not attack us, waiting for the arrival of four
+hundred infantry, who had been ordered to follow him. They were
+some time in coming up, having lost their way, owing to the
+rascally native who was their guide being killed by a shot from a
+window.</p>
+<p>"I was not sorry for the delay, for it gave us time to look at
+matters quietly, and prepare for defence. Another six hundred
+cavalry now came up, and Mercy placed them so as to cut off,
+altogether, the French cavalry, who were quartered away to the
+right; then he ordered the infantry to attack us.</p>
+<p>"Our position was a good one. The barricade was formed of square
+piles, driven into the ground with small narrow openings between
+them. I ordered the men to keep behind the timbers until the enemy
+came up. The Germans opened a murdering fire as they approached,
+but, though the bullets pattered like rain against the palisades,
+and whistled in between them, not a man was touched. I waited till
+they were within two paces, and then gave the word, and you may
+well guess that there was not a bullet thrown away, and the
+Germans, mightily astonished, drew back, leaving nigh forty of
+their men behind them. Then, falling back a bit, they opened fire
+upon us, but it was a game that two could play at. We could see
+them, but they could not see us; and while we loaded our muskets in
+shelter, they were exposed, and we picked them off by dozens.</p>
+<p>"The firing had, of course, given the alarm to our two
+regiments, who turned out just as they were, in their nightshirts.
+Major O'Mahony, who was in command of Dillon's regiment, as Lally
+was away on leave, luckily made his way in safety from his lodgings
+to the barracks, got his own men in order, while Colonel Wauchop,
+who commanded our regiment, took the command of the two battalions.
+Fortunately, a portion of the regiment had been ordered to fall in
+early for inspection, and this gave time for the rest to get into
+their uniforms; and, as soon as they were ready, Wauchop led them
+out and fell suddenly upon a portion of Mercy's force, poured in a
+volley, and then charged them.</p>
+<p>"Horse and foot fell back before the attack. Then they turned
+the cannon on the ramparts, and thus secured possession of the Po
+gate, and, pushing on, the guns helping them, drove the Austrians
+from the houses they occupied, and so opened communications with
+the French cavalry.</p>
+<p>"A brigadier now came up, and ordered the battalions to
+barricade all the streets they had won, with barrels and carts. A
+French regiment arrived, and occupied the church of Saint Salvador,
+and the battery which commanded the bridge, across which
+Vaudemont's corps could now be seen approaching. The redoubt on the
+other side of the bridge was only held by fifty men, and they were
+now strengthened by a hundred of the French soldiers. The Austrians
+approached, making sure that the town had already been taken, and
+looking out for a signal that was to be hoisted. Their astonishment
+was great, when a heavy musketry fire was opened upon them by the
+garrison of the outpost, while the guns of the battery on the wall
+plunged their shot in among them.</p>
+<p>"The column was at once halted. Eugene had regarded the struggle
+as over, when news was brought to him of the defeat of Mercy's
+corps by the Irish. Everywhere else things had gone most
+favourably. Marshal Villeroy had been wounded and made prisoner.
+His <em>marechal de camp</em> shared the same fate. The Chevalier
+D'Entregues, who advanced to meet the enemy, was defeated and
+killed, as was Lieutenant General de Trenan, and the Spanish
+Governor of the town mortally wounded.</p>
+<p>"On receiving the news, Eugene at once sent an officer to
+inspect the Irish position; but his report was that they were too
+well placed to be driven from it. He then sent Captain MacDonnell,
+an officer in his service, to offer, if the Irish would leave their
+position, to enrol them in the Austrian service, with higher pay
+than they now received. You may guess the sort of answer he
+received, and he was at once arrested for bringing such a message
+to them. Eugene then endeavoured to engage Marshal Villeroy to
+order the Irish to lay down their arms, as further resistance would
+only end in their slaughter. Villeroy simply replied that, as a
+prisoner, he could no longer give orders.</p>
+<p>"During this pause, the Count de Revel and the Marquis de
+Queslin succeeded in gathering together a considerable number of
+the scattered French infantry, and with these they marched to
+endeavour to recover the gates that had been lost, and, having
+occupied the church of Santa Maria, and a bastion near the gate of
+All Saints, ordered the Irish to leave a hundred men at the
+barricades, and with the rest to push forward to the gate of
+Mantua. So I found myself in command of a full company.</p>
+<p>"O'Mahony was now in command of the two regiments, as Wauchop
+had been wounded. It was pretty hard work they had of it, and they
+suffered heavily in carrying the guardhouse, held by two hundred
+Austrians. Eugene now launched a great force against our people,
+and attacked them on all sides; but O'Mahony faced them each way,
+and received the charge of the cuirassiers with so heavy a fire
+that they fled in disorder. Another corps of cuirassiers came up,
+and these charged with such fury that their leader, Monsieur de
+Freiberg, pushed his way into the middle of Dillon's regiment,
+where he was surrounded, and, refusing quarter, was killed; and his
+men, disheartened by the fall of their leader, fled, carrying with
+them the infantry who were ranged in their rear.</p>
+<p>"But our men were now exhausted by their exertions, and suffered
+heavily; and O'Mahony, seeing that he was likely to be attacked by
+fresh troops, and that my post guarding the approach of the Po gate
+would then be left altogether unsupported, returned to it. I was
+glad enough when I saw them coming, for it was mighty trying work
+being left there, and hearing the storm of battle going on all
+round, and knowing that at any moment we might be attacked.</p>
+<p>"They did not stop long, for orders came from Revel, who had
+captured the gate of All Saints, and was preparing to attack Saint
+Margaret's, to march again to the gate of Mantua. It seemed a
+hopeless enterprise. Captain Dillon, of Dillon's regiment, marched
+out and, after hard fighting, drove the Austrians from house to
+house; but, on reaching a spot where the ground was open, he was
+attacked on all sides, and for a time the enemy and our men were
+mixed up together in a melee.</p>
+<p>"I could hear by the sound of the firing that our men were
+returning, and posted my fellows so as to cover their retreat; and
+as they came back, hotly pressed by the enemy, we opened so warm a
+fire that they passed in through the gate of the barrier in safety,
+but only half as strong as they had gone out.</p>
+<p>"As soon as they were in, they aided us in strengthening the
+position. Seeing that Vaudemont's corps was on the point of
+attacking the redoubt, the Marquis de Queslin sent orders to the
+little garrison there to withdraw across the bridge, and destroy
+the boats. This they effected, in spite of the heavy fire kept up
+by the enemy.</p>
+<p>"In the meantime, fighting had been going on all over the town.
+The gate of Mantua had been held by Captain Lynch, of Dillon's
+battalion, and thirty-five men. As soon as he heard the din of
+battle in the town, he collected a few fugitives, entrenched his
+position at the guardhouse, and maintained it for the whole day;
+not only that, but, finding that his position was commanded by a
+party of Austrians, who had taken post in the church of Saint
+Marie, close by, he sallied out, drove them from the church, and
+maintained possession of that as well; until, late in the
+afternoon, he was reinforced by two companies of our regiment, who
+made their way this time without opposition.</p>
+<p>"The enemy fell back, but not unmolested, as, sallying out, we
+pressed hotly upon them. There now remained only the gate of Saint
+Margaret in the hands of the Austrians. Here a large body of troops
+had been stationed, and succeeded in repulsing the repeated attacks
+made upon them by Revel's force.</p>
+<p>"The fight had now lasted for eleven hours, and the position of
+the Austrians had become critical. The desperate resistance of our
+men had entirely changed the position. They had repulsed every
+attack upon them, had given time for the scattered French to
+gather, and the one gate remaining in Eugene's possession was
+seriously threatened. Vaudemont's corps was helpless on the other
+side of the river, and could render no assistance, and Eugene gave
+the order for his troops to retire, which they did in good
+order.</p>
+<p>"It had been a hot day, indeed, for us, and we were only too
+glad to see them go. We had lost three hundred and fifty men, out
+of the six hundred with which we began the fight; altogether, the
+garrison had lost, in killed, wounded, and in prisoners, fourteen
+hundred men and officers, while Eugene's loss was between fifteen
+and sixteen hundred.</p>
+<p>"Personally, I have had hotter fighting, but taking the day
+altogether, it was the most terrible through which I have ever
+passed. Throughout the day we were in total ignorance of what was
+going on elsewhere, though we knew, by the firing in other parts of
+the town, that the French there had not been overpowered, and, each
+time the regiments left us, I was expecting every moment to be
+attacked by an overwhelming force. Faith, it was enough to make
+one's hair white! However, I have no reason to grumble. I obtained
+great praise for the defence of the barrier, and was given my
+majority; and, if it had not been for the wound I received, two
+years ago, which incapacitated me from active service, I might now
+be in command of the regiment."</p>
+<p>"Yes, indeed," another officer said. "It was truly a gallant
+affair; and, although our men had fought equally as well in many
+another engagement, it was their conduct at Cremona that attracted
+the greatest attention, and showed the French the value of the
+Brigade. I would we had always been employed in actions on which we
+could look back, with the same pride and pleasure, as we can upon
+Cremona and a long list of battles where we bore the brunt of the
+fighting; and never failed to be specially mentioned with praise by
+the general.</p>
+<p>"The most unpleasant work that I ever did was when under Marshal
+de Catinat. Eight Irish battalions were sent up, in 1694, from
+Pignerolle into the valley of La Perouse, to oppose the Vaudois,
+who had always offered a vigorous resistance to the passage of our
+troops through their passes. They were wild mountaineers, and
+Huguenots to a man, who had, I believe, generations ago been forced
+to fly from France and take refuge in the mountains, and maintained
+themselves sturdily against various expeditions sent against
+them.</p>
+<p>"I own the business was not at all to my taste, and many others
+of our officers shared my opinions. It was too much like what we
+remembered so bitterly at home, when William's troopers pursued our
+fugitives to the hills, burning, destroying, and killing, and,
+above all, hunting down the priests. This was the other way, but
+was as cruel and barbarous. The poor people had given no offence,
+save that they held to their own religion. An Irishman should be
+the last to blame another for that, and, seeing they had
+successfully opposed the efforts of the French to root them out, it
+was much against my will that I marched with my regiment. I hope
+that, when it comes to fighting against regular troops, of whatever
+nationality, I am ready to do my work; but to carry fire and sword
+among a quiet people, in little mountain villages, went against the
+grain.</p>
+<p>"It seemed to us that it was to be a massacre rather than
+fighting, but there we were mistaken. It was the hardest work that
+I ever went through. It was impossible in such a country to move in
+large bodies, and we were broken up into small parties, which
+advanced into the hills, each under its own commander, without any
+fixed plans save to destroy every habitation, to capture or kill
+the flocks of goats, which afforded the inhabitants their chief
+means of subsistence, and to give no quarter wherever they
+resisted.</p>
+<p>"Even now, I shudder at the thought of the work we had to do;
+climbing over pathless hills, wading waist deep through mountain
+torrents, clambering along on the face of precipices where a false
+step meant death, and always exposed to a dropping fire from
+invisible foes, who, when we arrived at the spot from which they
+had fired, had vanished and taken up a fresh position, so that the
+whole work had to be done over again. Sometimes we were two or even
+more days without food, for, as you may imagine, it was impossible
+to transport provisions, and we had nothing save what we carried in
+our haversacks at starting. We had to sleep on the soaked ground,
+in pitiless storms. Many men were carried away and drowned in
+crossing the swollen torrents. Our clothes were never dry. And the
+worst of it was, after six weeks of such work, we felt that we were
+no nearer to the object for which we had been sent up than we were
+when we started.</p>
+<p>"It was true that we had destroyed many of their little
+villages, but as these generally consisted of but a few houses,
+only rough buildings that could be rebuilt in a few days, the gain
+was not a substantial one. We had, of course, killed some of the
+Vaudois, but our loss had been much heavier than theirs, for,
+active as our men were, they were no match in speed for these
+mountaineers, who were as nimble as their own goats, knew
+everything of the country, and could appear or disappear, as it
+seemed to us, almost by magic. It was a wretched business, and once
+or twice, when our parties were caught in the narrow ravines, they
+were overwhelmed by rocks thrown down from above; so that, on the
+whole, we lost almost as many men as we should have done in a
+pitched battle, gaining no credit, nor having the satisfaction that
+we were doing good service to France.</p>
+<p>"I hope I may never be employed in a business like that again.
+It was not only the Vaudois that we had to fight, for, seeing that
+at first we were pushing forward steadily, the Duke of Savoy, under
+whose protection they lived, sent six hundred regular troops to
+assist them, and these, who were well commanded, adopted the same
+tactics as the peasants, avoiding all our attempts to bring on an
+engagement, and never fighting except when they had us to great
+advantage.</p>
+<p>"As a rule, our men were always dissatisfied when they received
+orders to fall back, but I think that there was not a man among us
+but was heartily glad, when we were recalled to rejoin Catinat at
+Pignerolle."</p>
+<p>The expedition, however, although altogether unsuccessful in
+rooting out the Vaudois, created such terrible devastation in the
+mountains and valleys that the Irish name and nation will long
+remain odious to the Vaudois. Six generations have since passed
+away, but neither time nor subsequent calamities have obliterated
+the impression made by the waste and desolation of this military
+incursion.</p>
+<p>"You were at Blenheim, were you not, Captain O'Donovan?"</p>
+<p>"Yes. A tough fight it was, and a mismanaged one. I was in the
+Earl of Clare's regiment, which, with Lee and Dorrington's
+battalions, was stationed with the force in Oberglau in the centre
+of our position. It seemed to us, and to our generals, that our
+position was almost impregnable. It lay along a ridge, at the foot
+of which was a rivulet and deep swampy ground. On the right of the
+position was the village of Blenheim, held by twenty-seven
+battalions of good French infantry, twelve squadrons, and
+twenty-four pieces of cannon. Strong entrenchments had been thrown
+up round our position, but these were not altogether completed.
+Blenheim, moreover, had been surrounded by very heavy and strong
+palisades, altogether impassable by infantry, and, as the allies
+could not hope to get cannon across the stream and swamps, it
+seemed to defy any attack. From Oberglau the army of Marshal de
+Marcin and the Elector stretched to the village of Lutzingen. We
+had some five-and-twenty cannon at Oberglau.</p>
+<p>"The weak point, as it afterwards turned out to be, was the
+crest between us and Blenheim. Considering that both the artillery
+and musketry fire from both villages swept the slope, and as in
+numbers we equalled the enemy, it was thought well-nigh impossible
+for him to cross the swamps and advance to the attack; and almost
+the whole of the French cavalry were massed on the crest, in order
+to charge them, should they succeed in crossing and try to ascend
+the slope.</p>
+<p>"At first the battle went altogether favourably. We had opposite
+to us the English, Dutch, Hanoverians, and Danish troops under
+Marlborough, while facing our left were Prussians, Imperialists,
+and other German troops under Eugene. Marlborough's Danish and
+Hanoverian cavalry first crossed, but were at once charged and
+driven back. Then they tried again, supported by English infantry.
+Then Marlborough led up a still stronger force, drove back our
+light cavalry, and began to ascend the hill. We were attacked by
+ten battalions--Hanoverians, Danes, and Prussians, while the
+English bore against Blenheim. The fighting at both places was
+desperate, and I must do the Germans the justice to say that
+nothing could have exceeded the gallantry they showed, and that, in
+spite of the heavy fire we maintained, they pressed up the
+slope.</p>
+<p>"We remained in our entrenchments, till it could be seen that
+the English were falling back from Blenheim, whose palisade, manned
+by twenty-seven battalions of infantry, offered an obstacle that
+would have defied the best troops in the world to penetrate.</p>
+<p>"Immediately this was seen, nine battalions, headed by our three
+regiments, leapt from the trenches and poured down on the Germans.
+The enemy could not withstand our onslaught. Two of their regiments
+were utterly destroyed, the rest suffered terribly, and were driven
+back. On the left, Marcin held his ground against all the attacks
+of Eugene, and it seemed to us that the battle was won.</p>
+<p>"However, it was not over yet. While the fierce fighting had
+been going on in front of Oberglau and Blenheim, Marlborough had
+passed the whole of his cavalry and the rest of his infantry across
+the rivulet, and, in spite of artillery and musketry fire, these
+moved up in grand order, the infantry inclining towards the two
+villages as before, the cavalry bearing straight up the slope, and,
+when they reached the crest, charging furiously upon our horse
+stationed there. They were superior in numbers, but on this head
+accounts differ. At any rate, they overthrew our cavalry, who fled
+in the greatest disorder, pursued by the allied horse.</p>
+<p>"The infantry poured into the gap thus made, Blenheim was
+entirely isolated, and we were exposed to assault both in front and
+rear. Nevertheless, we repulsed all attacks, until Marcin sent
+orders for us to retire; then we sallied out, after setting fire to
+the village, flung ourselves upon the enemy, and succeeded in
+cutting our way through, our regiment forming the rear guard. The
+whole of Marcin's army were now in full retreat, harassed by the
+allied cavalry; but whenever their squadrons approached us, we
+faced about and gave them so warm a reception that they attacked
+less formidable foes. As for the garrison in Blenheim, you know
+they were at last surrounded by Marlborough's whole force, with
+artillery; and with the Danube in their rear, and no prospect of
+succour, they were forced to surrender.</p>
+<p>"It was a disastrous day, and I have not yet recovered from the
+wound I received there. Had five thousand infantry been posted in a
+redoubt, halfway between Blenheim and Oberglau, so as to give
+support to our cavalry, the result of the battle would have been
+very different. Still, I suppose that most battles are lost by some
+unlooked-for accident--some mistake in posting the troops. We can
+only say that, had the allied forces been all composed of such
+troops as those Eugene commanded, they would have been beaten
+decisively; and that had, on the contrary, Eugene commanded such
+troops as those under Marlborough, Marcin would never have held his
+ground."</p>
+<p>"How many British troops were there in the battle, Captain
+O'Donovan?"</p>
+<p>"Somewhere about twelve thousand, while the Continental troops
+were forty-seven or forty-eight thousand. There is no doubt that
+they were the backbone of the force, just as we flatter ourselves
+that our three regiments were the backbone of the defence of
+Oberglau."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch3" id="Ch3">Chapter 3</a>: A Strange Adventure.</h2>
+<p>When the party broke up, O'Neil and O'Sullivan, as usual, came
+in for a quiet chat to Desmond's room.</p>
+<p>"As we may be possibly ordered to Spain," Kennedy said, "I
+should like to know a little about what we are going to fight
+about; for, although I know a good deal about the war in Flanders,
+no news about that in Spain ever reached Kilkargan."</p>
+<p>"Well, you know, of course," O'Neil said, "that Philip the Fifth
+is a grandson of Louis; and is naturally supported by France
+against the Archduke Charles of Austria, who is competitor for the
+throne, and who is, of course, supported by England. Six thousand
+English and Dutch troops were sent to aid the Archduke Charles in
+his attempt to invade Spain and dethrone Philip. The King of
+Portugal, who is a member of the allied confederacy, promised to
+have everything ready to cooperate with them. They found, however,
+on their arrival, that no preparations had been made, and they were
+accordingly distributed, for a time, among the garrisons on the
+frontier.</p>
+<p>"Philip, on his part, had not been so inactive, and two
+armies--the one commanded by the Duke of Berwick, and the other by
+General Villadarias--invaded Portugal. Berwick surprised and
+captured two Dutch battalions, and then captured Portalagre, and
+compelled the garrison, including an English regiment of infantry,
+to surrender.</p>
+<p>"The allies, to make a diversion, sent General Das Minas into
+Spain, with fifteen thousand men, who captured one or two towns and
+defeated a body of French and Spanish troops. The hot weather now
+set in, and put a stop to hostilities, and the troops on both sides
+went into quarters. The general--I forget his name--who commanded
+the English and Dutch contingent, was so disgusted with the
+proceedings of the Portuguese that he resigned his command, and the
+Earl of Galway was appointed in his place. The next year he crossed
+the frontier, captured several towns, without much fighting, and
+invested Badajos. Here, however, a stern resistance was met with.
+Galway's hand was carried off by a shot, and the French general
+(Tesse) coming up in force to the relief of the town, and the
+Portuguese not arriving at all, the allies were obliged to fall
+back upon Portugal. But Philip was threatened from a fresh
+quarter.</p>
+<p>"In June, the Earl of Peterborough sailed from Portsmouth with
+five thousand men, and at Lisbon took on board the Archduke
+Charles. At Gibraltar some more troops were embarked, and
+Peterborough set sail for the coast of Valencia. Peterborough
+himself, one of the most daring of men, and possessed of
+extraordinary military talent, was in favour of a march upon
+Madrid; but, fortunately for us, he was overruled, and commenced
+the siege of Barcelona--a strong town garrisoned by five thousand
+good troops, while he himself had but a thousand more under his
+command. Nevertheless, by a sudden and daring attack he captured
+the strong castle of Montjuich, which commanded the town, which was
+in consequence obliged to surrender four days later, and the whole
+of Catalonia was then captured. Saint Matteo, ninety miles from
+Barcelona, which had declared for Charles and was besieged by a
+large force, was relieved; and so brilliant were the exploits
+accomplished by Peterborough, with most inadequate means, that the
+Spaniards came to the conclusion that he was possessed by an evil
+spirit.</p>
+<p>"Large reinforcements were sent from France, and King Philip
+advanced upon Barcelona, and invested it by land, while a French
+fleet bombarded it by sea. Peterborough hurried, with a small force
+from Valencia, to aid the besieged, the matter being all the more
+important since Charles himself was in the city. Before his
+arrival, however, an English fleet appeared, and our fleet
+retired.</p>
+<p>"Philip at once raised the siege, and retired to Madrid. His
+position was indeed serious. Lord Galway was advancing from the
+frontier, and Peterborough had gathered a force to cooperate with
+him. Upon the approach of Galway, Philip and the Duke of Berwick
+retreated to the frontier. There they received great
+reinforcements, and advanced against Madrid, which was evacuated by
+Galway, who marched away to form a junction with Lord
+Peterborough.</p>
+<p>"Owing to the dilatory habits and hesitation of the Austrian
+prince, the junction was not effected for some time, and then, in
+spite of the entreaties of the two English generals, he could not
+be persuaded to make a movement towards Madrid. Peterborough, whose
+temper was extremely fiery, at last lost all patience, abused
+Charles openly, and then, mounting his horse, rode down to the
+coast, embarked upon an English ship of war, and sailed away to
+assist the Duke of Savoy. After his departure, the ill feeling
+between the English force, the Portuguese, and the leaders of the
+Spanish adherents of Charles increased, and they spent their time
+in quarrelling among themselves. They were without money,
+magazines, and almost without provisions. Berwick was near them
+with a superior force, and they took the only step open, of
+retreating towards Valencia, which they reached, after suffering
+great hardships, before Berwick could overtake them.</p>
+<p>"French troops were poured into Spain, while no reinforcements
+were sent from England. Galway and the Portuguese advanced to meet
+the Duke of Berwick, who was marching with a large army to occupy
+Catalonia.</p>
+<p>"The two forces met, on the plain of Almanza, on the 24th of
+April. We and the Spaniards were superior in number to the English,
+Dutch, and Portuguese. The battle was maintained for six hours. The
+Portuguese infantry did little, but the English and Dutch repulsed
+charge after charge, even after the Portuguese and Spanish allies
+on both wings were defeated. But, in the end, victory remained with
+us. Galway and Das Minas, the Portuguese general, were both
+wounded, and five thousand of their men killed, and yet the Dutch
+and English infantry held together.</p>
+<p>"But on the following day, being absolutely without supplies,
+some effected their escape and succeeded in reaching Portugal,
+while the main body surrendered. Valencia, Saragossa, and other
+towns opened their gates to us, and, for a time, the cause of the
+Archduke Charles seemed lost.</p>
+<p>"Our success was, however, balanced by the loss, in the same
+year, of the whole of the Spanish possessions in Italy. As yet, in
+spite of the disasters that had befallen him, the cause of Charles
+was not altogether lost, for he received fresh promises of support
+from England, whose interest it was to continue the war in Spain,
+and thus compel France to keep a considerable body of troops there,
+instead of employing them against Marlborough in Flanders.</p>
+<p>"Galway and Das Minas were taken back to Portugal, in an English
+fleet, after their disaster, and General Stanhope, who, they say,
+is an officer of great military experience and talent, has been
+sent out to take the command; and as a portion of Catalonia is
+still held for Charles, there may yet be a good deal of hard
+fighting, before the matter can be considered finally settled."</p>
+<p>"Thank you, O'Neil. I feel that I know something about it, now.
+Are there any of our regiments there?"</p>
+<p>"Yes, three of them. There is also an Irish regiment in the
+Spanish service, under Colonel Crofton;" and with this, the talk
+ended for the night.</p>
+<p>After three months' work Desmond was dismissed from drill, and
+had obtained such a proficiency with the rapier that he felt that
+he could now relax his work, and see something of the city, which
+he had been hitherto too busy to explore. He had seen the principal
+streets, in the company of his comrades, had admired the mansions
+of the nobles, the richness of the goods exposed to view in the
+windows, and the gaiety and magnificence of the dresses of the
+upper class. His friends had warned him that, if he intended to go
+farther, he should never do so alone, but should take with him his
+soldier servant, a trooper named Mike Callaghan.</p>
+<p>Mike was some twenty-eight years old, strong and bony; his hair
+was red, and the natural colour of his face was obscured by a host
+of freckles; his eyes were blue, and his nose had an upward turn;
+his expression was merry and good humoured, but there was a twinkle
+about his eyes that seemed to show that he was by no means wanting
+in shrewdness.</p>
+<p>"Even in the daytime," O'Neil said, "it is not safe for a man,
+if well dressed and likely to carry money in his pocket, to go into
+some quarters of the town. Paris has always been a turbulent city,
+and, while it is the abode of the richest and noblest of Frenchmen,
+it is also the resort of the rascaldom of all France. Some streets
+are such that even the city guard would not venture to search for
+an ill doer, unless in considerable force and prepared for battle.
+There are, of course, many streets, both on this and the other side
+of the river, where life and property are as safe as in the Rue
+Royal; which, by the way, is not saying much, for it was only three
+days ago that a man was assassinated there in broad daylight. He
+was a captain in the Picardy regiment, and it was supposed that his
+murderer was a man who had been dismissed from the regiment with
+ignominy. But, whoever it was, he has got clear away, for your
+Parisian citizen takes good care not to interfere in such matters,
+and no one thought of laying hands on the villain, although it is
+said he walked quietly off.</p>
+<p>"It is in the streets that I am speaking of that adventures may
+most easily be met with. Here there are too many hotels of the
+nobles, with their numerous retainers, for it to be safe to commit
+crime, and the city guard are generally on the alert, for, were
+harm to come to one of the gentlemen attached to the great houses,
+the matter would be represented to the king, and the city
+authorities would come in for a sharp reproof for their failure to
+keep order in the city; whereas, anything that happens among the
+bourgeois would pass wholly without notice. However, if you keep
+out of the wine shops, you are not likely to become involved in
+trouble. Nine-tenths of the quarrels and tumults originate there.
+There is a dispute, perhaps, between a soldier and a citizen, or
+between soldiers of different regiments, and in a minute or two
+twenty swords are drawn, and the disturbance grows, sometimes,
+until it is necessary to call out troops from the nearest barracks
+to suppress it. However, I know that you are not likely to get into
+trouble that way, for you are a very model of moderation, to the
+corps."</p>
+<p>"I have seen enough of the consequences of drink in Ireland,"
+Desmond said, "to cure me of any desire for liquor, even had I a
+love for it. Faction fights, involving the people of the whole
+barony, arising from some drunken brawl, are common enough; while
+among the better class duels are common and, for the most part, are
+the result of some foolish quarrel between two men heated by wine.
+Besides, even putting that aside, I should have given up the habit.
+When I joined the regiment, I was anxious to become a good
+swordsman, but if one's head is overheated at night, one's hand
+would be unsteady and one's nerves shaken in the morning.</p>
+<p>"Possibly," he added, with a smile, "it is this, quite as much
+as the hotness of their temper, that prevents the best teachers
+from caring to undertake the tuition of the officers of the
+Brigade."</p>
+<p>"Possibly," Phelim laughed, "though I never thought of it
+before. There is no doubt that the French, who, whatever their
+faults be, are far less given to exceeding a fair allowance of wine
+than are our countrymen, would come to their morning lessons in the
+saloon in a better condition to profit by the advice of the master
+than many of our men."</p>
+<p>"I don't think," Patrick O'Neil said, "that we Irishmen drink
+from any particular love of liquor, but from good fellowship and
+joviality. One can hardly imagine a party of French nobles
+inflaming themselves with wine, and singing, as our fellows do.
+Frenchmen are gay in what I may call a feeble way--there is no go
+in it. There is no spirit in their songs, there is no real
+heartiness in their joviality, and the idea of one man playing a
+practical joke upon another, the latter taking it in good part,
+could never enter their heads, for they are ready to take offence
+at the merest trifle.</p>
+<p>"As you know, there are certain cabarets told off for the use of
+the soldiers of the Brigade. They are allowed to use no others, and
+no French troops are allowed to enter these wine shops. Similarly,
+there are certain establishments which are almost exclusively
+patronized by officers of the Brigade. There is, of course, no
+absolute rule here, and we can enter any cabaret we choose; but it
+is understood that it is at our own risk, and that, if we get into
+trouble there, we are sure to be handled over the coals pretty
+sharply, as it is considered that we must deliberately have gone
+there with the intention of picking a quarrel. The cabarets used by
+the men are all close to the barracks, so that, in case of a
+fracas, a guard is sent down to bring all concerned in it back to
+the barracks. Fortunately, there is no need for the places we
+frequent being so close to the barracks, for it is understood that
+anyone who takes too much liquor, outside his own quarters, brings
+discredit on the regiment; and it is after we adjourn to the rooms
+of one or other of us that liquor begins to flow freely, and we
+make a night of it."</p>
+<p>"Don't you ever have quarrels among yourselves?"</p>
+<p>"Angry words pass, sometimes, but all present interfere at once.
+The honour of the regiment is the first point with us all. If men
+want to quarrel, there are plenty of French officers who would be
+quite ready to oblige them, but a quarrel among ourselves would be
+regarded as discreditable to the corps. Consequently, a dispute is
+always stopped before it reaches a dangerous point, and if it goes
+further than usual, the parties are sent for by the colonel in the
+morning, both get heavily wigged, and the colonel insists upon the
+matter being dropped, altogether. As the blood has had time to
+cool, both are always ready to obey his orders, especially as they
+know that he would report them at once to the general, if the
+matter were carried further."</p>
+<p>"Well, I shall certainly not be likely to get into a quarrel
+over wine," Desmond said, "nor indeed, in any other way, unless I
+am absolutely forced into it. As to adventures such as you speak
+of, I am still less likely to be concerned in them. I hope that,
+when we are ordered on service, I shall have a full share of
+adventures such as may become a soldier."</p>
+<p>O'Neil smiled. "Time will show," he said. "Adventures come
+without being sought, and you may find yourself in the thick of
+one, before you have an idea of what you are doing. But mind, if
+you do get into any adventure and need assistance, you are bound to
+let us help you. That is the compact we made, two months ago. We
+agreed to stand by each other, to be good comrades, to share our
+last sous, and naturally to give mutual aid under all and every
+circumstance."</p>
+<p>Desmond nodded.</p>
+<p>"At any rate, O'Neil, adventures cannot be so common as you
+represent, since neither of you, so far, has called upon me for aid
+or assistance."</p>
+<p>"Have you heard the last piece of court scandal, Kennedy?"
+O'Sullivan asked, as the three friends sat down to breakfast
+together, a few days later.</p>
+<p>"No; what is it?"</p>
+<p>"Well, it is said that a certain damsel--her name is, at
+present, a secret--has disappeared."</p>
+<p>"There is nothing very strange about that," O'Neil laughed.
+"Damsels do occasionally disappear. Sometimes they have taken their
+fate into their own hands, and gone off with someone they like
+better than the man their father has chosen for them; sometimes,
+again, they are popped into a convent for contumacy. Well, go on,
+O'Sullivan, that cannot be all."</p>
+<p>"Well, it is all that seems to be certain. You know that I went
+with the colonel, last night, to a ball at the Hotel de Rohan, and
+nothing else was talked about. Several there returned from
+Versailles in the afternoon, and came back full of it. All sorts of
+versions are current. That she is a rich heiress goes without
+saying. If she had not been, her disappearance would have excited
+no attention whatever. So we may take it that she is an heiress of
+noble family. Some say that her father had chosen, as her husband,
+a man she disliked exceedingly, and that she has probably taken
+refuge in a convent. Some think that she has been carried off
+bodily, by someone smitten both by her charms and her fortune. It
+is certain that the king has interested himself much in the matter,
+and expresses the greatest indignation. Though, as it would not
+seem that she is a royal ward, it is not clear why he should
+concern himself over it. Some whisper that the king's anger is but
+feigned, and that the girl has been carried off by one of his
+favourites."</p>
+<p>"Why should such a thing as that be supposed?" Desmond asked,
+indignantly.</p>
+<p>"Well, there is something in support of the idea. If anyone else
+were to steal away, with or without her consent, a young lady of
+the court with influential friends, he would be likely to pass the
+first two years of his married life in one of the royal prisons;
+and therefore none but a desperate man, or one so secure of the
+king's favour as to feel certain that no evil consequences would
+befall him, would venture upon such a step. You must remember that
+there are not a few nobles of the court who have ruined themselves,
+to keep up the lavish expenditure incumbent upon those who bask in
+the royal favour at Versailles. It would be possible that His
+Majesty may have endeavoured to obtain the hand of this young lady
+for one of his favourites, and that her father may be a noble of
+sufficient consequence to hold his own, and to express to His
+Majesty his regret that he was unable to adopt his recommendation,
+as he had other views for the disposal of her hand.</p>
+<p>"The real singularity of the matter is, that no one can tell
+with certainty who the missing lady is. Early in the day half a
+dozen were named, but as I believe all of these put in an
+appearance at the reception in the afternoon, it is evident that,
+so far as they were concerned, there were no foundations for the
+rumour. It may be taken for certain, however, that her friends are
+powerful people, to have been able to impose silence upon those
+acquainted with the facts."</p>
+<p>"Well, it is impossible to take very much interest in the
+story," Desmond said carelessly, "when we are in ignorance of the
+very name of the lady, and of the important point, whether she has
+voluntarily gone away either with a lover or to a convent, or
+whether she has been carried off against her will. If the latter,
+you were talking of adventures, O'Neil, and this would be just the
+sort of adventure that I should like; for us three to discover the
+maiden, and rescue her from her abductor."</p>
+<p>The others both laughed loudly.</p>
+<p>"And this is the young officer who, the other day, declared that
+he wished for no adventures save those that came in the course of a
+campaign, and now he is declaring that he would like to become a
+very knight errant, and go about rescuing damsels in distress!"</p>
+<p>"I have no idea of carrying it into execution," Desmond said.
+"It was merely an expression of a wish. Of course, if the lady in
+question went willingly and to avoid persecution, I would rather
+help than hinder her; but if she has been carried off by some
+ruined courtier, nothing would please me better than to rescue her
+from him."</p>
+<p>Several days had passed, and at last it was confidently believed
+that the missing lady was the daughter of Baron Pointdexter, a
+magnate of Languedoc, who had but recently come up to court, on an
+intimation from the king that it was a long time since he had been
+seen there, and that His Majesty hoped that he would be accompanied
+by his daughter, of whose beauty reports had reached him. It was
+certain that neither she nor her father had attended any of the
+receptions or fetes at Versailles, since the rumour first spread,
+although the baron had had a private interview with the king a few
+hours afterwards, and had left his chamber with a frowning brow,
+that showed that the interview had not been a pleasant one. He had
+not again appeared at court, whether in consequence of the royal
+command, or not, no one knew.</p>
+<p>The baron was one of the richest proprietors in the south of
+France. He was a specimen of the best type of the French nobles,
+preferring to spend his time among his own wide estates to coming
+up to the capital, where his visits had at all times been rare.</p>
+<p>During the daytime, Desmond went out but little. When the hours
+of drill and exercise were over, he spent some time in visiting the
+quarters of the men of his company, making their personal
+acquaintance, and chatting freely with them. They were glad to hear
+from him about their native country; and, as some of them came from
+his own neighbourhood, they took a lively interest in the news--the
+first that had reached them for years--of families with whom they
+were acquainted. He spent two or three hours in the afternoons in
+the <em>salle d'armes</em> of the regiment, or at the schools of
+one or other of the <em>maitres d'armes</em> most in vogue, and
+then paid visits, with one or other of the officers of the
+regiment, to great houses of which they had the entree.</p>
+<p>Of an evening he went out, accompanied by Mike Callaghan, and
+wandered about the less fashionable part of the town, which pleased
+him better than the more crowded and busy quarters.</p>
+<p>One evening, he had gone farther than usual, had passed through
+the gates, and had followed the road by the banks of the river. As
+an officer in uniform, he was able to re-enter the town after the
+gates were closed, the rules being by no means strict, as, during
+the reign of Louis the 14th, France, though engaged in frequent
+wars abroad, was free from domestic troubles.</p>
+<p>Presently, he passed a lonely house of some size, standing back
+from the road and surrounded by a high wall. As he did so, he heard
+a scream in a female voice, followed by angry exclamations from two
+male voices, while loudly rose a woman's cries for help.</p>
+<p>"There is bad work of some sort going on in there," he said to
+Mike. "We had better see what it is all about. Do you go round the
+wall by the right, and I will go round by the left, and see if
+there is any way by which we can climb over."</p>
+<p>They met at the back of the house. The wall was unbroken, save
+by the gates in front.</p>
+<p>"The wall is too high for us to climb, Mike," Desmond said.
+"Even if I stood on your head, I could not reach the top. Let us go
+round to the front again."</p>
+<p>They returned, and closely scrutinized the gate. It was not so
+high as the wall itself, but was fully twelve feet.</p>
+<p>"I have got a pistol with me, your honour," Mike said. "I have
+seen doors blown in, by firing a gun through the keyhole."</p>
+<p>"That would do, if we were sure that there were no bars, Mike;
+but the chances are that it is barred, as well as locked. Besides,
+I am sure that we should not be justified in blowing in the door of
+a private house. It may be that they were the cries of a mad woman.
+I would rather get over as quietly as possible."</p>
+<p>"Well, sir, I will stand against it, and if you will get on to
+my shoulders and put your foot on my head, you will reach the top.
+Then, if you lower one end of your sash to me, I can pull myself up
+beside you."</p>
+<p>"Yes, I think we can manage it that way, Mike. I am convinced
+that there is something wrong going on here, and I don't mind
+taking the risk of getting into a scrape by interfering. Now do you
+stoop a bit, so that I can get on to your shoulder; then you can
+raise yourself to your full height. Take off your hat, first. I
+shall certainly have to put my foot on your head."</p>
+<p>"All right, your honour. Don't you be afraid of hurting me. My
+skull is thick enough to stand the weight of two of you."</p>
+<p>In a minute, Desmond had his fingers on the top of the gates,
+drew himself up, and, moving to the corner, where he could get his
+back against the end of the wall, lowered his sash to Mike.</p>
+<p>"You are sure I shall not pull you down?"</p>
+<p>"I am not sure, but we will try, anyhow."</p>
+<p>This was said in a whisper, for there might, for anything he
+knew, be two or three men in the garden. Mike took off his boots,
+so as to avoid making a noise. Desmond was sitting astride of the
+gate, and had his end of the sash over the top of it, and under his
+leg, thereby greatly reducing the strain that would be thrown on
+it, and then leaning with all his weight on it, where it crossed
+the gate. Mike was an active as well as a strong man, and speedily
+was by his side.</p>
+<p>"Now we will drop down," Desmond said, and, setting the example,
+lowered himself till he hung by his hands, and then dropped. Mike
+was soon beside him.</p>
+<p>"What shall we do next?"</p>
+<p>"We will go and knock boldly at the door; but before we do that,
+we will unbar the gate and shoot the bolt of the lock. We have no
+idea how many men there may be in the house. Maybe we shall have to
+beat a retreat."</p>
+<p>The lock was shot without difficulty, but the bolts were still
+fast, and were not drawn without noise. They pushed back the last
+of these, and then opened the gates, which creaked noisily as they
+did so.</p>
+<p>"They can hardly help hearing that," Desmond muttered; and
+indeed, as he spoke, the door of the house opened suddenly, and
+five men came out, two of them holding torches. A man, who seemed
+to be the leader of the party, uttered an exclamation of fury as
+the light fell upon the figures of the two men at the open
+gate.</p>
+<p>"Cut the villains down!" he shouted.</p>
+<p>"Stop!" Desmond cried, in a loud voice. "I am an officer of
+O'Brien's regiment of foot. I heard a scream, and a woman's cry for
+help, and, fearing that foul play was going on, I made my entry
+here."</p>
+<p>The man, who had drawn his sword, paused.</p>
+<p>"You have done wrong, sir. The cries you heard were those of a
+mad woman. You had better withdraw at once. I shall report you,
+tomorrow, for having forcibly made an entrance into private
+premises."</p>
+<p>"That you are perfectly at liberty to do," Desmond replied
+quietly; "but certainly I shall not withdraw, until I see this
+lady, and ascertain from herself whether your story is a true
+one."</p>
+<p>"Then your blood be on your own head!" the man said.</p>
+<p>"At them, men! you know your orders--to kill anyone who
+attempted to interfere with us, no matter what his rank."</p>
+<p>The five men rushed together upon the intruders.</p>
+<p>"Hold the gate, Mike," Desmond said, "and they cannot get behind
+us."</p>
+<p>They stepped back a pace or two, and drew their swords. The
+position was a favourable one, for the two halves of the gate
+opened inwards, and so protected them from any but an attack in
+front. The leader rushed at Desmond, but the latter guarded the
+sweeping blow he dealt at him, and at the first pass ran him
+through the body; but the other four men, enraged rather than
+daunted by the fall of their leader, now rushed forward together,
+and one of them, drawing a pistol, fired at Desmond when within
+three paces.</p>
+<p>The latter threw his head on one side, as he saw the pistol
+levelled. The action saved his life, for it was well aimed, and the
+bullet would have struck him full between the eyes. As it was, he
+felt a sharp sudden pain, as it grazed his cheek deeply. He sprang
+forward, and before the man could drop the pistol and change his
+sword from the left hand to the right, Desmond's weapon pierced his
+throat. At the same moment, Mike cut down one of his assailants
+with his sabre, receiving, however, a severe cut on the left
+shoulder from the other.</p>
+<p>Paralysed at the loss of three of their number, the remaining
+two of the assailants paused, for a moment. It was fatal to one of
+them, for Mike snatched his pistol from his pocket, and shot the
+man who had wounded him, dead. The other threw down his sword, and
+fell upon his knees, crying for mercy.</p>
+<p>"Shall I kill him, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"No. Fasten his hands behind him, with his own belt; and bind
+his ankles tightly together, with that of one of his comrades."</p>
+<p>He paused, while Mike adroitly carried out his instructions.</p>
+<p>"Now we will see what this is all about," Desmond said. "I don't
+suppose that there are any more of them in the house. Still, we may
+as well keep our swords in readiness."</p>
+<p>Picking up one of the torches that had fallen from their
+assailants' hands, and holding it above his head with his left
+hand, while his right held his sword ready for action, Desmond
+entered the house. The sitting rooms on both sides of the hall were
+empty, but, upon entering the kitchen, he found an old woman
+crouching in a corner, in the extremity of fear.</p>
+<p>"Stand up. I am not going to hurt you," Desmond said. "Lead us,
+at once, to the chamber of the lady we heard call out."</p>
+<p>The old woman rose slowly, took down a key hanging from a peg,
+and, leading the way upstairs, opened a door.</p>
+<p>"Keep a watch upon the crone," Desmond said, as he entered.</p>
+<p>As he did so, his eye fell upon a girl of some seventeen years
+old. She was standing at the window, with her hands clasped. She
+turned round as he entered, and, as her eye fell upon his uniform,
+she gave a cry of delight.</p>
+<p>"Ah, monsieur, you have rescued me! I heard the fight in the
+garden, and knew that the good God had sent someone to my aid. But
+you are wounded, sir. Your face is streaming with blood."</p>
+<p>"'Tis but the graze of a pistol ball," he said, "and needs but a
+bowl of water, and a strip of plaster, to put it right. I had
+well-nigh forgotten it.</p>
+<p>"I am glad, indeed, to have been able to render you this
+service, mademoiselle. It was most providential that I happened to
+come along the road, and heard your screams and cries for aid; and
+I determined to see if any foul business was being carried on here.
+What made you call out?"</p>
+<p>"I had let myself down from the window, by knotting the
+bedclothes together. I was blindfolded, when they carried me in
+here, and did not know that the walls were so high all round, but
+had hoped to find some gate by which I might escape. There were
+only the great gates, and these were locked; and I was trying to
+draw the bolts when two of the men suddenly rushed out. I suppose
+the old woman came up here, and found the room empty. It was then
+that I screamed for help, but they dragged me in, in spite of my
+struggles, and one said I might scream as much as I liked, for
+there was not a house within hearing, and no one would be passing
+anywhere near.</p>
+<p>"When he said that, I quite gave up hope. I had believed that I
+was in some lonely house, in the suburbs of the city, and I little
+thought that my cries could not be heard.</p>
+<p>"But where are the men who guarded me?"</p>
+<p>"Four of them are dead, mademoiselle, and the other securely
+bound. Now, if you will tell me who you are, and where your friends
+live, I and my soldier servant will escort you to them."</p>
+<p>"My name is Anne de Pointdexter."</p>
+<p>Desmond was scarcely surprised, for the care which had been
+taken in choosing so lonely a spot for her concealment, and the
+fact that an officer and four men should be placed there to guard
+her, showed that she must have been regarded as a prisoner of
+importance.</p>
+<p>"Then I am glad, indeed, to have been the means of rescuing you.
+All Paris has been talking of your disappearance, for the past ten
+days. The question is, what would you wish done? It is too far to
+take you to Versailles tonight, and too late to obtain means of
+conveyance."</p>
+<p>"There is a carriage in the stables behind the house, and there
+are some horses. I cannot say how many, but at night I have heard
+them stamping. I suppose the carriage was left here so that they
+could remove me to some other place, in case suspicion should fall
+upon this house. How many are there of you, monsieur?"</p>
+<p>"Only myself, and the trooper you see at the door."</p>
+<p>"And did you two fight with five men, and kill four of them!"
+she exclaimed, in surprise. "How brave of you, monsieur, and how
+good to run such risk, for a person of whom you knew nothing!"</p>
+<p>"I knew that it was a woman in distress," Desmond said, "and
+that was quite enough to induce two Irishmen to step in, and answer
+to her cry for aid. However, mademoiselle, if the carriage and
+horses are there, this will get us out of our difficulty. The only
+question is, will you start at once, or wait until daylight? We may
+be stopped by the patrols, as we approach Versailles, but I have no
+doubt that my uniform will suffice to pass us into the town, where
+probably your father is still lodging."</p>
+<p>"I would much rather go at once," the girl said. "There are
+others who come, sometimes at all hours of the night."</p>
+<p>"Very well, then, we will see about getting the carriage ready,
+at once. If you will come downstairs, we will lock this old woman
+up in your room."</p>
+<p>This was done at once, and the girl, who was so shaken by her
+captivity that she feared to remain for a moment by herself,
+accompanied her rescuers to the back of the house. Here, as she had
+said, they found a carriage and four horses, two of which stood
+ready saddled, while the others were evidently carriage horses.
+These were speedily harnessed, and put into the carriage.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mike, you had better drive. I will mount one of these
+saddle horses and ride alongside. I think, mademoiselle, as the
+drive will be a long one, it would be as well that we should put
+the old woman in the carriage with you. She will be a companion,
+though one that you would not take from choice. Still, your father
+may wish to question her, and, indeed, it would be better in many
+respects that you should have a female with you."</p>
+<p>"Thank you, Monsieur Kennedy,"--for she had already learned his
+name--she said gratefully, "it would certainly be much better."</p>
+<p>The old woman was therefore brought down, and made to enter the
+carriage, and seat herself facing Mademoiselle Pointdexter. Mike
+took his seat on the box, and Desmond mounted one of the saddle
+horses, and led the other. They had already removed the bodies that
+lay in front of the gates.</p>
+<p>They had to make a considerable detour round Paris, before they
+came down upon the Versailles road. The roads were bad and the
+carriage was heavy, and daylight was already breaking when they
+entered the town. They had twice been stopped by patrols, but
+Desmond's uniform had sufficed to pass them.</p>
+<p>Baron Pointdexter had taken up his abode in a large house,
+standing in a walled garden in the lower part of the town. When
+they reached it, Desmond dismounted and rung the bell. After he had
+done this several times, a step was heard in the garden, and a
+voice asked roughly, "Who is it that rings at this hour of the
+morning?"</p>
+<p>Mademoiselle Pointdexter, who had alighted as soon as the
+carriage stopped, called out, "It is I, Eustace."</p>
+<p>There was an exclamation of surprise and joy, bolts were at once
+drawn, and the gate thrown open, and an old servitor threw himself
+on his knees as the girl entered, and, taking the hand she held out
+to him, put it to his lips.</p>
+<p>"Ah, mademoiselle," he said, while the tears streamed down his
+cheeks, "what a joyful morning it is! We have all suffered, and
+monsieur le baron most of all. He has spoken but a few words, since
+you left, but walks up and down the garden as one distraught,
+muttering to himself, and sometimes even drawing his sword and
+thrusting it at an invisible enemy. He is up, mademoiselle. He has
+never gone to his bed since you were missing."</p>
+<p>As he spoke, the door of the house opened, and the baron hurried
+out, with the question, "What is it, Eustace?"</p>
+<p>Then, as his eye fell on his daughter, he gave a hoarse cry, and
+for a moment swayed, as if he would have fallen. His daughter ran
+up to him, and threw her arms round his neck.</p>
+<p>"Do you return to me safe and well?" he asked, as, after a long
+embrace, he stepped back and gazed into her face.</p>
+<p>"Quite safe and well, father."</p>
+<p>"The Lord be praised!" the baron exclaimed, and, dropping into a
+garden seat by his side, he burst into a passion of sobbing.</p>
+<p>As soon as he had appeared, Desmond had handed over the old
+woman to Eustace.</p>
+<p>"She is a prisoner--keep a watch over her," he said. "She can
+tell much. We will take the carriage round to a stable, and must
+then return at once to Paris, where I must be on duty at seven.
+Please inform the baron that I shall do myself the honour of
+calling, tomorrow, to enquire whether Mademoiselle Pointdexter has
+suffered from the effects of the fatigue and excitement. Express my
+regret that I am obliged to leave at once, but I am sure he will
+have so much to hear, from his daughter, that it is best they
+should be alone together, for a time."</p>
+<p>He at once remounted his horse, Mike climbed up on to his seat,
+and they drove off, and, knocking up the people at some large
+stables, left the carriage and horses there, telling the
+proprietors to send to the Baron Pointdexter to know his wishes
+regarding it. Then Mike mounted the spare horse, and they started
+at full speed for Paris, and arrived at the barracks in time for
+Desmond to take his place at the early parade.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch4" id="Ch4">Chapter 4</a>: At Versailles.</h2>
+<p>The regiment was on the point of falling in, on the parade
+ground, when Desmond Kennedy rode up. Leaping from his horse, he
+threw the reins to his servant.</p>
+<p>"Take them both round to the stables, and put them in spare
+stalls, Mike. I will get leave off parade for both of us, and ask
+the surgeon to dress your wounds properly."</p>
+<p>Then he went up to the colonel, who was just entering the
+barrack yard.</p>
+<p>"Colonel O'Brien," he said, "I must ask your leave off parade,
+for, as you see, I am scarcely in a condition to take my place with
+my company."</p>
+<p>"So it would seem, Mr. Kennedy. You have been in trouble, I see.
+Nothing serious, I hope?"</p>
+<p>"Nothing at all, sir, as far as I am concerned. It is merely a
+graze from a pistol ball."</p>
+<p>"Well, I must hear about it, afterwards."</p>
+<p>"I must also ask leave off parade for Callaghan, my servant,
+sir. He is hurt a good deal more than I am, though not, I hope,
+seriously."</p>
+<p>The colonel nodded. "I will send the surgeon to your quarters,
+and he will see to you both."</p>
+<p>As Desmond left the colonel, his two chums came up.</p>
+<p>"Why, Kennedy, what on earth have you been doing to yourself?
+This is what comes of gallivanting about after dark. When we came
+round, yesterday evening, to go out with you as usual, you were not
+in. There was nothing very unusual in that, for these evening walks
+of yours are often prolonged; but we called again, on our return at
+eleven o'clock, and found you were still absent. This looked
+serious. We came round again at six this morning, for we were
+anxious about you, and learned you had not been in all night, and,
+on enquiring, heard that Callaghan was also absent.</p>
+<p>"That was cheering. That you might get into some scrape or
+other, we could reasonably believe; but, as you had your man with
+you, we could hardly suppose that misfortune had fallen upon both
+of you."</p>
+<p>"The wound is a mere graze. I will tell you, after parade, what
+I have been doing," Desmond said, "but you must nurse your
+curiosity till you are dismissed."</p>
+<p>A few minutes after Desmond reached his quarters, the surgeon
+came in.</p>
+<p>"I do not think that I have any need of your services, doctor. I
+got a piece of plaster, and stuck it on two hours ago, and I have
+no doubt that the wound will heal in a few days."</p>
+<p>"However, I will, with your permission, take it off, Mr.
+Kennedy. It is much better that the wound should be properly
+washed, and some dressing applied to it. It will heal all the
+quicker, and you are less likely to have an ugly scar.</p>
+<p>"It is a pretty deep graze," he said, after he had carefully
+removed the plaster. "An eighth of an inch farther, and it would
+have made your teeth rattle. You had better keep quiet, today.
+Tomorrow morning, if there is no sign of inflammation, I will take
+off the dressing and bandage and put on a plaster--one a third of
+the size that I took off will be sufficient; and as I will use a
+pink plaster, it will not be very noticeable, if you go outside the
+barracks.</p>
+<p>"Where is your man? The colonel told me there were two
+patients.</p>
+<p>"A nasty cut," he said, after examining Mike's wound. "It is
+lucky that it was not a little higher. If it had been, you would
+have bled to death in five minutes. As it is, it is not serious.
+You will have to keep your arm in a sling for a fortnight. You are
+not to attend parade, or mount a horse, until I give you
+leave."</p>
+<p>On the ride from Versailles, Desmond had warned Mike to say no
+word as to the events of the night.</p>
+<p>"I do not know what course the young lady's father may take," he
+said, "and until I do, the matter had better be kept a secret,
+altogether."</p>
+<p>"I will keep a quiet tongue in my head, and no one shall hear
+anything, from me, as to how I got this slice on my shoulder. I
+will just say that it was a bit of a scrimmage I got into, with two
+or three of the street rascals; and the thing is so common that no
+one is likely to ask any further questions about it."</p>
+<p>After the parade was over, O'Neil and O'Sullivan came up to
+Desmond's quarters.</p>
+<p>"Now, Master Kennedy, we have come to receive your confession.
+We gave you credit for being a quiet, decent boy, and now it seems
+that you and that man of yours have been engaged in some
+disreputable riot, out all night, and coming in on two strange
+horses, which, for aught we know, have been carried off by force of
+arms."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"As to the horses, you are not so far wrong as one might expect,
+O'Neil. We rode them this morning from Versailles."</p>
+<p>"From Versailles!" O'Neil repeated. "And what, in the name of
+all the saints, took you to Versailles! I am afraid, Desmond, that
+you are falling into very evil courses.</p>
+<p>"Well, tell us all about it. I shall be glad to be able to
+believe that there is some redeeming feature in this strange
+business."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed, and then said, more seriously, "Well, I have
+had an adventure. Other people were concerned in it, as well as
+myself. I have made up my mind to tell you both, because I know
+that I can depend upon your promises to keep it an absolute
+secret."</p>
+<p>"This sounds mysterious indeed," O'Sullivan said. "However, you
+have our promises. O'Neil and I will be as silent as the
+grave."</p>
+<p>"Well, then, you know how you were chaffing me, the other day,
+about finding Mademoiselle Pointdexter?"</p>
+<p>"You don't mean to say that you have found her, Kennedy?" O'Neil
+exclaimed incredulously.</p>
+<p>"That is what I mean to say, though found is hardly the word,
+since I was not looking for her, or even thinking of her, at the
+time. Still, in point of fact, I accidentally came across the place
+where she was hidden away, and after a sharp skirmish, in which
+Callaghan and I each had to kill two men, we carried her off, and
+delivered her safely to her father this morning."</p>
+<p>The two young officers looked hard at Desmond, to discover if he
+was speaking seriously, for his tone was so quiet, and matter of
+fact, that they could scarce credit that he had passed through such
+an exciting adventure; and the three were so accustomed to hoax
+each other, that it struck them both as simply an invention on the
+part of their comrade, so absolutely improbable did it seem to
+them.</p>
+<p>"Sure you are trying to hoax us, Kennedy," O'Sullivan said.</p>
+<p>"You could not blame me, if I were," Desmond said, with a smile,
+"considering the cock-and-bull stories that you are constantly
+trying to palm off on me. However, you are wrong now. I will tell
+you the affair, just as it happened."</p>
+<p>And he related, in detail, the story of the rescue of
+Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and the manner in which he had conveyed
+her to Versailles.</p>
+<p>"By Saint Bridget, Kennedy, we were not far wrong when we called
+you a knight errant. Well, this is something like an adventure,
+though whether it will end well or ill for you I cannot say. Did
+you learn the name of the person who had the girl carried off?"</p>
+<p>"No. I asked no questions, and indeed had but little
+conversation with her; for, as I have told you, I put her in a
+carriage, with the old hag who was in charge of her, and rode
+myself by the side of it, in case the old woman should try to
+escape."</p>
+<p>"A truly discreet proceeding, Kennedy," O'Neil laughed. "I
+think, if I myself had been in your place, I should have taken a
+seat inside also, where you, of course, could at once have watched
+the old woman, and talked with the young one."</p>
+<p>"I don't think that you would have done anything of the sort,
+O'Neil," Desmond said gravely, "but would have seen, as I did, that
+it was better that she should travel alone, with the old woman,
+till she reached her father's house. Scandal will be busy enough
+with her name, in any case, and it is as well that it should not be
+said that she arrived home, in a carriage, with a young officer of
+O'Brien's Irish regiment."</p>
+<p>"By my faith, Kennedy, it seems to me that you are a Saint
+Anthony and a Bayard rolled into one. But, seriously, you are
+undoubtedly right. Well, it all depends upon who was the man who
+carried her off, as to whether you were fortunate or unfortunate in
+thus having thwarted his designs. If he is some adventurer, your
+action will gain you heaps of credit. If, on the other hand, it was
+one of the king's favourites, seeking to mend his fortunes by
+marrying, it is probable that you will have made a dangerous
+enemy--nay, more, have drawn upon yourself the king's displeasure.
+I should think it likely that, before attempting so desperate an
+action as the carrying off of the Baron Pointdexter's daughter,
+such a man would have assured himself that the king would not view
+the enterprise with displeasure.</p>
+<p>"We may assume that he would not inform His Majesty of any
+particulars, but would put it, hypothetically, that as he was
+getting into sore straits, he thought of mending his fortunes by
+carrying off an heiress--not, of course, one of those of whose
+hands the king had the disposal; and that he trusted that, if he
+succeeded, His Majesty would not view the matter as a grave
+offence. From what I know of Louis, he would reply gravely: 'I
+should be obliged (duke or viscount, as the case might be) to
+express very grave displeasure, and to order you to leave the court
+for a time; but, as the harm would be done, and the young lady
+married to you, it might be that, in time, I should pardon the
+offence.'</p>
+<p>"If this is how things have gone, you may be sure that the king
+will not view, with satisfaction, the man who has interfered with
+his favourite's plan for mending his fortunes."</p>
+<p>Desmond shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+<p>"The king's dissatisfaction would matter very little to me," he
+said, "especially as he could not openly manifest it, without
+making it apparent that he had approved of the scheme."</p>
+<p>"It is not such a trifle as you think, Kennedy. <em>Lettres de
+cachet</em> are not difficult to obtain, by powerful members of the
+court; especially when the person named is a young regimental
+officer, whose disappearance would excite no comment or curiosity,
+save among the officers of his own regiment. The man who carried
+off Mademoiselle Pointdexter must be a bold fellow, and is likely
+to be a vindictive one. No doubt, his object was to keep the young
+lady a prisoner, until she agreed to marry him, and the loss of a
+pretty bride with a splendid fortune is no trifling one, and likely
+to be bitterly resented. Whether that resentment will take the form
+of obtaining an order for your confinement in the Bastille, or
+other royal prison, or of getting you put out of the way by a stab
+in the back, I am unable to say, but in any case, I should advise
+you strongly to give up your fancy for wandering about after dark;
+and when you do go out, keep in the frequented portions of the
+town.</p>
+<p>"Jack Farquharson, who was at Versailles with the colonel last
+week, was speaking of Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and said that she
+was charming. Did you find her so?"</p>
+<p>"I thought nothing about it, one way or the other," Desmond
+said, carelessly. "I only saw her face by torchlight, and she was,
+of course, agitated by what had happened; and indeed, as I was busy
+helping Mike to yoke the horses to the carriage, I had scarcely
+time to look at her. When we reached Versailles it was barely
+daylight. I handed her out of the carriage, and left her to enter
+by herself, as I thought it was better that she should meet her
+father alone. I do not think that I should recognize her, were I to
+meet her in the street."</p>
+<p>"Most insensible youth!" O'Sullivan said, with a laugh;
+"insensible and discreet to a point that, were it not assured, none
+would believe that you had Irish blood in your veins. And so, you
+say you are going over to Versailles tomorrow?"</p>
+<p>"Yes. I left a message with the servant who opened the door, to
+that effect. Of course, I shall be glad to know if the baron
+intends to take any steps against his daughter's abductor, or
+whether he thinks it best not to add to the scandal by stirring up
+matters, but to take her away at once to his estates."</p>
+<p>"He is in a difficult position," O'Neil said gravely. "The young
+lady has been missing for a fortnight. No one knows whether she
+went of her own free will, or against it. Were her father to carry
+her off, quietly, it would excite the worst suspicions. Better by
+far lodge his complaint before the king, proclaim his grievances
+loudly everywhere, and tell the story in all its details. Whichever
+course he takes, evil-minded people will think the worse; but of
+the two evils, the latter seems to me to be the lesser."</p>
+<p>"I suppose it would be," Desmond agreed, "though, for my part, I
+should be heartily glad if I never heard another word about
+it."</p>
+<p>"You are too modest altogether, Kennedy. Whatever rumours may be
+current, concerning the young lady, there can be no doubt that you
+come out splendidly, in that you hear a cry of a woman in distress;
+you scale walls to get in to her assistance; you and your servant
+encounter five of her guards, kill four of them and bind the other;
+rescue the maiden, and carry her off, with flying colours, in the
+carriage of her abductor. My dear Kennedy, you will become an
+object of admiration to all the ladies of the court."</p>
+<p>"That will be absolutely disgusting," Desmond said, angrily. "It
+is almost enough to make one wish that one had never interfered in
+the affair."</p>
+<p>"Pooh, pooh, Kennedy! I am sure that either O'Sullivan or myself
+would give, I was going to say a year's pay, though how one would
+exist without it I don't know, to have been in your place. Why,
+man, if you had captured a standard in battle, after feats of
+superhuman bravery, you would not attract half the attention that
+will fall to you as a consequence of this adventure. Life in the
+court of His Most Christian Majesty is one of the most artificial
+possible. The women hide their faces with powder and patches, lace
+themselves until they are ready to faint, walk with a mincing air,
+and live chiefly upon scandal; but they are women, after all, and
+every woman has a spice of romance in her nature, and such an
+adventure as yours is the very thing to excite their
+admiration."</p>
+<p>"I know nothing about women," Desmond growled, "and don't want
+to know any of them, especially the ladies at the court of
+Louis."</p>
+<p>"Well, of course, Kennedy, if the baron proclaims his wrongs,
+and publishes the circumstances of his daughter's abduction and
+rescue, the seal of silence will be taken from our lips; especially
+as you will, almost to a certainty, be summoned to Versailles to
+confirm the lady's story."</p>
+<p>"I am afraid that that will be so," Desmond said, despondingly.
+"However, it can't be helped, and I suppose one must make the best
+of it."</p>
+<p>To most of the officers who dropped in, in the course of the
+day, to see Desmond and to enquire how he got his wound, he
+abstained from giving any particulars. It was merely said that he
+and Callaghan were suddenly attacked, by five ruffians, whom they
+managed to beat off. Much surprise was expressed that such attack
+should be made upon an officer and a soldier, on whom little
+plunder could be expected, and who would be sure to defend
+themselves stoutly. Several, indeed, expressed some
+incredulity.</p>
+<p>"We do not doubt for a moment, Kennedy, that you were attacked
+by five men, as you say, and that you routed them, but there must
+have been some motive for the attack. These evening strolls of
+yours are suspicious, and I will warrant that there must have been
+a great deal at the bottom of it. Now, can you deny that?"</p>
+<p>"I neither admit nor deny anything," Desmond said, with a smile;
+"enough that, at present, I have told you all that I feel justified
+in telling. I acknowledge that there is more behind it, but at
+present my mouth is sealed on the subject."</p>
+<p>The colonel was among those who came in to see him. To him,
+Desmond said frankly that the affair was altogether out of the
+common, that it was likely that the whole facts would be known
+shortly, but that, as other persons were concerned, he could not
+speak of it until he had obtained their permission.</p>
+<p>"Then I will ask no further," Colonel O'Brien said. "I have seen
+enough of you to know that you would not be concerned in any affair
+that could bring discredit upon the corps. I am curious to know the
+whole story, but am quite content to wait until you feel at liberty
+to tell me."</p>
+<p>The next morning, Desmond took part in the usual work of the
+regiment, and then, mounting his horse, rode to Versailles. On his
+ringing the bell at the house occupied by the Baron de Pointdexter,
+the old servitor, whom he had before seen, opened the gate.</p>
+<p>"The baron is expecting you, monsieur," he said, bowing deeply;
+and, at his call, another servant ran out and took Desmond's horse,
+and led it away to the stable, while Desmond followed the old man
+to the house.</p>
+<p>The door opened as they approached, and the baron, a tall man,
+some fifty years of age, advanced hastily, holding out both
+hands.</p>
+<p>"Monsieur Kennedy," he said, "you have rendered to me the
+greatest service that I have received during my life. No words can
+express the gratitude that I feel, for one who has restored to me
+my only child, just when I had come to believe that she was lost to
+me forever. It was surely her guardian saint who sent you to the
+spot, at that moment."</p>
+<p>"It might have happened to anyone, sir," Desmond said; "surely
+any gentleman, on hearing an appeal for help from a woman in
+distress, would have done just what I did."</p>
+<p>"Let us go in," the baron said. "My daughter has been eagerly
+waiting your coming, especially as she tells me that she does not
+think she said even a word of thanks to you, being overpowered by
+what she had gone through, and by her joy at her sudden and
+unexpected deliverance. Indeed, she says that she scarcely
+exchanged two words with you."</p>
+<p>"There was no opportunity, Baron, for indeed, as soon as she
+told me that there was a carriage and horses in the stable, I was
+too much occupied in getting it ready for her to depart without
+delay, to think of talking."</p>
+<p>They had now entered the house, and, as the baron led the way
+into the sitting room, the girl rose from a fauteuil.</p>
+<p>"This, Monsieur Kennedy, is my daughter, Mademoiselle Anne de
+Pointdexter. It is high time that you were formally presented to
+each other.</p>
+<p>"This, Anne, is the officer who rendered you such invaluable
+service."</p>
+<p>"We meet almost as strangers, mademoiselle," Desmond said,
+deeply bowing, "for I own that I saw so little of your face, the
+other night, that I should hardly have recognized you, had I met
+you elsewhere."</p>
+<p>"I should certainly not have recognized you, Monsieur Kennedy.
+What with my own fright, and, I may say, the condition of your
+face, I had but a faint idea of what you were really like; but I
+certainly did not think that you were so young. You had such a
+masterful way with you, and seemed to know so perfectly what ought
+to be done, that I took you to be much older than you now
+look."</p>
+<p>"I joined the regiment but little more than three months ago,"
+Desmond said, "and am its youngest ensign."</p>
+<p>"Monsieur, I owe to you more than my life, for, had it not been
+for you, I should have been forced into marriage with one whom I
+despise."</p>
+<p>"I cannot think that, mademoiselle. From what I saw of you, I
+should say that you would have resisted all threats, and even
+undergone hopeless imprisonment, rather than yield."</p>
+<p>"There is no saying, Monsieur Kennedy," the baron said. "Anne is
+of good blood, and I know that it would have been hard to break
+down her will, but confinement and hopelessness will tell on the
+bravest spirit. However that may be, she and I are your debtors for
+life."</p>
+<p>"Indeed, Monsieur Kennedy," the girl said, "I pray you to
+believe that I am more grateful to you than words can express."</p>
+<p>"I pray you to say no more about it, mademoiselle. I deem it a
+most fortunate circumstance, that I was able to come to your
+assistance, and especially so, when I found that the lady I had
+rescued was one whose disappearance had made so great a stir; but I
+should have been glad to render such service to one in the poorest
+condition."</p>
+<p>"My daughter said that you asked her no questions, Monsieur
+Kennedy, and you therefore are, I suppose, in ignorance of the name
+of her abductor?"</p>
+<p>"Altogether."</p>
+<p>"It was the Vicomte de Tulle, one who stands very high in the
+regard of the king, and who is one of the most extravagant and
+dissipated, even of the courtiers here. For some time, it has been
+reported that he had nigh ruined himself by his lavish expenditure,
+and doubtless he thought to reestablish his finances by this bold
+stroke.</p>
+<p>"His plans were well laid. He waited until I had gone to Paris
+on business that would keep me there for a day or two. A messenger
+arrived with a letter, purporting to be from me, saying that I
+wished my daughter to join me at once, and had sent a carriage to
+take her to me. Anne is young, and, suspecting no harm, at once
+threw on a mantle and hood, and entered the carriage. It was broad
+daylight, and there was nothing to disquiet her until, on
+approaching the town, the carriage turned off the main road. This
+struck her as strange, and she was just about to ask the question
+where she was being taken, when the carriage stopped in a lonely
+spot, the door was opened, and a man stepped in.</p>
+<p>"Before she had even time to recognize him, he threw a thick
+cloak over her head. She struggled in vain to free herself, but he
+held her fast. Again and again, she tried to cry out, but her mouth
+was muffled by the wrapping. She had heard the blinds of the
+carriage drawn, and finding that her struggles to free herself were
+vain, and receiving no answer to her supplications to be released,
+she remained quiet until the carriage stopped. Then she was lifted
+out, and carried into the house where you found her.</p>
+<p>"The wrapping was removed, and the man who had taken it off,
+and, who by his attire, was a gentleman in the service of some
+noble, said, 'Do not be alarmed, mademoiselle. No harm is intended
+to you. My master is grieved to be obliged to adopt such means, but
+his passion for you is so great that he was driven to this step,
+and it will entirely depend upon yourself when your captivity will
+end.'</p>
+<p>"'Your master, whoever he may be,' Anne said, 'is a contemptible
+villain.'</p>
+<p>"'Naturally, you have a poor opinion of him at present,' the
+fellow said; 'but I am convinced that, in time, you will come to
+excuse his fault. It is wholly due to the depth of the feeling that
+he entertains towards you. There is a woman here who will wait upon
+you. I and my men will not intrude. Our duty is solely to see that
+you do not escape, which indeed would be an impossibility for you,
+seeing that the wall that surrounds the garden is well-nigh fifteen
+feet high, and the gate barred and locked, and the key thereof in
+my pocket.'</p>
+<p>"He called, and the old woman whom you brought here with Anne
+entered, and bid her ascend to the room that had been prepared for
+her.</p>
+<p>"In that respect, she had nothing to complain of. Of course, you
+did not notice it, as you had other things to think of, but it was
+handsomely furnished. There was a bed in an alcove, some flowers on
+the table, some books, and even a harpsichord--evidently it was
+intended that her imprisonment should be made as light as might
+be.</p>
+<p>"Looking from the window, Anne saw that the room was at the back
+of the house, and had probably been chosen because some trees shut
+the window off from view of anyone beyond the wall. The next day,
+the old woman announced the Vicomte de Tulle. He bowed profoundly,
+and began by excusing the step that he had taken, and crediting it
+solely to the passion that he had conceived for her. You may
+imagine the scorn and reproaches with which she answered him. He
+was quite unmoved by her words.</p>
+<p>"'Mademoiselle,' he said calmly, when she paused, 'you may be
+sure that I should not have undertaken this scheme, unless I had
+fully weighed the consequences. My plans have been so laid that
+whatever search may be made for you will be in vain. Here you are,
+and here you will remain until you listen to my suit. Every want
+shall be satisfied, and every wish complied with; but, whether it
+is one year or five, you will not leave this house until you leave
+it as my bride.'</p>
+<p>"'Then, sir,' she said passionately, 'I shall be a prisoner for
+life.'</p>
+<p>"'So you may think, at present, mademoiselle,' he said. 'And I
+expected nothing else. But, with time and reflection, you may come
+to think otherwise. Union with me is not so terrible a matter. My
+rank you know, and standing high, as I do, in the favour of His
+Most Gracious Majesty, your position at court will be such as might
+gratify the daughter of the noblest family in France. The study of
+my life will be to make you happy.</p>
+<p>"'I shall now leave you to think over the matter. I shall not
+pester you with my attentions, and for another month you will not
+see me again. At the end of that time, I trust that you will have
+seen the futility of condemning yourself to further captivity, and
+will be disposed to make more allowance, than at present, for the
+step to which my passion for yourself has driven me.'</p>
+<p>"It was just a month since she had been carried off, and, the
+very day when you rescued her, the old woman had informed her that
+the vicomte would do himself the pleasure of calling upon her the
+next day. For the first fortnight she had held up bravely, in the
+hope that I should discover the place where she had been hidden.
+Then she began to feel the imprisonment and silence telling upon
+her, for the old woman only entered to bring in her meals, and
+never opened her lips, except on the first occasion, when she told
+her that she was strictly forbidden to converse with her. After
+that she began to despair, and the news that her abductor would
+visit her, the next day, decided her to make an attempt to escape.
+She had no difficulty in letting herself down from the window by
+the aid of her bedclothes, but she found that what had been said
+respecting the wall and gate was true, and that she was no nearer
+escape than she had been, before she had left her room. She was
+trying, in vain, to unbar the gate, which, indeed, would have been
+useless could she have accomplished it, as it was also locked. But
+she was striving, with the energy of desperation, when the door of
+the house opened, and the men rushed out and seized her. As they
+dragged her back to the house, she uttered the cries that brought
+you to her assistance. The rest you know.</p>
+<p>"As soon as I heard her story, I went to the palace and asked
+for a private interview with the king. The king received me
+graciously enough, and asked, with an appearance of great interest,
+if I had obtained any news of my daughter.</p>
+<p>"'I have more than obtained news, Your Majesty. I have my
+daughter back again, and I have come to demand justice at your
+hands.'</p>
+<p>"'I congratulate you, indeed, Baron,' the king said, with an
+appearance of warmth, but I saw his colour change, and was
+convinced that he knew something, at least, of the matter.</p>
+<p>"'And where has the damsel been hiding herself?' he went on.</p>
+<p>"'She has not been hiding herself, at all, Sire,' I said. 'She
+has been abducted, by one of Your Majesty's courtiers, with the
+intention of forcing her into a marriage. His name, Sire, is the
+Vicomte de Tulle, and I demand that justice shall be done me, and
+that he shall receive the punishment due to so gross an
+outrage.'</p>
+<p>"The king was silent for a minute, and then said:</p>
+<p>"'He has, indeed, if you have been rightly informed, acted most
+grossly. Still, it is evident that he repented the step that he
+took, and so suffered her to return to you.'</p>
+<p>"'Not so, Your Majesty,' I said. 'I owe her return to no
+repentance on his part, but to the gallantry of a young officer
+who, passing the house where she was confined, heard her cries for
+aid, and, with his soldier servant, climbed the gate of the
+enclosure, and was there attacked by the man who had charge of her,
+with four others. The young gentleman and his servant killed four
+of them, and bound the other; and then, entering the house,
+compelled the woman who had been appointed to act as her servant to
+lead the way to her chamber. Fortunately, the carriage in which she
+had been taken there was still in the stables, with its horses. The
+gallant young gentleman at once got the carriage in readiness,
+placed my daughter in it, with the woman who had been attending on
+her. The servant drove, and he rode by the side of the carriage,
+and in that way brought her home this morning.'</p>
+<p>"In spite of his efforts to appear indifferent, it was evident
+that the king was greatly annoyed. However, he only said:</p>
+<p>"'You did quite right to come to me, Baron. It is outrageous,
+indeed, that a young lady of my court should be thus carried off,
+and I will see that justice is done. And who is this officer, who
+has rendered your daughter such a service?'</p>
+<p>"'His name is Kennedy, Sire. He is an ensign in O'Brien's Irish
+regiment.'</p>
+<p>"'I will myself send for him,' he said, 'and thank him for
+having defeated this disgraceful plot of the Vicomte de Tulle. I
+suppose you are quite sure of all the circumstances, as you have
+told them to me?'</p>
+<p>"'It is impossible that there can be any mistake, Sire,' I said.
+'In the first place, I have my daughter's account. This is entirely
+corroborated by the old woman she had brought with her, and whose
+only hope of escaping from punishment lay in telling the truth. In
+every respect, she fully confirmed my daughter's account.'</p>
+<p>"'But the vicomte has not been absent from Versailles, for the
+past month. He has been at my morning levee, and on all other
+occasions at my breakfasts and dinners. He has walked with me in
+the gardens, and been always present at the evening
+receptions.'</p>
+<p>"'That is so, Sire,' I said. 'My daughter, happily, saw him but
+once; namely, on the morning after she was captured. He then told
+her, frankly, that she would remain a prisoner until she consented
+to marry him, however long the time might be. He said he would
+return in a month, and hoped by that time to find that, seeing the
+hopelessness of her position, she would be more inclined to accept
+his suit.</p>
+<p>"'It was on the eve of his coming again that my daughter, in her
+desperation, made the attempt to escape. She was foiled in her
+effort, but this, nevertheless, brought about her rescue, for her
+cries, as her guards dragged her into the house, attracted the
+attention of Monsieur Kennedy, who forthwith, as I have told you,
+stormed the house, killed her guards, and brought her home to
+me.'</p>
+<p>"The king then sent for de Tulle, and spoke to him with great
+sternness. The latter did not attempt to deny my accusation, but
+endeavoured to excuse himself, on the ground of the passion that he
+had conceived for my daughter. Certainly, from the king's tone, I
+thought that he would at least have sent him to the Bastille; but,
+to my great disappointment, he wound up his reproof by saying:</p>
+<p>"'I can, of course, make some allowances for your passion for so
+charming a young lady as Mademoiselle Pointdexter, but the outrage
+you committed is far too serious to be pardoned. You will at once
+repair to your estates, and will remain there during my
+pleasure.'</p>
+<p>"The vicomte bowed and withdrew, and, an hour later, left
+Versailles. The king turned to me, as he left the room, and said,
+'I trust, Monsieur le Baron, that you are content that justice has
+been done.'</p>
+<p>"I was too angry to choose my words, and I said firmly, 'I
+cannot say that I am content, Your Majesty. Such an outrage as that
+which has been perpetrated upon my daughter deserves a far heavier
+punishment than banishment from court; and methinks that an
+imprisonment, as long as that which he intended to inflict upon her
+unless she consented to be his wife, would have much more nearly
+met the justice of the case.'</p>
+<p>"The king rose to his feet suddenly, and I thought that my
+boldness would meet with the punishment that I desired for de
+Tulle; but he bit his lips, and then said coldly:</p>
+<p>"'You are not often at court, Baron Pointdexter, and are
+doubtless ignorant that I am not accustomed to be spoken to, in the
+tone that you have used. However, I can make due allowance for the
+great anxiety that you have suffered, at your daughter's
+disappearance. I trust that I shall see you and your daughter at my
+levee, this evening.'</p>
+<p>"As this was a command, of course we went, and I am bound to say
+that the king did all in his power to show to his court that he
+considered her to be wholly blameless. Of course, the story had
+already got about, and it was known that the vicomte had been
+ordered to his estates. The king was markedly civil to Anne, talked
+to her for some time, expressed his deep regret that she should
+have been subject to such an outrage, while staying at his court,
+and said, in a tone loud enough to be heard by all standing
+round:</p>
+<p>"'The only redeeming point in the matter is, that the Vicomte de
+Tulle in no way troubled or molested you, and that you only saw
+him, for a few minutes, on the first day of your confinement.'</p>
+<p>"I need not say that this royal utterance was most valuable to
+my daughter, and that it at once silenced any malicious scandal
+that might otherwise have got about.</p>
+<p>"The king stopped to speak to me, immediately afterwards, and I
+said:</p>
+<p>"'I trust that you will pardon the words I spoke this morning.
+Your Majesty has rendered me and my daughter an inestimable
+service, by the speech that you have just made.'</p>
+<p>"Thus, although dissatisfied with the punishment inflicted on
+the Vicomte de Tulle, and believing that the king had a shrewd idea
+who her abductor was, I am grateful to him for shielding my
+daughter from ill tongues, by his marked kindness to her, and by
+declaring openly that de Tulle had not seen her, since the day of
+her abduction. I intended to return home tomorrow, but the king
+himself, when I went this morning to pay my respects, and state my
+intention of taking Anne home, bade those standing round to fall
+back, and was good enough to say in a low voice to me:</p>
+<p>"'I think, Baron, that you would do well to reconsider your
+decision to leave tomorrow. Your sudden departure would give rise
+to ill-natured talk. It would be wiser to stay here, for a short
+time, till the gossip and wonder have passed away.'</p>
+<p>"I saw that His Majesty was right, and shall stay here for a
+short time longer. It would certainly have a bad effect, were we to
+seem to run away and hide ourselves in the provinces."</p>
+<p>Mademoiselle de Pointdexter had retired when her father began to
+relate to Desmond what had happened.</p>
+<p>"I know little of life in Paris, Monsieur le Baron," Desmond
+said, "but it certainly seems to me monstrous, that the man who
+committed this foul outrage should escape with what is, doubtless,
+but a short banishment from court."</p>
+<p>"I do not know that the matter is ended yet, Monsieur Kennedy.
+In spite of the edicts against duelling, I myself should have
+demanded satisfaction from him, for this attack upon the honour of
+my family, but I am at present Anne's only protector. It is many
+years since I have drawn a sword, while de Tulle is noted as a
+fencer, and has had many affairs, of which he has escaped the
+consequences owing to royal favour. Therefore, were I to challenge
+him, the chances are that I should be killed, in which case my
+daughter would become a ward of the crown, and her hand and estate
+be bestowed on one of the king's creatures. But, as I said, the
+matter is not likely to rest as it is.</p>
+<p>"Anne has, with my full consent and approval, given her love to
+a young gentleman of our province. He is a large-landed proprietor,
+and a connection of our family. They are not, as yet, formally
+betrothed, for I have no wish to lose her so soon; and, in spite of
+the present fashion of early marriages, I by no means approve of
+them, and told Monsieur de la Vallee that they must wait for
+another couple of years.</p>
+<p>"I need scarcely say that, after what has happened, I shall
+reconsider my decision; for the sooner she is married, and beyond
+the reach of a repetition of this outrage, the better. I imagine,
+however, that the young gentleman will be no better satisfied than
+I am, that the matter should have been passed over so lightly; and
+will take it into his own hands, and send a challenge immediately
+to the vicomte. He is high spirited, and has the reputation among
+us of being a good fencer, but I doubt whether he can possess such
+skill as that which de Tulle has acquired. It is not always the
+injured person that comes off victorious in a duel; and, should
+fortune go against Monsieur de la Vallee, it would be a terrible
+blow to my daughter, and indeed to myself, for I am much attached
+to him. She is worrying about it, already.</p>
+<p>"Of course, it is impossible that the affair can be hidden from
+him. It is public property now; and therefore, I sent off one of my
+grooms, an hour since, with a letter to him.</p>
+<p>"Hitherto, I had not written to him about my daughter's
+disappearance. Knowing he would, on hearing of it, at once hasten
+here, where he could do no good and would only add to my trouble, I
+thought it best to let matters go on as they were. I had been doing
+everything that was possible, and to have his troubles as well as
+my own on my hands would have driven me to distraction.</p>
+<p>"The groom is to change horses at every post house, and to use
+the greatest possible speed. You may be sure that Monsieur de la
+Vallee will do the same, and that in six days he will be here. I
+have given him the merest outline of the affair, and have not
+mentioned the name of Anne's abductor. Had I done so, it is
+probable that Philip would have gone straight to de Tulle, and
+forced on an encounter at once. As it is, I trust that Anne and I,
+between us, may persuade him to take no step in the matter. It is
+the honour of my family, not of his, that has been attacked. Had he
+been betrothed to my daughter, he would have been in a position to
+take up her quarrel. As it is, he has no status, except distant
+relationship.</p>
+<p>"And now, Monsieur Kennedy, I have the king's order to take you
+to the palace. He asked me several questions about you this
+morning. I said that I had not yet seen you, but that you were
+riding over here today, and he said:</p>
+<p>"'Bring him to me when he comes, Baron. I should like to see
+this young fire eater, who thrust himself so boldly into a matter
+in which he had no concern, solely because he heard a woman's voice
+calling for help.'"</p>
+<p>"I am sorry to hear it," Desmond said, bluntly. "From what you
+say I imagine that, in spite of what he has done, the king is far
+from gratified at the failure of his favourite's plan. However, I
+cannot disobey his commands in the matter."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch5" id="Ch5">Chapter 5</a>: A New Friend.</h2>
+<p>The baron sent a servant to request his daughter to come
+down.</p>
+<p>"I am going now, with Monsieur Kennedy, to the palace, Anne," he
+said, as she entered. "I do not suppose that we shall be absent
+very long. I have been talking matters over with him, and I think
+that he agrees with my view of them."</p>
+<p>"But I have hardly spoken to him, yet, father!"</p>
+<p>"You will have an opportunity of doing so, when we return.
+Monsieur Kennedy will, of course, dine with us. After the service
+that he has rendered to us, we have a right to consider him as
+belonging to us."</p>
+<p>"Had I had an idea of this," Desmond said, as they walked up the
+hill towards the palace gate, "I should have put on my full
+uniform. This undress is scarcely the attire in which one would
+appear before the King of France, who is, as I have heard, most
+particular in matters of etiquette."</p>
+<p>"He is so," the baron said. "He will know that you could not be
+prepared for an audience, and doubtless he will receive you in his
+private closet."</p>
+<p>On ascending the grand staircase, the baron gave his name to one
+of the court chamberlains.</p>
+<p>"I have orders," the latter said, "to take you at once, on your
+presenting yourself, to His Majesty's closet, instead of entering
+the audience chamber."</p>
+<p>They were conducted along a private passage, of considerable
+length. On arriving at a door, the chamberlain asked them to wait,
+while he went inside to ascertain whether His Majesty was
+disengaged.</p>
+<p>"His Majesty will see you in a few minutes, Baron," he said,
+when he came out. "The Duc d'Orleans is with him, but, hearing your
+name announced for a private audience, he is taking his leave."</p>
+<p>In two or three minutes a handbell sounded in the room, and the
+chamberlain, who at once entered, returned in a moment, and
+conducted the baron and Desmond into the king's private
+apartment.</p>
+<p>"Allow me to present, to Your Majesty," the former said,
+"Monsieur Desmond Kennedy, an officer in O'Brien's regiment, and an
+Irish gentleman of good family."</p>
+<p>The king, who was now far advanced in life, looked at the young
+man with some surprise.</p>
+<p>"I had expected to see an older man," he said.</p>
+<p>"Though you told me, Baron, he was but an ensign, I looked to
+see a man of the same type as so many of my gallant Irish officers,
+ready for any desperate service.</p>
+<p>"So, young sir, you have begun early, indeed, to play havoc
+among my liege subjects, for I hear that you, and a soldier with
+you, slew four of them."</p>
+<p>"Hardly your liege subjects, Your Majesty, if I may venture to
+say so; for, assuredly, they were not engaged in lawful
+proceedings, when I came upon them."</p>
+<p>A slight smile crossed the king's face. He was accustomed to
+adulation, and the simple frankness with which this young soldier
+ventured to discuss the propriety of the word he used surprised and
+amused him.</p>
+<p>"You are right, sir. These fellows, who are ready to undertake
+any service, however criminal, for which they are paid, certainly
+do not deserve to be called liege subjects. Now, I would hear from,
+your own lips, how it was that you thrust yourself into a matter
+with which you had no concern; being wholly ignorant, I understand,
+that the lady whose voice you heard was Mademoiselle
+Pointdexter."</p>
+<p>"The matter was very simple, Sire. Having joined the regiment
+but a few months, and being naturally anxious to perfect myself in
+exercises in arms, I have but little time to stir out, during the
+day, and of an evening I frequently go for long rambles, taking
+with me my soldier servant. I had, that evening, gone farther than
+usual, the night being fair and the weather balmy, and naturally,
+when I heard the cry of a woman in distress, I determined to see
+what had happened, as it might well be that murder was being
+done."</p>
+<p>He then related all the circumstances of his obtaining an
+entrance into the gardens, of the attack upon him by the guard, and
+how he finally brought Mademoiselle Pointdexter to Versailles. The
+king listened attentively.</p>
+<p>"It was an exploit I should have loved to perform, when I was
+your age, Monsieur Kennedy. You behaved in the matter with singular
+discretion and gallantry; but, if you intend always to interfere,
+when you hear a woman cry out, it is like that your time will be
+pretty well occupied; and that, before long, there will be a
+vacancy in the ranks of your regiment. Truly, Monsieur le Baron and
+his daughter have reason for gratitude that you happened to be
+passing at the time; and I, as King of France, am glad that this
+outrage on a lady of the court has failed.</p>
+<p>"I am, perhaps, not altogether without blame in the matter. A
+short time ago, the Vicomte de Tulle told me that he hoped to
+better his fortune by a rich marriage. He named no names, nor said
+aught of the measures he intended to adopt. But I said it would be
+well that he should do so, for rumours had reached me that his
+finances were in disorder. Whether he took this as a permission to
+use any means that he thought fit I cannot tell; and I certainly
+did not suspect, when I heard of the disappearance of Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter, that he had any hand in it, and was shocked when
+the baron came here and denounced him to me. I am glad, indeed,
+that his enterprise was thwarted, for it was a most unworthy
+one.</p>
+<p>"You are too young, yet, for me to grant you military promotion,
+but this will be a proof of my approbation of your conduct, and
+that the King of France is determined to suppress all
+irregularities at his court."</p>
+<p>And, taking a diamond ring from his finger, he handed it to
+Desmond, who went on one knee to receive it.</p>
+<p>"You will please inform your colonel that, when he comes to
+Versailles, I request he will always bring you with him."</p>
+<p>The audience was evidently finished, and the baron and Desmond,
+bowing deeply, left the king's cabinet. The baron did not speak,
+till they left the palace.</p>
+<p>"Louis has his faults," the baron then said, "but no one could
+play the part of a great monarch more nobly than he does. I have no
+doubt, whatever, that de Tulle relied implicitly upon obtaining his
+forgiveness, had he succeeded in forcing Anne into marrying him;
+though, doubtless, he would have feigned displeasure for a time. He
+has extricated himself most gracefully. I can quite believe that he
+did not imagine his favourite intended to adopt so criminal a
+course, to accomplish the matter of which he spoke to him, but he
+could not fail to have his suspicions, when he heard of Anne's
+disappearance. However, we can consider the affair as happily
+ended, except for the matter of Monsieur de la Vallee, of whom I
+spoke to you.</p>
+<p>"And now, sir, that the king has expressed his gratitude to you,
+for saving his court from a grave scandal, how can I fitly express
+my own, at the inestimable service that you have rendered us?"</p>
+<p>"I should say, Baron, that it will be most welcomely expressed,
+if you will abstain from saying more of the matter. It is a simple
+one. I went to the assistance of a woman in distress; and
+succeeded, at the expense of this trifling wound, in accomplishing
+her rescue. The lady happened to be your daughter, but had she been
+but the daughter of some little bourgeois of Paris, carried off by
+a reckless noble, it would have been the same. Much more has been
+made of the matter than there was any occasion for. It has gained
+for me the approbation and thanks of the king, to say nothing of
+this ring, which, although I am no judge of such matters, must be a
+very valuable one, or he would not have worn it; and I have had the
+pleasure of rendering a service to you, and Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter. Therefore, I feel far more than duly rewarded, for a
+service somewhat recklessly undertaken on the spur of the
+moment."</p>
+<p>"That may be very well, as far as it interests yourself,
+Monsieur Kennedy; but not so far as I am concerned, and I fear I
+shall have to remain your debtor till the end of my life. All I can
+say at present is that I hope that, as soon as you can obtain
+leave, you will come as a most honoured guest to my chateau. There
+you will see me under happier circumstances. The life of a country
+seigneur is but a poor preparation for existence in this court,
+where, although there is no longer the open licentiousness that
+prevailed in the king's younger days, there is yet, I believe, an
+equal amount of profligacy, though it has been sternly
+discountenanced since Madame Maintenon obtained an absolute, and I
+may say a well-used, influence over His Majesty."</p>
+<p>"I shall be happy, indeed, to pay you a visit, Baron, if my
+military duties will permit my absenting myself, for a time, from
+Paris. All I know of France is its capital, and nothing would give
+me greater pleasure than to have the opportunity of seeing its
+country life, in so pleasant a manner."</p>
+<p>"Our pleasure would be no less than your own, Monsieur
+Kennedy.</p>
+<p>"There is one thing I must warn you about, and that is, you must
+be careful for a time not to go out after dark. De Tulle has an
+evil reputation, and is vindictive as well as unscrupulous.
+Doubtless, he has agents here who will, by this time, have
+discovered who it was that brought his daring scheme to naught; and
+it is, to my mind, more than probable that he will endeavour to be
+revenged."</p>
+<p>"I shall be on my guard," Desmond said quietly.</p>
+<p>"You must be careful, indeed," the baron said. "Against open
+violence you can well defend yourself, but against a blow from
+behind with a dagger, skill and courage are of little avail. When
+you go out after dark, I pray you let your army servant follow
+closely behind you, and see that his sword is loose in its
+scabbard."</p>
+<p>Desmond nodded.</p>
+<p>"Believe me, I will take every precaution. It is not likely that
+there will long be need for it, for none can doubt that military
+operations will soon begin on a large scale, and we are not likely,
+if that is the case, to be kept in garrison in Paris."</p>
+<p>When Desmond arrived that evening at the barracks, he found that
+the story of the rescue of Mademoiselle de Pointdexter was already
+known, and also that the Vicomte de Tulle had been the abductor,
+and had, in consequence, been banished from court. The baron had
+indeed related the circumstances to some of his intimate friends,
+but the story had varied greatly as it spread, and it had come to
+be reported that an officer had brought a strong body of soldiers,
+who had assaulted the house where she was confined, and, after a
+desperate conflict, had annihilated the guard that had been placed
+over her.</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed, as this story was told to him, when he entered
+the room where the officers were gathered. The narrator
+concluded:</p>
+<p>"As you have been to Versailles, Kennedy, doubtless you will
+have heard all the latest particulars. Have you learnt who was the
+officer, what regiment he belonged to, and how came he to have a
+body of soldiers with him, outside the town? For they say that the
+house where she was confined was a mile and a half beyond the
+walls."</p>
+<p>There was no longer any reason for concealment. The matter had
+become public. The baron would certainly mention his name, and
+indeed his visit to the palace, and the private audience given to
+him and the baron, would assuredly have been noted.</p>
+<p>"Your story is quite new to me," he said, "and is swollen, in
+the telling, to undue proportions. The real facts of the case are
+by no means so romantic. The truth of the story, by this time, is
+generally known, as Mademoiselle Pointdexter and her father have
+many friends at court. The affair happened to myself."</p>
+<p>"To you, Kennedy?" was exclaimed, in astonishment, by all those
+present.</p>
+<p>"Exactly so," he said. "Nothing could have been more simple. The
+evening before last I was, as usual, taking a walk and, the night
+being fine, I passed beyond the gate. Presently, I heard a scream
+and a woman's cry for help. None of you, gentlemen, could have been
+insensible to such an appeal. Callaghan and I climbed over a pretty
+high gate. Not knowing what force there might be in the place, we
+occupied ourselves, at first, by unbarring and shooting the lock of
+the gate. The bolts were stiff, and we made some noise over it,
+which brought out five men. These we disposed of, after a short
+fight, in which I got this graze on the cheek, and Callaghan his
+sword wound in the shoulder."</p>
+<p>"How did you dispose of them, Kennedy?" the colonel asked.</p>
+<p>"I ran two of them through. Callaghan cut down one, and shot
+another. The fifth man cried for mercy, and we simply tied him
+up.</p>
+<p>"We then found Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and, learning from her
+that the carriage in which she had been brought there was, with its
+horses, still in the stable, we got it out, harnessed the horses,
+and put an old woman who was mademoiselle's attendant in the
+carriage with her. Mike took the reins, I mounted a saddle horse,
+and we drove her to her father's house at Versailles, saw her
+fairly inside, and then, as you know, got back here just as the
+regiment was forming up on parade."</p>
+<p>"A very pretty adventure, indeed," the colonel said warmly, and
+loud expressions of approbation rose from the other listeners.</p>
+<p>"And why did you not tell us, when you came in?" the colonel
+went on.</p>
+<p>"I had not seen Baron Pointdexter, and did not know what course
+he would take--whether he would think it best to hush the matter up
+altogether, or to lay a complaint before the king; and, until I
+knew what he was going to do, it seemed to me best that I should
+hold my tongue, altogether.</p>
+<p>"When I went to Versailles, today, I found that he had laid his
+complaint before the king, and that the Vicomte de Tulle, who was
+the author of the outrage, had been ordered to his estates. I may
+say that I had the honour of a private interview with His Majesty,
+who graciously approved of my conduct, and gave me this ring," and
+he held out his hand, "as a token of his approval."</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen, you will agree with me," the colonel said,
+"that our young ensign has made an admirable debut, and I am sure
+that we are all proud of the manner in which he has behaved; and
+our anticipations, that he would prove a credit to the regiment,
+have been verified sooner than it seemed possible."</p>
+<p>"They have, indeed, Colonel," the major said. "It was, in every
+way, a risky thing for him to have attempted. I do not mean because
+of the odds that he might have to face, but because of the trouble
+that he might have got into, by forcing his way into a private
+house. The scream might have come from a mad woman, or from a
+serving wench receiving a whipping for misconduct."</p>
+<p>"I never thought anything about it, Major. A woman screamed for
+help, and it seemed to me that help should be given. I did not
+think of the risk, either from armed men inside--for I had no
+reason to believe that there were such--or of civil indictment for
+breaking in. We heard the cry, made straight for the house, and, as
+it turned out, all went well."</p>
+<p>"Well, indeed," the colonel said. "You have rescued a wealthy
+heiress from a pitiable fate. You have fleshed your maiden sword in
+the bodies of two villains. You have earned the gratitude of the
+young lady and her father, and have received the approval of His
+Majesty--a very good night's work, altogether. Now, tell us a
+little more about it."</p>
+<p>Desmond was compelled to tell the story in much further detail
+than before. The colonel ordered in a dozen of champagne, and it
+was late before the party broke up.</p>
+<p>"You see, we were pretty nearly right in our guess," O'Neil
+said, as he and O'Sullivan walked across with Desmond to their
+quarters. "We said that we thought it likely she might have been
+carried off by one of the court gallants, who felt tolerably
+confident that, if successful, the king would overlook the offence.
+This fellow, thanks to your interference, did not succeed; and the
+king has let him off, lightly enough, by only banishing him from
+court. If it had been anyone but one of his favourites, he would,
+by this time, have been a tenant of the Bastille.</p>
+<p>"I do not think, myself, that his punishment was adequate; but
+then, I am not a courtier, and should be rather glad than not, to
+be sent away to any estates I might have."</p>
+<p>"But," Desmond remarked, "I suppose the punishment is a severe
+one to these men, accustomed to a round of pleasure and
+dissipation, and who consider it the highest of earthly honours to
+be in favour with the king. However, no one could be kinder than
+His Majesty has been, on the subject. At the reception last night,
+at which he ordered the baron and his daughter to appear, he showed
+her the most marked favour, and particularly put a stop to all
+scandals, by saying loudly that de Tulle had never seen her, after
+the first morning of her capture."</p>
+<p>Six days later, when Desmond was engaged in the fencing room,
+Callaghan came in, and told him that a gentleman was at his
+quarters, wishing particularly to see him.</p>
+<p>"What is his name?"</p>
+<p>"Sure, and I don't know, your honour. He did not mention it, and
+it was not for the likes of me to ask him."</p>
+<p>"Ridiculous, Mike! In future, when anyone comes and wishes to
+see me, you will say, 'What name shall I tell Mr. Kennedy?'"</p>
+<p>He put on his uniform coat reluctantly, for he was engaged in an
+interesting bout with a professor, who was an old friend of the
+<em>maitre d'armes</em>. As he entered his room, a young man, who
+had been staring out of the window, and drumming impatiently with
+his fingers, turned. He was a stranger to Desmond.</p>
+<p>"I am Desmond Kennedy, sir," the young officer said. "To what do
+I owe the honour of this visit?"</p>
+<p>The other did not reply, but stood looking at him, in so strange
+and earnest a way, that Desmond felt almost uneasy.</p>
+<p>"Sir," his visitor said at last, advancing to him and holding
+out both hands, "when I tell you that my name is Philip de la
+Vallee, you will understand what must strike you as my singular
+behaviour. I arrived last night at Versailles, and heard all that
+had happened. You can imagine, therefore, that my heart is almost
+too full for words, with gratitude and thankfulness."</p>
+<p>Desmond was moved by the emotion of his visitor, and their hands
+met in a hearty clasp. Monsieur de la Vallee was a young man, of
+four or five and twenty, well proportioned, and active and sinewy
+from his devotion to field sports. He was about the same height as
+Desmond himself, but the latter, who had not yet finished growing,
+was larger boned, and would broaden into a much bigger and more
+powerful man.</p>
+<p>"Henceforth, Monsieur Kennedy," de la Vallee went on, "I hope
+that we shall be as brothers, and more. Had it not been for you, my
+life would have been a ruined one. What agony have I been saved! It
+makes me mad, to think that I was idling at home, ignorant that my
+beloved had been carried away. I do not blame the baron for not
+informing me, and I acknowledge that the reasons he gave me were
+good ones. I could have done nothing, and should but have added to
+his troubles by my anxiety and anger. Still, he told me that, in
+another day or two, he would have felt that I ought no longer to be
+kept in the dark, and would have summoned me to Paris. I am
+thankful now that he did not do so, for I believe that my impotence
+to do anything would have driven me almost to distraction."</p>
+<p>"I agree with you that the baron acted wisely," Kennedy said.
+"Had not chance, or Providence, taken me past the house where she
+was imprisoned, at the very moment when Mademoiselle Pointdexter
+cried for help, she might, for aught I can say, have remained a
+captive there for months, or even years."</p>
+<p>"It was Providence, indeed, Monsieur Kennedy. Providence, not
+only that she should have cried at that moment, but that her cries
+should have reached the ears of one so ready and able to save her.
+And now, I pray you, call me Philip, and allow me to call you
+Desmond, as a pledge of our close friendship."</p>
+<p>"With pleasure," Kennedy replied; and the compact was sealed
+with another close grasp of the hand.</p>
+<p>"It is strange, Desmond, that while the king, who had but little
+interest in the matter, could present you, as I am told he did,
+with a diamond ring, the baron and I, who owe you so much, can do
+nothing to show our gratitude."</p>
+<p>Desmond smiled.</p>
+<p>"I can assure you that I need no such tokens," he said. "The
+thanks that I have received, from you both, are infinitely more
+grateful to me than any amount of rings and jewels."</p>
+<p>"And now, my friend," Philip de la Vallee went on, "my own
+burning desire is to go to de Tulle, as soon as I have accompanied
+the baron and Anne to their home; first, to publicly chastise this
+villain noble; and then, of course, to fight him. Naturally, I have
+said nothing of this to the baron, but I feel, after what has
+happened, that in you I shall find an adviser, and a
+sympathizer."</p>
+<p>"I sympathize with you, most heartily, Philip, and in your place
+should feel the same impulse; and yet, it would not be wise to give
+way to it. I say this on the ground that he is a notoriously good
+swordsman, and that, instead of your taking vengeance upon him, he
+might kill you.</p>
+<p>"I feel that that argument would not have any influence with you
+personally, but, taking your position with regard to Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter, it should have great weight. You can judge, from
+what you would have felt yourself, had you been aware of her
+disappearance, what she would feel, did she hear of your death in
+this quarrel. Were you her brother, I should say that you would be
+right--nay, that it would be your duty to endeavour to punish the
+outrage against the honour of your family. Were you openly
+betrothed to her, you would again have the right to punish her
+abductor; but, not being either her brother or her betrothed,
+neither reason nor public opinion would justify your doing so.
+Moreover, did you fight with him and kill him, you would incur the
+gravest resentment of the king; for, in fact, you would be
+impugning his justice, which has considered banishment from court
+to be a sufficient punishment for his offence. Not only was he a
+favourite of the king's, but he belongs, I understand, to a
+powerful family; who would, you may be sure, use their influence
+with the king to bring about your punishment, for the breach of the
+decree against duelling, and you would be fortunate if you escaped
+a long imprisonment."</p>
+<p>The other was silent.</p>
+<p>"I feel that you are right," he said, at last, "but, indeed, it
+is hard that I should not be able to avenge this outrage upon the
+lady who is to be my wife. I may tell you that, as soon as we
+return home, our formal betrothal is to take place, and ere long
+our marriage will be celebrated; but I shall feel lowered, in my
+own esteem, if I sit down quietly under this injury."</p>
+<p>"I do not see that," Desmond said. "If you abstain from
+challenging de Tulle, it is from no fear of the consequences, but
+it is, as I have shown you, because, whatever the issue of the
+contest, it would be bad both for you and her. If you were killed,
+her life would be spoilt. If you killed him, you might languish for
+years in one of the royal prisons. The king prides himself on his
+justice, and, by all accounts, rightly so; and I am sure that he
+would feel the deepest resentment, were you or anyone to show, by
+your actions, that you considered he has favoured the
+transgressor."</p>
+<p>"You are right, Desmond; and, at any rate for the present, I
+will put my intention aside; but should he ever cross my path,
+assuredly I will have a reckoning with him.</p>
+<p>"But how is it that you, who are at least eight years younger
+than I am, should argue as an old counsellor rather than a young
+ensign?"</p>
+<p>"I suppose, in the first place, it is from my bringing up. I
+lived with and was educated by a good priest, one not wanting in
+manliness and energy, but who often deplored the system of
+duelling, which is as strong with us as it is here, and denounced
+it as a relic of barbarism, and, at any rate, never to be put in
+use on account of a heated quarrel over wine, but only if some
+deadly injury had been inflicted, and even then better left alone.
+Of course, as an officer in one of His Majesty's regiments, I
+should be obliged to conform to the general usage; for, did I
+decline, I should be regarded as having brought dishonour on the
+corps. But my case differs altogether from yours.</p>
+<p>"In the next place, knowing you were coming to Versailles, I
+thought over what course you would be likely to pursue, and
+considered it was probable you would lose no time in challenging de
+Tulle. I have thought the matter over, in every light, and made up
+my mind to endeavour to dissuade you from doing so, if the
+opportunity offered.</p>
+<p>"So you see," he added with a smile, "I had prepared my array of
+arguments against it; and I cannot but think that the opinion of
+one interested, but not vitally so, on a point, is rather to be
+taken than that of a person smarting under an injury."</p>
+<p>"And now, to turn to other matters. In three days we start for
+the south. The baron accompanied me here, and went to see your
+colonel, while I came to your quarters. His object was to ask him
+to grant you a month's leave of absence, with the provision, of
+course, that you should return at once, if the regiment was ordered
+on service."</p>
+<p>"It is kind, indeed, of him," Desmond said, "but I doubt whether
+the colonel will assent. It is not a month since I was dismissed
+from drill, and took my place with my company, and I doubt whether
+he will consider that I am sufficiently versed in my duties, or
+that, after being so short a time in the regiment, I have any right
+to leave."</p>
+<p>"What you say is right enough, under ordinary circumstances, but
+these are altogether extraordinary. Then, after what you have done,
+he will feel it but natural that we should wish to have you with us
+for a time. Moreover, I do not consider that our journey will be
+altogether unattended by danger. From what I have heard of de
+Tulle, he is a man who never forgives, and will pursue his object
+with the pertinacity of a bloodhound. He has failed in his first
+attempt, but there is no reason why he should not renew it,
+confident, perhaps, that if successful the king, though he may feel
+it necessary to feign much anger for a time, will finally forgive
+him and take him into favour again, especially as his family would
+bring all their influence to bear to bring this about. Doubtless,
+he will be kept perfectly informed of what is going on here. There
+are several forests to be traversed on the way, and these are, for
+the most part, the haunts of robber bands; and, should the carriage
+be found overturned, and the baron and his daughter missing, it
+would be put down as their work. Having the baron as well as his
+daughter in his power, de Tulle would find it easier than before to
+compel Anne to purchase her father's freedom, as well as her own,
+by consenting to his terms.</p>
+<p>"Therefore, you see, the aid of a sword like yours would be
+valuable, and no doubt your servant, who is also a sturdy fighter,
+will accompany us."</p>
+<p>"I can hardly think that de Tulle would venture upon so bold a
+stroke as that, and yet he might do so. Men of that kind are not
+accustomed to be thwarted, and it would be a satisfaction to his
+resentment at his former failure, as well as the attainment of the
+wide estates of which Anne is heiress."</p>
+<p>At this moment there was a knock at the door, and the baron
+entered.</p>
+<p>"My dear Monsieur Kennedy," he said, "I have succeeded. Colonel
+O'Brien has been pleased to say that you have been so assiduous, in
+learning your duties, that he considers you as capable of
+performing them as any of his subalterns; and that you have just
+brought so much credit on the regiment, that he is pleased to be
+able to grant the favour I asked. Here is your furlough, duly
+signed. Now it only rests with yourself, to accept or refuse my
+invitation."</p>
+<p>"I accept it most gladly, Baron. It will give me the greatest
+pleasure to accompany you, and mademoiselle, and Monsieur de la
+Vallee, whom I now regard as a dear friend, to your home."</p>
+<p>"That is settled, then," the baron said. "We start early on
+Thursday morning. It would be well, therefore, if you were to ride
+over on Wednesday evening, and occupy one of the many spare
+chambers there are in the house."</p>
+<p>"I will do so willingly; and I shall ask the colonel to allow my
+servant to accompany me."</p>
+<p>"That is already settled. I told Colonel O'Brien that I owed
+much to him also, and he at once acceded to my request, saying
+that, although the wound is healing, the surgeon said that it would
+be a fortnight, yet, before he will be fit for service; and,
+moreover, that it was a custom when an officer went on leave that
+he should, if he wished it, take his soldier servant with him."</p>
+<p>"Thank you again, Baron. Mike is a faithful fellow, and a shrewd
+one. I am so accustomed now to his services that I should miss
+them, and his talk, very much."</p>
+<p>"Have you heard, Mike," Desmond asked, when his servant came up
+to his room, after the baron and Philip de la Vallee had left,
+"that you are to go with me, to stay for a month, at
+Pointdexter?"</p>
+<p>"I have, your honour. Sure, I was sent for to the colonel's
+quarters, and there I found a tall gentleman, whom I had never seen
+before, as far as I knew.</p>
+<p>"'This is Mike Callaghan, Mr. Kennedy's servant,' the colonel
+said, and the baron stepped forward, and shook hands with me, for
+all the world as if I had been a noble like himself; and he
+said:</p>
+<p>"'My brave fellow, I have to thank you for the aid you gave your
+master in rescuing my daughter, in which service you received the
+wound which still keeps your arm in a sling. Here is a token that
+we are not ungrateful for the service. If you will take my advice,
+you will hand it to an agent of mine here in Paris, who will keep
+it for you, and you may find it useful when the time comes for you
+to take your discharge.'</p>
+<p>"So saying, he put a heavy purse into my hand, and said:</p>
+<p>"'You will find my agent's name and address on a card inside the
+purse. I shall go round to him, now, and tell him that you are
+coming, and that he is to use the money to your advantage, and to
+hand it over to you whenever you choose to ask for it. Your master
+is coming down to stay for a month with me, and Colonel O'Brien has
+granted leave for you to accompany him.'</p>
+<p>"I thanked him heartily, as you may believe, sir; though, as I
+said, I wanted no reward for obeying your orders, and for the share
+I took in that little skirmish. After I came out, I looked into the
+purse, which was mighty heavy, expecting to find a handful of
+crowns; and it fairly staggered me when I found that it was full of
+gold pieces, and on counting them, found that there were a hundred
+louis. Never did I dream that I should be so rich. Why, your
+honour, when I lave the regiment, which will not be for many a long
+year, I hope, I shall be able to settle down comfortably, for the
+rest of my life, in a snug little shebeen, or on a bit of land with
+a cottage and some pigs, and maybe a cow or two; and it is all to
+your honour I owe it, for if you hadn't given the word, it would
+never have entered my head to attack a gentleman's house, merely
+because I heard a woman scream."</p>
+<p>"Well, I am heartily glad, Mike; and I hope that you will take
+it straight to the agent's, and not break in upon it, by treating
+half the regiment to drink."</p>
+<p>"I will, your honour. It was given me to stow away for the time
+when I might want it, and though I don't say that my own
+inclinations would not lead me to trate a few of the boys, I feel
+that I ought to do what the gentleman told me."</p>
+<p>"Certainly you should, Mike. If you once began to spend it in
+that way, it is not one louis, but five or more, that would
+disappear in a few hours. I am heartily glad that the baron has so
+handsomely rewarded you for the service, and if you like, I will go
+round with you this afternoon to his agent, and see the money
+safely deposited."</p>
+<p>"Thank you, your honour. I sha'n't feel easy, as long as I have
+got it in my pouch. I should suspict everyone who came near me, and
+should never dare take my hand off it, lest someone else might put
+his in."</p>
+<p>"You are a lucky fellow, Kennedy," O'Neil said, when Desmond
+told his two comrades of the arrangements that had been made. "And,
+if you go on like this, the regiment will believe that any good
+fortune that may fall to its lot is the result of your luck."</p>
+<p>"I really do not like having leave given to me, when I have been
+such a short time in the regiment. It does not seem fair upon
+others."</p>
+<p>"No one will grudge you that," O'Sullivan said. "It is not as if
+we were at home. Then, of course, everyone would like his turn. But
+here, although we are soldiers of France, we are as strangers in
+the land. Here in Paris we have many acquaintances, and a welcome
+at most of the receptions; but that is the end of it. It is seldom,
+indeed, that we are invited into the country houses of those we
+know. That sort of hospitality is not the fashion in France. Here,
+nobles may throw open their houses to all gentlemen by birth who
+happen to be presented to them, but at home they are rigidly
+exclusive; and, moreover, I am inclined to think they regard us
+Irishmen as detrimental and dangerous. Many Irishmen make
+exceedingly good matches, and we are regarded as having a way with
+us, with the girls, that is likely to interfere with the
+arrangements their parents have made for their marriages. Now, it
+seems to me that your baron must be a very confiding old gentleman,
+or he would never take you to stay in the society of the young lady
+who owes so much to you. Faith, it seems to me that you have the
+ball at your feet, and that you have only to go in and win. From
+what I hear, Mademoiselle Pointdexter is no older than you are
+yourself, and it is a glorious chance for you."</p>
+<p>Desmond broke into a laugh.</p>
+<p>"My dear O'Sullivan," he said, "it seems to me that it is the
+favourite dream of Irish soldiers of fortune, that they may improve
+their circumstances by marriage."</p>
+<p>"Well, there is no easier or more pleasant way," his friend
+said, stoutly.</p>
+<p>"Possibly I may come to think so, in another ten years," Desmond
+went on, "but, at present, I have no more thought of marrying than
+I have of becoming king of France. The idea is altogether absurd,
+and it happens to be particularly so, in the present case, since
+one of the objects of my going down to Pointdexter is that I may be
+present at the formal betrothal of this young lady, to Monsieur de
+la Vallee, a neighbour of theirs, whom I had the pleasure of
+meeting this afternoon, and to whom she is tenderly attached."</p>
+<p>"By the powers, but that is unlucky, Kennedy!" O'Neil said; "and
+I have been thinking that your fortune was made, and that the
+regiment would soon lose you, as you would, of course, settle down
+as a magnate in Languedoc; and now, it seems that what we thought
+the proper sequence of your adventure, is not to come off, after
+all. Well, lad, I congratulate you on putting a good face on it,
+and hiding your disappointment."</p>
+<p>"What nonsense you talk!" Desmond said, laughing. "It is you who
+have been building castles, not I, and it is your disappointment
+that they have fallen to pieces."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch6" id="Ch6">Chapter 6</a>: An Ambuscade.</h2>
+<p>On the morning arranged, the cavalcade started from Versailles.
+The baron had instructed the stable keeper, where the carriage and
+horses had been placed, to notify the Vicomte de Tulle that he held
+them at his disposal. The woman, who had been brought to
+Versailles, had been dismissed, after having made before a
+magistrate a deposition, stating how Mademoiselle de Pointdexter
+had been held a close prisoner, and that, with the exception of
+herself, no one whatever had entered her apartment, except that the
+Vicomte de Tulle had paid her a visit, of some five minutes'
+duration, on the morning after she was brought there. A copy of
+this was left in the magistrate's hands for safekeeping, while the
+original was kept by the baron, who regarded it as a most important
+document, concerning, as it did, the honour of his daughter.</p>
+<p>Anne had travelled to Paris in the family coach, and she again,
+with her maid, took her place in it. The baron, Monsieur de la
+Vallee, and Desmond rode on horseback behind it, two armed
+retainers rode in front, and two others, with Mike, took their
+places behind. The old servitor sat on the front seat, by the side
+of the coachman.</p>
+<p>"I do not think, Desmond," Philip de la Vallee said, as the
+baron fell back to talk for a while with his daughter, "that he has
+the slightest thought of our being attacked by any of the agents of
+the vicomte; but I have made a good many enquiries about the
+fellow, in the past few days, and from what I have heard I am still
+more convinced that, before long, he is likely to renew his attempt
+to get possession of Anne. I hear that his circumstances are
+well-nigh desperate. He has mortgaged the income of his estates,
+which, of course, he is unable to sell, as they go with the title
+to the heir. He is pressed by many creditors, who, now that he has
+lost the favour of the king, will give him no further grace.
+Indeed, I understand that the king, who is always liberal, and who
+not infrequently makes considerable gifts to the gentlemen of the
+court, to enable them to support the necessary expenses, has
+already assisted him several times, and that it was only by such
+aid that he has been able to hold on as long as he has done.</p>
+<p>"He is, in fact, a desperate man, and his only hope is in making
+a wealthy alliance. Therefore, putting aside his pique and anger at
+having failed, the temptation to again obtain possession of Anne is
+great, indeed. Once married to her he could, even if the king kept
+him in banishment, well maintain his position as a country
+magnate."</p>
+<p>"But Mademoiselle de Pointdexter cannot come into the estates
+until her father's death."</p>
+<p>"Not his estates, but those of her mother, who was also a
+wealthy heiress, and of which she will enter into possession either
+on coming of age or on marrying. So, you see, he can afford to
+disregard the enmity of her father, as well as the displeasure of
+the king, which probably would soon abate after the marriage took
+place. If I had known, when I left home, what had happened, and
+that if she was found we should be returning home, I would have
+brought with me a dozen stout fellows from my own estate. As it is,
+I sent off a messenger, yesterday, with an order to my majordomo to
+pick out that number of active fellows, from among the tenantry,
+and to start with the least possible delay by the route that we
+shall follow, of which I have given him particulars. He is to ride
+forward until he meets us, so that when he joins us, we shall be
+too strong a party for any force that the vicomte is likely to
+gather to intercept us."</p>
+<p>"A very wise precaution, Philip; but we shall be far upon our
+way, before this reinforcement can come up."</p>
+<p>"We shall be some distance, I admit. My messenger will take
+fully five days in going. He will take another day to gather and
+arm the tenants, so that they will not start until two days
+afterwards. Then, however, they will travel at least twice as fast
+as we shall, hampered as we are by the carriage. I should have
+suggested that Anne should ride on a pillion, behind me or her
+father, but I did not do so, because it would have been necessary
+to explain to him my reasons for suggesting the change; and,
+moreover, I felt sure that he would not agree to it, had I done so.
+Baron Pointdexter is one of the largest landowners in Languedoc,
+and although one of the kindest and best of men, he has his full
+share of family pride, and would consider that it was derogatory to
+his position for his daughter to be riding about on a pillion, like
+the wife or daughter of some small landed proprietor or tenant
+farmer, instead of in a carriage, as becomes her station.
+Therefore, I must accept the situation, carriage and all, and I can
+only hope that this villain will not attempt to interfere with us
+before my men join us.</p>
+<p>"Fortunately, even if a courier take the vicomte word that the
+baron and his daughter have made their adieus to His Majesty, the
+fellow cannot hear of it for two days, however fast the messenger
+may travel. Of course, Tulle is nigh a hundred miles nearer Paris
+than Pointdexter, which lies between Florac and Sainte Afrique,
+both of which towns lie within the circle of the estate. I admit
+that, foreseeing the baron is likely to return to his estates
+without delay, the vicomte may have made his preparations, and be
+ready to start as soon as he gets the news. Nevertheless, he will
+have a ride of some eighty miles to strike the road on which we
+shall be travelling. He may then move north, until he finds some
+suitable place for a surprise; but, even allowing for his
+exercising the greatest speed, we should be halfway from Paris
+before we can possibly meet him, and my men should join us by that
+time."</p>
+<p>"You have forgotten one contingency, which would entirely alter
+the state of things."</p>
+<p>"What is that?" Monsieur de la Vallee asked sharply.</p>
+<p>"We give this villain noble credit for resource and enterprise.
+What more likely than that he has left a couple of his retainers at
+Versailles, with orders that, should any messenger be sent off by a
+southern road from the baron, his journey is to be cut short, and
+any paper or letter found upon him carried with all speed to Tulle?
+In that case, the chances of our being met by a reinforcement are
+very small."</p>
+<p>"<em>Peste</em>! You are right, Desmond. I never gave the matter
+a thought. Now that you mention it, nothing is more probable. It
+was the servant who accompanied me whom I sent off, but, as de
+Tulle would have been notified of my arrival, and the man started
+from the baron's house, it would be deemed certain that he was
+either going to Pointdexter or my own estate, and that the message
+he carried was a somewhat urgent one. Well, all we can do is to
+hope that the fellow has not thought of our taking such a
+precaution, and that my messenger will arrive unmolested. Still, I
+acknowledge that the idea makes me anxious, and I fear that we
+shall not get through without serious trouble. There are so many
+disbanded soldiers, and other knaves, in the forests that de Tulle
+would have no difficulty in hiring any number of them, and carrying
+his scheme out without the assistance or knowledge of his own
+tenants. The heavy taxation necessary to keep up the expenses of
+the court has driven numbers of people to despair, and many
+hitherto law-abiding folk are being forced to leave their holdings,
+and to take to unlawful courses.</p>
+<p>"However, it is of no use our telling the baron our fears. He is
+obstinate, when he has once made up his mind to a thing, and
+nothing short of a royal command would induce him either to change
+his route, or to stop at one of the towns that we shall pass
+through, and wait until my band arrives. He would, indeed, consider
+his honour greatly attainted by allowing himself to make a change
+of plans, on the mere chance that our suspicions were
+justified."</p>
+<p>Six days passed without anything occurring. Impatient as Philip
+de la Vallee and Desmond were to get forward, they could not hurry
+the slow pace at which they travelled. Mademoiselle Pointdexter was
+now suffering from the reaction after her month of captivity and
+anxiety. The baron therefore travelled with provoking slowness.
+Obtaining, as he did, relays of horses at each post, they could
+without difficulty have travelled at almost double the rate at
+which they actually proceeded, but stoppages were made at all towns
+at which comfortable accommodation could be obtained. Indeed, in
+some places the roads were so bad that the carriage could not
+proceed at a pace beyond a walk, without inflicting a terrible
+jolting upon those within it.</p>
+<p>"There is one comfort," Philip said, when he had been bewailing
+the slowness of their pace, "my men should reach us at Nevers, at
+the latest, and you may take it as tolerably certain that any
+attempt to interfere with us will take place considerably south of
+that town. I should guess that it would be somewhere between
+Moulins and Thiers. If our escort does not come before we reach
+Moulins, I shall begin to think that your suggestion was correct,
+and that my messenger has indeed been intercepted and slain."</p>
+<p>Desmond could not gainsay the truth of his friend's calculation,
+but he said:</p>
+<p>"Possibly, Philip, instead of being attacked by the way, de
+Tulle's agents might rob him of his letter at one of the inns at
+which he put up. Did he know its contents?"</p>
+<p>"Yes. I told him that it contained an order for the majordomo to
+ride, with a troop of twelve men, to meet us, and that he was to
+give what aid he could in getting them together as quickly as
+possible; so that, even if robbed of the letter, he might still be
+able to fulfil his mission. Not, I own, that I thought of that at
+the time, for the idea that he might be stopped never once entered
+my mind."</p>
+<p>At Nevers, Desmond went round to all the inns in the town, to
+enquire if any body of men had put up at that place, but without
+success. When he related his failure to obtain any news to Philip,
+the latter said:</p>
+<p>"Well, we must hope that we shall meet them before we arrive at
+Moulins. If not, I shall no longer have any hope that my messenger
+got through safely, and then we shall have to consider whether it
+will not be necessary to inform the baron of our fears, and to get
+him to change his route and make a detour, cross the Loire at
+Bourbon, make for Maison, and then journey down on the other bank
+of the Saone as far as Pont Saint Esprit, and thence over the
+mountains to Florac."</p>
+<p>"That would certainly be the safest plan, always providing that
+we have not been watched ever since we left Paris. The vicomte
+might well take this precaution, in case we should deviate from the
+regular route."</p>
+<p>"<em>Sapriste</em>! Desmond, you are always full of evil
+prognostications. Still, as usual, I cannot but allow that there is
+reason in them."</p>
+<p>"You see, Philip, we have plenty of time, as we travel at a
+snail's pace, and in the evening when we stop, to think over the
+affair in every light. I always put myself in the position of the
+Vicomte de Tulle, and consider what steps I should take to ensure
+success in my next attempt to carry off Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter."</p>
+<p>"Then I am very glad that you are not in the position of de
+Tulle, for, if you were, I should consider that all was lost, and
+that there was not a chink or crevice by which we could escape. It
+is monstrous that a nobleman cannot travel from Paris to his
+estate, without being obliged to take as many precautions as the
+general of an army would have to do, against the attack of an
+active and formidable enemy."</p>
+<p>"And will you tell the baron, Philip?"</p>
+<p>"I hardly know what to do in that respect, for after all, we
+have no solid foundation whatever for our uneasiness, beyond the
+fact that the men I sent for have not met us. All our apprehensions
+are due solely to the fact that this fellow is utterly
+unscrupulous, and that his whole future depends on his carrying out
+his insolent designs successfully. If we had any solid facts to
+work on, I would urge the baron to change his route, but I fear
+that he would not only scoff at our views that there may be danger,
+but might be angry at my taking the step of sending for a party of
+my retainers, without his being in any way consulted in the matter.
+At any rate, I feel sure that he would refuse to change his route,
+without some very much stronger reason than we can give him."</p>
+<p>"Then we must let matters go on as they are, Philip. It may be
+that really we have been alarming ourselves without sufficient
+cause. If the worst comes to the worst, we can make a good fight
+for it."</p>
+<p>"It is certainly hard on you. You have performed one brave
+action for us, at the risk of your life, and now you are thrust
+into another danger, perhaps even greater than the first, and this
+in a quarrel in which you have no concern whatever."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"Do you not see, Philip, that the adventure is good training for
+a soldier, and that, if I am on duty in command of a company, I
+shall be all the more useful an officer for having served a sort of
+apprenticeship in surprises, ambuscades, and alarms. The journey
+has been vastly more interesting than it would have been under
+other circumstances. We should have found it dull, without such
+matter of interest as this affair has given us, and, even should
+nothing whatever come of it, it will have served its purpose by
+beguiling our journey, which, in truth, riding at so slow a pace,
+would otherwise scarce have been amusing."</p>
+<p>"Well, then, it seems that the only thing that we can do is to
+see that the servants all keep their pistols charged, and are
+prepared to do their duty in case of sudden attack. Of course, at
+present they have no idea that any special danger threatens us; but
+I shall tell them, before I start in the morning, that we fear the
+road is dangerous owing to a band of robbers reported to be in the
+forest, and that they must hold themselves in readiness for action,
+in case we fall in with any of them. Old Eustace and the coachman
+have both got arquebuses. I shall tell them that, should they be
+attacked, they are to fire at once, and then the coachman is to
+whip up his horses and drive at full speed, while we endeavour to
+keep off the assailants."</p>
+<p>"That would be of use, if the assailants should be for the most
+part on foot, but I think it more likely that they will be mounted,
+and however fast this lumbering carriage might go, they could
+easily keep up with it. Fight as hard as we may, the carriage must
+be overtaken if they are in sufficient force to overpower us. I
+should think that it would be well that you should warn
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter that we hear the road is not very safe,
+and that, if there is trouble, she is on no account to attempt to
+leave the carriage. As long as she remains there she will run but
+little risk, for you may be sure that de Tulle will have issued the
+strictest orders that no pistol is to be fired in its direction. I
+have also little doubt that he has ordered the baron's life to be
+respected, because his death would greatly add to the anger that
+would be excited by the attack, and would also put a barrier
+between him and mademoiselle, who would naturally regard him with
+even more hostility than before, as the author of her father's
+death. Therefore, I trust that in any case his life and hers will
+not be endangered, however numerous our assailants might be."</p>
+<p>"Yes, I have no doubt that that is so, Desmond, though I am sure
+that, were I wounded and on the point of death, I would rather know
+that Anne had fallen by a chance shot, than that she was in the
+power of this villain."</p>
+<p>The next morning, they started very early for Moulins, for the
+journey would be a longer one than usual, and the road through the
+forest would probably be so rough, that the pace must necessarily
+be very slow. At two o'clock, the men riding ahead noticed that a
+tree had fallen across the road, and one of them galloped back and
+informed the baron of it.</p>
+<p>"That is strange," the latter said. "There have been no storms
+for the past two days. It must have fallen quite recently, for
+otherwise the news would have been taken to the nearest commune,
+whose duty it would be to see at once to its removal."</p>
+<p>Philip de la Vallee had, as the servant was speaking, glanced at
+Desmond. To both, it seemed that this obstacle could scarcely be
+the result of an accident.</p>
+<p>"I will see how large the tree is," the baron said. "Whatever be
+its size, it is hard if eight men and four horses cannot drag it
+off the road."</p>
+<p>So saying, he cantered forward, followed by the retainer, whose
+comrade also fell in as they passed him.</p>
+<p>"Look to your arquebuses," Philip said to the two men on the
+box, and at the same time called up Mike and the two men, from
+behind.</p>
+<p>"A tree has fallen across the road," he said to them, "and it is
+possible that this may be an ambush, and that we may be attacked,
+so hold yourselves in readiness, look to your pistols, and see that
+the priming is all right in the pans."</p>
+<p>Then they went to the door of the carriage.</p>
+<p>"It is just possible that we are going to have trouble, Anne,"
+Philip said. "Remember what I told you last night, and on no
+account move from your seat, whatever may take place."</p>
+<p>As he spoke, there was a discharge of firearms in front, and at
+the same moment a score of horsemen broke from the trees, and rode
+down upon the carriage. Their leader was masked.</p>
+<p>As they came up, the coachman and Eustace discharged their
+arquebuses, emptying two saddles. Then, drawing their swords, both
+leapt to the ground. In the meantime Philip, Desmond, and the three
+men dashed at their assailants. Philip made for their leader, who,
+he doubted not, was the Vicomte de Tulle, but the latter drew a
+pistol and fired, when he was within a horse's length of him. The
+young man swayed in his saddle, and fell heavily to the ground,
+while a piercing cry from the carriage rose in the air.</p>
+<p>Desmond, after cutting down the first man he encountered, turned
+his horse and attacked the masked figure, who met him with a fury
+that showed he was animated by personal animosity. His skill in
+fencing, however, gave him but slight advantage in such an
+encounter, while Desmond's exercise with the sabre, in the
+regimental <em>salle d'armes</em>, was now most useful to him.
+Enraged at the fall of his friend, and seeing that there was but a
+moment to spare, for already some of the other assailants were
+coming to the assistance of their chief, he showered his blows with
+such vehemence and fury that his opponent had enough to do to guard
+his head, without striking a blow in return.</p>
+<p>Seeing in a moment that he would be surrounded, Desmond made a
+last effort. The vicomte's weapon shivered at the stroke, but it
+somewhat diverted the direction of the blow, and instead of
+striking him full on the head, the sword shore down his cheek,
+inflicting a ghastly wound, carrying away an ear as well as the
+cheek from the eye to the chin. Then, wheeling his horse, he dashed
+at two men who were riding at him.</p>
+<p>The attack was so sudden that one of their horses swerved, and
+Desmond, touching his charger's flank with a spur, rode at him and
+hurled horse and rider to the ground. A backhanded blow struck his
+other opponent full in the throat, and then he dashed into the
+wood, shouting to Mike to follow him.</p>
+<p>The two servitors had both fallen, and the greater part of the
+assailants were gathered round the carriage. Mike was engaged in a
+single combat with one of the horsemen, and had just run his
+opponent through when Desmond shouted to him; so, turning, he
+galloped after his master.</p>
+<p>They were not pursued. The fall of their leader had, for the
+moment, paralysed the band, and while three or four of them
+remained by the carriage--whose last defender had fallen--the
+others, dismounting, ran to where the vicomte was lying.</p>
+<p>"That has been a tough business, your honour," Mike said, as he
+joined his master. "It is right you were, sir, when you told me
+that you were afraid that rascal would try and hinder us on our
+way. Sure it has been a bad business, altogether. Monsieur Philip
+is killed, and the baron, too, I suppose, and all the others, and
+Miss Anne has fallen into the hands of that villain again."</p>
+<p>"I do not think that the baron has been hurt, Mike. I expect the
+orders were only to take him prisoner."</p>
+<p>"Where are we going, your honour?" Mike asked, for they were
+still galloping at full speed.</p>
+<p>"I am going to get into the road again, and try to find help, at
+Moulins, to recover the young lady. There is one thing, she is not
+likely to be molested by that fellow for some little time."</p>
+<p>"Then you did not kill him, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"No. I cut through his guard, but it turned my sword. But I laid
+his face open, and it will be some time before he will be fit to
+show himself to a lady. If, as I expect, I can get no help at
+Moulins, I shall ride on to Monsieur de la Vallee's place, gather
+some men there, and try to cut the party off before they get to
+Tulle. If I am too late, I shall see what I can do to rescue them.
+From la Vallee I shall go to Pointdexter. I have no doubt that we
+can get together a force, there, large enough to besiege de Tulle's
+castle."</p>
+<p>After an hour's ride, they arrived at Moulins, and Desmond rode
+at once to the mairie. Being in uniform, he was received with every
+respect by the mayor, who, however, on hearing his story, said that
+he did not see how he could interfere in the matter. It seemed to
+be a private quarrel between two nobles, and, even if he were ready
+to interpose, he had no force available; "but at the same time, he
+would send out four men, with a cart, to bring in any they might
+find with life in them."</p>
+<p>"Very well, sir," Desmond said, indignantly. "You know your
+duty, I suppose, and I know mine, and I shall certainly report to
+the king your refusal to give any assistance to punish these ill
+doers."</p>
+<p>So saying, he left the room, and at once rode to some stables.
+Leaving his horse and Mike's there, he hired others, and then
+continued his journey south at full speed, and before evening rode
+into Roanne. He knew that it was useless, endeavouring to stir up
+the authorities here, as they would naturally say that it was the
+business of the mayors at Nevers and Moulins, since the attack had
+taken place between those towns. Ordering fresh horses to be got
+ready, he said to Mike:</p>
+<p>"Do you go to all the inns on the left of the main street--I
+will go to all those on the right--and enquire if a troop of
+mounted men have come in. I am afraid there is no chance of it, but
+it is at least worth the trial."</p>
+<p>At the first four or five places he visited, the answer was that
+no such party had arrived; then, seeing one of the civic guards, he
+asked him if he had seen or heard of a troop of men passing through
+the town.</p>
+<p>"Such a troop arrived an hour ago, Monsieur l'officier. They
+stopped, as they passed me, and asked if Monsieur le Baron
+Pointdexter, accompanied by a carriage and some servants, had
+passed through the town. They put up at the Soleil, and I should
+think that they are there now, for they had evidently made a long
+journey, and their horses were too worn out to go farther."</p>
+<p>Delighted at the unexpected news, Desmond hurried to the inn. It
+was a second-class establishment, and evidently frequented by
+market people, as there were large stables attached to it. The
+landlord was standing at the door. He bowed profoundly, for it was
+seldom that guests of quality visited the inn.</p>
+<p>"What can I do for monsieur?" he enquired.</p>
+<p>"You have a party of travellers, who arrived an hour ago. I have
+business with them."</p>
+<p>"You will find them in this room, monsieur," the landlord said,
+opening a door.</p>
+<p>There were some twelve men inside. The remains of a repast were
+on the table. Some of the men were still sitting there, others were
+already asleep on benches. One, who was evidently their leader, was
+walking up and down the room impatiently. He looked up in surprise
+when Desmond entered.</p>
+<p>"You are the intendant of Monsieur de la Vallee, are you
+not?"</p>
+<p>"I am, sir," the man said, still more surprised.</p>
+<p>"I am a friend of your master. We have been expecting to meet
+you, for the past four or five days. He was travelling south with
+the Baron de Pointdexter and his daughter. We were attacked, this
+afternoon, on the other side of Moulins. The baron and his daughter
+were, I believe, carried off; the servants all killed. I saw your
+master fall, but whether mortally wounded or not I cannot say.</p>
+<p>"I and my servant cut our way through the assailants, who were
+led by the Vicomte de Tulle, who had before carried off
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter. I was on my way south to la Vallee,
+with but faint hope of meeting you on the road."</p>
+<p>"This is bad news indeed, sir," the intendant said. "I trust
+that my master is not killed, for we all loved him. As to
+Mademoiselle Pointdexter, it was an understood thing that she, one
+day, would be our mistress.</p>
+<p>"It is not our fault that we are so late. Our master's messenger
+was attacked, near Nevers, and was left for dead on the road. The
+letter he bore, and his purse, were taken from him. The night air
+caused his wounds to stop bleeding, and he managed to crawl to
+Moulins. Having no money, he was unable to hire a horse, and indeed
+could not have sat one. He went to an inn frequented by market
+people, and there succeeded in convincing an honest peasant, who
+had come in with a cart of faggots, that his story was a true one,
+and promised him large pay on his arrival at la Vallee.</p>
+<p>"The pace was, as you may imagine, a slow one, but two days ago
+he arrived home, and told me the story. I had the alarm bell at the
+castle rung at once, and in half an hour the tenants came in, and I
+chose these twelve, and started an hour later. Fortunately, the
+master had told the messenger what was the purport of his letter,
+and we have ridden night and day since. I am at your service,
+monsieur."</p>
+<p>"In the first place, let your men have a sleep. It is eight
+o'clock now. I will give them seven hours. At three in the morning,
+we will mount. There are not beds enough here, but if you get some
+clean straw scattered down in one of the sheds, the men can lie
+there. In the meantime, I will go round and hire fresh horses,
+leaving your own in pledge for their safe return.</p>
+<p>"You had better pick out two of your men to ride on to Moulins.
+The mayor there promised to send out a cart, to fetch in any
+wounded who might be found at the scene of the conflict. If, on
+their arrival, they find that Monsieur de la Vallee is not among
+these, they must ride on till they get there--it is some three
+leagues from the town--and bring in his body, together with those
+of his servants. They must arrange to give them Christian burial
+there, but your master's body they will, of course, take on to la
+Vallee.</p>
+<p>"His last wish, of course, would be that Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter should be rescued from the power of the villain noble
+who has carried her off. Starting in the morning so early, we shall
+have no difficulty in cutting him off long before he arrives at
+Tulle. He will probably cross the Alier at the ferry at Saint
+Pierre le Moutier. I must look at a map, and see the road that he
+is likely to follow, but it is probable that he will make by
+country tracks till he strikes the main road from Moulins."</p>
+<p>"Well, I should think, sir, that he would cross it near
+Aubusson, and then pass over the mountains by the road through
+Felletin, and come down upon Meimac, when he will be only two
+leagues from his castle near Correze. There is a good road from
+here to Aubusson, and we might take post on the road between that
+town and Felletin. At least, sir, we can avenge the murder of our
+dear master, though we have arrived too late to save him; and can
+rescue Mademoiselle de Pointdexter and her father."</p>
+<p>The men, who had roused themselves and listened to the
+conversation with many ejaculations of fury and regret, now
+exclaimed that they were ready to ride on at once.</p>
+<p>"There is no occasion for that, my friends," Desmond said. "The
+coach with mademoiselle can travel but slowly, especially along
+country roads."</p>
+<p>"Perhaps the vicomte may take her on the saddle behind him," the
+intendant suggested.</p>
+<p>"That he will not do," Desmond said. "In the fight I wounded him
+so sorely that he will, I think, have to be carried in a litter,
+and he will be in no condition for fast or long travelling, so that
+they certainly are not, at the present time, many leagues from the
+spot where they attacked us, and cannot reach Aubusson until the
+day after tomorrow. We might cut them off before they arrive there,
+but we do not know what road they may follow, and might miss them;
+whereas, from what you say, there can be no doubt that they would
+pass through Felletin."</p>
+<p>"I think that he would be sure to come that way, sir, for if he
+followed the road on to Limoges questions might be asked. At any
+rate, sir, we might post a man at Aubusson, and another at Pont
+Gibaut, as he might make from that town to Felletin through the
+village of Croc. How many men has he with him?"</p>
+<p>"That I cannot tell you. Some twenty mounted men, under his own
+leading, attacked the carriage. Two were shot by Eustace and the
+coachman. I disposed of two more, and my soldier servant of
+another. The two mounted men and the two servants probably killed
+two or three more, at least, before they themselves fell, so that
+the vicomte would only have some twelve mounted men with him. But
+there was another party in ambush, and I cannot say how strong they
+were; but probably, altogether, there would be twenty.</p>
+<p>"There are ten of your men, after sending two off to Moulins.
+Now there is yourself, my servant, and I, so we shall be thirteen.
+With the advantage of surprise, I think that we may calculate upon
+an easy victory, especially as I imagine that the men employed in
+the affair are not de Tulle's own retainers, but some robber band
+that he hired for the purpose; and these, having no special
+interest in the matter beyond earning the pay, are not likely to
+make any very determined resistance."</p>
+<p>Desmond now went back to the hotel where he had put up his
+horse. He found Mike awaiting him there, and the latter was
+delighted when he heard the news of the arrival of the party from
+la Vallee. Desmond's purse was but lightly furnished, and as he saw
+that the expenses might be heavy, he went to a jeweller's.</p>
+<p>"I want to borrow fifty louis," he said, "on this ring. It is, I
+imagine, worth a good deal more, since it was a present to me from
+the king."</p>
+<p>The jeweller examined the ring carefully.</p>
+<p>"It is a valuable one, indeed, sir," he said, "and I would
+willingly lend you double as much upon it."</p>
+<p>"Well, we will say seventy-five, then," Desmond said. "I think
+that will be ample for my purpose."</p>
+<p>Having received the money, he returned to the inn, accompanied
+by Mike; and went round to the various stables in the town, where
+he hired fifteen horses. These were to be taken to the Soleil, at
+three in the morning, and the men who brought them were to take
+back the tired horses as security.</p>
+<p>At that hour, the party started, and after a ride of some
+thirty-five miles reached Clermont, where they stabled the horses
+for six hours. Late that evening they arrived at Aubusson, having
+accomplished a journey of some seventy miles. One of the men had
+been left at Pont Gibaut, with orders to take a fresh horse and
+ride on to Aubusson, if the party they were in search of passed
+through the town.</p>
+<p>At Aubusson, Desmond took a fresh horse and rode back to Pont
+Gibaut, enquiring at all the villages along the road whether a
+party of twenty men had been seen to cross the road, at any point.
+Then he took four hours' sleep, and at daybreak started back again,
+making fresh enquiries till he arrived at Aubusson. He was
+convinced that the band had not, at that time, crossed the road on
+its way south.</p>
+<p>At ten o'clock he started out with his party, followed the road
+by the side of the Crorrere river--here a mere streamlet--and
+halted in a wood about five miles from Felletin.</p>
+<p>At six o'clock in the afternoon, a horseman was seen coming
+along, and was recognized as the man who had been left at Pont
+Gibaut. Desmond went out to meet him. He reported that, at twelve
+o'clock, a party of horsemen had come down on to the road a mile to
+the west of the town. He had followed at a distance, and they had
+turned off by the track leading to Croc. They had with them a
+carriage and a horse litter, and were travelling slowly.</p>
+<p>Desmond and his men at once shifted their position, and took up
+a post on the track between Croc and Felletin. An hour later, the
+party of horsemen were seen approaching the wood in which they were
+hidden. Desmond drew up the men, all of whom were armed with
+pistols, as well as swords, in line among the trees. He waited
+until the carriage was abreast of them, and then gave a shout, and
+the men at once dashed upon the escort.</p>
+<p>Taken completely by surprise, these made but a poor fight of it.
+Several were shot down at once. The vicomte, whose head was
+enveloped in bandages, leapt into the saddle of a horse whose rider
+had been shot, and, drawing his sword, rode at Desmond, who was
+making for the door of the carriage. Expecting no such attack, he
+would have been taken by surprise had not Mike, who saw his danger,
+shouted a warning, and at the same moment discharged his pistol.
+The ball struck de Tulle in the forehead, and he fell back
+dead.</p>
+<p>His fall at once put an end to the conflict. The robbers, who
+had lost some eight of their number, at once turned their horses'
+heads and rode off at full gallop.</p>
+<p>As Desmond drew bridle by the carriage, the door opened, and the
+baron leapt out.</p>
+<p>"By what miracle have you effected our rescue, my dear Monsieur
+Kennedy?" he exclaimed. "My daughter told me that she saw you and
+your servant break your way through these brigands, and ride off.
+She has been suffering an agony of grief for Philip, whom she saw
+shot. Have you any news of him?"</p>
+<p>"None, sir. I, too, saw him fall, but whether he was killed, or
+only wounded, I am unable to say. I have sent two men to bring him
+into Moulins, and I trust they will find that he is only
+wounded."</p>
+<p>"My daughter saw you cut down that villain with a terrible blow.
+We have not seen him since, but we know that he was carried on a
+horse litter behind the carriage."</p>
+<p>"At any rate, he will trouble you no more, Baron. My man shot
+him through the head, just as he was riding to attack me from
+behind."</p>
+<p>"Thank God! We are saved from further persecutions! And now,
+tell me how you came to be here."</p>
+<p>"It was simple enough, Baron. I found twelve men, with Monsieur
+de la Vallee's intendant, at Roanne. Philip, who feared that the
+vicomte would endeavour to make a further effort to repair his
+fortune, by carrying your daughter off on the road, sent a
+messenger to his intendant to ride at once, with twelve men, to
+meet us; and, had all gone well, they would have joined us fully
+two days' journey north of Nevers. The messenger was attacked on
+the way, robbed of his letter and purse, and left for dead. He
+managed to crawl to Nevers, and there, being too weak and ill to
+sit a horse, he hired a peasant's cart and made the journey, slowly
+and painfully, to la Vallee. As he knew the purport of the letter,
+two hours after his arrival there the intendant started, and rode,
+without drawing bridle, to Roanne. There, by great good fortune, I
+found them, though men and horses were alike done up. Knowing,
+however, that the vicomte, in his wounded state, and embarrassed
+with the coach, could proceed but slowly, I let them have seven
+hours' sleep, and in the meantime hired fresh horses for them; and
+we rode that day to Aubusson, and this morning moved down to within
+five miles of Felletin. I left a man on the road to Pont Gibaut,
+and he brought us word that you had left the main road, and were
+travelling through Croc, so we moved at once to intercept you; and
+you know the rest."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch7" id="Ch7">Chapter 7</a>: In Paris Again.</h2>
+<p>"You have indeed done well, Monsieur Kennedy," the baron said,
+when Desmond finished his story.</p>
+<p>"Now, let us see to my daughter. Her maid is attending on her.
+She fainted when the fight began. She is not of a fainting sort,
+but the trials of the last few weeks, and her belief that de la
+Vallee was killed, have very much upset her."</p>
+<p>"No wonder," Desmond said. "It must have been terrible, indeed,
+to lose her lover, and to know that she was again in the power of
+that villain.</p>
+<p>"And you, Baron; how did you escape the fate that befell the
+rest of your convoy?"</p>
+<p>"We had ridden close up to the tree, when suddenly there was a
+discharge of firearms. The two men with me fell at once. I was
+unhurt, but as I turned my horse he fell dead, three bullets having
+pierced his chest. Before I could recover my feet, the rascals were
+upon me. They evidently intended to take me alive, for they were
+provided with ropes, and, binding my arms, hurried me back to the
+carriage.</p>
+<p>"By the time we got there, all was over. My faithful Eustace and
+the coachman lay dead by the side of the carriage. They had fought
+stoutly, for three of the brigands lay beside them. Six others were
+scattered near, and the brigands were gathered round a fallen man,
+who I guessed was their leader.</p>
+<p>"I found Anne in a state of the wildest grief. She told me that
+she had seen Philip shot by the vicomte, just as he was attacking
+him, and that you in turn had cut down the villain.</p>
+<p>"For half an hour, nothing was done, and then one, who was
+evidently in authority over the others, left the troop and came up
+to the carriage.</p>
+<p>"'Monsieur le Baron,' he said, 'the orders of my chief are that
+you are to be placed in the carriage, with your daughter and her
+maid. If you will give your word of honour that you will not
+attempt to escape, or to give the alarm as you go along, or to
+address a word to anyone whom we may encounter, your arms will be
+freed, and you will be treated with all respect. If, on the
+contrary, you decline to give this promise, my instructions are
+that your feet as well as your hands are to be tied, and that you
+are to be gagged and placed in the bottom of the carriage. You are
+also to answer for your daughter and her maid; that they, too,
+neither by word nor gesture, shall attempt to attract the attention
+of anyone in the villages that we may pass through."</p>
+<p>"It was a hard condition, but I had no choice. The idea that I
+should suffer the indignity of being bound and gagged, like a
+common malefactor, made my blood boil. I should, in that case, no
+more be able to give the alarm than if I had been free; therefore I
+gave the promise, for at least it would be a comfort, to Anne, that
+I should be with her and able to talk to her.</p>
+<p>"We stopped two nights on the road, being lodged at solitary
+houses on the way. A guard was placed at my chamber door, and
+another at my window, and even had I not given my word I could not
+have escaped.</p>
+<p>"And now, Monsieur Kennedy, what do you propose?"</p>
+<p>"I think, sir, that it would be best that you should start at
+once, in the carriage, for Pointdexter. Monsieur Philip's intendant
+and his men will ride as your escort, but I do not think that there
+is the slightest probability of your being interfered with; for now
+that the vicomte is dead, these men--who were not, I think, his
+retainers, but a band of robbers whom he had hired for the
+occasion--will have no further motive for attacking you.</p>
+<p>"I myself shall return to Aubusson, send back the horse on which
+I rode there, hire another, and make straight for Moulins, where I
+still hope that I may find Monsieur de la Vallee alive.</p>
+<p>"Did you see the vicomte, after you were attacked?"</p>
+<p>"No. I heard one of the men tell the fellows who were guarding
+us that your stroke had cut off one of his ears, and laid his cheek
+bare from the eye to the chin. I fancy that he was too badly hurt
+to come to us, but in any case he would not have cared to show
+himself, in so terrible a plight."</p>
+<p>"We must admit that, with all his faults, he was brave," Desmond
+said; "for, in spite of his pain and weakness, and of the fact that
+his head was enveloped in bandages, he sprang from his litter,
+leapt into one of the saddles we had emptied, and, single handed,
+made for me, until my man cut his career short with a bullet.</p>
+<p>"As you go through Croc, it might be well that you should send
+one of the villagers off to his castle, to tell them that their
+master is lying dead here, when doubtless they will send out a
+party to fetch in his body."</p>
+<p>By this time, Mademoiselle de Pointdexter had recovered from her
+faint. She held out her hand to Desmond, as he stood bareheaded
+beside the door.</p>
+<p>"You have rescued me again, Monsieur Kennedy," she said; "for,
+though life seems worthless to me now, you have saved me from far
+worse than death. That you have so saved me, for my father's sake
+as well as my own, I thank you with all my heart."</p>
+<p>"I would have you still hope, mademoiselle. We know that
+Monsieur de la Vallee fell, but many men fall from their horses
+when wounded, even when the wound is not vital. I am riding at once
+to Moulins, and trust to find him still alive. Therefore, I pray
+you do not give up all hope."</p>
+<p>"I dare not let myself hope," she said. "It would be but to
+suffer another blow. Still, I feel that I have so much to be
+thankful for that, grievous as my sorrow is, I shall try to bear
+it, with the help of the Holy Virgin."</p>
+<p>The party now separated. The baron mounted one of the horses
+left behind by the brigands, and with the men from la Vallee
+started for Pointdexter; while Desmond, with Mike Callaghan, rode
+back to Aubusson.</p>
+<p>There they slept for a few hours, and then obtained fresh horses
+and started for Moulins, where they arrived late in the evening.
+They alighted at the Soleil, where Desmond had ordered the two men,
+who had gone on from Roanne, to bring the body of Monsieur de la
+Vallee.</p>
+<p>"The gentleman is not here, sir," the landlord said, as he came
+to the door. "He was brought into the town by the men sent out by
+the mayor. As, by his dress, he was evidently a gentleman of
+quality, they took him straight to the Couronne."</p>
+<p>"Was he alive?"</p>
+<p>"Yes, sir; but, as I hear, the surgeons are unable to decide yet
+whether he will live. The men you sent here arrived the day after
+he was brought in. They told me that you would return, and put
+their horses here, but they are now in attendance on the wounded
+gentleman, who, it seems, is their lord."</p>
+<p>"Thank God, he is alive!" Desmond exclaimed. "I have news for
+him that will do more than the surgeons can to restore him to
+himself."</p>
+<p>Leaving Mike to see the horses stabled, he hurried away to the
+other hotel. He sent up his name, and one of the surgeons came
+down.</p>
+<p>"Monsieur de la Vallee is very ill," he said, "although his
+wound is not necessarily mortal. This morning we succeeded in
+extracting the ball, but he is in a terribly weak state. He is
+unable to speak above a whisper, and does not seem to care to make
+any effort. It would appear that he even does not wish to
+live."</p>
+<p>"I have news that will put fresh life into him."</p>
+<p>"Then by all means go in and see him, sir. We have thought that
+he is fast sinking; but if the news you bring can rouse him into
+making an effort to live, he may yet recover. I will go in and give
+him a strong restorative, and tell him that you are here."</p>
+<p>In three or four minutes, he came to the door of the chamber,
+and beckoned to Desmond to enter.</p>
+<p>"The sound of your name has roused him from the lethargy, into
+which he seemed sinking," he whispered. "When I told him that I
+could not allow you to enter, until he had taken the draught that I
+gave him, he swallowed it eagerly."</p>
+<p>Desmond went up to the bedside, and took the hand which lay on
+the coverlet. The pressure was slightly returned, and Philip's lips
+moved, but he spoke so faintly that Desmond had to lean over him,
+to hear the words.</p>
+<p>"I am glad, indeed, that you are safe and sound. I have been
+reproaching myself, bitterly, that I should have brought you into
+this fatal business. As to the rest of it, I dare not even think of
+it; but I shall die all the easier for knowing that you have
+escaped."</p>
+<p>"I escaped for a good purpose, Philip. I have good news for you.
+Monsieur le Baron and mademoiselle are on their way to Pointdexter,
+under the guard of your men."</p>
+<p>"Is it possible, Desmond, or are you only saying it to rouse
+me?"</p>
+<p>"Not at all, Philip. You do not suppose that, even for that
+purpose, I would hold out false hopes to you; or tell an untruth on
+a matter so vital to your happiness."</p>
+<p>Philip's eyes closed, but his lips moved, and Desmond knew that
+he was returning thanks to God for this unlooked-for news.</p>
+<p>"How did it happen?" Philip said, after a silence of some
+minutes.</p>
+<p>His voice was much stronger than before, and there was a faint
+touch of colour in his cheeks. The surgeon nodded approvingly to
+Desmond, and murmured, "I think that he will live."</p>
+<p>"It is too long a story to tell you in full, now," Desmond said.
+"Seeing that all was lost, that you were down, and that further
+resistance was absolutely fruitless, Mike and I cut our way out;
+the more easily since I had struck down their leader, de Tulle, and
+most of his band had crowded round him. At Roanne I found your men,
+who had just arrived there. It matters not now why they had been
+detained. I got fresh horses for them and rode for Correze, placed
+an ambush, and turned the tables upon them. Mike shot the vicomte,
+and we easily defeated his followers, and rescued the baron and his
+daughter. I sent them to Pointdexter under charge of your intendant
+and followers, and rode hither, hoping against hope that I might
+find you still alive. Your two men, who came on here, could have
+told you that I had escaped."</p>
+<p>"I did not allow them to speak to monsieur," the surgeon said,
+"or even to see him. They are below, greatly grieved at being
+refused entry; but I told them that any agitation might be fatal to
+their master, and that they could do nothing for him if they came
+up; for indeed, up to the time when we extracted the ball, he was
+unconscious.</p>
+<p>"And now, monsieur, I think that it were best you should retire.
+I shall give Monsieur de la Vallee a soothing draught. A night's
+rest will be of vital importance to him. And now that you have
+relieved his mind of the load that has evidently weighed upon him,
+I think there is little doubt that he will soon fall asleep."</p>
+<p>"I will go and have supper," Desmond said, "for I have ridden
+fifty miles since I last ate, and then it was but a piece of bread
+with a draught of wine. After that I will, with your permission,
+return here, and if you tell me that he sleeps, will take my place
+by his bedside till morning."</p>
+<p>"To that I have no objection," the surgeon said. "I and a
+colleague have, one or other, been with him since he was brought
+in; and I shall be glad of a rest, myself."</p>
+<p>Desmond returned to the Soleil, where he had left Mike. The
+latter, who had just finished his supper, was delighted to hear
+that de la Vallee was likely to recover. After satisfying his own
+hunger, Desmond returned to the Couronne. He went upstairs, and,
+taking off his riding boots, stole to the door of his friend's
+chamber. It stood a little ajar, and, pushing it open noiselessly,
+he entered.</p>
+<p>The surgeon, who was sitting at the bedside, rose at once.</p>
+<p>"He is asleep already," he whispered, "and is breathing quietly.
+I think it likely that he will not stir until tomorrow morning. I
+shall be here at six. If he wakes, and there is any change, send
+for me at once."</p>
+<p>After he had left the room, Desmond took his place on the
+fauteuil by the bedside. For a time, he thought over the singular
+chain of adventures that he had gone through. Gradually, in spite
+of his efforts, his eyelids drooped. De la Vallee had not moved,
+and, being dead tired by the exertions of the past four days, he
+fell into a deep sleep, from which he did not awake until daylight
+streamed into the room.</p>
+<p>Shocked at having thus given way, he looked anxiously at de la
+Vallee, and was relieved to find that he was lying exactly in the
+same position, and had evidently slept without once waking. Half an
+hour later, Philip opened his eyes, looked wonderingly at him, and
+then said:</p>
+<p>"So, it was not all a good dream, Desmond! You are really here,
+and your news is true?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly, it is true, Philip. By this time Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter and her father are far on the way home. They were to
+have travelled on to Argentan, and then through Aurillac, striking
+the Lozere at Entraigues and proceeding along its banks to Mende,
+and thence by a road over the hills to Villefort, where they would
+be twenty miles from Pointdexter. The carriage was to be left
+behind at their first halting place. Mademoiselle was then to ride,
+and her maid to be carried behind one of your men, by which means
+they would travel more than twice as fast as they would do, if
+encumbered by the carriage. The baron said that he would spare no
+pains to get home as quickly as possible, and would send a man on,
+some hours ahead of him, to see that fresh horses were in readiness
+for the whole party at each town they came to."</p>
+<p>"Now tell me all about it, Desmond. I feel another man. Your
+good news, and a long night's sleep, have done wonders for me. Now,
+please tell me all about the affair."</p>
+<p>Seeing that Philip was so much stronger that he could hear,
+without being overexcited, the story of the rescue, Desmond related
+all the details to him.</p>
+<p>"You have indeed done wonders," Philip said. "You do not seem to
+know what fatigue is. How strange that you, whose name I had never
+heard until ten days back, should have rendered to Baron
+Pointdexter and myself two such inestimable services.</p>
+<p>"And so, after all your exertions and fatigue, you have been
+keeping watch at my bedside all night?"</p>
+<p>"I am ashamed to say that I have not been keeping watch,
+Philip," Desmond replied with a smile. "I had intended to, but you
+were sleeping so quietly, and everything was so still, that I went
+off and slept, as soundly as you have done, until within half an
+hour of the time when you opened your eyes; but I am sure that I
+should have awoke at once, had you moved."</p>
+<p>"Then I am glad that I did not move, Desmond, for you must
+sorely need a long sleep, after having passed three days and almost
+three nights in the saddle."</p>
+<p>The surgeons now arrived, and were delighted at the change that
+had taken place in their patient.</p>
+<p>"And when shall I be fit to travel, doctor?"</p>
+<p>"Ah, well, we will talk of that in another fortnight's time. You
+need absolute quiet, for were you to move, before your wound is
+fairly healed, inflammation might set in, and that would throw you
+back for a very long time. You have had a very narrow escape, and
+you are fortunate, indeed, to have got off with only a trifling
+detention."</p>
+<p>"But I might be carried in a horse litter?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly not, at present," the surgeon said decidedly.
+"Possibly, in ten days, you might without danger be so carried,
+providing they take you in short stages and with easy-paced horses;
+but I should say that it would be still better, were you to be
+carried on men's shoulders. There is never any difficulty in hiring
+men, and you could get relays every eight or ten miles, while it
+would be difficult to get horses accustomed to such work."</p>
+<p>"You don't think that I should be able to ride, doctor?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly not in less than a month, probably not in six
+weeks."</p>
+<p>"Then I must be carried," Philip said. "I should work myself
+into the fever you talk of, if I were to be kept here.</p>
+<p>"What are your plans, Desmond?"</p>
+<p>"I have not thought of them, yet. At any rate, I shall stay with
+you till you are well enough to start."</p>
+<p>"I could not think of that, Desmond."</p>
+<p>"You have no say in the matter, Philip. In the first place, you
+will get on all the faster for my being with you. In the next
+place, ten days of my leave are already expired, and were we to go
+on straight to Pointdexter, I should only have a few days there
+before starting back for Paris, and I must therefore postpone my
+visit to some future time. I can stay here ten days, accompany you
+some four days on your journey, and then turn back again."</p>
+<p>"A nice way of spending a month's holiday!" Philip grumbled.</p>
+<p>"It will be a holiday that I shall long look back to," Desmond
+said quietly, "and with pleasure. I do not say that I should not
+have enjoyed myself at the baron's chateau, for that I should have
+done; but the adventures that I have gone through will remain in my
+mind, all my life, as having gained the friendship of yourself, the
+baron, and his daughter."</p>
+<p>"Friendship seems to me too mild a word for it, Desmond. You
+have earned a gratitude so deep that it will be a pain to us, if we
+cannot show it in deeds."</p>
+<p>"And now, Philip," Desmond said, changing the subject abruptly,
+"I suppose that you will be, at once, sending off one of your men
+with the news that you are in a fair way towards recovery.
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter is suffering at the thought that you
+were probably killed. I did my best to give her hope, but without
+much success. Your two retainers have been fretting greatly that
+they were not allowed to see you, but I think that now they can be
+brought up, and you can choose one of them to act as your
+messenger. He will, of course, ride post, and can arrive at
+Pointdexter very soon after the baron, if indeed he does not get
+there first. If he starts at once, and changes horses at each
+place, he may be there by tomorrow at noon, if not earlier; for it
+is not more, I believe, than a hundred and twenty miles to
+Pointdexter. If you will dictate a letter for him to take, I will
+write it for you."</p>
+<p>"It must be a short one," the surgeon said, "just a few words.
+Monsieur de la Vallee has talked more than is good for him."</p>
+<p>Half an hour later the messenger started, carrying a note with a
+few words from Philip to Anne, and a longer letter from Desmond to
+the baron. Four days later answers were received. The messenger had
+arrived at Pointdexter two hours before the travellers reached
+home, and Anne's joy at the news that, not only was Philip alive,
+but might in a short time be with her, was deep indeed. The baron
+wrote to Desmond, as well as to Philip, again expressing the deep
+gratitude of himself and his daughter, greatly regretting that he
+should not have the opportunity, at present, of thanking him
+personally. With the letter the messenger brought a bag of money,
+concerning which he wrote:</p>
+<p>"You have, I know, dear Monsieur Kennedy, expended a
+considerable sum of money in hiring relays of horses, for yourself
+and Monsieur de la Vallee's men; and this, of course, is a debt you
+cannot object to my repaying. Without knowing the exact sum, I have
+roughly calculated the probable amount, and forward it to you by
+the messenger who will bring you this letter."</p>
+<p>Desmond had no hesitation in accepting the money. The baron had
+evidently taken considerable pains to calculate the sums that he
+must have laid out, in order not to hurt his feelings by sending a
+larger sum than he had spent, for the amount contained in the bag
+was but a few louis over his disbursements. He at once rode over to
+Roanne and redeemed his ring, which had proved of more value to him
+than he had ever anticipated.</p>
+<p>At the end of the ten days, Philip was strong enough to walk
+across the room, and the surgeon gave permission for him to start,
+if, instead of being carried all the way, he would be taken to
+Lyons, which was but twenty miles distant, and there take boat down
+the Rhone to Viviers. Desmond went with him to Lyons, and saw him
+comfortably bestowed on board a craft going down the river, and
+there left him in charge of his own retainers. Then, accompanied by
+Mike, whose wound was now well healed, he rode back to Paris by
+comparatively easy stages, arriving there on the day before his
+leave was up. He reported himself to the colonel.</p>
+<p>"So you have not been to Pointdexter after all! I received a
+long letter a week ago from the baron, sent by special messenger,
+giving me a full account of your doings, which reads like a chapter
+of romance. He mentioned that he had also written to the king,
+denouncing the conduct of the Vicomte de Tulle; and stating that,
+in the fight between his own rescuers and the vicomte's band, the
+latter was killed, and doing full justice to the part you played in
+the affair. I had a message from His Majesty yesterday, ordering
+that you should, as soon as you returned, go at once to Versailles,
+in order that he might question you further on the affair.</p>
+<p>"I have another piece of news for you. We have received orders
+to march in three days' time, which is a fortunate circumstance for
+you, for there can be no doubt that, however gallantly and well you
+have behaved in this affair, and in whatever light His Majesty may
+view it, you have incurred the enmity of de Tulle's family and
+connections, and the air of Paris would not be healthy for you, for
+a time. I need not say that I have read the baron's letter to your
+comrades, and that they fully shared with me the admiration I feel
+at your conduct."</p>
+<p>"Had I better start at once for Versailles, sir?"</p>
+<p>"I think so. The king is not pleased at being kept waiting. He
+is sure to ask you when you arrived. You had better take one of my
+horses. I will order it to be brought round, and shall be at your
+quarters by the time you have put on your full uniform."</p>
+<p>The king had just returned from hunting when Desmond arrived at
+the palace, and gave his name to one of the ushers. Five minutes
+later, he was conducted to the king's dressing room.</p>
+<p>"This is a serious business, young sir, in which you have been
+engaged," the king said shortly to Desmond, as he entered.</p>
+<p>"I am aware of that, Sire, and yet I am well assured that every
+officer in Your Majesty's service would have acted as I did, under
+similar circumstances."</p>
+<p>"The Baron de Pointdexter has written to us fully on the
+matter," the king said, "but we wish to hear the account from your
+own lips. When did you return to Paris?"</p>
+<p>"But two hours since, Sire."</p>
+<p>"Then you have lost no time in presenting yourself here. Now,
+tell us the whole matter, omitting no detail."</p>
+<p>Desmond told the story fully. He was interrupted once by the
+king.</p>
+<p>"How was it that Monsieur de la Vallee's people were at
+Roanne?"</p>
+<p>Desmond then related the fears that he and Philip had
+entertained, lest the vicomte should make another attempt to carry
+off Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and how, without the baron's
+knowledge, Philip had sent off a messenger to his intendant for a
+body of his men to meet them on the way; how the messenger had been
+intercepted and desperately wounded, and how, in consequence,
+instead of their being met by the party at Nevers, or north of that
+town, they had only reached Roanne after the attack had been made
+on the travellers, near Moulins.</p>
+<p>The king asked no more questions, until Desmond finished his
+story.</p>
+<p>"You did well, sir," he then said; "and the conduct of the
+Vicomte de Tulle was outrageous, and we should have visited him
+with our heaviest displeasure, had he not already received his
+deserts. It is intolerable that a noble gentleman, with his
+daughter, cannot travel along the highroads of our kingdom without
+being thus assaulted. It was the more scandalous when the vicomte
+was banished from our court for a similar attempt. The fact that he
+had enjoyed our favour would in no degree have mitigated--indeed it
+would have increased--our anger at his conduct, since it would have
+seemed as if he had relied upon it for immunity for his action.
+Surely, such a belief would have been an erroneous one. The law
+must be observed, and the higher placed a man is, the more is he
+bound to set an example of obedience to it.</p>
+<p>"We thank you, sir, for having thwarted so daring and villainous
+a scheme. We have not yet sent an answer to the Baron de
+Pointdexter, because we wished your report of the matter before
+doing so. We shall now cause him to be informed of our indignation
+at the plot against his person and that of his daughter, and our
+satisfaction that they have escaped from it.</p>
+<p>"You have begun your career well, indeed, young sir. Your
+regiment is about to start for the frontier. We shall direct your
+colonel to report to us, from time to time, as to your conduct, and
+shall see that your promotion is in accordance with your actions,
+and shall request him to offer you any opportunity that may occur
+for distinguishing yourself."</p>
+<p>Desmond rode back to Paris well satisfied with the result of the
+interview. He had not been slow in noticing that, although the
+king's approval of his actions had been warmly expressed in words,
+there was a certain coldness in the tone in which they were spoken,
+which showed that, although the king's sense of justice constrained
+him to praise, he was at heart sore at the death of one who had
+been a favoured companion in his sports and amusements.</p>
+<p>On his return, he found his two friends waiting for him, at his
+quarters. They gave him a hearty greeting.</p>
+<p>"You are a perfect paladin, Kennedy," O'Neil said; "and, though
+we are all proud of you, we cannot help feeling a little envious
+that such adventures have all fallen to the lot of our junior
+ensign. It is evident that, if you were not born with a silver
+spoon in your mouth, fortune determined to make up in other ways,
+by giving you such chances as do not fall to the lot of anyone
+else."</p>
+<p>"Yes, I think I have every right to consider myself
+exceptionally fortunate."</p>
+<p>"You may have been fortunate, Kennedy," O'Sullivan remarked.
+"The thing is, that you took advantage of the opportunities. You
+threw yourself into the first adventure that came your way, rescued
+a lovely damsel in distress, and her gratitude and that of her
+father attracted the king's notice, and gained that ring on your
+finger. In the next place, after escaping from the ruffians who
+attacked the coach--principally, as it seems, by cutting down their
+leader, and so occupying the attention of his followers--you
+instantly took the resolution to attempt to rescue him and his
+daughter, and succeeded in doing so. Another man might have stopped
+at Moulins, congratulating himself that he had escaped from the
+trap, and lamenting that he could do nothing towards again rescuing
+this damsel from her abductors. Of course, it was a piece of good
+fortune, meeting de la Vallee's men at Roanne; but I have no doubt
+that, if you had not done so, you would still have got to
+Pointdexter, gathered a force, and intercepted the vicomte's
+party."</p>
+<p>"It would have been a very near thing, O'Sullivan. Changing
+horse at every post, I might have got to Pointdexter from Roanne in
+twenty-four hours; but I doubt whether, even allowing that no time
+was lost in getting the men together, I could have got to Tulle
+before them. They had but one hundred and fifty miles to travel, I
+should have had still farther; and, as they would have had three
+days' start, they should have been there before me; for I heard
+from the baron that, in addition to the four horses in the coach,
+they had four others, ridden by troopers, fastened to it where the
+road was bad."</p>
+<p>"What would you have done if they had got to the vicomte's
+chateau--it is, I believe, a strong place--before you could
+intercept them?"</p>
+<p>"I cannot say what I should have done. I thought the matter over
+and over again as we rode. It seemed absurd to think of attacking a
+chateau with only twelve men; and besides, it would have been a
+very serious business to assault a noble in his own castle. There
+would almost certainly be twenty or thirty men there, at the least,
+and the ringing of the alarm bell would have brought all his
+vassals within five miles round to his aid, at once. I have no
+doubt that I should have attempted something, but in what way I
+could form no idea, until I saw the place."</p>
+<p>The two young men laughed.</p>
+<p>"I believe that you would have succeeded somehow, Kennedy,"
+O'Neil said. "After what you have done, I have an almost unlimited
+faith in you, and if you told me you could see no other plan than
+carrying off His Gracious Majesty, and taking him down to Tulle and
+forcing him to order this rascal vicomte to deliver up his
+captives, you would accomplish it."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"The plan might be as good as another, though I own that it had
+not occurred to me; but it would certainly necessitate my having
+him held prisoner until I had got safely out of France, otherwise
+my fate would assuredly be to be broken on the wheel."</p>
+<p>"Yes; I don't think His Gracious Majesty would have forgiven
+such an indignity, even if put upon him for a good purpose. It is
+almost treason even to dream of such a thing."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"It was a purely imaginary case; but you see, not having been
+accustomed, as you are, to a country where the king is regarded
+almost as a god, I am afraid I have not that awe of him that is
+generally entertained here. I have, naturally, a great respect for
+the king whom I serve, and whose pay is a matter of the greatest
+importance to me; but after all, although in his service, he is not
+my lawful king."</p>
+<p>"Then you would not even imagine such a thing as to take your
+lawful king, James, prisoner, however much the fate of someone in
+whom you were interested was concerned?"</p>
+<p>Desmond did not answer at once.</p>
+<p>"I don't know," he said at last, "what I should do, in such a
+case. For King James, as lawful king of my country, I have the
+deepest respect, and would freely venture my life in his service;
+but for him as a man, irrespective of his crown, I own that my
+admiration is not extreme, and that I should not hesitate to join
+in any plan for putting pressure upon him, on behalf of anyone in
+whom I was extremely interested, as I certainly am now in
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter and Monsieur de la Vallee."</p>
+<p>"You are a curious fellow, Kennedy," O'Neil said, with a smile,
+"and I should be very much puzzled if I were called upon to predict
+what your fate is likely to be. It seems to me that you have an
+equal chance of becoming a French marshal, or being broken on the
+wheel. Here you are, not yet seventeen. You have, as I doubt not,
+somewhat interfered with the king's plans, and caused him the loss
+of one of his personal friends. You have twice rescued a noble lady
+from the hands of her abductors. You have brought disgrace and
+death upon a member of one of the most powerful families in France.
+You have earned the gratitude and friendship of one of the leading
+nobles of Southern France, that of the fiance of his daughter, and
+of the daughter herself. As soon as this affair spreads abroad, you
+will be the object of general remark and attention. You have
+rendered the regiment to which you belong proud of you, its junior
+ensign, and made Paris emphatically too hot to hold you.</p>
+<p>"If all this is done before you are seventeen, what may we
+expect when another ten years have passed over your head?"</p>
+<p>"You had better wait for the ten years to pass, O'Neil," Desmond
+laughed; "by which time, perhaps, you and O'Sullivan will both have
+learned wisdom, and will see that, because a man happens to have
+gone through a very exciting adventure without discredit, it by no
+means proves him to be anything in the smallest degree out of the
+way."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch8" id="Ch8">Chapter 8</a>: To Scotland.</h2>
+<p>Two days later the regiment was paraded, but no order had been
+received for their start, and their destination was still
+uncertain. The officers stood in a group, awaiting the arrival of
+the colonel, who entered, accompanied by Colonel Wauchop and
+several other Irish officers. As there had been no notice of an
+official inspection, there was a general feeling of surprise at the
+appearance of the visitors. The colonel rode up to the group of
+officers.</p>
+<p>"Gentlemen," he said, "I must ask you all to accompany me to the
+common room. I have news of importance to give you."</p>
+<p>He and those with him dismounted, and, followed by the wondering
+officers of the regiment, went into the large room where they
+gathered in the evening.</p>
+<p>"The news that I am about to give you is of an important and
+happy nature. His Most Gracious Majesty has decided to send an
+expedition to Scotland, where the whole country is ready to rise in
+favour of our lawful king."</p>
+<p>A cheer broke from his hearers.</p>
+<p>"Many Scottish and Irish gentlemen," the colonel went on, "have
+been selected to accompany it. Among them is my friend, Colonel
+Wauchop, and the officers with him. The expedition will consist of
+six thousand French troops. I regret to say that no Irish regiments
+will accompany it."</p>
+<p>A groan of disappointment followed this announcement.</p>
+<p>"We must hope," the colonel said, "that Irish troops are not
+employed, only because it is intended that another expedition will
+sail to Ireland, in which case we may be sure that some of us will
+have an opportunity of fighting, again, on our own side of the
+water. Moreover, between France and Scotland there has long been a
+close connection and friendship, and the employment of French
+troops would, therefore, better suit the Scots than would be the
+case with Irishmen. Another reason perhaps is, the King of France
+does not like to spare his best troops, when he has sore need of
+them in Flanders and Spain.</p>
+<p>"However, a number of Irish officers will accompany the
+expedition, for the purpose of drilling and commanding the new
+levies, for which work they will be far better suited, by their
+knowledge of English, than French officers would be. Therefore, the
+various Irish regiments are all to furnish a certain number of
+lieutenants. Generals Hamilton, Sheldon, Dorrington, and Lords
+Galmoy and Fitzgerald, and our friend Colonel Wauchop will be in
+command of the newly-raised force, having with them many Scotch
+officers now in the service of France.</p>
+<p>"The secret of the expedition has been well kept, but I have
+known it for a fortnight, and have prepared a list of the fifteen
+officers who are to go. I may say that, in order to avoid
+partiality, I have, with one exception, selected them by lot. Those
+who are to go will doubtless consider themselves fortunate. Those
+who are to stay are still more lucky, if, as I hope, the regiment
+will form part of a similar expedition sent to Ireland."</p>
+<p>He then read out the list of the officers chosen. O'Sullivan and
+O'Neil were both among them, and the name of Desmond Kennedy was
+the last read out.</p>
+<p>"You will, gentlemen, start in an hour's time, taking the
+northern road through Montvidier and Arras. In each of these towns
+you will be joined by officers from other regiments. Colonel
+Wauchop will accompany you. I do not name the port from which you
+are to sail, and no word must be said, by you, as to the route you
+are to travel; but you can no doubt judge for yourselves, by the
+road that you are taking, what port is your destination. The French
+troops will be already there, and the fleet is all in
+readiness.</p>
+<p>"You all have horses. You can each take your soldier servant
+with you, but those who do so must either hire or purchase a horse
+for him. All further details you will learn from Colonel Wauchop,
+and the paymaster will have orders to issue two months' pay to each
+of you, in advance. The distance will be about a hundred and fifty
+miles, and you will perform it in five days."</p>
+<p>Colonel Wauchop then addressed a few words to the officers, all
+of whom were under the rank of captain.</p>
+<p>"Gentlemen," he said, "you have an honourable task before you.
+For years we have been waiting for the day when our swords might
+aid to place our king upon the throne. At last it has come. I need
+not say that the struggle will be a severe one, and that your
+courage will be taxed to the utmost, but you have proved that in a
+score of desperate fights.</p>
+<p>"The task before you will need tact to no ordinary degree. The
+Scotch are as peppery a race as the Irish are, and it will be
+necessary in no way to hurt their feelings, or to excite among them
+the smallest degree of discontent at being drilled and led by men
+who are not of their own race.</p>
+<p>"And now, as we have much to do before starting, I will leave
+you to make your arrangements. The rendezvous for us all is in your
+barrack yard, and at nine o'clock we shall be here."</p>
+<p>The colonel now left the room, and the officers eagerly and
+excitedly talked over the startling news that they had just heard.
+The greater part of those who had been selected for the service
+were delighted to go, while the others were equally pleased, at the
+thought that they might shortly be fighting for King James on the
+soil of Ireland.</p>
+<p>"Sure, your honour, I wish it had been in the ould country
+instead of Scotland," Mike said, when he heard the news.</p>
+<p>"I cannot say that I agree with you, Mike. In Ireland, we should
+find tens of thousands of brave hearts ready to join us, but they
+are unarmed, undrilled, and undisciplined, and would be of
+comparatively slight assistance to us against the English troops.
+Defeat would bring down fresh persecutions, fresh confiscations,
+and greater misery upon the land."</p>
+<p>"Sure we would beat them, your honour."</p>
+<p>"We might, Mike; but you must remember that we failed to do so,
+even when the people were armed. No doubt we shall take a certain
+amount of muskets and ammunition with us, but the power of England
+is more assuredly fixed in Ireland now than it was then--the
+influence of the old Irish families is broken, and even if we armed
+all who joined us, it would be but an armed rabble and not an
+army.</p>
+<p>"In Scotland it is altogether different. The Scottish clans
+would join us under their chiefs, to whom they give absolute
+obedience, and they would turn out armed and ready for action.
+Thus, then, I think that, allowing that Ireland is as loyal as
+Scotland, the choice has been a wise one."</p>
+<p>"Sure, you know best, your honour; but I will warrant that as
+soon as Scotland rises, Ireland will be in a blaze from one end to
+the other."</p>
+<p>"That may well be, Mike; but there will then be a chance of
+success, since the English forces will be fully occupied by our
+descent in the north, which will threaten London, while Ireland can
+be left to itself until the main question is settled."</p>
+<p>"It is mighty lucky, your honour, that I should have stuck to
+the horse we got when we rescued Miss Pointdexter."</p>
+<p>"I am very glad, too, Mike, for otherwise I should have had to
+buy one, and it is likely enough that I may want all the money I
+have, before this campaign that we are starting upon is over."</p>
+<p>O'Neil and O'Sullivan, at this moment, burst into the room.</p>
+<p>"It is glorious that we three should all be going, Kennedy!" the
+latter exclaimed. "It is just your luck, for you are the only
+ensign named, while the regiment will be left with only four
+lieutenants. Of course, I should be still better pleased if we were
+going to Ireland. Still, for anything we know that expedition may
+not come off, and, so that we are fighting for the king, it's all
+one whether it is in Scotland or at home."</p>
+<p>Having seen that all was ready for departure, Desmond went to
+the colonel's quarters to say goodbye. Several of the officers who
+were going were already there, and the colonel motioned to him to
+stay until they had left. When they had done so, he said:</p>
+<p>"Perhaps you guessed, Kennedy, that you were the one exception I
+mentioned to the rule I adopted, of fixing by lot upon those who
+were to go."</p>
+<p>"No, indeed, sir," Desmond said, in surprise; "I thought it an
+extraordinary piece of good fortune that I should be the only
+ensign to go, when there were so many others all senior to me.
+Indeed, I thought for a moment of saying that I would resign, in
+favour of one who was older and more experienced than myself; but
+then it struck me that if I did, some of the junior lieutenants
+might feel themselves obliged to do the same, in favour of their
+seniors."</p>
+<p>"I should not, in any case, have permitted a change to be made.
+I had decided that, in order to avoid jealousy, chance should
+decide the matter. Indeed, you are the only ensign going with the
+expedition. I informed Colonel Wauchop and General Hamilton of the
+reason for which I specially included you.</p>
+<p>"So long as it was supposed that the regiment was on the point
+of marching to Spain, I considered that, if you took my advice and
+did not leave the barracks after nightfall, no harm would befall
+you. But the case is altered, now that it may remain here for some
+time, for no doubt it will take part in any expedition sent to
+Ireland. I have heard, within the past forty-eight hours, that the
+friends of de Tulle have made very strong representations to the
+king. They have urged that your proceedings, involving what they
+call the murder of their kinsman, were of the nature of civil war;
+and that, if his conduct had been reprehensible, it was for the
+Baron de Pointdexter to lay the matter before His Majesty and ask
+for redress.</p>
+<p>"I hear, however, the king received their remonstrances coldly,
+told them that de Tulle had brought his fate upon himself, that it
+was the duty of every gentleman to endeavour to rescue a lady, so
+feloniously carried off, and that he approved of the readiness and
+energy with which you had taken steps to do so.</p>
+<p>"On finding, then, that they have failed in their hope of having
+you sent to one of the royal prisons, from which you would probably
+never have come out alive, I have no doubt whatever that these
+people will endeavour to take the matter into their own hands, and
+that, with the means at their disposal, they will find no
+difficulty in procuring persons who would undertake to assassinate
+you. As I have said, if you had at once started for the army, we
+might have looked after your safety until you crossed the frontier,
+but here in Paris you would not be safe for an hour, and could
+scarce venture between the barracks and your lodging, unless under
+a strong guard. Under such circumstances, I consider that I was
+justified in placing you on the list of the officers who would
+accompany the expedition.</p>
+<p>"I explained to General Hamilton and Colonel Wauchop, who both
+happened to be with me, my reasons for wishing to include so young
+an officer in the ranks of those selected for the service. The
+officers heartily agreed with me, having, of course, heard the
+story, or, at any rate, the main facts of your rescues of
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter."</p>
+<p>"I am indeed greatly obliged to you, Colonel. I know that it is
+a dangerous thing to incur the enmity of one of those powerful
+families, and, though I should certainly have taken every
+precaution in my power, I felt that I should be in constant danger
+until we fairly embarked upon a campaign."</p>
+<p>At nine o'clock the party started. It numbered some fifty
+officers, Scotch and Irish. The baggage had started half an hour
+before. It was to join the carts, with the baggage of the other
+officers, outside the northern gates; and was under an escort of
+dragoons, whose officer had powers given him to requisition fresh
+horses at each town through which he passed, and so to push on to
+the port with but two halts.</p>
+<p>Once off, there was no longer any necessity for keeping their
+destination a secret, and the officers were informed that, as they
+had already guessed, Dunkirk was the harbour from which they were
+to sail.</p>
+<p>The journey was a pleasant one. All were in the highest spirits.
+A short distance behind them marched a body of infantry, composed
+entirely of noncommissioned officers, of whom O'Brien's regiment
+furnished thirty. All were picked men, and, marching each day as
+far as the party of officers rode, arrived at Dunkirk on the fifth
+day after starting, and were at once embarked on the ships of
+war.</p>
+<p>Colonel Wauchop and the officers of O'Brien's regiment were told
+off to the Salisbury, which was a ship that had been taken from the
+English, and was now loaded with military stores, arms, and
+munitions for the use of those who were expected to join them on
+landing. After seeing that the officers were all properly
+accommodated, the colonel went ashore, and when he returned it was
+at once seen, by the expression of his face, that something was
+wrong.</p>
+<p>"I have very bad news," he said. "King James, who arrived here
+two days ago, has been taken suddenly ill, and until he is
+partially recovered we cannot sail, for it is absolutely necessary
+that he should be with us. This may mean the delay of a week or ten
+days, and may defeat all our arrangements. The English Government
+have spies here, as well as elsewhere; and their fleet has, for the
+last week, been hovering off the coast. They may not have known the
+purpose of the assembly of troops here, for this has been kept
+strictly secret; and few even of the French officers of the
+expedition knew, until they arrived here, for what reason the
+regiments had been ordered to Dunkirk. But the arrival of King
+James, of course, showed what was the intention, and, as soon as
+the news reaches London, you may be sure that the English fleet
+will be sent to intercept us."</p>
+<p>It was, indeed, ten days before James was sufficiently recovered
+to be embarked--a delay which probably cost him his kingdom, for
+there can be no doubt that, on landing, he would have been joined
+at once by all the great clans, and by no small proportion of the
+able-bodied men of the country.</p>
+<p>The consequences were so evident, to all engaged in the
+expedition, that despondency took the place of the enthusiasm with
+which they had embarked. The fact that the expedition, after being
+so carefully and secretly prepared, should at its outset meet with
+so serious a misfortune, was considered an omen of evil. At last,
+however, James embarked, under a salute by the guns of the ships of
+war; and as the sails were hoisted and the anchors weighed, the
+spirits of all again rose.</p>
+<p>They had sailed but a few miles when it became evident that the
+Salisbury was the slowest ship in the fleet, for, although she had
+every stitch of canvas set, she lagged behind the rest, and the
+other vessels were obliged to lower some of their sails, in order
+to allow her to keep up with them.</p>
+<p>"I begin to think, Kennedy," O'Neil said, "that the good fortune
+that has hitherto attended you has spent itself. O'Sullivan and I
+both regarded it as a good omen that you should be the one ensign
+selected to go with us, but this miserable delay at Dunkirk, and
+the fact that we are on board the slowest tub in the fleet, seems
+to show that Dame Fortune is no longer going to exercise herself in
+your favour."</p>
+<p>"It looks like it, indeed," Desmond agreed. "Still, I can't hold
+myself responsible for either the king's illness, or for our being
+allotted to this heavy-sailing craft; and, perhaps, even if fortune
+should not favour me any longer, she will do something for some of
+the others.</p>
+<p>"She has always been favourable to Colonel Wauchop. He has been
+through innumerable engagements. Though many times wounded, he has
+never been seriously so, though scores of other officers have
+fallen in enterprises in which he has taken part. In his case,
+fortune has not been fickle, and, as he is the chief officer on
+board, we must hope that she has not deserted him on this occasion.
+I think there is a certain amount of luck in the fact that we carry
+a large amount of guns and ammunition. If that had not been the
+case, it is likely that, rather than delay, the squadron would sail
+on at full speed, and have left us to follow as best we might."</p>
+<p>A constant watch was maintained at the masthead of the ship, but
+no signs were seen of the English fleet, until, on the 23rd of
+March, six days after sailing, they reached the mouth of the Firth
+of Forth, and were congratulating themselves that they had brought
+the voyage to a successful termination.</p>
+<p>At daybreak next morning, however, just as they were about to
+enter the estuary, they beheld the masts of a great fleet coming
+out to meet them. This was the squadron of Sir George Byng, which
+had for some days been on the coast, having been despatched as soon
+as the news reached London of the gathering of ships and troops at
+Dunkirk, and of the arrival of the Pretender there. The French
+admiral at once signalled to all the ships to put about, and he lay
+off until the English fleet were near enough to discern its
+composition, which was far superior in force to his own. Seeing the
+impossibility of landing the troops and stores, and the slight
+chances of success in giving battle, he hoisted the signal for all
+to make their way back to Dunkirk, keeping as much as possible
+together, in order to defend themselves if overtaken, or if
+intercepted by another hostile fleet.</p>
+<p>In vain, James begged that a few boats might be given him, with
+which to land with his chief followers. The French admiral replied
+that his instructions would not justify him in doing so, and that
+he had been ordered to specially protect the person of the young
+king, whose safety was of the highest concern to his sovereign.</p>
+<p>It was with the deepest feeling of disappointment, and
+depression, that the Scotch and Irish officers heard that it was
+determined to sail for Dunkirk again. Had the troops on board the
+ships been of their own nationality, they would have ordered them
+to disobey the admiral's commands, and to insist upon the fleet, if
+it succeeded in evading the pursuit of the enemy, making another
+effort to effect a landing. As, however, all the soldiers were
+French, with the exception of the two or three hundred
+noncommissioned Irish officers, they were powerless, and were half
+mad with rage and grief.</p>
+<p>"This looks bad for us," O'Sullivan said gravely to his two
+friends. "I think that the French ships will outsail the English,
+but there is little chance that this unwieldy craft will do so; in
+which case, my friends, it is likely that we shall all see the
+inside of an English prison, and that probably not a few of us will
+be executed. The colonel should be safe, for he came over with the
+Brigade after Limerick, and therefore by that treaty was allowed to
+enter the service of France; but it is different with the rest of
+us. We have all joined since those days, and are therefore not
+covered by the treaty, and so are liable to be tried as
+traitors."</p>
+<p>O'Neil shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+<p>"Well, we knew that when we joined," he said. "However, I hardly
+think they are likely to proceed to such an extremity. Very many of
+our Brigade have been taken prisoners, at Blenheim and other
+places, and they have always had the same treatment as other
+prisoners of war."</p>
+<p>"That may be," O'Sullivan replied; "but this is a different
+matter. It is not a question of war on foreign soil. We were going
+to attack the throne of Anne, to promote civil war, and to
+overthrow the Government. The attempt once made can be made again,
+and you may be sure that the news of our sailing has created a
+tremendous scare throughout the country. However, we are in for it,
+and there is no use grumbling against fate. Already, you see, the
+rest of the fleet are leaving us--faster, I think, than the English
+fleet are gaining on us--and I trust they will get safely away into
+Dunkirk.</p>
+<p>"The fact that we so nearly succeeded will, perhaps, act as an
+inducement to Louis to renew the expedition; and the loss of a
+colonel, fifteen lieutenants, and thirty noncommissioned officers
+will not seriously affect anyone except ourselves."</p>
+<p>"However," Desmond put in, "I think that, after all, things may
+not be as bad as you think. In the first place, our execution would
+have an extremely bad effect in Scotland and Ireland, and would add
+to the general hostility to the present Government. In the next
+place, Louis has many English prisoners in his hands, and might
+threaten reprisals. Lastly, there is always a chance of
+escape."</p>
+<p>"Your first two arguments are good, Kennedy," O'Neil said, "but
+I cannot say as much for the last. The chances of escape from an
+English prison must be small indeed."</p>
+<p>"Nevertheless there must always be chances," Desmond said. "If
+you will take my advice you will at once go below, and conceal your
+money."</p>
+<p>"Where are we going to conceal it?" O'Sullivan said. "You may be
+sure that we shall be searched."</p>
+<p>"Well, you took my advice, in changing the silver in which you
+were paid into gold, though you lost pretty heavily by the
+transaction. We did it to prevent lugging about a heavy bag of
+silver. Now, it has its advantages. You could not hope to conceal
+silver, but we may, at least, hide a few pieces of gold. Mike is a
+handy fellow, and I have no doubt will be able to help us. At any
+rate, let us go below and see what can be done."</p>
+<p>Mike was summoned to the cabin.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mike," Desmond said, "I suppose, in a campaign, a good
+many of you carry what money you may have about you, and I dare say
+some of you hide it so that, if you are taken prisoners, you may
+have means of adding to your prison fare."</p>
+<p>"We do, your honour; and, by the same token, I have a score of
+crowns in between the soles of my boots. It does not always
+succeed, for if your boots happen to be good, the chances are that
+someone takes a fancy to them. Still, on the whole, that is the
+best place there is, for they are sure to feel all the lining of
+your clothes."</p>
+<p>"Well, we want to hide some gold, Mike. In another hour we shall
+have the English within shot of us, and, of course, fighting is out
+of the question. Do you think that you will have time to hide a
+dozen gold pieces in each of our boots?"</p>
+<p>Mike looked doubtful.</p>
+<p>"To do the thing properly, your honour, one should take off the
+lower sole, take some leather out of the upper one, put some money
+in, and then sew it up again; but it would take more than an hour
+to do one pair."</p>
+<p>He thought for a moment.</p>
+<p>"The quickest way would be to get out the inside lining of the
+sole, then to cut out enough leather for the money to lie in, then
+to put in the lining again. It would not be soft walking on a
+twenty-mile march, but I think, if I get the lining in tight, with
+a few little nails to keep it from dropping out, if anyone takes
+the trouble to turn the boots upside down, I might manage it."</p>
+<p>"Well, let us commence at once, then, Mike. We have all got
+riding boots, and can put them on before we are taken prisoners. Do
+you take the linings out, as you say, and then we will help to cut
+out some of the leather of the upper sole."</p>
+<p>They were quickly at work. Mike cut out enough of the thin
+lining to admit of a hole being made, large enough to hold ten
+louis in each boot, and he and the two officers then set to work,
+to cut out a sufficient depth of leather for the coins to lie side
+by side. Half an hour sufficed for this.</p>
+<p>The coins were put in. Mike had, in the meantime, obtained a
+handful of pitch and melted it at the galley fire. This he ran in
+over the gold, and then replaced the pieces of lining with hot
+pitch.</p>
+<p>"There, your honours," he said, when he had finished. "I call
+that a neat job, and it would be hard, indeed, if the spalpeens
+find that there is anything amiss. And, with these heavy boots, the
+extra weight won't betray that there is anything hidden.</p>
+<p>"Don't put them on till the last moment. Give them time to cool,
+for if any of it oozes out, you will stick your stockings so tight
+to it that you won't get your foot out without laving them
+behind."</p>
+<p>Leaving their high boots in the cabin, the three young men went
+on deck. The leading vessel of the British fleet was not more than
+a mile astern, while the French fleet was three miles ahead, having
+gained more than a mile since the chase began. Mike had been given
+four louis, which he said he could hide in his mouth.</p>
+<p>Five minutes later, there was a puff of smoke from their
+pursuer's bow. The ball struck the water close to them.</p>
+<p>"Shall I hold on, Colonel?" the captain of the ship asked
+Colonel Wauchop.</p>
+<p>"There is no use in your doing so. That ship will be alongside
+in an hour, and it might only cause a useless loss of life were we
+to keep on. If she were alone I should say, let her come alongside,
+and with your crew and our officers and men we might, if we had
+luck, take her by boarding; but, with the whole fleet close behind
+us, it would be madness to think of such a thing, as we have but
+twelve guns, and those of small weight."</p>
+<p>Accordingly, the topsails were run down, and the courses brailed
+up, and the ship lay motionless till the English frigate came up.
+Signals had been exchanged between the English vessels, and as they
+came along six of them dropped boats, each with some twenty men in
+it. While these rowed towards the prize, the fleet pressed on,
+under all canvas, in pursuit of the French squadron.</p>
+<p>The English officer in command of the boats received the swords
+of the French officers, and the noncommissioned officers were all
+sent below into the hold. All sail was at once got on to the vessel
+again, and she followed in the wake of the fleet. The English
+lieutenant then took the names of the prisoners.</p>
+<p>"You are all Irish," he said, seriously. "I am sorry, gentlemen,
+that this should be so, for I fear that it will go harder with you
+than if you were French, when, of course, you would be merely
+prisoners of war."</p>
+<p>"We should be prisoners of war, now," Colonel Wauchop said. "We
+are in the service of the King of France, and were but obeying his
+orders, along with our French comrades."</p>
+<p>"I hope they may see it in that light, in London," the officer
+said courteously; "but I doubt whether, at the present moment, they
+will take a calm view of the subject. However, I hope they will do
+so, especially as no shot has been fired by you, and they cannot
+charge you with resisting capture. At any rate, gentlemen, I will
+do my best to make you comfortable while you are under my charge. I
+must ask a few of you to shift your quarters, so as to make room
+for me and the three officers with me; beyond that you will
+continue, as before, to use the ship as passengers."</p>
+<p>When darkness set in, the pursuit was discontinued. The French
+fleet was fully ten miles ahead, and it was evident that there was
+no chance, whatever, of overtaking it; while there was a risk of
+its doubling back during the night, and again making its way north.
+The greater part of the sails of the men-of-war were therefore
+furled, while the frigates and corvettes made off, on either hand,
+to establish themselves as sentries during the night, and to give
+warning should the French fleet be seen returning. An hour and a
+half after the pursuit had ceased, the Salisbury joined the fleet,
+and the officer in command went on board the admiral's ship, to
+report the number of prisoners taken and the nature of her
+cargo.</p>
+<p>The officers had, at his invitation, dined with him and his
+officers in the cabin. All political topics had been avoided, and
+no one who had looked in would have supposed that the majority of
+those present were the prisoners of the others. The Irish
+temperament quickly shakes off a feeling of depression, and the
+meal was as lively as it had been during the voyage north.</p>
+<p>The lieutenant, however, omitted no precaution. A dozen men kept
+guard over the prisoners below, and as many more, with loaded
+muskets, were always stationed on deck. The Irish officers saw
+that, among many of the sailors, there was a strong feeling of
+sympathy with them. The fleet had been largely recruited by
+impressment; and by the handing over, to the naval authorities, of
+numbers of men imprisoned for comparatively slight offences; and,
+as was natural, these had but small feeling of kindness towards the
+government who had so seized them; while many shared in the feeling
+of loyalty towards the house of Stuart, which was still so
+prevalent among the population.</p>
+<p>At daybreak, the cruisers all returned. None had seen any signs
+of the French squadron, and Sir George Byng, leaving the majority
+of the fleet to maintain watch, sailed with his prize for Harwich.
+Here the prisoners were handed over to the military authorities;
+while the admiral started for London, in a post chaise, to carry
+the news of the failure of the French to effect a landing, and of
+their return to Dunkirk,--news that was received with exuberant
+delight by the supporters of Government, and the commercial portion
+of the population, who had been threatened by ruin. The run upon
+the banks had been unprecedented, and although the House of Commons
+had relaxed the regulations of the Bank of England, the panic was
+so great that it could not have kept its doors open another twelve
+hours.</p>
+<p>The treatment of the prisoners was now very different from what
+it had been on board ship. Not only were they confined to prison,
+but, to their indignation, irons were placed on their legs, as if
+they had been common malefactors. The only mitigation allowed to
+them was that their servants were permitted to attend upon them.
+Their clothes had been rigorously searched, and their boots taken
+off, but no suspicions had been entertained that coin had been
+hidden in those of Desmond and his friends.</p>
+<p>Two days later an order was received from Government, and the
+officers were marched up to town, ironed as they were, under a
+strong guard, and were imprisoned at Newgate. Callaghan and the
+other servants remained in prison at Harwich.</p>
+<p>"Things are looking bad, Kennedy," O'Neil said dolefully, for
+the three officers had, at their own request, been allotted a cell
+together.</p>
+<p>"They don't look very bright, but we must make allowance for the
+awful fright that, as we hear, has been caused by the expedition.
+Possibly, when they have got over the shock, things may be
+better."</p>
+<p>"I will never forgive them for putting irons on us," O'Sullivan
+said passionately. "If they had shot us at once, it was, I suppose,
+what we had a right to expect; but to be treated like murderers, or
+ruffians of the worst kind, is too bad."</p>
+<p>"Well, we were rid of the irons as soon as we got here. No doubt
+these were only put on to prevent the possibility of any of us
+escaping. I am sure, by their looks, that some of our escort would
+willingly have aided us, only that it was impossible to do so; and,
+knowing how large a number of persons would sympathize with us, I
+cannot blame them so very much for taking steps to prevent our
+escape."</p>
+<p>"I never saw such a fellow as you for finding excuses for
+people," O'Sullivan said, almost angrily. "You look at things as
+calmly as if they concerned other people, and not ourselves."</p>
+<p>Kennedy smiled.</p>
+<p>"If an opinion is to be worth anything, O'Sullivan, it must be
+an impartial one; and it is best to look at the matter calmly, and
+to form our plans, whatever they may be, as if they were intended
+to be carried out by other people."</p>
+<p>O'Sullivan laughed.</p>
+<p>"My dear fellow, if you had not gone through those adventures, I
+should have said that you had mistaken your vocation, and were cut
+out for a philosopher rather than a soldier. However, although your
+luck did not suffice to save the Salisbury from capture, we must
+still hope that it has not altogether deserted you; and anyhow, I
+am convinced that, if it be possible for anyone to effect an escape
+from this dismal place, you are the man."</p>
+<p>Newgate, in those days, stood across the street, and constituted
+one of the entrances to the city. Its predecessor had been burnt,
+in the great fire of 1666, and the new one was at this time less
+than forty years old, and, though close and badly ventilated, had
+not yet arrived at the stage of dirt and foulness which afterwards
+brought about the death of numbers of prisoners confined there, and
+in 1750 occasioned an outbreak of jail fever, which not only swept
+away a large proportion of the prisoners, but infected the court of
+the Old Bailey close to it, causing the death of the lord mayor,
+several aldermen, a judge, many of the counsel and jurymen, and of
+the public present at the trials.</p>
+<p>The outward appearance of the building was handsome, but the
+cells were, for the most part, small and ill ventilated.</p>
+<p>"This place is disgraceful," O'Neil said. "There is barely room
+for our three pallets. The air is close and unwholesome, now, but
+in the heat of summer it must be awful. If their food is as vile as
+their lodging, the lookout is bad, indeed."</p>
+<p>"I fancy the cells in the French jails are no better,"
+O'Sullivan said. "No doubt, in the state prisons, high-born
+prisoners are made fairly comfortable; but the ordinary prisoners
+and malefactors, I have been told, suffer horribly. Thank goodness
+I have never entered one; but even the barrack cells can scarcely
+be called inviting."</p>
+<p>"You are learning philosophy from Kennedy," O'Neil said, with a
+laugh.</p>
+<p>"I don't know that I shall feel philosophic, if we are served
+with nothing but bread and water. However, the turnkey told us
+that, until we have been tried and condemned, we are at liberty to
+get our food from outside--certainly a mockery, in most cases,
+considering that we all were relieved of any money found upon us,
+when we arrived in Harwich. It is a comfort that we are, as he
+said, to take our meals together, and the money we have in our
+boots will alleviate our lot for some time. Probably, it will last
+a good deal longer than we are likely to be here."</p>
+<p>When they joined their companions, in the room in which they
+were to dine, all were astonished at seeing an excellent dinner on
+the table, with eight bottles of wine.</p>
+<p>"Is this the way they treat prisoners here?" Colonel Wauchop
+asked one of the jailers, of whom six remained present.</p>
+<p>The man smiled.</p>
+<p>"No, indeed. It has been sent in from a tavern outside, and with
+a message that a like meal will be provided, as long as you are
+here. One of us was sent across, to enquire as to the person who
+had given the order. The landlord said that he was a stranger to
+him, but that he had paid him a fortnight in advance, and would
+call in and renew the order, at the end of that time."</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen," the colonel said, "before we begin to eat, we
+will drink the health of our unknown benefactor. Not only is the
+gift a generous and expensive one, but it cannot be without danger
+to the donor, for none but a strong adherent of King James would
+have thought of thus relieving our necessities."</p>
+<p>It was plain that the authorities suspected that some message
+might have been sent in to the prisoners, concealed in the viands.
+The bread had been cut up into small squares, the crust had been
+lifted from two pasties, the meat had evidently been carefully
+searched; and the turnkeys placed themselves round the table so
+that they could narrowly watch every one of the prisoners, as they
+ate, and notice any movement that would seem to indicate that they
+had come across some pellet of paper or other substance.</p>
+<p>Every day, the servants at the tavern brought in similar fare,
+and this continued as long as the prisoners were in the jail; and
+it was a matter of deep regret, to all, that they were never able
+to discover the name of the person to whom they were so much
+indebted.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch9" id="Ch9">Chapter 9</a>: An Escape From
+Newgate.</h2>
+<p>After being allowed to remain an hour at the table, the
+prisoners were again marched off to their cells.</p>
+<p>"I wish we had Mike with us," Desmond said, as he and his
+comrades discussed the possibility of escape. "He is a shrewd
+fellow, and would probably be allowed greater freedom in moving
+about the prison than we are; but I was sure that we should see no
+more of him after we left Harwich.</p>
+<p>"Of course, the first question is, are we to try bribery, or to
+work our way out of this cell?"</p>
+<p>"I think that it would be dangerous to try bribery," O'Sullivan
+remarked. "Our turnkey is a sour-faced rascal. I am convinced that,
+if we were to try to bribe him, he would denounce us at once. Not
+from any principle, you know, but because he would think that it
+would pay him better to do so, and so obtain promotion and reward,
+rather than to accept our money and run the risk of being detected
+and hanged."</p>
+<p>"I don't blame him," O'Neil said. "He is, as you say, a
+sour-looking rascal, but I don't think that he is a fool, and none
+but a fool would run that risk for the sake of the money that we
+could give him; for, in any case, we should have to retain a
+portion of our store, in order to obtain disguises and maintain
+ourselves till we could find means of crossing the channel."</p>
+<p>"Then let us put that idea altogether aside, O'Neil, and give
+our whole attention to the manner in which we are to escape."</p>
+<p>"The manner in which we are to try to make our escape!" O'Neil
+repeated, with a laugh.</p>
+<p>"Well, put it that way if you like. Now, in the first place,
+there is the window, in the second the door, and lastly the walls
+and floor."</p>
+<p>"The door would withstand a battering ram," O'Sullivan said. "I
+noticed, as I went out, that it was solid oak some four inches
+thick, with two bolts as well as the lock, and, moreover, if we
+could get through it we should be no nearer escaping than we are at
+present. What with the corridors and passages, and the turnkeys and
+the outer gate, that course seems to me impossible.</p>
+<p>"Let us come to the second point, the window."</p>
+<p>They looked up at it. The sill was fully six feet from the
+ground. The window was a little over a foot wide, with a heavy bar
+running down the centre, and cross bars.</p>
+<p>"The first point is to see where it looks out on," Desmond said.
+"I will stand against the wall, and as you are the lighter of the
+two, O'Neil, you can stand on my shoulder and have a good look out,
+and tell us what you see.</p>
+<p>"Give him your hand, O'Sullivan.</p>
+<p>"Put your foot on that, O'Neil, and then step on my
+shoulder."</p>
+<p>O'Neil was soon in his place.</p>
+<p>"You need not hold me," he said. "The wall is very thick, the
+bars are placed in the middle, and there is just room for me to
+take a seat on the edge, then I can see things at my ease."</p>
+<p>He sat looking out, for a minute or two, before he spoke.</p>
+<p>"Well, what can you see?" O'Sullivan asked, impatiently.</p>
+<p>"This room is on the outer side of the prison," he said. "I
+noticed, as we came in, that it was built along on both sides of
+the gate; and, no doubt, this side stands on the city wall."</p>
+<p>"Then what do you see?"</p>
+<p>"I see the ground, sloping steeply down to a stream that runs
+along the bottom of it. There are a good many small houses,
+scattered about on the slope and along by the stream. Over to the
+left, there is a stone bridge across it. Near this is a large
+building, that looks like another prison, and a marketplace with
+stalls in it. Houses stand thickly on either side of the road, and
+beyond the bridge the opposite side of the slope is covered with
+them. Among these are some large buildings.</p>
+<p>"If we were once out, there would not be much chance of our
+being detected, if we had something to put over our uniforms; but,
+of course, they would betray us to the first man we met."</p>
+<p>"Yes, of course," O'Sullivan said; "but we might possibly obtain
+plain clothes at one of those small houses you speak of, though
+that would be risky."</p>
+<p>"We might leave our coatees behind us, and go only in our shirts
+and breeches; and give out that we had been attacked, and robbed of
+our money and coats by footpads," Desmond said.</p>
+<p>"That is a good idea," O'Neil agreed. "Yes, that might do,
+especially as, after dark, they would not be likely to notice that
+our breeches were of a French cut."</p>
+<p>"But it seems to me that we are beginning at the wrong end of
+the business. It is of no use discussing what we are to do, when we
+escape, till we have settled upon the manner in which we are to get
+out. Let us talk over that first.</p>
+<p>"Are the bars firmly in, O'Neil?"</p>
+<p>O'Neil tried, with all his strength, to shake them.</p>
+<p>"They are as firm as the walls," he said. "There is no getting
+them out, unless we have tools to cut away all the stonework round
+them."</p>
+<p>"I suppose there is no chance of cutting through them?"
+O'Sullivan asked.</p>
+<p>"There is not," O'Neil said. "We have not got such a thing as a
+knife about us. If we had, we could never saw through these thick
+bars; it would take a year of Sundays."</p>
+<p>"You are rather a Job's comforter. Now, do you get down, and let
+Kennedy and myself have a chance of a breath of fresh air, to say
+nothing of the view."</p>
+<p>A few minutes satisfied O'Sullivan, but Desmond, when he took
+his place, sat there considerably longer; while the other two,
+throwing themselves on their pallets, chatted gaily about Paris and
+their friends there.</p>
+<p>"Well, what conclusions do you arrive at?" they asked, when he
+leapt down from his seat.</p>
+<p>"They are not very cheering," he replied, "and I recognize fully
+that we cannot possibly make our escape, without aid from
+without."</p>
+<p>"That is the same as to say that we cannot make our escape at
+all."</p>
+<p>"Not exactly. We have found one unknown friend, who supplied us
+with our dinners. There is no absolute reason why we should not
+find one who would supply us with means of escape. There must be a
+great number of people who sympathize with us, and whose hearts are
+with King James. I have seen several men come from the market,
+stand and look up at this prison, and then walk off, slowly, as if
+they were filled with pity for us. Now, I propose that one of us
+shall always be at the window."</p>
+<p>"Oh, that is too much!" O'Sullivan said. "That ledge is so
+narrow that I could hardly sit there, even holding on by the bars;
+and as to stopping there half an hour, I would almost as soon be on
+the rack."</p>
+<p>"There will be no occasion for that," Desmond said. "We can
+easily move one of the pallets under it, pile the other straw beds
+upon it, and, standing on these, we could look out comfortably, for
+our shoulders would be well above the ledge."</p>
+<p>"I don't see that we should be nearer to it, then, Kennedy."</p>
+<p>"We should have gained this much: that directly we saw any
+person looking up, with a sympathizing air, especially if of a
+class who could afford to do what is necessary for us, we could
+wave our hands and attract his attention. If disposed to help us,
+he might give some sign. If not, no harm would be done. We might,
+too, tie a handkerchief to the bars, which in itself might be taken
+for an indication that there are followers of the Stuarts
+here."</p>
+<p>"But supposing all this turned out as you suggest it might, how
+could even the best disposed friend do anything to help us?"</p>
+<p>"That is for after consideration. Let us first find a friend,
+and we shall find a way to open communication with him. We have no
+paper, but we could write the message on a piece of linen and drop
+it down. As far as we can see, from here, there is nothing to
+prevent anyone coming up to the foot of the wall below us."</p>
+<p>For the next four days, nothing whatever happened. They could
+see that the white handkerchief at the bars attracted some
+attention, for people stopped and looked up at it, but continued
+their way without making any gesture that would seem to show that
+they interested themselves, in any way, in the matter.</p>
+<p>On the fourth day, Desmond, who was at the window, said in a
+tone of excitement:</p>
+<p>"There is a man down there who, after looking fixedly in this
+direction, is making his way towards us. He does not come straight,
+but moves about among the houses; but he continues to approach. I
+can't make out his face yet, but there is something about him that
+reminds me of Mike; though how he could be here, when we left him
+in the prison at Harwich, is more than I can say."</p>
+<p>O'Neil and O'Sullivan in turn looked through the window. Not
+being so much accustomed as he was to Mike's figure and walk, they
+could not recognize in the man, in the dress of a country peasant,
+the well-set-up soldier who attended on Desmond. Both admitted,
+however, that in point of figure it might well be the man.</p>
+<p>"If it is," Desmond said, "all our difficulties are at an end,
+and I will wager that we shall be free in three or four days. Now,
+how are we to communicate with him?"</p>
+<p>"I have a piece of paper in my pocket. It is only an old bill,
+and they threw it down, contemptuously, when they searched me,"
+O'Neil said. "I picked it up again. I hardly know why, except
+perhaps that the idea occurred to me that, some day, I might get a
+chance of paying it. But as we have no ink, nor pen, nor charcoal,
+I don't see how it can benefit us."</p>
+<p>He drew the bill from the pocket of his coatee. Desmond took it,
+and stood looking at it in silence for a minute. Then an idea
+occurred to him.</p>
+<p>"I have it!" he exclaimed, presently. "O'Neil, see if you can
+get a piece of this gold wire off my facings. I want it five or six
+inches long, so that when it is doubled up and twisted together, so
+as to be an inch long, it will be stiff enough for our
+purpose."</p>
+<p>Somewhat puzzled, O'Neil did as he was requested. Desmond
+straightened out the fine wire wrapped round the centre thread,
+doubled, and again doubled it, and finally twisting it together,
+reduced it to a length of about an inch, and the thickness of a
+pin. The others looked on, wondering what was his intention.</p>
+<p>He held the paper out before him, and began pricking small holes
+through it, close together. He continued to work for some time, and
+then held it up to the light. The others understood the nature of
+his work, and they could now read:</p>
+<p>Come ten tonight under window. Bring long thin string. Whistle.
+We will lower thread. Tie end of string to it. Will give further
+instructions.</p>
+<p>He tore off the portion of the bill on which the message was
+written, twisted off two of the buttons of his coatee, folded them
+in the paper, and took his place at the window again. The man who
+had been watching was standing some sixty feet from the foot of the
+wall. His back was towards them. Presently he turned, carelessly
+looked up at the window, and then, as if undecided what to do, took
+off his cap and scratched his head.</p>
+<p>"It is Mike, sure enough," Desmond exclaimed, and, thrusting his
+hand through the bars, waved it for a moment.</p>
+<p>Then, taking the little packet, he dropped it. Mike put on his
+hat again, turned round, then looked cautiously to see that no one
+was noticing him, and strolled, in an aimless and leisurely way,
+towards the wall. Desmond could no longer see him, but felt sure
+that he would find the missive.</p>
+<p>Presently he came in sight again, walking quietly away. He did
+not look round; but when nearly at the bottom of the hill turned,
+lifted one hand, and disappeared behind some houses.</p>
+<p>"He can't read," Desmond said, "but I have no doubt he will get
+someone to do it for him."</p>
+<p>A vigilant watch was kept up, but nothing was seen of Mike, till
+late in the afternoon, when he emerged into one of the open spaces.
+They had now taken the handkerchief down from the window, and,
+directly they saw him, Desmond waved it, showing that they were
+watching him. He threw up his arm, turned, and disappeared
+again.</p>
+<p>"He has made out my message," Desmond said. "We may expect him
+here at ten o'clock."</p>
+<p>While he had been watching, his two comrades had, under his
+instructions, been unravelling a portion of one of their blankets.
+When enough thread had been obtained, the strands were tied
+together and doubled, and Desmond had little doubt that it was
+sufficiently strong to draw up the string Mike would bring with
+him. He now took another portion of the bill, and pricked upon it
+the words:</p>
+<p>At nine tomorrow night, bring, if possible, fine steel saw, two
+files, and small bottle of oil. Fasten these to string we will
+lower with further instructions.</p>
+<p>He then opened his coatee, took out some of the white wool with
+which it was padded, formed this into a loose ball, in the centre
+of which the note was fastened, and all being in readiness, waited
+patiently, until, just as the city clock struck ten, they heard a
+low whistle. The ball had already been attached to the end of the
+thread, and Desmond at once lowered it down.</p>
+<p>Presently, they heard another whistle and, hauling at it again,
+they found that the ball had gone, and attached to the end of the
+thread was a very light silken cord, which they drew in. There was
+another low whistle, and all was silent.</p>
+<p>"So far, so good," Desmond said. "We are fairly on our way to
+liberty. How long do you suppose it will take us to cut through
+these bars?"</p>
+<p>"It would take us a long while to file through them all," O'Neil
+said, "but with a fine steel saw, I should think that a couple of
+nights' work should do it. But of course that is mere guesswork,
+for I have not the least idea how fast even the best saw could cut
+through iron."</p>
+<p>"Well, there is no particular hurry, for we know that no day has
+been fixed yet for our trial. So, whether it is one night or six,
+it does not matter much."</p>
+<p>On the following evening at nine o'clock the whistle was heard,
+and another ball lowered down at the end of the string. The
+instructions this time were:</p>
+<p>When we are ready, we will show a handkerchief at window. Bring
+with you, at nine that evening, rope strong enough to bear us, and
+have disguises for three ready for us at foot of wall. Herewith are
+ten louis to purchase three disguises.</p>
+<p>The cord brought up a small packet, which contained two very
+fine small steel saws, two files, and the oil. They did not lose a
+moment in setting to work, and, oiling the saws, one began to cut
+through the central bar, just above the point where the lowest
+cross bars went through it, as they determined to leave these to
+fasten the rope to. There was not room for two of them to work
+together, and they agreed to take it by turns, changing every
+quarter of an hour.</p>
+<p>To their great satisfaction, they found that the saw did its
+work much more quickly than they had expected, and by the time each
+had had a turn the bar was cut through; and by morning the side
+bars had also all been cut. They did not attempt to cut the main
+bar higher up, as, had they done so, it would have been difficult
+to keep the portion cut out in its place.</p>
+<p>When it was light, they filled up all the cuts with bread, which
+they had managed to secrete in the palms of their hands at dinner.
+This they kneaded into a sort of putty, rolled it in the dust of
+the floor until black, and then squeezed it into the
+interstices.</p>
+<p>"There is no fear of their noticing it," O'Neil said, when they
+had finished. "I cannot see the cuts myself from the floor, though
+I know where they are; and unless they were to climb up there, and
+examine the place very closely, they would not see anything
+wrong."</p>
+<p>"Shall we hang out the flag today, Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"I think we had better wait till tomorrow. He will be hardly
+expecting to see it, today, and may not be ready with the rope and
+disguises."</p>
+<p>The next morning the signal was hung out. They saw nothing of
+Mike, but as he would be able to make out the handkerchief from a
+considerable distance, they had no doubt whatever that he had
+observed it, but thought it prudent not to show himself near the
+prison again. As soon as it was dark they recommenced work, and had
+cut through the main bar, and cautiously lowered the grating to the
+ground, before the clock struck nine. Then, on hearing Mike's
+signal, they lowered the cord, and soon brought up a rope which,
+although small, was more than strong enough to support them.</p>
+<p>"We had better tie some knots in it," Desmond said. "They will
+help us to avoid sliding down too rapidly. If it was a thick rope,
+I think we could manage without them; but, not being sailors, I do
+not think that we could grasp this tightly enough."</p>
+<p>"How close shall we put them, Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"About two feet apart. Then we can come down hand over hand,
+helping our arms by twisting our legs round it.</p>
+<p>"Now," he went on, when they had finished the knots, "who will
+go down first?"</p>
+<p>"You had better do so," O'Sullivan said. "You are the lightest
+of us, and, I fancy, the strongest, too."</p>
+<p>"Very well. I don't think that it will make any difference, for
+the rope is strong enough to hold the three of us together.
+However, here goes. We may as well leave our coatees behind us.
+They might get us into difficulties, if we took them."</p>
+<p>So saying, he took off his coat, fastened the end of the rope
+securely to the bars that had been left for the purpose, and,
+holding it firmly, made his way through the opening and swung
+himself over. With his muscles strengthened by military exercises
+and sword practice, he found it easier work than he had expected.
+The depth was some sixty feet, and in a couple of minutes his feet
+touched the ground.</p>
+<p>Mike had been hanging on by the rope to steady it, and as
+Desmond descended, he seized him by the hand and shook it
+enthusiastically, murmuring brokenly, "My dear master, thank God
+that you are free!"</p>
+<p>"Thanks to you also, my dear fellow. Now, hold on again. My
+friends O'Neil and O'Sullivan shared my cell with me, and are
+following me."</p>
+<p>He added his weight to that of Mike, and it was not long before
+O'Neil came down; but not so quietly as Desmond had done, for his
+strength had failed him, and the rope had slipped rapidly through
+his fingers, and Mike and Desmond narrowly escaped being knocked
+down by the suddenness with which the descent was made. He stood
+for a minute, wringing his hand, and swearing in an undertone in
+English, Irish, and French.</p>
+<p>"By the powers," he said, "it has taken the skin off the inside
+of my hands, entirely! A red-hot poker could not have done it more
+nately!</p>
+<p>"Mike, you rascal, what are you laughing at? I have a mind to
+break your bones before thanking you."</p>
+<p>O'Sullivan succeeded better, but was completely exhausted when
+he joined his friends.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mike, where are the disguises?"</p>
+<p>"Here they are, your honour. They are just like my own. Loose
+coats, rough breeches, white stockings and buckled shoes, and soft
+hats with wide brims. I thought that you would pass better, like
+that, than in any other way; for if you were dressed up as
+citizens, your tongues might betray you, for somehow they don't
+speak English as we do; and whenever I open my mouth, they discover
+that I am an Irishman."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"There would be no difficulty about that. Now, let us put on our
+disguises at once, and be off. Sometimes the turnkeys take it into
+their heads to look in during the night, and we had to keep one on
+watch while we were at work, and take to our beds when we heard a
+footstep approaching.</p>
+<p>"I see you have brought shoes. I forgot to mention them. Our
+jack boots would have attracted attention, so we have left them
+behind us, after getting our stores of money from their hiding
+places."</p>
+<p>They were soon dressed.</p>
+<p>"What are we supposed to be, Mike?"</p>
+<p>"You are sedan chair men, sir. Most of the chairs are carried by
+Irishmen, who seem to be stronger in the leg than these London
+folk. You will have to cut your hair short, and then you will pass
+without observation."</p>
+<p>"Where are you taking us to?" Desmond asked, as they descended
+the hill.</p>
+<p>"I have got a lodging in a house out in the fields. I said that
+I was an Irishman who had come to London in search of employment,
+and that I expected three friends to join me, and that we intended
+to hire chairs and carry the gentry about, for here they seem too
+lazy to walk, and everyone is carried; though it is small blame to
+them, for dirtier streets I never saw. They are just full of holes,
+where you go in up to the knee in mud and filth of all kinds.
+Faith, there are parts of Paris which we can't say much for, but
+the worst of them are better than any here, except just the street
+they call Cheapside, which goes on past Saint Paul's, and along the
+Strand to Westminster."</p>
+<p>"What have you brought these sticks for, Mike?"</p>
+<p>For he had handed, to each, a heavy bludgeon.</p>
+<p>"Sure, your honour, 'tis not safe to be in the streets after
+nightfall. It is like that part of Paris where no dacent man could
+walk, without being assaulted by thieves and cutthroats. Dressed as
+we are, it is not likely anyone would interfere with us in the hope
+of finding money on us, but they are not particular at all, at all,
+and a party of these rascals might try to roll us in the mire, just
+for fun. So it is as well to be prepared."</p>
+<p>However, they met with no interruption, passed out through
+Holborn Bars, and soon arrived at the house where Mike had taken a
+lodging. They were not sorry, however, that they were armed, for,
+several times, they heard outbursts of drunken shouting and the
+sound of frays.</p>
+<p>Mike had hired two rooms. In one of these were three straw beds,
+for the officers. He himself slept on a blanket on the floor of the
+other room, which served as kitchen and sitting room.</p>
+<p>Now, for the first time, they were able to talk freely.</p>
+<p>"Mike, we have not said much to you, yet," Desmond began, "but I
+and these gentlemen are fully conscious that you have saved us from
+death, for we hear that Government is determined to push matters to
+the extremity, and to have all the officers captured condemned to
+be hanged."</p>
+<p>"Bad cess to them!" Mike exclaimed, indignantly. "If I had two
+or three of them, it's mighty little they would talk of execution,
+after I and me stick had had a few minutes' converse with them.</p>
+<p>"As to the getting you out, I assure you, your honour, there is
+little I have done, except to carry out your orders. When I first
+saw the prison, and the little white flag flying from the window, I
+said to myself that, barring wings, there was no way of getting to
+you; and it was only when I got your first letter that I saw it
+might be managed. Faith, that letter bothered me, entirely. I took
+it to the woman downstairs, and asked her to read it for me, saying
+that I had picked it up in the street, and wondered what it was
+about. She was no great scholar, but she made out that it was writ
+in a foreign language, and seemed to her to be a bit of an old
+bill. When I took it up to my room, I looked at it every way. I
+knew, of course, that it was a message, somehow, but devil a bit
+could I see where it came in.</p>
+<p>"I fingered it for an hour, looking at it in every way, and then
+I saw that there were some small holes pricked. Well, I could not
+ask the woman what they meant, as I had told her I picked it up; so
+I went across to an Irishman, whose acquaintance I had made the day
+before, and who had recommended me, if I wanted work, to hire one
+of these chairs and get a comrade to help me carry it. I could see
+that he was a man who had seen better days. I expect he had come
+over in the time of the troubles, and had been forced to earn his
+living as he could; so I went to him.</p>
+<p>"'I have got a message,' I said, 'pricked on a piece of paper. I
+picked it up, and am curious-like to know what it is about.'</p>
+<p>"So he held it up to the light, and read out your message.</p>
+<p>"'I think,' says he, 'it is some colleen who has made an
+appointment with her lover. Maybe she has been shut up by her
+father, and thought it the best way to send him a message.'</p>
+<p>"'That is it, no doubt,' says I; 'and it is plain that it never
+came to his hand.'</p>
+<p>"The next day, I went to him again with the second letter.</p>
+<p>"'It's lying you have been to me,' he said. 'It is some plot you
+are concerned in.'</p>
+<p>"'Well,' says I, 'you are not far wrong. I have some friends who
+have suffered for the Stuarts, and who have been laid by the leg,
+and it's myself who is trying to get them out of the hands of their
+persecutors.'</p>
+<p>"'In that case, I am with you,' he said, 'for I have suffered
+for the cause myself; and if you want assistance, you can depend
+upon me.'</p>
+<p>"'Thank you kindly,' says I. 'Just at present it is a one man
+job, but maybe, if I get them out, you will be able to give us some
+advice as to how we had best manage.'</p>
+<p>"So that is how it stands, your honour."</p>
+<p>"And now, tell us how you got away, Mike. You may guess how
+surprised we were, when we first made you out, believing that you
+were safe under lock and key at Harwich."</p>
+<p>"The matter was easy enough," Mike said. "It took me two or
+three days to get to understand the position of the place, with
+water all round it except on one side; and it was plain that, if I
+were to start running, it is little chance I should have if I did
+not hit upon the right road. Luckily, they were mounting some
+cannon the day after you were taken away. We were ordered to go out
+and lend a hand, so it was not long before I learnt enough to know
+which road I ought to take. I was always a good runner, your
+honour, and many a prize have I carried off, at fairs in the old
+country, before troubles began. So it seemed to me that, if I could
+have anything of a start, I ought to be able to get off.</p>
+<p>"There was nearly half a mile betwixt the town and the place
+where the narrow ground, at whose end it stood, widened out into
+the country. If I could only hold my own, as far as that, I could
+take to the woods and lanes and save myself.</p>
+<p>"A guard of soldiers, with muskets and bayonets, went out with
+us, and at the end of the second day I managed to slip off, and
+hide behind a pile of cannonballs. The rest assembled at a spot
+about fifty yards away, to be counted before they marched to prison
+again. As soon as the others had got there, and the guards had
+gathered round, I went off as hard as I could tear. And a good
+start I should have got, if it hadn't been that a sentry on a fort
+close by fired his piece at me. Still, I had a good hundred yards'
+start.</p>
+<p>"The guards set to, to run after me, and when they got in sight
+of me fired their guns; but they were flurried, and the bullets
+flew past without one of them touching me. Then I felt pretty safe.
+If they stopped to load their muskets, I should get clean away. If,
+as I expected, they would not stop for that, they would not have a
+chance with me, carrying their muskets and cartridge boxes and
+belts. I had taken off my coatee and boots, while I was waiting for
+the start, and went up the hill like a deer.</p>
+<p>"I did not look round, till I got to the top. Then I found that
+I had gained a hundred yards of them. I doubled down a lane, at
+once, and then struck through some orchards; and ran, without
+stopping, maybe a couple of miles.</p>
+<p>"I never heard any more of the soldiers, and knew that, for the
+present, I was safe, though maybe they would send some dragoons to
+scour the country when the news came in. I went on at a jog trot
+till it was quite dark; then I sat down to think what I should do
+next.</p>
+<p>"I had got my four louis with me, for they hadn't found them
+when they searched me. The first thing was to get some duds, and I
+walked along till I saw a light in a cottage, which I entered.
+There were two women there. I told them at once that I wanted
+clothes, and was ready to pay for them; but that, if they would not
+give them to me for money, I should take them without paying.
+Though I could see that they doubted the payment, and regarded me
+as a robber, they brought out the clothes, which belonged, one of
+the women said, to her husband. I took what I wanted.</p>
+<p>"'Now,' I said, 'how much shall I pay you for these?'</p>
+<p>"They were still terribly frightened, and said that I was
+welcome. However, I put one of my louis down on the table. This was
+certainly more than the clothes ever cost, so I said:</p>
+<p>"'Here is a gold piece, but I want a shilling in change, to buy
+food with.'</p>
+<p>"At first, they evidently hardly thought that I was in earnest.
+Then at last, when they found that I really intended to give the
+money, they brightened up, and not only gave me a shilling in
+change, but offered me some bread and cheese, which I was glad
+enough to take.</p>
+<p>"Then I put the clothes on over my own, not wishing to lave
+anything behind that would show searchers that it was I who had
+been there. I told the woman that the coin was a French one, but
+that it was worth about the same as an English guinea. I advised
+them to put it away, for the present, and not to try and change it
+for a few weeks, as enquiries might be made as to how they had
+obtained it.</p>
+<p>"I had no difficulty on my way up to London. I avoided the main
+road till I got to Colchester, and after that walked boldly on,
+having money to pay for victuals. When I got to town, I changed
+another of my louis at a money changer's. He asked me where I had
+got it, and when I said that it was no business of his, but that it
+had been paid me by a French Huguenot gentleman, who had lately
+arrived, and for whom I had been doing some work; and as there are
+many of these Huguenots in London, he was satisfied, and changed it
+for me.</p>
+<p>"I then fell across the Irish porter I told you of. He told me
+whereabouts I could get lodgings, and advised me to apply to one of
+the men who let out a number of sedan chairs, to hire one out to me
+by the week.</p>
+<p>"Well, your honour, once I had taken the lodging, I thought no
+more of the chair, but went about the business for which I had come
+to London. I had not been an hour in the town before I made the
+acquaintance of half a dozen, at least, of my countrymen, and found
+out which was the prison in which you were kept. At first, I
+thought of going there and giving myself up, on condition that I
+might be employed as your servant. Then I thought, perhaps they
+would not keep their word to me, but would send me back to Harwich;
+and then the thought struck me that I might, some way or other, get
+your honours out of prison.</p>
+<p>"When I first saw the place, it seemed to me that it was
+impossible. The place was mighty strong, the windows all barred,
+and I had no means of finding out where you were lodged. I spent a
+whole day in prowling round and round the jail, but sorra an idea
+came into my thick head, though I bate it wid my fists till it was
+sore; for, says I to myself, there is no lock so strong but it can
+be picked, if you do but know the right way. It was the second day,
+when I espied a little bit of white stuff at one of the windows. It
+might be a signal, or it might not, and even if it was, there was
+no reason why it should be yours, except that, I said to
+myself:</p>
+<p>"'Mr. Kennedy is not the boy to sit quiet in prison, if he can
+see any possible way of slipping out of it. His head is crammed
+full of ideas. So I will walk near and investigate the matter.'</p>
+<p>"As I came close, I could make out that there was someone behind
+the bars, but I could not see who it was. Of course, I did not come
+straight to the spot, but went about promiscuously.</p>
+<p>"For anything I could tell, there might be someone in the towers
+watching me. Then I saw a hand drop a little white parcel, and I
+found it without much trouble and went off with it. It was as much
+as I could do, to keep myself from running like a madman, for I
+felt somehow sure that it was you who had dropped it, but of
+course, it was not until I got it read for me that I was
+certain.</p>
+<p>"After that, your honour, it was all easy enough. You told me
+what to do, and I did it. There was a little difficulty about the
+saw, but I got it through one of the chair men, who told me, when I
+asked him, that he had the acquaintance of some cracksmen--more
+shame to him--and that he could get such a thing as I wanted
+through them. I was not surprised, for I had already heard that
+many of the chair men worked in connection with the bad characters,
+letting them know which way they were coming with people from an
+entertainment, and carrying them down lanes where there was little
+chance of the watch interfering.</p>
+<p>"It went against the grain to have dealings with such a man, for
+I was born of honest people, but if the ould gentleman himself had
+offered me a couple of saws, and I knew that I would have to give
+him a thousand years extra of purgatory, I would have closed with
+the bargain. Those two saws cost me another louis, and cheap
+enough, too.</p>
+<p>"After that, it was all plain sailing, and the money you lowered
+to me was much more than sufficient for all the other things. And
+now, what is your honour going to do next?"</p>
+<p>"That is more than I can tell you, Mike. We must talk it
+over."</p>
+<p>This was a matter that they had already discussed, in their
+cell, after they had once made their preparations for flight.
+Closely watched as they were, when with the other officers, it
+would have been impossible to communicate their plans to them; but,
+even if they could have done so, they could see no possible way in
+which the others could share in their escape. Doubtless the doors
+of their cells were also strong and heavy, and, could all these
+difficulties have been overcome, there would have been passages,
+corridors, and staircases to traverse, with the certainty of
+meeting with some of the night watchmen who patrolled them, and
+they would finally have had to force the door into their cell.</p>
+<p>They were, therefore, reluctantly obliged to abandon the hope of
+liberating their friends, and decided that, once away, they must
+endeavour to cross to France without delay. The king would
+doubtless have been, before now, informed by his agents in London
+of the determination of the English Government to bring all the
+prisoners to execution, but nevertheless, it would be their duty to
+obtain an audience, and implore him to take steps to save them.
+They would therefore, on their arrival in Paris, at once see
+General Hamilton, and other officers of rank, and beg them to
+accompany them to Versailles to act as spokesmen, and to influence
+the king in their favour.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch10" id="Ch10">Chapter 10</a>: Kidnapping A
+Minister.</h2>
+<p>In spite of the war between the two countries, communications
+were frequent. Smuggling boats brought over, with their cargoes of
+wine and brandy, Huguenot fugitives; and, by the same means, secret
+agents carried back news of events in Paris to the Government.
+Having decided upon making for the coast without delay, Desmond and
+his friends next discussed the port to which they had best travel,
+and which seemed to offer the fairest opportunities. They agreed
+that Weymouth seemed to be most advantageous, as it was from there
+that the communications with Brittany were chiefly maintained.</p>
+<p>At the same time, it was evident that considerable difficulty
+would be experienced in discovering the men engaged in such
+traffic, and in making an arrangement with them, and it was
+all-important that no time should be lost, for there was no saying
+when the trial might come on.</p>
+<p>"If we could but get hold of Godolphin," Desmond said, next
+morning, "we might get an order, from him, to embark in one of the
+boats that carry his agents."</p>
+<p>The others laughed.</p>
+<p>"Yes; and if you could get hold of Anne, you might persuade her
+to sign an order for the release of our comrades."</p>
+<p>Desmond did not answer, but sat thinking for a few minutes.</p>
+<p>"It is not so impossible as you seem to imagine," he said, at
+last. "Doubtless, like everyone else, he goes in a sedan chair to
+the meeting of the council, and returns in the same manner. There
+are two ways in which we could manage the matter. Of course, he has
+his own chair, with his chair men in livery. We might either make
+these men drunk and assume their dress, or attack them suddenly on
+the way; then we should, of course, gag and bind them, and carry
+him here, or to some other place that we might decide upon, and
+force him to give us an order for the boatmen to take us across the
+channel, at once. Of course, we should have horses in readiness,
+and ride for the coast. We should have a twelve hours' start, for
+it would be that time before our landlady came in as usual, with
+our breakfast, when Godolphin would, of course, be released."</p>
+<p>The two officers looked at each other, astounded at the audacity
+of the scheme that Desmond had quietly propounded. O'Sullivan was
+the first to speak.</p>
+<p>"Are you really in earnest, Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"Quite in earnest. I do not see why it should not be done."</p>
+<p>"Well, you are certainly the coolest hand I ever came across,"
+O'Neil said. "You are proposing to seize the first minister in
+England, as if it were merely an affair of carrying off a pretty
+girl quite willing to be captured. The idea seems monstrous, and
+yet, as you put it, I do not see why it might not succeed."</p>
+<p>"I hardly think that it could fail," Desmond said quietly. "De
+Tulle managed to carry off the Baron de Pointdexter's daughter from
+the court of Versailles, and did so without any hitch or
+difficulty. Surely three Irishmen could arrange an affair of this
+sort as well as a French vicomte."</p>
+<p>"If it is to be done," O'Sullivan said, "I think the second plan
+is best. You might fail in making the chair men drunk, or at any
+rate sufficiently drunk to allow them to be despoiled of their
+clothes; whereas you could have no difficulty in silencing a couple
+of chair men by a sudden attack--a sharp rap on the head with these
+bludgeons ought to settle that affair."</p>
+<p>"Quite so," Desmond agreed; "and while Mike and one of us were
+so employed, the other two might throw open the doors of the chair,
+and gag Godolphin before he was conscious of what was
+happening."</p>
+<p>"It all seems simple enough, Kennedy, and, if it were a citizen,
+one would think nothing of the undertaking. But it is nothing short
+of high treason for us thus to make free with the person of the
+chief minister of England."</p>
+<p>"That is a matter that does not concern me at all, O'Neil. If we
+were captured now, we should be executed for high treason with the
+others; and if we carried off Anne herself, they could not do much
+more to us.</p>
+<p>"Now, it seems to me that if you are both agreed that we should
+carry out the plan, the first thing to be done is to arrange for
+horses; or, better still, for a light cart to carry the four of us.
+I should think that Mike would, among his acquaintances, be able to
+hear of a man with a couple of fast horses and such a cart as we
+require, who would agree to drive us to the coast, arranging a
+change of horses on the way. He could offer ten louis, which would
+be a sum that a man of that kind would be well satisfied with."</p>
+<p>"I will see to that, your honour. I have no doubt that I can
+find such a man without difficulty. When would you want him?"</p>
+<p>"Tonight, certainly, with the arrangement that, if we do not
+come to the appointed spot, we shall be there tomorrow night.
+Recollect ten louis is all we can afford, but if he wants any more,
+he must have it.</p>
+<p>"Well, we will leave that to you."</p>
+<p>Then he went on to the others:</p>
+<p>"We had better go down to Saint James's. Mike can go out and buy
+us three shock wigs, with which we can cover our hair and look our
+parts better. We had better separate when we get there, and watch
+the entrances to the palace, gazing about like rustics; then we can
+get into a conversation with any servant that we see, and try and
+find out from which door members of the council usually issue, and
+at about what hour. We could succeed without that, because we
+should notice the chairs waiting for them. Still, it is as well
+that we should get all the information we can. There will be,
+doubtless, personages leaving who have been with the Princess Anne.
+They might go out by another entrance, and therefore we should miss
+our man."</p>
+<p>"You will have more than the two chair men to deal with, your
+honour, for there are sure to be two link men with the chair."</p>
+<p>"Well, it will be as easy to dispose of four men as of two,
+Mike."</p>
+<p>"Every bit, your honour, and the more of them the more
+divarsion."</p>
+<p>An hour later they set out, now so well disguised that no one
+would have dreamt that the three Irishmen were officers in a French
+regiment; and before noon Desmond succeeded in obtaining, from a
+scullion employed in the palace, the particulars that he required.
+On saying that he had but just come to London, and wanted to get a
+sight of the great people, the present of a shilling sufficed to
+extract the information from the boy; and Desmond then rejoined his
+companions, and they at once returned to their lodgings, where they
+found Mike awaiting them.</p>
+<p>"I have managed it, your honour, but it will cost twelve louis.
+I went to the man from whom I got the saws, and he said at once
+that the affair could be managed easily, and, sure enough, he took
+me to the shop of a man who, he said, sometimes acted with
+cracksmen. The fellow was sharp enough to see, at once, that it was
+something special that we wanted the horses for, but after some
+bargaining he agreed to do it for twelve gold pieces, and, if
+necessary, to get a change of horses twice on the road. He will be
+ready with his cart at twelve o'clock, a hundred yards or so
+outside the last houses on the south side of the Old Kent Road. I
+could not tell him which port you would go to, but he said from
+there he could go to Dover, or turn off so as to make for
+Southampton or Weymouth. It is to be twelve pounds if it is to
+Dover or Southampton; fifteen pounds if it is to Weymouth."</p>
+<p>"That is satisfactory," Desmond said. "Now we have nothing else
+to do till ten o'clock tonight, when, as the boy said, the council
+generally ends; though we will be there an hour earlier, in case
+they should leave before. Now I think we had better find out where
+Godolphin's house is, and fix upon the best spot for the attack,
+and how we shall each station ourselves."</p>
+<p>This part of the business offered no difficulties. They found
+that the minister would probably be carried through Saint James's
+Park, and they fixed upon the spot where they would await his
+coming.</p>
+<p>Mike was to attack the first porter. O'Sullivan was to follow
+close behind him and, at the same moment, fell the rearmost man.
+O'Neil and Desmond, who were to conceal themselves among trees on
+opposite sides of the path, were to spring out and strike down the
+link bearers, and then enter the chair and bind and gag the
+minister.</p>
+<p>Mike was sent out to buy a pot of black paint, with which to
+efface the gildings of the chair, and to reduce its appearance to
+that ordinarily used by the citizens. He was ordered to get a
+supply of rope, and some wood, to make gags for the men they were
+to stun.</p>
+<p>The others were to post themselves at the spot agreed on, while
+Desmond was to remain at the entrance to the palace by which
+ministers would issue, to note Lord Godolphin's chair, and, when he
+was fairly on his way, to follow it for a short distance to make
+sure that it was being taken through the park, and then to run on
+and warn the others to be in readiness.</p>
+<p>On their return to their lodging, they ate the dinner that Mike
+had got in for them, and, as they drank their wine, laughed and
+joked over their enterprise; for, now that they were fairly
+embarked upon the scheme, the two officers were as eager as Desmond
+in the matter, and were much more excited over the prospect than he
+was.</p>
+<p>Before nine o'clock, they and Mike were posted in the park, and
+Desmond was at the entrance to the palace. Here seven or eight
+chairs, with their bearers and link men, were assembled. As most of
+the porters were hired men, Desmond readily entered into
+conversation with them, and expressed his desire to see the great
+persons and learn which were their chairs, so that he should know
+them as they entered them.</p>
+<p>In half an hour there was a stir, and a servant, coming out,
+shouted:</p>
+<p>"His Grace the Duke of Somerset's chair."</p>
+<p>This was at once brought up to the door. Next came a call for
+the chair of Mr. Henry Boyle, who was followed by Harcourt, the
+attorney general, then the chair of My Lord Godolphin was
+summoned.</p>
+<p>Desmond and three or four others, who had gathered to see the
+members of the council come out, had been ordered off by the
+sentries as soon as the first chair was called, but remained near
+enough to hear the names. To his satisfaction, Godolphin's chair
+was carried off in the direction they had anticipated, and he at
+once ran on and joined his companions.</p>
+<p>Presently, the lights carried by the two link men were seen
+approaching, and, as the chair came abreast of him, he shouted:</p>
+<p>"Now!"</p>
+<p>Almost simultaneously, the four heavy cudgels alighted on the
+heads of the four men, levelling them senseless to the ground; and
+O'Neil and Desmond sprang to the chair, and wrenched the door open,
+while O'Sullivan and Mike bound the four men, and thrust the gags
+into their mouths. Lord Godolphin had been thrown from his seat by
+the sudden fall of his bearers, and was seized and bound before he
+was conscious of what had happened. Then his captors assisted the
+others in carrying the fallen men to some distance from the
+path.</p>
+<p>A couple of minutes sufficed to cover the gilding and armorial
+bearings upon the chair. The torches were still burning on the
+ground. One of these was stamped out. Desmond took the other. Mike
+and O'Sullivan went between the poles, and adjusted the leathern
+straps over their shoulders, and started.</p>
+<p>Emerging from the park at Charing Cross, past the old church of
+Saint. Martin's in the Fields, and keeping round the walls to
+Holborn Bars, they made their way to their lodging, and Godolphin
+was carried into their room, which was on the ground floor. Mike
+and O'Neil then took the chair away, and left it in a narrow alley,
+where it was not likely to attract attention until the morning.</p>
+<p>Not until they returned was anything said to their prisoner. It
+had been agreed that O'Neil, as the senior, was to be spokesman of
+the party.</p>
+<p>"Lord Godolphin," he said, "I regret that circumstances have
+obliged us to use force towards you, but our necessities compel us
+to leave the country at once, and it has appeared to us that in no
+way could we get away so expeditiously as with the aid of your
+lordship. We will now set you free. I must tell you, beforehand,
+that if you attempt to raise your voice and give the alarm, we
+shall be constrained to blow out your brains."</p>
+<p>Mike now released him from the bonds, and removed the gag from
+his mouth, but for a time the minister was incapable of speech,
+being choked by anger at the treatment he had met with.</p>
+<p>"You will repent this outrage," he burst out, at last.</p>
+<p>"I think not, sir," O'Neil said, quietly. "At any rate, we are
+quite ready to take our chance of that. In order that you may feel
+at ease with us, I have no hesitation in telling you who we are. We
+are the three French officers who, as no doubt you have heard,
+yesterday escaped from Newgate, and we are anxious to get out of
+the country as soon as possible. It will be also a guarantee to you
+that we have no designs on either your pockets or your person."</p>
+<p>Angry as he still was, it was evident, by the expression of the
+treasurer's face, that the information was a relief to him, for
+indeed he had supposed that he had been carried off by political
+enemies, and was very uncertain as to what would befall him.</p>
+<p>"What is it that you require, then?" he asked, after a
+pause.</p>
+<p>"Merely this, sir. That you will give us an order, upon an agent
+through whom you communicate with France, to take us across the
+channel immediately."</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen," Godolphin said, more calmly, "I must say your
+coolness surprises me. Your escape yesterday was, of course,
+reported to us; and the manner in which you obtained that rope, by
+which you descended, is a mystery that the jail authorities are
+wholly unable to solve.</p>
+<p>"If you obtain the order you desire, will you give me your word
+of honour that it shall be used in a manner in no way hostile to
+the interests of this country, but solely, as you say, for the
+purpose of conveying you across the channel?"</p>
+<p>"That promise we give willingly. We must ask you to pledge your
+honour, as a gentleman, that the order you give us will be a
+genuine one--a matter that we cannot ascertain until we arrive at
+the address given. We are willing to play fairly with you, sir, but
+if you do not do the same, we shall certainly return to London,
+though in some different guise, and, if so, I warn you that no
+guards will save you from our vengeance."</p>
+<p>"You need not threaten, sir," Lord Godolphin said calmly. "I
+will give you the order, to the person to whom such communications
+are addressed, and it shall be couched in the same words as
+usual."</p>
+<p>Desmond placed a sheet of paper, pen, and ink before him. He,
+dating it from the Treasury, wrote:</p>
+<p>To John Dawkins, Mariner, High Street, Rye. Urgent.</p>
+<p>On the receipt of this, you will at once convey the bearer, and
+three persons with him, and land them in some convenient spot in
+France.</p>
+<p>He then added his signature.</p>
+<p>"Now, gentlemen, what next?" he said, looking up.</p>
+<p>O'Neil looked at his companions, and then they spoke for a
+moment together.</p>
+<p>"We are about to start at once, my lord," he said, "and it was
+our intention to have left you bound and gagged, until the morning,
+when the woman of the house would have assuredly found you and
+released you. But, as you have acceded to our request at once, we
+will, if you give us your word of honour that you will raise no
+alarm, and say no word of this business until eight o'clock
+tomorrow morning, let you depart at once."</p>
+<p>"Thank you for your courtesy, gentlemen, and for your confidence
+in my honour. I am, indeed, anxious to return home at once. If I do
+not do so, there will be a hue and cry for me, and by the time I
+return in the morning all London will know that I am missing. I
+naturally should not wish this adventure to become a matter of
+common talk: in the first place, because the position in which you
+have placed me can scarcely be called a pleasant one; and secondly,
+because the success of your enterprise might lead others to make
+similar attempts on my person, or that of my colleagues. Even now,
+I fear that my servants, when sufficiently recovered, will go to my
+house and give the alarm."</p>
+<p>"I do not think that that is likely to be the case, my lord,"
+O'Neil said, "as we took the precaution of gagging and binding
+them, and laid them down some distance from the roadside. If, on
+your return home, you find they have not arrived, you have but to
+send a couple of your servants out to release them. You can give
+them strict orders that no word is to be said of the affair, and
+make them to understand you were attacked in error, and that the
+ruffians who took part in the outrage at once released you, upon
+discovering your identity."</p>
+<p>"Very good, sir," Godolphin said, with a grim smile. "I must
+really compliment you all on your fertility of resource and
+invention. And now, is there anything else that I can do for
+you?"</p>
+<p>"There is one small favour," Desmond said. "Your lordship has
+doubtless twenty guineas in your possession. You would greatly
+oblige us if you would give us them, for so many louis. These you
+will have no difficulty in exchanging, whereas the exhibition of
+French money, on our part, might excite suspicion."</p>
+<p>Lord Godolphin placed his hand in his pocket, drew out a heavy
+purse, and, opening it, counted out twenty guineas. O'Neil took
+these up, and handed to him twenty louis pieces.</p>
+<p>"One more question, gentlemen. What has become of my sedan
+chair?"</p>
+<p>"It is in an alley, hard by," O'Neil said, "and as we are
+ourselves going in your direction we will carry it to your
+door."</p>
+<p>"You are obliging, indeed, sir. If it had been found, the
+escutcheon on the panels would have shown that it was mine."</p>
+<p>"I fear, my lord, that you will have to have it repainted; for,
+before starting with you, we took the precaution to put black paint
+over the gilding and panels. Still, the lining and fittings would
+show that it belonged to some person of wealth and importance. As
+you have been so obliging to us, we will gladly escort you, with
+it, to your door."</p>
+<p>"I shall be glad, indeed, of that, gentlemen, for I certainly
+should not care about travelling alone through these lanes and
+alleys, which have by no means a good reputation."</p>
+<p>"We are ready to start at once, my lord," O'Neil said. "We have
+a long journey to perform, and, although there is now no need for
+extraordinary speed, we shall be glad to be off."</p>
+<p>They were ready at once, having settled with their landlady
+before starting out in the evening, telling her that they had heard
+of a job and should start early in the morning. Mike and Desmond
+fetched the empty chair, and they then started, Godolphin walking
+with the other officers in front.</p>
+<p>"This is the most surprising adventure that ever happened to
+me," Lord Godolphin said; "and it is a pity that officers who
+possess the wit to plan an escape from Newgate, and to ensure a
+speedy flight from the country by carrying me off, are not in the
+service of Her Majesty."</p>
+<p>"We may yet be in the British service some day, my lord,"
+O'Sullivan laughed; "but I may tell you that my friend, and myself,
+disclaim any credit in contriving the matter of which you spoke,
+that being solely the work of our young comrade, who is at present
+the youngest ensign in our regiment."</p>
+<p>"Then he must be a shrewd fellow, indeed," Godolphin said,
+"likely to do service in any position to which he may attain."</p>
+<p>They walked sharply. Several times rough men came and peered at
+them, but Godolphin was wrapped in a cloak, and the appearance of
+those with him showed that hard knocks, rather than booty, would be
+the result of interfering with them. On reaching Lord Godolphin's
+house they placed the sedan chair on the steps.</p>
+<p>"Goodnight to you, gentlemen, and good fortune!" Lord Godolphin
+said. "The lesson has not been lost, and I shall take good care, in
+future, to have a strong escort."</p>
+<p>They then crossed Westminster Bridge, and made rapidly for the
+spot where the cart was waiting for them.</p>
+<p>"You are an hour after your time," the man said. "I had begun to
+think that something had gone wrong with you."</p>
+<p>"That is not the case," O'Neil said; "but we have certainly been
+detained longer than we anticipated."</p>
+<p>"Where are we going to?"</p>
+<p>"To Rye."</p>
+<p>"That will suit me very well," the man said. "I have friends
+along that road, and shall have no trouble about horses."</p>
+<p>They started at once, at a rattling pace, the animals, though
+but sorry-looking creatures, being speedy and accustomed to long
+journeys. It was evident, from the man's manner, that he believed
+his passengers were cracksmen who had just successfully carried out
+an enterprise of importance. He expressed surprise that they had
+brought no luggage with them.</p>
+<p>They did not care to undeceive him. Mike had brought with him a
+bottle of good brandy, and a drink of this soon removed the
+vexation the man had felt at being kept waiting for them.</p>
+<p>Twice during the journey they changed horses, each time at small
+wayside inns, where some password, given by the driver, at once
+roused the landlord into activity. But a few minutes were spent in
+the changes, and the fifty miles to Rye were accomplished in seven
+hours--a very unusual rate of speed along the badly kept roads of
+the period. When the car drew up in the High Street of Rye, the
+four occupants were scarce able to stand, so bruised and shaken
+were they by their rapid passage over the rough road.</p>
+<p>They handed the twelve pounds agreed upon to the driver, adding
+another as a token of their satisfaction at the speed at which he
+had driven them, and then enquired for the house of William
+Dawkins. It was close by, and upon knocking at the door, it was
+opened by the man himself.</p>
+<p>"I have a message to deliver to you, in private," O'Neil
+said.</p>
+<p>The man nodded, and led the way indoors, where the letter was
+handed to him.</p>
+<p>"That is all right," he said. "My craft is always ready to set
+sail, at an hour's notice, and if the wind holds fair I will land
+you on the French coast before nightfall. I see that your business
+is urgent, or you would not have put on disguises before leaving
+London. I suppose you have brought other clothes to land in?"</p>
+<p>"We have not," O'Neil said. "We came away in such a hurry that
+we did not think of it until on the road, and then we thought that
+we might procure them here."</p>
+<p>"There will be no difficulty about that," the sailor said. "I
+will go out, and warn my men that we shall sail in half an hour,
+and then I can get any garments that you desire; for, doubtless,
+you do not wish to attract comment by the purchase of clothes that
+would seem unfitted to your present position."</p>
+<p>"That is so," O'Sullivan said, "and we shall gladly embrace your
+offer. We should like three suits, such as are worn by persons of
+fair position in France, and one proper for a serving man."</p>
+<p>"I cannot get you quite French fashion, sir, but they do not
+differ much from our own; and with a cloak each, I have no doubt
+that you would pass without attracting attention--that is, of
+course, if you speak French well."</p>
+<p>"As well as English," O'Neil said. "Here are seven pounds in
+gold, which will, I should think, be sufficient. If not, we are
+provided with French gold, for use after landing there."</p>
+<p>"I have no doubt it will suffice, sir. If not, I will pay what
+is the excess, and you can settle with me afterwards."</p>
+<p>In three-quarters of an hour after their arrival at Rye, they
+were dressed in their new disguises and on board the little lugger,
+which at once started down the river, which was at that time much
+more free from shoals and difficulties than it is at present.</p>
+<p>"Your boat seems fast," Desmond remarked, as, having cleared the
+mouth of the river, she put out to sea.</p>
+<p>"She is fast, sir; the fastest thing that sails out of Rye. She
+needs be, for the gentlemen who come to me are always in a
+hurry."</p>
+<p>"I suppose you have no fear of English cruisers?"</p>
+<p>"Not at all. I have the order you brought with you, and have
+only to show it to any English ship of war that overhauls us, for
+them to let us go on at once. I am careful when I get near the
+French coast, for although their big craft never venture out far,
+there are numbers of <em>chasse-maree</em> patrolling the coast.
+However, even if caught by them, it would be but a temporary
+detention, for I am well known at Etaples, which is always my port,
+unless specially directed to land my passengers elsewhere."</p>
+<p>The wind was fresh and favourable, and at six o'clock in the
+afternoon they entered the little port. Some gendarmes came down to
+the wharf.</p>
+<p>"We need have no fear of them," William Dawkins said. "Their
+lieutenant is paid handsomely for keeping his eyes shut, and asking
+no questions."</p>
+<p>"So you are back again," the officer said. "Why, it is not a
+week since you were here!"</p>
+<p>"No, it is but six days since I sailed."</p>
+<p>"And you have four passengers?"</p>
+<p>"That's the number, sir. The Irish gentlemen are desirous of
+entering the service of France."</p>
+<p>The officer nodded.</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen, you will find plenty of your countrymen in
+Paris; and, as everyone knows, there are no better or braver
+soldiers in His Majesty's service."</p>
+<p>The friends had already enquired, from William Dawkins, whether
+there was any passage money to pay, saying that they had forgotten
+to ask before starting.</p>
+<p>"Not at all. I am well paid by Government. My boat is always
+retained at a price that suits me well, and I get so much extra for
+every voyage I make. No, sir, thank you; I will take nothing for
+myself, but if you like to give half a guinea to the crew, to drink
+success to you, I will not say no."</p>
+<p>The party made no stay at Etaples, but at once ordered a chaise
+and post horses. Then, changing at every post house, and suffering
+vastly less discomfort than they experienced in the journey to
+Rye--the roads being better kept in France than they were on the
+English side of the channel--they arrived in Paris at eleven
+o'clock next day.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch11" id="Ch11">Chapter 11</a>: On the Frontier.</h2>
+<p>On entering the barrack yard, they found that the regiment had
+marched, ten days before, for the frontier, and that Lord Galmoy's
+regiment had taken their place. They went at once to his quarters
+and told him that, having effected their escape, they had travelled
+with all speed to inform the king of the determination of the
+English Government to bring the Irish officers to execution, and to
+implore him to intervene in their favour.</p>
+<p>"I will go with you to Versailles, at once," Lord Galmoy said;
+"but, as you have no uniforms, and the king is very strict on
+matters of etiquette, three of my officers will lend you their
+suits and swords. While they are being fetched, sit down and share
+my meal, for doubtless you have not waited to eat on the road."</p>
+<p>He then gave the necessary instructions, and half an hour later
+the three officers, now in uniform, started with him on horseback
+for Versailles. The king had just returned from hunting, and it was
+an hour before Lord Galmoy could obtain an audience with him. He
+had, on the road, told the others he felt sure that the king, who
+was well served by his agents in London, had already heard of the
+intention of the English Government, but as to whether he had sent
+off a remonstrance he was of course ignorant.</p>
+<p>"I shall press the matter strongly upon him, and point out the
+deep feeling that will be excited, throughout his Irish and Scotch
+troops, if nothing is done to save the prisoners.</p>
+<p>"Louis is a politic monarch," he said, "and, knowing our worth
+and that of his Scotch soldiers, I think that he will, on my
+representations, bestir himself. Wauchop has many times performed
+brilliant services, and deserves well of France. However, we shall
+see."</p>
+<p>When they were admitted to the audience, Lord Galmoy introduced
+the three soldiers of O'Brien's regiment as coming that morning to
+Paris, having effected their escape from Newgate. As he repeated
+their names, the king looked sharply at Desmond.</p>
+<p>"Ah, ah!" he said, "so our young ensign is in the thick of
+adventures again. These we will hear presently.</p>
+<p>"Well, my lord, why have they come here so hurriedly after their
+arrival?"</p>
+<p>"They came to inform Your Majesty that the English Government
+have determined to execute Colonel Francis Wauchop, and the twelve
+officers of their regiment who were on board the Salisbury,
+captured on the coast of Scotland."</p>
+<p>Desmond, who was watching the king's face closely, saw that this
+was no news to him, and that he was annoyed by its being now
+brought to his notice; for doubtless the fate of a colonel, and a
+dozen young officers, was a matter that affected him little; and
+that, had the matter not been forced upon him, he would not have
+troubled about it, but, when it was too late, would have professed
+entire ignorance of the intentions of the English Government.</p>
+<p>He only said, however, "It is incredible that there can be an
+intention to execute officers in our service, captured upon a
+warlike expedition."</p>
+<p>"It is but too true, sir. Against Colonel Wauchop they have no
+ground for severity. By the convention of Limerick, he and all
+other officers were formally permitted to enter Your Majesty's
+service; but the young lieutenants have, of course, joined long
+since that time, and therefore cannot benefit by the terms of the
+convention; and could, with a show of justice, be executed as
+English subjects, traitors serving against their country."</p>
+<p>"We are afraid that our remonstrance would have but little
+effect with the English Government."</p>
+<p>Lord Galmoy smiled slightly, for it was notorious that
+negotiations had gone on between King James and his councillors,
+and several of the members of the English Ministry, Marlborough
+himself being more than suspected of having a secret understanding
+with the little court at Saint Germain.</p>
+<p>He only said, however, "Your Majesty has in your hands the power
+of compelling the English Government to alter their determination
+in this matter."</p>
+<p>"How so, my lord?" the king asked, in much surprise.</p>
+<p>"You have, sire, many prisoners, Frenchmen of the reformed
+religion, who had entered the service of the Protestant
+princes--your enemies--and who were taken in Dutch and Flemish
+towns we have captured. These stand in the same relation towards
+Your Majesty as the Irish officers towards England. You have, then,
+but to inform the government there that, if they in any way harm
+the Irish officers and noncommissioned officers in their hands, you
+will at once execute a similar number of these French Protestant
+officers, whom you have hitherto treated as prisoners of war. Then,
+possibly, an exchange might be effected.</p>
+<p>"Your Majesty will, I think, pardon me for saying that, unless
+steps are taken to save these officers' lives, the matter is likely
+to have a very bad effect on the Irish and Scotch regiments, whose
+ardour will not be improved by the knowledge that in case of a
+reverse they will, if not killed in the field, be executed as
+traitors; for nearly half of the men who are now serving have
+joined since the formation of the Brigade, and are not protected by
+the terms of the Limerick treaty. They are devoted to Your
+Majesty's service, and are ready to lay down their lives freely for
+the cause of France; but it would not be fair that they should also
+run the risk of execution, if they are by misfortune made
+prisoners."</p>
+<p>"There is much in what you say, Lord Galmoy, and you certainly
+point out a way by which these officers can be saved. A messenger
+shall start, in an hour's time, with a letter to the English
+Government. It shall be delivered at their headquarters in Flanders
+by noon tomorrow, with a request that it shall be forwarded by
+special messenger to the British minister; and we will have a
+proclamation posted in Paris, and in the various camps of the army,
+saying that we have warned the English Government that, unless the
+officers and men captured off the coast of Scotland are treated as
+prisoners of war, we shall retaliate by treating all French
+officers taken in foreign service in the same way; and that we have
+furthermore offered to exchange an equal number of such officers
+and men, in our hands, for those held by the British
+Government."</p>
+<p>"I thank Your Majesty, most respectfully and heartily, in the
+name of all the foreign officers in your service. Even should,
+unfortunately, the English Government refuse to pardon or exchange
+their prisoners, it will be seen that Your Majesty has done all in
+your power to save them, and there will be a general feeling of
+reprobation, throughout Europe, at the conduct of the English
+Ministry."</p>
+<p>"We beg these officers to wait in the anteroom, while we dictate
+our despatch and proclamation to our secretary. We would fain
+question them as to how they effected their escape from their
+prison, and how they have made so speedy a journey here."</p>
+<p>Lord Galmoy bowed, and retired with the others.</p>
+<p>"We have done well," he said, "better indeed than I had hoped.
+Now, having succeeded in saving our countrymen's lives, which I
+doubt not would have been otherwise sacrificed, I shall return at
+once to Paris, for there is an inspection of my regiment this
+afternoon."</p>
+<p>"We have been fortunate, indeed," O'Neil said, when Lord Galmoy
+had left. "I have no doubt the king had heard that the English
+Government had resolved to execute the prisoners, but I question
+whether he would have stirred in the matter, had it not been for
+Galmoy's representation."</p>
+<p>"I am sure, by his manner, that he had received the news
+before," Desmond said, "and, as you say, had not intended to
+interfere. It was the suggestion that he might threaten
+retaliation, and that the effect of his not moving in the matter
+would be very bad among his Irish troops, that decided him to
+interfere. He may have felt that any mere protest made by him would
+have had little effect, and it is not his nature to expose himself
+to a rebuff; but, directly he saw that he had an effective weapon
+in his hands, he took the matter up as warmly as we could
+wish."</p>
+<p>In point of fact, the king's threat had the desired effect, and
+two months later the imprisoned officers and men were exchanged for
+an equal number of Huguenots.</p>
+<p>In a quarter of an hour, the three officers were again summoned
+to the king's presence. With him was a tall dark officer, of
+distinguished mien, whom O'Neil and O'Sullivan both recognized as
+the Duke of Berwick, one of the most famous generals of the time.
+He had been in command of the French forces in Spain, from which he
+had been recalled suddenly, two days before, in order that the
+king, who had a great confidence in him, might consult him as to
+the general plan of operations, in that country and in the north,
+before despatching him to join the army in Flanders. This was
+commanded by the Duke of Burgundy and the Duke of Vendome jointly;
+and as both were headstrong and obstinate, and by no means agreed
+as to the operations to be undertaken, the king had determined to
+send Berwick there, in order that he might, by his military genius
+and influence, bring matters to a better state between the two
+dukes, and arrange with them some definite plan by which the tide
+of fortune, which had hitherto gone against the French, might be
+arrested.</p>
+<p>The king appeared now to be in a good humour.</p>
+<p>"And now, young sirs," he said, "I have an hour at leisure, and
+would fain hear a true account of your adventures, omitting
+nothing.</p>
+<p>"I have no doubt, Monsieur Kennedy, that your ready wit had no
+small share in the matter."</p>
+<p>"With your permission, Sire, I will tell the story," O'Neil
+said, "for Mr. Kennedy is not likely to place his own share of the
+work in its due prominence."</p>
+<p>The king nodded, and O'Neil gave a detailed account of the
+manner in which they had made their escape, and succeeded in
+getting themselves conveyed across the channel in a vessel in the
+Government service, explaining that both affairs were due entirely
+to Desmond's initiative and ingenuity. The king listened with great
+interest, and even laughed at the story of the capture of Lord
+Godolphin.</p>
+<p>"You have all three behaved extremely well," he said.</p>
+<p>"You, Monsieur Kennedy, have again shown that you possess
+unusual shrewdness, as well as daring.</p>
+<p>"What think you, Duke, of this young subaltern, who is, we may
+tell you, the hero of whom you have doubtless heard, who twice
+rescued Mademoiselle de Pointdexter from the hands of her
+abductor?"</p>
+<p>"I was told the story yesterday, Sire, and was filled with
+admiration at the boldness and resource of her rescuer, who was, I
+heard, an ensign in O'Brien's regiment; but certainly I did not
+expect to find him so young a man. He has, indeed, a fertility of
+invention that fills me with surprise. The other officers deserve
+praise, for having so willingly followed the leadership of their
+junior, and their generosity in assigning to him the whole merit of
+their undertaking is highly commendable. It is no easy thing, Sire,
+to find in young officers--especially, if I may say so, among the
+cadets of good family, who form for the most part the staff of your
+generals--men ready to exercise their own discretion when in
+difficulties, and to carry out with due diligence the orders
+committed to them."</p>
+<p>"O'Brien's regiment has marched to the northern frontier. The
+vacancies in the ranks of its officers have been filled up from
+those of other regiments. I should, with Your Majesty's permission,
+be glad to take these three officers on my own staff, as, leaving
+Spain privately in accordance with Your Majesty's orders, I have
+brought with me only Captain Fromart, my secretary, and one young
+aide-de-camp. I should be glad if you would promote Mr. Kennedy to
+the rank of lieutenant."</p>
+<p>"We quite approve of both requests," the king said graciously;
+"and indeed," he added with a smile, "shall not be altogether sorry
+to see Lieutenant Kennedy employed outside our kingdom, for, after
+making war on his own account with one of our nobles, and
+kidnapping the first minister of England, there is no saying what
+enterprise he might next undertake. And should he join any of those
+who trouble the country with their plots, we should feel compelled
+to double our guards, in order to hold ourself secure from his
+designs.</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen, since the Duke of Berwick has appointed you
+his aides-de-camp, the least we can do is to see that you are
+properly fitted out for the expedition. You have, of course, lost
+your uniforms, horses, and money in our service, and it is but just
+that we should see to your being refitted. If you will wait in the
+anteroom, you shall each receive an order on our treasury for a
+hundred louis d'ors."</p>
+<p>The three officers bowed deeply in acknowledgment to the king,
+and, bowing also to the Duke of Berwick, returned to the anteroom,
+where presently one of the royal attendants brought to them the
+three orders on the treasury, and also begged them, in the name of
+the Duke of Berwick, to wait until his audience with the king
+should be over.</p>
+<p>They were all highly delighted with the change in their
+position. The posts of staff officers were, as the duke had said,
+considered to belong almost of right to members of noble families,
+and it was seldom that officers of the line could aspire to
+them.</p>
+<p>"Did I not tell you, Kennedy, that your luck would bring good
+fortune to us all! And, by the powers, it has done so! Faith, if
+anyone had said a month ago that I should by now be on the Duke of
+Berwick's staff, I should have laughed in his face, if indeed I had
+not quarrelled with him for mocking at me. And now here we are,
+with money to buy horses and outfit, and with no more drilling
+recruits and attending parades."</p>
+<p>"But not an end to work, O'Sullivan," Desmond Kennedy said. "You
+won't find much idle time, when you are serving with the duke."</p>
+<p>"No. He has the name of being a strict commander, sparing
+neither himself nor his soldiers; and I have heard that his staff
+have a very hard time of it. However, I am not afraid of hard work,
+when it is done on horseback, and there are many more chances of
+promotion on the staff than there are in marching regiments. Well,
+I don't mind being taken prisoner a dozen times if this is what
+comes of it, providing always that you are taken with me, Kennedy,
+and are there to help me out of the scrape."</p>
+<p>"We should have to have Mike prisoner, too," Desmond laughed,
+"for without his help we should be in Newgate at present."</p>
+<p>"I don't believe it. I am sure that, even if he hadn't turned
+up, you would have managed somehow."</p>
+<p>In a short time, the duke came out.</p>
+<p>"I am likely to be detained here another week, before I start
+for Flanders. That will give you time to procure your outfit of
+horses and equipments and arms. You will require two horses each,
+and these should be good ones. I doubt whether, if you get proper
+outfits, the sum that His Majesty has given you will suffice to buy
+two horses. I have, however, in my stables here, plenty of good
+animals that have been taken from the enemy, and one will be given
+to each of you. Therefore, it will be only necessary for you to
+purchase one.</p>
+<p>"I am staying here, and should be obliged, when you have taken a
+lodging, if you would send me your address. I shall then let you
+know where and when you are to join me. Is there anything else that
+you would ask me?"</p>
+<p>"I would ask, sir, that I might take my servant with me,"
+Desmond said.</p>
+<p>"Certainly; and you can do so without further question. One man,
+more or less, will make no difference to O'Brien's regiment, and it
+would be a pity that you should not have him with you, for it is
+evident that he is at once faithful, and possesses a large amount
+of shrewdness."</p>
+<p>After thanking the duke for the present of the horses, the three
+officers, having drawn their money, left the palace and rode back
+to Paris. They went first to the barracks, and returned the horses
+and uniforms, with many thanks, to the officers who had lent them;
+had an interview with Lord Galmoy, and informed him of their new
+appointments.</p>
+<p>"You have well won them," he said, "and I wish you every good
+fortune. Assuredly, you are more likely to rise under the Duke of
+Berwick than as subaltern in the Irish Brigade, though promotion is
+not slow there, owing to the vacancies that battle always makes in
+their ranks."</p>
+<p>They went out and took a lodging together, and then went to a
+military tailor, who promised them their undress and full dress
+suits in four days. Then they ordered military saddles, bridles,
+and equipments.</p>
+<p>On the next day, after visiting half the stables in Paris, they
+purchased three horses for themselves, and Desmond bought, in
+addition, a serviceable animal for Mike, with a cavalry saddle and
+accoutrements, and ordered a uniform for him. Each provided himself
+with a sword and a brace of pistols.</p>
+<p>Mike was greatly pleased when Desmond communicated his promotion
+and appointment to him.</p>
+<p>"You will look grand, your honour, as a general's aide-de-camp,
+with your handsome uniform and your horses and all that, and 'tis
+glad I am that we are going to Flanders, for, from all I have heard
+from men who have fought in Spain, little pleasure is to be had in
+campaigning there. The food is vile, the roads are bad. You are
+choked with dust and smothered with heat.</p>
+<p>"As to their making you lieutenant, if you had your dues, it
+would be a colonel they should have made you, or at any rate a
+major."</p>
+<p>"There is plenty of time, Mike," Desmond laughed. "A nice
+colonel I should look, too, leading a thousand men into battle. If
+I obtain a majority in another fifteen years, I shall consider
+myself lucky."</p>
+<p>Desmond did not share Mike's gratification that they were to
+campaign with the army of the north, instead of with that in Spain.
+However, as he would be fighting against English troops in either
+country, he concluded it would not make much difference, especially
+as, being an aide-de-camp, he would not himself have to enter into
+actual conflict with them.</p>
+<p>His friends were heartily glad that their destination was not
+Spain, for all had, like Mike, heard much of the hardships suffered
+by the troops in that country.</p>
+<p>"I know from what you have said, Kennedy, that if you had had
+your choice you would have taken Spain, but, putting aside the heat
+there, it is but poor work, by all accounts. You are well-nigh
+starved, you can't get at your enemy, who knows all the mountains
+and the paths over them, is as difficult to catch as one of their
+fleas, harasses you while you are on the march, and shirks fighting
+as the old one shirks holy water. There has only been one fight
+which could be called a battle since the war began; and as for the
+sieges, it means that you lose a lot of men, and have little credit
+when you take a place, especially as the moment you go out one way
+the enemy enter on the other side, and there is all the work to be
+done over again."</p>
+<p>"I admit that we shall see a great deal more of war in the
+north," Kennedy said, "and Marlborough and Eugene on the other
+side, and the Dukes of Berwick and Vendome on ours, are such
+skilful commanders that there will be far greater interest in the
+operations, than in carrying on what is little more than a partisan
+war in Spain."</p>
+<p>"Not only that," O'Neil put in, "but there will be a possibility
+of getting decent food. While in Spain there are few great towns,
+and these a long distance from each other; in Flanders there are
+towns every few miles, and you are sure of decent quarters and good
+cooking."</p>
+<p>"Why, O'Neil, I did not know that you were particular as to your
+food," Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"I can starve as well as another, Kennedy, but when I get good
+food and good wine and good lodgings, I own that I prefer it vastly
+to the fare that our troops have to put up with, in Spain. I can
+see no reason why, because you are going to risk your life in
+battle, you should put up with all sorts of miseries and
+inconveniences beforehand, if they can be avoided.</p>
+<p>"As to fighting against the English, there are English both in
+Spain and Flanders, and in both armies they form but a small
+proportion of the force, though I grant willingly that they are the
+backbone of both armies. If you look at the thing sensibly, you
+will see that we have gained no slight advantage by Berwick's going
+to Flanders, instead of returning to Spain."</p>
+<p>Three days after their preparations were completed, an orderly
+brought a note from the Duke of Berwick. It was brief and to the
+point.</p>
+<p>The rendezvous is at six o'clock tomorrow morning, in front of
+La Louvre.</p>
+<p>(Signed) Berwick.</p>
+<p>All were glad that the summons had come. They had discussed the
+future from every point of view, and were already growing
+impatient, short as their stay had been in Paris.</p>
+<p>Five minutes before the hour, they were at the rendezvous. As
+the clock struck, the duke rode up with two officers and an escort
+of six troopers. He looked at their accoutrements and horses, and
+nodded his head approvingly.</p>
+<p>"You will do very well," he said. "I can tell you that the gloss
+of your uniforms will not last long, in Flanders."</p>
+<p>The other officers were Captain Fromart, who acted as the duke's
+secretary, and Lieutenant d'Eyncourt. Mike fell in with the escort,
+behind which also rode the body servant of the duke, and the two
+cavalry men who were the servants of his officers.</p>
+<p>Once beyond the limits of the town, the party broke into a trot.
+The duke rode on ahead, evidently in deep thought, and the five
+officers followed in a group.</p>
+<p>"I see, messieurs," d'Eyncourt said, "that only one of you has
+brought a servant with him."</p>
+<p>"We only arrived in Paris a week ago," O'Neil said. "Our own
+regiment had left, and we did not care to ask for two soldiers from
+another regiment, as these might have turned out badly. We thought
+it better, therefore, to delay until we joined the army, and wait
+till we could obtain a couple of good men from one of the cavalry
+regiments there. As it is, Monsieur Kennedy's servant can look
+after the three of us, and, I have no doubt, two of the soldiers of
+the escort will not object to earn a few livres by looking after
+our horses on the way."</p>
+<p>"I think you are right," the other said. "If one gets a good
+man, a soldier servant is invaluable. If, as is often the case, he
+is a bad one, well, one is far better without him. It is curious
+how men who have been smart soldiers, when in the ranks, are apt to
+go to the bad when they become servants. They have more time on
+their hands, are free from most of the parades, have no sentry duty
+to perform, and the consequence is that they become slovenly and
+careless, and in nine cases out of ten give way to drink at every
+opportunity. If Mr. Kennedy's servant is really a good one, you
+will be better off, with a third of his services, than you would be
+with the whole of that of an ordinary soldier servant.</p>
+<p>"You have just returned from England, have you not? The duke
+told Captain Fromart that you were among those who were captured in
+the Salisbury, but that you had made your escape. He gave no
+particulars, for indeed, the duke is not given to much speech. As a
+general he is splendid, but it would be more pleasant for his staff
+if he were to unbend a little."</p>
+<p>"Yes, we managed to give them the slip," O'Neil said, "thanks to
+Monsieur Kennedy and his servant. Did you return from Spain with
+the general, Captain Fromart?"</p>
+<p>"Yes. There was nothing doing at the moment, and he gave us the
+option of accompanying him or staying behind. We vastly preferred
+the trip, as we considered it, for of course we had no idea that
+the duke was about to be sent to Flanders. You hear a good deal of
+the climate of Spain. It is said to be lovely. I vow that it is
+detestable. The heat, when it is hot, is terrible, and when it is
+not hot, there is a bitter wind that chills you to the bone. A
+great portion of the country is but half populated, and you can go
+a day's march without coming to a village. The roads are
+villainous. There is nothing to buy, and it is as much as the
+transport can do to get, I will not say enough bread, but a bare
+sufficiency to maintain the troops. Moreover, the duke has been
+constantly thwarted in his plans by the Spaniards, who are ready
+enough to make promises, but never take a single step towards their
+fulfilment. The duke's temper is of the shortest, and he has
+quarrelled openly with most of the leading Spaniards, and has
+threatened, four or five times, to throw up his command and return
+to France. He did do so a year ago, but affairs went so badly,
+without him, that the cause of France was seriously imperilled by
+his absence, and it was at the urgent request of Philip that he
+returned; for at that time the English general, Peterborough, was
+striking dismay all over the country, and if the duke's advice had
+not been taken, all our officers acknowledge that we should
+speedily have crossed the Pyrenees."</p>
+<p>"And do the population incline towards Philip or the
+Austrian?"</p>
+<p>"As a rule, they incline towards the party which seems likely to
+win. They would shout in Madrid as loudly for the Archduke Charles
+as for Philip. Catalonia and Valencia are the exceptions. There the
+balance of feeling is certainly in favour of the Austrian, but this
+is principally because they are afraid of Peterborough, whom they
+regard as almost supernatural, and fear he would take vengeance
+upon those who deserted his cause. But there is no accounting for
+them; cities have held out as stoutly for one candidate as for the
+other, without any apparent reason, so far as we can observe.</p>
+<p>"We fight for Philip because he is Louis's grandson, and it is
+important in the interest of France to stand closely allied with
+his party. But as for the Spaniards with us, I can tell you that we
+have but little trust in them."</p>
+<p>"But some of them are good, are they not?"</p>
+<p>"We do not consider any of them of much account. But then the
+Spaniards on the other side are no better. They seem to have lost
+all their military virtues, ever since their best troops were
+demolished at Rocroi by Conde. That and the destruction of their
+fleet by the English, and the drain of their resources both in men
+and money, entailed by the long war in Holland, altogether deprived
+the people of their martial spirit. The war is to some extent
+between the English and us, because, of the allies England,
+Holland, and Austria, neither the Austrians nor the Dutch take any
+great share in the struggle. The Dutch are wholly engrossed with
+the defence of their fens, the Austrians are fully occupied in
+Italy and on the Rhine frontier, and it is only the English, who,
+fortunately, are not very numerous, who are against us, for the
+Portuguese can scarcely be counted in the business, being, if
+anything, slower and more stupid than the Spaniards themselves.</p>
+<p>"However, at present the prospect is good. Peterborough has
+gone. Galway's army has been almost destroyed; though, to do them
+justice, the English regiments fought magnificently, and if they
+had been seconded by the Portuguese the result might have been
+altogether different."</p>
+<p>"Then you found Spain much less rich than France?"</p>
+<p>"There is no comparison," Captain Fromart said. "It ought to be
+fully as rich, but the plains lie almost uncultivated. The people
+seem wholly without energy, and the ruling class are always
+intriguing, and seem to pay little attention to their estates. You
+see but few castles and chateaux, such as are dotted over France. I
+do not say that, at the present moment, France can be considered a
+prosperous country in material matters. The expenses of the wars
+have been enormous, to say nothing of the Court. The people are
+ground down by taxation, and the misery in some parts of the
+country is extreme; but left to themselves the people will work,
+and work hard. Our soil will grow anything, and after twenty years
+of peace, France would altogether recover herself."</p>
+<p>"And yet the alliance of Spain is considered as of vital
+importance to France!"</p>
+<p>"Of great importance, certainly. Spain has still soldiers who
+can fight well, as they have proved in Italy; and were the levies
+at home equally well drilled and disciplined, they would no doubt
+turn out good soldiers. But these are, at present, almost
+undrilled. They desert in numbers and return to their homes, after
+the slightest reverse, and prefer to act as partisans under leaders
+of their own choosing. But with Philip once firmly seated on the
+throne, with French advisers and officers to assist him, and a few
+regiments to serve as a nucleus to his army, Spain could turn out a
+force which would be a very valuable addition to the strength of
+any European power. With Spain as our ally we can, in addition to
+the force that she can put in the field, neglect altogether our
+southern frontier, and employ our whole army elsewhere. With her as
+an ally of Austria or of England, we should have to keep an army in
+the south to guard our borders."</p>
+<p>Two days after leaving Paris, the party arrived at Peronne,
+where a considerable body of troops were collected, of which,
+although an aide-de-camp, Desmond now learned for the first time
+the duke was to take the command. No movements of importance had
+taken place in the field, and as the force at Peronne still wanted
+several regiments, to bring it up to the intended strength, some
+weeks passed before it was set in motion.</p>
+<p>The four aides-de-camp, however, had a busy time of it. The main
+army was stationed in the neighbourhood of Lille, and frequent
+communications passed between Berwick and Vendome.</p>
+<p>The allies were inactive. Eugene had, early in April, met
+Marlborough at the Hague, and had concerted with him the plan for
+the campaign. He had then gone to Vienna to bring up
+reinforcements, and until these arrived Marlborough hardly felt in
+a position to take the offensive, as the French armies were
+considerably stronger than his own, and he had not yet been joined
+by the troops from Hanover.</p>
+<p>Except to receive orders, the aides-de-camp saw little of their
+commander. He was absorbed in the difficult problems of the war,
+and was occasionally absent for two or three days at the camp of
+Vendome. He always spoke kindly to them when on duty, but at other
+times dispensed altogether with their attendance, and as a rule
+took his meals alone.</p>
+<p>"You see him at his worst," d'Eyncourt said one day to his new
+comrades, "He is a different man when he is in the field. Then he
+is full of life and activity, looking into every detail himself,
+endeavouring to infuse some of his own energy into others, full of
+care for the comfort of his troops, though ready to endure any
+hardship himself. Then you see the real man; a noble character,
+idolized by the soldiers and loved by us all. You must not judge
+him, in the slightest degree, by what he now is. He has a great
+deal on his mind, and has, so it is whispered, no small trouble in
+keeping the peace between Vendome and Burgundy. The failure, too,
+of the expedition to Scotland must have greatly disappointed him,
+and I have no doubt he expected to be put at the head of any French
+army sent over to place James upon the throne. However, he may
+congratulate himself now that he was not with it, for no honour and
+no gain has been earned by any concerned in it."</p>
+<p>"That certainly is so," Desmond agreed. "It was a mismanaged
+affair altogether. To begin with, twenty thousand men should have
+been sent instead of six thousand; and in the next place, the fleet
+should have assembled at Brest or Bordeaux, for in that case,
+although the news of its assembling would assuredly have reached
+England, it would not have been known whether it was intended that
+the landing should be made in Ireland, Scotland, or on the English
+coast, while by gathering at Dunkirk no doubt was left as to the
+destination. This was proved by the fact that, when the English
+fleet watching the port was driven off by a gale, and an
+opportunity was thus given for a start, instead of coming back
+again, as we had hoped, only to find that we had left, it sailed
+straight for the north, making absolutely certain that we were
+bound for Edinburgh."</p>
+<p>"Well, we must hope," O'Sullivan said, "that next time the force
+will, as you say, be fully twenty thousand men, will include the
+Irish Brigade, will be led by Berwick, and will land in
+Ireland."</p>
+<p>At this moment an orderly entered.</p>
+<p>"The duke requires your attendance, Lieutenant Kennedy."</p>
+<p>Desmond at once went to the duke's apartments.</p>
+<p>"You will start at once for Lille, Mr. Kennedy, and will report
+yourself to Marshal Vendome. I have arranged with him that one of
+my aides-de-camp shall accompany the force that is about to
+advance, and shall keep me informed of what is being done. I have
+selected you because I know you to be active and shrewd. The
+marshal is too much occupied to send me such full reports as I
+should wish, and I look to you not only to give me facts, but to
+convey to me your impressions of what you see passing around you.
+Do not fear to speak plainly. Your communications will be strictly
+private, and your views will be thus of far more use to me than the
+official expressions of the marshal and his staff.</p>
+<p>"You will, of course, take your servant with you, and I have
+told off three troopers to accompany you, for the purpose of
+bringing your reports to me. There is no probability of a general
+engagement at present, and until we obtain some idea of
+Marlborough's plans, no extensive operations will be
+undertaken."</p>
+<p>From the manner in which he spoke, Desmond had no doubt that
+Berwick himself was in favour of taking the initiative without
+delay, but that he had been overruled. It was indeed of importance
+to the French that, before advancing, they should secure possession
+of the towns of west Flanders, so that the great roads would all be
+open to them.</p>
+<p>Half an hour after leaving the duke, Desmond was in the saddle,
+and, followed by the four soldiers, rode for Vendome's camp.
+According to instructions he halted for the night at Arras, and
+reached Lille at ten the next morning. He at once presented himself
+to the marshal, and handed to him the letter from Berwick, of which
+he was the bearer.</p>
+<p>The duke glanced through it.</p>
+<p>"I have been expecting you, Lieutenant Kennedy, and have
+arranged that you shall mess and ride with the junior officers of
+my staff. I will order a tent to be erected for you, at once.
+Should any portion of my force move without me, I have arranged
+that you shall accompany it. You will find many of your compatriots
+in camp, for we have five battalions of the Irish Brigade with us,
+among them that of O'Brien, to which the Duke of Berwick informed
+me you belonged before you were appointed to his staff, having
+distinguished yourself markedly on several occasions."</p>
+<p>The <em>marechal-de-camp</em> coming in, Vendome placed Desmond
+in his charge, requesting him to introduce him to the various
+officers of his staff, with whom he would have to mess, and to see
+that he was well cared for. He was well received by the young
+French officers, all of whom, with scarce an exception, belonged to
+good families, and Desmond was not long in discovering that they
+regarded their occupation rather as a pleasant and exciting
+diversion, than as a matter of duty, and that the greater portion
+of their time was devoted to pleasure. They rode, practised with
+the pistol and rapier, made excursions into the country, dined, and
+spent their evenings as if the army were nonexistent. A few only,
+and these were men who had served as officers, took their
+profession seriously, and divided among themselves what work had to
+be done, the young nobles gladly relinquishing it to them.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch12" id="Ch12">Chapter 12</a>: Oudenarde.</h2>
+<p>Desmond did not remain long at the marshal's camp, but
+accompanied expeditions that were sent to Bruges, Ghent, and Ypres.
+The inhabitants of these towns had, for some time, been in
+communication with the marshal. They were hostile to the English,
+and had a standing feud, of many years' duration, with the
+Dutch.</p>
+<p>As soon, therefore, as the French columns approached, they
+opened their gates. The weak garrisons that had been placed there,
+finding themselves unable to at once control the population and
+defend the walls, evacuated the town before the French arrived.</p>
+<p>Beyond writing confidential reports to Berwick, Desmond had had
+little to do, and spent most of his time with his own regiment, by
+whom he was heartily welcomed, and with the other Irish battalions
+encamped near them. He and the other officers captured in the
+Salisbury had been given up as lost by their comrades; and the
+appearance of Desmond, in his staff uniform, was the first
+intimation they had received of his escape, of which he had more
+than once to give a detailed account.</p>
+<p>In doing this, he made no mention of the seizure of Lord
+Godolphin. He knew that the minister was anxious that this should
+not get abroad, and, as he had behaved fairly to them, Desmond
+considered that he ought to remain silent on the subject; and
+merely said that, on their arrival at Rye, they had made an
+arrangement with a man who was in the habit of conveying persons
+secretly, to or from France, to take them across the channel.</p>
+<p>"You amaze me more and more, Kennedy," the colonel said. "Six
+months ago, when you joined, you seemed to me little more than a
+boy, and yet you have been through adventures that demanded the
+brain and courage of a veteran. We missed you all much; but I hope
+we shall soon get the others back again, for I had news the other
+day, from Paris, that arrangements for their exchange were going
+on, and no doubt they will rejoin as soon as they land.</p>
+<p>"There is little chance of you, O'Neil and O'Sullivan coming
+back to the regiment; but, at any rate, as Berwick's force is sure
+to join ours, as soon as operations begin in earnest, we shall
+often see you."</p>
+<p>It was the end of June before the main army advanced. Desmond
+had returned to Peronne after the capture of the three Flemish
+towns, and was warmly praised by Berwick for the manner in which he
+had carried out the work entrusted to him. On the 6th of July, he
+received orders to accompany the duke.</p>
+<p>"There is bad news," Captain Fromart said, entering the room
+where the four aides-de-camp were together. "You know the marshal
+had commenced the siege of Oudenarde. We have news now that the
+enemy has suddenly advanced towards him, and he has been obliged to
+raise the siege, and fall back across the Scheldt. The troops are
+to go forward at once. The duke will ride on, with all speed, in
+accordance with Vendome's urgent request. All four of you are to go
+on with him. I shall accompany the force here.</p>
+<p>"There is no time to be lost. The duke's horse is to be at the
+door in a quarter of an hour, and it will not please him to be kept
+waiting. You had better leave your spare horses, for the present. I
+have already warned the escort."</p>
+<p>It was a short notice, but by the time named the four
+aides-de-camp were in their saddles, as were their soldier
+servants, for by this time Desmond's two friends had obtained
+servants from a dragoon regiment. They were but just in time, for
+they had scarcely mounted when the duke came out, sprang into his
+saddle, and went off at a canter.</p>
+<p>The distance was some fifty miles. They stopped once for two
+hours, to refresh themselves and their horses, and rode into
+Vendome's camp soon after nightfall. A large tent had been already
+erected for Berwick's use, close to that of the marshal; and
+another, close by, for the use of the officers who might come with
+him.</p>
+<p>A quarter of an hour later, a soldier entered the
+aides-de-camp's tent, with a large tray.</p>
+<p>"The Duke of Berwick bids me say, gentlemen, that he is supping
+with the marshal, who has sent these dishes to you from his own
+table."</p>
+<p>"Please to give our thanks to the Duke of Vendome, for his
+kindness," Desmond said; but when the soldier had left the tent, he
+went on, "I have no doubt that this is the result of a suggestion
+on the part of Berwick, and greatly obliged to him we must feel. We
+had just been saying that we supposed we should get nothing to eat
+till tomorrow morning, while here is a supper worthy of the
+marshal, and four flasks of wine, which I doubt not are good."</p>
+<p>It was ten o'clock before the duke returned to his tent, when he
+at once sent for his aides-de-camp.</p>
+<p>"There will be nothing more for you to do, tonight, gentlemen.
+Sleep soundly, for we shall have a hard day's work tomorrow. We are
+to cross the Scheldt again at daybreak. The enemy are on the other
+side of the Dender, and the next day a pitched battle will probably
+be fought. You may be surprised that we do not wait until my forces
+arrive, but we have heard that Eugene's reinforcements are within
+two days' march of Marlborough, and, as they are more numerous than
+those I command, it has been decided to accept battle at once. Good
+night."</p>
+<p>"The general is in a good temper," d'Eyncourt said, as they
+reentered their tent. "I expect that his views have been adopted,
+and that there was a warm discussion over them."</p>
+<p>This was indeed the case. The Duke of Burgundy, an obstinate man
+without any knowledge of war, had been in favour of pushing
+forward, crossing the Lys as well as the Scheldt, and attacking the
+allies as soon as they met them. Vendome, on the other hand, was of
+opinion that the army which was now collected near Ghent had better
+advance against Oudenarde, which might be carried by a coup de main
+before Marlborough could come to its assistance, which he might be
+some days in doing, seeing that he was in command of a mixed force,
+composed of Dutch, Danes, Hanoverians, Prussians, and British.
+Burgundy then maintained that they should retire, and fight near
+Ypres, where they would be close to the frontier, and could retire
+upon Lille in case matters went against them. Berwick, however, at
+last managed to persuade him to agree to Vendome's plan, as the
+capture of Oudenarde was a matter of the utmost importance, and it
+would be as easy to fall back thence to Lille as it would be from
+Ypres.</p>
+<p>This Burgundy had sullenly assented to, and the next morning the
+army marched to the position fixed upon. This was on steeply rising
+ground, with the river Norken running at its foot. Beyond this were
+two other eminences, on each of which stood a windmill. That on the
+west was called the windmill of Oycke, and that on the adjoining
+hill the windmill of Royegham, the latter flanking the main
+position. Oudenarde being found to be strongly garrisoned, it was
+decided, in spite of the opposition of Burgundy, to cross the
+Scheldt at Gavre, and then to give battle to the allies between
+that river and the Dender.</p>
+<p>Marlborough had, however, been joined by Prince Eugene, who had,
+like Berwick, hurried on in advance of his army, and the two great
+generals decided, instead of attacking the French by the road from
+Brussels, to sweep round across the Scheldt at Oudenarde, and by
+other bridges across the river, and so to place themselves between
+Vendome and France.</p>
+<p>A portion of the French army was already in movement, when the
+news came that the allies were fast coming up. Early the next
+morning their advance guard, composed of twelve battalions of
+infantry and the whole of the cavalry, reached the Scheldt; and,
+having thrown bridges over the river, crossed, and soon came in
+contact with the French advance guard, under Biron. There was some
+severe fighting, in which neither party gained any great advantage,
+the French maintaining possession of the village of Eynes.</p>
+<p>While this conflict was going on, Marlborough and Eugene, with
+the main body, had reached the river, and were engaged in crossing
+it; and Vendome determined to attack them while carrying out the
+operation. He was, as usual, opposed by Burgundy, who wished to
+continue the march to Ghent. Marshal Vendome pointed out that, in a
+country so broken and interspersed with hedges, an army possessing
+the greatest strength--for the French numbered eighty-five
+thousand, while Marlborough had but eighty thousand under
+him--would lose the advantage of that superiority; and, upon
+Berwick strongly siding with the marshal, Burgundy was forced to
+give way.</p>
+<p>The discussion lasted some time, enabling the allies to pass
+bodies of troops across the river, where they were formed up at a
+village a few hundred yards north of Oudenarde; and immediately
+Marlborough felt strong enough to risk an attack, orders were sent
+to Cadogan, who commanded the advance guard, to drive the enemy out
+of Eynes.</p>
+<p>Four English battalions attacked the seven French battalions in
+the village, while the cavalry crossed higher up, and came down on
+the back of the village. Three of the French battalions were
+surrounded and made prisoners, while the other four were
+dispersed.</p>
+<p>It was now evident, even to Burgundy, that an action could not
+be avoided, but again an angry dispute took place. Vendome would
+have stood on the defensive, with the river Norken to be crossed
+before he could be attacked. He was, however, overruled by
+Burgundy, who had nominally chief command. Marlborough took
+advantage of the delay, and posted his troops in front of the
+castle of Bevere, and sent the twelve battalions at Eynes to
+reinforce his left, against which he saw the main attack of the
+French would be directed. He then lined all the hedges with
+infantry, and stationed twenty British battalions, under Argyle, in
+reserve.</p>
+<p>Crossing the Norken, the French fell upon the Dutch and
+Hanoverians, who constituted the left wing, and who, though
+fighting obstinately, were driven back. Marlborough moved from the
+centre with twenty battalions to reinforce them, and despatched
+Eugene to command on the right.</p>
+<p>A desperate fight now took place. On both flanks, the ground was
+broken by enclosures with deep wet ditches, bridges, woods, and
+small villages; and the cavalry were unable to act on such ground.
+The infantry on both sides fought with extreme resolution; every
+hedge, ditch, bridge, and house being defended to the last. Seldom,
+indeed, in modern warfare, has so obstinate and terrible a fight
+taken place. Frequently the combatants were mingled together, and
+fought with bayonets and the butt ends of their muskets.</p>
+<p>Gradually, however, the Dutch and the Hanoverian battalions won
+their way forward, and drove the French back to the village of
+Diepenbeck, where the latter successfully maintained themselves.
+Marlborough then ordered General Overkirk to move round and seize
+the hill at Oycke, which, although it flanked the enemy's position,
+was not held by them.</p>
+<p>This he did, with twenty Dutch and Danish battalions, who had
+only just crossed the river. He then pressed on and seized the mill
+of Royegham, thus cutting the communication between the French at
+Diepenbeck and the troops that still remained on the plateau beyond
+the Norken. Eugene then swung round his right, and, pressing
+forward, surrounded the French on that side, so completely
+enveloping them that his men and those of Overkirk each believed
+the other to be French--for darkness had now fallen--and fought for
+some time before the mistake was discovered.</p>
+<p>As, in such a country, it was impossible to move troops in
+regular formation in the darkness, Marlborough gave orders for the
+troops to halt in the positions they held. Had the light lasted two
+hours longer, the whole of the French army would have been slain or
+captured; but, under cover of darkness, the greater portion made
+their way through the intervals of the allied troops. Many fled to
+Ghent, while thousands made for the French frontier. Vendome lost
+in killed and wounded six thousand men, and nine thousand
+prisoners, and his total loss exceeded twenty thousand; while the
+allies lost five thousand, of whom the great majority were Dutch,
+Danes, and Germans.</p>
+<p>The French troops on the plateau withdrew, under the direction
+of Vendome, in good order; and before morning a large number of
+fugitives had rallied. Marlborough sent forty squadrons of horse in
+pursuit of them, but the French showed so firm an attitude that the
+cavalry were unable to seriously interfere with their retreat.
+Berwick had remained, during the day, near the marshal; and had
+placed his aides-de-camp at his disposal, for the difficulty of the
+ground, and the distance from the plateau of the various points at
+which the troops were engaged, rendered communication much slower
+than it otherwise would have been, and Desmond and his companions
+were frequently sent off with orders.</p>
+<p>It was the first time Desmond had been under fire, and the
+effect of the roar of musketry, the whizzing of bullets, and the
+shouts of the combatants, gave him a much stronger feeling of
+discomfort than he had expected. The roar of cannon was not added
+to the other sounds, for the guns of the day were clumsy and
+difficult to move; and, owing to the rapid marches and
+countermarches of both armies, the greater portion of the artillery
+had been left behind, and only a few guns were on the field, and
+these, in so close and confined a country, were of little use.</p>
+<p>Desmond felt now that he would far rather be fighting in the
+thick of it, with O'Brien's regiment, than making his way alone
+along the lanes, impeded constantly by columns advancing to the
+front, while he was met by a stream of wounded men making their way
+to the rear.</p>
+<p>At first, all was exultation among the troops, for as the
+Hanoverians and Dutch were forced to give way before the assault of
+the main body of the French, shouts of victory rose; and it was
+confidently believed that they would, this day, avenge the two
+great victories Marlborough and Eugene had gained over them.</p>
+<p>Having delivered his orders to the officer in command, Desmond
+rode back. Vendome and Berwick had both dismounted, and were
+standing together, with a few of their staff, at the edge of the
+plateau, examining the field with their telescopes.</p>
+<p>"I have delivered your message, sir," he said, riding up and
+saluting. "The general bade me tell you all was going well. The
+enemy were falling back, and will soon be in full flight."</p>
+<p>"Very well, Mr. Kennedy. By this time, he will have found out
+that he was a little too sanguine."</p>
+<p>The fire had, indeed, for the past few minutes broken out with
+augmented fury. Marlborough had arrived at the threatened point,
+and had placed himself at the head of the Dutch and Hanoverians,
+and, animated by his presence, these had not only ceased to fall
+back, but were in turn advancing.</p>
+<p>"The battle is not won yet, Kennedy," O'Sullivan, who had
+returned a few minutes before from the front, said, as he joined
+him. "On our left we are being driven back, for a large force has
+reinforced the enemy there, and unless our main column defeats the
+allied left, and pushes them into Oudenarde, we shall have night
+coming on before we have finished; and, as our cavalry cannot act
+in these cramped fields, Marlborough will be able to draw off
+without any great loss."</p>
+<p>For an hour, there was no change. Then Berwick, looking round,
+beckoned to Desmond.</p>
+<p>"Mr. Kennedy," he said, "a strong force of the enemy moved, half
+an hour ago, towards their left. I have lost sight of them, owing
+to the high hedges and trees, but it does not seem to me that they
+can have joined in the battle. Our troops are strongly posted at
+Diepenbeck, and should be able to maintain themselves there against
+the whole allied army; but the enemy cannot see our dispositions,
+and would surely have pushed forward and made a desperate assault
+on the village, had they been joined by the strong force I saw
+moving in that direction.</p>
+<p>"It may be that this force has been held in reserve, in case our
+line should be reinforced, and again advance. Marlborough may be
+content to hold his own on his left, while Prince Eugene, who, we
+have heard, commands on their right, turns our flank on that
+side.</p>
+<p>"I wish you to ascertain, if possible, what this force is doing,
+and where it is posted. If you ride across to the mill, on the
+eminence behind Diepenbeck, you may be able to get sight of them;
+or, if the smoke renders it impossible to discover matters from
+that point, ride on to the farther hill, and, descending there on
+the enemy's left, you will be able to make your way close enough to
+ascertain what is going on. You are well mounted, and need not
+greatly fear capture, for they would hardly care to divert a party
+of cavalry in pursuit of a single officer. Still, it is as well not
+to push your horse too hard on your way out, for you may possibly
+need all his strength."</p>
+<p>A minute later, Desmond was cantering his horse down the
+declivity to the Norken. Crossing by the bridge near Mullen, he
+turned to the right and rode up the hill of Royegham. Here a strong
+brigade, composed of cavalry and infantry, under General Grimaldi,
+was stationed. Desmond rode up to him.</p>
+<p>"The Duke of Berwick has sent me to ascertain, sir, the position
+of a strong body of the enemy's troops, whom he observed marching
+from the river towards our right. May I ask if you have noticed
+them?"</p>
+<p>"We saw them move away, after crossing the river, but have not
+seen them since. I should fancy they are engaged in front of
+Diepenbeck; but the ground is so undulating, and the view so
+obscured by smoke, that we have not caught sight of them since they
+issued from Oudenarde--indeed, the hill behind Diepenbeck prevents
+our seeing down into the low land beyond."</p>
+<p>"I will ride on there, sir," Desmond said. "Certainly a better
+view can be obtained than from this side."</p>
+<p>A canter of a mile took him to the summit of the hill at whose
+foot Diepenbeck stood. He could see the masses of French troops,
+gathered in and in front of the village; but beyond that a veil of
+smoke covered the country, and entirely obscured the contending
+parties, whose position could only be guessed by the incessant
+rattle of their musketry fire.</p>
+<p>Turning again, he rode down the dip that separated the hill from
+that of Oycke. He had just gained the crest, when he saw a large
+force marching rapidly towards the mill. Seeing at once the serious
+nature of the movement, he turned and galloped, at full speed, to
+the point where the generals were still watching the progress of
+the fight.</p>
+<p>"I could learn nothing of the force you spoke of from General
+Grimaldi at Royegham, nor on the heights above Diepenbeck; but,
+riding towards Oycke, I saw them advancing at full speed towards
+the windmill, at which they had already almost arrived."</p>
+<p>An exclamation of anger broke from the duke.</p>
+<p>"This is what comes," he muttered, "of placing a fool in command
+of the army."</p>
+<p>Turning away, he at once communicated the news to Vendome, who
+stamped his foot furiously on the ground.</p>
+<p>"Just when victory was in our grasp," he said, and turned his
+glass towards Oycke, which was some four miles distant.</p>
+<p>"I can make them out now," he said. "There is a black mass
+issuing from the village of Oycke, and ascending the hill in the
+direction of Royegham. It is too late to reinforce Grimaldi there.
+They will be upon him before we can cross the Norken. But, at any
+rate, we must send a brigade down to Henhelm, where, with
+Grimaldi's men, they can try to keep open the road from
+Diepenbeck."</p>
+<p>Ten minutes later they could hear, by a sudden outburst of fire,
+that Grimaldi was engaged. The sun had already set, but Berwick was
+able to make out, with his glass, that the left was giving way
+before the attack of Eugene, and that the twenty battalions under
+Argyle, which had hitherto remained inactive, were advancing by the
+main road leading, through Mullen, to the plateau on which they
+stood.</p>
+<p>"The day is lost," Berwick said bitterly. "The troops at
+Diepenbeck are completely cut off. Darkness alone can save them
+from annihilation. And to think that, if it had not been for
+Burgundy, we could have maintained ourselves here against double
+the force of the allies! So long as the system of giving the
+command of armies to royal incapables continues, we cannot hope for
+success."</p>
+<p>Vendome lost no time in issuing orders. The troops still on the
+plateau were brought forward, whence their fire would command its
+approaches. Aides-de-camp were sent in all directions, to order the
+generals of divisions to draw off at once, and to make their way up
+to the plateau; and Berwick's four aides-de-camp were told to make
+their way, if possible, by different routes to Diepenbeck, and to
+give orders for the troops there to maintain themselves, at all
+costs, until darkness had completely fallen; and then to make their
+way as best they could to the plateau; if that was impossible, to
+march for either Ghent or Lille.</p>
+<p>"The service is a desperate one, gentlemen," Berwick said, as he
+turned to give the orders to his officers, "but it is necessary,
+for if the force remain there until morning, they are all
+irretrievably lost. It is getting dark already, and you may,
+therefore, hope to pass unnoticed between the intervals of the
+enemy. If you get there safely, do not try to return at once, but,
+like the rest, endeavour to make off during the night."</p>
+<p>Without waiting for orders, Mike followed his master. Going
+down, they met the remnants of Biron's division flying in disorder.
+They separated at the bridge of Mullen, and, with a word of adieu
+to his comrades, Desmond turned to the right, and rode for
+Groenvelde.</p>
+<p>Suddenly, a volley of musketry was fired from the hill to the
+right. Desmond staggered for a moment in the saddle, and the bridle
+fell from his left hand. Mike was by his side in a moment.</p>
+<p>"Where are you hurt, master?"</p>
+<p>"In the left wrist, I fancy. By the way the hand hangs down, it
+must have smashed both bones. However, there is no time to wait,
+now. It is a matter of life and death to get to Diepenbeck."</p>
+<p>"One moment, your honour. Let me put your hand into the breast
+of your coatee; then, if you keep your elbow tight against your
+body, it will keep it steady."</p>
+<p>Although Mike carried out his suggestion as gently as he could,
+Desmond almost fainted with pain.</p>
+<p>"Take a drop of brandy from your flask, master. It won't take
+half a minute, and then we will be off."</p>
+<p>They continued their journey. The rattle of musketry, ahead of
+them, showed that the combat had already commenced close by;
+between either the advancing troops of Argyle, or those who had
+crossed the hill of Royegham; and Grimaldi's brigade, which was
+probably endeavouring to hold them in check, until the troops at
+Diepenbeck came back.</p>
+<p>It was already too dark to distinguish the uniforms, except at a
+distance of a few yards. Dashing on, he saw a dark mass
+ahead--three officers rode out.</p>
+<p>"Who are you, sir?" they shouted.</p>
+<p>"I am carrying a report from the general," he replied, in
+English, and without drawing rein dashed on, passing within twenty
+yards of the column, and reached Diepenbeck without further
+interruption.</p>
+<p>In the centre of the village, the French general was sitting on
+his horse, surrounded by his staff. The combat beyond raged as
+furiously as before. Desmond rode up, and saluted.</p>
+<p>"I am the bearer of orders from Marshal Vendome, sir," he said.
+"He bid me tell you that a large force of the enemy has crossed the
+hills of Oycke and Royegham, and is already in your rear, the
+enemy's right overlapping your left; while the whole British
+reserve is pressing forward, and will ere long effect a junction
+with both these forces. Your retreat, therefore, is entirely cut
+off. The orders are that you shall maintain yourself here as long
+as possible, as in the darkness and confusion, it is unlikely that
+the allies can attack you from the rear before morning.</p>
+<p>"The marshal himself holds the plateau, and will continue to do
+so. You are to make your way tonight, if possible, in battalions
+and in good order, through the intervals between the various
+divisions of the enemy; or, if that is not possible, singly. All
+are to endeavour to join him on the plateau. Those who cannot do
+this are to make for Ghent or Lille."</p>
+<p>"Your order scarcely comes as a surprise, sir," the general said
+bitterly. "We have heard firing in our rear for some time, and we
+were afraid that things had gone badly with us, after all."</p>
+<p>He at once gave orders that the troops behind the village were
+to take up a position to resist any attack made in that direction.
+Desmond dismounted, as did Mike, and the latter took the two
+horses, fastened them to a tree, and then, with Desmond's scarf,
+bound his arm firmly against his side.</p>
+<p>"We have made a mess of it entirely, your honour," he said, "and
+have got a terrible bating. Sure we were lucky in getting here.
+Faith, I thought we were caught when you were hailed."</p>
+<p>"It was a narrow escape, Mike; and if they had waited till I had
+got a little nearer, and had seen my uniform, I must have
+surrendered."</p>
+<p>"It seems to me that we are like rats in a trap, Mr.
+Kennedy."</p>
+<p>"Something like it, Mike; but it is hard if we can't get through
+them, in the dark."</p>
+<p>"That we will do, sure enough," Mike said confidently; "but
+which way should we go?"</p>
+<p>"That I can't tell you. You see, they are in strength in front,
+Marlborough and Eugene are on the left and partly behind us, and
+the troops you saw come across the hills are somewhere in the rear.
+If it were daylight, not a man of us would escape; but as it is, it
+will be hard if we cannot make our way through.</p>
+<p>"What I am thinking about chiefly, at present, is the safety of
+O'Sullivan, O'Neil, and d'Eyncourt. They ought to have been here as
+soon as we were. They may either have lost their way in the
+darkness, or fallen into the hands of the enemy. However, I shall
+not give them up for another half hour."</p>
+<p>The firing was now abating, and presently died away completely;
+except for a few scattered shots, showing that the allies had been
+halted where they stood, and were no longer pressing forward.
+Another hour passed, and Desmond's comrades were still absent.</p>
+<p>In the meantime, the general had called together the colonels of
+the several regiments, had explained the situation to them, and
+repeated Vendome's orders. The news came like a thunderbolt upon
+them, for the din of firing round the village had completely
+deadened all distant sound, and they were wholly unaware of what
+was passing in other parts of the field.</p>
+<p>"I must leave the matter to your individual discretion," the
+general said. "Those of you who think your men can be relied on,
+can try to escape and join the marshal in a body. Those who have
+not that confidence in their regiments--and indeed some of these
+have been almost annihilated--had best tell them to scatter. Those
+who remain here will assuredly be made prisoners in the
+morning.</p>
+<p>"It is possible that that may be the better plan, for it is
+better to surrender than to be cut to pieces. I therefore leave the
+matter entirely in your hands. I myself shall remain here. We have
+done all that men can do in the way of fighting, and, as I was told
+to hold this place till the last, I shall remain at my post."</p>
+<p>Desmond was present when this conversation took place.</p>
+<p>"We will wait another hour, Mike," he said, as he rejoined his
+follower. "We may be sure that the greater part of the enemy's
+troops will be asleep by that time. They must have made a
+tremendous march, for the news last night was that they were twenty
+miles away; and they have been fighting twelve hours. After such
+work as that, the men will drop down to sleep as soon as they have
+halted."</p>
+<p>"Shall we go on horse or on foot, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"I think the best plan will be to lead our horses, Mike, across
+this country. It would seem natural to do so, and once through
+them, we could then gallop round and join the troops on the
+plateau."</p>
+<p>"I should say, sir, that if I were to steal out to where they
+have been fighting for the last six hours, I might get a couple of
+uniforms to put over our own. They will be lying thick enough
+there, poor chaps. If we had them on, we might pass through any
+troops we might meet, as we both speak English."</p>
+<p>"That is a good idea, Mike, if you can carry it out."</p>
+<p>"Sure I can do that, and without difficulty, your honour. I
+expect the enemy have drawn back a little, so as to be in some sort
+of order if we were to fall upon them in the night; and I know that
+all our men have been recalled. I will fasten the horses to this
+tree, and perhaps your honour will keep an eye on them."</p>
+<p>"I will stay with them, Mike."</p>
+<p>The soldier at once made off. The village was now crowded with
+troops. All order was at an end, and the regiments were
+considerably mixed up. The officers went among them, saying that an
+attempt was going to be made to pass through the enemy, and join
+the force on the plateau. They pointed out that there was at least
+as much hope in being able to do so as in making off singly.</p>
+<p>Many of the soldiers, not having themselves suffered defeat,
+responded to the call; and several bodies, four or five hundred
+strong, marched out into the darkness. The majority, however,
+decided to shift for themselves, and stole away in threes and
+fours. Of those that remained, some broke into the village wine and
+beer shops and drank to stupefaction; while others, exhausted by
+the efforts of the day, threw themselves down and slept.</p>
+<p>Mike was away half an hour.</p>
+<p>"I have got an officer's cloak for you, and a helmet with
+feathers. I think he must have been a staff officer, who was killed
+while delivering his orders. I have got a soldier's overcoat and
+shako for myself."</p>
+<p>"Capital, Mike! Now I think that we can venture, and we will go
+the shortest way. We might very well lose ourselves among these
+hills, if we were to try to make a circuit."</p>
+<p>Having put the Dutch uniforms over their own, they set out,
+taking the way to the left until they came to the main road by
+which the British reserve had advanced. Then they mounted their
+horses.</p>
+<p>"It is no use trying to make our way through the broken ground,
+Mike. There is another road that goes through Huerne. We will
+strike that, and must so get round on the right of the enemy. Even
+if we come upon them, we are not likely to excite suspicion, as we
+shall be on a road leading from Oudenarde.</p>
+<p>"I was noticing that road from the height. It runs into this
+again, near Mullen, and the enemy are not likely to have posted
+themselves so near to the river."</p>
+<p>They rode on through Huerne. The village was full of wounded. No
+one paid them any attention, and they again went on, until suddenly
+they were challenged with the usual "Who comes there?"</p>
+<p>"A staff officer, with despatches," Desmond replied.</p>
+<p>He heard the butt of the soldier's musket drop upon the ground,
+and rode forward.</p>
+<p>"Can you tell me, my man," he said as he reached the sentinel,
+"where the Duke of Marlborough is to be found?"</p>
+<p>"I don't know, sir," the man replied. "Only our regiment is
+here. I know there are a number of cavalry away there on the left,
+and I heard someone say that the duke himself was there. There is a
+crossroad, a hundred yards farther on, which will lead you to
+them."</p>
+<p>Thanking the man, Desmond rode on. A few bivouac fires had been
+lighted, and these were already beginning to burn low, the troops
+having dropped asleep almost as soon as they halted.</p>
+<p>"I hope we shall meet no more of them, Mike," Desmond said, as
+they went on at a brisk trot. "I sha'n't feel quite safe till we
+get to Mullen."</p>
+<p>They met, however, with no further interruption. As they crossed
+the bridge, they halted, took off the borrowed uniforms, threw away
+the headgear and put on their own hats, which they carried under
+their cloaks, and then rode on up the hill, after having first
+satisfied the officer commanding a strong guard placed at the
+bridge that they were friends.</p>
+<p>Another ten minutes, and they were upon the plateau. Desmond had
+no difficulty in finding out where the headquarters were
+established at Hayse, and, riding there, he at once went into the
+house occupied by Berwick, and reported his return.</p>
+<p>"I am glad to see you back again, Kennedy," the duke said,
+heartily. "It is something to have recovered one friend from the
+wreck. Now, what is your news?"</p>
+<p>Desmond related what had happened to him from the time he left,
+and said that a large proportion of the troops at Diepenbeck had
+already left, and, as he heard no outburst of firing, he hoped most
+of them had got safely away.</p>
+<p>"I see you are wounded."</p>
+<p>"I have had my wrist smashed with a musket ball, fired by a
+party on a hill to the right, belonging, I suppose, to the force
+that came up from Oycke."</p>
+<p>"You had a narrow escape of your life," Berwick said. "If you
+had been hit a little farther back, the ball would have gone
+through your body. Sit down at once. I will send for my
+surgeon."</p>
+<p>And he instantly gave orders for the surgeon of the staff to
+come to his tent, and then made Desmond, who was suffering terribly
+from the agony of the wound, drink a tumbler of wine.</p>
+<p>"I know you are all busy, doctor," the duke said, as the surgeon
+entered, "but you must do something for Mr. Kennedy, who is badly
+wounded in the arm."</p>
+<p>The surgeon examined the wound, and shook his head.</p>
+<p>"Both bones are fractured," he said, "and I am afraid that there
+is nothing for it but amputation."</p>
+<p>"Then leave it till tomorrow, doctor," Desmond said faintly.
+"There must be a number of poor fellows who want your attention
+much more than I do."</p>
+<p>"That would do, if I could make you a cradle, but we are badly
+off for all surgical appliances."</p>
+<p>"Could you cut one out of one of my jack boots?"</p>
+<p>"A capital idea, Mr. Kennedy. Nothing could be better. And I
+will put it in operation, at once, with some of my other
+patients."</p>
+<p>"Mr. Kennedy is full of expedients, doctor, and it seems to me
+that this may be really a valuable one. All the cavalry men have
+jack boots, and I will give you an order to requisition as many as
+may be required. The men can get new ones from the stores at
+Ghent."</p>
+<p>The surgeon at once cut off the foot of one of Desmond's boots,
+and then divided the leg longways. "There," he said, taking up one
+of the halves; "you could not wish for a better cradle."</p>
+<p>He took out some lint that he had brought with him, together
+with some flat splints, bound the hand in its proper position, and
+then laid the arm from the elbow to the fingers in the cradle,
+round which he tightly put a few bandages to keep it in
+position.</p>
+<p>"Now for your scarf," he said, and with this made a sling to
+support the arm.</p>
+<p>The whole operation did not take five minutes.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mr. Kennedy, you had best lie down and get what sleep you
+can. I will take the other half of your boot, and the other boot
+also. It will be no use without its fellow. It will make three
+wounded men comparatively comfortable, and I will send for some
+more from the troopers."</p>
+<p>"Yes, lie down at once, Kennedy," Berwick said. "We are going to
+march off at daybreak, and the marshal and I have arranged
+everything between ourselves. You had better try and eat something,
+if it is only a wing of that chicken and a few mouthfuls of meat.
+Your faintness must be due as much to hunger as to your wound, for
+you have been at work since early morning, and cannot have had time
+to eat anything."</p>
+<p>This was indeed the case, and Desmond managed to swallow a few
+mouthfuls, and then lay down upon the sofa, where, in spite of the
+pain of his wound, he presently dozed off, being utterly worn out
+with the work and excitement of the day.</p>
+<p>Before morning, some five thousand of the troops from Diepenbeck
+had marched into the camp, in good order and with their arms, and
+as soon as it was daylight the whole force started for Ghent. With
+deep regret, Desmond had learned from the marshal, before lying
+down, that none of his comrades had returned; and as they had not
+reached Diepenbeck, he felt sure that they were either killed or
+prisoners.</p>
+<p>"D'Eyncourt will, of course, be treated as a prisoner of war;
+but if the identity of O'Sullivan or O'Neil is proved with the
+officers of that name who escaped from Newgate, it is likely to go
+hard with him."</p>
+<p>After repulsing the cavalry sent in pursuit, the army marched
+away unmolested, being joined as they went by large numbers of
+fugitives, who had made their way through the allied lines in small
+parties. Marlborough's army remained on the ground they had won,
+collecting and caring for the wounded of both armies.</p>
+<p>Two days later, Berwick's corps joined Vendome, and that of
+Eugene marched into Marlborough's camp. In spite of the loss that
+he had suffered at Oudenarde, this reinforcement raised Vendome's
+army to over one hundred and ten thousand men, which was about the
+same force as Marlborough had under his command.</p>
+<p>After Eugene had joined him, standing as he did between
+Vendome's army and Paris, Marlborough proposed that the enemy's
+fortresses should be neglected, and that the army should march
+directly on Paris. The movement might have been attended with
+success, but was of so daring a description that even Eugene
+opposed it, while the commanders of the Dutch, Danes, and Prussians
+were unanimously against it; and he consequently decided to lay
+siege to Lille--a tremendous undertaking, for Lille was considered
+the strongest fortress in France, and Vendome, with over a hundred
+thousand men, was within a couple of days' march of it.</p>
+<p>His dispositions were made with extreme care, and a tremendous
+convoy of heavy artillery, ammunition, and provisions was brought
+up from Ostend, without the French being able to interfere with its
+progress. Marlborough, with his British contingent and the
+Hanoverians, was to cover the operations of the siege, which was to
+be undertaken by Prince Eugene with the rest of the allied
+army.</p>
+<p>Vendome marched at once with his army, and, making a circuit,
+placed himself between Lille and Paris, deserting his recent
+conquests in Ypres, Ghent, and Bruges, all of which fell into the
+hands of the allies.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch13" id="Ch13">Chapter 13</a>: Convalescent.</h2>
+<p>Desmond was not present with the French army, for many hours
+after their arrival at Ghent. He suffered intense pain on the ride
+thither, and was then taken to a hospital that had been hastily
+formed for the reception of wounded officers. Here the surgeons had
+agreed that there was nothing for it, but to amputate the arm
+halfway between the wrist and the elbow. The limb was already
+greatly swollen.</p>
+<p>"Under ordinary circumstances," the surgeon said, "we should
+wait until we had reduced the inflammation, but this might be a
+matter of a week or ten days, and there is no time to spare, as the
+army will probably march away in a few days, and travel would
+increase the inflammation to such an extent that your life might be
+sacrificed."</p>
+<p>"I would rather have it taken off at once, doctor," Desmond
+said. "The operation cannot hurt very much more than the arm is
+hurting already, and the sooner it is over, the better."</p>
+<p>Surgery was in its infancy at that time. Anesthetics were
+undreamt of; but the surgeons of the French army had large
+experience, and the operation was very skilfully performed, for the
+time. The stump was then seared with a hot iron.</p>
+<p>"You have stood it well," the surgeon said, for, except when the
+iron was applied to the wound, no groan had issued from Desmond's
+lips. "Now, your servant must keep these dressings continually
+soaked with water, and, in a few days, we may hope that you will be
+able to travel in a waggon without danger."</p>
+<p>When the army marched away a week later, Desmond was placed in a
+waggon, half filled with hay, with several other wounded officers.
+At Arras, where there was a large military hospital, he was kept
+for a few days, and then sent on to Amiens, only the most severe
+cases being retained at Arras, as another engagement might take
+place at any moment, and the resources of the town would be taxed
+to the utmost. He gained strength very slowly, and it was six weeks
+before the surgeons pronounced him to be sufficiently convalescent
+to be moved.</p>
+<p>"It would," they said, "be probably some months before he would
+be fit to return to active service."</p>
+<p>He was sitting, looking listlessly out of the window of the
+chamber that he and three other officers occupied, when Mike came
+in, followed, to Desmond's intense surprise, by Monsieur de la
+Vallee.</p>
+<p>"My dear Desmond," the latter exclaimed, hurrying forward and
+grasping his hand, "you must have thought that we had all forgotten
+you."</p>
+<p>"Indeed, I never thought anything of the kind, Philip. I did not
+suppose that you had ever heard of me, since we parted at
+Moulins."</p>
+<p>"News travels but slowly, but we did hear that fifteen
+subalterns of O'Brien's regiment were captured in the Salisbury. I
+wrote to a friend in Paris, and he told me that you were among the
+number, but that, on making enquiries, he found you had, in some
+manner or other, effected your escape, and that you and two other
+officers had had an audience with the king, and had then gone to
+the northern frontier on the staff of the Duke of Berwick. I wrote
+begging him to get, if possible, a sight of the despatches, and if
+your name appeared, to let us know. Ten days ago, I received a
+letter from him, to say that you had been wounded at Oudenarde. The
+Duke of Berwick had, in his private despatch to the king, mentioned
+your name with very high praise, saying that it was due to you,
+alone, that so many of the troops hemmed in at some village or
+other--I forget its name--managed to make their escape during the
+night, for, although he sent off four aides-de-camp with orders,
+you alone managed to get through the enemy, though wounded by a
+bullet which had caused you the loss of your hand. He said he had
+written to the chief surgeon on Berwick's staff, who was a personal
+friend of his, to ascertain, if possible, where you were. Of
+course, I set out as soon as I received his letter."</p>
+<p>"What! Have you ridden all the way from the south of France to
+come to me, Philip?"</p>
+<p>"Of course I have, and should have ridden all across Europe, if
+it had been necessary. I went round by Pointdexter. The baron is
+laid up with an attack of gout, or he would have accompanied me. He
+sent all sorts of messages, and so did Anne, and the latter
+informed me that I need not show my face at the chateau again,
+until I came accompanied by you. When I reached Paris my friend had
+learned from the surgeon that you were at Amiens, and so, here I
+am.</p>
+<p>"I met your faithful Mike at the gate of the hospital. I was
+glad, indeed, to see that he had come out unharmed from that
+terrible fight. When I told him I had come to take you away, he
+almost cried with joy."</p>
+<p>"It will be the saving of him," he said. "He has been going down
+the hill for the last fortnight, and it is change and good nursing
+he wants."</p>
+<p>"He will get good nursing, I warrant," I said, "and the soft air
+of the south will soon set him up."</p>
+<p>"It is wonderfully kind of you, Philip; but I am sure I am not
+strong enough to ride."</p>
+<p>"No one is thinking of your riding, at present, Desmond. I have
+brought down a horse litter with me, and four of my men, with the
+quietest horses on the estate, and all you have to do is to lie
+down in it, and talk with me whenever you are disposed. You have a
+whole batch of adventures to tell me."</p>
+<p>"I feel better already, Philip. I own that I have been
+downhearted of late, for it seemed to me that I should be an
+invalid for months, and be living in Paris without a friend except
+Mike, for all the regiments of the Brigade are either with Vendome
+or in Spain. The sight of your face, and the thought of your
+kindness, so cheers me that I feel capable of anything."</p>
+<p>"Well, we will start tomorrow morning, Desmond. I shall go at
+once and see the director of the hospital, and get an order for
+your discharge."</p>
+<p>The next morning they set out. Desmond had to be assisted
+downstairs. There he was laid on a litter, packed with soft rugs.
+This was raised and placed between two horses, ridden by two of de
+la Vallee's men. De la Vallee himself took his place by the side of
+the litter, Mike rode on ahead leading Desmond's charger, and the
+other two servants fell to the rear, in readiness to change with
+those bearing the litter, when half the day's journey was done.</p>
+<p>Seeing that the exertion of being moved had exhausted his
+friend, de la Vallee rode for some time in silence. Then, when
+Desmond opened his eyes and smiled at him, he said:</p>
+<p>"I hope you are feeling comfortable?"</p>
+<p>"Perfectly. I hardly feel any motion."</p>
+<p>Every care had been taken to prevent jolting. The poles of the
+litter were unusually long, thus adding to their elasticity. The
+ends passed through leathern loops suspended from the saddle; and
+were, at this point, covered with a thick wrapping of flannel
+bandages, which aided in minimizing the effect of any jar. The
+first day's journey was performed at a walking pace, and they
+reached Beauvais, twenty-five miles being accomplished.</p>
+<p>The fresh air and the slight easy motion were beneficial, and in
+the afternoon, Desmond was able to talk cheerfully with his friend.
+There was, however, no continued conversation, Philip saying he
+would ask no questions about Desmond's doings until he was
+stronger. His story had better be told while sitting quietly in a
+room, where it would not be necessary, as it was on the road, for
+the voice to be raised.</p>
+<p>In the evening, however, after partaking of supper, Desmond,
+without being asked, related the incidents, so far as he knew them,
+of the battle of Oudenarde, and of the manner in which he received
+his wound.</p>
+<p>"The whole disaster was due entirely to the Duke of Burgundy, or
+rather to the king, who placed him in command over two generals of
+the highest skill and reputation. If he had wanted to accompany the
+army, Burgundy should have done so just as our King James did,
+merely as a volunteer.</p>
+<p>"I am told that the king showed great courage in the battle. For
+my part, I think his presence was altogether a mistake. He claims
+that the English are his subjects, and yet he takes part with a
+foreign army in battle against them. His being present will
+certainly not add to his popularity in England."</p>
+<p>"I agree with you," de la Vallee said. "It would have been much
+wiser for him to have abstained, altogether, from interference in
+the matter. It was, of course, a different thing when he attempted
+to land in Scotland. Then he would have been leading the loyal
+portion of his subjects, against those whom he considers rebels
+against his authority. That was quite a different thing from
+acting, without cause or reason, as a volunteer in the French army,
+against those whom he regards as his countrymen and subjects.</p>
+<p>"I am afraid, Desmond, that, though it may shock you to think
+so, these Stuart princes of yours are not wise men. Legitimate
+monarchs of England though they may be, they do not possess the
+qualities that endear kings to their people. From what I have
+heard, James was a heavy pedant, a rank coward, essentially not a
+man to be popular among a spirited people. Charles had a noble
+presence and many fine qualities. But, although his ideas of kingly
+power would have suited us well enough in France, his arbitrary
+measures alienated a large proportion of his people, and brought
+ruin upon him.</p>
+<p>"Your second Charles, in spite of his numerous indiscretions,
+was not unpopular, because the people were wearied of the stern
+repression of Puritan rule, and were therefore disposed to look
+leniently upon his frailties, while they appreciated his good
+temper and wit. His fatal mistake was allying himself so closely
+with us--a grievous mistake, indeed, when we remember that for
+centuries the two nations had been bitterly opposed to each other.
+As for his brother, he forfeited his throne by his leanings towards
+the Catholic Church, in whose communion he died. Decidedly, the
+Stuart kings were not a success.</p>
+<p>"As to James the Third, as you call him, I know nothing beyond
+the fact that he is a protege of the king of France, and has now
+fought against his own people--a blunder, as it seems to me, of the
+worst kind, and one which is certain to alienate many of his
+supporters on the other side of the water. Were he to mount the
+throne, it would be partly due to the aid of French troops and
+French money--men and money, mind you, of a power at war with
+England! He would therefore, necessarily, like Charles the Second,
+be regarded as a protege of France. He would be bound in gratitude
+to Louis, and the position of England would be altogether changed.
+She would become the ally of Spain and France, her ancient enemies;
+and opponent of her present allies, Holland, Austria, Protestant
+Germany, and Denmark."</p>
+<p>Desmond was silent. He could not but agree with what his friend
+said, and had himself considered that it was a most unwise step for
+James to appear in the field, fighting against his countrymen.</p>
+<p>"I don't think I am strong enough to argue, Philip," he said
+with a smile, after a long pause, "and I don't mean to give you a
+victory, when I am fighting under disadvantages. The Stuarts
+certainly never did any special benefit to Ireland, and assuredly
+brought ruin and misery upon us; and at the present moment, I don't
+seem able to explain why we should be so devoted to the cause of
+these Scottish Stuarts, rather than to that of Anne, who is, after
+all, of the same family and race. However, we will fight it out
+when my brain is not so dull as it is at present."</p>
+<p>They slept the next night at Pontoise, having made a somewhat
+short journey, though Desmond protested that he felt quite equal to
+going on to Paris.</p>
+<p>"You are a good deal better today, Desmond, but there is no
+hurry, and we will take matters quietly. If you continue to make
+improvement we shall be able, in another day or two, to travel
+faster; and I hope that, before we get to the end of our journey,
+you will be strong enough to sit your horse for a few miles each
+day."</p>
+<p>They made no stay in Paris, but proceeded on their way, the
+morning after their arrival. Melun and Montargis were their next
+halting places. Desmond was gaining strength rapidly. His good
+spirits were returning, and at their evening halt, he had been able
+to recite the history of his escape from England. His wound had a
+less angry appearance, and on the day of their leaving Montargis
+the horses, at his request, occasionally broke into a trot for a
+mile or two.</p>
+<p>"You are looking paler. I think the motion is too much for you,"
+Philip said after one of these occasions, when they again settled
+down to a walking pace.</p>
+<p>"I feel a bit tired, Philip, but one must make a beginning, and
+I shall never get strong unless I begin to use my muscles. At
+present, I acknowledge I feel as if I had been beaten all over with
+sticks, but I have no doubt that I shall shake this off, after a
+bit."</p>
+<p>This was indeed the case, and on the last three days of their
+journey to Pointdexter, he sat his horse for two or three hours.
+Philip had, on the last day, sent on one of his men to inform the
+baron that he would arrive that evening with Desmond, and as they
+were seen approaching, the baron and his daughter came out from the
+chateau, and welcomed them as they alighted.</p>
+<p>"Do not upset the young fellow by appearing shocked at his
+appearance," the former had said to Anne. "It was certainly a blow,
+this morning, to hear that he had lost his left hand, and that the
+greater portion of the journey had had to be performed in a litter,
+so you must expect to find him greatly pulled down. But see, they
+are breaking into a trot, so he has evidently gained strength on
+the way."</p>
+<p>In spite of the warning, the girl's eyes filled with tears as
+she saw Desmond's thin face and wasted figure, and his left arm in
+a sling.</p>
+<p>"Welcome to Pointdexter, Monsieur Kennedy! Many have entered
+here, since the old chateau was built, but none who have rendered
+such vital service to our race. Do not try to speak. I see that you
+are shaken with your journey. We will soon put that all right."</p>
+<p>"It has been a rather longer journey than we have previously
+made," Desmond said, after dismounting and shaking hands with the
+baron and his daughter, "and we rode somewhat faster than usual, as
+we were both of us anxious to be here. It was good, indeed, of
+Philip to make such a journey to find and bring me to you."</p>
+<p>"If he had not done so, assuredly we should. My foot was so bad,
+with this villainous gout, that I could not put it in a stirrup,
+but we should have had out the family coach. I had half a mind to
+do so as it was, and Anne was most anxious to try her powers of
+nursing, but Philip overruled us, and said that he would be with
+you a week earlier than we could reach you in the coach, and that,
+moreover, he was sure the journey in an open horse litter would be
+far better for you than being jolted in a close carriage. So, as
+usual, he had his own way; though I must say that, for once, Anne
+rebelled strongly against his authority."</p>
+<p>"You are all very good, Baron," Desmond said; "but, indeed, I
+think that Philip was right. I can assure you that the journey has
+done me an immense deal of good, and he will tell you that I am
+very different, now, from what I was when he found me at Amiens,
+for I had begun to think that I should never get away alive."</p>
+<p>"Do not let us stay talking here," the baron said. "Anne has had
+some soup prepared for you, under her own eyes; and that, and a
+glass or two of good Burgundy, will do wonders for you."</p>
+<p>Desmond, indeed, was greatly revived, and was able to join in a
+cheerful conversation with his hosts.</p>
+<p>"We are both dying to hear your adventures," the baron said,
+"and how you managed to escape from that jail in England, as you
+did, and also how it was that we met with that dreadful disaster at
+Oudenarde. It really seems that those terrible fellows, Marlborough
+and Prince Eugene, are invincible."</p>
+<p>"They are good generals, Baron. Beyond troubles with the
+commanders of the forces of their allies, they are able to carry
+out their own plans. The Dukes of Vendome and Berwick are also able
+commanders, but they were hampered by the presence of the Duke of
+Burgundy, who, on several occasions, overruled their opinions and
+ruined their plans. It is to him, alone, that the defeat at
+Oudenarde is due. The French soldiers fought as well as ever, and
+it was the position in which they were placed, and not the superior
+fighting powers of the enemy, that caused their defeat."</p>
+<p>"But how is it," the baron asked, "that with, as I hear, one
+hundred and ten thousand men, Vendome does not raise the siege of
+Lille? It seems incredible that, with so great a force, he should
+remain inactive while the enemy are carrying out their works for
+the siege."</p>
+<p>"That I cannot tell you, sir. We heard all sorts of rumours at
+Amiens, but it seems that Marlborough had taken up a strong
+position, and entrenched himself there with seventy thousand men,
+while Eugene is conducting the siege operations."</p>
+<p>"I don't understand it," the baron said, irritably. "There must
+be more ways of marching to Lille than one. If one road is barred,
+why not advance by another? The Duke of Burgundy is not with the
+army now, so the blame cannot be put on him."</p>
+<p>"No, sir; but Berwick's army is still, as I hear, under his
+independent command, and the duke, excellent soldier as he is, is
+not one to be easily led. If his opinion differs from that of
+Vendome, he would assuredly maintain it; and as his manner is not
+conciliatory, and his opinions are very strongly expressed, it may
+well be that there are, as was rumoured at Amiens, constant
+dissensions between him and Vendome."</p>
+<p>"Well, it seems to me very strange, Monsieur Kennedy, after
+having during the last reign defeated the best infantry of Spain,
+humbled Austria, subdued Bavaria, crushed the enemy in Italy, and
+shown ourselves to be the best soldiers in Europe; that we should
+now suffer defeat after defeat, by an army containing men of half a
+score of nationalities, though led by the greatest general that
+England has ever produced."</p>
+<p>"And, Baron, with English troops under him who have, for
+hundreds of years, shown themselves invincible!"</p>
+<p>"Yes, yes," the baron said, hastily. "We know all about Crecy,
+Poitiers, and Agincourt; and how well they fought in Holland; but I
+thought, Kennedy, that you were the enemy of the English, and were
+here with your brave countrymen to fight against them."</p>
+<p>"Not in my case, assuredly, Baron. I came over here because
+there is no opening for Irish gentlemen at home, and because only
+by the aid of France could our lawful king be placed on the throne.
+It is true that a section of the English people, under Oliver
+Cromwell, not only conquered us, but divided a great portion of our
+land among themselves; and, although we were again defeated by a
+usurping Dutch king, with the Dutch troops under his command, that
+is no reason why I should feel any animosity to the people at
+large, whose qualities I admire, and the majority of whom are, in
+their hearts, attached to the cause of the Stuarts, and hate those
+who are keeping the king from his throne. I own that I would rather
+that it had fallen to my lot to fight for France against Spaniards,
+Germans, and Italians, than against the English."</p>
+<p>"Did you lose many friends at Oudenarde, Monsieur Kennedy?" Anne
+asked.</p>
+<p>"I lost my two greatest friends," Desmond said. "At least, I
+fear that both are dead. They were the two who escaped with me from
+the English prison. They, with Monsieur d'Eyncourt, another of
+Berwick's aides-de-camp, started with me to carry orders to the
+troops, who were all but surrounded by the enemy. We went by
+different roads, to increase the chances of one of us getting
+there.</p>
+<p>"I succeeded with but this comparatively trifling wound," and he
+pointed to his empty sleeve, "but none of the other three got
+through, nor did their names appear when the lists were exchanged
+of the prisoners captured. Therefore, I have no doubt that all fell
+in the performance of their duty. We had been great friends, ever
+since I came out, and their loss has greatly affected me."</p>
+<p>"You are young, and will find fresh friends," the baron said,
+briskly. "Do not let us dwell on the past. You have now to apply
+all your energy to getting strong, and if you show as much vigour
+in that, as in other matters, I hope that in a month's time you
+will be well on the road towards complete recovery."</p>
+<p>"I mean to try hard, Baron," Desmond said, with a smile. "If I
+continue to gain strength as quickly as I have done during the
+journey, I shall certainly insist, before long, on being considered
+convalescent."</p>
+<p>Day by day, indeed, his strength increased. At first he wandered
+about in the park, accompanied by Philip and Anne, for the baron,
+although somewhat recovered from his attack of gout, still walked
+with difficulty. In a week, he again took to horse exercise, and
+was ere long able to join in hunting and hawking parties.</p>
+<p>The house was gay, for the baron, as soon as Desmond was able to
+take his share in conversation, invited many of the neighbouring
+gentry to the chateau, and introduced him to them as the man who
+had done so much for his daughter and himself. Several
+entertainments were given, at which the chateau was thrown open to
+all comers, in honour partly of Desmond and partly of the
+approaching marriage of the baron's daughter to Monsieur de la
+Vallee.</p>
+<p>This had been arranged to take place in September. Before that
+time arrived, Desmond had completely recovered his strength, and
+being now fit for service, was anxious to join. But his friends
+would not hear of his departure until after the marriage; and as
+news came that Lille had been captured by the allies, and it was
+certain that both armies would soon go into winter quarters, and
+would fight no more that year, he allowed himself to be persuaded
+to stay.</p>
+<p>The siege had been one of the most terrible in history. The
+place was nobly defended, and its conquest cost the allies dearly,
+twelve thousand being killed and wounded, and over seven thousand
+succumbing to diseases; while of the garrison, nearly seventeen
+thousand strong, but four thousand five hundred remained alive at
+the time it capitulated. Its fall caused general consternation
+throughout France, for it opened the road to Paris, and during the
+winter Louis made strenuous efforts to obtain peace; but the terms
+demanded by the allies were so onerous that the negotiations were
+broken off.</p>
+<p>In spite of the general distress throughout the country, the
+wedding was a gay one.</p>
+<p>Desmond had written to the Duke of Berwick, who was now in
+Paris, saying that he was fit for duty, and would report himself at
+the end of the month; and, on the day before he was about to leave
+Pointdexter, he received a reply from him.</p>
+<p>It ran as follows:</p>
+<p>Dear Monsieur Kennedy:</p>
+<p>I am heartily glad to hear of your restoration to health. I
+mentioned you to His Majesty today, who was pleased to speak very
+highly of you.</p>
+<p>The campaign is virtually at an end, for the present year. His
+Majesty has informed me that various changes will be made in the
+spring. Marshal de Villars is to replace the Duke of Vendome in the
+command of the northern army. The latter has been unfortunate, and
+misfortune on the part of a soldier is regarded as next door to a
+crime. Certainly the defeat at Oudenarde was not his fault, but had
+he taken my advice, Lille might have been saved. Doubtless he was
+as much dissatisfied with me as I was with him, and perhaps with
+reason; for, as you know, I am not accustomed to mince my phrases.
+However, as His Majesty was pleased to say, it is evident that
+having two generals acting together, each with an independent
+command, is a mistake, and one that should not be again committed.
+Therefore, next spring I am to take the command of an army in
+Dauphiny, and to check the Austrians and Italians.</p>
+<p>He said, "If you can spare him, Duke, I should be glad if you
+would let me have this young Irishman for a time. I shall promote
+him to the rank of captain, for the great service he rendered in
+carrying, as you say, at grievous risk and with the loss of his
+hand, the order to the troops at Diepenbeck to scatter during the
+night, thus saving me at least ten thousand of my soldiers. I shall
+also settle upon him a pension of fifty louis a year, for the loss
+of his hand. I will send him to Spain, having had several
+complaints from the Duke of Orleans" (who, as you know, is now in
+command there) "of the incompetence of many of his staff".</p>
+<p>I said that, although I had found you a most zealous and useful
+officer, and had a warm regard for you, I would of course accede to
+His Majesty's wishes in the matter. Enclosed in this letter is the
+order for you to join the Duke of Orleans, and a private letter
+from myself to the duke, giving a sketch of your services and
+exploits, which will doubtless give you, at once, a place in his
+favour.</p>
+<p>I do not think that this war will last very much longer. France
+is well-nigh ruined by the sacrifices she has made, and the drain
+upon the allies must be almost as great. Therefore, I trust that
+another campaign will bring it to an end. If not, you may be
+assured that when the duke no longer requires your services--and it
+is probable that, after a year's campaigning, he will be heartily
+tired with the difficulties that he, as I did, will meet with from
+the procrastination and general stupidity of the Spanish--you will
+be free to return to me, and I shall be glad to number you again
+among the members of my staff.</p>
+<p>Desmond was sorry to leave the service of the duke, but consoled
+himself with the hope that it would be only temporary; and the
+prospect of a year's campaigning, in a new country, was by no means
+displeasing to him. Therefore, after writing a suitable letter to
+the duke, he took leave of the Baron Pointdexter, with many thanks
+for his kindness, and, attended by Mike, started for Spain.</p>
+<p>"It's glad I am to be on the move again, Captain Kennedy," the
+soldier said, as they rode away. "Sure, your honour, idleness is
+not good for a man, especially when he has lashings of the best of
+food and drink. When I came to buckle on my sword belt, this
+morning, I found it would not meet within three inches, and the
+coatee is so tight that I feel as if I was suffocated."</p>
+<p>"You will soon work it down again, Mike. From what I hear of
+Spain, there is no fear of your getting too much food there. Rough
+work and small rations are, I hear, the rule."</p>
+<p>"I am ready for a good spell then, your honour. I hardly know
+myself now, for I am flabby and short of wind. Still, I am sorry to
+leave the chateau, for I have had the best time I ever had, in my
+life. Everyone was mighty kind, and seemed to think that I had done
+great things in helping to rescue Miss Anne, whereas I did nothing
+at all, except to follow you."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch14" id="Ch14">Chapter 14</a>: A Mission.</h2>
+<p>On arriving at Madrid in the first week in December, 1708,
+Desmond, after putting up at an hotel, and changing the uniform in
+which he travelled for his dress suit, proceeded to the
+headquarters of the Duke of Orleans, and sent in his name, together
+with Berwick's letter of introduction. In a few minutes he was
+shown into his room. The duke looked at him in some surprise.</p>
+<p>"Are you Captain Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"I am, Your Royal Highness."</p>
+<p>"The Duke of Berwick has very strongly recommended you to me,
+saying that you had performed excellent service under him, and that
+he parted with you, with regret, at the express wish of His
+Majesty. He speaks of you as a young officer, but I was hardly
+prepared to see one so youthful. He says that you are devoted to
+your work, active and intelligent as well as brave; and as such
+your arrival is very welcome to me, for although excellent in
+battle, I own that my officers are less devoted to the hard work
+and detail that are as necessary as bravery on a general's
+staff.</p>
+<p>"By the way, I seem to have heard your name before. Let me see,
+it was in connection, was it not, with that affair of the Marquis
+de Tulle and Baron de Pointdexter's daughter?"</p>
+<p>"I certainly had the good fortune to take part in that affair,
+sir."</p>
+<p>"The king himself was pleased to tell me the details of that
+adventure, and to speak very highly of your courage and energy in
+carrying it out. And so, you are really the hero of that affair? He
+said that you were a young ensign in O'Brien's Irish regiment. You
+have risen rapidly, sir, for it is but eighteen months since it
+took place."</p>
+<p>"His Majesty graciously promoted me to the rank of lieutenant
+when I was appointed by the Duke of Berwick to his staff. I
+obtained my next step after the battle of Oudenarde, for carrying a
+despatch to the force cut off in the village of Diepenbeck, in
+which service I received a wound which resulted in the loss of my
+left hand. I was several weeks in hospital, and then obtained sick
+leave and went down for two months to Baron de Pointdexter, which
+visit resulted in my complete restoration to health. At the end of
+that time the Duke of Berwick, who had also returned from the army,
+was good enough to recommend me to His Majesty, and he thereupon
+promoted me and appointed me to join your staff."</p>
+<p>"If Marshal Berwick spoke approvingly of your conduct, Captain
+Kennedy, it is in itself a sufficient recommendation, for the duke
+is not easily satisfied. I am sure that I shall find you a valuable
+acquisition to my staff."</p>
+<p>The duke invited Desmond to dine with him that evening, and
+presented him to several of his staff who were among the company.
+These were, for the most part, personal friends and associates of
+the duke; gallant gentlemen, but wholly ignorant of war, and
+adverse to hard work, and it was not long before Desmond found that
+his services were called into requisition whenever it was necessary
+that a despatch should be carried to a distance. He was by no means
+sorry that this should be the case, for he soon tired of the
+stiffness and ceremony of the Spanish Court, and of the
+conversation (chiefly relating to ladies in Paris, whose very names
+were unknown to him) among the French officers, and it was a relief
+to him, indeed, when he could get away from attendance at
+headquarters, and enjoy an evening's talk with the officers of one
+or other of the four Irish regiments there.</p>
+<p>Many of these expeditions were attended by considerable danger,
+for the wars that had for some years devastated the country had
+resulted in general disorder. Armed bands, under the pretence of
+acting in the interest of one claimant or other to the throne,
+traversed the country, pillaging the villages, driving off flocks
+and herds to the mountains, and ruthlessly slaying any who ventured
+to offer the smallest opposition. Catalonia and Valencia had been
+the scene of the greater portion of the conflicts between the rival
+claimants. Throughout the rest of the country the population looked
+on apathetically at the struggle for mastery, caring but little
+which of the two foreign princes reigned over them; but, in the
+out-of-the-way districts, the wilder spirits left their homes in
+numbers, enticed by the prospects of plunder, under the leading of
+one or other of the partisan chiefs.</p>
+<p>Desmond had, from the moment of his arrival, spent the greater
+portion of his spare time in the study of Spanish, and, aided much
+by his knowledge of French, had made rapid progress, and in three
+months was able to converse fairly in it. It was, indeed, essential
+for his work, as without it he could not have made his way about,
+and safely delivered the orders of which he was the bearer.</p>
+<p>In the beginning of March, the duke sent for him.</p>
+<p>"I have been greatly pleased, Captain Kennedy, with the activity
+that you have displayed, and am going to make a further call upon
+you. This mission is of greater importance than any on which you
+have hitherto been engaged, and is one which, ordinarily, would be
+entrusted to an officer of higher rank; but I feel that I cannot do
+better than place it in your hands. From what we learn, I believe
+that it is the intention of the enemy to commence the campaign by
+crossing the frontier, near Badajos. By so doing, they can either
+follow the valley of the Guadiana to the sources of the river, and
+then come down into Valencia; or they could cross the sierras, come
+down into the valley of the Tagus, and march on Madrid.</p>
+<p>"In the first place, I wish a report as to the state of the
+fortifications of Badajos, and the efficiency of its garrison. I
+am, of course, acquainted with the official reports, sent by the
+Spanish commander of the town to his Government, but I have come to
+place no faith whatever in Spanish reports, which, for the most
+part, are a tissue of falsehoods. Your first duty, then, will be to
+give me as complete a report as possible of the state of things
+there; of your impressions of the capacity of the governor, as
+shown by his preparations; also of the morale of the troops. In the
+next place, I shall be glad of any information you can gather of
+the country beyond the frontier, and the state of the roads in all
+that neighbourhood. Here, again, the native reports are absolutely
+untrustworthy. The line of the enemy's advance would be either
+direct from Lisbon through Vicosa, or up the Tagus, which offers
+them great facilities for carriage, and down through Portalegre and
+Alvas.</p>
+<p>"During the past four years, there has been a good deal of
+fighting near the frontier, but the reports of the officers
+commanding the Spanish forces there are devoid of any practical
+information as to the roads on our side of the boundary. As it has
+been resolved to give the enemy battle, as soon as he crosses the
+frontier, it is most important that I should know the best lines by
+which troops can move, the state of the bridges, and the positions
+in which a battle on a large scale can best be fought.</p>
+<p>"You see, the mission is an important one, and I selected you
+for it as a proof of the confidence I feel in your ability. While
+carrying out this duty you shall have the temporary rank of major,
+as it will less ruffle the susceptibility of the Spaniards, if an
+officer of that rank be employed, than if a captain be sent to
+institute such enquiries.</p>
+<p>"You will, of course, be provided with a letter to the Governor
+of Badajos, couched in such terms that he will not consider your
+mission has any reference to himself, its object being to discover
+whether the magazines at Badajos are sufficiently well supplied to
+admit of their being, if necessary, drawn upon for the subsistence
+of the army; also, whether the garrison needs strengthening, in
+case the enemy should lay siege to the town before our army is at
+hand to give battle. Thus you will ostensibly confine your
+enquiries to the amount of provisions and ammunition, and consult
+the governor as to whether he considers the force at his disposal
+sufficient for the defence of the fortress against a vigorous
+attack. Fortunately, the Spanish methods are so slow that, before
+you get these particulars, you will have ample time to ascertain
+the points as to which I am chiefly concerned.</p>
+<p>"You will be furnished with a native guide, well acquainted with
+the passes of the sierras between the Tagus and the Guadiana. This
+part of your journey will not be unattended with danger, for the
+mountains swarm with bands of partisans; that is to say, bandits. I
+shall, however, give you an order, to the officer in command of the
+garrison at Toledo, to furnish you with an escort of ten troopers
+under an officer, to conduct you across the mountains. Four of
+these will accompany you to Badajos, and remain with you until you
+return to Toledo. Once in the valley of the Guadiana, you should
+have little chance of falling in with any bands of guerrillas, but
+an escort will add to your weight and importance in the eyes of the
+Spaniards."</p>
+<p>"I feel greatly honoured, Your Royal Highness, by your selecting
+me for the mission, and will carry it out to the best of my
+ability."</p>
+<p>"In an hour the papers will be ready for you, and you can start
+at daybreak tomorrow."</p>
+<p>"We are going on a long trip this time, Mike."</p>
+<p>"Back to France, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"No; we are going to the western frontier, by Badajos."</p>
+<p>"It makes no difference to me, sir, where we are going; but, in
+truth, I shall be glad to go anywhere, for I am mightily sick of
+this town, where the people have no great love for the French, and
+the best part of them seem to look down upon us soldiers, as if we
+were dirt under their feet. It is unsafe to go through the streets
+alone at night. A score of men have, since we came here, been found
+lying dead with a knife between their ribs."</p>
+<p>"Yes; the population here is very much divided, Mike, and even
+those who are favourable to Philip have no love for the foreign
+soldiers whose bayonets keep him on the throne. The duke has, many
+times, made formal complaints to the king and the city authorities.
+Philip has given strict orders for the arrest of bad characters,
+but the city civil authorities protest that they cannot lay hands
+upon them, and I believe have never taken the slightest trouble to
+do so."</p>
+<p>"How long shall we be away, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"I should say, a month. I am to have temporary rank as major,
+while engaged on this business. Anyone under that grade would
+receive but little courtesy from the Spaniards."</p>
+<p>"They are a mighty haughty lot," Mike grumbled. "I believe they
+think that, when the flood came, the Spanish grandees had an ark
+all to themselves, as they could not be expected to put up with a
+conveyance full of animals."</p>
+<p>Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"They haven't yet taken in the fact that Spain is no longer the
+great power she was when she was mistress of half of Europe. They
+were fine fighters then, Mike. For my part, I own that I cannot
+understand how it is they have fallen off in that respect; for
+certainly, without our troops, they would make but a poor stand
+against the Portuguese, backed up by the English and Dutch."</p>
+<p>"I have not seen them fighting yet, sir, but to my mind people
+so fond of using their knives are not likely to be of much account,
+when it comes to manly, straightforward fighting.</p>
+<p>"Well, your honour, if you are to go as a major, you will need
+some slight alterations in your uniform--more gold lace, and such
+like. So I had best see about it, at once."</p>
+<p>"I did not think of that, Mike; but you are right. I don't know
+whether, as I only hold temporary rank, I have a right to wear the
+uniform of a field officer; but, as the duke wishes me to be able
+to speak with some authority, there can be no harm in making the
+change, and the additions can easily be taken off, upon my
+return."</p>
+<p>"The duke ought to have given you the full rank, instead of the
+temporary one, sir. You have done more work, since you came here,
+than all the colonels and majors on his staff."</p>
+<p>"As far as work goes that may be so, Mike; but as the work
+consisted in carrying despatches about on horseback, it certainly
+affords no claim for promotion. And, indeed, I have no wish
+whatever for it. I am already the youngest captain in the service,
+except the young nobles who got their commissions as colonels,
+without even serving a day in inferior rank. I feel uncomfortable
+now when I go to our regiments, to see men who have been years in
+the service, and gone through many a desperate action, still
+lieutenants; while I, after two years' service, and still under
+nineteen, am a captain."</p>
+<p>"Yes, sir; but you know that you saved eight or ten thousand men
+to France at Oudenarde, and you lost a hand in the service of the
+country. That would count for a great deal."</p>
+<p>"It counts for something, no doubt, Mike, but many of these
+officers have risked their lives a score of times, and been wounded
+frequently, though they may not have lost a limb."</p>
+<p>"Ah well, sir!" Mike said, philosophically, "Luck is everything.
+And who would go soldiering, if it was not so? When going into
+battle, everyone knows that a lot of his comrades will be killed,
+but he trusts to his luck to get through safely. One man gets
+promoted and another doesn't, and he hopes that luck will come his
+way next time. I don't say that your honour's promotion has been
+luck, but you have had luck in being on the staff of the Duke of
+Berwick, and everyone knows that it is the staff officers who get
+the credit and promotion, while the men who do most of the fighting
+get passed over. There would be nothing to say against that if, as
+in your honour's case, a man was chosen for the staff because he
+had done something that showed that he was fit for it. But it isn't
+so here. If a man belongs to a good family, and has interest, he
+gets a good appointment; and it is mighty seldom that a man is
+taken from his regiment, and put on to the staff, because he has
+done something which showed he was a good soldier."</p>
+<p>"That is so, Mike. There is no denying it. And I believe it is
+one reason why so many disasters have befallen the French army. The
+generals are, as a rule, good, and the soldiers are excellent, but
+the staff are generally altogether incompetent, and seem to
+consider that the fact that they are nobles renders it unnecessary
+for them to give attention to details, or to be more than
+ornamental figures in the general's train. And when we see the
+authority of Vendome overruled by a young prince, who is grandson
+of the king, and nothing else, one must not be surprised that it is
+the same all through the army."</p>
+<p>That evening, Desmond received a packet containing his
+appointment as major while on special service, details of
+instructions as to the points to be attended to, and letters from
+the duke to the commandant of the garrison at Toledo, and from
+Philip to the Governor at Badajos.</p>
+<p>The next morning he started at daybreak, accompanied by Mike,
+and arrived that evening at Toledo. Here he presented his letter to
+the commandant.</p>
+<p>"Very well, sir," the officer said, when he had read it. "At
+what hour do you wish the escort and guide to be ready in the
+morning?"</p>
+<p>"I should like to start as early as possible, Colonel. I myself,
+being well mounted, might cross the sierra in a day; but the
+troopers' horses could not do that."</p>
+<p>"You would not gain anything if they could, Major Kennedy, for
+even if your horse could carry you over sixty or seventy miles of
+mountain roads in a day, you would certainly need a couple of days'
+rest before proceeding farther. If you get as far as Enmedio, which
+is in the heart of the sierra, you will have done well. You will
+then have another long day's ride down to Ciudad Real, from which
+place the officer with six of the troopers will return. The general
+says nothing about a noncommissioned officer, but I shall take it
+upon myself to send one to accompany you, with the four men. It
+will take a good deal of trouble off your hands."</p>
+<p>"I am much obliged to you, Colonel."</p>
+<p>"Now that we have finished business," the officer said, "we can
+talk of other things. You will, of course, put up here. I have two
+or three spare rooms, and the accommodation at the inns is
+wretched. I am always very glad when an officer rides through,
+because we hear little enough about what is passing, and as there
+is no sort of sociability among the Spaniards, life is very dull
+here, and one is very glad of the change."</p>
+<p>"Thank you, Colonel. I will gladly accept your invitation."</p>
+<p>The colonel rang a bell, and ordered a servitor, who answered,
+to show Major Kennedy's servant where to put up his master's horses
+and his own, to bring up the officer's valises, and to make the
+soldier comfortable below.</p>
+<p>"We shall sup in half an hour," he said to Desmond, when the man
+had left. "Two of my majors are going to share the meal."</p>
+<p>As soon as the valises were brought up, Desmond changed his
+uniform, got rid of the dust of the road, and was just ready when a
+servant knocked at the door and said that the supper was served.
+The meal was a pleasant one. The three French officers were anxious
+to hear the last news that had reached Madrid from France. The
+conversation did not flag for a moment during the meal.</p>
+<p>After this was over, and cigars were lighted--for the officers
+had all adopted the custom of the country--the colonel said
+courteously, "Would you mind telling us, Major Kennedy, how it is
+that you, who by your name are Irish, although you speak excellent
+French, have made your way so rapidly as to be already a
+major?"</p>
+<p>"Not at all, Colonel. I am, myself, as much surprised at it as
+you may be. But, really, my present rank is only temporary. I am
+going down to Badajos, on a special mission for the Duke of
+Orleans, and as he thought that I should be received better were I
+a field officer, instead of captain, he has given me the temporary
+rank of major while so employed.</p>
+<p>"I will briefly tell you how I obtained the other steps. The
+first was given me, by the king, on my appointment as aide-de-camp
+to the Duke of Berwick; His Majesty being good enough to take an
+interest in me, owing to a little adventure in which I had become
+involved. It concerned, I may say, the almost accidental rescue of
+a lady, who had been carried off by a nobleman of the court."</p>
+<p>"I remember now," the colonel said. "The lady was Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter, and her abductor Vicomte de Tulle. It happened a
+month or so before our regiment left Paris for Spain, and was the
+chief topic of talk. I recall your name, now, in connection with
+the affair, and how warmly everyone spoke of your gallantry. Well,
+Major, how did you gain your next step?"</p>
+<p>"I had the good fortune to be the only one who survived, of four
+aides-de-camp who were sent off by the Duke of Berwick, at
+Oudenarde, to make their way through the allied lines with orders,
+to the division cut off from the rest of the army in the village of
+Diepenbeck, to disperse and make off across the country, as best
+they could. My comrades were all killed, but I was lucky enough to
+succeed in reaching the village uninjured, with the exception of a
+ball in the wrist, which caused the loss of my hand, and, I may
+say, almost of my life. It was because of the favourable report,
+which the duke was pleased to make of this service, that I received
+my rank as captain."</p>
+<p>"It was well earned, too, sir," the colonel said warmly. "I
+confess, I thought when you arrived that, although Irish by name,
+you must have had some very powerful influence at your back to have
+risen so early. Unhappily, promotion often bears no relation
+whatever to merit; and one sees young nobles, with no other
+recommendation than that of their birth, placed over the heads of
+officers of five-and-twenty years service. No one is jealous of a
+man who owes his rise to brilliant deeds of courage, or signal
+ability; but it is galling to see these young popinjays thrust
+forward, simply by family influence."</p>
+<p>In passing over the hills the next day, a large party of armed
+men made their appearance, suddenly, on a height above; but, seeing
+that an attack was likely to meet with a stout resistance, and as
+little booty would be obtainable, they did not interfere with their
+passage. Desmond congratulated himself on having an escort, for it
+would have gone hard with him, had he been accompanied only by
+Mike.</p>
+<p>On the fifth day after leaving Madrid he arrived at Badajos,
+with the sergeant, the four troopers, and Mike. After some
+formalities--for the town, being close to the frontier, was liable
+at any moment to be suddenly attacked--Desmond was conducted to the
+governor, a pompous Spanish officer.</p>
+<p>"Are you yourself Major Kennedy?" he asked, looking with some
+surprise at his young visitor.</p>
+<p>"My name is Kennedy, sir, and I have the honour of being major,
+and to serve on the staff of his grace, the Duke of Orleans. I am
+the bearer of a letter to you from His Majesty, King Philip."</p>
+<p>The Spaniard took the letter and read it, and Desmond could see,
+by the expression of his countenance, that he was by no means
+pleased.</p>
+<p>"I do not understand," he said coldly, "why an officer should
+have been specially despatched to obtain information which I have
+already duly furnished."</p>
+<p>"I understood from the Duke of Orleans, sir, that as news has
+been received that the enemy's plans were to cross the frontier
+near this town, it became a matter of special importance to see
+that it was sufficiently supplied with provisions, and munitions of
+war to stand a siege. It has been found more than once that, owing
+to the culpable neglect of subordinates, fortresses when besieged
+were by no means so well supplied with provisions, powder and shot,
+as had been supposed. Naturally, the governor of a fortress like
+this, with a considerable garrison, is too much occupied to
+personally superintend all these matters, and must leave them in
+the hands of his subordinates, who on their part commit them to
+those of sergeants and storekeepers; so that, while everything is
+reported to be ready, there are really deficiencies. A waste often
+takes place in the distribution of stores, and the matter was so
+important that the king requested the duke to send one of his staff
+to give you every assistance, and to receive your suggestions,
+which will be complied with to their full extent. As your last
+report was sent in some three months back, necessarily considerable
+changes have taken place, in that time."</p>
+<p>"Well, sir, I will obey His Majesty's orders, and give you every
+facility. My officers shall be instructed to open such magazines as
+you may select, and you will be then able personally to judge as to
+the quantity and condition of the stores. It will, of course, be
+impossible, unless with an immense expenditure of labour, to go
+through the whole of the magazines and to reckon up their contents;
+but as many as you wish shall be opened, and a party of soldiers
+told off to count the bales and cases."</p>
+<p>"A very few will suffice, sir. Of course, in the event of a
+battle being fought and a reverse occurring, the enemy might sit
+down before your town. You would be exposed to a long siege, for it
+might be some time before the army was again in a position to
+advance and fight another battle, or raise the siege. I have little
+doubt that everything will be found in excellent order, but should
+there be any deficiencies, the duke assured me that they would be
+at once made good."</p>
+<p>"If you will call tomorrow morning, sir," the governor said, "I
+will have some of the officials, in whose charge these matters are,
+placed at your disposal; but I am convinced that you will find that
+my reports on the stores and ammunition in hand are fully borne
+out."</p>
+<p>"The governor is, as I expected, a good deal put out, Mike,"
+Desmond said as he rejoined his follower, who was waiting outside
+with the horses. "Now, let us find out the best hotel."</p>
+<p>"Didn't he ask you to stay with him, your honour?" Mike asked in
+surprise.</p>
+<p>"No. He is much too grand a man for that, and besides, he may
+have his wife and children with him; and however much a Spaniard
+may place his house and all within it at your service, it is very
+seldom that he invites a stranger to enter it. Moreover, glad as
+they may be to have French help in fighting their battles, they
+look with suspicion and dislike upon an individual Frenchman.</p>
+<p>"Besides, I fancy I shall find that these stores and magazines
+by no means tally with the report sent in by the governor. I heard
+the Duke of Berwick one day speaking about it, and he said there
+was corruption and dishonesty among their officials, from the
+highest to the lowest. It is probable that both the king and the
+Duke of Orleans have the same opinion, and that it was for this
+reason that they sent me here, in order to assure them that the
+fortress is as well supplied as has been stated. With the other
+papers, I have received a copy of the governor's report, although I
+did not think it necessary to tell him so."</p>
+<p>The next morning, on going to the governor's, Desmond found a
+number of officials assembled there.</p>
+<p>"These are the officers in charge of the stores and magazines,"
+the governor said. "Colonel Mendez will accompany you, and will see
+that everything is done to facilitate your examination."</p>
+<p>The governor bowed formally. Desmond returned his salute, and
+then went down with the Spanish colonel, the other officials
+following. He saw that there was an expression of malicious
+pleasure in the colonel's face, and guessed that he was, by no
+means, sorry at the investigation that was to take place.</p>
+<p>"I think, sir," Desmond said, "that it will not be necessary for
+us to have all these officials going round with us. It will be
+impossible, in one day, to do more than examine one department. As
+ammunition is the most important of all stores, I would suggest
+that we take only those in charge of the war material."</p>
+<p>"Very good;" and, turning to those behind, he said: "For today,
+all those save the officers in charge of the magazines can be
+relieved from this duty. Their turn will come tomorrow, or next
+day."</p>
+<p>With the exception of five or six, all moved away.</p>
+<p>"We have three magazines in the town," the colonel went on, "so
+as to lessen the chance of our resources being destroyed by a
+single blow. There is the Central magazine, another that is known
+as the San Juan magazine, and the Western magazine."</p>
+<p>"We may as well visit the Central one first, as, no doubt, that
+is the most important one."</p>
+<p>As they went on, a party of twenty soldiers, who had been drawn
+up there, fell in behind, while Mike and two troopers of his escort
+also, at his orders, accompanied them. The magazine was formed in
+what had formerly been an old castle, but which was now used for
+another purpose, that of a store, its thick walls affording
+protection against any but very heavy missiles. On entering what
+had been the courtyard, Desmond saw that the greater portion of it
+was occupied by storehouses, massively built, and covered by some
+five or six feet of earth.</p>
+<p>"The first of these on the right contains musketry ammunition,"
+Colonel Mendez said, "the next two contain cannonballs; powder is
+stored in the three houses at the farther end, and the three on the
+left side contain hand grenades, fuses for mines, signal rockets,
+and other miscellanies, such as brimstone."</p>
+<p>"We will examine number one first," Desmond said. "Which is the
+officer in charge?"</p>
+<p>One of the officials stepped forward, with a key. Desmond saw
+that his face was pale, and that he had a sullen look.</p>
+<p>"I will ask you, before we enter," he said, "how often do you
+take stock of your stores? I suppose when the governor sends in his
+half-yearly report?"</p>
+<p>"We do not do it that way at all," the man said. "I have a book.
+It was given to me by the officer I succeeded. Here it is. You will
+see that he handed over so many barrels of cartridges. On one side
+of the page I put down the number of barrels issued, and on the
+other the number I receive, and thus, at any time, without
+disturbing the contents of the store, I can state the number of
+barrels it contains."</p>
+<p>"Then how long have you held this position, sir?"</p>
+<p>"I have been in charge of this store, and of those used for
+powder in the cellars underneath the castle, for ten years."</p>
+<p>"The man whom you succeeded--how long had he been here?"</p>
+<p>"I believe he had been here for twenty years, or more."</p>
+<p>"And his system of keeping account was the same as yours?"</p>
+<p>"Precisely. He handed his books to me, and I have kept mine in
+the same way."</p>
+<p>"Then it is a fact, if I understand you rightly, that there has
+been no taking of stock for the past thirty years?"</p>
+<p>"It was not necessary," the officer said, in a surly tone.
+"There can be no mistake possible, considering the way in which we
+made our entries."</p>
+<p>They now entered the store. It was some sixty feet long and
+forty feet wide, with pillars of masonry along the centre to
+support the weight of the roof. It was lighted only by small
+loopholes in the thick walls. Four of the soldiers carried
+lanterns, and they were about to enter, when Desmond said:</p>
+<p>"There is no loose powder lying about, I suppose?"</p>
+<p>"None," the officer replied. "The barrels were all carefully
+examined before being taken into the store. They are, as you can
+see, strongly made. A leakage is out of the question, unless by any
+accident one should fall off the pile and burst; but such a thing
+has never happened, as far as I know."</p>
+<p>"I see, by your book, that there should be three thousand four
+hundred and eighty-two barrels, each containing five hundred
+cartridges. Certainly an ample supply, even for a prolonged
+siege."</p>
+<p>The barrels were piled in four tiers, one above another, forming
+a wall on each side of a central path, seven feet wide.</p>
+<p>"Give me your hand, Mike," Desmond said to his follower, and,
+standing upon it, he was able to scramble on to the top.</p>
+<p>"Twelve barrels deep," he said, as he descended. "Now, let us
+count the number in each line."</p>
+<p>The wall of barrels extended only some two-thirds of the length
+of the stores, and there were thirty barrels in each line. He made
+a rapid calculation.</p>
+<p>"That is three thousand two hundred, but I see that, in
+addition, there is a small pile on each side, beyond the others,
+which would about make up the correct total. Your record is
+strictly accurate."</p>
+<p>The official took up the lantern, as if the matter was now
+finished, but Desmond said:</p>
+<p>"No, sir. I have but begun; and my instructions were to see how
+much musket ammunition there was here, at present. I only know how
+many barrels there are.</p>
+<p>"And now, Colonel, I will ask you to call your men in, and set
+them to work. I wish two passages made through each of these piles
+of barrels. Three feet wide will be sufficient."</p>
+<p>"It would be very dangerous to move them," the official said
+hastily.</p>
+<p>"Not if it is carefully done. You tell me the barrels are
+strong, and that there is no leakage. Even if this should not be
+the case, there is little fear of the powder coming in contact with
+the candles in these lanterns; and besides, as the powder is in
+cartridges, it would not leak out even if one of the barrels were
+to burst."</p>
+<p>The soldiers had set to work at four points, chosen at hazard by
+Desmond. The barrels, as they were taken down, were ranged along on
+each side of the central path. When three lines had been cleared
+out, one of the soldiers gave an exclamation.</p>
+<p>"This is lighter than the one I carried out last!" he said.</p>
+<p>"Carry it out into the courtyard," Desmond said. "I should like
+to look at the contents."</p>
+<p>It was taken out to the courtyard, and one end carefully taken
+out.</p>
+<p>"You see, Colonel," Desmond said, as he looked at its contents,
+"you would have been reduced to great straits, long before you
+expected it."</p>
+<p>The colonel, who belonged to the artillery, looked into the
+barrel, which was full of earth.</p>
+<p>"Empty it out!" Desmond ordered.</p>
+<p>They did so. There was not a single cartridge in it.</p>
+<p>"This is scandalous!" the colonel exclaimed. "I did not expect
+that everything would be found right, but I had no idea of such
+villainy as this!"</p>
+<p>He turned to the men.</p>
+<p>"Arrest the commissary, at once," he said.</p>
+<p>But that official was nowhere to be found. He had slipped away,
+as soon as the men began to take down the barrels. Some soldiers
+were at once sent off in search of him.</p>
+<p>"We will continue the work," Desmond said, "and see how
+extensively this fraud has been carried on."</p>
+<p>The same result was met with in each of the openings. The first
+three lines consisted of barrels filled with cartridges; the seven
+lines behind contained nothing but earth.</p>
+<p>"You see, Colonel, instead of having over three thousand two
+hundred barrels of cartridges, you have less than a thousand. It is
+almost beyond belief! It is clear that this fellow, and probably
+the man who was in charge before him, have been in collusion with
+the contractors for these cartridges, and allowed them to send in
+seven barrels of earth for every three of cartridges. No doubt,
+they calculated that there was little chance of the fraud being
+detected--never, indeed, until there was a prolonged siege--for
+they would naturally serve out the barrels from the front row, as
+they were required, filling their places with fresh ones as
+supplies came in."</p>
+<p>The other storehouses were now examined. The number of
+cannonball alone tallied with the account. There were large
+deficiencies in the store of powder, and, indeed, among almost all
+the other munitions.</p>
+<p>"It is infinitely worse than I thought," the colonel said, "and
+I fear that the storekeepers are not the only people concerned in
+these frauds."</p>
+<p>"Now, Colonel, if you do not mind, I should like to go to one of
+the provision stores at once. Possibly, after what we have
+discovered, some pretext to stop further examination may be
+invented, if we wait till tomorrow."</p>
+<p>Great as had been the fraud in the magazines, that in the
+supplies of provisions was even greater. There was a deficiency of
+many hundreds of sacks of flour and beans. The meat stores were
+entirely empty, although they should have contained a large number
+of tierces of salted beef. This was a matter of minor importance,
+for in case of the approach of an enemy, the people of the country
+round would drive their cattle into the town, and, indeed, the
+allowance of meat to a Spanish soldier was so small that he could
+do well without it, existing entirely upon bread and fried beans.
+Of wine there was scarce half the amount indicated. A great number
+of the barrels had been filled only with water.</p>
+<p>It was late in the afternoon when the work ceased.</p>
+<p>"I should require a fortnight," Desmond said, "to get accurate
+figures. This, however, is comparatively unimportant. It is quite
+sufficient to know that in no case is there half the amount, either
+of ammunition or of provisions, given in the governor's last
+report, and that fraud on a large scale has been carried on; and I
+cannot but think that some men, at least, of higher rank than these
+storekeepers must have been privy to the affair."</p>
+<p>"There has certainly been something wrong in the supply of
+clothes, Major Kennedy. My men have had no new ones served out to
+them for the past year and a half, although I have made repeated
+applications during the past two months."</p>
+<p>"Yes; I noticed when I walked about in the town, yesterday, that
+many of the troops were almost in rags, and I have no doubt there
+has been fraud in the clothing department, as well as in all the
+others."</p>
+<p>"Well, sir, as a Spaniard I lament this terrible exposure.
+Blame, however, must not be laid entirely upon the military. The
+supply of provisions of all kinds, of cloth for clothing, and,
+indeed, of everything but guns and ammunition, is in the hands of
+the junta of the province, and of the civil authority here. Many of
+the members must be concerned in the matter, and I have no doubt
+that the officials here are heavily bribed to shut their eyes, and
+to arrange matters so that the frauds may escape attention.</p>
+<p>"I know that once, when I proposed to the governor to examine
+some of the barrels of cartridges as they came in, he answered me
+very sharply, and told me that my business was to work the guns,
+and not to meddle with the duties of the storekeeper."</p>
+<p>"Then do you think, Colonel?--"</p>
+<p>"I think nothing," the officer replied. "The governor is the
+governor, and it is not for me to discuss his conduct in any way,
+nor even to admit the possibility of his knowing of this
+affair."</p>
+<p>Only two or three of the storekeepers had been arrested. The
+rest had slunk away, as soon as they saw how matters were
+going.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch15" id="Ch15">Chapter 15</a>: Treachery.</h2>
+<p>At this moment an officer came down, and said that the governor
+wished to see Colonel Mendez and Major Kennedy, at once. As they
+entered the room, they saw the governor walking up and down in a
+state of great agitation.</p>
+<p>"I hear, Colonel Mendez," he said, stopping before that officer,
+"that you have, on your own authority, placed several of the
+commissariat storekeepers under arrest. What does this mean,
+sir?"</p>
+<p>"It means, sir, that Major Kennedy has discovered enormous
+deficiencies in the stores, and there can be little doubt that a
+number of persons must have been concerned in the matter, besides
+those in charge of the storehouses. Wholesale bribery must have
+been practised, by those who supplied the goods to those whose duty
+it was to receive them."</p>
+<p>"I shall order a commission of enquiry to sit at once, and beg
+that you, Colonel Mendez, will send me in a detailed report of the
+matter, which is, I need hardly say, one of extreme gravity."</p>
+<p>"I was right," Colonel Mendez said, as they left the governor's
+house. "I suspected that something was wrong, ever since he refused
+to allow me access to the magazines. I have no doubt that he has
+been acting in collusion with the contractors, though he may not
+have been aware of the extent of their rascality, for his
+subordinates may not only have accepted bribes from the contractors
+to carry out the frauds to which the governor may have consented,
+but may also have taken money from these to allow of still greater
+ones to be perpetrated."</p>
+<p>"What will he do, do you think, Colonel?"</p>
+<p>"He will endeavour, by every means in his power, to prevent any
+word of your discovery from leaking out. And, if I may advise you,
+I should say it would be well that you should take every precaution
+for your own safety. His position is a desperate one, for one
+cannot doubt that your report will be followed by his removal from
+his post, his dismissal from the army, and the confiscation of
+everything of which he is possessed. Therefore, it is almost a
+matter of life and death to him to prevent your report from being
+sent to headquarters, and to have you removed altogether. This
+done, the facts might not leak out. It would be supposed, at
+Madrid, that you had been stabbed by some street ruffian. And,
+although another officer might be sent down to report, it is by no
+means likely that he would go so rigorously into matters as you
+did, but would be contented merely to count barrels and bales,
+without troubling to investigate their contents."</p>
+<p>"But your evidence would be as strong against him as mine."</p>
+<p>"Yes; but that evidence is not yet given. He can, in the first
+place, and I have no doubt will, suppress my report to him. In the
+second place, he would consider it unlikely that I should venture
+to make the matter public, for he has powerful friends at court. He
+is connected with many of the leading families in the province, and
+might rely upon being able to hush the matter up, so long as it was
+known only to the heads of our army, who are not unaware that,
+although the pay of a commander of a fortress is not more than
+sufficient to maintain his position, they, like most other of our
+officials, generally retire with considerable fortunes. Therefore,
+any interference on my part would be more disastrous to my
+prospects than to his.</p>
+<p>"It is humiliating to say so, Major Kennedy, but both our civil
+and military systems are rotten to the core. There are, of course,
+honest men in both services, but as a rule corruption is almost
+universal. Still, although he cannot fear me as he must fear you,
+it is possible he may endeavour to make himself safe by removing me
+also from his path; and for a time I shall take good care to remain
+in my own barracks, as much as possible."</p>
+<p>"I will be careful also," Desmond said, "and I thank you much
+for the warning, which was needed, for it would never have struck
+me that he would even attempt to suppress the information that I
+have gained; but I see that it will be necessary to be very
+careful, especially in the manner of sending off my reports."</p>
+<p>"If I were in your place, I should mount my horse at once, and
+with the troopers of the escort ride straight for Madrid."</p>
+<p>"I cannot do that, Colonel, for the examination into the state
+of the stores here was only a part of my instructions, and I must,
+if possible, carry these out to the letter before leaving for
+Madrid. I might, however, send off my despatch by two of the
+troopers with me."</p>
+<p>"I think you may take my word for it, Major, that they would
+never reach their destination. Even while we are speaking, a
+messenger may be sent off either to one of these bands in the
+mountains, or to two or three of the contractors--who are, of
+course, as deeply involved as the governor, for there is no doubt
+of their guilt, while no proof can be given to his being a party to
+it--telling them that it is a matter of life and death to them to
+prevent you or your messengers from reaching Madrid."</p>
+<p>"The lookout is certainly far from comfortable," Desmond
+admitted, "and I must, tonight, think it over in every way, and
+decide upon what course I had best pursue."</p>
+<p>When he reached the hotel, he told Mike what Colonel Mendez had
+said.</p>
+<p>"By the powers, your honour, it is a nasty scrape that we seem
+to be in, almost as bad as when you were shut up in that prison in
+London."</p>
+<p>"Worse, Mike; for then we knew that we should be tried, but
+hoped that Louis would interfere in our favour, and by threatening
+reprisals obtain our liberty; whereas here we have only ourselves
+to depend upon, and the blow may come at any moment."</p>
+<p>"Well, at any rate, your honour, we will see that none get at
+you unbeknown. I will lie down in your room against the door, and
+if the sergeant places a man on guard outside, it is hard if anyone
+gets at you."</p>
+<p>"I hardly think the precaution necessary; but there is no saying
+what this man might not do in so desperate a situation, so I will
+tell the sergeant to place a sentry at the door, and to relieve him
+every two hours. I shall think the matter over, and by tomorrow
+morning shall decide whether I had best remain here and complete my
+work, or ride at once to Madrid."</p>
+<p>At about two o'clock in the morning Desmond, who had but just
+dropped off to sleep, was aroused by hearing the sentry outside his
+door challenge. There was no answer. All remained quiet. Mike leapt
+to his feet and opened the door.</p>
+<p>"What is it?" he asked the sentry.</p>
+<p>"I saw two or three men at the end of the corridor. It was too
+dark to make them out clearly. They were coming this way. I
+levelled my carbine and cried, 'Who comes there?' and at once they
+stole away. They could have been after no good, for their steps
+were noiseless, and they must have come up without boots."</p>
+<p>"Keep a sharp lookout, sentry," Desmond said, "and see that they
+don't steal up to you, for if they do, you may be stabbed before
+you have time to turn round.</p>
+<p>"It is lucky that I carried out your suggestion, Mike, and
+posted a sentry at the door. Of course, these men the sentry saw
+may not have been coming here, but at any rate their conduct was
+suspicious."</p>
+<p>In a few minutes Desmond was again asleep. He had had a long
+day's work, and believing that the affair was over, at least for
+the night, he did not even try to keep awake.</p>
+<p>As soon as Mike heard, by his breathing, that he was asleep, he
+got up noiselessly and seated himself near the open window, with a
+loaded pistol. An hour passed, and then he heard a slight stir in
+the street. He did not look out, but grasped his pistol
+tightly.</p>
+<p>Their room was on the first floor. Presently, he heard a grating
+sound against the window. It was very dark, and he knelt down so
+that he would be able to make out any figure that showed above the
+windowsill. He thought first of rousing his master, but as he had
+another pistol in his belt, and his sword leaned against the wall,
+ready to his hand, he thought it better to let matters take their
+course.</p>
+<p>He had heard no further sound, but presently a round object
+appeared in sight. Stretching out his arm, he fired without a
+moment's hesitation. There was a sound of a heavy fall below,
+followed by some muttered exclamations. In a moment, Desmond was on
+his feet, a pistol which he had laid by his pillow in his
+grasp.</p>
+<p>"What is it, Mike?"</p>
+<p>"It is only a gentleman who had a fancy for looking in at the
+window, your honour, and I have no doubt would have come in,
+without saying by your leave, if I had not cut the matter short by
+putting a bullet into his forehead. He had some friends down below.
+He came up on a ladder."</p>
+<p>He looked out of the window.</p>
+<p>"They are taking it down now, your honour. Shall I give them
+another shot?"</p>
+<p>"No, Mike; let them go. The lesson has been good enough."</p>
+<p>The sentry had also run into the room, on hearing the shot.</p>
+<p>"It is all over," Desmond said. "Seeing that you prevented them
+from getting in at the door, they tried the window. Mike has shot
+one of them."</p>
+<p>There was a sound of feet and loud talking in the passage, and
+as Desmond went out, the landlord, two of the serving men, and
+several of those staying at the hotel ran up.</p>
+<p>"What is it, senor? We heard a shot."</p>
+<p>"Yes; a fellow tried to enter my window, by means of a ladder;
+but fortunately my man heard him, and shot him before he came in.
+No doubt it was some prowling marauder, who, seeing my window open,
+thought that there was a chance of plunder."</p>
+<p>"<em>Carrambo</em>!" the landlord exclaimed, "then we shall have
+enquiries, and all sorts of trouble."</p>
+<p>"I don't think you will," Desmond said quietly. "I fancy he had
+some friends down below, and they will probably carry his body and
+the ladder away, and, if you hold your tongues, nothing more will
+be heard of it.</p>
+<p>"Mike, do you and the sentry take a lantern and go down and
+see."</p>
+<p>The landlord looked out of the window.</p>
+<p>"As far as I can see, everything is quiet there," he said. "Are
+you sure that your servant was not dreaming?"</p>
+<p>"That you will soon ascertain, if you go down with him," Desmond
+said. "I fancy that you will find some traces of the affair
+there."</p>
+<p>The landlord, followed by his two servants, went down with the
+soldiers, and then, lighting a lantern and handing it to them, went
+out, keeping carefully behind them.</p>
+<p>"There," Mike said, when he stopped under Desmond's window;
+"does that look like a dream?" and he pointed to a patch of blood
+on the pavement.</p>
+<p>"It is true enough," the landlord said.</p>
+<p>"Pedro and Lopez, fetch pails of water and brooms, and get rid
+of this blood, otherwise we shall be having enquiries made in the
+morning."</p>
+<p>Mike returned to his master, at whose door the sergeant and the
+other troopers were standing.</p>
+<p>"There is no occasion, sergeant," Desmond had just said, "to
+keep a sentry at the door any longer. We can be quite sure that we
+shall not be disturbed again before morning, and indeed, I am not
+likely to sleep after this."</p>
+<p>"Very well, sir; but if you don't mind, I will keep a sentry on
+watch."</p>
+<p>"Just as you like, sergeant, but I feel sure there is no
+occasion for it. Still, after what has happened, it may perhaps be
+wise to do so."</p>
+<p>"Well, Mike," Desmond said, when they were again alone, "the
+campaign has opened with spirit. This is something like that
+journey with the Baron de Pointdexter, when we expected to be
+attacked every minute."</p>
+<p>"Well, we got through that all right, your honour, and it is
+hard if we don't get through this."</p>
+<p>At six o'clock, a volley of musketry was fired.</p>
+<p>"They are practising early, sir," Mike said.</p>
+<p>"It can't be that, Mike. It is too close. They would go beyond
+the outer works to practise, and, by the sound, it is certainly
+much nearer than that, though possibly just outside the walls."</p>
+<p>"I will go out and enquire, your honour. When one is at war, it
+is as well to know exactly what the enemy are doing."</p>
+<p>"Take one of the troopers with you, Mike. Pierre speaks Spanish
+well."</p>
+<p>Mike returned in an hour.</p>
+<p>"They have shot all the prisoners we took yesterday," he said.
+"I hear they held a sort of court martial in the evening, at the
+governor's. It did not sit more than ten minutes. They were all
+found guilty of fraud and treachery, and were shot this
+morning."</p>
+<p>"Worse and worse, Mike! Evidently, the governor is determined to
+get rid of all whose evidence might throw any light on this matter.
+After what has happened here, and these summary executions, I feel
+very uncomfortable as to Colonel Mendez. Will you go to the
+artillery barracks with a message from me that, as I have my first
+report to write out, I shall not continue the investigations today?
+Take Pierre with you again."</p>
+<p>When Mike returned, Desmond saw that his news was bad.</p>
+<p>"The colonel had not been seen when I got there, and his servant
+went up to his room and found him lying dead, stabbed to the
+heart."</p>
+<p>"Another witness gone," Desmond said. "An honourable gentleman,
+and a pleasant one. Well, Mike, the matter becomes more and more
+serious. After this there is but one thing open to me, and that is
+to return to Madrid at once. When I relate the circumstances to the
+duke, he will see that, had I endeavoured to carry out the rest of
+his instructions, the chance of my report ever coming to hand would
+have been slight indeed, and it is all important that he should get
+it.</p>
+<p>"The question is, shall we mount and ride at once, or shall I go
+and take leave of the governor?"</p>
+<p>"Of course, your honour, you can do as you like, but I should
+say that the sooner we are out of this, the better. The longer we
+stay here, the more time he will have to take care we don't get
+back alive.</p>
+<p>"There was another thing I did not tell you, sir. As we went to
+the barracks, we passed some cavalry men talking. They were arguing
+that the enemy must be marching this way, for at two o'clock last
+night ten troopers were suddenly called up and sent off, the gates
+being opened for them by order of the governor."</p>
+<p>"Just what I expected, Mike. He has written to warn the various
+contractors that the frauds have been discovered, and, no doubt,
+telling them that all messengers from here must be stopped and
+searched, and all reports and documents taken from them; that if I
+come myself, I am to be put out of the way; and that if this can be
+done the matter can be hushed up, as he has taken measures to
+silence all those who know anything about the affair.</p>
+<p>"Well, I think you are right. We need not mind saying goodbye to
+this scoundrel, as it would only give him time to perfect his
+arrangements. I have no doubt that he would pretend to be ill, or
+to be engaged in some business that would detain him, and manage to
+keep me waiting some hours before he saw me. Order the sergeant to
+saddle up at once. Let the men eat a meal as quickly as possible,
+and let each put a bottle of wine and a loaf of bread into his
+valise, so that we shall be able to ride without stopping anywhere.
+Say that we shall mount in twenty minutes, and they must not wait
+to polish up their accoutrements. Tell them to put plenty of forage
+before the horses, and not to put the bridles in their mouths until
+the last thing. Let each pour four or five feeds of corn into his
+forage bag.</p>
+<p>"When you have given the orders, have your own breakfast. I will
+go downstairs and get something there. I packed my valises while
+you were away."</p>
+<p>Exactly twenty minutes later the little troop started. The men
+had, at Desmond's orders, loaded their pistols and short guns.
+Avoiding the principal streets, they rode by narrow lanes until
+they emerged close to the eastern gate. Through this he and his
+followers rode, without question, at a quiet pace until beyond the
+exterior fortifications, across the bridge over the Guadiana, and
+then broke into a canter.</p>
+<p>The sergeant and men were not a little surprised at the sudden
+departure, for they had supposed that they would remain for some
+time at Badajos. Desmond called the sergeant up to his side.</p>
+<p>"I dare say you are surprised at this sudden move, but you know
+that two attempts were made upon my life last night, and I have no
+doubt that these would be repeated, and perhaps with greater
+success, had I stayed there. You were present yesterday, with two
+of your men, when we discovered that large portions of the stores
+were mere dummies filled with earth. Whether or not the governor
+was a party to the fraud I cannot say, but this morning he had all
+the storekeepers who were arrested shot, and Colonel Mendez, who
+was present at the investigation, was murdered during the night. It
+is evident, therefore, that many people are interested in
+preventing the discovery we made from getting known. Of course, the
+soldiers who assisted would be aware of it, but they would not
+venture to speak, and it is only I and your men and my servant who
+have still to be silenced.</p>
+<p>"I tell you this, in order that you may impress upon the men the
+necessity for the greatest vigilance, such as they would use if
+travelling through an enemy's country. Messengers were, I hear,
+sent off yesterday evening in various directions, and I have no
+doubt that these were to the various contractors concerned in the
+plot, urging upon them the necessity of preventing the news from
+reaching Madrid; and perhaps to some of the robber bands in the
+sierra. Therefore, instead of keeping the main road up the valley,
+we will ride by country tracks and avoid all large towns. We will
+not put up anywhere, but will bivouac in the open. In this way I
+hope that we shall yet avoid any parties of men who may be lying in
+wait for us.</p>
+<p>"The most dangerous part of the journey will, of course, be the
+passage of the mountains. We must there travel by one or other of
+the roads through the defiles, and it is possible all these may be
+watched. If we are attacked, we must endeavour to ride through
+them. If this is impossible, we will sell our lives as dearly as we
+can."</p>
+<p>"You may trust us for that, Major," the sergeant said. "I have
+no love for these Spaniards, and we are all discontented at being
+kept down here to fight the King of Spain's battles, instead of
+being up in the north, where every man is wanted to prevent the
+enemy marching to Paris."</p>
+<p>They struck off from the road when nearing Merida, and followed
+a country track until they came upon the road between that town and
+Torre Mocha. Avoiding the latter place, they took the road to
+Truxillo, and, late in the afternoon, approached that town and
+halted in a wood two miles distant from it.</p>
+<p>Here Desmond consulted his map. There were two roads from
+Truxillo. Crossing the sierra, the main and shorter road came down
+upon the Tagus at Almarez. The other passed through Deleytoza, and
+came down upon the bridge at Condo. Beyond Deleytoza it appeared to
+be a mere mule track.</p>
+<p>"If there are any parties watching," he said to Mike, "they will
+expect that my messenger, or I myself, will travel by the main road
+to Almarez, for not only is it better, but it is shorter. But
+again, they might think that, if I suspected we might be attacked,
+I should take the road through Deleytoza, and would, at any rate,
+make matters safe by watching both roads. It is a difficult
+question which to choose."</p>
+<p>"Well, your honour, if you have got to fight, it would be best
+to do so on a good road. Our horses would be of no use to us, if we
+were going single file along a bad road; while on a good road we
+could charge the spalpeens, and cut our way through."</p>
+<p>"You are quite right, Mike, and we will take the main road. They
+will not be mounted, and I don't think they would stand before a
+charge of seven men; but they may shoot some of us as we come down
+upon them.</p>
+<p>"See here, Mike, this is my report that I wrote out yesterday
+evening;" and he took a packet from the inside of his coat. "When
+we start tomorrow morning I shall put it in my left holster. If I
+am shot, you will not wait for a moment, but will snatch it out and
+ride on to Madrid, and deliver it to the duke there. I have, this
+morning, added a few lines relating the murder of Colonel Mendez,
+the hurried trial and execution of the storekeepers, and the
+attempts upon my life, and said I have not the least doubt that the
+governor is at the bottom of it all."</p>
+<p>"If your honour is killed, I will carry out your orders, but if
+it is only wounded you are, I will try to take you off with
+me."</p>
+<p>"You must do as I order you."</p>
+<p>"I obey your honour's orders when they are reasonable," Mike
+said doggedly; "but leave you behind, to have your throat cut by
+those villains! I would not do such a thing, so there is an end of
+it."</p>
+<p>Desmond smiled at the earnestness of his faithful follower.</p>
+<p>"Well, Mike, you must be guided by circumstances; but remember,
+it is of extreme importance that this report should reach the Duke
+of Orleans. Unless he has it we may lose Badajos, and the cause
+suffer irreparable injury."</p>
+<p>"To the devil wid the cause," Mike said. "The cause doesn't
+trouble me one way or the other. I don't care a brass farthing
+whether Philip or Charles reigns over the Spaniards. It is not a
+nice job they will be taking on, any way, and not worth a drop of
+Irish blood. Well, if your honour should have the bad fortune to be
+hit, I shall either carry you off, though there's not a breath in
+your body, or else go down with you."</p>
+<p>As there was no doubt that Mike meant what he said, Desmond did
+not press the matter further.</p>
+<p>The next day they set out at daybreak, and, in two hours, were
+mounting the slope of the sierra. There were no signs of any men
+being about, until they reached a point where the road ran between
+steep hills.</p>
+<p>"There they are," Desmond exclaimed, reining in his horse.
+"There are some thirty or forty of them on the road.</p>
+<p>"Now, my men, we will ride forward to those boulders you see, a
+hundred yards this side of them, and then we will dismount and give
+them a volley. If you keep that up, it will soon be too hot for
+them to remain on the road; while we, sheltered behind the rocks,
+will be safe from their shot. It is certain that your guns will
+carry farther and shoot straighter than theirs, as the Spanish
+powder is so much inferior to the French."</p>
+<p>Accordingly, they rode forward at a canter to the heap of
+boulders, then suddenly left the road, dismounted, and took cover
+among the rocks.</p>
+<p>"Take steady aim, men," Desmond said, "then you can hardly miss
+hitting some of them, standing close together as they do."</p>
+<p>The bandits had waited, undecided, at the sudden disappearance
+of those whom they had regarded as a certain prey; and before they
+could form any plans, five muskets flashed out, and four of their
+number fell. A cry of rage burst from them, and there was a general
+discharge of their guns, the balls pattering thickly against the
+stones.</p>
+<p>The soldiers now fired as quickly as they could load, doing
+considerable execution. Their foes left the road, and imitated them
+by taking shelter behind stones. For ten minutes the combat
+continued, and then a party of men were seen, mounting the hill on
+either side.</p>
+<p>"That is just what I hoped for," Desmond said. "Fire at them, so
+as to force them to climb a little higher up the hill. As soon as
+they are pretty well out of gunshot, we will mount and charge down
+the road. There cannot be many men left there."</p>
+<p>His orders were followed. Some of the men on the hillside
+dropped, and the others continued to mount the slopes. When, as
+they believed, out of fire, they moved forward so as to take the
+defenders of the rocks in flank.</p>
+<p>"Now, fire a volley among the men in front of us," Desmond said.
+"We are not likely to hit any of them, but it is sure to draw their
+fire, and there will not be many unemptied guns as we pass
+them."</p>
+<p>As he expected, the volley was answered by a general fire from
+their hidden foes. Then the party leapt into their saddles, and,
+pistol in hand, galloped up the road. Several hurried shots were
+fired from the front, and then, at a shout from their leader, some
+twenty men leapt from their hiding places and ran down into the
+road.</p>
+<p>Desmond was supported on one side by Mike, and on the other by
+the sergeant. He dropped his reins--the horse had learned to obey
+the motions of his knees--and, drawing his sword, rode straight at
+the bandits. Only a few muskets were discharged, and these so
+hurriedly that the balls missed their aim, and, with a shout, the
+party fell upon the brigands. The pistols of the troopers and Mike
+cracked out, but they had no need to draw their swords, for the
+rush of the horses struck such a panic into the Spaniards that they
+sprang from the road, leaving the path clear, and the party
+thundered past them without a check.</p>
+<p>"Is anyone wounded?" Desmond asked, when they had passed beyond
+gunshot of their assailants.</p>
+<p>"I have a ball in my shoulder, Major," one of the troopers said.
+The rest were silent.</p>
+<p>"Well, we have been fortunate," Desmond said. "I will see to
+your wound, my man, when we get a little farther. If those fellows
+had not been so scared with our sudden charge that they fired
+almost at random, we might have lost half our number."</p>
+<p>They stopped half a mile farther, and Desmond examined the
+trooper's arm.</p>
+<p>"The ball has gone through the flesh," he said, "without
+touching the bone, so you will soon have the use of it again."</p>
+<p>He bound the wound tightly up with the soldier's sash; and then
+made, with his own, a sling.</p>
+<p>"You may as well put the other arm in your jacket," he said,
+"and I will tie it round your neck. The air is cold upon the
+hills."</p>
+<p>"We did that well, sir," the sergeant said, as they rode on
+again. "If you had not thought of taking shelter, and shaking them
+up, we should all have been shot down before we reached them.</p>
+<p>"Is there any chance of another attack, sir?"</p>
+<p>"None at all. I should think a messenger was sent to them,
+yesterday, telling them our strength; and no doubt they thought
+that, with sixty men, they would be certain to overpower us. That
+is probably the whole of the band, and in any case, as they would
+not imagine that we could pass them, they are not likely to have
+set another ambush."</p>
+<p>They slept that night at Almarez, made a short journey to
+Oropesa, and a long one on the following day to Toledo, where
+Desmond dismissed his escort, with a handsome reward for their
+services, and upon the next afternoon rode with Mike into Madrid.
+The Duke of Orleans looked astonished when he entered the room.</p>
+<p>"What! Back already, Major Kennedy? Surely you cannot have
+carried out all the work that I entrusted to you?"</p>
+<p>"By no means, Your Royal Highness; but what I did carry out was
+so important that I deemed it my duty to ride back at once, to
+acquaint you with what I have discovered. There is the report,
+sir."</p>
+<p>The duke took it.</p>
+<p>"It is a bulky one," he said. "Tell me its purport in as few
+words as possible."</p>
+<p>"I have discovered, sir, that the report sent by the governor of
+the supply of provisions and stores in Badajos is altogether
+inaccurate, that frauds to an enormous extent have been
+perpetrated, that the supply of powder and cartridges is less by
+two-thirds than was represented, and that similar deficiencies
+exist in every department."</p>
+<p>"This is indeed serious," the duke said. "The possession of
+Badajos is essential to us. It blocks the way to an enemy's
+advance, and indeed, they can scarce move forward until it is
+captured. Now, tell me more about it; or no, I will read your
+report, and then question you concerning it."</p>
+<p>A heavy frown settled on the duke's brow, as he perused the
+document.</p>
+<p>"Infamous!" he exclaimed, when he had finished. "And you say
+that two attempts were made to murder you that night, and that the
+Spanish colonel who gave you so much assistance was assassinated,
+and the commissaries shot the next morning? It shows how anxious
+the governor was to remove from his path all those who could
+inculpate him.</p>
+<p>"And how did you manage to get out of the toils? For it was
+clearly of no use killing the minor witnesses, and allowing you to
+ride here to report the facts."</p>
+<p>"I saw that, sir; and as I learned that eight or ten troopers
+had been sent off, late the night before, I concluded that the road
+would be sure to be beset, for doubtless some of the contractors
+would feel it as essential as the governor did, that my mouth
+should be silenced and my report suppressed. I therefore started
+early. Keeping by byroads, we were not molested until we had nearly
+reached the summit of the sierra, when we found a party of some
+sixty men barring the road. We had a fight with them, and succeeded
+in getting through with no further damage than a ball through the
+arm of one of my escort, and that, fortunately, was only a flesh
+wound."</p>
+<p>"But tell me how it was that so small a party escaped so
+easily?"</p>
+<p>Desmond then recounted the incidents of the fight.</p>
+<p>"Admirably contrived, sir!" the duke said warmly. "Excellent
+generalship! You first attack their centre and drive them off the
+road, then you compel them to weaken themselves by throwing out
+flanking parties. You keep these out of musket shot, and then
+charge on their weakened centre after drawing their fire. I am not
+surprised that, with such generalship, you got off almost
+scatheless.</p>
+<p>"And now, sir, I must ask you to come with me to the king. The
+matter is too serious for a moment's delay. I must lay the whole
+case before His Majesty."</p>
+<p>Leaving Desmond in the antechamber, he went in to the king, read
+the full report to him, and added the details he had heard from
+Desmond.</p>
+<p>"I have met with many bad cases of Spanish corruption and
+peculation," the king said, when he had finished, "but this is by
+far the worst. Steps must be taken instantly to secure the
+governor, arrest the contractors, and fill up the magazines. What
+do you propose?"</p>
+<p>"I think, sir, that if we send forward, at once, a regiment of
+French soldiers from Toledo, accompanied by Colonel Crofton's
+regiment of dragoons, there is no likelihood that any resistance
+will be offered--indeed, I should imagine that the governor will
+have taken to flight, as soon as he learns that his plans for the
+assassination of Major Kennedy have failed."</p>
+<p>"So I should think," the king said; "and certainly he will have
+warned his accomplices, the contractors; and probably, by this
+time, they are all on their way either into Andalusia or to the
+north. Any that are found shall certainly be hanged.</p>
+<p>"This young officer of yours must be a wonderfully shrewd
+fellow. I should like to question him as to how he discovered these
+frauds."</p>
+<p>Desmond was called in.</p>
+<p>"This is Major Kennedy, Your Majesty," the duke said. "That is
+his temporary rank, which I bestowed upon him in order to add
+weight to his mission."</p>
+<p>"I have noticed him before, cousin," Philip said, "when I had
+gone to your quarters, and wondered to see so young a man in the
+uniform of a captain.</p>
+<p>"Now, sir, will you give me an account of how you discovered
+these frauds?"</p>
+<p>Desmond then related how he had caused the piles of barrels to
+be opened out, so that he could examine those next to the wall as
+well as those in front; and how he had similarly examined the other
+stores.</p>
+<p>"Very good, indeed, sir," the king said. "Most officers would
+have contented themselves with, at most, counting the number of
+barrels and sacks; and that you should have so thoroughly
+investigated the matter shows both zeal and shrewdness."</p>
+<p>"He has shown that on various occasions," the duke said, "as you
+may judge from the promotion that he has received. As you see, by
+the loss of his hand, he has suffered as well as fought on behalf
+of France. When Your Majesty is at leisure I will, some evening,
+relate to you a story which I heard from the king himself, of the
+manner in which he, twice, rescued a fair damsel from an
+evil-minded noble who carried her off."</p>
+<p>"I shall hear it with pleasure, cousin. You say he holds only
+temporary rank. I think that, after the signal service he has
+rendered, it should be made substantial."</p>
+<p>"I certainly intend to make it so," the duke said.</p>
+<p>"Pardon, sir," Desmond said, "but, while thanking you for your
+kindness, I would beg to be allowed to remain a captain. Already I
+have obtained more promotion than others have done, after many
+years of good service, and I should regret very much passing over
+the heads of so many of my old companions."</p>
+<p>"It is the first time that I have had promotion declined," the
+duke said, smiling. "However, for the present, at least, I will let
+the matter remain so."</p>
+<p>With an expression of warm thanks, Desmond retired.</p>
+<p>"We must lose no time over this matter," the king said. "For
+aught we know, this scoundrel may be in communication with the
+enemy, and may be prepared to open the gates of the fortress at the
+first summons."</p>
+<p>"I will act at once," the duke replied. "I will, this evening,
+send orders to Toledo for a regiment to march at nine o'clock
+tomorrow morning, and, if you will send a similar order to Colonel
+Crofton, he will overtake the infantry before they get to
+Almarez."</p>
+<p>"I will do so, and will also send with them three field
+officers, with full power to arrest, try, and execute all those who
+have taken part in this treacherous fraud."</p>
+<p>On the duke leaving the king, Desmond joined him in the
+antechamber, and as they walked towards the French headquarters,
+said:</p>
+<p>"I hope, sir, that you will permit me to start tomorrow with any
+force you may be sending, as I wish to carry out the rest of the
+mission with which you entrusted me."</p>
+<p>"By all means, do so if you wish it," the duke said. "Colonel
+Crofton's regiment will start at nine o'clock tomorrow morning, and
+you may accompany it. On the road it will overtake one of our
+regiments from Toledo."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch16" id="Ch16">Chapter 16</a>: Captured.</h2>
+<p>"I have a job for you, Mike."</p>
+<p>"What is it, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"I want you to take off all the marks of a field officer from my
+clothes. I am going to be a captain again."</p>
+<p>Mike looked with surprise at his master.</p>
+<p>"Well, your honour, it is ungrateful bastes they must be. Sure I
+thought that the least they could do was to make you a full major,
+though if they had made you a colonel, it would be no more than you
+deserve."</p>
+<p>"I was offered the majority, Mike, but I declined it. It would
+be absurd, at my age, to have such a rank, and I should be ashamed
+to look officers of our brigade, who have done nigh twenty years of
+good service and are still only captains, in the face. I would much
+rather remain as I am."</p>
+<p>"Well, it may be you are right, sir, but it is disappointed I
+am, entirely."</p>
+<p>"You will get over it, Mike," Desmond laughed.</p>
+<p>"That may be," Mike said doubtfully, "but I should have felt
+mighty proud of being a colonel's servant."</p>
+<p>"I don't suppose you will ever be that, Mike. You know that,
+after the last war was over, several of the Irish regiments were
+disbanded, and no doubt it will be the same when this war is
+finished, so you could not count upon seeing me a colonel, at any
+rate not for another twenty years."</p>
+<p>"Ah, your honour, I hope we shall be back in old Ireland years
+before that!"</p>
+<p>"I hope so, too, Mike. I have only been out here for two years,
+and yet I am beginning to feel that I should like a quieter life.
+No doubt the loss of my hand has something to do with that, but I
+would give up, willingly, all chance of ever becoming a colonel, if
+I could but settle down in the old country, though I fear there is
+very little chance of that."</p>
+<p>"But sure there may be fighting there, too, your honour," Mike
+said; "and if King James goes across the water, there is sure to be
+divarsion that way."</p>
+<p>"I hope not, Mike. It is not that I do not feel as loyal as ever
+to the cause of the Stuarts, but if they cannot come to their own
+without Ireland being again deluged with blood, I would rather they
+would stay away. Twice Ireland has suffered for the Stuarts: first,
+when Cromwell came over, carrying fire and sword through the land,
+and divided half the country among his followers; next, when Dutch
+William did the same. I am loyal to the Stuarts, as I said, but I
+am still more loyal to Ireland, and would rather that King James
+remained all his life at Saint Germain, than that those scenes
+should ever come again."</p>
+<p>"That's true for you, sir; and when I come to think of it, I
+should be just as easy and comfortable in a snug little cot in
+Killarney, which is my county, whether King James or Queen Anne was
+ruling it in England."</p>
+<p>"Quite so, Mike; and if I had, as you say, a snug little cot to
+go to, and an income to live comfortably in it, and no fear of
+being hauled off to prison and hanged for joining the brigade, I
+should not be sorry to settle down.</p>
+<p>"We start back for Badajos tomorrow morning."</p>
+<p>"Faith, your honour, it has been so hard getting away from
+there, that I should not have thought you wished to put your foot
+inside the place again. You might not be so lucky in getting off,
+next time."</p>
+<p>"We are going in a different way, Mike. Colonel Crofton's
+regiment of Irish dragoons is going with us, and a French infantry
+regiment from Toledo."</p>
+<p>"Then I am well content to go back, your honour, and I hope we
+shall see that murthering governor hung."</p>
+<p>"I think you have a good chance of seeing that, Mike, if he has
+not taken himself off before we arrive there; which I think he is
+pretty sure to do, directly he hears we have got through safely;
+for he will know that, as soon as my report is handed in, he is a
+lost man."</p>
+<p>"Bad cess to him! At any rate, I hope I shall light upon him
+some day, sir, and pay him out for sending those fellows to kill
+you at night, and to hinder us in the hills. As to his cheating the
+Spaniards, that is their business, and they can reckon with him for
+it; but I should like to pay our debt myself."</p>
+<p>"I don't suppose there is much chance of your having an
+opportunity of doing that."</p>
+<p>"Then why are we going back, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"To carry out my original orders, Mike--survey the roads, and
+passes, and bridges. The duke cannot rely upon Spanish testimony in
+these matters, and it is most important that we should ascertain,
+accurately, how good are the roads by which he would advance with
+the army into Portugal, or where best to oppose the enemy if they
+cross the Guadiana."</p>
+<p>"I am glad to hear you say so, sir, for I was afraid that we
+were going to have a long stay here again, and I would rather be on
+horseback, riding all over the country, than walking up and down
+these streets till my feet fairly ache."</p>
+<p>"That is my opinion, too, Mike. We have had a good many rides
+with despatches, but between times it is stupid work, hanging about
+the general's quarters waiting for orders."</p>
+<p>The next morning, Desmond joined Colonel Crofton's regiment as
+it was on the point of starting from the barracks. It was in the
+service of Spain, and had taken a brilliant part in several
+engagements. Desmond was acquainted with the colonel and his
+officers.</p>
+<p>"Good morning, Kennedy!" Crofton said, as he rode up and saluted
+him. "I had a note from the Duke of Orleans, last night, saying you
+were going on special service, and would travel with us as far as
+Badajos. King Philip sent for me, later on, and himself gave me
+instructions, besides handing me the written orders. It seems you
+have discovered that the governor is mixed up, with a lot of
+contractors, in swindling the state by supplying earth instead of
+powder and flour."</p>
+<p>"So far as the governor goes, Colonel, there is no absolute
+proof. I have not the smallest doubt that he was the prime mover in
+the matter, and that the commissaries only received a small portion
+of the bribes paid to him. It is hardly possible that every one of
+them should have betrayed his trust, unless sure of the governor's
+protection. I cannot prove that he had all these men shot in order
+to silence them, employed men to assassinate Colonel Mendez, or set
+men to murder me in my hotel and afterwards to intercept us in
+crossing the sierra. Still, I have no shadow of doubt in my mind
+that it was so.</p>
+<p>"However, I do not think you will find him at Badajos. No doubt,
+as soon as he heard I had got safely down into the valley of the
+Tagus, he made off. There is just a possibility that the
+contractors, knowing that their lives will be forfeited by the
+discovery of the frauds, might at once have sent in supplies of
+powder, flour, and other things, to take the place of the casks and
+sacks of earth; in which case he would probably deny the truth of
+my statement altogether, and declare that I had simply invented it
+in order to do credit to myself. But I hardly think that possible.
+In the first place, there are the soldiers both of my escort and of
+Colonel Mendez, who assisted in the work of examination; besides
+which more than half the commissaries escaped while this was taking
+place, and, on an offer of pardon, would no doubt gladly come
+forward and give evidence, especially as the execution of their
+comrades will have shown them that the governor is determined to
+throw them over."</p>
+<p>"Yes; I don't suppose we shall find the arch-scoundrel there,
+unless, indeed, he can rely upon the support of his garrison; in
+which case he may have ridden to Portugal, offering to surrender
+the place at once to them, and will close his gates against
+us."</p>
+<p>"I don't think there is any chance of that, Colonel. In the
+short time during which I was there, I was able to see that the
+troops were deeply discontented. They were almost in rags, and the
+landlord of the inn told me that they were kept on the scantiest
+rations, and those of a very inferior kind. So I do not think, for
+a moment, he could trust them to act against a royal force."</p>
+<p>Desmond's anticipation proved to be correct. As they descended
+into the valley of the Guadiana, they met an officer of the
+garrison, who was bearing a despatch from the senior military
+officer, saying that the governor and his family had suddenly left
+without issuing any orders, and, as he had taken all his portable
+property with him, it was supposed that he did not intend to
+return. Under these circumstances he wrote to ask for orders.</p>
+<p>Colonel Crofton sent him back with instructions, to the colonel
+commanding the troops, that he was coming with a regiment of
+dragoons and one of infantry, and had full authority from the king
+to take all measures that seemed to him desirable. Accordingly,
+when they arrived at Badajos they were met, at the gate, by the
+colonel commanding the troops, and a party of his officers.</p>
+<p>"I have the king's authority," Colonel Crofton said to him, "to
+act as temporary governor until another may be appointed. I do not
+know whether you are aware of the circumstances that led to the
+flight of Don Juan de Munos?"</p>
+<p>"No, sir, we have heard nothing. Rumours were current, among the
+men, that some strange discoveries were made when the stores were
+examined, but beyond that I know nothing. In fact, at the time, the
+assassination of Colonel Mendez of the artillery created such an
+excitement that nothing else was spoken of."</p>
+<p>"Well, Colonel, if you will accompany me to the governor's
+house, I will enter into the matter fully with you. You may well
+believe that it is serious, as I have been despatched here with my
+regiment, and with one of French infantry, for both of whom
+quarters must be found at once."</p>
+<p>"There is plenty of room, sir. The barracks will contain ten
+thousand men, and at present we have but four thousand here."</p>
+<p>"Then I beg, Colonel, that instead of coming at once to my
+quarters, you will tell off officers to conduct the troops to the
+most convenient of the buildings now empty. After that, I shall be
+glad to see you and the commanding officers of the other
+regiments.</p>
+<p>"You will, of course, take up your quarters at the governor's
+house, Captain Kennedy," he went on, as he rode forward. "As you
+are going to be employed in surveying duties, you will naturally be
+a good deal away. But your presence here will be absolutely
+necessary, as a witness against any of these rascally contractors
+we can lay our hands on."</p>
+<p>When the four colonels arrived, after seeing that the troops
+were housed, Colonel Crofton obtained from them the names and
+addresses of the various contractors; and, half an hour later,
+parties of the cavalry regiment in garrison were despatched, under
+officers, with orders to arrest and bring them into Badajos. During
+the meal, Colonel Crofton explained to the four colonels the
+discovery of the frauds, which naturally excited the greatest
+indignation among them. He then requested them and Desmond to
+accompany him to the stores. This they did, after sending to the
+barracks for a party of fifty men for fatigue duty.</p>
+<p>The gaps made during Desmond's explorations had been carefully
+filled up again, but upon fresh openings being made, his reports
+were fully borne out. Some hours were spent at the central
+magazine, and orders given that the other magazines should be
+opened and examined on the following day.</p>
+<p>Desmond did not join in this search, but started early, with
+Mike, to carry out his own mission. He had been furnished with
+reports, sent in by the provincial and local juntas, as to the
+state of the roads, but, as he had expected, he soon found these to
+be grossly inaccurate. The roads marked as excellent, and fit for
+the passage of artillery and trains, were found to be mere bridle
+roads. Others, marked as highroads, were almost impassable lanes.
+The bridges across the streams were, for the most part, in such a
+bad condition as to be unsafe for a country cart and, until
+repaired, impossible for the passage of artillery.</p>
+<p>He carefully noted all the points at which work was required to
+render them in any degree practicable for the passage of troops,
+and reported fully to Colonel Crofton. The latter, who was provided
+with full authority, despatched the greater portion of his troops,
+with a large number of peasants, with materials to fill up the deep
+ruts, repair the bridges, and make the roads, as far as possible,
+fit for the passage of an army.</p>
+<p>In ten days, Desmond had surveyed all the roads down both the
+valley of the Guadiana and that of the Tagus, and had sent off his
+report to Madrid, together with his observations as to the points
+at which a defensive position could, in his opinion, be best taken
+up. Having done this, he prepared to undertake the second part of
+his mission, and to investigate the roads on the Portuguese side of
+the frontier.</p>
+<p>"Now we shall have to keep our eyes open, Mike," he said. "So
+far as we have heard, there are no bodies of the enemy's troops
+anywhere in this neighbourhood, but there is a bitter enmity
+between the Spanish and Portuguese, and we shall be liable to be
+attacked by the peasants."</p>
+<p>"Are we to ride in our uniforms, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly we are, Mike. If we are captured in uniform, we
+should be dealt with as prisoners of war and have a right to fair
+treatment. If we are taken in disguise, we shall be shot as
+spies."</p>
+<p>"Faith, your honour, the alternative is not a pleasant one. If
+we go as civilians, we may be shot as spies; if we go in uniform,
+we may be murdered by the peasants."</p>
+<p>"That is so, Mike. But, you see, we are not likely to fall into
+the hands of the peasants. We are both well mounted, and the
+peasants will be on foot, and a great proportion of them unarmed;
+so that, beyond the chance of being hit by a ball, the risk is not
+great."</p>
+<p>Accordingly, on the following day they rode out, and for nearly
+a week examined the lines of route across the frontier. They
+followed the roads between the foot of the mountains and the
+frontier, as far as Portalegre, but avoided the towns of Campo
+Mayor and Arronches; crossed the hills, and struck upwards by the
+bank of the Zarina to Frontiera, and thence west as far as Lavre.
+They met with no interference by such peasants as they saw working
+in the fields, or by those in the small villages through which they
+passed, these supposing the uniforms to be those of English or
+Dutch officers.</p>
+<p>They found that the roads were fully as bad as those of Spain,
+and would present great difficulty to any army with artillery and a
+long train of waggons. In one of the places they heard from a
+peasant, with whom they conversed, that there was another pass over
+the mountains from Elvas. Of course, the man spoke in Portuguese,
+but the language sufficiently resembled Spanish for Desmond to
+understand its meaning.</p>
+<p>"We must investigate that road, Mike, for, if it is practicable,
+it would be the most direct for an army coming from Lisbon. Of
+course, we shall have to make a wide circle round Elvas, as there
+is sure to be a strong garrison there, and any soldiers riding
+about the country would be certain to know that our uniform was
+French. When we have done that road, we shall have finished our
+work."</p>
+<p>Accordingly, they passed round the fortress at a distance, and
+presently came upon the road. It showed signs of having lately been
+repaired, in some parts, but these were so badly done that they
+increased rather than diminished the difficulties it presented to
+the passage of troops. They had ridden some ten miles, and were
+already among the mountains, when they dismounted to rest their
+horses and to eat the food they carried with them.</p>
+<p>Suddenly, looking down the road behind them, they saw a squadron
+of cavalry coming along.</p>
+<p>"This is awkward, Mike. There is nothing for it, now, but to
+ride on, and when we have reached the foot of the mountains on the
+other side, strike across country until we come upon the road
+running direct to Badajos. They are a good two miles behind us, so
+we need not blow our horses."</p>
+<p>Mounting, they proceeded at a trot up the road. As far as they
+could see, the cavalry behind them did not quicken their pace,
+which showed that they were on some ordinary duty and not, as
+Desmond at first supposed, in pursuit of them, some peasant having,
+perhaps, taken word that an officer and soldier in strange uniform
+had been seen riding round the town. They therefore took matters
+quietly, and indeed, sometimes the road was so steep that it would
+have been impossible for the horses to go beyond a quick walk.</p>
+<p>Suddenly, on reaching the crest of the rise, they saw, at a
+distance of a hundred yards ahead of them, a party of officers,
+followed by an escort of dragoons.</p>
+<p>"We are caught this time, Mike!" Desmond exclaimed. "Escape is
+impossible. I will ride straight up and surrender. Fortunately they
+are English uniforms, so we are certain to get fair treatment,
+which we could not be sure of, had they been Portuguese."</p>
+<p>So saying, he rode forward at a trot. The party had drawn rein
+at his approach, and he rode up to one who was evidently a general
+officer.</p>
+<p>"Sir, I surrender as a prisoner of war. My name is Kennedy, and
+I am a captain on the staff of the Duke of Orleans."</p>
+<p>"And what are you doing here, sir?"</p>
+<p>"I am surveying the road, General, by which the allied army is
+likely to advance. Our information on that score is very defective,
+and I believe the duke wishes to ascertain, from my report, the
+state of the roads by which the advance would most probably be
+made."</p>
+<p>The general's question had been in French, and he replied in the
+same language.</p>
+<p>"You do not bear a French name, sir," the general said.</p>
+<p>"No, sir, I am an Irishman," Kennedy replied, in English. "I
+belonged, before I received a staff appointment, to one of the
+regiments of the Irish Brigade."</p>
+<p>"You are a daring fellow, thus to venture so far across the
+frontier."</p>
+<p>"I simply obeyed my orders, sir; and, had I been ordered to
+reconnoitre Lisbon, I should have attempted to do so."</p>
+<p>"Well, sir, I shall have an opportunity of talking to you, later
+on. I, as you see, am engaged in precisely the same work as you
+are; namely, in ascertaining, for myself, the state of the roads
+across these mountains."</p>
+<p>"Then, General," Desmond said, with a smile, "I should say that
+your investigations are hardly satisfactory."</p>
+<p>The general also smiled.</p>
+<p>"Not so much so as I could wish," he said. "And now, may I ask
+why, seeing that you are well mounted, you did not turn and ride
+for it, when you first perceived us?"</p>
+<p>"The reason is simple, General. A squadron of cavalry were
+coming up behind me, and there was evidently no possibility of
+escape."</p>
+<p>"No doubt they were sent out to meet me. Well, sir, if you will
+give me your word not to attempt to escape, you can retain your
+sword, and ride with us."</p>
+<p>"I give my parole, sir, with many thanks for your courtesy."</p>
+<p>"And now, Captain Kennedy," the other went on, "it is probable
+that you have, about you, the result of your investigations along
+these roads, which I must request you to hand to me; as it may be
+as useful, to me, as it would have been to the Duke of Orleans, and
+may save me a good deal of trouble."</p>
+<p>Desmond took out the notebook in which he had, each day, jotted
+down the result of his observations, with suggestions as to the
+points where repairs were most needed. He had each night, on his
+return to Badajos, written up his reports from these, intending,
+when he had completed the work, to take it himself to Madrid.</p>
+<p>The general glanced through the notebook.</p>
+<p>"You have done your work very thoroughly, Captain Kennedy, and
+have rendered me considerable service. Now, we will move forward
+again. Please follow with my aides-de-camp."</p>
+<p>These were two pleasant young men, who were glad of a talk with
+an officer from the other side.</p>
+<p>"How long have you been riding about here, if it is fair to put
+the question?" one said.</p>
+<p>As the notebook contained all the particulars of his journeys on
+that side of the frontier, Desmond replied at once:</p>
+<p>"Eight days, I think. I have been up the road to Portalegre, and
+by that to Lavre; and if I had not, unfortunately, accidentally
+heard of this road over the mountains, I should now be on my way to
+Madrid; but luck has been against me."</p>
+<p>"Promotion must be very rapid in your army," the other
+aide-de-camp said, "or you would hardly be a captain already."</p>
+<p>"I was fortunate enough to attract the notice of the King of
+France, and the Duke of Berwick, on various occasions, and when one
+has such a piece of good fortune as that, promotion is rapid."</p>
+<p>"It is lucky for you that you fell into the hands of the Earl of
+Galway, instead of into those of the Portuguese generals, who would
+probably, in spite of your uniform, have made short work of
+you."</p>
+<p>"I did not know that the general was the Earl of Galway,"
+Desmond said. "Certainly, it was lucky that I fell into his hands.
+Indeed, if I had not seen the English uniforms, I should have
+turned and charged the squadron behind us; preferring very much to
+be killed fighting, than to be hanged or shot like a dog."</p>
+<p>In a few minutes they met the squadron of cavalry, who had, as
+the general supposed, been sent out by the Governor of Elvas to
+meet him. Half of these now took their place in front, and the
+remainder, drawing aside to let the party pass, fell in behind.
+Mike had, without orders, fallen in with the earl's escort; and
+more than once Desmond heard his laugh, as he chatted with the
+troopers. On arriving at Elvas, the general directed his
+aides-de-camp to obtain a room, for Desmond, in the house in which
+they were quartered; and as no one attended to him, Mike undertook
+his usual duties as his servant.</p>
+<p>The next morning, one of the aides-de-camp came in, and
+said:</p>
+<p>"The general wishes to speak to you, Captain Kennedy."</p>
+<p>On entering the general's apartment, the earl asked him to take
+a seat.</p>
+<p>"I could not see you yesterday evening," he began, "as I was
+learning from the Governor the state of the stores here. I should
+like to have a talk with you. May I ask you, in the first place,
+how you have so early attained the rank of captain? My aide-de-camp
+tells me that you said you had attracted the notice of the King of
+France. It must have been by some singular action, and as I have an
+hour to spare, before I ride out, I shall be glad if you can tell
+me some particulars about yourself; unless, indeed, they are of a
+private nature."</p>
+<p>"Not at all, sir. The story is generally known to members of the
+court at Versailles, and indeed to all Paris;" and he then related
+to the earl the story of his release of Anne de Pointdexter from
+her imprisonment, the journey to the south, the attack on the party
+by the Vicomte de Tulle, and her second rescue from him.</p>
+<p>"Thank you, sir," the general said, when he had concluded. "I am
+not surprised that, after so romantic an adventure, the King of
+France took notice of an officer who had shown such courage and
+intelligence. You see, sir, that you and I are, to a certain
+extent, in a similar position. From motives of religion,
+principally, you Irish have left your country, and are fighting for
+a foreign monarch. I, as you are doubtless aware, belong to a
+French Huguenot family, and, being forced to leave France by the
+severe edicts, entered the service of Holland, and followed the
+fortunes of King William, and am now fighting against the troops of
+the country of my birth. In other respects, there is a similarity.
+We have both lost a hand in the service of our adopted countries; I
+at the siege of Badajos, and you at--?"</p>
+<p>"Oudenarde, sir."</p>
+<p>"I have been thinking it over," the general went on. "I might,
+of course, send you to Lisbon as a prisoner, but one extra prisoner
+would not largely benefit my government. You have not been taken in
+action. Your papers have saved me an immense deal of trouble, for
+we are no more able to rely upon the information given by the
+Portuguese than, I should think, the Duke of Orleans can upon that
+of the Spaniards.</p>
+<p>"Therefore, sir, I think that, in the present case, I can make
+an exception to the rule. In an hour I shall mount and ride down
+the road to Badajos, and I shall there restore your liberty to you,
+and permit you to recross the frontier. It would be a thousand
+pities that so young and gallant an officer should waste, perhaps,
+some years of his life in an English prison, for the number of
+prisoners taken in Flanders is so great that it is impossible for
+the French to find officers to exchange for them. You will
+understand that, dealing with allies so jealous and susceptible as
+the Portuguese, I can hardly take the step of releasing you, as it
+would be at once rumoured that I had been in communication with a
+French officer, doubtless from some sinister motive.</p>
+<p>"I think, Captain Kennedy, that it would be as well," he said
+with a smile, "that you should withdraw your parole, and do so
+before we start, in the presence of the officers of my staff. Of
+course, you must be placed under a very strict guard, and although
+so near the frontier, you will find it very difficult to escape.
+Still, such things are managed."</p>
+<p>"I thank you most deeply, sir," Desmond said, understanding the
+tone in which the earl spoke, "and I shall ever retain a deep
+feeling of gratitude for your generosity."</p>
+<p>When the party assembled, in readiness to mount, Desmond walked
+up to the earl, and said in a tone that could be heard by the
+officers round:</p>
+<p>"Sir, I have changed my mind, and beg to be allowed to withdraw
+my parole."</p>
+<p>"You are at liberty to do so, Captain Kennedy; but nevertheless
+I shall take you with us today. I shall not, of course, ask you to
+give any information as to matters on the other side of the
+frontier, but there are points on which you could inform me,
+without detriment to your friends."</p>
+<p>"That I shall be happy to do, sir."</p>
+<p>The earl called up four troopers.</p>
+<p>"You will place this officer and his servant between you," he
+said, "and keep a vigilant lookout upon their movements."</p>
+<p>Desmond had not even told Mike of the conversation with the
+earl, thinking it better that he should remain in ignorance that
+this escape was connived at by an English general, and his follower
+was therefore greatly astonished when he heard that his master had
+withdrawn his parole, and that they were henceforth to be strictly
+guarded. The party rode until they reached a rise from which they
+could obtain a view of Badajos, and of the country extending far up
+the valley of the Guadiana. The ground in front of them sloped
+gradually.</p>
+<p>The earl took his place with two or three officers of his staff,
+fifty yards in front of the rest, and, dismounting, examined
+Badajos with his telescope. Then he asked one of his aides-de-camp
+to bring Captain Kennedy to him.</p>
+<p>"You may as well bring his servant, too," he added. "No doubt he
+knows the country as well as his master does, and may not be so
+unwilling to answer questions."</p>
+<p>The order was carried out, and Desmond and Mike rode up with the
+aide-de-camp, followed closely by the four troopers. The earl at
+once began to question Desmond as to the names of the villages
+visible up the valley. He had remounted now, but his staff, who had
+dismounted when he did, remained on their feet, as it was evident
+that he had no intention of moving forward for some time.</p>
+<p>While they were speaking, the earl, accompanied by Desmond, rode
+forward some twenty yards, as if to obtain a better view. Mike had
+followed him, but the four troopers remained behind the group of
+officers, having no orders to follow the general so closely.</p>
+<p>"This is good ground for galloping, Captain Kennedy," the earl
+said quietly. "You are within two miles of Badajos."</p>
+<p>"Thank you deeply, sir.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mike, ride for it!" and, spurring his horse, he dashed off
+at a headlong gallop.</p>
+<p>There was a shout of surprise, the officers of the staff ran to
+their horses, which were being held by the orderlies, and the four
+troopers at once galloped forward, snatching their carbines from
+the slings.</p>
+<p>"Do not fire," the earl shouted as they passed. "Take them
+alive."</p>
+<p>As the officers came up, the general signalled to them to
+stop.</p>
+<p>"Don't go farther, gentlemen," he said. "The troopers will
+doubtless overtake them; but for aught we know, there may be a
+Spanish force in the village just on the other side of the
+frontier, and, instead of capturing two prisoners, you might be
+taken or shot yourself; and I am not disposed to lose any of my
+staff, just as we are about to commence operations in earnest."</p>
+<p>Desmond looked back. He saw that only the four dragoons were
+following.</p>
+<p>"They will not overtake us, Mike," he said, "our horses are
+certainly better than theirs."</p>
+<p>Indeed, they had increased their lead fast. A few minutes later,
+they heard a trumpet call in their rear, and their pursuers at once
+checked their horses, and rode back in answer to the recall.</p>
+<p>"Tare an' ages," Mike exclaimed, "but that was nately managed.
+Who would have thought that they would have let us give them the
+slip so easily!"</p>
+<p>"Well, Mike--but this you must never mention to a soul--the earl
+gave us this chance of escape, I believe. He had, you know, a long
+talk with me, and said that they had so many French officers
+captured in Flanders, that one more or less would make little
+difference. He had asked about my adventures, and seemed much
+interested in them, and remarked that our positions were somewhat
+similar, both being exiles on account of our religion, and so
+serving in foreign armies against our own countrymen. At any rate,
+it was on his suggestion that I withdrew my parole not to attempt
+to escape."</p>
+<p>"Then he is a rale gintleman, sir, and mighty obliged I feel to
+him, for I have had enough of English prisons, though indeed, it
+was only three or four days that I stopped at Harwich."</p>
+<p>The party on the hill had watched the pursuit, until the earl
+said:</p>
+<p>"Well, gentlemen, I fancy he has slipped from our hands. I admit
+that I am hardly sorry, for he was a very fine young fellow, and it
+would have been a pity for him to be spending, perhaps some years
+of the best part of his life, in prison.</p>
+<p>"Captain Chetwynde, will you order the trumpeter to sound the
+recall? They are leaving our men behind fast. It is no use losing
+four troopers as well as two prisoners."</p>
+<p>More than one quiet smile was exchanged between the English
+officers, for, from the tone in which the earl spoke, they had no
+doubt that he was by no means sorry at Desmond's escape, and that
+possibly he had even taken him forward with him to afford him a
+chance of making it. They had, indeed, been a little surprised
+that, when Desmond withdrew his parole, the earl had not ordered
+him into strict confinement, instead of taking him with him on his
+reconnaissance.</p>
+<p>The pursuit over, Desmond rode on at a canter to Badajos, and
+reported to Colonel Crofton that he had been taken prisoner, but
+had managed to effect his escape, as he was but carelessly
+guarded.</p>
+<p>"I shall now, sir, return to Madrid. I have completed the work I
+was told to carry out, and shall finish writing up my report this
+afternoon, and start tomorrow morning."</p>
+<p>"I congratulate you on your escape. The Portuguese are not very
+particular, and might, as likely as not, have paid small regard to
+the fact that you were in uniform."</p>
+<p>"Fortunately, sir, it was not by them that I was captured, but
+by a small party of English dragoons, who were, I fancy, like
+myself, investigating the state of the roads."</p>
+<p>Desmond had not been called upon to give evidence before the
+commission of enquiry, it being found that all the contractors had
+left their homes, a week before the troops arrived at Badajos,
+taking all portable property with them. Some had apparently gone to
+Andalusia, while others had made for Catalonia. All had
+unquestionably made a considerable sum of money by their frauds,
+and would take good care not to fall into the hands of the
+French.</p>
+<p>"They will never be able to return here," Desmond remarked to
+Colonel Crofton.</p>
+<p>The latter smiled.</p>
+<p>"You do not know these people yet, Captain Kennedy, or you would
+not say so. Some of these fellows are certainly among the richest
+men in the province, and we may be quite sure that, in a very short
+time, when the affair has blown over, they will, partly by
+influence and more by bribery, obtain from the central junta an
+order that no proceedings shall be taken against them. Anything can
+be done with money in Spain. There are many upright and honourable
+Spaniards, but very few of them take any part in public affairs,
+and would not associate with such men as those who are in the
+ascendant in all the provincial juntas, and even in the central
+body in Madrid.</p>
+<p>"In France there is distress enough, and no doubt the men who
+farm the taxes are no more scrupulous than they are in Spain, but
+there is not the same general corruption, and the French nobility,
+haughty and despotic to their tenants as they may be, are not
+corrupt, and would scorn to take a bribe. Now that there is a
+French king on the throne here, there may be, when matters have
+settled down, some improvement; but it will be a long time, indeed,
+before the nation can be regenerated, and even the king will soon
+find that, if he is to reign peaceably, he must not interfere too
+violently with methods that are so common that they have come to be
+accepted as inevitable, even by the people who suffer by them.</p>
+<p>"I can assure you that I, myself, have been many times
+approached by men who supply forage and other things to the
+regiment, and when I have indignantly refused to entertain any
+proposals whatever, they have not been at all abashed, but have
+said boldly that it was the general custom. I do not believe they
+thought any the better of me for refusing even to listen to their
+offers, but regarded me as a sort of Don Quixote, with ridiculously
+exaggerated ideas of honour."</p>
+<p>On the morning following his return to Badajos, Desmond started
+on his way to Madrid. Although this time he had no apprehension
+whatever of a planned attack, he thought it safer and better to
+travel north from Badajos, and skirt the foot of the sierras until
+he reached the banks of the Tagus, where there was a strong
+garrison in each of the towns, and the country was, in consequence,
+free from the incursions of bands from the hills. The journey
+passed without an incident, and on reaching Madrid and presenting
+his report, he received high commendation from the Duke of Orleans,
+and spent a long day with the general's staff, explaining his
+report, and going into details as to the nature of the roads, the
+repairs necessary, and the positions which were, in his opinion,
+most suitable for battle.</p>
+<p>On the following day, the members of the staff were all summoned
+to meet him by the Duke of Orleans, who informed them that he had
+received a sudden summons to return to Paris, and that Marshal de
+Bay would, in his absence, be in command of the French troops. The
+announcement came as a great surprise to Desmond, but was not
+unexpected by the other officers.</p>
+<p>During the winter, the King of France had been engaged in
+efforts to bring about a general peace, and had offered terms that
+showed he was ready to make any sacrifices to procure it. The
+allies, on the contrary, were bent upon continuing the war. The
+victory of Oudenarde, the capture of Lille, Namur, and other
+fortresses, opened the way to Paris, and knowing the general
+distress that prevailed in France, they raised their demands higher
+and higher, as they perceived the anxiety of Louis for peace.</p>
+<p>One of the obstacles to this was the situation in Spain, and it
+was reported that Louis was ready to yield on this point also, and
+not only to consent to the cession of the Spanish dominion in
+Spain, but to his grandson Philip surrendering the crown to the
+Archduke Charles; and that, ere long, the French troops would be
+withdrawn altogether. While, during the month that had elapsed
+since Desmond first left Madrid, these rumours had increased in
+strength, it was known that couriers were constantly passing to and
+fro, between Madrid and Versailles, with private communications
+between Louis and Philip; and there was great excitement, in
+Madrid, at the rumour of this desertion of their king by
+France.</p>
+<p>The rumours were indeed correct. The king had informed Philip
+that, great as was the affection he bore for him, the state of
+France, which was necessarily his chief care, would compel him, ere
+long, to recall his troops from Spain. Philip had entreated him not
+to desert him, and declared that, in any case, he would remain in
+Spain, confiding in the support of the people who had selected him
+as their monarch. At present, however, the communications were
+proceeding, and nothing definite had been arranged.</p>
+<p>The whole of the staff were to remain with Marshal de Bay, in
+the same position as they had held under the duke, and, except for
+the departure of the prince, matters went on as before.</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch17" id="Ch17">Chapter 17</a>: An Old Friend.</h2>
+<p>The command had been effected so suddenly that Desmond had not
+been able to make up his mind to request the Duke of Orleans, to
+whom he had been attached personally, rather than to the French
+army in Spain, to allow him to return with him to France, in order
+that he might again join the Duke of Berwick. Before, however, he
+could decide whether to do so or not, the duke had taken his
+departure.</p>
+<p>Desmond spoke to the head of the staff, with whom he had been
+constantly thrown in contact before he left Madrid, and whilst
+explaining to him, on his return, the details of his report, asked
+him for his advice.</p>
+<p>"I should think you had better remain here, Captain Kennedy.
+There is likely to be a great battle fought, in a few weeks; but if
+the rumours we hear are correct, we may not be here very much
+longer. Certainly I hope there will be no change until then, for if
+we win the battle, and so relieve Spain from the risk of invasion
+for a time, we can leave the country with a better grace, as Philip
+would then only have to battle with his rebellious subjects in
+Catalonia."</p>
+<p>"I should certainly not wish to leave when a great battle is
+about to be fought," Desmond said, "and will, therefore, continue
+to serve under the Marshal de Bay until it is certain what is going
+to be done."</p>
+<p>In a short time a general movement of the troops, both Spanish
+and French, began. Desmond and the other aides-de-camp were
+actively employed in keeping up communication between the various
+columns, which were to assemble near Badajos. Moving forward at the
+same rate as the troops, the march was a pleasant one. It was April
+now, the country looked bright, and the heat was not too great for
+marching.</p>
+<p>The marshal had gone on with the greater portion of his staff,
+Desmond having been detailed to accompany the division from Toledo.
+When within two days' march of Badajos, an orderly brought a note
+from the marshal, requesting him to ride forward at once. This he
+did without loss of time.</p>
+<p>Marshal de Bay had taken up his quarters at Badajos, and on
+arriving in the town, Desmond alighted at the governor's house.</p>
+<p>"It was a stupid mistake of mine," the head of the staff said,
+"in sending you on detached duty. I forgot at the moment, when I
+nominated you, that your knowledge of the locality would be
+invaluable to us. I only thought of it yesterday when, on the
+marshal asking for some information on this matter, I pulled out
+your report. He examined it and said, 'This is very complete and
+valuable, Colonel. Whom is it made by?'</p>
+<p>"'By an officer of your staff, sir, Captain Kennedy.'</p>
+<p>"'Where is he?'</p>
+<p>"'He is coming down with the Toledo column, sir.'</p>
+<p>"'Please send for him at once,' he said. 'One of the others
+should have been detached for that service. He is just the man we
+want here.'</p>
+<p>"Accordingly we sent for you, and here you are."</p>
+<p>"This is an excellent report of yours, sir," the duke said, when
+the colonel introduced Desmond to him. "As we came down, I noticed
+that the roads had, in many cases, been thoroughly repaired at the
+points mentioned in your report as being particularly bad, and the
+bridges in many places greatly strengthened. Had it not been for
+that, I do not know how I should have got my guns along.</p>
+<p>"And now, sir, I want to ask you a few questions as to the road
+on the other side. By your report, I see that you consider the road
+through Campo Mayor to be the only one by which an army could move,
+and that a large body of workmen must be employed to make the other
+road fit for the passage of cannon."</p>
+<p>He then asked a number of questions concerning this road.</p>
+<p>"I see," he said, "you have marked several places, in your
+report, where an enemy coming down that road could post themselves
+strongly, and others which might be defended to advantage by
+us."</p>
+<p>"Yes, sir; but of course, the suitability of those places would
+depend largely upon the respective strength of the armies."</p>
+<p>The marshal nodded approvingly.</p>
+<p>"From all I hear from our agents in Lisbon," he said, "the
+enemy's forces will be superior to our own in numbers, but the main
+portion are Portuguese, who have shown very little fight, hitherto.
+Their cavalry are almost entirely Portuguese. The only really
+fighting portion of their forces are the English and Dutch, who are
+most formidable foes; but against these we have our French
+regiments, on whose bravery we can rely. Were it not that I think
+the Portuguese will probably, as at the battle of Almanza, fly as
+soon as the engagement begins, I should fall back and take up a
+strongly defensive position. As it is, in spite of their superior
+numbers, I think we can meet them on an equal field."</p>
+<p>The conversation lasted over an hour, and then Desmond retired,
+leaving Colonel Villeroy with the marshal. As he left the house, an
+officer standing at the door seized his hand.</p>
+<p>"My dear Kennedy," he said, "who would have thought that we
+should have met again here!"</p>
+<p>Desmond staggered back. He could not, for a moment, believe the
+evidence of his eyes and ears.</p>
+<p>"Why, O'Neil, I thought you were dead."</p>
+<p>"I am worth a good many dead men, yet," the other one laughed.
+"Let us go into this wine shop and crack a bottle. We can then talk
+over matters quietly."</p>
+<p>"And O'Sullivan, is he alive too?" Desmond asked.</p>
+<p>"No, poor fellow. He has never been heard of since that
+tremendous licking we got. There is not a shadow of hope."</p>
+<p>Then many questions were asked, on both sides; and when these
+were answered, Desmond said:</p>
+<p>"Now about yourself, O'Neil. I thought I was the only one that
+got through safe."</p>
+<p>"So you were, for the other three of us were all on our
+backs."</p>
+<p>"But we did not hear of you as among the prisoners, of whom a
+list was furnished by Marlborough."</p>
+<p>"No; the name of Patrick O'Neil did not appear. I was shot
+through the body, and during the night I lay insensible, but in the
+morning I opened my eyes and began to think. It seemed to me that
+the name was not one that would be likely to please. In the first
+place, because it was evident, by my age, that I was not one of the
+Limerick men; in the next place, because of that little matter of
+my escape from the jail in London. I had no fear of being shot. I
+should be a prisoner of war, but I should not be likely to be over
+kindly treated, and when they exchanged prisoners I should
+certainly not be one of those sent back. You see, what with
+Blenheim and Ramillies and Oudenarde, they had taken ten of our
+officers for every one of their officers captured by us, so I
+thought it best to pass as a French officer.</p>
+<p>"It was easy to do so, as my French was good enough to pass
+anywhere, and, you see, I had on a French staff uniform. Luckily my
+horse had been shot at the same time as I was. He was lying dead
+beside me, and within reach of my arm, so that I was able to lean
+over and get my flask from one of the holsters. I had a terrible
+thirst on me, and could have drunk a barrel.</p>
+<p>"As I heard no firing, I knew that the fighting was over; and in
+two or three hours a party came along with a stretcher, having a
+doctor with them. When he saw that my eyes were open, and that I
+was alive, he examined my wound and shook his head.</p>
+<p>"'He is badly hit,' he said, 'but you may as well carry him
+in.'</p>
+<p>"So they took me into Oudenarde, which had been turned into a
+big hospital.</p>
+<p>"'You are not to speak,' the doctor said to me, before they
+lifted me up. 'You must keep yourself perfectly quiet.'</p>
+<p>"When they got me into the hospital, they found a hole behind as
+well as in front, which I heard one of the doctors say was a good
+thing. They dressed the wounds and left me. I could see by their
+faces, the next time they came, that they were surprised to see me
+alive. One of them said to the other:</p>
+<p>"'The bullet must have passed through him without touching any
+vital point. He may do yet.'</p>
+<p>"He bent down, and asked me in French what my name was, and I
+said 'Victor Dubosc, lieutenant;' so they stuck a card with my name
+over my bed, and asked me no more questions. I lay there for six
+weeks, and then I was well enough to get up and walk about.</p>
+<p>"Three weeks later, I went down with some other convalescents to
+Ostend, and there we were embarked, and taken to Portsmouth. Then
+we were put in boats and rowed to Porchester, which is a place at
+the end of a sort of lake behind Portsmouth. There was an old
+castle there, with a mighty high wall, enclosing a lot of ground,
+where there were huts--rows of them--all filled with our prisoners.
+Some of the huts were a little better than others, and these were
+for the use of officers. A regiment of soldiers was in tents
+outside the walls, and a hundred men were always on guard with
+loaded muskets.</p>
+<p>"I said to myself, often and often, 'If Kennedy were here, he
+would soon hit upon some plan for getting away;' but for the life
+of me, I could not see how it was to be managed. It was a dull
+time, I can tell you. The food was bad, and the cooking was worse.
+Only a few officers were there, most of them being sent to some
+place a long distance inland; but, as we were all wounded, I
+suppose they thought that the loss of blood would keep us
+quiet.</p>
+<p>"One of the officers, having a little money hidden about him,
+bought a pack of cards from an English soldier, and we passed most
+of our time playing; but it was poor work, for we had nothing to
+play for. At last, I said to myself, 'Patrick O'Neil, there must be
+an end of this or your brain will go altogether. It is not worth
+much at the best of times, or it would have thought of some plan
+for getting out of this place before now.'</p>
+<p>"At last, I hit on a plan. It was a dangerous one, there was no
+doubt of that; but as I was desperate, I did not think much of the
+danger. The worst they could do was to shoot me, which I suppose is
+what they would have done. My idea was to pounce suddenly on one of
+the sentries, who kept guard all night; to gag him, and tie him up,
+before he could give the alarm; and then to dress up in his
+clothes, and take his matchlock.</p>
+<p>"But the difficulty was, what was I to do next. The soldiers
+came on duty for twelve hours, coming in at six in the morning and
+going out at six in the evening.</p>
+<p>"It was clear to me that it could only be done in the dark, and
+I had to wait for nearly two months. It was the beginning of
+October before it was dark enough, at six in the morning, for me to
+fall in with the others and march out without being noticed.</p>
+<p>"At last, the time came. I stole out of my hut an hour before
+the change would be made, and crept along quietly, till I heard a
+sentry marching up and down between our huts and those of the
+soldiers. I had torn up a blanket into strips, and twisted them
+together to make ropes; and with these in one hand, and a big piece
+ready to shove into his mouth in the other, I stole up close to
+him; and when he turned his back to me, I jumped upon him. Luckily,
+instead of carrying the musket on his shoulder, he had it under his
+arm, so that I was able to seize the lock with one hand, and clutch
+him by the throat with the other. I gripped pretty hard, and the
+man, in half a minute, slipped down to the ground.</p>
+<p>"Before he could recover, I had stripped off his coatee and
+cloak; then I tied his hands and feet, fastened the gag firmly in
+his mouth, and dragged him in between two huts, where he would not
+be found till morning. Then I took off my own coat and threw it
+over him, for the night was chilly, and put on his cloak and shako,
+and took his place.</p>
+<p>"In half an hour I heard a tramp of men, and knew the relief had
+entered. Then there was a bugle call, and two or three sentries
+passed towards the entrance. I ran on, too. When they fell in, I
+managed to get in the last section. Some sergeants ran down the
+line counting the men, and reported that all were present. The
+gates were opened, and we marched out.</p>
+<p>"As soon as we got among the tents, we fell out, and I had no
+difficulty whatever in getting off without being observed. Leaving
+my musket and shako behind me, I went up a long lane which brought
+me on to the main road, crossed that, climbed a hill beyond, and
+came down into a wooded country.</p>
+<p>"At the first cottage I came to, I stopped. A man and woman came
+out on my knocking. They looked kindly and good tempered, and I
+told them a pitiful story, about how I had been unjustly accused of
+striking an officer, and had been sentenced to two hundred lashes;
+and that I had managed, in the night, to cut a slit in the back of
+the guard tent and escape.</p>
+<p>"As I had been walking along, a sudden thought had struck me. At
+Oudenarde, I was wearing the same boots I had worn when we were
+captured together. When we took the money out, we each left, if you
+remember, five pieces of gold in one of our boots, which I had
+never thought of till that day; and, as I came along, I opened the
+sole and took them out. It was a perfect godsend, as you may
+guess.</p>
+<p>"The man and his wife expressed such sympathy that I did not
+hesitate to say: 'I want to get rid of my coatee, and of this
+cloak. The coatee would be of no use to you, and you had best burn
+it, but the cloak, if you alter it, might be useful; or, if you cut
+it up, will make a cover for your bed. I will give you that and a
+gold piece--it is a French one I got in the wars, but you can
+change it easily enough, when you go into the town marketing--if
+you will give me a suit of your clothes.'</p>
+<p>"This the man readily consented to do, and the woman set before
+me a large bowl of milk, and some bread, which I ate as soon as I
+had put on a pair of breeches, smock, and broad hat. Now I felt
+perfectly safe. They might send news all over the country of the
+escape of a French officer, but as I had never spoken a word of
+English, from the time that I was taken, no one would suspect a
+countryman speaking English to be the man whom they were in search
+of.</p>
+<p>"After leaving the cottage, I travelled quietly to Rye. I
+thought it best to go there, for it was likely that it would be
+difficult, elsewhere, for an unknown man to get a passage to
+France, and it struck me that the man who took us across before,
+would carry me over the first time he was going with despatches. I
+found him easily enough, and though I was not dressed quite in the
+same way as I was when we called on him before, he recognized me at
+once.</p>
+<p>"'Another job for me?' he asked.</p>
+<p>"'Not a special one,' I said. 'I am going across again, but
+there is no occasion for you to make a special trip, and indeed my
+employer forgot to give me an order upon you. I should have gone
+back, if I had remembered it, but I thought you would not mind
+giving me a passage the next time you sailed across.'</p>
+<p>"As the man remembered that we had made ourselves pleasant on
+board, he agreed at once to take me, next time the boat should be
+going. I laid out a pound in getting a coat more suitable for
+travelling in France than the peasant's smock. Then I took a
+lodging in a small inn.</p>
+<p>"Three days later, a messenger came down with an order for the
+man to take him across at once, and as the captain charged me
+nothing for my passage, I had enough left to pay for my place in a
+diligence, and on arriving in Paris duly reported myself, at the
+barracks, as having returned.</p>
+<p>"My first enquiry, of course, was about you and O'Sullivan. I
+found that he had never been heard of, but that you had lost a
+hand, and had been promoted to a captaincy; had been very ill, and
+had gone to the south of France on sick leave.</p>
+<p>"After I heard that, I remained for two or three months at the
+depot, and then learned that the Duke of Berwick had just arrived
+from Dauphiny. I at once went to see him. He told me he could not
+put me on his staff again, as his numbers were complete, but would
+give me a letter to the Duke of Orleans, asking him to employ me in
+that capacity. When I got down here, I found that the duke had
+left, and that the Marshal de Bay was in command.</p>
+<p>"On reading Berwick's letter, he at once appointed me one of his
+aides-de-camp. You were away, I found to my great disappointment,
+and I was sent off into Catalonia, with orders for four battalions
+to be sent at once to Badajos. I arrived here yesterday, in time
+for the shindy."</p>
+<p>"Fortunately, O'Neil, I do not think there is much fear of
+another Oudenarde. There is no royal duke here, to interfere with
+our general; and the Portuguese are not to be compared with the
+Hanoverians, and Dutch, and the other allies that fought against us
+there."</p>
+<p>"I hear, from the others, that you have been occupied in
+reconnoitring the country."</p>
+<p>"Yes, and I was captured, but was fortunately able to give them
+the slip."</p>
+<p>Desmond did not care to tell even his friend that his escape was
+due to the kindness of the British general.</p>
+<p>The next morning, Desmond was sent off to hurry up a body of
+troops which was still some seven or eight marches away. The news
+had come that the allied army was in motion, and would probably
+concentrate near Portalegre. This seemed to show that they intended
+to invade Spain by Badajos, and the valley of the Guadiana; for,
+had their aim been to advance up the valley of the Tagus, to
+Madrid, they would have marched towards Montalvao, and so on by
+Alcantara to Almarez.</p>
+<p>After two days' hard riding he met the column, which, on
+receiving the order from the marshal to hasten forward with all
+speed, performed double marches until they arrived at Badajos.
+Desmond found that the allies had not wasted their time, and that
+their advance guard was already at Campo Mayor. The Spanish army
+were posted on the Caya river, a stream that flowed down from the
+sierra, and fell into the Guadiana at Badajos.</p>
+<p>Their position was a defensive one. The army of the allies was
+known to be some twenty-two thousand strong, of whom some five
+thousand were cavalry. The Spanish had about the same strength of
+cavalry, but were inferior in infantry. The number of guns also was
+about equal, both sides having about forty cannon.</p>
+<p>On the 7th of May, the two armies faced each other on opposite
+sides of the river Caya. As neither party made any movement of
+advance, Marshal de Bay determined to force on an engagement, and
+sent orders to the cavalry to cross the river, and to place
+themselves on the road between the enemy and Campo Mayor.</p>
+<p>The allies suffered, as the French had done at Oudenarde, by
+conflicting counsels. The Earl of Galway was in command of the
+British, and of two or three Dutch regiments. The Marquis de
+Frontiera was in command of the Portuguese, who formed by far the
+greater portion of the force, and, as soon as the movement was seen
+on the other side of the river, he determined to cross and attack
+the Spaniards.</p>
+<p>The Earl of Galway was strongly of opinion that it would not be
+wise to take the offensive, but that the army should remain in its
+present position, until the intentions of the enemy were clearly
+ascertained. Their cavalry, he urged, could do little by
+themselves, and it was evident that the infantry could not be
+attacked while they remained under the shelter of the guns of the
+fortress. The Marquis de Frontiera, however, and the other
+Portuguese generals, were unanimous in insisting that battle should
+be given at once, and the former gave orders for the Portuguese
+cavalry, with a body of foot and five field pieces, to march
+immediately.</p>
+<p>Seeing that, if unsupported, this force must meet with disaster,
+the Earl of Galway reluctantly ordered the troops under his command
+to advance. The river was fordable, and they met with no
+opposition, until they crossed it and formed up in order of battle.
+The Portuguese horse were now divided on each wing, the British
+were in the centre; a portion of the Portuguese infantry were on
+either flank, the rest were in the rear.</p>
+<p>"Captain Kennedy, you will carry my orders at once, to our
+cavalry, to charge the Portuguese horse on the right wing."</p>
+<p>Desmond saluted, and was about to ride off, when he paused a
+moment and asked:</p>
+<p>"May I charge with Brigadier Crofton's dragoons, sir?"</p>
+<p>The marshal nodded, and Desmond galloped off. Crofton was in
+command of the first line of cavalry. His own regiment, which was
+composed partly of Irishmen and partly of Spaniards, was in the
+centre of the line.</p>
+<p>After delivering his orders to the general commanding the
+cavalry, Desmond rode on to Crofton.</p>
+<p>"The cavalry are going to charge, sir," he said, "and I have
+permission to ride with you."</p>
+<p>Crofton waited until the order from the general arrived, and
+then, drawing his sword, shouted, "The first brigade will charge,"
+and, riding forward, led the way against the Portuguese horse,
+whose cannon had already opened fire. The Portuguese fell into
+disorder as soon as they saw the long line of horsemen charging
+down on them like a torrent, and when it neared them broke and
+fled. They were soon overtaken, great numbers were cut down, and
+the remainder galloped off, a panic-stricken mob, and did not draw
+rein until they reached Campo Mayor.</p>
+<p>The Spaniards at once turned the five cannon the fugitives had
+left behind them upon the allied infantry, and then, after a few
+rounds had been fired, the cavalry charged the British infantry.
+But they had now foes of a different metal to reckon with, and
+although, three times, the horsemen reformed their ranks and hurled
+themselves against the infantry, they were each time repulsed with
+heavy loss.</p>
+<p>Then, swerving round, they fell on the Portuguese infantry in
+the second line, whom they dispersed as easily as they had defeated
+the cavalry.</p>
+<p>The Earl of Galway now brought up the brigade of Brigadier
+General Pierce, which consisted of the two British regiments of
+Barrimore and Stanwix, and a Spanish regiment which had been
+recently raised and named after himself. These charged the enemy
+with great bravery, drove back their infantry for some distance,
+recovered the five guns the cavalry had lost, and, still pressing
+forward, fought their way deep into the centre of the Spanish
+ranks.</p>
+<p>Had they been supported by the Portuguese infantry, on their
+flank, the battle might still have been won. But the latter, in
+spite of the persuasions and orders of their officers, refused to
+advance, and, turning their backs, made off in confusion, although
+not yet attacked by the enemy. Orders were then sent to the
+Portuguese horse on the left to charge to the assistance of
+Pierce's brigade. But instead of doing this, they also galloped off
+the field, and after defending themselves with desperate valour for
+some time, the little brigade, being unsupported, and being
+surrounded by the whole strength of the Spaniards, was forced to
+surrender.</p>
+<p>In the meantime the Earl of Galway, seeing that the battle was
+lost, through the cowardice of the Portuguese, was preparing to
+withdraw his men, and had only despatched Pierce's brigade to check
+the advance of the enemy while he did so. Seeing that these, by
+their ardour, were irretrievably cut off, he gave the order to the
+Marquis Montandre to draw off the British infantry, who alone
+remained firm, and against whom the whole of the French and Spanish
+forces now advanced; while he himself with a small body of cavalry,
+charged into the midst of the enemy in hopes of reaching Pierce's
+brigade and drawing it off.</p>
+<p>Although weakened by the loss of that brigade, attacked on both
+flanks as well as in front, and frequently charged by the Spanish
+horse, among which Crofton's dragoons were conspicuous for their
+bravery, the retreating British maintained admirable order.
+Occasionally, when severely pressed, they charged the enemy and
+beat them back; till they were able to withdraw from the field with
+comparatively trifling loss, thus saving the flying Portuguese from
+annihilation. As at Almanza, the whole of the fighting, and almost
+all the loss, fell upon the English, although a considerable number
+of the Portuguese were cut down in their flight, before the Spanish
+cavalry returned to join in the attack on the retiring English. The
+allies had, altogether, seventeen hundred men killed or wounded,
+and two thousand three hundred taken prisoners, of whom fifteen
+hundred were Pierce's brigade; and eight hundred Portuguese, who
+were cut off by the cavalry.</p>
+<p>Among the prisoners were the Earl of Barrimore, all the officers
+of Pierce's brigade, Lord Pawlet, one of the earl's aides-de-camp,
+two of his pages, and his master of horse.</p>
+<p>After the battle was over, and Desmond had rejoined the marshal,
+he was sent to ride over the field, and ascertain who had fallen
+and what prisoners had been taken. Night was already coming on,
+and, after fulfilling his mission as far as was possible in the
+confusion, he came upon two Spanish soldiers, with a prisoner.</p>
+<p>"Whom have you there?" he asked, in Spanish.</p>
+<p>"I don't know, sir. We found him lying under his horse, which,
+in its fall, had so pinned down his leg that he could not escape.
+Several others had fallen round him, and it was only when we heard
+a cry for help that we turned the dead horse over, and found him
+under it, and then got him out."</p>
+<p>Standing close, there was light enough for Desmond to
+distinguish the prisoner's features. He gave a slight start of
+surprise, then he said:</p>
+<p>"You have done well, my men. Here is a doubloon, to get some
+drink with your comrades when you get into the town. I will look
+after the prisoner."</p>
+<p>The men saluted and went off, well pleased to have got rid of
+the trouble of marching their prisoner into the town. Mike, rather
+surprised, moved up to take charge of the captive.</p>
+<p>"My lord," Desmond said, "I will now endeavour to repay the
+kindness you showed me.</p>
+<p>"Do you see that little hut, Mike, just at the edge of those
+trees? You must hide the earl there. Our cavalry are still all over
+the country, hunting down fugitives."</p>
+<p>The earl, who was scarcely able to walk, his leg having been
+injured by the weight of the horse upon it, murmured his thanks,
+but did not speak again until they had entered the shed, when
+Desmond said:</p>
+<p>"Now, General, I will first cut down your riding boot, to ease
+your leg. Then, if you will lie down in that corner, we will pile
+this firewood over you. It will not be safe for you to attempt to
+go forward for two or three hours yet. I have a report to make to
+Marshal de Bay. When I have handed it in, I will return at
+once.</p>
+<p>"Mike, do you stay near the hut, and if any searching party
+should come along, which is scarcely likely, for they have all gone
+farther afield, you can say there is no need to search the hut, as
+you, with an officer, have already examined it."</p>
+<p>In a few minutes, the earl was completely hidden. Desmond then
+rode into Badajos, and delivered his report to the marshal. He then
+went to the stables, took out his spare horse, and, leading it,
+rode out to the hut again.</p>
+<p>"Has anyone been here?" he asked Mike.</p>
+<p>"Not a soul, sir."</p>
+<p>"Take the horses into the wood, then, and stay with them for the
+present. It will not be safe for the earl to move for a couple of
+hours.</p>
+<p>"Now, General," he went on, as he removed the firewood, "I fear
+that you have been very uncomfortable."</p>
+<p>"I can hardly say that I have been comfortable, sir, but that is
+of no consequence. The pain in my leg has abated, since you cut the
+boot open.</p>
+<p>"And now, how can I express my gratitude to you, for thus
+sheltering me?"</p>
+<p>"It is but a fair return of services, sir. You gave me my
+liberty, and I am doing my best to restore yours to you."</p>
+<p>"It is all very well to say that, Captain Kennedy. I am the
+general in command of the British forces in Portugal, and had I
+chosen to openly release you, none could have questioned me. It was
+only because some magnified report of the affair might have reached
+the ears of the Portuguese Government, and given rise to rumours
+hostile to me, that I thought it best to let it appear to be an
+accidental escape. You see, I am by no means popular with the
+Portuguese. In the first place, I am a Protestant; and in the next
+place, I am constantly bringing pressure to bear upon them, as to
+the supply of provisions, the making of roads, the proper feeding
+and arming of their own troops, and other matters of the same kind;
+and they would be only too glad to have some cause of complaint
+against me.</p>
+<p>"But your case is altogether different, for you are risking even
+your life in thus aiding me to escape."</p>
+<p>"That may be, General, but it was nevertheless my duty, as a
+matter of conscience, to endeavour to return the kindness that you
+showed me; and as, at present, your army will hardly be in a state
+to take the field against us for a long time, I do not feel that I
+am seriously injuring our cause."</p>
+<p>"Well, sir, I shall be your debtor for life.</p>
+<p>"Do you intend to remain always an exile, Captain Kennedy?" the
+Earl of Galway went on. "It seems to me little short of madness
+that so many gallant gentlemen should cut themselves altogether
+adrift from their native country, and pass their lives fighting as
+mercenaries. I do not use the word offensively, but only in its
+proper meaning, of foreigners serving in the army of a nation not
+their own. Nor do I mean to insult Irish gentlemen, by even hinting
+that they serve simply for pay. They fight for France mainly in the
+hope that France will some day aid in setting James Stuart on the
+British throne; a forlorn hope, for although Louis may encourage
+the hopes of the Stuarts and their followers, by patronizing their
+cause, which it suits him to do because it gives him the means of
+striking at England, by effecting a landing in Scotland or Ireland;
+it is yet a matter upon which he must be indifferent, save in his
+own interest, and in the advantage it gives him of keeping in his
+service some dozen or so splendid regiments, on whose valour he can
+always rely."</p>
+<p>"That is true, sir," Desmond replied; "and I own I have no great
+hope that, by the means of French assistance, the Stuarts will
+regain their throne. But what could I do if I were to return to
+Ireland? Beyond the fact that my name is Kennedy, I am in absolute
+ignorance as to what branch of that family I belong to, and have
+practically not a friend in the country. Were I to land in Ireland,
+I have no means of earning my living, and should doubtless be
+denounced as one who had served in the Irish Brigade. I own that I
+should be glad to return there, for a time, in order to make
+enquiries as to my family. I was but sixteen when I left, and was
+kept, as it seems to me, purposely, in total ignorance on the
+subject. It may be that I was the son of a brave officer of that
+name, who certainly came over to France soon after I was born, and
+fell fighting some years before I came out; but I have no proof
+that it was so, and would give a great deal to be able to ascertain
+it.</p>
+<p>"In Ireland they think a great deal of genealogy, and I am often
+questioned, by Irishmen of old descent, as to my family; and find
+it extremely awkward to be obliged to own that I know nothing of
+it, with any certainty. I have no desire to pass my life in battles
+and sieges, and, if I survive the risks and perils, to settle down
+as a Frenchman with an Irish name."</p>
+<p>"That I can well understand," the earl said. "'Tis a life that
+no man could desire, for it would certainly be a wasted one. I can
+assure you that I think the chance of James Stuart, or his
+descendants, gaining the throne of England is remote in the
+extreme. When William of Orange came over, there was no standing
+army, and as James the Second had rendered himself extremely
+unpopular by his Catholic leanings, he became possessed of England
+without opposition, and of Ireland by means of his Dutch troops.
+The matter is entirely changed, now. England has a strong army,
+against which a gathering, however strong, of undisciplined men
+could have but little chance. I conceive it possible that a
+Catholic Stuart might regain the throne of Ireland, if backed by a
+French army, and if the people were supplied with French arms and
+money. But that he would retain the throne, after the French were
+withdrawn, I regard as next to impossible."</p>
+<p>"I cannot but think the same, sir. However, as I see no chance
+of my being able to go to Ireland, even to push my enquiries as to
+my family, there is nothing for it but to remain a soldier of
+France."</p>
+<p>"In that matter, I might assist you, Captain Kennedy. I have no
+doubt that my influence, and that of my friends in England, would
+without difficulty suffice to gain permission for you to visit
+Ireland on private business, on my undertaking that you have no
+political object whatever in desiring to do so, and that you engage
+yourself to enter into no plots or schemes for a rising.
+Furthermore, I think I can promise that, if you succeed in your
+researches, and find that you have relations and friends there, I
+could, if you desire it, obtain a revocation of any pains and
+penalties you may have incurred, and a restoration of all your
+rights as an Irishman. That is certainly the least I can do, after
+the vital service that you have rendered me--a service that, in
+itself, shows you do not share in the bitter enmity so many of your
+countrymen, unfortunately, feel against England."</p>
+<p>"I have no such enmity, assuredly," Desmond said. "The choice of
+coming out here, to enter the service of France, was not of my own
+making; but was made, for some reason which I have never been able
+to understand, by the gentleman who had borne the expenses of my
+bringing up, but who was himself a strong supporter of the English
+rule, and therefore would have been expected to place every
+obstacle in the way of my entering the Irish Brigade."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch18" id="Ch18">Chapter 18</a>: War.</h2>
+<p>After hearing Desmond's story the earl asked several questions,
+and obtained further details of his life when a boy, and of his
+interview with John O'Carroll.</p>
+<p>"It is certainly strange," he said thoughtfully, "and worth
+enquiring into, for it would seem that he must have some interest
+in thus getting you out of the way, and in your entering a service
+that would render it next to impossible that you should ever return
+to your native land."</p>
+<p>"I don't see any possible interest that he could have had in
+that, sir; but, certainly, I have never been able to account for
+his conduct."</p>
+<p>"It is clear that there is some mystery about it," the earl said
+warmly, "and were I you, I should certainly take leave of absence,
+for a time, and go over and get to the bottom of the matter. At any
+rate, I will at once write to London and obtain a safe conduct for
+you. This you can use, or not, as you may decide, and can then, if
+you so please, return and continue your service here.</p>
+<p>"Methinks that the war will not last very much longer. France is
+impoverished, the disasters which have befallen her arms in
+Flanders have rendered the war unpopular, and in England, in spite
+of the success gained by their arms, the heavy taxation is making
+men ask why a war should be continued which may benefit Holland,
+and the German allies, but can result in no good to England.</p>
+<p>"And now, Captain Kennedy, I will be making my way to join the
+remains of my army. I thank you again, most heartily, for your
+generous conduct; and, believe me, you may always command my
+services in any direction. I only regret that these unhappy
+political difficulties should drive you, and so many of your brave
+countrymen, into the service of a power that has always been, and
+so far as I can see is likely to remain, an enemy of England."</p>
+<p>"I may say, sir, that Lord Godolphin has, for a certain reason,
+promised to befriend me; and that, if you write to him on the
+subject of a safe conduct, I think I could rely upon his taking a
+favourable view of the matter."</p>
+<p>"I will do so, certainly," the earl said. "His power is great.
+If he is favourably disposed towards you, you may consider the
+matter as done."</p>
+<p>They chatted for some time longer, and then Desmond said:</p>
+<p>"I think now, sir, that it would be safe to move. Everything is
+perfectly quiet without, and I have no doubt that, by this time,
+the cavalry have all returned to Badajos. However, I will accompany
+you for a short distance, for you may be stopped by some of our
+advance posts. You had best take the cloak and hat of my follower,
+and, as I am well known, no questions will then be asked."</p>
+<p>"By the way," Lord Galway added as, Mike having brought up the
+horses, he mounted; "where shall I send a letter to you, with your
+safe conduct? We are in communication with many persons at Madrid,
+and can pass a letter through the lines at any time."</p>
+<p>"When there, I lodge at the house of Don Pedro Sarasta, in the
+Calle del Retiro. I will request him to forward any letters to me,
+should I be absent."</p>
+<p>The earl made a note of the address in his pocketbook, and then,
+putting on Mike's cloak and hat, started with Desmond, who passed
+him without question through the lines of outposts; which were
+indeed but carelessly kept, as it was certain that, after the
+signal victory that had been gained, it would be a long time before
+any enemy would venture to attack them.</p>
+<p>Two days after the fight, the Marquis de Bay moved forward with
+his army, with the intention of fighting another battle; but Galway
+and Frontiera had, by this time, reorganized their forces, and
+occupied so strong a position, near Elvas, that he could not
+venture to attack them. However, he occupied the country for a
+considerable distance beyond the frontier, subsisting his army upon
+the provisions and forage collected by his cavalry in the villages
+and small towns. As it was evident that, after the proof given of
+the inability of the Portuguese to withstand any attack, there was
+no probability of offensive operations being renewed by the allies;
+and, the heat becoming intense, the force was withdrawn across the
+frontier and went into quarters, the general returning to Madrid,
+where he received an enthusiastic welcome from the inhabitants.</p>
+<p>By this time, however, the knowledge that the king of France was
+entering into negotiations, which would necessitate his desertion
+of Spain, greatly excited the population against the French
+stationed in the capital. They were hissed and hooted when they
+appeared in the streets, and for a time, the indignation was so
+great that the troops were ordered to remain in their barracks. The
+king himself, however, gained rather than lost popularity, as he
+issued a proclamation to the people, saying that, having accepted
+their invitation to be their king, he would remain with them until
+driven from his throne by force; and he confided absolutely in
+their affection, and aid, to enable him to withstand any foes who
+might attempt to dethrone him.</p>
+<p>In the autumn another change occurred. Although, in order to
+obtain peace, he had granted all the demands, however exorbitant,
+of the allies, and had undertaken to withdraw his troops from
+Spain, Louis stood firm when to these conditions they added
+another, namely, that he should himself undertake, by force, to
+dethrone his grandson. This monstrous demand united, at once, both
+those who wished to continue the war rather than grant such
+humiliating terms as those which had been insisted upon, and the
+party who were in favour of peace, even at that cost. The
+negotiations were abruptly broken off, and the French troops, who
+were already on the march towards the frontier, received orders to
+remain in Spain.</p>
+<p>Now that he had O'Neil with him, the time in Madrid passed more
+pleasantly for Desmond than before. He was frequently away for
+several days, carrying despatches to the commanders of the forces
+in Valencia and Barcelona. In the capital the French were again
+regarded as friends, and as several successes had been gained and
+places captured, in Catalonia, the hope that the civil war that had
+so long been waged was approaching its end, and the confidence
+engendered by the victory on the Caya, made the people doubt
+whether any attempt at invasion from the west would be
+contemplated, and they gave themselves up to gaiety. Balls and
+fetes were frequently organized, and at these the French were among
+the most honoured guests.</p>
+<p>Early in the spring preparations were made for active
+operations. Lieutenant General O'Mahony had just returned from
+Sicily, where he had rendered distinguished service. In the
+previous year, Crofton had been made a major general, and two new
+regiments of Irish infantry had been formed, of deserters from the
+enemy in Catalonia and Portugal. These were commanded by Colonel
+Dermond M'Auliffe and Colonel John Comerford. These two regiments,
+with another under Colonel Macdonald, marched from Madrid in
+April.</p>
+<p>As the Marquis de Bay was not yet moving he offered O'Mahony,
+who had the command of the force, the services of Desmond and
+O'Neil as aides-de-camp. The offer was a welcome one, for, as none
+of the men in the newly raised regiments was acquainted with the
+language, Desmond, who now spoke Spanish well, would be far more
+valuable to him than Spanish officers could be.</p>
+<p>For two months the little force moved about in Catalonia, the
+rapidity of its marches baffling the attempts of the archduke's
+forces to interfere with its operations. These were principally
+directed against various small fortresses, held by partisans of
+Charles. Several of these were captured, thus clearing the roads
+they guarded, and opening the country for the more important
+operations that Philip himself was about to undertake.</p>
+<p>It was not until July that the royal army approached Lerida,
+where O'Mahony's force joined it. General Stanhope marched, with
+the troops under his command, and encamped at Balaguer; where he
+was joined by Baron de Wetzel, with some troops which had been
+brought from Italy. As Stanhope's force was insufficient to give
+battle until joined by the main army of Charles, he marched, on the
+31st of July, headed by two English and two Dutch regiments of
+dragoons, to secure the passes near Alfaro, and so check the
+advance of the Spaniards.</p>
+<p>After performing a long and difficult march, they took up a
+defensive position. Stanhope found, however, that the river in
+front of him was so low that cavalry and artillery could pass
+easily, and even infantry could cross without difficulty. Scarcely
+had he taken up his position when two brigades of infantry and
+nineteen squadrons of cavalry were seen approaching, having been
+detached from the Spanish army to occupy the position which had
+been secured by the rapidity of Stanhope's march. They therefore
+waited for their main army to come up, but before it did so, the
+whole of Stanhope's force had arrived, and was prepared for
+battle.</p>
+<p>Although it was past six o'clock in the evening, Charles, on his
+arrival, decided to fall upon the enemy before they could encamp,
+which they might do in a position in which it would be difficult to
+attack them. Fourteen cannon at once opened fire from an eminence,
+whence they commanded the position taken up by the advance force of
+the Spaniards. This position was on low ground in front of the
+ridge upon which the village of Almenara stood, and nothing could
+be seen of the force that lay behind this ridge.</p>
+<p>The advanced force of Spaniards ascended this ridge, as soon as
+the artillery opened upon them, and General Stanhope obtained leave
+from Marshal Staremberg, who commanded the archduke's army, to
+charge them. With ten squadrons of horse he rode up the ascent, and
+there, when he gained it, saw to his surprise twenty-two squadrons
+facing him, flanked with infantry, and supported with another line
+of cavalry equally strong. He sent back at once for fourteen
+squadrons from his second line, and when six of these came up he
+advanced against the Spaniards, who at the same time moved forward
+to meet him.</p>
+<p>The cavalry on Philip's left at once gave way. The centre and
+right, aided by the fire of the infantry, made a stout fight, but
+were driven back by the English and Dutch cavalry. The fighting was
+severe, for of the six English squadrons who charged, two hundred
+men and twenty-one officers were killed or wounded.</p>
+<p>Philip's second line of cavalry gave but feeble support, and
+Stanhope's horse soon had them all in confusion, and, driving them
+from the field, pursued them hotly. The fugitives dashed into their
+own infantry, who were just arriving in force, and their panic
+communicated itself to them, and a total rout took place. The
+pursuit was kept up until it was so dark that the troopers were
+unable to see each other's faces, and they then halted, having
+defeated the Spanish without the aid of their infantry, which had
+not come up in time to take any part in the fight. Much of the
+baggage, together with tents, many cannon, and a quantity of
+ammunition, fell into the hands of the victors. Owing to the
+darkness, the number of prisoners taken was small.</p>
+<p>O'Mahony and his troops had taken no part in the engagement, as,
+having arrived late on the previous evening after a long march,
+they were still at Lerida. It had not been deemed necessary to
+hurry them forward, as no battle was expected to take place for
+some days--as, indeed, would have been the case had the force sent
+forward arrived at the river before Stanhope.</p>
+<p>The routed troops arrived under the shelter of the guns of
+Lerida. Charles did not attack them there, but, making a detour,
+seized several places in Aragon, with the intention of cutting the
+line by which Philip would probably retire, and forcing him to
+fight again. Philip, however, on his part, marched from Lerida in
+order to retire into Castile by way of Saragossa. Charles followed
+hotly, and a portion of his cavalry came up to the rear of the
+enemy in the defile of Penalva. Here the Spaniards posted a strong
+force of grenadiers, and the defile being too narrow for the
+cavalry to act, these dismounted, and a hot fight took place, in
+which both parties claimed the victory. However, Philip retired the
+same day in great haste. Charles, arriving three hours later, ate
+the dinner that had been prepared for his rival.</p>
+<p>The Spaniards, covered by the defence of the pass, crossed the
+Ebro and posted themselves in a strong position within a mile of
+Saragossa. On the 21st of August Marshal Staremberg, with his
+generals, having reconnoitred their position, gave orders for the
+attack to take place the next morning, and at daybreak the cannon
+on both sides opened fire. General Stanhope, who commanded on the
+left wing, found that the enemy had the greater part of their
+cavalry facing him, and therefore strengthened his force by four
+battalions of foot and six squadrons of Portuguese horse.</p>
+<p>The Spanish line ran obliquely, from the river on their left to
+a steep hill on their right, occupied by their cavalry and a
+battery of artillery. These, therefore, were much nearer to the
+attacking force than were those on the plain.</p>
+<p>The battle began at twelve o'clock, Charles's force marching in
+two lines, with the exception of Stanhope's cavalry and infantry.
+These, from their situation, were the first to come in contact with
+the enemy. The four battalions first pushed forward up the hill,
+and, driving the Spanish cavalry back, allowed Stanhope's horse to
+ascend the hill and form on its crest. The battle speedily ranged
+along the whole line. The Spaniards, with superior numbers, gained
+ground on their left. Here O'Mahony's corps were stationed, and
+they drove a portion of the allies across the Ebro again; but this
+success was more than counterbalanced on the other flank, where
+Stanhope's cavalry and infantry carried all before them. The
+latter, posted in a hollow, opened so heavy a fire upon the Spanish
+infantry, as they advanced, that they fell into disorder; and as
+their cavalry were driven off, hotly pursued by Stanhope, they fell
+back upon the centre, which they threw into disorder. Seeing that
+the battle was lost, the Marquis de Bay gave the order to
+retire.</p>
+<p>Two hours after the first shot was fired, the rout of the
+Spanish centre and right was complete, but a considerable portion
+of the troops were rallied by de Bay at Alagon, three leagues above
+Saragossa. The left wing, under Generals Amezaga and O'Mahony, were
+checked in their course of victory by the disaster which befell the
+centre and right; but, maintaining their discipline, they fell back
+in good order, and rejoined their defeated comrades at Alagon.</p>
+<p>All the cannon and most of the colours of the regiments forming
+the centre and right fell into the hands of the victors. The loss
+of the allies was about two thousand men, killed or wounded; and
+that of the Spaniards and French three thousand killed and wounded,
+and between five and six thousand prisoners. Philip rode at once to
+Madrid, and on the evening of the battle the archduke entered
+Saragossa; while de Bay retired, with the broken remains of his
+troops, towards Navarre.</p>
+<p>Desmond and O'Neil, who had ridden behind O'Mahony, saw the
+Spanish troops of the archduke yield before the impetuous attacks
+of the Irish regiments, who, as they pressed their foes backwards,
+burst into loud cheering, believing the victory already won.
+Presently, O'Mahony stopped the advance.</p>
+<p>"We must not push too far forward," he said. "It seems to me
+that things are not going so well in other directions. Our centre
+is being pressed back. What is going on on the right I cannot say,
+but the enemy seems to have gained the top of the hill, for our
+cannon there are silent. If the centre is driven back, those we
+have now beaten will rally, and we shall be taken in flank by the
+fire of their centre. Therefore, let us be content with what we
+have done, and wait and see how things turn out elsewhere."</p>
+<p>Even before the rout of the Spanish right, their centre was
+yielding, for opposed to them were the British and Dutch regiments,
+whose attack they were altogether unable to withstand. It soon
+became clear that, at all other points on the field, the battle was
+going against the Spaniards, and an aide-de-camp presently rode up,
+hastily, with orders from Marshal de Bay for his left to fall back
+and retire to Alagon.</p>
+<p>Deep was the rage and disappointment among the troops of
+O'Mahony and Amezaga, as they faced about and set out on their
+march. They were unmolested. The troops they had beaten were in no
+disposition to follow them, while the allied cavalry and the
+infantry of their centre were in full pursuit of the rest of
+Philip's army, the remnants of which the little force joined, at
+Alagon, before nightfall.</p>
+<p>It was some days before the archduke's army moved forward again.
+The troops were exhausted by the long marches they had made, and
+there was a difference of opinion among the generals as to the
+course that had best be followed. The king wished to pursue the
+beaten enemy and, if possible, to intercept their march towards
+France, but Count Staremberg and Stanhope were of opinion that they
+should first occupy Madrid, and then march into Navarre, so as to
+bar the advance of fresh French troops into Spain, and at the same
+time open communications by sea with England, whence they could be
+supplied with reinforcements and stores of provisions.</p>
+<p>Finally, Charles gave way, and the allies marched towards
+Madrid. The main portion of the army halted at Alcala, a day's
+march from the capital, and General Stanhope marched on with his
+division to Madrid, which opened its gates without resistance,
+Philip having retired with his army. Charles entered the city on
+the 28th of September, 1710.</p>
+<p>The alarm, in France, at the news of the defeat at Saragossa was
+great, and Louis at once despatched the Duke of Vendome to command
+there. The latter, travelling fast, and gathering up the garrisons
+of the towns through which he passed, crossed the frontier at
+nearly the same time as Charles entered Madrid, and effected a
+junction with de Bay's army; which had, by this time, been
+increased by some fourteen thousand men, drawn from the garrisons
+of towns in Navarre, Castile, Galicia, and Valencia.</p>
+<p>Vendome had no doubt that the intention of the allies, in
+marching upon Madrid, was to open communication with the
+Portuguese, and determined to throw himself between the capital and
+the frontier. Marching with all speed, he encamped near Salamanca
+on the 6th of October, and thence moved to Plasencia, thereby
+securing the bridge of Almarez, and preventing the Portuguese from
+joining Charles.</p>
+<p>Had it not been for the usual indecision and want of energy on
+the part of the Portuguese Government, the junction might have been
+effected before Vendome arrived at Plasencia, for both Charles and
+Stanhope had, after the victory of Saragossa, written urgently,
+begging that the Portuguese army should at once advance and join
+them at Madrid; and that, at any rate, if the whole army could not
+move, at least the troops in the pay of England should push forward
+instantly. Stanhope, indeed had marched with his division to the
+bridge of Almarez to facilitate the junction, and had defeated a
+Spanish force guarding the bridge. However, the Portuguese did not
+arrive; and when a messenger brought the alarming news that a
+Spanish and French army had occupied Plasencia, Stanhope fell back
+towards Madrid.</p>
+<p>As large French reinforcements were known to be approaching the
+frontier, and Philip's army was already much superior in numbers to
+that of the allies, it was decided, in a council of war, to
+evacuate Madrid. The forces which had occupied Toledo and other
+towns were recalled, and, early in December, the army left the
+capital; the archduke riding at once to Barcelona, while the army,
+of which Stanhope's division formed the rear guard, followed in the
+same direction.</p>
+<p>The movement had been delayed too long. Vendome and Philip were
+already at hand, and on the 9th fell upon Stanhope's division at
+Brihuega. This force, consisting of eight English battalions and
+the same number of Portuguese horse, defended themselves
+desperately, and although the town was wholly without
+fortifications, they repulsed every attack until their ammunition
+was exhausted, and they were then forced to surrender. Staremberg,
+on hearing that Stanhope was attacked and surrounded, turned back
+and marched with all speed to relieve him, but on arriving within
+three hours' march of the town, heard that he had surrendered.</p>
+<p>The Duke of Vendome, hearing of his coming, drew his troops out
+and formed them in line of battle, and the next morning attacked
+him vigorously. The allied right held their ground, but the left
+fled, and Vendome swept his right round and took the centre and
+right of the allies in the rear. Three battalions of the second
+line, however, fell in turn upon the French rear and repulsed them,
+and the left wing, rallying again, renewed the battle.</p>
+<p>The combat was indecisive, both parties claiming the victory.
+Staremberg wrote to Charles that he had captured all the enemy's
+guns, and had killed six thousand of them; while the French claimed
+that they had totally defeated the allies, and captured all their
+cannon, killed four thousand, and taken nine thousand prisoners.
+The balance of probability lies to some extent with the French, for
+the day after the battle, Staremberg retired and marched to
+Barcelona; but the fact that he was not at once pursued shows that
+the French and Spaniards must have suffered very heavily.</p>
+<p>Desmond had passed unscathed through the battle of Saragossa.
+O'Neil had been severely wounded, but had managed to sit his horse
+until the division effected its junction with the Marquis de Bay's
+shattered forces. Great was the wrath among the two Irish regiments
+at the issue of the battle.</p>
+<p>"What is the use," an officer said to Desmond, "of our throwing
+away our lives, fighting for these Spaniards, when they themselves
+are useless, save when they meet the Portuguese, who are still more
+contemptible? Here have we, on level ground, fairly beaten the
+enemy, while the right and centre, although having a great
+advantage in position, allow themselves to be scattered like a
+flock of sheep."</p>
+<p>"They had stouter foes to meet than we had," Desmond said. "We
+had only Spaniards opposed to us, while they had English and Dutch
+to fight; and as the best French troops have found, in Flanders,
+that these were at least a match for them, we must not blame the
+Spanish too severely for giving way before they were attacked."</p>
+<p>"There is something in that, I admit, Kennedy. It seems to me
+that, in this war, it would be much better if the Spaniards and
+Portuguese had both remained at home, and allowed the French and us
+fight it out with the English and Dutch. The battles would have
+been small, but at least they would have been desperately
+fought."</p>
+<p>"But it would be absurd, Moore, for us to lay down our lives in
+a struggle in which those principally concerned took no part
+whatever, and which was of no great interest either to us or to the
+English. After the way in which Louis was ready to throw over Spain
+and Philip at the beginning of the year, the Spanish alliance can
+be of no great advantage to him, and I do not think that even
+Philip's orders would induce a Spanish army to march across the
+frontier to assist France. Therefore, as Louis can gain nothing by
+the Spanish alliance, why should he weaken himself by sending
+forces here to maintain Philip on the throne?"</p>
+<p>"But with the Archduke Charles here, he would have an enemy on
+his frontier. Philip might not assist him, but Charles would be
+actively hostile. The English and Dutch troops would be pouring
+into the peninsula, and we should have another Flanders in the
+south of France."</p>
+<p>"Well," Desmond said, after a pause; "the best way I can see out
+of it is for both Philip and Charles to withdraw, and allow the
+Spanish to elect a Spaniard for their king; or, if they could not
+agree to that, which I don't suppose they could do, choose some
+foreign prince belonging to a petty state which stands altogether
+aloof from European affairs, and seat him on the throne. If, again,
+they would not accept him, England and France should mutually agree
+not to interfere in the affair, and let the Spaniards indulge in
+civil war as long as it pleases them."</p>
+<p>Moore laughed.</p>
+<p>"It might be a good solution, Kennedy, but there is no more
+chance of Philip or Charles renouncing their pretensions, or indeed
+of the French on one side and the allies on the other permitting
+them to do so, than there is of the world becoming an utopia, where
+war shall be unknown, and all peoples live together in peace and
+amity."</p>
+<p>"Well," Desmond said, "for my part, I am sick of fighting in
+quarrels that do not concern me, and when this campaign comes to an
+end I shall, if possible, rejoin Berwick. The cause of the Stuarts
+is not advanced, in the slightest, by what is taking place in
+Spain, and if I am to fight, I would rather do so where victory
+would benefit us."</p>
+<p>"I don't know that you are not right," the other assented. "It
+certainly seems a pity that the best blood of Ireland should be
+spilled, in Flanders and Spain, in the service of a foreign
+country. To my mind, the terms of the surrender of Limerick were
+disadvantageous both to Ireland and England. England has gained a
+number of inveterate foes who, with good and wise treatment, might
+now be fighting in her own ranks. Ireland has lost her best blood,
+men who were her natural leaders, and belonged to the old families,
+whom all respected."</p>
+<p>"I am sure it was a mistake," Desmond said. "If the terms had
+been an absolute equality in all matters of religion, and the free
+pardon of all, without confiscation of their property or other
+disability, it would have gone far to reconcile our people to
+defeat; for they would have seen that they could not hope for more
+than the right of free exercise of their religion, if the Stuarts
+came to the throne again."</p>
+<p>"Perhaps you are right, Kennedy. I know that I myself, had it
+not been for the persecutions and the priest hunting, and the
+closing of our chapels, should never have thought of leaving
+Ireland and taking foreign service. But now there is no going
+back."</p>
+<p>"No, I suppose not," Desmond said, gloomily. "Nothing short of
+an amnesty, ensuring freedom of worship, and perfect civil equality
+to all, would induce the majority of us to return to Ireland; and,
+indeed, it is not easy to see what we could do if we got there. The
+estates of our fathers are in the hands of strangers. We should
+soon be altogether without resources, and we should be almost
+driven to conspire again, even though success would in no way mend
+the matter.</p>
+<p>"However, there is no chance of such an act being passed, for,
+even if the English Ministry desired to do so, the Protestant
+feeling in England and Scotland would be too strong for them; and
+Parliament, which strongly represents that feeling, would reject
+the bill by an immense majority."</p>
+<p>"Then there is nothing to do but to go on fighting," Moore
+said.</p>
+<p>"I see nothing else for it, Moore, but I own that I do not care
+for the life. I have had three years of it now, and don't like the
+prospect of another thirty."</p>
+<p>"You have been fortunate, too, Kennedy!"</p>
+<p>"Yes, I have been fortunate in the way of getting promotion;
+fortunate that I was not, long before this, put under the sod; but
+it is no great gratification to be a captain, and though in another
+thirty years, if I live, I may be a general, I don't think even
+that would reconcile me to the life. It is just as hard, and a good
+deal more responsible; and if thirty years passed over, and the
+Stuarts were not restored, they assuredly never would be, and I
+should have wasted my life for nothing."</p>
+<p>"Well, I am very glad," Moore laughed, "that all our fellows do
+not look at it in the same light as you do, but take things as they
+come. I don't bother myself about the future."</p>
+<p>"It is a good thing," Desmond said, "and it is the national
+character to take things as they come. I dare say I shall get into
+the same way, some day, but just at present, I suppose partly
+because we have got a thrashing, I feel rather down in the
+dumps."</p>
+<p>Desmond continued his duties as aide-de-camp to O'Mahony, and
+took his share in the various operations, that ended with the army
+going into winter quarters and Philip making a triumphant entry
+into Madrid. Then he went to the general.</p>
+<p>"General, I wish to ask leave to return to France, at any rate
+for a time. The Duke of Berwick, when he despatched me to join the
+staff of the Duke of Orleans, said he would reinstate me on his
+staff as soon as the duke no longer required my services. When the
+Duke of Orleans left, I was handed over with the rest of the staff
+to the Marshal de Bay, under whom I served in the battle of the
+Guadiana, and until, as you know, I was detailed to accompany your
+brigade. Now that the campaign is over, I should, at any rate, like
+to pay a visit to the Duke of Berwick, under whom I served at
+Oudenarde. I have, therefore, come to ask you to dispense with my
+services, and to permit me to return to France."</p>
+<p>"Certainly, Captain Kennedy. Your assistance has been of great
+value to me, but there is no chance of anything being done during
+the winter; and, as many of my officers are now beginning to speak
+Spanish, they will, should they remain here till the spring, be
+able to get on very fairly. I shall be pleased, before you start,
+to furnish you with a testimonial stating the services you have
+rendered me. Indeed, I have, more than once, mentioned them in my
+reports."</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch19" id="Ch19">Chapter 19</a>: In Search of a
+Family.</h2>
+<p>On the following day, Desmond left the brigade, and, followed by
+Mike, rode for Madrid, where was still lying a letter which had
+arrived, some months before, from England. He had not asked for it
+to be forwarded, for if he had been killed, and it had been found
+on him, it might do his memory a great disservice, as it would seem
+that he had been in correspondence with the British. The letter,
+which contained an enclosure, was, to his surprise, from Lord
+Godolphin. It ran:</p>
+<p>Dear Captain Kennedy:</p>
+<p>Partly at the request of the Earl of Galway, and still more from
+my own remembrance of your conduct, in that affair you know of, and
+of the silence that you maintained concerning it, I have pleasure
+in sending you a safe conduct to visit Ireland on private affairs.
+The earl tells me that you have rendered him the greatest of
+services, and this alone should cancel the fact that you have been
+serving against us in Flanders and Spain. For this, and your
+conduct to myself, I can promise you that should you, at any time
+while I am in power, decide to remain in Ireland, I will obtain for
+you a full and complete pardon, and a restoration to all your
+rights as an Irish subject of the queen. I will also obtain a
+reversal of any attainders or acts of confiscation that may have
+been passed against your family, on your giving your promise that
+you will not take part in any secret plots or conspiracies against
+the reigning family, though, in the event of a general rising in
+Ireland, with the assistance perhaps of a French army, you would be
+at liberty to choose your own course of action, without incurring
+more pains and penalties than those which might befall any native
+of Ireland waging war against the queen.</p>
+<p>As both Godolphin and Marlborough were known to be by no means
+unfavourably disposed to the cause of the Stuarts, Desmond was
+hardly surprised at the latter part of this intimation. Though he
+had but small hopes of being enabled to remain permanently at home,
+it was yet very welcome to him. Certainly, if he remained in
+Ireland he would consider himself bound to hold himself aloof from
+all Jacobite plots, although, if the country rose and a French army
+landed, he would, unless he considered the cause a hopeless one,
+draw his sword on behalf of him whom he considered as his lawful
+sovereign.</p>
+<p>"It is not sorry I am, your honour, to be turning my back on
+this country," Mike said, as they rode out from the gate. "The wine
+is good, which is more than I can say for anything else in it,
+except that the people are good Catholics."</p>
+<p>"I am starting a longer journey than you think, Mike. I am only
+going to the duke, now, to ask for a year's leave; though I do not
+think that I shall be absent more than a few months."</p>
+<p>"And where are you going, your honour, if I may make so bold as
+to ask?"</p>
+<p>"I am going to Ireland, Mike."</p>
+<p>Mike looked at him with astonishment.</p>
+<p>"To Ireland, your honour? Sure they will hang you, before you
+set your foot a week in the country."</p>
+<p>"I have obtained a safe conduct, Mike, from Lord Godolphin. You
+remember him, the nobleman we kidnapped?"</p>
+<p>"Sure I remember him, your honour; and he has given you a safe
+conduct? It is in luck you are, to be going back to Ireland
+again."</p>
+<p>"It is not a visit of pleasure, Mike. I am going over to try to
+ascertain to which branch of my family I belong."</p>
+<p>"And what can it matter, your honour? It's a good name you have
+made for yourself out here."</p>
+<p>"I have done well enough, Mike, but I am tired of being asked,
+by almost every officer I meet, about my family, when in fact I
+know nothing myself."</p>
+<p>"Well, Captain, it does not seem to me worth troubling about,
+for if you don't know who they are, it is little they can have done
+for you."</p>
+<p>"It would seem so, Mike. There is a mystery about the whole
+affair, and I want to get to the bottom of it."</p>
+<p>He rode silently for some distance. He knew that Mike would go
+through fire and water for him, and that, simple as he seemed, he
+had no ordinary amount of shrewdness; and he determined to tell him
+all he knew, especially as he intended to take him to Ireland with
+him.</p>
+<p>"Mike," he said at last, "I suppose you would like to pay a
+visit to Ireland, also?"</p>
+<p>"I should that," Mike said, emphatically. "I was but eighteen
+when I came out here to enlist in the brigade--that is twelve years
+ago now, and it is few people would be likely to know me
+again."</p>
+<p>"Well, I am thinking of taking you with me, Mike; and, as
+possibly you may be of use in my search, I will tell you my
+story."</p>
+<p>And he related the history of his youth.</p>
+<p>"He must be an unfeeling baste, to treat you like that," Mike
+exclaimed indignantly. "Sure I know the name, and have heard him
+spoken of as a traitor who had gone over to the enemy, and turned
+Protestant to save his estate."</p>
+<p>"That is how you would hear him spoken of, Mike, for it is true;
+but as to his treatment of me, it all depends whether I was forced
+upon him by threats, or was taken by him out of friendship to my
+father. If it were the first of these reasons, he cannot be blamed
+for keeping me at a distance. If the second, he certainly ought to
+have behaved differently. But neither explains why he, a supporter
+of the usurper, should have sent me out to France to fight against
+the English. It is a hard nut to crack."</p>
+<p>Mike agreed. "Mighty hard; but your honour will get to the
+bottom of it, never fear. And why are we going to the duke,
+master?"</p>
+<p>"To get leave of absence. I cannot disappear suddenly, without
+asking for leave. I shall, of course, tell the Duke of Berwick
+exactly why I am going, and I feel sure he will grant my request,
+without hesitation. There is no fighting to be done, just at
+present, and even if there were, one officer more or less would
+make no difference.</p>
+<p>"Have you any relations in Ireland, Mike?"</p>
+<p>"None that I know of, sir, barring a sister, who was twelve
+years older than myself; and it is little I saw of her, for she
+married when I was a bit of a gossoon. Her husband was killed in
+the siege of Limerick, and I heard that after it was over, she went
+to settle with some cousins in Cork. Whether she is there now, is
+married again, or is dead years ago, is more than I can say, seeing
+that I have never heard of her since."</p>
+<p>"Was she with her husband in the siege of Limerick?"</p>
+<p>"She was that. I heard about her from some men who knew her
+husband. They said, after he was killed, she went as a servant in
+the family of an officer and his wife for a bit, but the officer
+was killed, and the lady died of grief and trouble; and it was hard
+work she had to live till the place surrendered. That is all I know
+about it, your honour. It might have been true, and it might not. I
+was but a boy, and maybe I bothered the man with questions, and he
+just told me what came into his head to keep me quiet."</p>
+<p>"Well, at any rate, Mike, as we shall most likely land at Cork,
+you might try to find your sister out. If she went through the
+siege, she will know the names of many of the officers. She may
+have heard of a Kennedy."</p>
+<p>"Maybe of half a dozen, your honour. As loyal gentlemen, they
+would be sure to be there."</p>
+<p>"What was her name, Mike?"</p>
+<p>"Sure it was the same as my own before she married, just Norah
+Callaghan."</p>
+<p>"So I suppose, Mike," Desmond said with a laugh; "but what was
+the name of the husband?"</p>
+<p>"Rooney. I have not thought of it this many a year, but it is
+sure I am that it was Rooney; and now I think of it, a message came
+to me from her, just before I left the country, saying that should
+I ever be in the neighbourhood, it is glad she would be to see me;
+and I was to ask for Mrs. Rooney, who lived with her cousin, Larry
+Callaghan, a ship's carpenter, in Middle Lane, which I should find
+by the river bank."</p>
+<p>"Well, that is something to go by, Mike. Of course, she may have
+moved away long since; but if her cousin is a ship's carpenter, it
+is not likely that he would have left the neighbourhood."</p>
+<p>"I wonder your honour never asked about the Kennedys from some
+of the officers who were at the siege?"</p>
+<p>"I did not like to do so. The colonel came to the conclusion
+that I must be the son of Murroch Kennedy, who came out soon after
+Limerick surrendered, and was killed at Breda two or three months
+after he joined the brigade. The officers agreed with the colonel
+that this gentleman was probably my father, and of course I was
+contented that it should be supposed so, and therefore I asked no
+questions about other Kennedys. Of late, however, I have been
+worried over the matter. In the Irish regiments in Spain, as
+elsewhere, were a number of officers belonging to good old Irish
+families, and though I have got on well enough with them--in the
+first place as Berwick's aide-de-camp, and afterwards as on the
+staff of the generals here--I could see that when, in answer to
+their question, it was evident I knew little or nothing of my
+family, there was a sort of coolness in their manner which I could
+quite understand, counting back their ancestors, as they did,
+pretty nearly to the flood. At present, it does not make any
+difference to me personally, one way or the other, but I am
+convinced that if, by chance, when I get older, I should fall in
+love with the daughter of an officer of one of these old families,
+he would not for a moment listen to me, until I could give him some
+proofs that I had a right to the name I bear, or at any rate came
+of a good family. Certainly, at present, I could not assure him on
+either point. I only know that I have always been called Kennedy,
+and that it was under that name that I was committed to the care of
+Father O'Leary. That proves nothing more than that it is the name
+by which John O'Carroll wished me to be called; and it is as likely
+as not--indeed a good deal more likely--that it was not the true
+one."</p>
+<p>"Well, at any rate, your honour, you have made the name of
+Desmond Kennedy well known and liked, both among the Irish and
+French officers, for it is no slight thing that an officer in an
+infantry regiment should be taken on the staff of the Duke of
+Berwick."</p>
+<p>"All that is very well, Mike; but it will not satisfy me more
+than it satisfies others. So I am resolved to try to get to the
+bottom of the affair, even if I have to go direct to John
+O'Carroll, though I know that the chance of his telling me anything
+is but slight. The only way, indeed, that seems likely to lead to
+anything is to call upon as many of the Kennedys as I can discover,
+and ask whether Murroch Kennedy, who left Ireland after the siege
+of Limerick, married and left a child of two years old behind him.
+If so, and that child suddenly disappeared when his father left for
+France, there would be every reason for assuming that I was the
+child in question; though why he should have committed me to the
+charge of John O'Carroll, instead of to one of his own family, is
+not easily seen; unless the whole of the Kennedys were in such ill
+favour, with the English Government, that he thought it better to
+trust me to one who was in good odour with the supporters of Dutch
+William, and was therefore safe from disturbance in his
+estates."</p>
+<p>"Sure, your honour, you are arguing it out like a counsellor,
+and there is no gainsaying what you have spoken. I have no doubt
+you will ferret it out. With such a head as you have on your
+shoulders, it is hard if you cannot circumvent that ould rascal at
+Kilkargan."</p>
+<p>"At any rate we will try, you and I. While I am visiting the
+Kennedys, you can be finding out people who were at Limerick during
+the siege, and gather all they can remember about the Kennedys
+there."</p>
+<p>As Desmond had expected, the duke, as soon as he heard his
+story, at once granted him leave of absence.</p>
+<p>"I hope you may succeed, Kennedy," he said. "It is a poor
+lookout to be risking death continually in the service of a foreign
+king. I grant that we have the knack of making ourselves at home,
+wherever we may be, and there are Irish officers in every army in
+Europe; but, however successful Irishmen may be, they cannot but
+long to be among their own people in their own land. And if, as you
+tell me, Lord Godolphin will befriend you, I for one shall think no
+worse of you if you settle down at home when you have found your
+family. I know that if the sword should be again drawn, with a fair
+prospect of success, you will declare for the rightful king."</p>
+<p>"That I should certainly do, sir; and will assuredly give no
+promise, or undertaking, to abstain from joining any royal army
+that may be raised in Ireland. But it is not with any intention of
+settling at home that I am going there, but simply, as I have told
+you, to discover to what family I belong, so that I can have a
+right to the name I bear."</p>
+<p>"At what port will you embark?"</p>
+<p>"I intend to pay a visit, for a few days, to the Baron de
+Pointdexter and Monsieur de la Vallee, after which I shall cross
+into Italy. I have no doubt that I shall be able to find some
+fishermen, at Toulon, who will undertake to land me somewhere near
+Genoa, where I shall be able to take a passage in a ship bound for
+England."</p>
+<p>"And I suppose you take your servant with you?"</p>
+<p>"With your permission, Duke. He has been my companion for three
+years. He is shrewd as well as brave, and will give me valuable
+help in my enquiries."</p>
+<p>After remaining a couple of days with Berwick's army, Desmond
+started with Mike, and received the warmest welcome from the Baron
+de Pointdexter, and afterwards from Philip and his wife. Then they
+travelled on to Toulon, where Desmond sold the horses and
+equipments. He left his uniform and Mike's there, and procured two
+civilian suits. As he anticipated, he experienced no difficulty in
+arranging to be landed near Genoa. There he found several ships
+bound for England or Ireland, and took a passage in one that would
+touch at Cork, on its way to Dublin. The voyage was uneventful, and
+the ship, which had no great draught of water, proceeded up the
+river to the city.</p>
+<p>"The first thing to do, Mike," Desmond said, as they stepped
+ashore, "is to get rid of these clothes, whose French cut will at
+once attract attention. I shall get a suit such as is worn by an
+Irish gentleman. You had better equip yourself as my servant. No
+livery is worn here, but any quiet dress will be suitable."</p>
+<p>They put up at a small inn, and remained there until a suit such
+as Desmond desired was made for him, and Mike found no difficulty
+in purchasing ready-made clothes suitable to his new position.
+Desmond had taken rooms as Mr. Kennedy, and had asked carelessly if
+there were any families of that name living in the
+neighbourhood.</p>
+<p>"There is one who lives a short distance out of the town. It is
+a small house, and shame it is that one of the old family should
+come down so; but most of their estates were stolen from them after
+the war. Still, the old man holds his head as if he was still lord
+of broad acres, and he is mightily respected among the gentry."</p>
+<p>The next day, Desmond hired a horse and rode out to the house of
+Mr. Kennedy, which was some three miles from the town. He sent in
+his name, and was shown into a room, where a tall man, with a
+somewhat haughty air, received him not unkindly.</p>
+<p>"Your name is the same as my own," he said, "though I do not
+recognize the name of Desmond Kennedy among such members of the
+family as I am acquainted with."</p>
+<p>"I have but just landed from France, and my object in coming
+here is to obtain some information as to my father's family.
+Hearing that a gentleman of the name lived here, I came first to
+you. May I ask if you were acquainted with a Murroch Kennedy?"</p>
+<p>"Surely I was. He was my first cousin. We fought side by side at
+Limerick. I was not one of those who cared to enter foreign
+service. My estates were confiscated, and I have ever since lived
+here on the wreck of my fortune, taking no part in politics.</p>
+<p>"My cousin was of a different mind. He did not, indeed, go out
+at once with the greater part of the army of Limerick, but still,
+hoping that the cause was not altogether lost, he lived for some
+months among the mountains, and took part in a rising which was
+promptly suppressed, and then joined the Irish Brigade; and I
+received a notification, from one of his brother officers, that he
+had fallen at the battle of Breda. And now may I ask, in turn, what
+Murroch Kennedy's relationship was to you?"</p>
+<p>"I will tell you, sir. But first, will you kindly inform me
+whether your cousin left a child about a year old behind him?"</p>
+<p>"Certainly not, sir. My cousin was an unmarried man, at any rate
+up to the time when he left Ireland."</p>
+<p>"Then, sir, my questions are at an end. I may tell you that,
+about the time your cousin left Ireland, I was sent as an infant to
+the care of John O'Carroll, the traitor, of Kilkargan, and was
+brought up under the name of Desmond Kennedy. He showed me but
+little kindness, and, nearly three years ago, I went abroad and
+obtained a commission in one of the regiments in the Irish Brigade,
+and now hold the rank of captain. For many reasons, I am anxious to
+find out what family I belong to. It was assumed, by my colonel and
+fellow officers, that I was the son of Murroch Kennedy, and I
+wished to ascertain whether this was true, and with that object
+obtained leave of absence, and made my way back."</p>
+<p>"I am sorry that I can give you no assistance, sir. Assuredly
+you are not the son of my cousin, Murroch Kennedy; and had you
+been, John O'Carroll, the traitor, would have been the last man to
+whom he would have entrusted you. I know well the history of all
+the members of my branch of the family, and can answer, with
+certainty, that no child was lost, or missing, or unaccounted for
+at the time he went out; and as all were loyal gentlemen, none
+would have had any dealings with John O'Carroll, who betrayed the
+cause for which his brother died fighting at Limerick. I will,
+however, jot down, for your information, the other branches of the
+family of Kennedy and their places of residence, though I fear that
+there is but little probability of your search being successful,
+as, during the years that have elapsed since the late war, many
+must have died. Others, like my cousin, have taken service in one
+or other of the continental armies. Moreover, there is also a
+possibility that the name by which you are known is not your
+own."</p>
+<p>"I feel that myself, sir, and fear that my enquiries will not
+meet with success. Still, I shall pursue them until I have at least
+proved that I cannot belong to any well-known branch of the family.
+I am much obliged to you, for having so courteously answered my
+questions, and for your offer to give me a list of the various
+branches of the family."</p>
+<p>For the next few minutes, Mr. Kennedy was engaged in making out
+the list, which he then handed to Desmond.</p>
+<p>"And now, sir," the former went on, "that we have finished what
+we may consider business, will you tell me a little more about
+yourself? Your story naturally interests me, and I own that I am
+surprised that a young gentleman who, from what you have told me,
+cannot be much more than twenty years old, has risen to the rank of
+captain, in a brigade where so many officers have signally
+distinguished themselves. Your story, too, is an interesting one,
+and seems to me in many respects remarkable; and possibly, when I
+hear more of how you came to be brought up by John O'Carroll, it
+may throw some light upon the subject."</p>
+<p>Desmond gave a detailed account of his life as a boy, and a
+short sketch of his subsequent adventures.</p>
+<p>"A romantic story, young sir," Mr. Kennedy said, when he had
+finished, "and to whatever family you belong, they should be proud
+of possessing so gallant a member. You tell me that you have a safe
+conduct, but you did not mention how you obtained it."</p>
+<p>Desmond had abstained from making any allusion, either to the
+affair with Lord Godolphin, or to that with the Earl of Galway, and
+he replied:</p>
+<p>"Sir, this is a secret that concerns other people, as well as
+myself, consequently I am not at liberty to explain it. I may say,
+however, that it was given to me on my engagement that my visit to
+Ireland was one of a private nature only, and that I would in no
+way meddle with politics. When I tell you that the Duke of Berwick,
+himself, granted me the necessary leave of absence, it will prove
+to you that he, on his part, was well satisfied that the safe
+conduct had been issued to me without any unworthy offers, on my
+part, to the Princess Anne's ministers."</p>
+<p>After chatting for some time longer, Desmond took his leave and
+returned to Cork.</p>
+<p>Mike was standing at the door of the inn.</p>
+<p>"I have had no success, Mike. Have you fared better?"</p>
+<p>"I have not found her yet, your honour, but I have great hopes
+of doing so. Larry Callaghan died four years ago, and the woman of
+the house she occupied said that Mrs. Rooney moved, with his widow
+and children, to some other part of the town. She knew little about
+them, seeing that she only went into the house after they had left;
+but her husband worked in the same yard as Larry did, and she
+thought that he would be able to find out, from some of the old
+hands, where the widow Callaghan had moved to. She said she would
+ask her husband when he came home to his dinner, and maybe he would
+be able to give her some news.</p>
+<p>"And so, your honour has learned nothing about yourself?"</p>
+<p>"Nothing, Mike, except that I am certainly not the son of
+Murroch Kennedy, who was a cousin of the gentleman I called on. I
+was assured that he was a single man, when he went to France.
+However, he gave me a list of the principal branches of the Kennedy
+family, but there is no hurry about starting to see them, and I
+will certainly wait here till you find your sister, which should
+not be many days, for some of Callaghan's fellow workmen are almost
+sure to know where his widow lives."</p>
+<p>Mike went out, at seven o'clock that evening, and returned half
+an hour later.</p>
+<p>"I have got the address, your honour. She and the widow
+Callaghan have got a little place outside the town, and take in
+washing there, and are going on nicely."</p>
+<p>"I am pleased to hear it, I am sure, Mike. I have but small hope
+that she will be able to give any useful information, but for your
+sake, I am glad that you have found a sister whom you have not seen
+for so many years. I suppose you will go up there, at once."</p>
+<p>"I will that. They will have done their work, and we shall have
+a comfortable talk, whereas she would not thank me if I were to
+drop in when she was busy at the washtub."</p>
+<p>"Well, you might ask her to come down, tomorrow morning, to see
+me. Of course, she shall not be a loser by giving up her morning's
+work."</p>
+<p>"Whisht, your honour! When she knows how much you have done for
+me, and how you have treated me, she would willingly lose a week's
+work to give you pleasure. Well, I will be off at once."</p>
+<p>It was eleven o'clock before Mike returned.</p>
+<p>"We have had a great talk, your honour, me and Norah. She would
+not believe at first that I was her brother, and in truth, I found
+it hard to credit that she was Norah, who was a purty colleen when
+I saw her last; but when we had convinced each other that we were
+both who we said we were, matters went on pleasantly. I told her
+some of my adventures with you, and that, by the same token, I had
+a hundred gold pieces that the Baron of Pointdexter had given me,
+sewn up in a belt round my waist, where it has been ever since I
+got it, except when we went into battle, or on that expedition to
+Scotland, when, as your honour knows, I always put it in with the
+agent in your name, seeing that I would rather, if I was killed,
+know that your honour would have it, instead of its being taken by
+some villain searching the dead. I told her that, if she and Mrs.
+Callaghan wanted to take a bigger place, I would share it with her,
+and that quite settled the matter, in her mind, that I was her
+brother. She said, as I knew she would, that she would come and
+talk to you for a week, if you wanted it; and she will be here
+tomorrow, at nine o'clock."</p>
+<p>"That is very satisfactory. I am afraid nothing will come of our
+talk; but still, one may get a clue to other Kennedys who were
+present at the siege of Limerick."</p>
+<p>Punctually at nine o'clock, Mike ushered his sister into
+Desmond's sitting room.</p>
+<p>"I am glad to see you, Mrs. Rooney. Your brother has been with
+me for three years, and has rendered me very many services, and I
+regard him as a friend, rather than as a servant. I am glad that he
+has found his sister, from whom he had been so long parted."</p>
+<p>"Mike has been telling me how good you have been to him, and
+that he would go through fire and water for you, and that you have
+had some wonderful adventures together. He said you wanted to speak
+to me about the siege of Limerick. If there is anything that I can
+tell you, your honour, I will do so gladly."</p>
+<p>"What I want to know is, what Kennedys were at the siege?"</p>
+<p>"There was Murroch Kennedy, and Phelim, who was always called
+'Red Kennedy', on account of his colour; and James and Fergus. I
+knew all those, because they were friends of my master's. It may be
+that there were many others, but they were unbeknown to me."</p>
+<p>"Am I like any of them?"</p>
+<p>The woman looked at him searchingly.</p>
+<p>"You are not, sir; but you are mighty like my master, barring,
+of course, that he was a man ten years older than yourself. But the
+more I look at you, the more I see the likeness."</p>
+<p>"I did not know that you had a master, Mrs. Rooney. I thought
+that you were there with your husband."</p>
+<p>"So I was, your honour; but when he was kilt I was left alone,
+saving for a child that had been born a fortnight before; and what
+with the bad smells of the place, and the sound of the cannon, and
+the fact of my grief, he pined away all at once, and died a week
+after me husband. It is well-nigh starving we all were. Even the
+fighting men had scarce enough food to keep their strength up, and
+a lone woman would have died from hunger. So I was mighty glad,
+when a friend of mine told me that there was an officer's lady who
+had had a baby, and, being but weak and ailing, wanted a foster
+mother for it; so I went at once and got the place, and was with
+her for a month.</p>
+<p>"Her husband was killed three weeks after I went there, and the
+blow was too much for her, and she died a week later. A fortnight
+after that came the peace, and as everything was in confusion, what
+wid our soldiers all going away to France, and the persecutions and
+slaughterings, I took the child with me and went down to my cousin
+Larry's here. Av course, I could not part with it, and I could not
+make my way alone across the country, so I came down here with the
+troops. I was not strong myself, and it was a year later before I
+was able to take it to its friends."</p>
+<p>"What was the name of your master?" Desmond asked eagerly, for
+her last words had excited a sudden train of ideas in his mind.</p>
+<p>"He was Mr. James O'Carroll, a great gentleman, and the head of
+his family."</p>
+<p>Desmond sprang to his feet.</p>
+<p>"That explains it all!" he exclaimed. "Mrs. Rooney, I have no
+doubt that I am your foster child."</p>
+<p>"Why, how can that be, your honour, seeing as your name is
+Kennedy? Though, except for that, you might well be so, seeing that
+you are so like my master."</p>
+<p>"At any rate, Mrs. Rooney, I was reared at Kilkargan, at the
+expense of John O'Carroll, and was, as I heard, brought there by a
+woman when I was a year old. O'Carroll said that my name was
+Desmond Kennedy, but I had only his word for it."</p>
+<p>"Then how is it that you are not master of Kilkargan, for if you
+are Mr. James O'Carroll's son, it is you that ought to be? I have
+always thought of you as there. I have not been in the way of
+getting news. I left my address with Mr. John, but I never heard
+from him, or you. I thought, perhaps, that he might have lost the
+address, but I never dreamt that you had been kept out of your
+own."</p>
+<p>"I don't know that I can say that, altogether," Desmond said;
+"for, if it had been known that James O'Carroll had left an heir,
+his estates would certainly have been confiscated; whereas, owing
+to his brother's turning Protestant, and joining the Williamites,
+he was allowed to keep possession of them. I can understand now
+what seemed so strange, namely, that he feared I might somehow
+learn that I was his nephew, and heir to the estates. Therefore, he
+behaved as if I was the son of a stranger, and when I was old
+enough, sent me off to join the Irish Brigade, in hopes that he had
+seen the last of me; for, even if not killed, I should never be
+able to set foot in Ireland again after fighting for France. 'Tis
+strange that none of my father's brother officers ever made any
+enquiries about it."</p>
+<p>"They all went with the army to France, sir. They knew, of
+course, that the child was born, though they may never have seen
+you, for the mistress never left her bed after you were born.
+Naturally, after her death they lost sight of me, and might well
+have believed that the child had died."</p>
+<p>"You must give me the names of all the officers who came to the
+house, Mrs. Rooney. Many of them may be alive still, and their
+testimony that a child was born would be most important, for at
+present there is only your word against John O'Carroll's."</p>
+<p>"There is more than that, sir. You were baptized on the day she
+died. My mistress gave me the paper the priest had given to her,
+saying that it was of the greatest importance to you, and that I
+was to give it to Mr. John O'Carroll when, as I promised, I took
+the child to him."</p>
+<p>"And did you give it him?" Desmond asked eagerly.</p>
+<p>"No, your honour. I took it with me to the castle, but from the
+reception I got, I thought it best to say nothing about it, but to
+give it to yourself when you were old enough. I have got it at home
+now. There it is, certifying that Gerald O'Carroll, the son of
+James O'Carroll and his wife Elizabeth, was baptized by him on the
+6th of September, 1692."</p>
+<p>"That is fortunate, indeed," Desmond exclaimed. "And now, tell
+me how this uncle of mine received you."</p>
+<p>"Faith, your honour, he was mightily put out, at first. He said
+that I was an impostor, and that he would have me given in charge.
+I told him that I had proofs that what I said was true, and that
+there were many gentlemen, brother officers of Mr. James, who would
+speak for me, and say in court that a son was born to his brother
+before he died. He wanted to get out of me what proofs I had, and
+who were the officers; but I told him that was my business. Then he
+cooled down, and after a time he said that, if he were to let it be
+known that Mr. James had left a son, the estate would surely be
+confiscated, seeing that his father died as a rebel fighting
+against the king; but that, as soon as the persecutions had ceased,
+and it would be safe to do so, he would say who the child was, and
+give him his rightful place. That seemed reasonable enough, and so
+I left you with him, and have always supposed that he kept his
+word; and that, as soon as it was safe, he acknowledged you to be
+master of your father's estate."</p>
+<p>"And now, Mrs. Rooney, I must think matters over, and see how I
+had best proceed. I feel how much I owe to you, and, if I recover
+my estates, you shall see that I am not ungrateful. Will you come
+again tomorrow morning, and bring with you the certificate of my
+baptism, and all the names that you can recollect of the officers
+who were intimate with my father?"</p>
+<h2><a name="Ch20" id="Ch20">Chapter 20</a>: Gerald O'Carroll.</h2>
+<p>Mike, who had remained silent during the conversation between
+his sister and Desmond, returned to the room after seeing her
+out.</p>
+<p>"Well, Mike, you have rendered me many services, but this is the
+greatest of all. Little did I think, when you said you had found
+your sister, and that she was coming to me this morning, that she
+would be able to clear up the mystery of my birth, and to place me
+in a position to prove myself a son of James O'Carroll. I do not
+say that I shall regain the estates. My having been in the Brigade
+will certainly render it difficult for me to do so, though
+possibly, with the patronage of Lord Godolphin, I may succeed. For
+that, however, I care comparatively little. My object, in coming
+here, was to obtain proof that I belong to a good Irish family, and
+that I have no doubt I shall be able to establish."</p>
+<p>"And what am I to call you, your honour, now that I know you are
+Captain Gerald O'Carroll, and not Desmond Kennedy, at all?"</p>
+<p>"At any rate, I must remain Desmond Kennedy at present, Mike. It
+is under that name that my safe conduct was made out, and if I were
+arrested as Gerald O'Carroll, it would be no protection to me.
+However, I shall not want to use it long, for it seems to me that
+my first step must be to return to France, and to see some of the
+officers who knew my father, and were aware of my birth. Their
+testimony would be of great value, and without it there would be
+little chance of your sister's evidence being believed."</p>
+<p>"But there is the paper, your honour."</p>
+<p>"Yes; that will show that a child was born, but the proof that I
+am that child rests entirely with your sister. It might have died
+when its mother did, and they would say that your sister was trying
+to palm off her own child, or someone else's, as his. Of course,
+Mrs. Callaghan would be able to prove that your sister arrived
+immediately after the surrender of Limerick, bringing a child with
+her, and that she said it was the son of James O'Carroll; and that
+she went a year later to Kilkargan, and left it there with John
+O'Carroll. Moreover, I could get plenty of evidence, from those on
+the estate, that I was the child so left."</p>
+<p>"The likeness that Norah saw between you and your father might
+be taken as a proof, sir."</p>
+<p>"I did not think of that, Mike. Yes, if some of these officers
+will also testify to the likeness, it will greatly strengthen my
+case. The chain of evidence seems pretty strong. First, there is
+the certificate of my baptism, your sister's declaration that I was
+entrusted to her by my mother on her deathbed, supported by Mrs.
+Callaghan's declaration that three weeks later she arrived in Cork
+with the child, which she told her was that of James O'Carroll;
+your sister's declaration that she took me to Kilkargan and handed
+me over to my uncle, which would be supported by the evidence of
+the woman he first placed me with; while the servants of the castle
+could prove that I was brought by a woman who, an hour later, left
+the castle without speaking to anyone but my uncle.</p>
+<p>"John O'Carroll will find it difficult to explain why he took me
+in, and who is the Kennedy of whom I was the son, and what service
+he had rendered for him, a Protestant and a Williamite, to have
+undertaken the charge of the child of a rebel. There is no doubt
+that the weight of evidence is all on my side, but whether the
+judges would decide in favour of the son of a rebel, as against a
+friend of the English party, is doubtful. Possibly Lord Godolphin's
+influence might be exerted in my favour. He promised in his letter
+to me to do me any service in his power. Still, even if I lose the
+estate, which I may well do on the ground of my father having
+fought and died for the cause of James the Second, I should still
+have the satisfaction of establishing my name, which I consider of
+more importance than the estates."</p>
+<p>"Sure, your honour, it's a grand thing to belong to a good old
+Irish stock; but for myself, I would rather be Mike Callaghan and
+have a fine estate, than Mike O'Neil without an acre of land."</p>
+<p>Desmond smiled.</p>
+<p>"There is common sense in what you say, Mike, but there is
+nothing more unpleasant than, when you are with a number of Irish
+gentlemen or Spanish grandees, who are equally proud of their
+ancestors, to be unable to give any account of your family, or even
+to be sure that you have a right to the name that you bear."</p>
+<p>"Well, your honour, it is a matter of taste. As for myself, if
+the whisky is good, it makes no differ to me whether they call it
+Cork or Dublin, or whether it is made up in the mountains and has
+sorra a name at all."</p>
+<p>The next morning, Mrs. Rooney returned with the certificate of
+baptism, and a list containing some twenty names of officers who
+had been frequent visitors at James O'Carroll's. Among these
+Desmond, to his satisfaction, found Arthur Dillon, Walter Burke,
+Nicholas Fitzgerald, and Dominic Sheldon, all of whom now held the
+rank of general in the French service, and to all of whom he was
+personally known, having met them either when with Berwick or in
+Spain.</p>
+<p>"Those names are good enough," he said. "And if they can testify
+to my likeness to my father, it will go a long way towards
+furnishing proof, when required. All of them entered the service
+under the provisions of the treaty of Limerick, and therefore their
+testimony cannot be treated as that of traitors; and their names
+must be as well known in England as in France.</p>
+<p>"Now, Mike, our business here is, for the present, concluded. I
+shall at once return to France, see all these officers who are
+still alive, and obtain, if possible, their recognition. As I have
+a year's leave, I can travel about as I choose. Then I shall decide
+whether I shall commence an action in the courts, or whether I
+shall first go over to England, see Lord Godolphin, explain the
+circumstances to him, and ask for his protection and patronage.</p>
+<p>"I suppose the case would be tried at Dublin, where the judges
+are all creatures of England, and there can be no doubt that a
+notification, from Godolphin, that he considered my claim to be a
+good one, and was favourable to it, would have no slight influence
+with them; and would counteract, to some extent, the fact of my
+uncle's being a Protestant, and what they would consider a loyal
+man. Before beginning an action, I should certainly communicate
+with my uncle, and call upon him to resign in my favour; for I
+would avoid the scandal of proving an O'Carroll to be a scoundrel,
+as well as a traitor. As it has turned out, the step which he
+thought would disembarrass him of me has had the other effect, for,
+if I had not gone out to France, I should never have been troubled
+by questions about my family; and should not have met you, Mike, or
+known of the existence of your sister, the only person who could
+clear up the matter.</p>
+<p>"I shall begin to think what O'Neil and O'Sullivan used to say,
+that my luck would carry me through anything; and certainly, at
+present, it has been marvellous."</p>
+<p>"Which way will we go back, your honour?"</p>
+<p>"Not the way we came, if we can help it. We were nearly a month
+coming from Genoa, and might have been twice as long, if the wind
+had not been fairly favourable. I think our best plan will be to
+take passage by sea to London. There we shall have no difficulty in
+finding a vessel bound for Rotterdam, or the Hague. Then we will
+buy horses, and ride along by the Rhine. If we can get through
+Luxembourg into France we will do so, but I think it will perhaps
+be best to go on through Switzerland, and pass the frontier
+somewhere near Lyons, where we shall be but a short distance from
+Berwick's headquarters in Dauphiny."</p>
+<p>A month later, they rode into the duke's camp. They had, on
+leaving Toulon, packed up their uniforms and sent them to the care
+of a friend on the general's staff. To his quarters they first
+went, and having changed his civilian costume for a military one,
+Desmond waited on the duke.</p>
+<p>"Why, Captain Kennedy," the duke said, in surprise; "I did not
+look to see you again, so soon. Have you been over to Ireland?"</p>
+<p>"I have, sir, and though there only a few days, gained
+information that necessitated my return here. I have found out that
+the name I go by is not mine, and that my proper name is Gerald
+O'Carroll."</p>
+<p>"The son of Major James O'Carroll, who fought by my side at the
+Boyne, and was through the first siege of Limerick with me! That
+explains it. Your face has often puzzled me. It seemed to me that I
+recognized it, and yet I could not recall whose face it was that it
+resembled so strongly. Now you tell me, I know at once. Your
+father, when I first knew him, was a few years older than you are;
+but he had the same figure, face, and expression.</p>
+<p>"And so, you are his son! By what miracle have you discovered
+your relationship to him?"</p>
+<p>Desmond, or as he should now be called, Gerald, related as
+briefly as possible the manner in which he had discovered his
+parentage.</p>
+<p>"Your uncle must be a thorough villain," the duke said, hotly.
+"That he was a traitor we all knew, but that he should thus rob his
+brother's son of his inheritance is monstrous and unnatural."</p>
+<p>"I am glad, indeed, sir, that you have thus recognized me. Your
+testimony will go for much, even in an English court, and I hope to
+receive a similar recognition from the officers who were intimate
+with my father in the second siege, and whose names I have
+here."</p>
+<p>The duke glanced down the list.</p>
+<p>"Well-nigh half of them are still alive," he said, "and all of
+them are men of rank and repute, whose word would be taken even by
+an enemy. How do you mean to proceed? Because I am afraid that,
+even if we could spare them, there would be some difficulty about
+their making their appearance in a court, in either England or
+Ireland."</p>
+<p>"I quite see that that is out of the question. All I can hope
+for is, that such of them as recognize my likeness to my father
+will draw up a paper saying so, and will attest it before a notary,
+having as witnesses men of weight and honour equal to their own.
+The production of such certificates could not but have a strong
+influence in my favour."</p>
+<p>"I will most willingly sign such a document," the duke said,
+"and four of my best-known generals can sign as witnesses to my
+signature."</p>
+<p>"I thank you most heartily, sir. Such a document should, in
+itself, be considered as ample proof of my strong resemblance to my
+father."</p>
+<p>"That may or may not be," the duke said, "but do not be content
+with that. Get as many of the others as possible to make similar
+declarations. One man may see a likeness where another does not,
+but if a dozen men agree in recognizing it, their declarations must
+have a great weight. Certainly no Irish judge would doubt the
+testimony of so many men, whose families and whose deeds are so
+well known to them."</p>
+<p>From Dauphiny, Gerald travelled first into Spain, and the three
+Irish officers there whose names were on his list all recognized
+the likeness, even before he told them his name. He put the
+question to them in a general way.</p>
+<p>"I have learned, sir, that the name I bear is not my own, that I
+am the son of an officer who was killed in the siege of Limerick.
+May I ask you if you can recognize any likeness between myself and
+any officer with whom you were well acquainted there?"</p>
+<p>In each case, after a little consideration, they declared that
+he must be the son of James O'Carroll. All remembered that their
+comrade's wife had borne a son, shortly before the end of the
+siege. They remembered her death, but none had heard what became of
+the child, for in the excitement of the closing scenes, and of the
+preparation for the march immediately afterwards, they had had
+little time on their hands, and it was hitherto supposed that it
+had, like so many other infants, perished miserably. They willingly
+signed documents, similar to that which he had received from
+Berwick.</p>
+<p>He met with almost equal success on the northern frontier, only
+two out of eight officers failing to identify him by his likeness;
+until he mentioned his name, when they, too, acknowledged that, now
+they recalled James O'Carroll's face, they saw that the likeness
+was a striking one.</p>
+<p>Having obtained these documents, he resumed civilian attire,
+and, riding by crossroads, passed through Flanders to Sluys,
+without coming in contact with any body of the allied troops. There
+he had no difficulty in obtaining a passage to London, and on his
+arrival called upon Lord Godolphin, who received him cordially.</p>
+<p>"So you have utilized your safe conduct, Captain Kennedy. I am
+glad to see my former captor, and I am as grateful as ever to you
+for the silence you maintained as to that affair. If it had been
+known to my enemies, I should never have heard the last of it. They
+would have made me such a laughingstock that I could scarcely have
+retained office.</p>
+<p>"Now, what can I do for you?"</p>
+<p>"It is a long story, my lord."</p>
+<p>"Then I cannot listen to it now; but if you will sup with me
+here, at nine o'clock this evening, I shall be glad to hear it. I
+am so harassed by the backstair intrigues of my enemies, that it
+would be a relief to me to have something else to think of."</p>
+<p>Gerald returned at the appointed time. Nothing was said as to
+his affairs while supper was served, but after the table had been
+cleared, decanters of port placed on the table, and the servants
+had retired, Godolphin said:</p>
+<p>"Now, Captain Kennedy, let us hear all about it."</p>
+<p>Gerald related the history of his younger days, and of the
+manner in which he had discovered his real parentage, producing the
+certificate of his baptism, a statement which had been drawn up at
+Cork and signed by Norah Rooney, and the testimony of the Duke of
+Berwick and the other Irish officers.</p>
+<p>"There can be no doubt whatever, in the mind of any fair man,"
+Lord Godolphin said, after listening attentively to the whole
+story, and examining the documents, "that your uncle, John
+O'Carroll, is a villain, and that you have been most unjustly
+deprived of your rights. I know him by name, and from the reports
+of our agents in Ireland, as one of the men who turned his coat and
+changed his religion to save his estates. Those men I heartily
+despise; while those who gave up all, and went into exile in order,
+as they believed, there to serve the cause of their rightful
+sovereign, are men to be admired and respected. Be assured that
+justice shall be done you. Of course, you will take action in the
+courts?"</p>
+<p>"I shall first summon him to give up the estate, shall let him
+know that I have indisputable evidence to prove that I am the son
+of his elder brother, and shall say that, if he will give up
+possession peaceably, I will take no further steps in the matter,
+for the sake of the family name. If he refuses, as I fear is
+probable, I must then employ a lawyer."</p>
+<p>"Yes, and a good one. I will furnish you with letters to the
+lord lieutenant, and to Lord Chief Justice Cox, strongly
+recommending you to them, and requesting the latter to appoint one
+of the law officers of the crown to take up your case. I should say
+that, when this John O'Carroll sees that you have such powerful
+friends, he will perceive that it is hopeless for him to struggle
+in so bad a cause, and will very speedily accept your terms, though
+methinks it is hard that so great a villain should go
+unpunished.</p>
+<p>"Now, it will be as well that you should have something stronger
+than the safe conduct that I sent you. I will therefore draw out a
+document for Her Majesty to sign, granting you a full and free
+pardon for any offences that you may have committed against her and
+the realm, and also settling upon you the estates to which you are
+the rightful heir, in and about the barony of Kilkargan; being
+influenced in so doing by the great services rendered by you, both
+to Her Majesty's well-beloved and faithful minister and counsellor,
+myself, and to her trusty general, the Earl of Galway.</p>
+<p>"The queen is not very likely to ask the nature of the service.
+Unless it be something that concerns herself, she asks but few
+questions, and signs readily enough the documents laid before her.
+If she asks what are the offences for which she grants her pardon,
+I shall say, when but a boy you were maliciously sent abroad to
+join the Irish Brigade by your uncle, who wished thus to rid
+himself of you altogether, and who had foully wronged you by
+withholding your name, from you and all others. I shall also add
+that you have distinguished yourself much, and have gained the
+friendship of her half brother, the Duke of Berwick; and you know
+that the queen, in her heart of hearts, would rather that her
+brother, whom you Jacobites call James the Third, should succeed
+her than the Elector of Hanover, for whom she has no love."</p>
+<p>"I thank you greatly, indeed, my lord. Never was a man so amply
+rewarded for merely holding his tongue."</p>
+<p>"It was not only that, sir. It was your conduct in general to
+me. You might have left me tied up in that house, to be found in
+the morning, and to be made the jest of the town; instead of which,
+you yourself conducted and guarded me hither, and so contrived it
+that no whisper spread abroad that I had been carried off between
+Saint James's and my own house. You trusted to my honour, in not
+causing a pursuit of you to be set on foot, and behaved in all ways
+as a gallant young gentleman, and certainly gained my high esteem,
+both for the daring and ingenuity with which you carried out your
+plans for obtaining a passage to France, and for your personal
+conduct towards myself.</p>
+<p>"Where are you lodging?"</p>
+<p>"At the Eagle, hard by the Abbey."</p>
+<p>"Remain there, until you hear from me. Do not be impatient. I
+must choose my time, when either the queen is in a good temper, or
+is in such a hurry to get rid of me, in order to plot and gossip
+with Mistress Harley, who is now her prime favourite, that she is
+ready to sign any document I may lay before her."</p>
+<p>Feeling that his cause was as good as won, Gerald returned in
+high spirits to his inn, where he delighted Mike by relating how
+the great minister had promised to forward his suit.</p>
+<p>"Ah, your honour, it will be a grand day when you take
+possession of Kilkargan--bonfires and rejoicing of all sorts, and
+lashings of drink. Won't all the boys in the barony be glad to be
+free from the traitor, and to have the true heir come to be their
+master. None the less glad will be my sister."</p>
+<p>"You must fetch her from Cork, Mike. It is owing to her that I
+am alive, and it will be owing to her if I recover the estate. She
+shall have the place of honour on the occasion, though all the
+gentry in the neighbourhood are there. When I tell them what she
+has done for me, they will say that she well deserves the
+honour!"</p>
+<p>"And you will go no more to the wars, Captain O'Carroll?"</p>
+<p>"No, Mike. I have been but three years in the French army, but I
+have seen enough of fighting, and, worse still, of fighting against
+men of our own nation. Besides, if the queen grants me the estates
+of my father, I shall consider myself bound in honour not to draw
+my sword against her, or to mix myself up in any plot or
+conspiracy, but to remain strictly neutral whatever may be going
+on. Indeed, the more I think of it, the more I doubt whether it
+would be for the good of Ireland did the Stuarts return to the
+throne. It could only be done at a further cost of blood and
+misery. The old religious quarrels would break out more fiercely
+than ever, there would be risings and civil wars, confiscations and
+massacres, whichever side happened to get the upper hand. That
+James the Third is the lawful sovereign of the three kingdoms, I
+shall always uphold, but there are cases when it is to the benefit
+of the country, at large, that there should be a change in the
+succession."</p>
+<p>"Sure that may be so, your honour; and yet, it is hard that a
+man should be kept out of his own."</p>
+<p>"No doubt it is hard; but it is far harder that thousands of
+people should be killed, and tens of thousands ruined, for the sake
+of one man."</p>
+<p>"So it is, sir. So it is, sure enough, when one comes to think
+of it. Ireland has suffered mightily in the cause of the Stuarts,
+and I don't suppose that, if King James succeeded to the throne,
+his English ministers would let him turn out all the men who have
+taken the places and lands of the old families."</p>
+<p>"That they certainly would not, Mike. When Charles the Second
+returned from exile, all those who had fought and suffered for him
+thought that they would recover their estates, and turn out
+Cromwell's men, to whom they had been granted. But they were
+disappointed. The king found that he could not make so great a
+change, without upsetting the whole country, and that an attempt to
+do so would cost him his crown; and you may be sure that James
+would find an equal difficulty, were he to come to the throne."</p>
+<p>"Well, well, your honour, you know more of such matters than I
+do; but I have no doubt that you are right. I am sure we don't want
+the bad times to come over again, in Ireland."</p>
+<p>Three days later, Gerald received a message from Lord Godolphin,
+saying that he wished to see him; and, on going to his house, the
+minister handed to him the paper with the full pardon, and the
+confirmation of his ownership in his father's estates; together
+with a letter to the lord lieutenant, and the Lord Chief Justice
+Cox.</p>
+<p>The next day, he took ship for Dublin, and on arriving there
+presented his letters, and was well received by those to whom they
+were directed.</p>
+<p>The lord lieutenant said:</p>
+<p>"It is enough for me, Mr. O'Carroll, that Lord Godolphin speaks
+of you in such high terms, and I question not that he has
+thoroughly satisfied himself as to your right to these estates. At
+the same time, I should be glad if you will give me a brief outline
+of how it is that you never claimed them before, though perhaps it
+is as well that you did not do so, for, until the passions excited
+by the war had somewhat subsided, a friend of the Government would
+hardly have interposed for the benefit of the son of one who had
+died fighting for James."</p>
+<p>Gerald had drawn up three copies of a statement containing a
+precis of the case, and he handed one of these to the lord
+lieutenant, saying:</p>
+<p>"As the story is a somewhat long one, my lord, I have written it
+down, in order that you might read it at your leisure."</p>
+<p>"I will certainly do so, Mr. O'Carroll. I should like to be
+personally acquainted with the details of the matter. It will
+doubtless excite a considerable stir. It is, I believe, the first
+time that a supporter of the Government has had to defend his title
+against one of the family that fought on the other side."</p>
+<p>"It is hardly a case of royalist and rebel, sir, but the
+deliberate action of a man suppressing all knowledge of the
+existence of his own nephew, in order that he might himself obtain
+the property of his dead brother.</p>
+<p>"I have no doubt that, had it been known that I was in
+existence, I should still have been thrust aside in order to reward
+his adhesion to the cause of William, but that would have made his
+position intolerable. As one who has changed his religion and his
+politics, he is regarded as a traitor by the people of the barony,
+and avoided by all the gentry round; but the feeling would have
+been infinitely stronger, if it had been known that he was keeping
+his own nephew out of his inheritance. My father was, as I
+understand, immensely popular, and I doubt whether his brother
+would have dared to show his face within fifty miles of Kilkargan,
+had it been known that not only was he a traitor, but a
+usurper."</p>
+<p>The lord lieutenant smiled.</p>
+<p>"I am not surprised at your warmth, Mr. O'Carroll; but,
+unfortunately, your case is not a solitary one. There are thousands
+of men in Ireland who have suffered for the deeds of their fathers.
+However, I shall understand the case better when I have read your
+statement."</p>
+<p>It was evident to Gerald that the lord chief justice, who had
+taken a leading part in the prosecution and punishment of persons
+known to be favourable to the Jacobite cause, was not altogether
+pleased with Lord Godolphin's letter.</p>
+<p>"A strange affair," he said. "A strange and, as it appears to
+me, an unfortunate business.</p>
+<p>"However, sir," he went on, with a changed tone; "I shall
+certainly do my best to see justice done, in accordance with his
+lordship's request. I will read carefully through this statement of
+your claim, and, after considering it, place it in the hands of the
+crown lawyers.</p>
+<p>"But it seems to me that your own position here is a strange
+one, and that you yourself are liable to arrest, as a member of a
+family whose head was one of the late king's strongest
+adherents."</p>
+<p>"My own position, sir, is regulated by this document, bearing
+the signature of the queen and her chief minister;" and he laid the
+official paper before Cox.</p>
+<p>"That certainly settles that question," the latter said, after
+perusing it. "Of course I shall, for my own satisfaction, read your
+statement; but I do not wish to see any documents or proofs you may
+possess in the matter. These you must, of course, lay before your
+counsel. I think I can't do better than give you a letter to Mr.
+Counsellor Fergusson, with whom you can go into all particulars,
+and who will advise you as to the course that you had best
+take."</p>
+<p>Mr. Fergusson, although one of the crown lawyers, enjoyed a wide
+reputation, even among the Jacobite party, for the moderation and
+the fairness with which he conducted the crown cases placed in his
+hands. He had less employment than his colleagues, for only cases
+in which the evidence of acts of hostility to the crown were
+indisputable were committed to him, it having been found that he
+was unwilling to be a party to calling doubtful witnesses, or to
+using the means that were, in the majority of cases, employed to
+obtain convictions.</p>
+<p>The lord chief justice's letter to him was as follows:</p>
+<p>Dear Mr. Counsellor Fergusson:</p>
+<p>I have been requested, by Lord Godolphin, to place the case of
+the bearer of this letter in good hands, and cannot better carry
+out his request than by asking you to act in the matter. Lord
+Godolphin has expressed himself most strongly as to the justness of
+his claim. The bearer's father was, he states, James O'Carroll, a
+noted rebel who was killed at the siege of Limerick. This alone
+would, it might have been thought, have proved a bar to any action
+on his part against the present possessor of the property; but he
+is the bearer of a document, signed by the queen herself,
+reinstating him in all rights he may possess, notwithstanding the
+actions of his father or of himself. It is not for me to make any
+comment upon the royal document, though I may say that I fear it
+may give rise to other suits, and alarm many loyal subjects who
+have become possessed of confiscated estates. However, we must hope
+that this will not be so, as it is expressly stated that, in this
+instance, the pardon and restoration of rights are given in
+consideration of services rendered by this young gentleman to Lord
+Godolphin himself, and to the Earl of Galway. What the nature of
+these services may have been does not concern me.</p>
+<p>Gerald carried this letter to the address indicated, and on
+saying that he was the bearer of a letter from the lord chief
+justice, he was at once shown into the counsellor's room. The
+latter, a man of some fifty-five years old, with features that told
+of his Scottish extraction, with keen eyes and a kindly face, took
+the letter which Gerald presented to him, and begged him to be
+seated while he read it. As he glanced through it, a look of
+surprise came across his face, and he read the letter carefully,
+and then looked at Gerald keenly.</p>
+<p>"You are fortunate in having such good friends, Mr. O'Carroll,"
+he said. "Before I go into the case, will you let me know something
+about yourself? You are, I take it, some twenty years of age?"</p>
+<p>"I am but a few months past nineteen."</p>
+<p>"By your figure, I should have put you as three years older; by
+your face, two years. You must have been fortunate, indeed, to have
+gained the protection both of Lord Godolphin and the Earl of
+Galway. No less than this would have sufficed to gain for you this
+rescript of Her Majesty.</p>
+<p>"And now, sir, please to give me an outline of your case, as to
+the nature of which I am, at present, entirely ignorant."</p>
+<p>"I have put it down in writing, sir," Gerald said, handing him
+the third copy of his statement.</p>
+<p>"It will take me some time to read this, Mr. O'Carroll, and I
+would rather do so alone, and ask you any question that may occur
+to me afterwards. Will you therefore call upon me again, in an
+hour's time?"</p>
+<p>Upon Gerald's return, the counsellor said:</p>
+<p>"It is a strange story, Mr. O'Carroll, and a very disgraceful
+one. You allude, I see, to testimonies of Irish officers in the
+French service as to your likeness to the late Mr. James O'Carroll.
+Will you please let me see them?"</p>
+<p>"Here they are, sir, together with a sworn statement by my
+nurse."</p>
+<p>The lawyer read the documents through carefully.</p>
+<p>"The testimony of the Duke of Berwick, and of the other
+honourable and well-known Irish gentlemen, as to the striking
+likeness between yourself and Mr. James O'Carroll, cannot but carry
+immense weight in the minds of all unprejudiced persons. They prove
+too, conclusively, that James O'Carroll left an infant boy behind
+him, and the statement of the nurse goes a long way to prove you
+are that son; and I think that this is substantiated by the conduct
+of John O'Carroll; first in receiving you and undertaking your
+care; secondly, in the neglect, and I should almost say the
+dislike, he manifested towards the child he had sheltered; and
+thirdly, in the extraordinary step that he, a professedly loyal
+subject of Her Majesty, took in sending you off to enlist in the
+brigade composed of the devoted adherents of the son of James the
+Second.</p>
+<p>"No doubt, at any rate, can arise that you are the child brought
+by this Mrs. Rooney to Kilkargan. That can be proved beyond all
+question; and the fact that your nurse was sent off without having
+any conversation save with John O'Carroll himself, would show how
+anxious he was that no one but himself should know her errand.</p>
+<p>"I must say that you have shown great acumen in mustering
+evidence, of all kinds, that would bear upon the question. I say
+frankly that, without this royal rescript, and the influence of
+these two noblemen, your chance, as James O'Carroll's son, of
+wresting your patrimony from the hands of your uncle would be small
+indeed. Politics have, much more than facts, to do with decisions
+here; but with such powerful credentials, and with the chief
+minister of England interfering on your behalf, I think that there
+is no great doubt that you will secure a judgment in your favour.
+When the facts are known, the feeling of the greater portion of the
+population will run strongly with you, and against this unnatural
+uncle of yours."</p>
+<p>"I should be desirous, if possible, sir, of avoiding a public
+trial that would bring discredit upon the name of my family, and
+would, in the eyes of the supporters of the present Government, act
+prejudicially to myself."</p>
+<p>"You are quite right. How do you propose to proceed?"</p>
+<p>"I was thinking, sir, of sending a statement to my uncle,
+similar to that which I laid before you, going somewhat further
+into details, and promising that, if he would surrender the
+property to me and publicly acknowledge me as his nephew, giving
+what reason he chose for having so long concealed his knowledge of
+the fact, I would take no proceedings against him, and would do my
+best to prevent any discredit falling upon him."</p>
+<p>"That would do very well," the lawyer said, "but I should
+abstain from making any allusion to the protectors you have gained.
+He will learn that soon enough, and it will be well to see what his
+first impulse is. Do not mention the names of the Duke of Berwick
+and the others, who have testified to your likeness to your late
+father. Simply say that many of his comrades have recognized your
+likeness to him. It is of no use showing him all the cards we have
+to play. I should not send the letter by post, but by hand. If you
+like, I will despatch one of my own messengers down with it, with
+instructions to bring back an answer, but not to say anything, if
+questioned, as to his being in my employment."</p>
+<p>The next morning, the messenger started by coach for Kilkargan.
+He returned four days later, bearing John O'Carroll's answer. It
+read as follows:</p>
+<p>Sir:</p>
+<p>I have received your audacious letter, and proclaim you to be an
+impostor, worthy of the severest punishment for attempting to
+personate a son of my late brother. However, for the sake of my
+friendship for Mr. Kennedy, your father, I give you twenty-four
+hours to leave the country, before laying any information against
+you, both as an impostor and as a rebel who has served against the
+armies of Her Majesty. I shall, however, at once apply for a writ
+ordering your arrest, which will be served upon you within
+twenty-four hours of your receipt of this communication. I shall
+also have this woman, your pretended nurse, arrested for perjury
+and conspiracy.</p>
+<p>Gerald took this letter to the counsellor.</p>
+<p>"That is exactly what I expected," he said, after reading it.
+"It shows the man in his true colours. We shall see what he says
+when he learns who are employed against him, and what protection
+you have obtained. My opinion is that, before many hours have
+passed, you will receive a letter in a different strain. I consider
+it by no means improbable that the lord chief justice will have
+written to him privately, warning him that you have received a full
+pardon, and are restored to all your rights, and that you are
+strongly supported by Lord Godolphin, who has written to him and
+the lord lieutenant in your favour; that you have also the
+protection of the Earl of Galway, an officer who possesses the
+confidence of Her Majesty; and that the Duke of Berwick, and many
+of the best-known Irish officers in the service of France, have all
+given their testimony, in the most positive manner, of your
+likeness to James O'Carroll, whom they knew intimately; and will
+say that, at the request of Lord Godolphin that the matter should
+be placed in the hands of one of the crown lawyers, it has been
+submitted to me; and that in my opinion, which I wrote him after
+our interview, a decision in your favour is inevitable; and
+strongly advising him to make the best compromise with you in his
+power."</p>
+<p>The same evening, indeed, a mounted messenger, who had ridden
+posthaste from Kilkargan, arrived with another letter from John
+O'Carroll. It began:</p>
+<p>My Dear Nephew:</p>
+<p>I wrote yesterday in haste, on the receipt of your
+communication. It seemed to me that you were rushing on
+destruction, by avowing yourself to be the son of my brother James;
+and that you would be liable to be arrested as a Jacobite agent in
+the service of France. Therefore, I wrote the letter that I did in
+hopes that you would leave the country, for the time had not yet
+arrived when you could safely be recognized by me as the rightful
+owner of Kilkargan. I have heard, however, that you have received a
+full pardon for past offences, and a restitution of your rights,
+and I am only too glad to be able to retire from the false position
+in which I was placed, and by which I incurred the hostility and
+dislike of my neighbours and tenants. As you know, I have lived an
+almost solitary life here, and have spent far less than the income
+of the estate. I am well aware that, acting as I have done as your
+trustee, you have a right to demand from me an account of the rents
+I have received; but I trust that you will not press this matter,
+as you'll at once come in for the receipt of the rents; and I shall
+be enabled to live in comfort, in Dublin, upon the savings I have
+effected, and a small property I received as a younger brother's
+portion.</p>
+<p>You will, of course, understand why, during your stay here, I
+refrained from any outward demonstrations of affection for you. I
+felt that suspicions might have arisen, had I not done so, that you
+were my brother's son, in which case the estate would surely have
+been confiscated. Seeing that the bent of your inclinations was for
+an active and stirring life, and as the English army was barred to
+you, I thought it best that you should go abroad, and so be out of
+the way until the time should come when matters would so quieten
+down, in Ireland, that my influence might avail to secure an
+indemnity for you for serving in France, and enable me to hand over
+your estate to you.</p>
+<p>Your affectionate uncle, John O'Carroll.</p>
+<p>Gerald laughed aloud as he read the letter.</p>
+<p>"Is it good news, your honour?" Mike, who happened to be busy in
+the room, asked.</p>
+<p>"Nothing could be better. My dear uncle has heard that Lord
+Godolphin and the Earl of Galway have become my patrons, that the
+queen has restored to me my rights, and Mr. Counsellor Fergusson
+has taken up my case. He therefore declares that, as it was always
+his intention to restore the estate to me, as soon as I could
+safely return, he is now ready to do so, and only hopes that I will
+not insist upon his handing over the back rents; which, indeed, I
+question whether I could do, as the estate was granted to him,
+personally, by the Government.</p>
+<p>"However, of course I shall not press that. I shall be only too
+glad to obtain possession without the scandal of having to show, in
+the public courts, that my father's brother was a villain."</p>
+<p>"The ould fox!" Mike exclaimed indignantly. "I felt sure, when
+you told me what the counsellor had said, that he would wriggle out
+of it somehow. I would give all the gold pieces I have in my belt
+for half an hour's talk with him, with a good shillelah!"</p>
+<p>"Well, we can afford to let bygones be bygones, Mike. And after
+all, he did me a service, unwittingly, in sending me over to
+France. In the first place, I had three years of stirring life; in
+the next, I have made many good friends, and have gained the
+patronage of two powerful noblemen, without which I should have
+assuredly never come in for Kilkargan at all."</p>
+<p>"That is true for you, your honour. And without it, I might be
+still a private in O'Brien's regiment, instead of being your
+honour's body servant."</p>
+<p>"And friend, Mike."</p>
+<p>"Yes, sir, as you are good enough to say so."</p>
+<p>Mr. Fergusson put John O'Carroll's letter down, with a gesture
+of disgust, after he had read it.</p>
+<p>"It is what might have been expected from such a man," he said.
+"A traitor to the cause he once adhered to, false to his religion,
+and a usurper of his nephew's rights.</p>
+<p>"At any rate, Mr. O'Carroll, I congratulate you. It has
+prevented a grievous scandal from being made public, and the large
+expenditure entailed by such a case. You have now only to go down
+and take possession."</p>
+<p>"I shall write to my uncle, and give him a week to clear out,
+and to make what explanation he chooses of the change."</p>
+<p>Gerald wrote at once to his uncle. It was coldly worded, and
+showed unmistakably that he was, in no way, deceived by the
+professions in his letter. He told him that he considered it fair
+that he should retain the savings he had made, as he had personally
+been confirmed in the ownership of Kilkargan, the Government being
+ignorant that his brother had left a son. He said that he thought
+it would be more pleasant, for both of them, that they should not
+meet, and wished, therefore, that he would leave, before his
+arrival to take possession.</p>
+<p>John O'Carroll at once summoned the tenants, and astonished them
+by informing them that, he was glad to say, he was free at last to
+lay down the position he had held as owner of Kilkargan. That his
+brother James had left a son, whom they all knew as Desmond
+Kennedy, but whom he had been obliged to treat with coldness, lest
+suspicions should be excited as to his identity. Had this been
+known, he would assuredly have been proscribed as the son of a
+rebel, and debarred by law from any inheritance. He was delighted
+to say that the time had come when he could publicly acknowledge
+him, and place him in possession of the estate, as Her Majesty had
+granted him a special indemnity against the pains and penalties
+incurred by his father's act of rebellion and treason, and had
+restored to him his full rights.</p>
+<p>A burst of cheering, such as had not been heard in Kilkargan
+since James O'Carroll rode out, at the head of a troop raised among
+his tenantry, to fight for King James, greeted the announcement;
+and, for the first time since that event, John O'Carroll was, for
+the moment, popular. Subsequent reflection, and their knowledge of
+his character, soon dissipated that feeling; but in their joy at
+the announced approaching arrival of their new master, John
+O'Carroll rode away, with his followers, without the manifestation
+of hostility that would otherwise have attended his departure.</p>
+<p>Bonfires blazed all over the barony when Gerald rode in,
+accompanied by Mike. The tenants, and a number of the gentry who
+had known him when a boy, assembled at the castle to meet him; and
+even his father could not have met with a more enthusiastic welcome
+than that which was given him.</p>
+<p>The next day, Gerald wrote to the Duke of Berwick, telling him
+what had taken place, and resigning his commission in the Irish
+Brigade.</p>
+<p>"I intend," he said, "to abstain from all part in politics.
+Although no condition was made, in my pardon for serving abroad and
+in the restoration of my estate, I feel that, having accepted these
+favours, I must hold myself aloof from all plots against Queen
+Anne, though my heart will still be with him whom I hold to be my
+lawful sovereign. Unless a large army from France was landed here,
+I believe that any attempt at his restoration would only bring down
+fresh misery upon Ireland. But, should a force land that would
+render success almost a certainty, I should then, with the great
+bulk of my countrymen, join it."</p>
+<p>In due time he received an answer, approving the course he had
+taken.</p>
+<p>"I myself," the Duke said, "am under no delusions. With the ten
+regiments of the Irish Brigade, twenty thousand French troops, and
+arms sufficient to distribute to the whole country, I believe that
+Ireland and Scotland might again come under the rule of the
+Stuarts; but nothing short of such a force would be of any avail.
+So convinced was I of this that, in 1691, after the successful
+defence of Limerick, I saw that the cause was for the time lost,
+and that further resistance would only prove disastrous to Ireland.
+I therefore resigned my command, and went over to France to serve
+as a volunteer, and took no part in the war at home. Therefore, I
+think that you are fully justified in the course you have taken.
+When the present war, which I think is approaching its end,
+terminates, and you can again visit France, I trust that I shall
+see you; and I am sure that you will receive the heartiest of
+welcomes from your comrades in the Brigade."</p>
+<p>Gerald followed out strictly the line he had laid down for
+himself, and kept aloof from the plots and conspiracies that, for
+years, agitated the country, entailing disaster upon all concerned
+in them. Mike was installed as his body servant, and majordomo of
+his household; and Norah Rooney as housekeeper at the castle.</p>
+<p>Three years later, in 1713, the treaty of Utrecht brought the
+war to an end. Communications being restored between the two
+countries, Gerald wrote to the Baron de Pointdexter, and told him
+of the changes which had taken place in his position. He received a
+warm letter in reply, urging him to go over and pay him and his
+son-in-law a visit.</p>
+<p>But Gerald had had enough of travelling, and wrote to say that
+he could not leave his estate, as there was much to look after.
+Letters were, however, frequently exchanged between them, and when,
+three years later, Gerald married the daughter of the Mr. Kennedy
+he had visited near Cork, a present of a superb set of jewels, the
+joint gift of the baron and Monsieur de la Vallee, arrived for the
+bride.</p>
+<p>After the conclusion of the peace, some of the Irish regiments
+were disbanded, and as the British Government, wiser than before,
+offered a free pardon to all men and officers who would return,
+many availed themselves of it; and among these was O'Neil, who
+delighted Gerald by riding up, one day, to the castle.</p>
+<p>"You did not expect to see me again, Kennedy; or, as I hear we
+ought to call you, O'Carroll. Not knowing where I should find you,
+I took the liberty of writing to Baron de Pointdexter, and he
+informed me of your good luck, and your change of name."</p>
+<p>"And you have left the French service altogether, O'Neill?"</p>
+<p>"Yes, and glad enough I am that I shall be able to end my days
+at home."</p>
+<p>"And what are you thinking of doing?"</p>
+<p>"Anything I can get."</p>
+<p>"Well, O'Neil, I have some interest with the lord lieutenant. As
+I am no longer regarded as one likely to join in plots, I think
+that, were I to ride with you to Dublin after you have been here
+for a time; and speak to him for you, as one who had seen the
+errors of his ways, and was anxious to live peacefully, he would
+procure you some appointment."</p>
+<p>O'Neil stayed there for three weeks, and they then rode to
+Dublin. The lord lieutenant granted Gerald's request, and gave
+O'Neil an appointment which would enable him to live in comfort;
+knowing that there is nothing, for keeping a man peaceable, like
+giving him something to do; and that an idle man is a dangerous
+man, while one who has a comfortable position can be trusted to
+hold himself aloof from any business that might imperil his
+place.</p>
+<p>O'Neil thoroughly justified Gerald's recommendation of him, and,
+a couple of years after his return, married a young and
+well-endowed widow; and, to the end of his life, abstained
+carefully from mixing himself up, in any way, in politics.</p>
+<p>Gerald saw the failure of Prince Charlie's expedition to
+Scotland; and the terrible disasters, that befell all who had taken
+part in the movement, showed him the wisdom of the course he had
+adopted--of standing aloof from all intrigues in favour of the
+descendants of James the Second.</p>
+<p>THE END.</p>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<pre>
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of In the Irish Brigade, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE IRISH BRIGADE ***
+
+***** This file should be named 18349-h.htm or 18349-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/1/8/3/4/18349/
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+*** END: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+</body>
+</html>
+
diff --git a/18349.txt b/18349.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c8d2eef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/18349.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,14726 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of In the Irish Brigade, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: In the Irish Brigade
+ A Tale of War in Flanders and Spain
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Illustrator: Charles M. Sheldon
+
+Release Date: May 8, 2006 [EBook #18349]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE IRISH BRIGADE ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+
+
+
+In the Irish Brigade:
+A Tale of War in Flanders and Spain
+By G. A. Henty.
+
+
+
+Contents
+
+
+Preface.
+Chapter 1: Fresh from Ireland.
+Chapter 2: A Valiant Band.
+Chapter 3: A Strange Adventure.
+Chapter 4: At Versailles.
+Chapter 5: A New Friend.
+Chapter 6: An Ambuscade.
+Chapter 7: In Paris Again.
+Chapter 8: To Scotland.
+Chapter 9: An Escape From Newgate.
+Chapter 10: Kidnapping A Minister.
+Chapter 11: On the Frontier.
+Chapter 12: Oudenarde.
+Chapter 13: Convalescent.
+Chapter 14: A Mission.
+Chapter 15: Treachery.
+Chapter 16: Captured.
+Chapter 17: An Old Friend.
+Chapter 18: War.
+Chapter 19: In Search of a Family.
+Chapter 20: Gerald O'Carroll.
+
+
+
+Preface.
+
+
+The evils arising from religious persecution, sectarian hatred,
+ill government, and oppression were never more strongly
+illustrated than by the fact that, for a century, Ireland, which
+has since that time furnished us with a large proportion of our
+best soldiers, should have been among our bitterest and most
+formidable foes, and her sons fought in the ranks of our greatest
+continental enemy. It was not because they were adherents of the
+house of Stuart that Irishmen left their native country to take
+service abroad, but because life in Ireland was rendered well-nigh
+intolerable for Catholics, on account of the nature and severity
+of the laws against them, and the bitterness with which those laws
+were carried into effect.
+
+An Irish Catholic had no prospects of employment or advancement at
+home. He could hold no civil appointment of any kind. He could not
+serve as an officer, nor even enlist as a private, in the army. He
+could not hold land. He was subject to imprisonment, and even
+death, on the most trifling and frivolous accusations brought
+against him by the satellites of the Irish Government. Not only
+could he not sit in the parliament of Dublin, but he could not
+even vote at elections. It was because they believed that the
+return of the Stuarts would mean relief, from at least some of
+their disabilities, and liberty to carry out the offices of their
+religion openly, and to dwell in peace, free from denunciation and
+persecution, that the Irish remained so long faithful to the
+Jacobite cause.
+
+It was not, indeed, until 1774 that the Catholics in Ireland were
+admitted to qualify themselves as subjects of the crown, and not
+until the following year that they were permitted to enlist in the
+army. Irish regiments had enlisted in France, previous to the
+Convention of Limerick; but it was the Irish army that defended
+that town, and, having been defeated, passed over to France, that
+raised the Irish Brigade to the position of an important factor in
+the French army, which it held for nearly a hundred years, bearing
+a prominent part in every siege and battle in Flanders, Germany,
+Italy, and Spain. A long succession of French marshals and
+generals have testified to the extraordinary bravery of these
+troops, and to their good conduct under all circumstances. Not
+only in France did Irishmen play a prominent part in military
+matters, but they were conspicuous in every continental army, and
+their descendants are still to be found bearing honoured names
+throughout Europe.
+
+Happily, those days are past, and for over a hundred years the
+courage and military capacity of Irishmen have been employed in
+the service of Great Britain. For records of the doings of some of
+the regiments of the Irish Brigade, during the years 1706-1710, I
+am indebted to the painstaking account of the Irish Brigade in the
+service of France, by J. C. O'Callaghan; while the accounts of the
+war in Spain are drawn from the official report, given in Boyer's
+Annals of the Reign of Queen Anne, which contains a mine of
+information of the military and civil events of the time.
+
+G. A. Henty.
+
+
+
+Chapter 1: Fresh from Ireland.
+
+
+A number of officers of O'Brien's regiment of foot, forming a part
+of the Irish Brigade in the service of France, were gathered in a
+handsome apartment in the Rue des Fosses, on the 20th of June,
+1701, when the door opened, and their colonel entered with a young
+officer in the uniform of the regiment.
+
+"I have asked you here, gentlemen all," he said, "to present to
+you a new comrade, Desmond Kennedy, who, through the good offices
+of the Marshal de Noailles, has been appointed, by His Gracious
+Majesty, to a cornetcy in our regiment.
+
+"Now, gentlemen, I have known, and doubtless you can all of you
+recall, instances where the harmony of a regiment has been
+grievously disturbed, and bad blood caused, owing to the want of a
+clear understanding upon matters connected with a family; which
+might have been avoided, had proper explanations been given at the
+commencement. I have spoken frankly to Mr. Kennedy, and he has
+stated to me certain particulars, and has not only authorized me,
+but requested me to repeat them to you, feeling that you had a
+right to know who it was that had come among you, and so to avoid
+questioning on matters that are, of all others, prone to lead to
+trouble among gentlemen.
+
+"Beyond the fact that he is a Kennedy, and that his father had to
+fly from Ireland, two years after the siege of Limerick, owing to
+a participation in some plot to bring about a fresh rising in
+favour of King James, he is unacquainted with his family history.
+He has never heard from his father, and only knows that he made
+for France after throwing the usurper's spies off his track, and
+there can be little doubt that it was his intention to take
+service in this brigade. There have been several Kennedys in the
+service, and I have little doubt that this young gentleman's
+father was the Murroch Kennedy who joined the third regiment,
+about that time, and was killed a few months afterwards at the
+battle of Breda. His death would account for the fact that his son
+never received a letter from him. At the time when he left
+Ireland, the child was some two years old, and, as communication
+was difficult, and the boy so young, Murroch might very well have
+put off writing until the boy grew older, not thinking that death
+might intervene, as it did, to prevent his doing so.
+
+"This is all simple and straightforward enough, and you will, I am
+sure, have no hesitation in extending the hand of friendship to
+the son of a gallant Irishman, who died fighting in the ranks of
+the Irish Brigade, exiled, like the rest of us, for loyalty to our
+king.
+
+"Still, gentlemen, you might, perhaps, wonder how it is that he
+knows no more of his family, and it was that this question might
+be disposed of, once for all, that I am making this statement to
+you on his behalf. He was not brought up, as you might expect,
+with some of his father's connections. Whether the family were so
+scattered that there was no one to whom he could safely entrust
+the child, I know not, but, in point of fact, he sent him to one
+of the last houses where a loyal gentleman would wish his son to
+be brought up. We all know by name and reputation--I and your
+majors knew him personally--the gallant James O'Carroll, who died,
+fighting bravely, at the siege of Limerick. He was succeeded in
+his estate by his brother John, one of the few Irishmen of good
+family who turned traitor to his king, and who secured the
+succession to his brother's possessions by becoming an ardent
+supporter of the usurper, and by changing his religion.
+
+"Why Murroch Kennedy should have chosen such a man as the guardian
+of his son is a mystery. Whether they had been great friends in
+earlier times, when John O'Carroll professed as warm an attachment
+to the Stuart cause as did his brother James, or whether Kennedy
+possessed such knowledge of O'Carroll's traitorous dealings with
+the Dutchman as would, if generally known, have rendered him so
+hateful to all loyal men that he could no longer have remained in
+the country, and so had a hold over him, Mr. Kennedy can tell us
+nothing. He was brought by his nurse to Castle Kilkargan, and was
+left with John O'Carroll. It is clear that the latter accepted the
+charge unwillingly, for he sent the child to a farm, where he
+remained until he was eight years old, and then placed him with
+the parish priest, who educated him. The lad visited at the houses
+of the neighbouring gentry, shot and rowed and fished with their
+sons. O'Carroll, however, beyond paying for his maintenance, all
+but ignored his existence, showing no interest whatever in him, up
+to the time when he furnished him with a letter of introduction to
+de Noailles, except that he made him a present of a gun, as soon
+as he became of an age to use one. He never attempted to tamper
+with his loyalty to King James, and in fact, until he sent for him
+to ask what profession he would choose, he never exchanged ten
+words with him, from the time that he was brought to the castle.
+
+"We can each form our own theory as to the cause of such strange
+conduct. He may have given a pledge, to Murroch, that the boy
+should be brought up a loyalist, and a true son of the church. It
+may have been that the loyalty of the boy's father formed so
+unpleasant a contrast to his own disloyalty, and apostasy, that he
+disliked the sight of him. However, these theories can make no
+difference in our reception of Desmond Kennedy, as a gentleman of
+a good family, and as the son of a loyal adherent of the king; and
+as such, I think that I can, from what I have already seen of him,
+assert that he is one who will be a good comrade, a pleasant
+companion, and a credit to the regiment."
+
+The subject of these remarks was a tall and handsome young fellow,
+some sixteen years of age. He was already broad at the shoulders,
+and promised to become an exceedingly powerful man. He had stood
+somewhat behind the colonel, watching calmly the effect of his
+words on those whose comrade he was to be, for he knew how
+punctilious were his countrymen, on the subject of family, placing
+as much or even more value than did the Scots, on points of
+genealogy, and of descent from the old families. His frank open
+face, his bearing and manner, did as much to smooth his way as did
+the speech of his colonel, who, when he had been introduced to
+him, two days before, had questioned him very closely on the
+subject of his family. It had almost been a matter of satisfaction
+to Desmond when he heard, from the colonel, that the officer who
+had fallen at Breda was probably the father of whom he had no
+remembrance; for, from the time he attained the age of boyhood, it
+had been a grief and pain that he should never have heard from his
+father, who, it now appeared, had been prevented by death from
+ever communicating with him.
+
+The officers received him cordially. They had little doubt that he
+was the son of the Murroch Kennedy, of Dillon's regiment,
+although, after they separated, some wonder was expressed as to
+the reason why the latter had committed his son to the care of so
+notorious a traitor as John O'Carroll.
+
+Desmond had been specially introduced to two of the young
+lieutenants, Patrick O'Neil and Phelim O'Sullivan, and these took
+him off with them to their quarters.
+
+"And what is the last news from Ireland? I suppose that the
+confiscations have ceased, for the excellent reason that they have
+seized the estates of every loyal gentleman in the country?"
+
+"That was done long ago, in the neighbourhood of Kilkargan, and,
+so far as I know, everywhere the feeling is as bitter as ever,
+among those who have been dispossessed, and also among the tenants
+and peasantry, who have found themselves handed over to the
+mercies of Dutchmen, or other followers of William. At Kilkargan
+there was not that grievance; but, although they had still one of
+the old family as their master, they could not forgive him for
+deserting to the side of the usurper, nor for changing his
+religion in order to do pleasure to William. Certainly, he can
+have derived but little satisfaction from the estates. He seldom
+showed himself out of doors, never without two or three armed
+servants, all of whom were strangers from the north, and he was
+often away, for months together, at Dublin."
+
+"And what did you do with yourself?"
+
+"I fished, shot, and rode. I had many friends among the gentry of
+the neighbourhood, who would, doubtless, have shown less kindness
+than they did, had it not been for the neglect with which
+O'Carroll treated me. His unpopularity was all in my favour.
+
+"However, I have one good reason for being obliged to him, since
+it was through him that I obtained my commission. He told me that,
+in his young days, he had been at a French college with the duke.
+They had been great friends there, and he thought that, in memory
+of this, de Noailles would procure me a commission."
+
+"I suppose the real fact was, Kennedy, that he was glad to get rid
+of you altogether?"
+
+"I think that is likely enough. He certainly raised no objection,
+whatever, to my going abroad, and seemed to think it natural that
+I should choose the Irish Brigade, here, in preference to the
+British service. He said something unpleasant about its not being
+singular that I should be a rebel, when I always associated with
+rebels, to which I replied that it seemed to me that I could
+hardly be blamed for that, seeing that my father had been what he
+called a rebel, and that I had little choice in the matter of my
+associates; and that if I had been educated at a school in
+England, instead of by good Father O'Leary, I might have had other
+sentiments. He replied that my sentiments were nothing to him, one
+way or the other. He was glad to wash his hands of me altogether;
+and, at any rate, if I went to France, I could drink the health of
+King James every day without his being involved in my treason."
+
+"It almost looked as if he wished you to grow up a rebel, Kennedy,
+or he would hardly have placed you in the charge of a priest. He
+may have reckoned that if there was another rising, you might join
+it, and so be taken off his hands, altogether."
+
+"Whatever the reason was, I have certainly cause for satisfaction
+that he removed me from the care of the farmer's wife, with whom
+he at first placed me, and arranged with the priest to take charge
+of me altogether. O'Leary himself had been educated at Saint Omer,
+and was a splendid fellow. He was very popular on the countryside,
+and it was owing to my being with him that I was admitted to the
+houses of the gentry around, whereas, had I remained in the
+farmhouse in which O'Carroll first placed me, I should only have
+associated with the sons of other tenants."
+
+"It looked, at any rate, as if he wished to make a gentleman of
+you, Kennedy."
+
+"Yes, I suppose my father had asked him to do so. At any rate, I
+was infinitely better off than I should have been if he had taken
+me in at Kilkargan, for in that case I should have had no
+associates, whatever. As it was, I scarcely ever exchanged a word
+with him, until that last meeting. He sent down, by one of his
+servants, the letter to the Duc de Noailles, and a bag containing
+money for my outfit here, and for the purchase of a horse,
+together with a line saying that he had done his duty by me, and
+had no desire to hear from me in the future. I was inclined to
+send the money back to him, but Father O'Leary persuaded me not to
+do so, saying that I must be in a position to buy these things, if
+I obtained a commission; and that, no doubt, the money had been
+given me, not for my own sake, but because he felt that he owed it
+to me, for some service rendered to him by my father."
+
+"It was an ungracious way of doing it," O'Sullivan said, "but, in
+your circumstances, I should have taken the money had it come from
+the old one himself. It is, perhaps, as well that it should have
+been done in such a manner that you may well feel you owe no great
+gratitude towards such a man."
+
+"And how did you get over here?"
+
+"There was no great difficulty about that. In spite of the
+activity of the English cruisers, constant communication is kept
+up between Ireland and France, and fortunately I had, a short time
+before, made the acquaintance of one of your officers, who was
+over there, in disguise, gathering recruits for the Brigade."
+
+"Yes, there are a good many agents in Ireland engaged in that
+work. There is no difficulty in obtaining recruits, for there is
+scarcely a young Irishman who does not long to be with his
+countrymen, who have won such credit out here, and many abstain
+from joining only because they do not know how to set about it.
+The work of the agents, then, is principally to arrange means for
+their crossing the channel. It is well that the supply is steadily
+kept up, for, I can assure you, every battle fought makes very
+heavy gaps in our ranks; but in spite of that, three fresh
+regiments have been raised, in the last year, partly by fresh
+comers from Ireland, and partly by Irish deserters from
+Marlborough's regiments.
+
+"But I am interrupting your story."
+
+"Well, after leaving Mr. O'Carroll, and making my preparations, I
+paid a visit to the cottage where the officer was staying, in
+disguise, and told him that I wanted to cross. He gave instructions
+as to how to proceed. I was to go to a certain street in Cork, and
+knock at a certain door. When it was opened, I was to say, 'The sea
+is calm and the sky is bright'.
+
+"'Then', he said, 'you will be taken in hand, and put on board one
+of the craft engaged in the work of carrying our recruits across
+the water. You will be landed at Saint Malo, where there is an
+agent of the Brigade, who gives instructions to the recruits as to
+how they are to proceed, supplies them with money enough for the
+journey, and a man to accompany each party, and act as interpreter
+on the way.
+
+"I carried out his instructions, crossed the channel in a lugger
+with thirty young peasants, bound also for Paris, and, on landing
+at Saint Malo, took my place in the diligence for Paris; having,
+fortunately, no need for an interpreter. On my presenting my
+letter to the Marquis de Noailles, he received me with great
+kindness, and treated me as a guest, until he had obtained me a
+commission in your regiment.
+
+"Now, when are we likely to go on active service?"
+
+"Soon, I expect," O'Neil said; "but whether we shall be sent to
+the Peninsula, or to Flanders, no one knows. In fact, it is likely
+enough that we shall, for the present, remain here; until it is
+seen how matters go, and where reinforcements will be most
+required. It is but ten months since we came into garrison, in
+Paris, and we may therefore expect to be one of the last regiments
+ordered off.
+
+"For my part, I am in no particular hurry to exchange comfortable
+quarters, and good living, and such adventures as may fall to the
+lot of a humble subaltern, for roughing it in the field; where, as
+has been the case ever since the Brigade was formed, we get a good
+deal more than our fair share of hard work and fighting."
+
+"I should have thought that you would all have liked that,"
+Desmond said, in some surprise.
+
+"Enough is as good as a feast," the other said; "and when you have
+done a few weeks' work in trenches, before a town you are
+besieging; stood knee deep for hours in mud, soaked to the skin
+with rain, and with the enemy's shot coming through the parapet
+every half minute or so; you will see that it is not all fun and
+glory.
+
+"Then, too, you see, we have no particular interest in the
+quarrels between France and Germany. When we fight, we fight
+rather for the honour of the Irish Brigade, than for the glory of
+France. We have a grudge against the Dutch, and fight them as
+interested parties, seeing that it was by his Dutch troops that
+William conquered Ireland. As to the English troops, we have no
+particular enmity against them. Cromwell's business is an old
+story, and I don't suppose that the English soldier feels any
+particular love for Queen Anne, or any animosity against us. And
+after all, we are nearer in blood to them than we are to the
+Germans, Austrians, or Spaniards, for there are few, even of our
+oldest families, who have not, many times since the days of
+Strongbow, intermarried with the English settlers. At any rate,
+there are still plenty of adherents of King James in England and
+Scotland. We speak the same language, and form part of the same
+nation, and I own that I would rather fight against any foreign
+foe than against them."
+
+"So would I," Desmond said heartily. "Our only point of difference
+is that we don't agree as to who should be king. We want a
+Catholic king, and the majority of the English want a Protestant
+king. We have fought on the subject, and been beaten. Next time,
+we hope that we may succeed. If the king were to land in England
+again, I would fight heart and soul in his cause; but whether the
+French beat the English, in the present war, or the English beat
+the French, will not, as far as I can see, make much difference to
+King James; who, Father O'Leary tells me, is, in his opinion,
+supported here by the French king from no great love for himself,
+but because, so long as James has adherents in Ireland, Scotland,
+and England, he is able to play him off against the English
+Government."
+
+The other young men laughed.
+
+"For heaven's sake, Kennedy, keep such sentiments as these to
+yourself. It is a matter of faith, in our brigade, that we are
+fighting in the cause of King James, as against the English
+usurper. Now that William is dead, and James's daughter on the
+throne, matters are complicated somewhat; and if the Parliament
+had settled the succession, after Anne, on her brother, there
+might have been an end of the quarrel altogether. But now that
+they have settled it on Sophia of Hanover, granddaughter of James
+the 1st, and her descendants, subject to the restriction that they
+shall be Protestants, the quarrel does not seem likely to be
+healed."
+
+"This priest of yours must be a dangerous man," O'Sullivan said.
+
+"Not at all. I can assure you, he is devoted to the king; but, as
+he told me, there is no use in Irishmen always closing their eyes
+to the true state of things. He says that we must rely upon
+ourselves, and our loyal friends in Scotland and England, but that
+he is sure the king will never be placed on his throne by French
+bayonets. A small auxiliary force may be sent over, but, in all
+these years, Louis has made no real effort to assist him; and even
+if, for his own purposes, he sent a great army to England, and
+placed him on the throne, he would not be able to maintain himself
+there for a month after the French had withdrawn, for even a
+rightful king would be hated by the people upon whom he had been
+forced, by a foreign power, especially a power that had, for
+centuries, been regarded as their chief enemy. If he had been in
+earnest, Louis would have sent over a great army, instead of a few
+thousand men, to Ireland, when such a diversion would have turned
+the scale in our favour. As he did not do so then, he is not
+likely to do so in the future. The king is useful to him, here, by
+keeping up an agitation that must, to some extent, cripple the
+strength of England; but, were a Stuart on the throne, he would
+have to listen to the wishes of the majority of his people, and
+France would gain nothing by placing him there. Moreover, she
+would lose the services of twenty thousand of her best soldiers,
+for naturally the exiles would all return home, and what is now
+the most valuable force in the French service, might then become
+an equally important one in the service of Britain."
+
+"I am glad that this priest of yours remains quietly in Kilkargan,
+for, if he were to come here, and expound his views among our
+regiments, he might cause quite a defection among them. At any
+rate, Kennedy, I should advise you not to take to propagating his
+views in the regiment. It would not add to your comfort, or ours,
+and there are a good many hot-headed men who would take up the
+idea that you had been infected by O'Carroll's principles."
+
+"It would not be well for anyone to say as much to my face,"
+Desmond said. "Father O'Leary is loyal to the backbone, although
+he has his own ideas as to the hopelessness of our obtaining any
+efficient help from Louis. He thinks that it will be far better to
+trust to our friends at home, and that, even did Louis carry out
+his promises, it would in the long run harm rather than benefit
+King James."
+
+"I am not saying that his view may not be correct, Kennedy. I am
+only saying that the view would be a very unpopular one, among the
+Brigade. We are fighting for France because we believe that
+France, in turn, will aid in placing our rightful king on the
+throne, and if we once entertained the notion that Louis was
+deceiving us, that he had no intention of helping us, and that, if
+he did place James on the throne, he would alienate all his
+sympathizers at home, we should ask ourselves of what use was it,
+spending our blood in fighting the battles of France."
+
+"At any rate, I will take your advice, O'Sullivan, and will keep
+my lips sealed, as to Father O'Leary's views. As you see, by my
+presence here, he has not convinced me, and as long as there is a
+hope that, by the aid of a French army, we may yet see our king
+come to his own again, I shall do my best to prove myself a
+faithful soldier of France. I have chosen my career with my eyes
+open. A loyal Irishman cannot obtain employment, still less
+military employment, in his own country, and accordingly, we are
+to be found fighting as soldiers of fortune in every country in
+Europe. At least there is some chance that we may be benefiting
+the royal cause by fighting for the country that gave King James
+shelter, and rendered him armed assistance in his struggle with
+the usurper, and will probably give aid, more or less efficient,
+when the next attempt is made. In other countries we are but
+soldiers of fortune. In France we may regard ourselves as serving
+our own king by serving King Louis."
+
+"Do you speak French well, Kennedy?" O'Neil said, changing the
+conversation abruptly.
+
+"Yes. Father O'Leary took care of that, for I always said that I
+should take service abroad, as there was clearly nothing else to
+do for a living, and, consequently, he generally talked to me in
+that language, and I speak it as well as I do English or Irish."
+
+"You have not had much practice with the sword, I suppose?"
+
+"Not so much as I could wish, though I never lost an opportunity
+of practising. There were several of the tenants who served in the
+regiment James O'Carroll raised. I used to practise with them, but
+I shall lose no time in getting the best instruction I can, here."
+
+"You may want it, Kennedy. We are not particularly liked by the
+French officers, because we are generally chosen to lead an
+assault, or for other desperate service. Duelling is, of course,
+forbidden, but that in no way prevents duels from being frequent.
+As for fighting in action, as far as I have seen or heard,
+swordsmanship does not go for a great deal. If you press on hard
+enough, and there are men following you, the enemy give way,
+generally, before it comes to hand-to-hand fighting. If, on the
+other hand, they are the more numerous, and hold their position in
+the breach, it is the musketry that settles it. It is only when
+two officers happen to meet, in a fierce fight, that swordsmanship
+becomes of importance.
+
+"We have a good school in the regiment, and there are several
+famous masters of fence in the town, so I should advise you to
+give a couple of hours a day, for a time, to making yourself a
+first-rate swordsman. I have just left off. Our maitre d'armes
+tells me I am too hotheaded ever to make a fine blade; but I
+should fancy, from the way you have been arguing, that you are
+likely to be cooler than most of us in a fencing bout. It is the
+fault with us all that we are apt to lose our tempers, and indeed
+Maitre Maupert, who is the best teacher here, declines absolutely
+to take any of us as pupils, saying that, while we may do
+excellently well in battle, he can never hope to make first-class
+fencers of men who cannot be relied upon to keep their heads cool,
+and to fight with pointed weapons as calmly as they might fence
+with a friend in a saloon."
+
+"Well, I shall work hard to become a fair swordsman," Desmond
+said, with a laugh. "I suppose there is plenty of time to spare."
+
+"Plenty. We have a couple of hours' drill in the morning, and
+after that, except when you are officer of the day, you can spend
+your time as you like. The colonel and two of his officers attend
+at the king's levees, when he is in Paris, but, as he spends the
+greater portion of his time at Versailles, we are seldom called
+upon for that duty."
+
+A few days after Desmond's arrival, the colonel took him with him
+to Saint Germain, where James the 3rd, as his supporters called
+him, held a miniature court. The colonel presented Desmond as a
+loyal subject of His Majesty, and a newly-joined cornet in his
+regiment.
+
+The young prince was a lad of eighteen. He was surrounded by a
+group of courtiers, who had accompanied or followed his father
+into exile, and whose insistence upon treating him with the
+respect due to a monarch was in no slight degree galling to him,
+for, as he often declared to the few friends he had about his own
+age, he had all the disadvantages of being a king, without any of
+the advantages.
+
+He was at once taken with the appearance of Desmond Kennedy.
+
+"Ah, Monsieur Kennedy," he said, after the ceremony of
+presentation had been completed; "I wish that I had all my
+faithful subjects, of the Irish Brigade, across the water with me;
+and that I could put on a uniform like yours, and fight at their
+head for my rights."
+
+"I would that you had, Sire. It would be a good day for us all;
+and believe me, that either in Ireland or Scotland you would soon
+find yourself at the head of an army, many times more numerous
+than our brigade."
+
+"They all tell me that I must wait," the young prince said, with a
+sigh, "but I have been waiting a long time now, and it seems no
+nearer than when I was a child. However, the King of France has
+promised me that it cannot be much longer; and that, when
+Marlborough is defeated, and his army driven back across the sea,
+he will send a fleet and an army to place me on my throne."
+
+"We shall all rejoice, indeed, when that time comes, Sire; and I
+am sure there is not a man in the Irish Brigade who will not
+follow you to the death, and serve you as faithfully as many of
+them did your royal father."
+
+"I hope you will come here often, Monsieur Kennedy. I am sure that
+I shall like you very much, and I think that you would always say
+what you thought, and tell me the real truth about things."
+
+"Sire!" one of the older men exclaimed, reproachfully.
+
+"I mean no reflection on anyone, Dillon. You all say what I am
+sure you feel, but you have grown accustomed to waiting, and all
+think of what is politic, and complain that I speak too frankly.
+Monsieur Kennedy comes straight from Ireland, and he is not old
+enough, yet, to have learned to measure his words, and will not be
+always afraid that anything he may say will be carried to the
+king.
+
+"How I wish that the king would send me with Marshal Tallard!"
+
+"That would never do, Sire. The English are your subjects, and
+they would never forgive you, if you were to appear in the field
+with a French army, fighting against them."
+
+"But the Irish Brigade fight, Dillon?"
+
+"Yes, Your Majesty, but they are in the service of France, and, by
+the terms of the treaty of Limerick, were allowed to expatriate
+themselves, and to enter the French service. We have, in fact,
+renounced our nationality, with the consent of the English, and,
+if taken prisoners, could only be treated as captured foes, and
+not as traitors. Of course, when Your Majesty ascends the throne,
+we shall again become British subjects."
+
+"I trust that that may come soon, Dillon, and for your sake,
+rather than my own. When the time comes, you will not find me
+backward, but this weary waiting tries me sorely, and, were it not
+for those who have remained faithful to our cause, I would gladly
+resign such chances as I have of succeeding to the throne of
+England, and take a commission in the Irish Brigade."
+
+Dillon and some of the elder men shook their heads.
+
+"Can you wonder?" the young prince said, passionately. "Here is
+Master Kennedy, who is younger than myself, though a free life and
+exercise have made him a man, in comparison to me. He has his life
+before him. He will bear his part in many a pitched battle, and,
+doubtless, in many a private adventure. He is his own master, and,
+as long as he does his duty, there are none to say, 'you must not
+do that; you must not say that; you must preserve your dignity;
+you must speak softly and discreetly; you must wait patiently.'
+
+"I envy you, Master Kennedy. I envy you, from the bottom of my
+heart! Come often to see me. You will always be welcome;" and,
+turning abruptly away, he left the chamber hurriedly, to conceal
+the tears which filled his eyes.
+
+His counsellors shook their heads solemnly, but Colonel O'Brien
+said, warmly:
+
+"What the king says is natural, for a man of his age; and, for my
+part, it has increased my respect for him. I say it without
+offence, but what could be duller than the life this lad leads
+here? He has been brought up, literally, without a pleasure. His
+late Majesty, heaven rest his soul! was absorbed in his religious
+exercises, and nothing could have been more trying, to a boy, than
+a court in which the priests and confessors were practically
+supreme. Since his father's death, things have been but little
+better, and now I see that, at heart, the young king has plenty of
+spirit and energy, I can feel that his life has been that of a
+caged hawk, and I am not surprised that he occasionally breaks out
+into revolt against it. It would, methinks, do him a world of
+good, had he a few companions about his own age, like Ensign
+Kennedy. I would even say that, although I can quite understand
+that, as King of England, he could not well take a commission in
+one of our regiments, he might at least be placed with one of our
+most experienced and honoured colonels, in order to learn military
+exercises, and to mix with the officers as any other nobleman
+might do, when attached to the regiment."
+
+Murmurs of dissent arose among the counsellors.
+
+"Well, gentlemen," the colonel went on, "I have no desire to
+interfere with your functions, but, in my opinion, it is good that
+a king should also be a general. Did anyone think any the worse of
+Dutch William, that he was able to command his army, personally?
+None of us can believe that King James will ever succeed to the
+inheritance of his fathers, without fighting; and it would be
+well, indeed, that he should not appear as a puppet, but as one
+qualified to command. It was the fault, or rather the misfortune,
+of his father, that he was unfit to lead his troops in the field.
+Had he been able to do so, he would, in all probability, have died
+King of England, instead of as a fugitive and a pensioner of King
+Louis. In one way, it grieves me to see that the young king feels
+his position acutely; but, on the other hand, I am rejoiced to see
+that he is in no way lacking in spirit, and that he longs to be
+out of his cage, and to try his wings for himself.
+
+"Well, gentlemen, having had my say, I will take my leave of you,
+as duty calls me back to my regiment. I trust that the frankness
+with which I have spoken will not be misunderstood."
+
+So saying, with a bow to the courtiers he left the room, followed
+by Kennedy.
+
+"They mean well," he said, after they had mounted, and ridden off
+at a gallop; "but it is a pity that these gentlemen, all loyal and
+honourable men as they are, should surround the young king. They
+suited, well enough, to the mood of his father, who was always
+wanting in spirit, and was broken down, not only by the loss of
+his kingdom, but by the conduct of his daughters; and, what with
+that, and his devotion to religion, he was rather a monk than a
+monarch. He believed--but most mistakenly--that he had a genius
+for politics, and was constantly intriguing with his adherents at
+home, notably Marlborough and other lords, from whom he obtained
+fair words and promises of support, but nothing else. But though
+he could plan, he did not possess a spark of energy, and was one
+of the most undecided of men, though, like most undecided men, he
+could be extremely obstinate; and, unfortunately, the more wrong
+he was, the more obstinately he held to his course.
+
+"However, all this can make no difference in our devotion to the
+Stuart cause. But I hail, with satisfaction, the prospect that, in
+his son, we may have one to whom we may feel personally loyal; for
+there can be no doubt that men will fight with more vigour, for a
+person to whom they are attached, than for an abstract idea."
+
+"I have heard Father O'Leary say the same, sir. His opinion was
+that, had the late king possessed the qualities that commanded the
+personal admiration and fidelity of his followers, and excited
+something like enthusiasm among the people at large, he would
+never have lost his throne; nor, could he have led his armies, as
+did Gustavus or Charles the 12th of Sweden, would William of
+Orange ever have ventured to cross to England."
+
+"It was a bad business, altogether, lad. His cause was practically
+lost, from the day that William set foot upon English soil. He
+had, in reality, no personal friends; and those who would have
+remained faithful to the cause, were paralysed by his indecision
+and feebleness. Charles the Martyr made many mistakes, but he had
+the passionate adherence of his followers. His personality, and
+his noble appearance, did as much for him as the goodness of his
+cause; while his son, James, repelled rather than attracted
+personal devotion. I trust that his grandson will inherit some of
+his qualities. His outburst, today, gave me hope that he will do
+so; but one must not build too much on that. It may have been only
+the pettishness of a young man, sick of the constant tutelage to
+which he is subjected, and the ennui of the life he leads, rather
+than the earnestness of a noble spirit.
+
+"Of course, Kennedy, I need not tell you that it would be well to
+make no mention, to anyone, of the scene that you have witnessed."
+
+"I shall certainly make no mention of it to anyone, sir. I am
+sorry, indeed, for the young king. His life must be a dreadful
+one, conscious of the impossibility of breaking the bonds in which
+he is held, and knowing that his every word and action will be
+reported, by spies, to the King of France."
+
+For three months, Desmond Kennedy worked hard at drill and sword
+exercise. He became a general favourite in the regiment, owing to
+his good temper, high spirits, and readiness to join in everything
+that was going on.
+
+He went over, several times, to Saint Germain. At first, the
+king's counsellors looked but coldly upon him, and he would have
+ceased to come there, had it not been for the unaffected pleasure
+shown by the king at his visits. In time, however, two of the
+principal men at the little court requested him to have a
+conversation with them, before going into the king's chamber.
+
+"You will understand, Mr. Kennedy," one of them said, when they
+had seated themselves in a quiet spot in the garden; "that we,
+standing in the position of His Majesty's counsellors, are in a
+position of great responsibility. His Majesty, as we admit is but
+natural, chafes over the inaction to which he is condemned by
+circumstances; and is apt, at times, to express his desire for
+action in terms which, if they came to the ears of King Louis, as
+we have every reason to believe is sometimes the case, would do
+him and the cause serious injury. Naturally, we should be glad for
+him to have companions of his own age, but it behoves us to be
+most careful that such companionship should not add to our
+difficulties in this direction; and we should view with
+satisfaction a friendship between the young king and one who, like
+yourself, is nearly of his own age and, as we can see, full of
+spirit and energy. In these matters the king is deficient; but it
+would be better that he should, for the present, remain as he is,
+rather than that he should, in acquiring more manly habits, grow
+still more impatient and discontented with his position.
+
+"We have naturally taken some little trouble in finding out how
+you stand in your regiment, and we hear nothing but good of you.
+You are much liked by your comrades, pay the greatest attention to
+your military exercises, and are regarded as one who will, some
+day, do much credit to the regiment; and we feel that, in most
+respects, your influence could not but be advantageous to the
+young king; but the good that this might do him would be more than
+balanced, were you to render him still more impatient than he is
+for action. You may well suppose that we, exiles as we have been
+for so many years from our country, are not less impatient than he
+for the day of action; but we know that such action must depend
+upon the King of France, and not upon ourselves. We would gladly
+risk all, in an effort to place him on the throne of England, to
+repair past injustices and cruel wrongs; but, were we to move
+without the assistance of Louis, instead of achieving that object
+we might only bring fresh ruin, confiscations, and death upon the
+royalists of England, Scotland, and Ireland. Are you of our
+opinion?"
+
+"Completely so, sir. Of course, I know but little of what is
+passing, save in the neighbourhood where I have been brought up;
+but I know that there, even among the king's most devoted
+adherents, there is a feeling that nothing can possibly be done
+until France lends her aid, in earnest. The English army is far
+stronger than it was when we were last in arms, and when William
+had to rely, almost entirely, upon his Dutch troops and Dutch
+generals; while the friends of the Stuarts are almost without
+arms, without leaders, and without organization."
+
+"That is good, Mr. Kennedy; and, if we were to sanction King
+James's forming an intimacy with you, can I understand that we
+could rely upon your not using your influence to add to his
+impatience for action, and discontent with his present position?"
+
+"Certainly, sir. Being so recently from Ireland, I could assure
+him that even his most devoted adherents, there, are of opinion
+that no rising could be attended with success, unless backed by
+French arms, and especially by the aid of the Irish Brigade, which
+has already won such renown for itself, and whose appearance would
+excite the greatest enthusiasm among all Irishmen."
+
+"In that case, Mr. Kennedy, so far from throwing any difficulties
+in the way of His Majesty seeking your companionship, we shall
+encourage him, and shall be glad to see you here, as often as your
+military duties will permit."
+
+
+
+Chapter 2: A Valiant Band.
+
+
+The permission was not attended with the result that the young
+prince's counsellors had hoped. For a time, James showed a lively
+pleasure when Desmond rode over to Saint Germain, walked with him
+in the gardens, and talked to him alone in his private apartments,
+and professed a warm friendship for him; but Desmond was not long
+in discovering that his first estimate of the prince's character
+had been wholly erroneous, and that his outburst at their first
+meeting had been the result of pique and irritation, rather than
+any real desire to lead a more active life. Upon the contrary, he
+was constitutionally indolent and lethargic. There were horses at
+his command, but it was seldom, indeed, that he would take the
+trouble to cross the saddle, although walking was distasteful to
+him. Even when speaking of his hopes of ascending the throne of
+England, he spoke without enthusiasm, and said one day:
+
+"It is a pity that it cannot be managed without fuss and trouble.
+I hate trouble."
+
+"Nothing can be done worth doing, without trouble, Your Majesty,"
+Desmond said sturdily. "It almost seems to me that, if everything
+could be had without trouble, it would not be worth having."
+
+"How do you mean, Mr. Kennedy?"
+
+"I may illustrate it by saying, Sire, that no true fisherman would
+care about angling in a pond, close to his house, and so full of
+fish, that he had but to drop a baited hook into the water to
+bring up one immediately. The pleasure of fishing consists largely
+in the hard work that it demands. It is, perhaps, miles to a
+stream across the hills, and a long day's work may produce but a
+half dozen fish; but these the angler prizes in proportion to the
+trouble he has had to get them. I think that, were I born heir to
+a throne, I would rather that it should cost me hardship, toil,
+and danger to obtain it, than walk into a cathedral, a few days
+after my father's death, and there be crowned."
+
+"I do not agree with you, at all," James said, shortly. "If
+anything could not be had without toil, hardship, and danger, as
+you say, I would willingly go without it."
+
+"Then, Sire, I can only hope that the toil and danger may be borne
+by your devoted followers, and that you may be spared them,
+personally."
+
+James looked sharply up at his companion, to gather whether the
+words were spoken sarcastically, but Desmond's face, though
+flushed, was calm and serious. Nevertheless, indolent as he was,
+James felt that the words were a reproof; that, although he had at
+first liked him, there was in reality little in common between him
+and this energetic young fellow; and the next time he came, he
+received him with much less cordiality than before; while Desmond,
+who was beginning to tire of the companionship of one who lacked,
+alike, the fun and humour, and the restless activity of his
+comrades, Patrick and Phelim; and who saw that the professions of
+James's friendship were but short lived, came over to Saint
+Germain less frequently, until, at last, he only rode over with
+his colonel, or when some duty called him there.
+
+"So you have been a failure, Master Kennedy," the counsellor who
+had first spoken to him said, one day, when the change in the
+king's manner became evident to them all.
+
+"I am afraid so, sir," Desmond replied with a smile. "I have no
+doubt that it was my fault. Perhaps I was not patient enough with
+him; but, indeed, my efforts to rouse him to take exercise, to
+practise in arms, and so on, were so ill received, that I felt I
+was doing more harm than good."
+
+"I was afraid that it would be so," the other said, regretfully.
+"You see, during his later years, his father gave up his time
+almost entirely to religious observances; and, consequently, the
+lad's life was very dull and monotonous. Constitutionally, he
+undoubtedly takes after his father, who, with all his virtues, was
+at once indolent and undecided. We have observed, with regret, his
+disinclination to bestir himself in any way. Seeing that we, who
+were his father's companions, are too old, or too much disheartened,
+to be lively companions for him, we had hoped that the talk of one
+of spirit, and of his own age, might have roused him to make some
+exertions to overcome his disinclination for anything like active
+exercise. I think now, however, that we were wrong; that the tonic
+was too strong; that he could not but feel that your abundance of
+spirits, and life, were too much for him; and that the companion he
+needs is one who could, to some extent, sympathize with him, and
+who could, perhaps, make more allowance for the manner in which he
+has been brought up.
+
+"We do not blame you at all. I am sure that you have done your
+best. But it is evident that the contrast between you and himself
+has been too strong a one; and that, feeling he cannot hope to
+emulate your soldierly activity, he has come to resent it, as a
+sort of reflection upon himself."
+
+Desmond was, by no means, sorry at being relieved of the necessity
+of paying frequent visits to Saint Germain. In the first place, he
+begrudged the time that was taken from his fencing lessons, at
+which he had worked enthusiastically; and in the next, he had
+felt, after two or three visits, that between himself and the
+young king there was really nothing in common. Full of life and
+spirits himself, it seemed to him nothing short of disgraceful
+that one, who aspired to rule, should take no pains whatever to
+fit himself for a throne, or to cultivate qualities that would
+render himself popular among a high-spirited people. And, as he
+came to understand James more thoroughly, he had found his visits
+increasingly irksome, all the more so, as he felt their inutility.
+
+"Thank goodness," he said, to his two friends, when he went home
+that day, "I have done with Saint Germain. I am as warm an
+adherent as ever of the cause of the Stuarts, and should be
+perfectly ready, when the time comes, to fight my hardest for
+them; but I would vastly rather fight for the king, than converse
+with him."
+
+"I suppose, by what I have seen of him, that he must be somewhat
+wearisome," Phelim O'Sullivan said, with a laugh. "Fortunately,
+wit and gaiety are not essential qualities on the part of a
+monarch; but I must own that, treasonable as it may sound, I fear
+His Majesty is lacking in other qualities, far more essential in a
+monarch. I should say that he is kindly and well disposed, he
+wishes to be fair and just, and may turn out a wise ruler; but he
+is altogether deficient in energy. I suppose there is no occasion
+for a king, safely seated upon a throne, to be energetic; but a
+prince in exile should possess the qualities that excite
+enthusiasm, and bind men to him. Possibly, the qualities King
+James possesses would be highly valued by the Scotch, but they
+would certainly fail to inspire our people."
+
+"Yes," Patrick O'Neil agreed. "His father did more to ruin his
+cause, in Ireland, than all William's Dutch generals and troops,
+together. It was disheartening to be risking life and possessions
+for a man who would do nothing for himself, whose indecision
+paralysed our leaders, and who, the moment a reverse came, sought
+safety in flight, instead of taking his place among the men who
+were devoted to his cause. I can understand that, in England,
+where the majority of those who professed to be devoted to him
+were betraying him, and were in secret communication with William,
+he should be by turns obstinate and vacillating; but in Ireland,
+where every man who surrounded him was risking his life in his
+cause, he should have shown absolute confidence in them, listened
+to their advice, set an example of personal gallantry and courage,
+and, at least, remained among them until all was definitely lost.
+It was the desertion of James, rather than the loss of the battle
+of the Boyne, that ruined his cause.
+
+"Well, I am glad you are out of it, for it was a pity that you
+should be going without your work at the salle d'armes, when you
+were making such progress that, the master reported, in a few
+months you would become one of the best swordsmen in the
+regiment."
+
+There were, in Paris, many Irish officers besides those belonging
+to Colonel O'Brien's regiment. These were, for the most part, men
+who had been severely wounded in the preceding campaign, and who
+now remained in the capital with the depots of their regiments.
+These were constantly recruited by fresh arrivals from Ireland, by
+which means the Irish Brigade was not only kept up to their
+original strength, in spite of the heavy losses they suffered, in
+the engagements in which they had taken part, but largely
+increased its force, new regiments being constantly formed.
+Naturally, O'Brien's corps, being the only complete regiment in
+Paris, at the time, was regarded as the headquarters and general
+meeting place of all the Irish officers there; and, as some of
+these had campaigned in Flanders, in Italy, and in Spain, Desmond
+learned, from their talk and anecdotes, far more of the doings of
+the Brigade than he had hitherto known. From the first they had,
+by their reckless bravery, in almost every engagement that had
+taken place, so distinguished themselves that they received the
+highest commendation from the French generals, and were almost
+invariably selected for specially dangerous service.
+
+"I think the hottest affair I was ever engaged in," a major, who
+had served in Burke's regiment, said one evening, when some ten or
+twelve of his companions had gathered, at the room which was the
+general meeting place of the officers of the corps, "was at the
+attack on Cremona by Eugene. You have all heard how our regiment,
+and that of Dillon, distinguished themselves there, but you may
+not have heard particulars. The place was a strong one, and it was
+garrisoned by some 4000 men--all French, with the exception of our
+two regiments. Marshal Villeroy was himself in command; an
+excellent officer, but, as is often the case in the French army,
+very badly served by his subordinates.
+
+"Here, as you know, almost everything goes by influence; and the
+generals are surrounded by men who have been forced upon them by
+powerful persons, whom they cannot afford to disoblige. The
+consequence was that, relying upon the strength of the place, no
+proper watch was set. There were guards, indeed, at the gates, but
+with no communication with each other; no soldiers on the
+ramparts; no patrols were sent out beyond the town, or maintained
+in the streets.
+
+"No harm might have come of this, had it not been that treachery
+was at work. There was a scoundrel, who was brother of the priest
+of one of the parishes near the wall, and both were in favour of
+the enemy. The priest's residence was near a sewer, which
+communicated with the moat outside the walls. The entrance was
+closed by an iron grating. Were this removed, troops could enter,
+by the sewer, into the priest's wine cellar.
+
+"The priest, being promised a large sum of money, set to work.
+First, he laid a complaint before the governor that the sewer was
+choked with filth, which might be a source of disease to the town
+unless removed; and to do this, it was necessary that the grating
+should be taken down. Being altogether unsuspicious of evil, the
+governor granted his request.
+
+"As soon as the grating was removed, Eugene despatched eight
+miners, who crossed the moat at night, made their way up the
+sewer, and opened a communication between it and the priest's
+house. When all was ready, four or five hundred picked grenadiers
+entered, and were concealed in the house of the priest, and other
+adherents of the emperor.
+
+"Eugene set two strong bodies of picked troops in motion. The one
+was to enter by the Saint Margaret gate, which would be seized by
+the force already in the city. This column consisted of five
+thousand men. The second force, of two thousand infantry and three
+thousand cavalry, under the Prince de Vaudemont, was to cross the
+river by a bridge of boats.
+
+"We slept like stupid dogs. Such watchmen as there were on the
+walls gave no alarm. The gate of All Saints was seized, its guard
+being instantly overpowered, and a party of engineers broke down
+the gate of Saint Margaret, which had been walled up; and at
+daylight Eugene rode into the town, followed by his troops and one
+thousand cavalry; while another mounted force watched the gate,
+and the country round, to prevent the escape of fugitives.
+
+"Before any alarm was given, Eugene had established himself at the
+Hotel de Ville, was master of the great street that separated half
+the garrison from the other half, had taken possession of the
+cathedral; and, in fact, the place was captured without a shot
+being fired.
+
+"Then the uproar began. Parties of troops, led by natives of the
+town, seized a large number of officers at their lodgings; and as
+the alarm spread, the troops seized their muskets and rushed out,
+only to be sabred and trodden down by the enemy's cavalry. I was
+asleep, and dreaming, when my servant rushed into my room, and
+said:
+
+"'The Germans are in possession of the town, Captain.'
+
+"'You are a blathering idiot,' I said.
+
+"'It's true, your honour. Get up and listen.'
+
+"Very unwillingly, I got out of bed and opened the window, and, by
+the holy poker, I found that Pat was right. There was a sound of
+firing, shouting, and screaming, and I heard the gallop of a heavy
+body of horsemen, and, directly afterwards, a squadron of German
+cuirassiers came galloping down the street.
+
+"'It is time for us to be out of this, Pat,' I said, and jumped
+into my clothes, quicker than I had ever done before.
+
+"We went downstairs, and I borrowed two overcoats that we found
+hanging there, and put them on over our uniforms. Then we went
+out, by the back door, and ran as hard as we could, keeping
+through narrow lanes, to the barracks.
+
+"On my way, I had to pass a barrier near a toll gate. Here there
+were thirty-six of our men under a sergeant. Not knowing where the
+enemy were, or whether they were between me and the barracks, I
+thought it best to stay there, and of course took the command.
+Just as I had done so, I heard the tramping of cavalry, and had
+the gate shut. We were just in time, for two hundred and fifty
+cuirassiers came galloping along.
+
+"Their leader, Baron de Mercy, as soon as the troops began to
+enter Saint Margaret's gate, was ordered to dash round and capture
+the Po gate, through which Vaudemont's corps would, after crossing
+the bridge, enter the town. He shouted to me to surrender,
+promising us our lives. I told him that if he wanted the place, he
+would have to come and take it. He used language which I need not
+repeat, but he did not attack us, waiting for the arrival of four
+hundred infantry, who had been ordered to follow him. They were
+some time in coming up, having lost their way, owing to the
+rascally native who was their guide being killed by a shot from a
+window.
+
+"I was not sorry for the delay, for it gave us time to look at
+matters quietly, and prepare for defence. Another six hundred
+cavalry now came up, and Mercy placed them so as to cut off,
+altogether, the French cavalry, who were quartered away to the
+right; then he ordered the infantry to attack us.
+
+"Our position was a good one. The barricade was formed of square
+piles, driven into the ground with small narrow openings between
+them. I ordered the men to keep behind the timbers until the enemy
+came up. The Germans opened a murdering fire as they approached,
+but, though the bullets pattered like rain against the palisades,
+and whistled in between them, not a man was touched. I waited till
+they were within two paces, and then gave the word, and you may
+well guess that there was not a bullet thrown away, and the
+Germans, mightily astonished, drew back, leaving nigh forty of
+their men behind them. Then, falling back a bit, they opened fire
+upon us, but it was a game that two could play at. We could see
+them, but they could not see us; and while we loaded our muskets
+in shelter, they were exposed, and we picked them off by dozens.
+
+"The firing had, of course, given the alarm to our two regiments,
+who turned out just as they were, in their nightshirts. Major
+O'Mahony, who was in command of Dillon's regiment, as Lally was
+away on leave, luckily made his way in safety from his lodgings to
+the barracks, got his own men in order, while Colonel Wauchop, who
+commanded our regiment, took the command of the two battalions.
+Fortunately, a portion of the regiment had been ordered to fall in
+early for inspection, and this gave time for the rest to get into
+their uniforms; and, as soon as they were ready, Wauchop led them
+out and fell suddenly upon a portion of Mercy's force, poured in a
+volley, and then charged them.
+
+"Horse and foot fell back before the attack. Then they turned the
+cannon on the ramparts, and thus secured possession of the Po
+gate, and, pushing on, the guns helping them, drove the Austrians
+from the houses they occupied, and so opened communications with
+the French cavalry.
+
+"A brigadier now came up, and ordered the battalions to barricade
+all the streets they had won, with barrels and carts. A French
+regiment arrived, and occupied the church of Saint Salvador, and
+the battery which commanded the bridge, across which Vaudemont's
+corps could now be seen approaching. The redoubt on the other side
+of the bridge was only held by fifty men, and they were now
+strengthened by a hundred of the French soldiers. The Austrians
+approached, making sure that the town had already been taken, and
+looking out for a signal that was to be hoisted. Their astonishment
+was great, when a heavy musketry fire was opened upon them by the
+garrison of the outpost, while the guns of the battery on the wall
+plunged their shot in among them.
+
+"The column was at once halted. Eugene had regarded the struggle
+as over, when news was brought to him of the defeat of Mercy's
+corps by the Irish. Everywhere else things had gone most
+favourably. Marshal Villeroy had been wounded and made prisoner.
+His marechal de camp shared the same fate. The Chevalier
+D'Entregues, who advanced to meet the enemy, was defeated and
+killed, as was Lieutenant General de Trenan, and the Spanish
+Governor of the town mortally wounded.
+
+"On receiving the news, Eugene at once sent an officer to inspect
+the Irish position; but his report was that they were too well
+placed to be driven from it. He then sent Captain MacDonnell, an
+officer in his service, to offer, if the Irish would leave their
+position, to enrol them in the Austrian service, with higher pay
+than they now received. You may guess the sort of answer he
+received, and he was at once arrested for bringing such a message
+to them. Eugene then endeavoured to engage Marshal Villeroy to
+order the Irish to lay down their arms, as further resistance
+would only end in their slaughter. Villeroy simply replied that,
+as a prisoner, he could no longer give orders.
+
+"During this pause, the Count de Revel and the Marquis de Queslin
+succeeded in gathering together a considerable number of the
+scattered French infantry, and with these they marched to
+endeavour to recover the gates that had been lost, and, having
+occupied the church of Santa Maria, and a bastion near the gate of
+All Saints, ordered the Irish to leave a hundred men at the
+barricades, and with the rest to push forward to the gate of
+Mantua. So I found myself in command of a full company.
+
+"O'Mahony was now in command of the two regiments, as Wauchop had
+been wounded. It was pretty hard work they had of it, and they
+suffered heavily in carrying the guardhouse, held by two hundred
+Austrians. Eugene now launched a great force against our people,
+and attacked them on all sides; but O'Mahony faced them each way,
+and received the charge of the cuirassiers with so heavy a fire
+that they fled in disorder. Another corps of cuirassiers came up,
+and these charged with such fury that their leader, Monsieur de
+Freiberg, pushed his way into the middle of Dillon's regiment,
+where he was surrounded, and, refusing quarter, was killed; and
+his men, disheartened by the fall of their leader, fled, carrying
+with them the infantry who were ranged in their rear.
+
+"But our men were now exhausted by their exertions, and suffered
+heavily; and O'Mahony, seeing that he was likely to be attacked by
+fresh troops, and that my post guarding the approach of the Po
+gate would then be left altogether unsupported, returned to it. I
+was glad enough when I saw them coming, for it was mighty trying
+work being left there, and hearing the storm of battle going on
+all round, and knowing that at any moment we might be attacked.
+
+"They did not stop long, for orders came from Revel, who had
+captured the gate of All Saints, and was preparing to attack Saint
+Margaret's, to march again to the gate of Mantua. It seemed a
+hopeless enterprise. Captain Dillon, of Dillon's regiment, marched
+out and, after hard fighting, drove the Austrians from house to
+house; but, on reaching a spot where the ground was open, he was
+attacked on all sides, and for a time the enemy and our men were
+mixed up together in a melee.
+
+"I could hear by the sound of the firing that our men were
+returning, and posted my fellows so as to cover their retreat; and
+as they came back, hotly pressed by the enemy, we opened so warm a
+fire that they passed in through the gate of the barrier in
+safety, but only half as strong as they had gone out.
+
+"As soon as they were in, they aided us in strengthening the
+position. Seeing that Vaudemont's corps was on the point of
+attacking the redoubt, the Marquis de Queslin sent orders to the
+little garrison there to withdraw across the bridge, and destroy
+the boats. This they effected, in spite of the heavy fire kept up
+by the enemy.
+
+"In the meantime, fighting had been going on all over the town.
+The gate of Mantua had been held by Captain Lynch, of Dillon's
+battalion, and thirty-five men. As soon as he heard the din of
+battle in the town, he collected a few fugitives, entrenched his
+position at the guardhouse, and maintained it for the whole day;
+not only that, but, finding that his position was commanded by a
+party of Austrians, who had taken post in the church of Saint
+Marie, close by, he sallied out, drove them from the church, and
+maintained possession of that as well; until, late in the
+afternoon, he was reinforced by two companies of our regiment, who
+made their way this time without opposition.
+
+"The enemy fell back, but not unmolested, as, sallying out, we
+pressed hotly upon them. There now remained only the gate of Saint
+Margaret in the hands of the Austrians. Here a large body of
+troops had been stationed, and succeeded in repulsing the repeated
+attacks made upon them by Revel's force.
+
+"The fight had now lasted for eleven hours, and the position of
+the Austrians had become critical. The desperate resistance of our
+men had entirely changed the position. They had repulsed every
+attack upon them, had given time for the scattered French to
+gather, and the one gate remaining in Eugene's possession was
+seriously threatened. Vaudemont's corps was helpless on the other
+side of the river, and could render no assistance, and Eugene gave
+the order for his troops to retire, which they did in good order.
+
+"It had been a hot day, indeed, for us, and we were only too glad
+to see them go. We had lost three hundred and fifty men, out of
+the six hundred with which we began the fight; altogether, the
+garrison had lost, in killed, wounded, and in prisoners, fourteen
+hundred men and officers, while Eugene's loss was between fifteen
+and sixteen hundred.
+
+"Personally, I have had hotter fighting, but taking the day
+altogether, it was the most terrible through which I have ever
+passed. Throughout the day we were in total ignorance of what was
+going on elsewhere, though we knew, by the firing in other parts
+of the town, that the French there had not been overpowered, and,
+each time the regiments left us, I was expecting every moment to
+be attacked by an overwhelming force. Faith, it was enough to make
+one's hair white! However, I have no reason to grumble. I obtained
+great praise for the defence of the barrier, and was given my
+majority; and, if it had not been for the wound I received, two
+years ago, which incapacitated me from active service, I might now
+be in command of the regiment."
+
+"Yes, indeed," another officer said. "It was truly a gallant
+affair; and, although our men had fought equally as well in many
+another engagement, it was their conduct at Cremona that attracted
+the greatest attention, and showed the French the value of the
+Brigade. I would we had always been employed in actions on which
+we could look back, with the same pride and pleasure, as we can
+upon Cremona and a long list of battles where we bore the brunt of
+the fighting; and never failed to be specially mentioned with
+praise by the general.
+
+"The most unpleasant work that I ever did was when under Marshal
+de Catinat. Eight Irish battalions were sent up, in 1694, from
+Pignerolle into the valley of La Perouse, to oppose the Vaudois,
+who had always offered a vigorous resistance to the passage of our
+troops through their passes. They were wild mountaineers, and
+Huguenots to a man, who had, I believe, generations ago been
+forced to fly from France and take refuge in the mountains, and
+maintained themselves sturdily against various expeditions sent
+against them.
+
+"I own the business was not at all to my taste, and many others of
+our officers shared my opinions. It was too much like what we
+remembered so bitterly at home, when William's troopers pursued
+our fugitives to the hills, burning, destroying, and killing, and,
+above all, hunting down the priests. This was the other way, but
+was as cruel and barbarous. The poor people had given no offence,
+save that they held to their own religion. An Irishman should be
+the last to blame another for that, and, seeing they had
+successfully opposed the efforts of the French to root them out,
+it was much against my will that I marched with my regiment. I
+hope that, when it comes to fighting against regular troops, of
+whatever nationality, I am ready to do my work; but to carry fire
+and sword among a quiet people, in little mountain villages, went
+against the grain.
+
+"It seemed to us that it was to be a massacre rather than
+fighting, but there we were mistaken. It was the hardest work that
+I ever went through. It was impossible in such a country to move
+in large bodies, and we were broken up into small parties, which
+advanced into the hills, each under its own commander, without any
+fixed plans save to destroy every habitation, to capture or kill
+the flocks of goats, which afforded the inhabitants their chief
+means of subsistence, and to give no quarter wherever they
+resisted.
+
+"Even now, I shudder at the thought of the work we had to do;
+climbing over pathless hills, wading waist deep through mountain
+torrents, clambering along on the face of precipices where a false
+step meant death, and always exposed to a dropping fire from
+invisible foes, who, when we arrived at the spot from which they
+had fired, had vanished and taken up a fresh position, so that the
+whole work had to be done over again. Sometimes we were two or
+even more days without food, for, as you may imagine, it was
+impossible to transport provisions, and we had nothing save what
+we carried in our haversacks at starting. We had to sleep on the
+soaked ground, in pitiless storms. Many men were carried away and
+drowned in crossing the swollen torrents. Our clothes were never
+dry. And the worst of it was, after six weeks of such work, we
+felt that we were no nearer to the object for which we had been
+sent up than we were when we started.
+
+"It was true that we had destroyed many of their little villages,
+but as these generally consisted of but a few houses, only rough
+buildings that could be rebuilt in a few days, the gain was not a
+substantial one. We had, of course, killed some of the Vaudois,
+but our loss had been much heavier than theirs, for, active as our
+men were, they were no match in speed for these mountaineers, who
+were as nimble as their own goats, knew everything of the country,
+and could appear or disappear, as it seemed to us, almost by
+magic. It was a wretched business, and once or twice, when our
+parties were caught in the narrow ravines, they were overwhelmed
+by rocks thrown down from above; so that, on the whole, we lost
+almost as many men as we should have done in a pitched battle,
+gaining no credit, nor having the satisfaction that we were doing
+good service to France.
+
+"I hope I may never be employed in a business like that again. It
+was not only the Vaudois that we had to fight, for, seeing that at
+first we were pushing forward steadily, the Duke of Savoy, under
+whose protection they lived, sent six hundred regular troops to
+assist them, and these, who were well commanded, adopted the same
+tactics as the peasants, avoiding all our attempts to bring on an
+engagement, and never fighting except when they had us to great
+advantage.
+
+"As a rule, our men were always dissatisfied when they received
+orders to fall back, but I think that there was not a man among us
+but was heartily glad, when we were recalled to rejoin Catinat at
+Pignerolle."
+
+The expedition, however, although altogether unsuccessful in
+rooting out the Vaudois, created such terrible devastation in the
+mountains and valleys that the Irish name and nation will long
+remain odious to the Vaudois. Six generations have since passed
+away, but neither time nor subsequent calamities have obliterated
+the impression made by the waste and desolation of this military
+incursion.
+
+"You were at Blenheim, were you not, Captain O'Donovan?"
+
+"Yes. A tough fight it was, and a mismanaged one. I was in the
+Earl of Clare's regiment, which, with Lee and Dorrington's
+battalions, was stationed with the force in Oberglau in the centre
+of our position. It seemed to us, and to our generals, that our
+position was almost impregnable. It lay along a ridge, at the foot
+of which was a rivulet and deep swampy ground. On the right of the
+position was the village of Blenheim, held by twenty-seven
+battalions of good French infantry, twelve squadrons, and
+twenty-four pieces of cannon. Strong entrenchments had been thrown
+up round our position, but these were not altogether completed.
+Blenheim, moreover, had been surrounded by very heavy and strong
+palisades, altogether impassable by infantry, and, as the allies
+could not hope to get cannon across the stream and swamps, it
+seemed to defy any attack. From Oberglau the army of Marshal de
+Marcin and the Elector stretched to the village of Lutzingen. We
+had some five-and-twenty cannon at Oberglau.
+
+"The weak point, as it afterwards turned out to be, was the crest
+between us and Blenheim. Considering that both the artillery and
+musketry fire from both villages swept the slope, and as in
+numbers we equalled the enemy, it was thought well-nigh impossible
+for him to cross the swamps and advance to the attack; and almost
+the whole of the French cavalry were massed on the crest, in order
+to charge them, should they succeed in crossing and try to ascend
+the slope.
+
+"At first the battle went altogether favourably. We had opposite
+to us the English, Dutch, Hanoverians, and Danish troops under
+Marlborough, while facing our left were Prussians, Imperialists,
+and other German troops under Eugene. Marlborough's Danish and
+Hanoverian cavalry first crossed, but were at once charged and
+driven back. Then they tried again, supported by English infantry.
+Then Marlborough led up a still stronger force, drove back our
+light cavalry, and began to ascend the hill. We were attacked by
+ten battalions--Hanoverians, Danes, and Prussians, while the
+English bore against Blenheim. The fighting at both places was
+desperate, and I must do the Germans the justice to say that
+nothing could have exceeded the gallantry they showed, and that,
+in spite of the heavy fire we maintained, they pressed up the
+slope.
+
+"We remained in our entrenchments, till it could be seen that the
+English were falling back from Blenheim, whose palisade, manned by
+twenty-seven battalions of infantry, offered an obstacle that
+would have defied the best troops in the world to penetrate.
+
+"Immediately this was seen, nine battalions, headed by our three
+regiments, leapt from the trenches and poured down on the Germans.
+The enemy could not withstand our onslaught. Two of their
+regiments were utterly destroyed, the rest suffered terribly, and
+were driven back. On the left, Marcin held his ground against all
+the attacks of Eugene, and it seemed to us that the battle was
+won.
+
+"However, it was not over yet. While the fierce fighting had been
+going on in front of Oberglau and Blenheim, Marlborough had passed
+the whole of his cavalry and the rest of his infantry across the
+rivulet, and, in spite of artillery and musketry fire, these moved
+up in grand order, the infantry inclining towards the two villages
+as before, the cavalry bearing straight up the slope, and, when
+they reached the crest, charging furiously upon our horse
+stationed there. They were superior in numbers, but on this head
+accounts differ. At any rate, they overthrew our cavalry, who fled
+in the greatest disorder, pursued by the allied horse.
+
+"The infantry poured into the gap thus made, Blenheim was entirely
+isolated, and we were exposed to assault both in front and rear.
+Nevertheless, we repulsed all attacks, until Marcin sent orders
+for us to retire; then we sallied out, after setting fire to the
+village, flung ourselves upon the enemy, and succeeded in cutting
+our way through, our regiment forming the rear guard. The whole of
+Marcin's army were now in full retreat, harassed by the allied
+cavalry; but whenever their squadrons approached us, we faced
+about and gave them so warm a reception that they attacked less
+formidable foes. As for the garrison in Blenheim, you know they
+were at last surrounded by Marlborough's whole force, with
+artillery; and with the Danube in their rear, and no prospect of
+succour, they were forced to surrender.
+
+"It was a disastrous day, and I have not yet recovered from the
+wound I received there. Had five thousand infantry been posted in
+a redoubt, halfway between Blenheim and Oberglau, so as to give
+support to our cavalry, the result of the battle would have been
+very different. Still, I suppose that most battles are lost by
+some unlooked-for accident--some mistake in posting the troops. We
+can only say that, had the allied forces been all composed of such
+troops as those Eugene commanded, they would have been beaten
+decisively; and that had, on the contrary, Eugene commanded such
+troops as those under Marlborough, Marcin would never have held
+his ground."
+
+"How many British troops were there in the battle, Captain
+O'Donovan?"
+
+"Somewhere about twelve thousand, while the Continental troops
+were forty-seven or forty-eight thousand. There is no doubt that
+they were the backbone of the force, just as we flatter ourselves
+that our three regiments were the backbone of the defence of
+Oberglau."
+
+
+
+Chapter 3: A Strange Adventure.
+
+
+When the party broke up, O'Neil and O'Sullivan, as usual, came in
+for a quiet chat to Desmond's room.
+
+"As we may be possibly ordered to Spain," Kennedy said, "I should
+like to know a little about what we are going to fight about; for,
+although I know a good deal about the war in Flanders, no news
+about that in Spain ever reached Kilkargan."
+
+"Well, you know, of course," O'Neil said, "that Philip the Fifth
+is a grandson of Louis; and is naturally supported by France
+against the Archduke Charles of Austria, who is competitor for the
+throne, and who is, of course, supported by England. Six thousand
+English and Dutch troops were sent to aid the Archduke Charles in
+his attempt to invade Spain and dethrone Philip. The King of
+Portugal, who is a member of the allied confederacy, promised to
+have everything ready to cooperate with them. They found, however,
+on their arrival, that no preparations had been made, and they
+were accordingly distributed, for a time, among the garrisons on
+the frontier.
+
+"Philip, on his part, had not been so inactive, and two
+armies--the one commanded by the Duke of Berwick, and the other by
+General Villadarias--invaded Portugal. Berwick surprised and
+captured two Dutch battalions, and then captured Portalagre, and
+compelled the garrison, including an English regiment of infantry,
+to surrender.
+
+"The allies, to make a diversion, sent General Das Minas into
+Spain, with fifteen thousand men, who captured one or two towns
+and defeated a body of French and Spanish troops. The hot weather
+now set in, and put a stop to hostilities, and the troops on both
+sides went into quarters. The general--I forget his name--who
+commanded the English and Dutch contingent, was so disgusted with
+the proceedings of the Portuguese that he resigned his command,
+and the Earl of Galway was appointed in his place. The next year
+he crossed the frontier, captured several towns, without much
+fighting, and invested Badajos. Here, however, a stern resistance
+was met with. Galway's hand was carried off by a shot, and the
+French general (Tesse) coming up in force to the relief of the
+town, and the Portuguese not arriving at all, the allies were
+obliged to fall back upon Portugal. But Philip was threatened from
+a fresh quarter.
+
+"In June, the Earl of Peterborough sailed from Portsmouth with
+five thousand men, and at Lisbon took on board the Archduke
+Charles. At Gibraltar some more troops were embarked, and
+Peterborough set sail for the coast of Valencia. Peterborough
+himself, one of the most daring of men, and possessed of
+extraordinary military talent, was in favour of a march upon
+Madrid; but, fortunately for us, he was overruled, and commenced
+the siege of Barcelona--a strong town garrisoned by five thousand
+good troops, while he himself had but a thousand more under his
+command. Nevertheless, by a sudden and daring attack he captured
+the strong castle of Montjuich, which commanded the town, which
+was in consequence obliged to surrender four days later, and the
+whole of Catalonia was then captured. Saint Matteo, ninety miles
+from Barcelona, which had declared for Charles and was besieged by
+a large force, was relieved; and so brilliant were the exploits
+accomplished by Peterborough, with most inadequate means, that the
+Spaniards came to the conclusion that he was possessed by an evil
+spirit.
+
+"Large reinforcements were sent from France, and King Philip
+advanced upon Barcelona, and invested it by land, while a French
+fleet bombarded it by sea. Peterborough hurried, with a small
+force from Valencia, to aid the besieged, the matter being all the
+more important since Charles himself was in the city. Before his
+arrival, however, an English fleet appeared, and our fleet
+retired.
+
+"Philip at once raised the siege, and retired to Madrid. His
+position was indeed serious. Lord Galway was advancing from the
+frontier, and Peterborough had gathered a force to cooperate with
+him. Upon the approach of Galway, Philip and the Duke of Berwick
+retreated to the frontier. There they received great reinforcements,
+and advanced against Madrid, which was evacuated by Galway, who
+marched away to form a junction with Lord Peterborough.
+
+"Owing to the dilatory habits and hesitation of the Austrian
+prince, the junction was not effected for some time, and then, in
+spite of the entreaties of the two English generals, he could not
+be persuaded to make a movement towards Madrid. Peterborough,
+whose temper was extremely fiery, at last lost all patience,
+abused Charles openly, and then, mounting his horse, rode down to
+the coast, embarked upon an English ship of war, and sailed away
+to assist the Duke of Savoy. After his departure, the ill feeling
+between the English force, the Portuguese, and the leaders of the
+Spanish adherents of Charles increased, and they spent their time
+in quarrelling among themselves. They were without money,
+magazines, and almost without provisions. Berwick was near them
+with a superior force, and they took the only step open, of
+retreating towards Valencia, which they reached, after suffering
+great hardships, before Berwick could overtake them.
+
+"French troops were poured into Spain, while no reinforcements
+were sent from England. Galway and the Portuguese advanced to meet
+the Duke of Berwick, who was marching with a large army to occupy
+Catalonia.
+
+"The two forces met, on the plain of Almanza, on the 24th of
+April. We and the Spaniards were superior in number to the
+English, Dutch, and Portuguese. The battle was maintained for six
+hours. The Portuguese infantry did little, but the English and
+Dutch repulsed charge after charge, even after the Portuguese and
+Spanish allies on both wings were defeated. But, in the end,
+victory remained with us. Galway and Das Minas, the Portuguese
+general, were both wounded, and five thousand of their men killed,
+and yet the Dutch and English infantry held together.
+
+"But on the following day, being absolutely without supplies, some
+effected their escape and succeeded in reaching Portugal, while
+the main body surrendered. Valencia, Saragossa, and other towns
+opened their gates to us, and, for a time, the cause of the
+Archduke Charles seemed lost.
+
+"Our success was, however, balanced by the loss, in the same year,
+of the whole of the Spanish possessions in Italy. As yet, in spite
+of the disasters that had befallen him, the cause of Charles was
+not altogether lost, for he received fresh promises of support
+from England, whose interest it was to continue the war in Spain,
+and thus compel France to keep a considerable body of troops
+there, instead of employing them against Marlborough in Flanders.
+
+"Galway and Das Minas were taken back to Portugal, in an English
+fleet, after their disaster, and General Stanhope, who, they say,
+is an officer of great military experience and talent, has been
+sent out to take the command; and as a portion of Catalonia is
+still held for Charles, there may yet be a good deal of hard
+fighting, before the matter can be considered finally settled."
+
+"Thank you, O'Neil. I feel that I know something about it, now.
+Are there any of our regiments there?"
+
+"Yes, three of them. There is also an Irish regiment in the
+Spanish service, under Colonel Crofton;" and with this, the talk
+ended for the night.
+
+After three months' work Desmond was dismissed from drill, and had
+obtained such a proficiency with the rapier that he felt that he
+could now relax his work, and see something of the city, which he
+had been hitherto too busy to explore. He had seen the principal
+streets, in the company of his comrades, had admired the mansions
+of the nobles, the richness of the goods exposed to view in the
+windows, and the gaiety and magnificence of the dresses of the
+upper class. His friends had warned him that, if he intended to go
+farther, he should never do so alone, but should take with him his
+soldier servant, a trooper named Mike Callaghan.
+
+Mike was some twenty-eight years old, strong and bony; his hair
+was red, and the natural colour of his face was obscured by a host
+of freckles; his eyes were blue, and his nose had an upward turn;
+his expression was merry and good humoured, but there was a
+twinkle about his eyes that seemed to show that he was by no means
+wanting in shrewdness.
+
+"Even in the daytime," O'Neil said, "it is not safe for a man, if
+well dressed and likely to carry money in his pocket, to go into
+some quarters of the town. Paris has always been a turbulent city,
+and, while it is the abode of the richest and noblest of
+Frenchmen, it is also the resort of the rascaldom of all France.
+Some streets are such that even the city guard would not venture
+to search for an ill doer, unless in considerable force and
+prepared for battle. There are, of course, many streets, both on
+this and the other side of the river, where life and property are
+as safe as in the Rue Royal; which, by the way, is not saying
+much, for it was only three days ago that a man was assassinated
+there in broad daylight. He was a captain in the Picardy regiment,
+and it was supposed that his murderer was a man who had been
+dismissed from the regiment with ignominy. But, whoever it was, he
+has got clear away, for your Parisian citizen takes good care not
+to interfere in such matters, and no one thought of laying hands
+on the villain, although it is said he walked quietly off.
+
+"It is in the streets that I am speaking of that adventures may
+most easily be met with. Here there are too many hotels of the
+nobles, with their numerous retainers, for it to be safe to commit
+crime, and the city guard are generally on the alert, for, were
+harm to come to one of the gentlemen attached to the great houses,
+the matter would be represented to the king, and the city
+authorities would come in for a sharp reproof for their failure to
+keep order in the city; whereas, anything that happens among the
+bourgeois would pass wholly without notice. However, if you keep
+out of the wine shops, you are not likely to become involved in
+trouble. Nine-tenths of the quarrels and tumults originate there.
+There is a dispute, perhaps, between a soldier and a citizen, or
+between soldiers of different regiments, and in a minute or two
+twenty swords are drawn, and the disturbance grows, sometimes,
+until it is necessary to call out troops from the nearest barracks
+to suppress it. However, I know that you are not likely to get
+into trouble that way, for you are a very model of moderation, to
+the corps."
+
+"I have seen enough of the consequences of drink in Ireland,"
+Desmond said, "to cure me of any desire for liquor, even had I a
+love for it. Faction fights, involving the people of the whole
+barony, arising from some drunken brawl, are common enough; while
+among the better class duels are common and, for the most part,
+are the result of some foolish quarrel between two men heated by
+wine. Besides, even putting that aside, I should have given up the
+habit. When I joined the regiment, I was anxious to become a good
+swordsman, but if one's head is overheated at night, one's hand
+would be unsteady and one's nerves shaken in the morning.
+
+"Possibly," he added, with a smile, "it is this, quite as much as
+the hotness of their temper, that prevents the best teachers from
+caring to undertake the tuition of the officers of the Brigade."
+
+"Possibly," Phelim laughed, "though I never thought of it before.
+There is no doubt that the French, who, whatever their faults be,
+are far less given to exceeding a fair allowance of wine than are
+our countrymen, would come to their morning lessons in the saloon
+in a better condition to profit by the advice of the master than
+many of our men."
+
+"I don't think," Patrick O'Neil said, "that we Irishmen drink from
+any particular love of liquor, but from good fellowship and
+joviality. One can hardly imagine a party of French nobles
+inflaming themselves with wine, and singing, as our fellows do.
+Frenchmen are gay in what I may call a feeble way--there is no go
+in it. There is no spirit in their songs, there is no real
+heartiness in their joviality, and the idea of one man playing a
+practical joke upon another, the latter taking it in good part,
+could never enter their heads, for they are ready to take offence
+at the merest trifle.
+
+"As you know, there are certain cabarets told off for the use of
+the soldiers of the Brigade. They are allowed to use no others,
+and no French troops are allowed to enter these wine shops.
+Similarly, there are certain establishments which are almost
+exclusively patronized by officers of the Brigade. There is, of
+course, no absolute rule here, and we can enter any cabaret we
+choose; but it is understood that it is at our own risk, and that,
+if we get into trouble there, we are sure to be handled over the
+coals pretty sharply, as it is considered that we must deliberately
+have gone there with the intention of picking a quarrel. The
+cabarets used by the men are all close to the barracks, so that,
+in case of a fracas, a guard is sent down to bring all concerned
+in it back to the barracks. Fortunately, there is no need for the
+places we frequent being so close to the barracks, for it is
+understood that anyone who takes too much liquor, outside his own
+quarters, brings discredit on the regiment; and it is after we
+adjourn to the rooms of one or other of us that liquor begins to
+flow freely, and we make a night of it."
+
+"Don't you ever have quarrels among yourselves?"
+
+"Angry words pass, sometimes, but all present interfere at once.
+The honour of the regiment is the first point with us all. If men
+want to quarrel, there are plenty of French officers who would be
+quite ready to oblige them, but a quarrel among ourselves would be
+regarded as discreditable to the corps. Consequently, a dispute is
+always stopped before it reaches a dangerous point, and if it goes
+further than usual, the parties are sent for by the colonel in the
+morning, both get heavily wigged, and the colonel insists upon the
+matter being dropped, altogether. As the blood has had time to
+cool, both are always ready to obey his orders, especially as they
+know that he would report them at once to the general, if the
+matter were carried further."
+
+"Well, I shall certainly not be likely to get into a quarrel over
+wine," Desmond said, "nor indeed, in any other way, unless I am
+absolutely forced into it. As to adventures such as you speak of,
+I am still less likely to be concerned in them. I hope that, when
+we are ordered on service, I shall have a full share of adventures
+such as may become a soldier."
+
+O'Neil smiled. "Time will show," he said. "Adventures come without
+being sought, and you may find yourself in the thick of one,
+before you have an idea of what you are doing. But mind, if you do
+get into any adventure and need assistance, you are bound to let
+us help you. That is the compact we made, two months ago. We
+agreed to stand by each other, to be good comrades, to share our
+last sous, and naturally to give mutual aid under all and every
+circumstance."
+
+Desmond nodded.
+
+"At any rate, O'Neil, adventures cannot be so common as you
+represent, since neither of you, so far, has called upon me for
+aid or assistance."
+
+"Have you heard the last piece of court scandal, Kennedy?"
+O'Sullivan asked, as the three friends sat down to breakfast
+together, a few days later.
+
+"No; what is it?"
+
+"Well, it is said that a certain damsel--her name is, at present,
+a secret--has disappeared."
+
+"There is nothing very strange about that," O'Neil laughed.
+"Damsels do occasionally disappear. Sometimes they have taken
+their fate into their own hands, and gone off with someone they
+like better than the man their father has chosen for them;
+sometimes, again, they are popped into a convent for contumacy.
+Well, go on, O'Sullivan, that cannot be all."
+
+"Well, it is all that seems to be certain. You know that I went
+with the colonel, last night, to a ball at the Hotel de Rohan, and
+nothing else was talked about. Several there returned from
+Versailles in the afternoon, and came back full of it. All sorts
+of versions are current. That she is a rich heiress goes without
+saying. If she had not been, her disappearance would have excited
+no attention whatever. So we may take it that she is an heiress of
+noble family. Some say that her father had chosen, as her husband,
+a man she disliked exceedingly, and that she has probably taken
+refuge in a convent. Some think that she has been carried off
+bodily, by someone smitten both by her charms and her fortune. It
+is certain that the king has interested himself much in the
+matter, and expresses the greatest indignation. Though, as it
+would not seem that she is a royal ward, it is not clear why he
+should concern himself over it. Some whisper that the king's anger
+is but feigned, and that the girl has been carried off by one of
+his favourites."
+
+"Why should such a thing as that be supposed?" Desmond asked,
+indignantly.
+
+"Well, there is something in support of the idea. If anyone else
+were to steal away, with or without her consent, a young lady of
+the court with influential friends, he would be likely to pass the
+first two years of his married life in one of the royal prisons;
+and therefore none but a desperate man, or one so secure of the
+king's favour as to feel certain that no evil consequences would
+befall him, would venture upon such a step. You must remember that
+there are not a few nobles of the court who have ruined themselves,
+to keep up the lavish expenditure incumbent upon those who bask in
+the royal favour at Versailles. It would be possible that His
+Majesty may have endeavoured to obtain the hand of this young lady
+for one of his favourites, and that her father may be a noble of
+sufficient consequence to hold his own, and to express to His
+Majesty his regret that he was unable to adopt his recommendation,
+as he had other views for the disposal of her hand.
+
+"The real singularity of the matter is, that no one can tell with
+certainty who the missing lady is. Early in the day half a dozen
+were named, but as I believe all of these put in an appearance at
+the reception in the afternoon, it is evident that, so far as they
+were concerned, there were no foundations for the rumour. It may
+be taken for certain, however, that her friends are powerful
+people, to have been able to impose silence upon those acquainted
+with the facts."
+
+"Well, it is impossible to take very much interest in the story,"
+Desmond said carelessly, "when we are in ignorance of the very
+name of the lady, and of the important point, whether she has
+voluntarily gone away either with a lover or to a convent, or
+whether she has been carried off against her will. If the latter,
+you were talking of adventures, O'Neil, and this would be just the
+sort of adventure that I should like; for us three to discover the
+maiden, and rescue her from her abductor."
+
+The others both laughed loudly.
+
+"And this is the young officer who, the other day, declared that
+he wished for no adventures save those that came in the course of
+a campaign, and now he is declaring that he would like to become a
+very knight errant, and go about rescuing damsels in distress!"
+
+"I have no idea of carrying it into execution," Desmond said. "It
+was merely an expression of a wish. Of course, if the lady in
+question went willingly and to avoid persecution, I would rather
+help than hinder her; but if she has been carried off by some
+ruined courtier, nothing would please me better than to rescue her
+from him."
+
+Several days had passed, and at last it was confidently believed
+that the missing lady was the daughter of Baron Pointdexter, a
+magnate of Languedoc, who had but recently come up to court, on an
+intimation from the king that it was a long time since he had been
+seen there, and that His Majesty hoped that he would be
+accompanied by his daughter, of whose beauty reports had reached
+him. It was certain that neither she nor her father had attended
+any of the receptions or fetes at Versailles, since the rumour
+first spread, although the baron had had a private interview with
+the king a few hours afterwards, and had left his chamber with a
+frowning brow, that showed that the interview had not been a
+pleasant one. He had not again appeared at court, whether in
+consequence of the royal command, or not, no one knew.
+
+The baron was one of the richest proprietors in the south of
+France. He was a specimen of the best type of the French nobles,
+preferring to spend his time among his own wide estates to coming
+up to the capital, where his visits had at all times been rare.
+
+During the daytime, Desmond went out but little. When the hours of
+drill and exercise were over, he spent some time in visiting the
+quarters of the men of his company, making their personal
+acquaintance, and chatting freely with them. They were glad to
+hear from him about their native country; and, as some of them
+came from his own neighbourhood, they took a lively interest in
+the news--the first that had reached them for years--of families
+with whom they were acquainted. He spent two or three hours in the
+afternoons in the salle d'armes of the regiment, or at the schools
+of one or other of the maitres d'armes most in vogue, and then
+paid visits, with one or other of the officers of the regiment, to
+great houses of which they had the entree.
+
+Of an evening he went out, accompanied by Mike Callaghan, and
+wandered about the less fashionable part of the town, which
+pleased him better than the more crowded and busy quarters.
+
+One evening, he had gone farther than usual, had passed through
+the gates, and had followed the road by the banks of the river. As
+an officer in uniform, he was able to re-enter the town after the
+gates were closed, the rules being by no means strict, as, during
+the reign of Louis the 14th, France, though engaged in frequent
+wars abroad, was free from domestic troubles.
+
+Presently, he passed a lonely house of some size, standing back
+from the road and surrounded by a high wall. As he did so, he
+heard a scream in a female voice, followed by angry exclamations
+from two male voices, while loudly rose a woman's cries for help.
+
+"There is bad work of some sort going on in there," he said to
+Mike. "We had better see what it is all about. Do you go round the
+wall by the right, and I will go round by the left, and see if
+there is any way by which we can climb over."
+
+They met at the back of the house. The wall was unbroken, save by
+the gates in front.
+
+"The wall is too high for us to climb, Mike," Desmond said. "Even
+if I stood on your head, I could not reach the top. Let us go
+round to the front again."
+
+They returned, and closely scrutinized the gate. It was not so
+high as the wall itself, but was fully twelve feet.
+
+"I have got a pistol with me, your honour," Mike said. "I have
+seen doors blown in, by firing a gun through the keyhole."
+
+"That would do, if we were sure that there were no bars, Mike; but
+the chances are that it is barred, as well as locked. Besides, I
+am sure that we should not be justified in blowing in the door of
+a private house. It may be that they were the cries of a mad
+woman. I would rather get over as quietly as possible."
+
+"Well, sir, I will stand against it, and if you will get on to my
+shoulders and put your foot on my head, you will reach the top.
+Then, if you lower one end of your sash to me, I can pull myself
+up beside you."
+
+"Yes, I think we can manage it that way, Mike. I am convinced that
+there is something wrong going on here, and I don't mind taking
+the risk of getting into a scrape by interfering. Now do you stoop
+a bit, so that I can get on to your shoulder; then you can raise
+yourself to your full height. Take off your hat, first. I shall
+certainly have to put my foot on your head."
+
+"All right, your honour. Don't you be afraid of hurting me. My
+skull is thick enough to stand the weight of two of you."
+
+In a minute, Desmond had his fingers on the top of the gates, drew
+himself up, and, moving to the corner, where he could get his back
+against the end of the wall, lowered his sash to Mike.
+
+"You are sure I shall not pull you down?"
+
+"I am not sure, but we will try, anyhow."
+
+This was said in a whisper, for there might, for anything he knew,
+be two or three men in the garden. Mike took off his boots, so as
+to avoid making a noise. Desmond was sitting astride of the gate,
+and had his end of the sash over the top of it, and under his leg,
+thereby greatly reducing the strain that would be thrown on it,
+and then leaning with all his weight on it, where it crossed the
+gate. Mike was an active as well as a strong man, and speedily was
+by his side.
+
+"Now we will drop down," Desmond said, and, setting the example,
+lowered himself till he hung by his hands, and then dropped. Mike
+was soon beside him.
+
+"What shall we do next?"
+
+"We will go and knock boldly at the door; but before we do that,
+we will unbar the gate and shoot the bolt of the lock. We have no
+idea how many men there may be in the house. Maybe we shall have
+to beat a retreat."
+
+The lock was shot without difficulty, but the bolts were still
+fast, and were not drawn without noise. They pushed back the last
+of these, and then opened the gates, which creaked noisily as they
+did so.
+
+"They can hardly help hearing that," Desmond muttered; and indeed,
+as he spoke, the door of the house opened suddenly, and five men
+came out, two of them holding torches. A man, who seemed to be the
+leader of the party, uttered an exclamation of fury as the light
+fell upon the figures of the two men at the open gate.
+
+"Cut the villains down!" he shouted.
+
+"Stop!" Desmond cried, in a loud voice. "I am an officer of
+O'Brien's regiment of foot. I heard a scream, and a woman's cry
+for help, and, fearing that foul play was going on, I made my
+entry here."
+
+The man, who had drawn his sword, paused.
+
+"You have done wrong, sir. The cries you heard were those of a mad
+woman. You had better withdraw at once. I shall report you,
+tomorrow, for having forcibly made an entrance into private
+premises."
+
+"That you are perfectly at liberty to do," Desmond replied
+quietly; "but certainly I shall not withdraw, until I see this
+lady, and ascertain from herself whether your story is a true
+one."
+
+"Then your blood be on your own head!" the man said.
+
+"At them, men! you know your orders--to kill anyone who attempted
+to interfere with us, no matter what his rank."
+
+The five men rushed together upon the intruders.
+
+"Hold the gate, Mike," Desmond said, "and they cannot get behind
+us."
+
+They stepped back a pace or two, and drew their swords. The
+position was a favourable one, for the two halves of the gate
+opened inwards, and so protected them from any but an attack in
+front. The leader rushed at Desmond, but the latter guarded the
+sweeping blow he dealt at him, and at the first pass ran him
+through the body; but the other four men, enraged rather than
+daunted by the fall of their leader, now rushed forward together,
+and one of them, drawing a pistol, fired at Desmond when within
+three paces.
+
+The latter threw his head on one side, as he saw the pistol
+levelled. The action saved his life, for it was well aimed, and
+the bullet would have struck him full between the eyes. As it was,
+he felt a sharp sudden pain, as it grazed his cheek deeply. He
+sprang forward, and before the man could drop the pistol and
+change his sword from the left hand to the right, Desmond's weapon
+pierced his throat. At the same moment, Mike cut down one of his
+assailants with his sabre, receiving, however, a severe cut on the
+left shoulder from the other.
+
+Paralysed at the loss of three of their number, the remaining two
+of the assailants paused, for a moment. It was fatal to one of
+them, for Mike snatched his pistol from his pocket, and shot the
+man who had wounded him, dead. The other threw down his sword, and
+fell upon his knees, crying for mercy.
+
+"Shall I kill him, your honour?"
+
+"No. Fasten his hands behind him, with his own belt; and bind his
+ankles tightly together, with that of one of his comrades."
+
+He paused, while Mike adroitly carried out his instructions.
+
+"Now we will see what this is all about," Desmond said. "I don't
+suppose that there are any more of them in the house. Still, we
+may as well keep our swords in readiness."
+
+Picking up one of the torches that had fallen from their
+assailants' hands, and holding it above his head with his left
+hand, while his right held his sword ready for action, Desmond
+entered the house. The sitting rooms on both sides of the hall
+were empty, but, upon entering the kitchen, he found an old woman
+crouching in a corner, in the extremity of fear.
+
+"Stand up. I am not going to hurt you," Desmond said. "Lead us, at
+once, to the chamber of the lady we heard call out."
+
+The old woman rose slowly, took down a key hanging from a peg,
+and, leading the way upstairs, opened a door.
+
+"Keep a watch upon the crone," Desmond said, as he entered.
+
+As he did so, his eye fell upon a girl of some seventeen years
+old. She was standing at the window, with her hands clasped. She
+turned round as he entered, and, as her eye fell upon his uniform,
+she gave a cry of delight.
+
+"Ah, monsieur, you have rescued me! I heard the fight in the
+garden, and knew that the good God had sent someone to my aid. But
+you are wounded, sir. Your face is streaming with blood."
+
+"'Tis but the graze of a pistol ball," he said, "and needs but a
+bowl of water, and a strip of plaster, to put it right. I had
+well-nigh forgotten it.
+
+"I am glad, indeed, to have been able to render you this service,
+mademoiselle. It was most providential that I happened to come
+along the road, and heard your screams and cries for aid; and I
+determined to see if any foul business was being carried on here.
+What made you call out?"
+
+"I had let myself down from the window, by knotting the bedclothes
+together. I was blindfolded, when they carried me in here, and did
+not know that the walls were so high all round, but had hoped to
+find some gate by which I might escape. There were only the great
+gates, and these were locked; and I was trying to draw the bolts
+when two of the men suddenly rushed out. I suppose the old woman
+came up here, and found the room empty. It was then that I
+screamed for help, but they dragged me in, in spite of my
+struggles, and one said I might scream as much as I liked, for
+there was not a house within hearing, and no one would be passing
+anywhere near.
+
+"When he said that, I quite gave up hope. I had believed that I
+was in some lonely house, in the suburbs of the city, and I little
+thought that my cries could not be heard.
+
+"But where are the men who guarded me?"
+
+"Four of them are dead, mademoiselle, and the other securely
+bound. Now, if you will tell me who you are, and where your
+friends live, I and my soldier servant will escort you to them."
+
+"My name is Anne de Pointdexter."
+
+Desmond was scarcely surprised, for the care which had been taken
+in choosing so lonely a spot for her concealment, and the fact
+that an officer and four men should be placed there to guard her,
+showed that she must have been regarded as a prisoner of
+importance.
+
+"Then I am glad, indeed, to have been the means of rescuing you.
+All Paris has been talking of your disappearance, for the past ten
+days. The question is, what would you wish done? It is too far to
+take you to Versailles tonight, and too late to obtain means of
+conveyance."
+
+"There is a carriage in the stables behind the house, and there
+are some horses. I cannot say how many, but at night I have heard
+them stamping. I suppose the carriage was left here so that they
+could remove me to some other place, in case suspicion should fall
+upon this house. How many are there of you, monsieur?"
+
+"Only myself, and the trooper you see at the door."
+
+"And did you two fight with five men, and kill four of them!" she
+exclaimed, in surprise. "How brave of you, monsieur, and how good
+to run such risk, for a person of whom you knew nothing!"
+
+"I knew that it was a woman in distress," Desmond said, "and that
+was quite enough to induce two Irishmen to step in, and answer to
+her cry for aid. However, mademoiselle, if the carriage and horses
+are there, this will get us out of our difficulty. The only
+question is, will you start at once, or wait until daylight? We
+may be stopped by the patrols, as we approach Versailles, but I
+have no doubt that my uniform will suffice to pass us into the
+town, where probably your father is still lodging."
+
+"I would much rather go at once," the girl said. "There are others
+who come, sometimes at all hours of the night."
+
+"Very well, then, we will see about getting the carriage ready, at
+once. If you will come downstairs, we will lock this old woman up
+in your room."
+
+This was done at once, and the girl, who was so shaken by her
+captivity that she feared to remain for a moment by herself,
+accompanied her rescuers to the back of the house. Here, as she
+had said, they found a carriage and four horses, two of which
+stood ready saddled, while the others were evidently carriage
+horses. These were speedily harnessed, and put into the carriage.
+
+"Now, Mike, you had better drive. I will mount one of these saddle
+horses and ride alongside. I think, mademoiselle, as the drive
+will be a long one, it would be as well that we should put the old
+woman in the carriage with you. She will be a companion, though
+one that you would not take from choice. Still, your father may
+wish to question her, and, indeed, it would be better in many
+respects that you should have a female with you."
+
+"Thank you, Monsieur Kennedy,"--for she had already learned his
+name--she said gratefully, "it would certainly be much better."
+
+The old woman was therefore brought down, and made to enter the
+carriage, and seat herself facing Mademoiselle Pointdexter. Mike
+took his seat on the box, and Desmond mounted one of the saddle
+horses, and led the other. They had already removed the bodies
+that lay in front of the gates.
+
+They had to make a considerable detour round Paris, before they
+came down upon the Versailles road. The roads were bad and the
+carriage was heavy, and daylight was already breaking when they
+entered the town. They had twice been stopped by patrols, but
+Desmond's uniform had sufficed to pass them.
+
+Baron Pointdexter had taken up his abode in a large house,
+standing in a walled garden in the lower part of the town. When
+they reached it, Desmond dismounted and rung the bell. After he
+had done this several times, a step was heard in the garden, and a
+voice asked roughly, "Who is it that rings at this hour of the
+morning?"
+
+Mademoiselle Pointdexter, who had alighted as soon as the carriage
+stopped, called out, "It is I, Eustace."
+
+There was an exclamation of surprise and joy, bolts were at once
+drawn, and the gate thrown open, and an old servitor threw himself
+on his knees as the girl entered, and, taking the hand she held
+out to him, put it to his lips.
+
+"Ah, mademoiselle," he said, while the tears streamed down his
+cheeks, "what a joyful morning it is! We have all suffered, and
+monsieur le baron most of all. He has spoken but a few words,
+since you left, but walks up and down the garden as one
+distraught, muttering to himself, and sometimes even drawing his
+sword and thrusting it at an invisible enemy. He is up,
+mademoiselle. He has never gone to his bed since you were
+missing."
+
+As he spoke, the door of the house opened, and the baron hurried
+out, with the question, "What is it, Eustace?"
+
+Then, as his eye fell on his daughter, he gave a hoarse cry, and
+for a moment swayed, as if he would have fallen. His daughter ran
+up to him, and threw her arms round his neck.
+
+"Do you return to me safe and well?" he asked, as, after a long
+embrace, he stepped back and gazed into her face.
+
+"Quite safe and well, father."
+
+"The Lord be praised!" the baron exclaimed, and, dropping into a
+garden seat by his side, he burst into a passion of sobbing.
+
+As soon as he had appeared, Desmond had handed over the old woman
+to Eustace.
+
+"She is a prisoner--keep a watch over her," he said. "She can tell
+much. We will take the carriage round to a stable, and must then
+return at once to Paris, where I must be on duty at seven. Please
+inform the baron that I shall do myself the honour of calling,
+tomorrow, to enquire whether Mademoiselle Pointdexter has suffered
+from the effects of the fatigue and excitement. Express my regret
+that I am obliged to leave at once, but I am sure he will have so
+much to hear, from his daughter, that it is best they should be
+alone together, for a time."
+
+He at once remounted his horse, Mike climbed up on to his seat,
+and they drove off, and, knocking up the people at some large
+stables, left the carriage and horses there, telling the
+proprietors to send to the Baron Pointdexter to know his wishes
+regarding it. Then Mike mounted the spare horse, and they started
+at full speed for Paris, and arrived at the barracks in time for
+Desmond to take his place at the early parade.
+
+
+
+Chapter 4: At Versailles.
+
+
+The regiment was on the point of falling in, on the parade ground,
+when Desmond Kennedy rode up. Leaping from his horse, he threw the
+reins to his servant.
+
+"Take them both round to the stables, and put them in spare
+stalls, Mike. I will get leave off parade for both of us, and ask
+the surgeon to dress your wounds properly."
+
+Then he went up to the colonel, who was just entering the barrack
+yard.
+
+"Colonel O'Brien," he said, "I must ask your leave off parade,
+for, as you see, I am scarcely in a condition to take my place
+with my company."
+
+"So it would seem, Mr. Kennedy. You have been in trouble, I see.
+Nothing serious, I hope?"
+
+"Nothing at all, sir, as far as I am concerned. It is merely a
+graze from a pistol ball."
+
+"Well, I must hear about it, afterwards."
+
+"I must also ask leave off parade for Callaghan, my servant, sir.
+He is hurt a good deal more than I am, though not, I hope,
+seriously."
+
+The colonel nodded. "I will send the surgeon to your quarters, and
+he will see to you both."
+
+As Desmond left the colonel, his two chums came up.
+
+"Why, Kennedy, what on earth have you been doing to yourself? This
+is what comes of gallivanting about after dark. When we came
+round, yesterday evening, to go out with you as usual, you were
+not in. There was nothing very unusual in that, for these evening
+walks of yours are often prolonged; but we called again, on our
+return at eleven o'clock, and found you were still absent. This
+looked serious. We came round again at six this morning, for we
+were anxious about you, and learned you had not been in all night,
+and, on enquiring, heard that Callaghan was also absent.
+
+"That was cheering. That you might get into some scrape or other,
+we could reasonably believe; but, as you had your man with you, we
+could hardly suppose that misfortune had fallen upon both of you."
+
+"The wound is a mere graze. I will tell you, after parade, what I
+have been doing," Desmond said, "but you must nurse your curiosity
+till you are dismissed."
+
+A few minutes after Desmond reached his quarters, the surgeon came
+in.
+
+"I do not think that I have any need of your services, doctor. I
+got a piece of plaster, and stuck it on two hours ago, and I have
+no doubt that the wound will heal in a few days."
+
+"However, I will, with your permission, take it off, Mr. Kennedy.
+It is much better that the wound should be properly washed, and
+some dressing applied to it. It will heal all the quicker, and you
+are less likely to have an ugly scar.
+
+"It is a pretty deep graze," he said, after he had carefully
+removed the plaster. "An eighth of an inch farther, and it would
+have made your teeth rattle. You had better keep quiet, today.
+Tomorrow morning, if there is no sign of inflammation, I will take
+off the dressing and bandage and put on a plaster--one a third of
+the size that I took off will be sufficient; and as I will use a
+pink plaster, it will not be very noticeable, if you go outside
+the barracks.
+
+"Where is your man? The colonel told me there were two patients.
+
+"A nasty cut," he said, after examining Mike's wound. "It is lucky
+that it was not a little higher. If it had been, you would have
+bled to death in five minutes. As it is, it is not serious. You
+will have to keep your arm in a sling for a fortnight. You are not
+to attend parade, or mount a horse, until I give you leave."
+
+On the ride from Versailles, Desmond had warned Mike to say no
+word as to the events of the night.
+
+"I do not know what course the young lady's father may take," he
+said, "and until I do, the matter had better be kept a secret,
+altogether."
+
+"I will keep a quiet tongue in my head, and no one shall hear
+anything, from me, as to how I got this slice on my shoulder. I
+will just say that it was a bit of a scrimmage I got into, with
+two or three of the street rascals; and the thing is so common
+that no one is likely to ask any further questions about it."
+
+After the parade was over, O'Neil and O'Sullivan came up to
+Desmond's quarters.
+
+"Now, Master Kennedy, we have come to receive your confession. We
+gave you credit for being a quiet, decent boy, and now it seems
+that you and that man of yours have been engaged in some
+disreputable riot, out all night, and coming in on two strange
+horses, which, for aught we know, have been carried off by force
+of arms."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"As to the horses, you are not so far wrong as one might expect,
+O'Neil. We rode them this morning from Versailles."
+
+"From Versailles!" O'Neil repeated. "And what, in the name of all
+the saints, took you to Versailles! I am afraid, Desmond, that you
+are falling into very evil courses.
+
+"Well, tell us all about it. I shall be glad to be able to believe
+that there is some redeeming feature in this strange business."
+
+Desmond laughed, and then said, more seriously, "Well, I have had
+an adventure. Other people were concerned in it, as well as
+myself. I have made up my mind to tell you both, because I know
+that I can depend upon your promises to keep it an absolute
+secret."
+
+"This sounds mysterious indeed," O'Sullivan said. "However, you
+have our promises. O'Neil and I will be as silent as the grave."
+
+"Well, then, you know how you were chaffing me, the other day,
+about finding Mademoiselle Pointdexter?"
+
+"You don't mean to say that you have found her, Kennedy?" O'Neil
+exclaimed incredulously.
+
+"That is what I mean to say, though found is hardly the word,
+since I was not looking for her, or even thinking of her, at the
+time. Still, in point of fact, I accidentally came across the
+place where she was hidden away, and after a sharp skirmish, in
+which Callaghan and I each had to kill two men, we carried her
+off, and delivered her safely to her father this morning."
+
+The two young officers looked hard at Desmond, to discover if he
+was speaking seriously, for his tone was so quiet, and matter of
+fact, that they could scarce credit that he had passed through
+such an exciting adventure; and the three were so accustomed to
+hoax each other, that it struck them both as simply an invention
+on the part of their comrade, so absolutely improbable did it seem
+to them.
+
+"Sure you are trying to hoax us, Kennedy," O'Sullivan said.
+
+"You could not blame me, if I were," Desmond said, with a smile,
+"considering the cock-and-bull stories that you are constantly
+trying to palm off on me. However, you are wrong now. I will tell
+you the affair, just as it happened."
+
+And he related, in detail, the story of the rescue of Mademoiselle
+Pointdexter, and the manner in which he had conveyed her to
+Versailles.
+
+"By Saint Bridget, Kennedy, we were not far wrong when we called
+you a knight errant. Well, this is something like an adventure,
+though whether it will end well or ill for you I cannot say. Did
+you learn the name of the person who had the girl carried off?"
+
+"No. I asked no questions, and indeed had but little conversation
+with her; for, as I have told you, I put her in a carriage, with
+the old hag who was in charge of her, and rode myself by the side
+of it, in case the old woman should try to escape."
+
+"A truly discreet proceeding, Kennedy," O'Neil laughed. "I think,
+if I myself had been in your place, I should have taken a seat
+inside also, where you, of course, could at once have watched the
+old woman, and talked with the young one."
+
+"I don't think that you would have done anything of the sort,
+O'Neil," Desmond said gravely, "but would have seen, as I did,
+that it was better that she should travel alone, with the old
+woman, till she reached her father's house. Scandal will be busy
+enough with her name, in any case, and it is as well that it
+should not be said that she arrived home, in a carriage, with a
+young officer of O'Brien's Irish regiment."
+
+"By my faith, Kennedy, it seems to me that you are a Saint Anthony
+and a Bayard rolled into one. But, seriously, you are undoubtedly
+right. Well, it all depends upon who was the man who carried her
+off, as to whether you were fortunate or unfortunate in thus
+having thwarted his designs. If he is some adventurer, your action
+will gain you heaps of credit. If, on the other hand, it was one
+of the king's favourites, seeking to mend his fortunes by
+marrying, it is probable that you will have made a dangerous
+enemy--nay, more, have drawn upon yourself the king's displeasure.
+I should think it likely that, before attempting so desperate an
+action as the carrying off of the Baron Pointdexter's daughter,
+such a man would have assured himself that the king would not view
+the enterprise with displeasure.
+
+"We may assume that he would not inform His Majesty of any
+particulars, but would put it, hypothetically, that as he was
+getting into sore straits, he thought of mending his fortunes by
+carrying off an heiress--not, of course, one of those of whose
+hands the king had the disposal; and that he trusted that, if he
+succeeded, His Majesty would not view the matter as a grave
+offence. From what I know of Louis, he would reply gravely: 'I
+should be obliged (duke or viscount, as the case might be) to
+express very grave displeasure, and to order you to leave the
+court for a time; but, as the harm would be done, and the young
+lady married to you, it might be that, in time, I should pardon
+the offence.'
+
+"If this is how things have gone, you may be sure that the king
+will not view, with satisfaction, the man who has interfered with
+his favourite's plan for mending his fortunes."
+
+Desmond shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"The king's dissatisfaction would matter very little to me," he
+said, "especially as he could not openly manifest it, without
+making it apparent that he had approved of the scheme."
+
+"It is not such a trifle as you think, Kennedy. Lettres de cachet
+are not difficult to obtain, by powerful members of the court;
+especially when the person named is a young regimental officer,
+whose disappearance would excite no comment or curiosity, save
+among the officers of his own regiment. The man who carried off
+Mademoiselle Pointdexter must be a bold fellow, and is likely to
+be a vindictive one. No doubt, his object was to keep the young
+lady a prisoner, until she agreed to marry him, and the loss of a
+pretty bride with a splendid fortune is no trifling one, and
+likely to be bitterly resented. Whether that resentment will take
+the form of obtaining an order for your confinement in the
+Bastille, or other royal prison, or of getting you put out of the
+way by a stab in the back, I am unable to say, but in any case, I
+should advise you strongly to give up your fancy for wandering
+about after dark; and when you do go out, keep in the frequented
+portions of the town.
+
+"Jack Farquharson, who was at Versailles with the colonel last
+week, was speaking of Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and said that she
+was charming. Did you find her so?"
+
+"I thought nothing about it, one way or the other," Desmond said,
+carelessly. "I only saw her face by torchlight, and she was, of
+course, agitated by what had happened; and indeed, as I was busy
+helping Mike to yoke the horses to the carriage, I had scarcely
+time to look at her. When we reached Versailles it was barely
+daylight. I handed her out of the carriage, and left her to enter
+by herself, as I thought it was better that she should meet her
+father alone. I do not think that I should recognize her, were I
+to meet her in the street."
+
+"Most insensible youth!" O'Sullivan said, with a laugh;
+"insensible and discreet to a point that, were it not assured,
+none would believe that you had Irish blood in your veins. And so,
+you say you are going over to Versailles tomorrow?"
+
+"Yes. I left a message with the servant who opened the door, to
+that effect. Of course, I shall be glad to know if the baron
+intends to take any steps against his daughter's abductor, or
+whether he thinks it best not to add to the scandal by stirring up
+matters, but to take her away at once to his estates."
+
+"He is in a difficult position," O'Neil said gravely. "The young
+lady has been missing for a fortnight. No one knows whether she
+went of her own free will, or against it. Were her father to carry
+her off, quietly, it would excite the worst suspicions. Better by
+far lodge his complaint before the king, proclaim his grievances
+loudly everywhere, and tell the story in all its details.
+Whichever course he takes, evil-minded people will think the
+worse; but of the two evils, the latter seems to me to be the
+lesser."
+
+"I suppose it would be," Desmond agreed, "though, for my part, I
+should be heartily glad if I never heard another word about it."
+
+"You are too modest altogether, Kennedy. Whatever rumours may be
+current, concerning the young lady, there can be no doubt that you
+come out splendidly, in that you hear a cry of a woman in
+distress; you scale walls to get in to her assistance; you and
+your servant encounter five of her guards, kill four of them and
+bind the other; rescue the maiden, and carry her off, with flying
+colours, in the carriage of her abductor. My dear Kennedy, you
+will become an object of admiration to all the ladies of the
+court."
+
+"That will be absolutely disgusting," Desmond said, angrily. "It
+is almost enough to make one wish that one had never interfered in
+the affair."
+
+"Pooh, pooh, Kennedy! I am sure that either O'Sullivan or myself
+would give, I was going to say a year's pay, though how one would
+exist without it I don't know, to have been in your place. Why,
+man, if you had captured a standard in battle, after feats of
+superhuman bravery, you would not attract half the attention that
+will fall to you as a consequence of this adventure. Life in the
+court of His Most Christian Majesty is one of the most artificial
+possible. The women hide their faces with powder and patches, lace
+themselves until they are ready to faint, walk with a mincing air,
+and live chiefly upon scandal; but they are women, after all, and
+every woman has a spice of romance in her nature, and such an
+adventure as yours is the very thing to excite their admiration."
+
+"I know nothing about women," Desmond growled, "and don't want to
+know any of them, especially the ladies at the court of Louis."
+
+"Well, of course, Kennedy, if the baron proclaims his wrongs, and
+publishes the circumstances of his daughter's abduction and
+rescue, the seal of silence will be taken from our lips;
+especially as you will, almost to a certainty, be summoned to
+Versailles to confirm the lady's story."
+
+"I am afraid that that will be so," Desmond said, despondingly.
+"However, it can't be helped, and I suppose one must make the best
+of it."
+
+To most of the officers who dropped in, in the course of the day,
+to see Desmond and to enquire how he got his wound, he abstained
+from giving any particulars. It was merely said that he and
+Callaghan were suddenly attacked, by five ruffians, whom they
+managed to beat off. Much surprise was expressed that such attack
+should be made upon an officer and a soldier, on whom little
+plunder could be expected, and who would be sure to defend
+themselves stoutly. Several, indeed, expressed some incredulity.
+
+"We do not doubt for a moment, Kennedy, that you were attacked by
+five men, as you say, and that you routed them, but there must
+have been some motive for the attack. These evening strolls of
+yours are suspicious, and I will warrant that there must have been
+a great deal at the bottom of it. Now, can you deny that?"
+
+"I neither admit nor deny anything," Desmond said, with a smile;
+"enough that, at present, I have told you all that I feel
+justified in telling. I acknowledge that there is more behind it,
+but at present my mouth is sealed on the subject."
+
+The colonel was among those who came in to see him. To him,
+Desmond said frankly that the affair was altogether out of the
+common, that it was likely that the whole facts would be known
+shortly, but that, as other persons were concerned, he could not
+speak of it until he had obtained their permission.
+
+"Then I will ask no further," Colonel O'Brien said. "I have seen
+enough of you to know that you would not be concerned in any
+affair that could bring discredit upon the corps. I am curious to
+know the whole story, but am quite content to wait until you feel
+at liberty to tell me."
+
+The next morning, Desmond took part in the usual work of the
+regiment, and then, mounting his horse, rode to Versailles. On his
+ringing the bell at the house occupied by the Baron de Pointdexter,
+the old servitor, whom he had before seen, opened the gate.
+
+"The baron is expecting you, monsieur," he said, bowing deeply;
+and, at his call, another servant ran out and took Desmond's
+horse, and led it away to the stable, while Desmond followed the
+old man to the house.
+
+The door opened as they approached, and the baron, a tall man,
+some fifty years of age, advanced hastily, holding out both hands.
+
+"Monsieur Kennedy," he said, "you have rendered to me the greatest
+service that I have received during my life. No words can express
+the gratitude that I feel, for one who has restored to me my only
+child, just when I had come to believe that she was lost to me
+forever. It was surely her guardian saint who sent you to the
+spot, at that moment."
+
+"It might have happened to anyone, sir," Desmond said; "surely any
+gentleman, on hearing an appeal for help from a woman in distress,
+would have done just what I did."
+
+"Let us go in," the baron said. "My daughter has been eagerly
+waiting your coming, especially as she tells me that she does not
+think she said even a word of thanks to you, being overpowered by
+what she had gone through, and by her joy at her sudden and
+unexpected deliverance. Indeed, she says that she scarcely
+exchanged two words with you."
+
+"There was no opportunity, Baron, for indeed, as soon as she told
+me that there was a carriage and horses in the stable, I was too
+much occupied in getting it ready for her to depart without delay,
+to think of talking."
+
+They had now entered the house, and, as the baron led the way into
+the sitting room, the girl rose from a fauteuil.
+
+"This, Monsieur Kennedy, is my daughter, Mademoiselle Anne de
+Pointdexter. It is high time that you were formally presented to
+each other.
+
+"This, Anne, is the officer who rendered you such invaluable
+service."
+
+"We meet almost as strangers, mademoiselle," Desmond said, deeply
+bowing, "for I own that I saw so little of your face, the other
+night, that I should hardly have recognized you, had I met you
+elsewhere."
+
+"I should certainly not have recognized you, Monsieur Kennedy.
+What with my own fright, and, I may say, the condition of your
+face, I had but a faint idea of what you were really like; but I
+certainly did not think that you were so young. You had such a
+masterful way with you, and seemed to know so perfectly what ought
+to be done, that I took you to be much older than you now look."
+
+"I joined the regiment but little more than three months ago,"
+Desmond said, "and am its youngest ensign."
+
+"Monsieur, I owe to you more than my life, for, had it not been
+for you, I should have been forced into marriage with one whom I
+despise."
+
+"I cannot think that, mademoiselle. From what I saw of you, I
+should say that you would have resisted all threats, and even
+undergone hopeless imprisonment, rather than yield."
+
+"There is no saying, Monsieur Kennedy," the baron said. "Anne is
+of good blood, and I know that it would have been hard to break
+down her will, but confinement and hopelessness will tell on the
+bravest spirit. However that may be, she and I are your debtors
+for life."
+
+"Indeed, Monsieur Kennedy," the girl said, "I pray you to believe
+that I am more grateful to you than words can express."
+
+"I pray you to say no more about it, mademoiselle. I deem it a
+most fortunate circumstance, that I was able to come to your
+assistance, and especially so, when I found that the lady I had
+rescued was one whose disappearance had made so great a stir; but
+I should have been glad to render such service to one in the
+poorest condition."
+
+"My daughter said that you asked her no questions, Monsieur
+Kennedy, and you therefore are, I suppose, in ignorance of the
+name of her abductor?"
+
+"Altogether."
+
+"It was the Vicomte de Tulle, one who stands very high in the regard
+of the king, and who is one of the most extravagant and dissipated,
+even of the courtiers here. For some time, it has been reported that
+he had nigh ruined himself by his lavish expenditure, and doubtless
+he thought to reestablish his finances by this bold stroke.
+
+"His plans were well laid. He waited until I had gone to Paris on
+business that would keep me there for a day or two. A messenger
+arrived with a letter, purporting to be from me, saying that I
+wished my daughter to join me at once, and had sent a carriage to
+take her to me. Anne is young, and, suspecting no harm, at once
+threw on a mantle and hood, and entered the carriage. It was broad
+daylight, and there was nothing to disquiet her until, on
+approaching the town, the carriage turned off the main road. This
+struck her as strange, and she was just about to ask the question
+where she was being taken, when the carriage stopped in a lonely
+spot, the door was opened, and a man stepped in.
+
+"Before she had even time to recognize him, he threw a thick cloak
+over her head. She struggled in vain to free herself, but he held
+her fast. Again and again, she tried to cry out, but her mouth was
+muffled by the wrapping. She had heard the blinds of the carriage
+drawn, and finding that her struggles to free herself were vain,
+and receiving no answer to her supplications to be released, she
+remained quiet until the carriage stopped. Then she was lifted
+out, and carried into the house where you found her.
+
+"The wrapping was removed, and the man who had taken it off, and,
+who by his attire, was a gentleman in the service of some noble,
+said, 'Do not be alarmed, mademoiselle. No harm is intended to
+you. My master is grieved to be obliged to adopt such means, but
+his passion for you is so great that he was driven to this step,
+and it will entirely depend upon yourself when your captivity will
+end.'
+
+"'Your master, whoever he may be,' Anne said, 'is a contemptible
+villain.'
+
+"'Naturally, you have a poor opinion of him at present,' the
+fellow said; 'but I am convinced that, in time, you will come to
+excuse his fault. It is wholly due to the depth of the feeling
+that he entertains towards you. There is a woman here who will
+wait upon you. I and my men will not intrude. Our duty is solely
+to see that you do not escape, which indeed would be an
+impossibility for you, seeing that the wall that surrounds the
+garden is well-nigh fifteen feet high, and the gate barred and
+locked, and the key thereof in my pocket.'
+
+"He called, and the old woman whom you brought here with Anne
+entered, and bid her ascend to the room that had been prepared for
+her.
+
+"In that respect, she had nothing to complain of. Of course, you
+did not notice it, as you had other things to think of, but it was
+handsomely furnished. There was a bed in an alcove, some flowers
+on the table, some books, and even a harpsichord--evidently it was
+intended that her imprisonment should be made as light as might
+be.
+
+"Looking from the window, Anne saw that the room was at the back
+of the house, and had probably been chosen because some trees shut
+the window off from view of anyone beyond the wall. The next day,
+the old woman announced the Vicomte de Tulle. He bowed profoundly,
+and began by excusing the step that he had taken, and crediting it
+solely to the passion that he had conceived for her. You may
+imagine the scorn and reproaches with which she answered him. He
+was quite unmoved by her words.
+
+"'Mademoiselle,' he said calmly, when she paused, 'you may be sure
+that I should not have undertaken this scheme, unless I had fully
+weighed the consequences. My plans have been so laid that whatever
+search may be made for you will be in vain. Here you are, and here
+you will remain until you listen to my suit. Every want shall be
+satisfied, and every wish complied with; but, whether it is one
+year or five, you will not leave this house until you leave it as
+my bride.'
+
+"'Then, sir,' she said passionately, 'I shall be a prisoner for
+life.'
+
+"'So you may think, at present, mademoiselle,' he said. 'And I
+expected nothing else. But, with time and reflection, you may come
+to think otherwise. Union with me is not so terrible a matter. My
+rank you know, and standing high, as I do, in the favour of His
+Most Gracious Majesty, your position at court will be such as
+might gratify the daughter of the noblest family in France. The
+study of my life will be to make you happy.
+
+"'I shall now leave you to think over the matter. I shall not
+pester you with my attentions, and for another month you will not
+see me again. At the end of that time, I trust that you will have
+seen the futility of condemning yourself to further captivity, and
+will be disposed to make more allowance, than at present, for the
+step to which my passion for yourself has driven me.'
+
+"It was just a month since she had been carried off, and, the very
+day when you rescued her, the old woman had informed her that the
+vicomte would do himself the pleasure of calling upon her the next
+day. For the first fortnight she had held up bravely, in the hope
+that I should discover the place where she had been hidden. Then
+she began to feel the imprisonment and silence telling upon her,
+for the old woman only entered to bring in her meals, and never
+opened her lips, except on the first occasion, when she told her
+that she was strictly forbidden to converse with her. After that
+she began to despair, and the news that her abductor would visit
+her, the next day, decided her to make an attempt to escape. She
+had no difficulty in letting herself down from the window by the
+aid of her bedclothes, but she found that what had been said
+respecting the wall and gate was true, and that she was no nearer
+escape than she had been, before she had left her room. She was
+trying, in vain, to unbar the gate, which, indeed, would have been
+useless could she have accomplished it, as it was also locked. But
+she was striving, with the energy of desperation, when the door of
+the house opened, and the men rushed out and seized her. As they
+dragged her back to the house, she uttered the cries that brought
+you to her assistance. The rest you know.
+
+"As soon as I heard her story, I went to the palace and asked for
+a private interview with the king. The king received me graciously
+enough, and asked, with an appearance of great interest, if I had
+obtained any news of my daughter.
+
+"'I have more than obtained news, Your Majesty. I have my daughter
+back again, and I have come to demand justice at your hands.'
+
+"'I congratulate you, indeed, Baron,' the king said, with an
+appearance of warmth, but I saw his colour change, and was
+convinced that he knew something, at least, of the matter.
+
+"'And where has the damsel been hiding herself?' he went on.
+
+"'She has not been hiding herself, at all, Sire,' I said. 'She has
+been abducted, by one of Your Majesty's courtiers, with the
+intention of forcing her into a marriage. His name, Sire, is the
+Vicomte de Tulle, and I demand that justice shall be done me, and
+that he shall receive the punishment due to so gross an outrage.'
+
+"The king was silent for a minute, and then said:
+
+"'He has, indeed, if you have been rightly informed, acted most
+grossly. Still, it is evident that he repented the step that he
+took, and so suffered her to return to you.'
+
+"'Not so, Your Majesty,' I said. 'I owe her return to no
+repentance on his part, but to the gallantry of a young officer
+who, passing the house where she was confined, heard her cries for
+aid, and, with his soldier servant, climbed the gate of the
+enclosure, and was there attacked by the man who had charge of
+her, with four others. The young gentleman and his servant killed
+four of them, and bound the other; and then, entering the house,
+compelled the woman who had been appointed to act as her servant
+to lead the way to her chamber. Fortunately, the carriage in which
+she had been taken there was still in the stables, with its
+horses. The gallant young gentleman at once got the carriage in
+readiness, placed my daughter in it, with the woman who had been
+attending on her. The servant drove, and he rode by the side of
+the carriage, and in that way brought her home this morning.'
+
+"In spite of his efforts to appear indifferent, it was evident
+that the king was greatly annoyed. However, he only said:
+
+"'You did quite right to come to me, Baron. It is outrageous,
+indeed, that a young lady of my court should be thus carried off,
+and I will see that justice is done. And who is this officer, who
+has rendered your daughter such a service?'
+
+"'His name is Kennedy, Sire. He is an ensign in O'Brien's Irish
+regiment.'
+
+"'I will myself send for him,' he said, 'and thank him for having
+defeated this disgraceful plot of the Vicomte de Tulle. I suppose
+you are quite sure of all the circumstances, as you have told them
+to me?'
+
+"'It is impossible that there can be any mistake, Sire,' I said.
+'In the first place, I have my daughter's account. This is
+entirely corroborated by the old woman she had brought with her,
+and whose only hope of escaping from punishment lay in telling the
+truth. In every respect, she fully confirmed my daughter's
+account.'
+
+"'But the vicomte has not been absent from Versailles, for the
+past month. He has been at my morning levee, and on all other
+occasions at my breakfasts and dinners. He has walked with me in
+the gardens, and been always present at the evening receptions.'
+
+"'That is so, Sire,' I said. 'My daughter, happily, saw him but
+once; namely, on the morning after she was captured. He then told
+her, frankly, that she would remain a prisoner until she consented
+to marry him, however long the time might be. He said he would
+return in a month, and hoped by that time to find that, seeing the
+hopelessness of her position, she would be more inclined to accept
+his suit.
+
+"'It was on the eve of his coming again that my daughter, in her
+desperation, made the attempt to escape. She was foiled in her
+effort, but this, nevertheless, brought about her rescue, for her
+cries, as her guards dragged her into the house, attracted the
+attention of Monsieur Kennedy, who forthwith, as I have told you,
+stormed the house, killed her guards, and brought her home to me.'
+
+"The king then sent for de Tulle, and spoke to him with great
+sternness. The latter did not attempt to deny my accusation, but
+endeavoured to excuse himself, on the ground of the passion that
+he had conceived for my daughter. Certainly, from the king's tone,
+I thought that he would at least have sent him to the Bastille;
+but, to my great disappointment, he wound up his reproof by
+saying:
+
+"'I can, of course, make some allowances for your passion for so
+charming a young lady as Mademoiselle Pointdexter, but the outrage
+you committed is far too serious to be pardoned. You will at once
+repair to your estates, and will remain there during my pleasure.'
+
+"The vicomte bowed and withdrew, and, an hour later, left
+Versailles. The king turned to me, as he left the room, and said,
+'I trust, Monsieur le Baron, that you are content that justice has
+been done.'
+
+"I was too angry to choose my words, and I said firmly, 'I cannot
+say that I am content, Your Majesty. Such an outrage as that which
+has been perpetrated upon my daughter deserves a far heavier
+punishment than banishment from court; and methinks that an
+imprisonment, as long as that which he intended to inflict upon
+her unless she consented to be his wife, would have much more
+nearly met the justice of the case.'
+
+"The king rose to his feet suddenly, and I thought that my
+boldness would meet with the punishment that I desired for de
+Tulle; but he bit his lips, and then said coldly:
+
+"'You are not often at court, Baron Pointdexter, and are doubtless
+ignorant that I am not accustomed to be spoken to, in the tone
+that you have used. However, I can make due allowance for the
+great anxiety that you have suffered, at your daughter's
+disappearance. I trust that I shall see you and your daughter at
+my levee, this evening.'
+
+"As this was a command, of course we went, and I am bound to say
+that the king did all in his power to show to his court that he
+considered her to be wholly blameless. Of course, the story had
+already got about, and it was known that the vicomte had been
+ordered to his estates. The king was markedly civil to Anne,
+talked to her for some time, expressed his deep regret that she
+should have been subject to such an outrage, while staying at his
+court, and said, in a tone loud enough to be heard by all standing
+round:
+
+"'The only redeeming point in the matter is, that the Vicomte de
+Tulle in no way troubled or molested you, and that you only saw
+him, for a few minutes, on the first day of your confinement.'
+
+"I need not say that this royal utterance was most valuable to my
+daughter, and that it at once silenced any malicious scandal that
+might otherwise have got about.
+
+"The king stopped to speak to me, immediately afterwards, and I
+said:
+
+"'I trust that you will pardon the words I spoke this morning.
+Your Majesty has rendered me and my daughter an inestimable
+service, by the speech that you have just made.'
+
+"Thus, although dissatisfied with the punishment inflicted on the
+Vicomte de Tulle, and believing that the king had a shrewd idea
+who her abductor was, I am grateful to him for shielding my
+daughter from ill tongues, by his marked kindness to her, and by
+declaring openly that de Tulle had not seen her, since the day of
+her abduction. I intended to return home tomorrow, but the king
+himself, when I went this morning to pay my respects, and state my
+intention of taking Anne home, bade those standing round to fall
+back, and was good enough to say in a low voice to me:
+
+"'I think, Baron, that you would do well to reconsider your
+decision to leave tomorrow. Your sudden departure would give rise
+to ill-natured talk. It would be wiser to stay here, for a short
+time, till the gossip and wonder have passed away.'
+
+"I saw that His Majesty was right, and shall stay here for a short
+time longer. It would certainly have a bad effect, were we to seem
+to run away and hide ourselves in the provinces."
+
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter had retired when her father began to
+relate to Desmond what had happened.
+
+"I know little of life in Paris, Monsieur le Baron," Desmond said,
+"but it certainly seems to me monstrous, that the man who
+committed this foul outrage should escape with what is, doubtless,
+but a short banishment from court."
+
+"I do not know that the matter is ended yet, Monsieur Kennedy. In
+spite of the edicts against duelling, I myself should have
+demanded satisfaction from him, for this attack upon the honour of
+my family, but I am at present Anne's only protector. It is many
+years since I have drawn a sword, while de Tulle is noted as a
+fencer, and has had many affairs, of which he has escaped the
+consequences owing to royal favour. Therefore, were I to challenge
+him, the chances are that I should be killed, in which case my
+daughter would become a ward of the crown, and her hand and estate
+be bestowed on one of the king's creatures. But, as I said, the
+matter is not likely to rest as it is.
+
+"Anne has, with my full consent and approval, given her love to a
+young gentleman of our province. He is a large-landed proprietor,
+and a connection of our family. They are not, as yet, formally
+betrothed, for I have no wish to lose her so soon; and, in spite
+of the present fashion of early marriages, I by no means approve
+of them, and told Monsieur de la Vallee that they must wait for
+another couple of years.
+
+"I need scarcely say that, after what has happened, I shall
+reconsider my decision; for the sooner she is married, and beyond
+the reach of a repetition of this outrage, the better. I imagine,
+however, that the young gentleman will be no better satisfied than
+I am, that the matter should have been passed over so lightly; and
+will take it into his own hands, and send a challenge immediately
+to the vicomte. He is high spirited, and has the reputation among
+us of being a good fencer, but I doubt whether he can possess such
+skill as that which de Tulle has acquired. It is not always the
+injured person that comes off victorious in a duel; and, should
+fortune go against Monsieur de la Vallee, it would be a terrible
+blow to my daughter, and indeed to myself, for I am much attached
+to him. She is worrying about it, already.
+
+"Of course, it is impossible that the affair can be hidden from
+him. It is public property now; and therefore, I sent off one of
+my grooms, an hour since, with a letter to him.
+
+"Hitherto, I had not written to him about my daughter's
+disappearance. Knowing he would, on hearing of it, at once hasten
+here, where he could do no good and would only add to my trouble,
+I thought it best to let matters go on as they were. I had been
+doing everything that was possible, and to have his troubles as
+well as my own on my hands would have driven me to distraction.
+
+"The groom is to change horses at every post house, and to use the
+greatest possible speed. You may be sure that Monsieur de la
+Vallee will do the same, and that in six days he will be here. I
+have given him the merest outline of the affair, and have not
+mentioned the name of Anne's abductor. Had I done so, it is
+probable that Philip would have gone straight to de Tulle, and
+forced on an encounter at once. As it is, I trust that Anne and I,
+between us, may persuade him to take no step in the matter. It is
+the honour of my family, not of his, that has been attacked. Had
+he been betrothed to my daughter, he would have been in a position
+to take up her quarrel. As it is, he has no status, except distant
+relationship.
+
+"And now, Monsieur Kennedy, I have the king's order to take you to
+the palace. He asked me several questions about you this morning.
+I said that I had not yet seen you, but that you were riding over
+here today, and he said:
+
+"'Bring him to me when he comes, Baron. I should like to see this
+young fire eater, who thrust himself so boldly into a matter in
+which he had no concern, solely because he heard a woman's voice
+calling for help.'"
+
+"I am sorry to hear it," Desmond said, bluntly. "From what you say
+I imagine that, in spite of what he has done, the king is far from
+gratified at the failure of his favourite's plan. However, I
+cannot disobey his commands in the matter."
+
+
+
+Chapter 5: A New Friend.
+
+
+The baron sent a servant to request his daughter to come down.
+
+"I am going now, with Monsieur Kennedy, to the palace, Anne," he
+said, as she entered. "I do not suppose that we shall be absent
+very long. I have been talking matters over with him, and I think
+that he agrees with my view of them."
+
+"But I have hardly spoken to him, yet, father!"
+
+"You will have an opportunity of doing so, when we return.
+Monsieur Kennedy will, of course, dine with us. After the service
+that he has rendered to us, we have a right to consider him as
+belonging to us."
+
+"Had I had an idea of this," Desmond said, as they walked up the
+hill towards the palace gate, "I should have put on my full
+uniform. This undress is scarcely the attire in which one would
+appear before the King of France, who is, as I have heard, most
+particular in matters of etiquette."
+
+"He is so," the baron said. "He will know that you could not be
+prepared for an audience, and doubtless he will receive you in his
+private closet."
+
+On ascending the grand staircase, the baron gave his name to one
+of the court chamberlains.
+
+"I have orders," the latter said, "to take you at once, on your
+presenting yourself, to His Majesty's closet, instead of entering
+the audience chamber."
+
+They were conducted along a private passage, of considerable
+length. On arriving at a door, the chamberlain asked them to wait,
+while he went inside to ascertain whether His Majesty was
+disengaged.
+
+"His Majesty will see you in a few minutes, Baron," he said, when
+he came out. "The Duc d'Orleans is with him, but, hearing your
+name announced for a private audience, he is taking his leave."
+
+In two or three minutes a handbell sounded in the room, and the
+chamberlain, who at once entered, returned in a moment, and
+conducted the baron and Desmond into the king's private apartment.
+
+"Allow me to present, to Your Majesty," the former said, "Monsieur
+Desmond Kennedy, an officer in O'Brien's regiment, and an Irish
+gentleman of good family."
+
+The king, who was now far advanced in life, looked at the young
+man with some surprise.
+
+"I had expected to see an older man," he said.
+
+"Though you told me, Baron, he was but an ensign, I looked to see
+a man of the same type as so many of my gallant Irish officers,
+ready for any desperate service.
+
+"So, young sir, you have begun early, indeed, to play havoc among
+my liege subjects, for I hear that you, and a soldier with you,
+slew four of them."
+
+"Hardly your liege subjects, Your Majesty, if I may venture to say
+so; for, assuredly, they were not engaged in lawful proceedings,
+when I came upon them."
+
+A slight smile crossed the king's face. He was accustomed to
+adulation, and the simple frankness with which this young soldier
+ventured to discuss the propriety of the word he used surprised
+and amused him.
+
+"You are right, sir. These fellows, who are ready to undertake any
+service, however criminal, for which they are paid, certainly do
+not deserve to be called liege subjects. Now, I would hear from,
+your own lips, how it was that you thrust yourself into a matter
+with which you had no concern; being wholly ignorant, I
+understand, that the lady whose voice you heard was Mademoiselle
+Pointdexter."
+
+"The matter was very simple, Sire. Having joined the regiment but
+a few months, and being naturally anxious to perfect myself in
+exercises in arms, I have but little time to stir out, during the
+day, and of an evening I frequently go for long rambles, taking
+with me my soldier servant. I had, that evening, gone farther than
+usual, the night being fair and the weather balmy, and naturally,
+when I heard the cry of a woman in distress, I determined to see
+what had happened, as it might well be that murder was being
+done."
+
+He then related all the circumstances of his obtaining an entrance
+into the gardens, of the attack upon him by the guard, and how he
+finally brought Mademoiselle Pointdexter to Versailles. The king
+listened attentively.
+
+"It was an exploit I should have loved to perform, when I was your
+age, Monsieur Kennedy. You behaved in the matter with singular
+discretion and gallantry; but, if you intend always to interfere,
+when you hear a woman cry out, it is like that your time will be
+pretty well occupied; and that, before long, there will be a
+vacancy in the ranks of your regiment. Truly, Monsieur le Baron
+and his daughter have reason for gratitude that you happened to be
+passing at the time; and I, as King of France, am glad that this
+outrage on a lady of the court has failed.
+
+"I am, perhaps, not altogether without blame in the matter. A
+short time ago, the Vicomte de Tulle told me that he hoped to
+better his fortune by a rich marriage. He named no names, nor said
+aught of the measures he intended to adopt. But I said it would be
+well that he should do so, for rumours had reached me that his
+finances were in disorder. Whether he took this as a permission to
+use any means that he thought fit I cannot tell; and I certainly
+did not suspect, when I heard of the disappearance of Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter, that he had any hand in it, and was shocked when
+the baron came here and denounced him to me. I am glad, indeed,
+that his enterprise was thwarted, for it was a most unworthy one.
+
+"You are too young, yet, for me to grant you military promotion,
+but this will be a proof of my approbation of your conduct, and
+that the King of France is determined to suppress all irregularities
+at his court."
+
+And, taking a diamond ring from his finger, he handed it to
+Desmond, who went on one knee to receive it.
+
+"You will please inform your colonel that, when he comes to
+Versailles, I request he will always bring you with him."
+
+The audience was evidently finished, and the baron and Desmond,
+bowing deeply, left the king's cabinet. The baron did not speak,
+till they left the palace.
+
+"Louis has his faults," the baron then said, "but no one could
+play the part of a great monarch more nobly than he does. I have
+no doubt, whatever, that de Tulle relied implicitly upon obtaining
+his forgiveness, had he succeeded in forcing Anne into marrying
+him; though, doubtless, he would have feigned displeasure for a
+time. He has extricated himself most gracefully. I can quite
+believe that he did not imagine his favourite intended to adopt so
+criminal a course, to accomplish the matter of which he spoke to
+him, but he could not fail to have his suspicions, when he heard
+of Anne's disappearance. However, we can consider the affair as
+happily ended, except for the matter of Monsieur de la Vallee, of
+whom I spoke to you.
+
+"And now, sir, that the king has expressed his gratitude to you,
+for saving his court from a grave scandal, how can I fitly express
+my own, at the inestimable service that you have rendered us?"
+
+"I should say, Baron, that it will be most welcomely expressed, if
+you will abstain from saying more of the matter. It is a simple
+one. I went to the assistance of a woman in distress; and
+succeeded, at the expense of this trifling wound, in accomplishing
+her rescue. The lady happened to be your daughter, but had she
+been but the daughter of some little bourgeois of Paris, carried
+off by a reckless noble, it would have been the same. Much more
+has been made of the matter than there was any occasion for. It
+has gained for me the approbation and thanks of the king, to say
+nothing of this ring, which, although I am no judge of such
+matters, must be a very valuable one, or he would not have worn
+it; and I have had the pleasure of rendering a service to you, and
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter. Therefore, I feel far more than duly
+rewarded, for a service somewhat recklessly undertaken on the spur
+of the moment."
+
+"That may be very well, as far as it interests yourself, Monsieur
+Kennedy; but not so far as I am concerned, and I fear I shall have
+to remain your debtor till the end of my life. All I can say at
+present is that I hope that, as soon as you can obtain leave, you
+will come as a most honoured guest to my chateau. There you will
+see me under happier circumstances. The life of a country seigneur
+is but a poor preparation for existence in this court, where,
+although there is no longer the open licentiousness that prevailed
+in the king's younger days, there is yet, I believe, an equal
+amount of profligacy, though it has been sternly discountenanced
+since Madame Maintenon obtained an absolute, and I may say a
+well-used, influence over His Majesty."
+
+"I shall be happy, indeed, to pay you a visit, Baron, if my
+military duties will permit my absenting myself, for a time, from
+Paris. All I know of France is its capital, and nothing would give
+me greater pleasure than to have the opportunity of seeing its
+country life, in so pleasant a manner."
+
+"Our pleasure would be no less than your own, Monsieur Kennedy.
+
+"There is one thing I must warn you about, and that is, you must
+be careful for a time not to go out after dark. De Tulle has an
+evil reputation, and is vindictive as well as unscrupulous.
+Doubtless, he has agents here who will, by this time, have
+discovered who it was that brought his daring scheme to naught;
+and it is, to my mind, more than probable that he will endeavour
+to be revenged."
+
+"I shall be on my guard," Desmond said quietly.
+
+"You must be careful, indeed," the baron said. "Against open
+violence you can well defend yourself, but against a blow from
+behind with a dagger, skill and courage are of little avail. When
+you go out after dark, I pray you let your army servant follow
+closely behind you, and see that his sword is loose in its
+scabbard."
+
+Desmond nodded.
+
+"Believe me, I will take every precaution. It is not likely that
+there will long be need for it, for none can doubt that military
+operations will soon begin on a large scale, and we are not
+likely, if that is the case, to be kept in garrison in Paris."
+
+When Desmond arrived that evening at the barracks, he found that
+the story of the rescue of Mademoiselle de Pointdexter was already
+known, and also that the Vicomte de Tulle had been the abductor,
+and had, in consequence, been banished from court. The baron had
+indeed related the circumstances to some of his intimate friends,
+but the story had varied greatly as it spread, and it had come to
+be reported that an officer had brought a strong body of soldiers,
+who had assaulted the house where she was confined, and, after a
+desperate conflict, had annihilated the guard that had been placed
+over her.
+
+Desmond laughed, as this story was told to him, when he entered
+the room where the officers were gathered. The narrator concluded:
+
+"As you have been to Versailles, Kennedy, doubtless you will have
+heard all the latest particulars. Have you learnt who was the
+officer, what regiment he belonged to, and how came he to have a
+body of soldiers with him, outside the town? For they say that the
+house where she was confined was a mile and a half beyond the
+walls."
+
+There was no longer any reason for concealment. The matter had
+become public. The baron would certainly mention his name, and
+indeed his visit to the palace, and the private audience given to
+him and the baron, would assuredly have been noted.
+
+"Your story is quite new to me," he said, "and is swollen, in the
+telling, to undue proportions. The real facts of the case are by
+no means so romantic. The truth of the story, by this time, is
+generally known, as Mademoiselle Pointdexter and her father have
+many friends at court. The affair happened to myself."
+
+"To you, Kennedy?" was exclaimed, in astonishment, by all those
+present.
+
+"Exactly so," he said. "Nothing could have been more simple. The
+evening before last I was, as usual, taking a walk and, the night
+being fine, I passed beyond the gate. Presently, I heard a scream
+and a woman's cry for help. None of you, gentlemen, could have
+been insensible to such an appeal. Callaghan and I climbed over a
+pretty high gate. Not knowing what force there might be in the
+place, we occupied ourselves, at first, by unbarring and shooting
+the lock of the gate. The bolts were stiff, and we made some noise
+over it, which brought out five men. These we disposed of, after a
+short fight, in which I got this graze on the cheek, and Callaghan
+his sword wound in the shoulder."
+
+"How did you dispose of them, Kennedy?" the colonel asked.
+
+"I ran two of them through. Callaghan cut down one, and shot
+another. The fifth man cried for mercy, and we simply tied him up.
+
+"We then found Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and, learning from her
+that the carriage in which she had been brought there was, with
+its horses, still in the stable, we got it out, harnessed the
+horses, and put an old woman who was mademoiselle's attendant in
+the carriage with her. Mike took the reins, I mounted a saddle
+horse, and we drove her to her father's house at Versailles, saw
+her fairly inside, and then, as you know, got back here just as
+the regiment was forming up on parade."
+
+"A very pretty adventure, indeed," the colonel said warmly, and
+loud expressions of approbation rose from the other listeners.
+
+"And why did you not tell us, when you came in?" the colonel went
+on.
+
+"I had not seen Baron Pointdexter, and did not know what course he
+would take--whether he would think it best to hush the matter up
+altogether, or to lay a complaint before the king; and, until I
+knew what he was going to do, it seemed to me best that I should
+hold my tongue, altogether.
+
+"When I went to Versailles, today, I found that he had laid his
+complaint before the king, and that the Vicomte de Tulle, who was
+the author of the outrage, had been ordered to his estates. I may
+say that I had the honour of a private interview with His Majesty,
+who graciously approved of my conduct, and gave me this ring," and
+he held out his hand, "as a token of his approval."
+
+"Well, gentlemen, you will agree with me," the colonel said, "that
+our young ensign has made an admirable debut, and I am sure that
+we are all proud of the manner in which he has behaved; and our
+anticipations, that he would prove a credit to the regiment, have
+been verified sooner than it seemed possible."
+
+"They have, indeed, Colonel," the major said. "It was, in every
+way, a risky thing for him to have attempted. I do not mean
+because of the odds that he might have to face, but because of the
+trouble that he might have got into, by forcing his way into a
+private house. The scream might have come from a mad woman, or
+from a serving wench receiving a whipping for misconduct."
+
+"I never thought anything about it, Major. A woman screamed for
+help, and it seemed to me that help should be given. I did not
+think of the risk, either from armed men inside--for I had no
+reason to believe that there were such--or of civil indictment for
+breaking in. We heard the cry, made straight for the house, and,
+as it turned out, all went well."
+
+"Well, indeed," the colonel said. "You have rescued a wealthy
+heiress from a pitiable fate. You have fleshed your maiden sword
+in the bodies of two villains. You have earned the gratitude of
+the young lady and her father, and have received the approval of
+His Majesty--a very good night's work, altogether. Now, tell us a
+little more about it."
+
+Desmond was compelled to tell the story in much further detail
+than before. The colonel ordered in a dozen of champagne, and it
+was late before the party broke up.
+
+"You see, we were pretty nearly right in our guess," O'Neil said,
+as he and O'Sullivan walked across with Desmond to their quarters.
+"We said that we thought it likely she might have been carried off
+by one of the court gallants, who felt tolerably confident that,
+if successful, the king would overlook the offence. This fellow,
+thanks to your interference, did not succeed; and the king has let
+him off, lightly enough, by only banishing him from court. If it
+had been anyone but one of his favourites, he would, by this time,
+have been a tenant of the Bastille.
+
+"I do not think, myself, that his punishment was adequate; but
+then, I am not a courtier, and should be rather glad than not, to
+be sent away to any estates I might have."
+
+"But," Desmond remarked, "I suppose the punishment is a severe one
+to these men, accustomed to a round of pleasure and dissipation,
+and who consider it the highest of earthly honours to be in favour
+with the king. However, no one could be kinder than His Majesty
+has been, on the subject. At the reception last night, at which he
+ordered the baron and his daughter to appear, he showed her the
+most marked favour, and particularly put a stop to all scandals,
+by saying loudly that de Tulle had never seen her, after the first
+morning of her capture."
+
+Six days later, when Desmond was engaged in the fencing room,
+Callaghan came in, and told him that a gentleman was at his
+quarters, wishing particularly to see him.
+
+"What is his name?"
+
+"Sure, and I don't know, your honour. He did not mention it, and
+it was not for the likes of me to ask him."
+
+"Ridiculous, Mike! In future, when anyone comes and wishes to see
+me, you will say, 'What name shall I tell Mr. Kennedy?'"
+
+He put on his uniform coat reluctantly, for he was engaged in an
+interesting bout with a professor, who was an old friend of the
+maitre d'armes. As he entered his room, a young man, who had been
+staring out of the window, and drumming impatiently with his
+fingers, turned. He was a stranger to Desmond.
+
+"I am Desmond Kennedy, sir," the young officer said. "To what do I
+owe the honour of this visit?"
+
+The other did not reply, but stood looking at him, in so strange
+and earnest a way, that Desmond felt almost uneasy.
+
+"Sir," his visitor said at last, advancing to him and holding out
+both hands, "when I tell you that my name is Philip de la Vallee,
+you will understand what must strike you as my singular behaviour.
+I arrived last night at Versailles, and heard all that had
+happened. You can imagine, therefore, that my heart is almost too
+full for words, with gratitude and thankfulness."
+
+Desmond was moved by the emotion of his visitor, and their hands
+met in a hearty clasp. Monsieur de la Vallee was a young man, of
+four or five and twenty, well proportioned, and active and sinewy
+from his devotion to field sports. He was about the same height as
+Desmond himself, but the latter, who had not yet finished growing,
+was larger boned, and would broaden into a much bigger and more
+powerful man.
+
+"Henceforth, Monsieur Kennedy," de la Vallee went on, "I hope that
+we shall be as brothers, and more. Had it not been for you, my
+life would have been a ruined one. What agony have I been saved!
+It makes me mad, to think that I was idling at home, ignorant that
+my beloved had been carried away. I do not blame the baron for not
+informing me, and I acknowledge that the reasons he gave me were
+good ones. I could have done nothing, and should but have added to
+his troubles by my anxiety and anger. Still, he told me that, in
+another day or two, he would have felt that I ought no longer to
+be kept in the dark, and would have summoned me to Paris. I am
+thankful now that he did not do so, for I believe that my
+impotence to do anything would have driven me almost to
+distraction."
+
+"I agree with you that the baron acted wisely," Kennedy said. "Had
+not chance, or Providence, taken me past the house where she was
+imprisoned, at the very moment when Mademoiselle Pointdexter cried
+for help, she might, for aught I can say, have remained a captive
+there for months, or even years."
+
+"It was Providence, indeed, Monsieur Kennedy. Providence, not only
+that she should have cried at that moment, but that her cries
+should have reached the ears of one so ready and able to save her.
+And now, I pray you, call me Philip, and allow me to call you
+Desmond, as a pledge of our close friendship."
+
+"With pleasure," Kennedy replied; and the compact was sealed with
+another close grasp of the hand.
+
+"It is strange, Desmond, that while the king, who had but little
+interest in the matter, could present you, as I am told he did,
+with a diamond ring, the baron and I, who owe you so much, can do
+nothing to show our gratitude."
+
+Desmond smiled.
+
+"I can assure you that I need no such tokens," he said. "The
+thanks that I have received, from you both, are infinitely more
+grateful to me than any amount of rings and jewels."
+
+"And now, my friend," Philip de la Vallee went on, "my own burning
+desire is to go to de Tulle, as soon as I have accompanied the
+baron and Anne to their home; first, to publicly chastise this
+villain noble; and then, of course, to fight him. Naturally, I
+have said nothing of this to the baron, but I feel, after what has
+happened, that in you I shall find an adviser, and a sympathizer."
+
+"I sympathize with you, most heartily, Philip, and in your place
+should feel the same impulse; and yet, it would not be wise to
+give way to it. I say this on the ground that he is a notoriously
+good swordsman, and that, instead of your taking vengeance upon
+him, he might kill you.
+
+"I feel that that argument would not have any influence with you
+personally, but, taking your position with regard to Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter, it should have great weight. You can judge, from
+what you would have felt yourself, had you been aware of her
+disappearance, what she would feel, did she hear of your death in
+this quarrel. Were you her brother, I should say that you would be
+right--nay, that it would be your duty to endeavour to punish the
+outrage against the honour of your family. Were you openly
+betrothed to her, you would again have the right to punish her
+abductor; but, not being either her brother or her betrothed,
+neither reason nor public opinion would justify your doing so.
+Moreover, did you fight with him and kill him, you would incur the
+gravest resentment of the king; for, in fact, you would be
+impugning his justice, which has considered banishment from court
+to be a sufficient punishment for his offence. Not only was he a
+favourite of the king's, but he belongs, I understand, to a
+powerful family; who would, you may be sure, use their influence
+with the king to bring about your punishment, for the breach of
+the decree against duelling, and you would be fortunate if you
+escaped a long imprisonment."
+
+The other was silent.
+
+"I feel that you are right," he said, at last, "but, indeed, it is
+hard that I should not be able to avenge this outrage upon the
+lady who is to be my wife. I may tell you that, as soon as we
+return home, our formal betrothal is to take place, and ere long
+our marriage will be celebrated; but I shall feel lowered, in my
+own esteem, if I sit down quietly under this injury."
+
+"I do not see that," Desmond said. "If you abstain from
+challenging de Tulle, it is from no fear of the consequences, but
+it is, as I have shown you, because, whatever the issue of the
+contest, it would be bad both for you and her. If you were killed,
+her life would be spoilt. If you killed him, you might languish
+for years in one of the royal prisons. The king prides himself on
+his justice, and, by all accounts, rightly so; and I am sure that
+he would feel the deepest resentment, were you or anyone to show,
+by your actions, that you considered he has favoured the
+transgressor."
+
+"You are right, Desmond; and, at any rate for the present, I will
+put my intention aside; but should he ever cross my path,
+assuredly I will have a reckoning with him.
+
+"But how is it that you, who are at least eight years younger than
+I am, should argue as an old counsellor rather than a young
+ensign?"
+
+"I suppose, in the first place, it is from my bringing up. I lived
+with and was educated by a good priest, one not wanting in
+manliness and energy, but who often deplored the system of
+duelling, which is as strong with us as it is here, and denounced
+it as a relic of barbarism, and, at any rate, never to be put in
+use on account of a heated quarrel over wine, but only if some
+deadly injury had been inflicted, and even then better left alone.
+Of course, as an officer in one of His Majesty's regiments, I
+should be obliged to conform to the general usage; for, did I
+decline, I should be regarded as having brought dishonour on the
+corps. But my case differs altogether from yours.
+
+"In the next place, knowing you were coming to Versailles, I
+thought over what course you would be likely to pursue, and
+considered it was probable you would lose no time in challenging
+de Tulle. I have thought the matter over, in every light, and made
+up my mind to endeavour to dissuade you from doing so, if the
+opportunity offered.
+
+"So you see," he added with a smile, "I had prepared my array of
+arguments against it; and I cannot but think that the opinion of
+one interested, but not vitally so, on a point, is rather to be
+taken than that of a person smarting under an injury."
+
+"And now, to turn to other matters. In three days we start for the
+south. The baron accompanied me here, and went to see your
+colonel, while I came to your quarters. His object was to ask him
+to grant you a month's leave of absence, with the provision, of
+course, that you should return at once, if the regiment was
+ordered on service."
+
+"It is kind, indeed, of him," Desmond said, "but I doubt whether
+the colonel will assent. It is not a month since I was dismissed
+from drill, and took my place with my company, and I doubt whether
+he will consider that I am sufficiently versed in my duties, or
+that, after being so short a time in the regiment, I have any
+right to leave."
+
+"What you say is right enough, under ordinary circumstances, but
+these are altogether extraordinary. Then, after what you have
+done, he will feel it but natural that we should wish to have you
+with us for a time. Moreover, I do not consider that our journey
+will be altogether unattended by danger. From what I have heard of
+de Tulle, he is a man who never forgives, and will pursue his
+object with the pertinacity of a bloodhound. He has failed in his
+first attempt, but there is no reason why he should not renew it,
+confident, perhaps, that if successful the king, though he may
+feel it necessary to feign much anger for a time, will finally
+forgive him and take him into favour again, especially as his
+family would bring all their influence to bear to bring this
+about. Doubtless, he will be kept perfectly informed of what is
+going on here. There are several forests to be traversed on the
+way, and these are, for the most part, the haunts of robber bands;
+and, should the carriage be found overturned, and the baron and
+his daughter missing, it would be put down as their work. Having
+the baron as well as his daughter in his power, de Tulle would
+find it easier than before to compel Anne to purchase her father's
+freedom, as well as her own, by consenting to his terms.
+
+"Therefore, you see, the aid of a sword like yours would be
+valuable, and no doubt your servant, who is also a sturdy fighter,
+will accompany us."
+
+"I can hardly think that de Tulle would venture upon so bold a
+stroke as that, and yet he might do so. Men of that kind are not
+accustomed to be thwarted, and it would be a satisfaction to his
+resentment at his former failure, as well as the attainment of the
+wide estates of which Anne is heiress."
+
+At this moment there was a knock at the door, and the baron
+entered.
+
+"My dear Monsieur Kennedy," he said, "I have succeeded. Colonel
+O'Brien has been pleased to say that you have been so assiduous,
+in learning your duties, that he considers you as capable of
+performing them as any of his subalterns; and that you have just
+brought so much credit on the regiment, that he is pleased to be
+able to grant the favour I asked. Here is your furlough, duly
+signed. Now it only rests with yourself, to accept or refuse my
+invitation."
+
+"I accept it most gladly, Baron. It will give me the greatest
+pleasure to accompany you, and mademoiselle, and Monsieur de la
+Vallee, whom I now regard as a dear friend, to your home."
+
+"That is settled, then," the baron said. "We start early on
+Thursday morning. It would be well, therefore, if you were to ride
+over on Wednesday evening, and occupy one of the many spare
+chambers there are in the house."
+
+"I will do so willingly; and I shall ask the colonel to allow my
+servant to accompany me."
+
+"That is already settled. I told Colonel O'Brien that I owed much
+to him also, and he at once acceded to my request, saying that,
+although the wound is healing, the surgeon said that it would be a
+fortnight, yet, before he will be fit for service; and, moreover,
+that it was a custom when an officer went on leave that he should,
+if he wished it, take his soldier servant with him."
+
+"Thank you again, Baron. Mike is a faithful fellow, and a shrewd
+one. I am so accustomed now to his services that I should miss
+them, and his talk, very much."
+
+"Have you heard, Mike," Desmond asked, when his servant came up to
+his room, after the baron and Philip de la Vallee had left, "that
+you are to go with me, to stay for a month, at Pointdexter?"
+
+"I have, your honour. Sure, I was sent for to the colonel's
+quarters, and there I found a tall gentleman, whom I had never
+seen before, as far as I knew.
+
+"'This is Mike Callaghan, Mr. Kennedy's servant,' the colonel
+said, and the baron stepped forward, and shook hands with me, for
+all the world as if I had been a noble like himself; and he said:
+
+"'My brave fellow, I have to thank you for the aid you gave your
+master in rescuing my daughter, in which service you received the
+wound which still keeps your arm in a sling. Here is a token that
+we are not ungrateful for the service. If you will take my advice,
+you will hand it to an agent of mine here in Paris, who will keep
+it for you, and you may find it useful when the time comes for you
+to take your discharge.'
+
+"So saying, he put a heavy purse into my hand, and said:
+
+"'You will find my agent's name and address on a card inside the
+purse. I shall go round to him, now, and tell him that you are
+coming, and that he is to use the money to your advantage, and to
+hand it over to you whenever you choose to ask for it. Your master
+is coming down to stay for a month with me, and Colonel O'Brien
+has granted leave for you to accompany him.'
+
+"I thanked him heartily, as you may believe, sir; though, as I
+said, I wanted no reward for obeying your orders, and for the
+share I took in that little skirmish. After I came out, I looked
+into the purse, which was mighty heavy, expecting to find a
+handful of crowns; and it fairly staggered me when I found that it
+was full of gold pieces, and on counting them, found that there
+were a hundred louis. Never did I dream that I should be so rich.
+Why, your honour, when I lave the regiment, which will not be for
+many a long year, I hope, I shall be able to settle down
+comfortably, for the rest of my life, in a snug little shebeen, or
+on a bit of land with a cottage and some pigs, and maybe a cow or
+two; and it is all to your honour I owe it, for if you hadn't
+given the word, it would never have entered my head to attack a
+gentleman's house, merely because I heard a woman scream."
+
+"Well, I am heartily glad, Mike; and I hope that you will take it
+straight to the agent's, and not break in upon it, by treating
+half the regiment to drink."
+
+"I will, your honour. It was given me to stow away for the time
+when I might want it, and though I don't say that my own
+inclinations would not lead me to trate a few of the boys, I feel
+that I ought to do what the gentleman told me."
+
+"Certainly you should, Mike. If you once began to spend it in that
+way, it is not one louis, but five or more, that would disappear
+in a few hours. I am heartily glad that the baron has so
+handsomely rewarded you for the service, and if you like, I will
+go round with you this afternoon to his agent, and see the money
+safely deposited."
+
+"Thank you, your honour. I sha'n't feel easy, as long as I have
+got it in my pouch. I should suspict everyone who came near me,
+and should never dare take my hand off it, lest someone else might
+put his in."
+
+"You are a lucky fellow, Kennedy," O'Neil said, when Desmond told
+his two comrades of the arrangements that had been made. "And, if
+you go on like this, the regiment will believe that any good
+fortune that may fall to its lot is the result of your luck."
+
+"I really do not like having leave given to me, when I have been
+such a short time in the regiment. It does not seem fair upon
+others."
+
+"No one will grudge you that," O'Sullivan said. "It is not as if
+we were at home. Then, of course, everyone would like his turn.
+But here, although we are soldiers of France, we are as strangers
+in the land. Here in Paris we have many acquaintances, and a
+welcome at most of the receptions; but that is the end of it. It
+is seldom, indeed, that we are invited into the country houses of
+those we know. That sort of hospitality is not the fashion in
+France. Here, nobles may throw open their houses to all gentlemen
+by birth who happen to be presented to them, but at home they are
+rigidly exclusive; and, moreover, I am inclined to think they
+regard us Irishmen as detrimental and dangerous. Many Irishmen
+make exceedingly good matches, and we are regarded as having a way
+with us, with the girls, that is likely to interfere with the
+arrangements their parents have made for their marriages. Now, it
+seems to me that your baron must be a very confiding old
+gentleman, or he would never take you to stay in the society of
+the young lady who owes so much to you. Faith, it seems to me that
+you have the ball at your feet, and that you have only to go in
+and win. From what I hear, Mademoiselle Pointdexter is no older
+than you are yourself, and it is a glorious chance for you."
+
+Desmond broke into a laugh.
+
+"My dear O'Sullivan," he said, "it seems to me that it is the
+favourite dream of Irish soldiers of fortune, that they may
+improve their circumstances by marriage."
+
+"Well, there is no easier or more pleasant way," his friend said,
+stoutly.
+
+"Possibly I may come to think so, in another ten years," Desmond
+went on, "but, at present, I have no more thought of marrying than
+I have of becoming king of France. The idea is altogether absurd,
+and it happens to be particularly so, in the present case, since
+one of the objects of my going down to Pointdexter is that I may
+be present at the formal betrothal of this young lady, to Monsieur
+de la Vallee, a neighbour of theirs, whom I had the pleasure of
+meeting this afternoon, and to whom she is tenderly attached."
+
+"By the powers, but that is unlucky, Kennedy!" O'Neil said; "and I
+have been thinking that your fortune was made, and that the
+regiment would soon lose you, as you would, of course, settle down
+as a magnate in Languedoc; and now, it seems that what we thought
+the proper sequence of your adventure, is not to come off, after
+all. Well, lad, I congratulate you on putting a good face on it,
+and hiding your disappointment."
+
+"What nonsense you talk!" Desmond said, laughing. "It is you who
+have been building castles, not I, and it is your disappointment
+that they have fallen to pieces."
+
+
+
+Chapter 6: An Ambuscade.
+
+
+On the morning arranged, the cavalcade started from Versailles.
+The baron had instructed the stable keeper, where the carriage and
+horses had been placed, to notify the Vicomte de Tulle that he
+held them at his disposal. The woman, who had been brought to
+Versailles, had been dismissed, after having made before a
+magistrate a deposition, stating how Mademoiselle de Pointdexter
+had been held a close prisoner, and that, with the exception of
+herself, no one whatever had entered her apartment, except that
+the Vicomte de Tulle had paid her a visit, of some five minutes'
+duration, on the morning after she was brought there. A copy of
+this was left in the magistrate's hands for safekeeping, while the
+original was kept by the baron, who regarded it as a most
+important document, concerning, as it did, the honour of his
+daughter.
+
+Anne had travelled to Paris in the family coach, and she again,
+with her maid, took her place in it. The baron, Monsieur de la
+Vallee, and Desmond rode on horseback behind it, two armed
+retainers rode in front, and two others, with Mike, took their
+places behind. The old servitor sat on the front seat, by the side
+of the coachman.
+
+"I do not think, Desmond," Philip de la Vallee said, as the baron
+fell back to talk for a while with his daughter, "that he has the
+slightest thought of our being attacked by any of the agents of
+the vicomte; but I have made a good many enquiries about the
+fellow, in the past few days, and from what I have heard I am
+still more convinced that, before long, he is likely to renew his
+attempt to get possession of Anne. I hear that his circumstances
+are well-nigh desperate. He has mortgaged the income of his
+estates, which, of course, he is unable to sell, as they go with
+the title to the heir. He is pressed by many creditors, who, now
+that he has lost the favour of the king, will give him no further
+grace. Indeed, I understand that the king, who is always liberal,
+and who not infrequently makes considerable gifts to the gentlemen
+of the court, to enable them to support the necessary expenses,
+has already assisted him several times, and that it was only by
+such aid that he has been able to hold on as long as he has done.
+
+"He is, in fact, a desperate man, and his only hope is in making a
+wealthy alliance. Therefore, putting aside his pique and anger at
+having failed, the temptation to again obtain possession of Anne
+is great, indeed. Once married to her he could, even if the king
+kept him in banishment, well maintain his position as a country
+magnate."
+
+"But Mademoiselle de Pointdexter cannot come into the estates
+until her father's death."
+
+"Not his estates, but those of her mother, who was also a wealthy
+heiress, and of which she will enter into possession either on
+coming of age or on marrying. So, you see, he can afford to
+disregard the enmity of her father, as well as the displeasure of
+the king, which probably would soon abate after the marriage took
+place. If I had known, when I left home, what had happened, and
+that if she was found we should be returning home, I would have
+brought with me a dozen stout fellows from my own estate. As it
+is, I sent off a messenger, yesterday, with an order to my
+majordomo to pick out that number of active fellows, from among
+the tenantry, and to start with the least possible delay by the
+route that we shall follow, of which I have given him particulars.
+He is to ride forward until he meets us, so that when he joins us,
+we shall be too strong a party for any force that the vicomte is
+likely to gather to intercept us."
+
+"A very wise precaution, Philip; but we shall be far upon our way,
+before this reinforcement can come up."
+
+"We shall be some distance, I admit. My messenger will take fully
+five days in going. He will take another day to gather and arm the
+tenants, so that they will not start until two days afterwards.
+Then, however, they will travel at least twice as fast as we
+shall, hampered as we are by the carriage. I should have suggested
+that Anne should ride on a pillion, behind me or her father, but I
+did not do so, because it would have been necessary to explain to
+him my reasons for suggesting the change; and, moreover, I felt
+sure that he would not agree to it, had I done so. Baron
+Pointdexter is one of the largest landowners in Languedoc, and
+although one of the kindest and best of men, he has his full share
+of family pride, and would consider that it was derogatory to his
+position for his daughter to be riding about on a pillion, like
+the wife or daughter of some small landed proprietor or tenant
+farmer, instead of in a carriage, as becomes her station.
+Therefore, I must accept the situation, carriage and all, and I
+can only hope that this villain will not attempt to interfere with
+us before my men join us.
+
+"Fortunately, even if a courier take the vicomte word that the
+baron and his daughter have made their adieus to His Majesty, the
+fellow cannot hear of it for two days, however fast the messenger
+may travel. Of course, Tulle is nigh a hundred miles nearer Paris
+than Pointdexter, which lies between Florac and Sainte Afrique,
+both of which towns lie within the circle of the estate. I admit
+that, foreseeing the baron is likely to return to his estates
+without delay, the vicomte may have made his preparations, and be
+ready to start as soon as he gets the news. Nevertheless, he will
+have a ride of some eighty miles to strike the road on which we
+shall be travelling. He may then move north, until he finds some
+suitable place for a surprise; but, even allowing for his
+exercising the greatest speed, we should be halfway from Paris
+before we can possibly meet him, and my men should join us by that
+time."
+
+"You have forgotten one contingency, which would entirely alter
+the state of things."
+
+"What is that?" Monsieur de la Vallee asked sharply.
+
+"We give this villain noble credit for resource and enterprise.
+What more likely than that he has left a couple of his retainers
+at Versailles, with orders that, should any messenger be sent off
+by a southern road from the baron, his journey is to be cut short,
+and any paper or letter found upon him carried with all speed to
+Tulle? In that case, the chances of our being met by a reinforcement
+are very small."
+
+"Peste! You are right, Desmond. I never gave the matter a thought.
+Now that you mention it, nothing is more probable. It was the
+servant who accompanied me whom I sent off, but, as de Tulle would
+have been notified of my arrival, and the man started from the
+baron's house, it would be deemed certain that he was either going
+to Pointdexter or my own estate, and that the message he carried
+was a somewhat urgent one. Well, all we can do is to hope that the
+fellow has not thought of our taking such a precaution, and that
+my messenger will arrive unmolested. Still, I acknowledge that the
+idea makes me anxious, and I fear that we shall not get through
+without serious trouble. There are so many disbanded soldiers, and
+other knaves, in the forests that de Tulle would have no
+difficulty in hiring any number of them, and carrying his scheme
+out without the assistance or knowledge of his own tenants. The
+heavy taxation necessary to keep up the expenses of the court has
+driven numbers of people to despair, and many hitherto law-abiding
+folk are being forced to leave their holdings, and to take to
+unlawful courses.
+
+"However, it is of no use our telling the baron our fears. He is
+obstinate, when he has once made up his mind to a thing, and
+nothing short of a royal command would induce him either to change
+his route, or to stop at one of the towns that we shall pass
+through, and wait until my band arrives. He would, indeed,
+consider his honour greatly attainted by allowing himself to make
+a change of plans, on the mere chance that our suspicions were
+justified."
+
+Six days passed without anything occurring. Impatient as Philip de
+la Vallee and Desmond were to get forward, they could not hurry
+the slow pace at which they travelled. Mademoiselle Pointdexter
+was now suffering from the reaction after her month of captivity
+and anxiety. The baron therefore travelled with provoking
+slowness. Obtaining, as he did, relays of horses at each post,
+they could without difficulty have travelled at almost double the
+rate at which they actually proceeded, but stoppages were made at
+all towns at which comfortable accommodation could be obtained.
+Indeed, in some places the roads were so bad that the carriage
+could not proceed at a pace beyond a walk, without inflicting a
+terrible jolting upon those within it.
+
+"There is one comfort," Philip said, when he had been bewailing
+the slowness of their pace, "my men should reach us at Nevers, at
+the latest, and you may take it as tolerably certain that any
+attempt to interfere with us will take place considerably south of
+that town. I should guess that it would be somewhere between
+Moulins and Thiers. If our escort does not come before we reach
+Moulins, I shall begin to think that your suggestion was correct,
+and that my messenger has indeed been intercepted and slain."
+
+Desmond could not gainsay the truth of his friend's calculation,
+but he said:
+
+"Possibly, Philip, instead of being attacked by the way, de
+Tulle's agents might rob him of his letter at one of the inns at
+which he put up. Did he know its contents?"
+
+"Yes. I told him that it contained an order for the majordomo to
+ride, with a troop of twelve men, to meet us, and that he was to
+give what aid he could in getting them together as quickly as
+possible; so that, even if robbed of the letter, he might still be
+able to fulfil his mission. Not, I own, that I thought of that at
+the time, for the idea that he might be stopped never once entered
+my mind."
+
+At Nevers, Desmond went round to all the inns in the town, to
+enquire if any body of men had put up at that place, but without
+success. When he related his failure to obtain any news to Philip,
+the latter said:
+
+"Well, we must hope that we shall meet them before we arrive at
+Moulins. If not, I shall no longer have any hope that my messenger
+got through safely, and then we shall have to consider whether it
+will not be necessary to inform the baron of our fears, and to get
+him to change his route and make a detour, cross the Loire at
+Bourbon, make for Maison, and then journey down on the other bank
+of the Saone as far as Pont Saint Esprit, and thence over the
+mountains to Florac."
+
+"That would certainly be the safest plan, always providing that we
+have not been watched ever since we left Paris. The vicomte might
+well take this precaution, in case we should deviate from the
+regular route."
+
+"Sapriste! Desmond, you are always full of evil prognostications.
+Still, as usual, I cannot but allow that there is reason in them."
+
+"You see, Philip, we have plenty of time, as we travel at a
+snail's pace, and in the evening when we stop, to think over the
+affair in every light. I always put myself in the position of the
+Vicomte de Tulle, and consider what steps I should take to ensure
+success in my next attempt to carry off Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter."
+
+"Then I am very glad that you are not in the position of de Tulle,
+for, if you were, I should consider that all was lost, and that
+there was not a chink or crevice by which we could escape. It is
+monstrous that a nobleman cannot travel from Paris to his estate,
+without being obliged to take as many precautions as the general
+of an army would have to do, against the attack of an active and
+formidable enemy."
+
+"And will you tell the baron, Philip?"
+
+"I hardly know what to do in that respect, for after all, we have
+no solid foundation whatever for our uneasiness, beyond the fact
+that the men I sent for have not met us. All our apprehensions are
+due solely to the fact that this fellow is utterly unscrupulous,
+and that his whole future depends on his carrying out his insolent
+designs successfully. If we had any solid facts to work on, I
+would urge the baron to change his route, but I fear that he would
+not only scoff at our views that there may be danger, but might be
+angry at my taking the step of sending for a party of my
+retainers, without his being in any way consulted in the matter.
+At any rate, I feel sure that he would refuse to change his route,
+without some very much stronger reason than we can give him."
+
+"Then we must let matters go on as they are, Philip. It may be
+that really we have been alarming ourselves without sufficient
+cause. If the worst comes to the worst, we can make a good fight
+for it."
+
+"It is certainly hard on you. You have performed one brave action
+for us, at the risk of your life, and now you are thrust into
+another danger, perhaps even greater than the first, and this in a
+quarrel in which you have no concern whatever."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"Do you not see, Philip, that the adventure is good training for a
+soldier, and that, if I am on duty in command of a company, I
+shall be all the more useful an officer for having served a sort
+of apprenticeship in surprises, ambuscades, and alarms. The
+journey has been vastly more interesting than it would have been
+under other circumstances. We should have found it dull, without
+such matter of interest as this affair has given us, and, even
+should nothing whatever come of it, it will have served its
+purpose by beguiling our journey, which, in truth, riding at so
+slow a pace, would otherwise scarce have been amusing."
+
+"Well, then, it seems that the only thing that we can do is to see
+that the servants all keep their pistols charged, and are prepared
+to do their duty in case of sudden attack. Of course, at present
+they have no idea that any special danger threatens us; but I
+shall tell them, before I start in the morning, that we fear the
+road is dangerous owing to a band of robbers reported to be in the
+forest, and that they must hold themselves in readiness for
+action, in case we fall in with any of them. Old Eustace and the
+coachman have both got arquebuses. I shall tell them that, should
+they be attacked, they are to fire at once, and then the coachman
+is to whip up his horses and drive at full speed, while we
+endeavour to keep off the assailants."
+
+"That would be of use, if the assailants should be for the most
+part on foot, but I think it more likely that they will be
+mounted, and however fast this lumbering carriage might go, they
+could easily keep up with it. Fight as hard as we may, the
+carriage must be overtaken if they are in sufficient force to
+overpower us. I should think that it would be well that you should
+warn Mademoiselle de Pointdexter that we hear the road is not very
+safe, and that, if there is trouble, she is on no account to
+attempt to leave the carriage. As long as she remains there she
+will run but little risk, for you may be sure that de Tulle will
+have issued the strictest orders that no pistol is to be fired in
+its direction. I have also little doubt that he has ordered the
+baron's life to be respected, because his death would greatly add
+to the anger that would be excited by the attack, and would also
+put a barrier between him and mademoiselle, who would naturally
+regard him with even more hostility than before, as the author of
+her father's death. Therefore, I trust that in any case his life
+and hers will not be endangered, however numerous our assailants
+might be."
+
+"Yes, I have no doubt that that is so, Desmond, though I am sure
+that, were I wounded and on the point of death, I would rather
+know that Anne had fallen by a chance shot, than that she was in
+the power of this villain."
+
+The next morning, they started very early for Moulins, for the
+journey would be a longer one than usual, and the road through the
+forest would probably be so rough, that the pace must necessarily
+be very slow. At two o'clock, the men riding ahead noticed that a
+tree had fallen across the road, and one of them galloped back and
+informed the baron of it.
+
+"That is strange," the latter said. "There have been no storms for
+the past two days. It must have fallen quite recently, for
+otherwise the news would have been taken to the nearest commune,
+whose duty it would be to see at once to its removal."
+
+Philip de la Vallee had, as the servant was speaking, glanced at
+Desmond. To both, it seemed that this obstacle could scarcely be
+the result of an accident.
+
+"I will see how large the tree is," the baron said. "Whatever be
+its size, it is hard if eight men and four horses cannot drag it
+off the road."
+
+So saying, he cantered forward, followed by the retainer, whose
+comrade also fell in as they passed him.
+
+"Look to your arquebuses," Philip said to the two men on the box,
+and at the same time called up Mike and the two men, from behind.
+
+"A tree has fallen across the road," he said to them, "and it is
+possible that this may be an ambush, and that we may be attacked,
+so hold yourselves in readiness, look to your pistols, and see
+that the priming is all right in the pans."
+
+Then they went to the door of the carriage.
+
+"It is just possible that we are going to have trouble, Anne,"
+Philip said. "Remember what I told you last night, and on no
+account move from your seat, whatever may take place."
+
+As he spoke, there was a discharge of firearms in front, and at
+the same moment a score of horsemen broke from the trees, and rode
+down upon the carriage. Their leader was masked.
+
+As they came up, the coachman and Eustace discharged their
+arquebuses, emptying two saddles. Then, drawing their swords, both
+leapt to the ground. In the meantime Philip, Desmond, and the
+three men dashed at their assailants. Philip made for their
+leader, who, he doubted not, was the Vicomte de Tulle, but the
+latter drew a pistol and fired, when he was within a horse's
+length of him. The young man swayed in his saddle, and fell
+heavily to the ground, while a piercing cry from the carriage rose
+in the air.
+
+Desmond, after cutting down the first man he encountered, turned
+his horse and attacked the masked figure, who met him with a fury
+that showed he was animated by personal animosity. His skill in
+fencing, however, gave him but slight advantage in such an
+encounter, while Desmond's exercise with the sabre, in the
+regimental salle d'armes, was now most useful to him. Enraged at
+the fall of his friend, and seeing that there was but a moment to
+spare, for already some of the other assailants were coming to the
+assistance of their chief, he showered his blows with such
+vehemence and fury that his opponent had enough to do to guard his
+head, without striking a blow in return.
+
+Seeing in a moment that he would be surrounded, Desmond made a
+last effort. The vicomte's weapon shivered at the stroke, but it
+somewhat diverted the direction of the blow, and instead of
+striking him full on the head, the sword shore down his cheek,
+inflicting a ghastly wound, carrying away an ear as well as the
+cheek from the eye to the chin. Then, wheeling his horse, he
+dashed at two men who were riding at him.
+
+The attack was so sudden that one of their horses swerved, and
+Desmond, touching his charger's flank with a spur, rode at him and
+hurled horse and rider to the ground. A backhanded blow struck his
+other opponent full in the throat, and then he dashed into the
+wood, shouting to Mike to follow him.
+
+The two servitors had both fallen, and the greater part of the
+assailants were gathered round the carriage. Mike was engaged in a
+single combat with one of the horsemen, and had just run his
+opponent through when Desmond shouted to him; so, turning, he
+galloped after his master.
+
+They were not pursued. The fall of their leader had, for the
+moment, paralysed the band, and while three or four of them
+remained by the carriage--whose last defender had fallen--the
+others, dismounting, ran to where the vicomte was lying.
+
+"That has been a tough business, your honour," Mike said, as he
+joined his master. "It is right you were, sir, when you told me
+that you were afraid that rascal would try and hinder us on our
+way. Sure it has been a bad business, altogether. Monsieur Philip
+is killed, and the baron, too, I suppose, and all the others, and
+Miss Anne has fallen into the hands of that villain again."
+
+"I do not think that the baron has been hurt, Mike. I expect the
+orders were only to take him prisoner."
+
+"Where are we going, your honour?" Mike asked, for they were still
+galloping at full speed.
+
+"I am going to get into the road again, and try to find help, at
+Moulins, to recover the young lady. There is one thing, she is not
+likely to be molested by that fellow for some little time."
+
+"Then you did not kill him, your honour?"
+
+"No. I cut through his guard, but it turned my sword. But I laid
+his face open, and it will be some time before he will be fit to
+show himself to a lady. If, as I expect, I can get no help at
+Moulins, I shall ride on to Monsieur de la Vallee's place, gather
+some men there, and try to cut the party off before they get to
+Tulle. If I am too late, I shall see what I can do to rescue them.
+From la Vallee I shall go to Pointdexter. I have no doubt that we
+can get together a force, there, large enough to besiege de
+Tulle's castle."
+
+After an hour's ride, they arrived at Moulins, and Desmond rode at
+once to the mairie. Being in uniform, he was received with every
+respect by the mayor, who, however, on hearing his story, said
+that he did not see how he could interfere in the matter. It
+seemed to be a private quarrel between two nobles, and, even if he
+were ready to interpose, he had no force available; "but at the
+same time, he would send out four men, with a cart, to bring in
+any they might find with life in them."
+
+"Very well, sir," Desmond said, indignantly. "You know your duty,
+I suppose, and I know mine, and I shall certainly report to the
+king your refusal to give any assistance to punish these ill
+doers."
+
+So saying, he left the room, and at once rode to some stables.
+Leaving his horse and Mike's there, he hired others, and then
+continued his journey south at full speed, and before evening rode
+into Roanne. He knew that it was useless, endeavouring to stir up
+the authorities here, as they would naturally say that it was the
+business of the mayors at Nevers and Moulins, since the attack had
+taken place between those towns. Ordering fresh horses to be got
+ready, he said to Mike:
+
+"Do you go to all the inns on the left of the main street--I will
+go to all those on the right--and enquire if a troop of mounted
+men have come in. I am afraid there is no chance of it, but it is
+at least worth the trial."
+
+At the first four or five places he visited, the answer was that
+no such party had arrived; then, seeing one of the civic guards,
+he asked him if he had seen or heard of a troop of men passing
+through the town.
+
+"Such a troop arrived an hour ago, Monsieur l'officier. They
+stopped, as they passed me, and asked if Monsieur le Baron
+Pointdexter, accompanied by a carriage and some servants, had
+passed through the town. They put up at the Soleil, and I should
+think that they are there now, for they had evidently made a long
+journey, and their horses were too worn out to go farther."
+
+Delighted at the unexpected news, Desmond hurried to the inn. It
+was a second-class establishment, and evidently frequented by
+market people, as there were large stables attached to it. The
+landlord was standing at the door. He bowed profoundly, for it was
+seldom that guests of quality visited the inn.
+
+"What can I do for monsieur?" he enquired.
+
+"You have a party of travellers, who arrived an hour ago. I have
+business with them."
+
+"You will find them in this room, monsieur," the landlord said,
+opening a door.
+
+There were some twelve men inside. The remains of a repast were on
+the table. Some of the men were still sitting there, others were
+already asleep on benches. One, who was evidently their leader,
+was walking up and down the room impatiently. He looked up in
+surprise when Desmond entered.
+
+"You are the intendant of Monsieur de la Vallee, are you not?"
+
+"I am, sir," the man said, still more surprised.
+
+"I am a friend of your master. We have been expecting to meet you,
+for the past four or five days. He was travelling south with the
+Baron de Pointdexter and his daughter. We were attacked, this
+afternoon, on the other side of Moulins. The baron and his
+daughter were, I believe, carried off; the servants all killed. I
+saw your master fall, but whether mortally wounded or not I cannot
+say.
+
+"I and my servant cut our way through the assailants, who were led
+by the Vicomte de Tulle, who had before carried off Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter. I was on my way south to la Vallee, with but faint
+hope of meeting you on the road."
+
+"This is bad news indeed, sir," the intendant said. "I trust that
+my master is not killed, for we all loved him. As to Mademoiselle
+Pointdexter, it was an understood thing that she, one day, would
+be our mistress.
+
+"It is not our fault that we are so late. Our master's messenger
+was attacked, near Nevers, and was left for dead on the road. The
+letter he bore, and his purse, were taken from him. The night air
+caused his wounds to stop bleeding, and he managed to crawl to
+Moulins. Having no money, he was unable to hire a horse, and
+indeed could not have sat one. He went to an inn frequented by
+market people, and there succeeded in convincing an honest
+peasant, who had come in with a cart of faggots, that his story
+was a true one, and promised him large pay on his arrival at la
+Vallee.
+
+"The pace was, as you may imagine, a slow one, but two days ago he
+arrived home, and told me the story. I had the alarm bell at the
+castle rung at once, and in half an hour the tenants came in, and
+I chose these twelve, and started an hour later. Fortunately, the
+master had told the messenger what was the purport of his letter,
+and we have ridden night and day since. I am at your service,
+monsieur."
+
+"In the first place, let your men have a sleep. It is eight
+o'clock now. I will give them seven hours. At three in the
+morning, we will mount. There are not beds enough here, but if you
+get some clean straw scattered down in one of the sheds, the men
+can lie there. In the meantime, I will go round and hire fresh
+horses, leaving your own in pledge for their safe return.
+
+"You had better pick out two of your men to ride on to Moulins.
+The mayor there promised to send out a cart, to fetch in any
+wounded who might be found at the scene of the conflict. If, on
+their arrival, they find that Monsieur de la Vallee is not among
+these, they must ride on till they get there--it is some three
+leagues from the town--and bring in his body, together with those
+of his servants. They must arrange to give them Christian burial
+there, but your master's body they will, of course, take on to la
+Vallee.
+
+"His last wish, of course, would be that Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter should be rescued from the power of the villain noble
+who has carried her off. Starting in the morning so early, we
+shall have no difficulty in cutting him off long before he arrives
+at Tulle. He will probably cross the Alier at the ferry at Saint
+Pierre le Moutier. I must look at a map, and see the road that he
+is likely to follow, but it is probable that he will make by
+country tracks till he strikes the main road from Moulins."
+
+"Well, I should think, sir, that he would cross it near Aubusson,
+and then pass over the mountains by the road through Felletin, and
+come down upon Meimac, when he will be only two leagues from his
+castle near Correze. There is a good road from here to Aubusson,
+and we might take post on the road between that town and Felletin.
+At least, sir, we can avenge the murder of our dear master, though
+we have arrived too late to save him; and can rescue Mademoiselle
+de Pointdexter and her father."
+
+The men, who had roused themselves and listened to the
+conversation with many ejaculations of fury and regret, now
+exclaimed that they were ready to ride on at once.
+
+"There is no occasion for that, my friends," Desmond said. "The
+coach with mademoiselle can travel but slowly, especially along
+country roads."
+
+"Perhaps the vicomte may take her on the saddle behind him," the
+intendant suggested.
+
+"That he will not do," Desmond said. "In the fight I wounded him
+so sorely that he will, I think, have to be carried in a litter,
+and he will be in no condition for fast or long travelling, so
+that they certainly are not, at the present time, many leagues
+from the spot where they attacked us, and cannot reach Aubusson
+until the day after tomorrow. We might cut them off before they
+arrive there, but we do not know what road they may follow, and
+might miss them; whereas, from what you say, there can be no doubt
+that they would pass through Felletin."
+
+"I think that he would be sure to come that way, sir, for if he
+followed the road on to Limoges questions might be asked. At any
+rate, sir, we might post a man at Aubusson, and another at Pont
+Gibaut, as he might make from that town to Felletin through the
+village of Croc. How many men has he with him?"
+
+"That I cannot tell you. Some twenty mounted men, under his own
+leading, attacked the carriage. Two were shot by Eustace and the
+coachman. I disposed of two more, and my soldier servant of
+another. The two mounted men and the two servants probably killed
+two or three more, at least, before they themselves fell, so that
+the vicomte would only have some twelve mounted men with him. But
+there was another party in ambush, and I cannot say how strong
+they were; but probably, altogether, there would be twenty.
+
+"There are ten of your men, after sending two off to Moulins. Now
+there is yourself, my servant, and I, so we shall be thirteen.
+With the advantage of surprise, I think that we may calculate upon
+an easy victory, especially as I imagine that the men employed in
+the affair are not de Tulle's own retainers, but some robber band
+that he hired for the purpose; and these, having no special
+interest in the matter beyond earning the pay, are not likely to
+make any very determined resistance."
+
+Desmond now went back to the hotel where he had put up his horse.
+He found Mike awaiting him there, and the latter was delighted
+when he heard the news of the arrival of the party from la Vallee.
+Desmond's purse was but lightly furnished, and as he saw that the
+expenses might be heavy, he went to a jeweller's.
+
+"I want to borrow fifty louis," he said, "on this ring. It is, I
+imagine, worth a good deal more, since it was a present to me from
+the king."
+
+The jeweller examined the ring carefully.
+
+"It is a valuable one, indeed, sir," he said, "and I would
+willingly lend you double as much upon it."
+
+"Well, we will say seventy-five, then," Desmond said. "I think
+that will be ample for my purpose."
+
+Having received the money, he returned to the inn, accompanied by
+Mike; and went round to the various stables in the town, where he
+hired fifteen horses. These were to be taken to the Soleil, at
+three in the morning, and the men who brought them were to take
+back the tired horses as security.
+
+At that hour, the party started, and after a ride of some
+thirty-five miles reached Clermont, where they stabled the horses
+for six hours. Late that evening they arrived at Aubusson, having
+accomplished a journey of some seventy miles. One of the men had
+been left at Pont Gibaut, with orders to take a fresh horse and
+ride on to Aubusson, if the party they were in search of passed
+through the town.
+
+At Aubusson, Desmond took a fresh horse and rode back to Pont
+Gibaut, enquiring at all the villages along the road whether a
+party of twenty men had been seen to cross the road, at any point.
+Then he took four hours' sleep, and at daybreak started back
+again, making fresh enquiries till he arrived at Aubusson. He was
+convinced that the band had not, at that time, crossed the road on
+its way south.
+
+At ten o'clock he started out with his party, followed the road by
+the side of the Crorrere river--here a mere streamlet--and halted
+in a wood about five miles from Felletin.
+
+At six o'clock in the afternoon, a horseman was seen coming along,
+and was recognized as the man who had been left at Pont Gibaut.
+Desmond went out to meet him. He reported that, at twelve o'clock,
+a party of horsemen had come down on to the road a mile to the
+west of the town. He had followed at a distance, and they had
+turned off by the track leading to Croc. They had with them a
+carriage and a horse litter, and were travelling slowly.
+
+Desmond and his men at once shifted their position, and took up a
+post on the track between Croc and Felletin. An hour later, the
+party of horsemen were seen approaching the wood in which they
+were hidden. Desmond drew up the men, all of whom were armed with
+pistols, as well as swords, in line among the trees. He waited
+until the carriage was abreast of them, and then gave a shout, and
+the men at once dashed upon the escort.
+
+Taken completely by surprise, these made but a poor fight of it.
+Several were shot down at once. The vicomte, whose head was
+enveloped in bandages, leapt into the saddle of a horse whose
+rider had been shot, and, drawing his sword, rode at Desmond, who
+was making for the door of the carriage. Expecting no such attack,
+he would have been taken by surprise had not Mike, who saw his
+danger, shouted a warning, and at the same moment discharged his
+pistol. The ball struck de Tulle in the forehead, and he fell back
+dead.
+
+His fall at once put an end to the conflict. The robbers, who had
+lost some eight of their number, at once turned their horses'
+heads and rode off at full gallop.
+
+As Desmond drew bridle by the carriage, the door opened, and the
+baron leapt out.
+
+"By what miracle have you effected our rescue, my dear Monsieur
+Kennedy?" he exclaimed. "My daughter told me that she saw you and
+your servant break your way through these brigands, and ride off.
+She has been suffering an agony of grief for Philip, whom she saw
+shot. Have you any news of him?"
+
+"None, sir. I, too, saw him fall, but whether he was killed, or
+only wounded, I am unable to say. I have sent two men to bring him
+into Moulins, and I trust they will find that he is only wounded."
+
+"My daughter saw you cut down that villain with a terrible blow.
+We have not seen him since, but we know that he was carried on a
+horse litter behind the carriage."
+
+"At any rate, he will trouble you no more, Baron. My man shot him
+through the head, just as he was riding to attack me from behind."
+
+"Thank God! We are saved from further persecutions! And now, tell
+me how you came to be here."
+
+"It was simple enough, Baron. I found twelve men, with Monsieur de
+la Vallee's intendant, at Roanne. Philip, who feared that the
+vicomte would endeavour to make a further effort to repair his
+fortune, by carrying your daughter off on the road, sent a
+messenger to his intendant to ride at once, with twelve men, to
+meet us; and, had all gone well, they would have joined us fully
+two days' journey north of Nevers. The messenger was attacked on
+the way, robbed of his letter and purse, and left for dead. He
+managed to crawl to Nevers, and there, being too weak and ill to
+sit a horse, he hired a peasant's cart and made the journey,
+slowly and painfully, to la Vallee. As he knew the purport of the
+letter, two hours after his arrival there the intendant started,
+and rode, without drawing bridle, to Roanne. There, by great good
+fortune, I found them, though men and horses were alike done up.
+Knowing, however, that the vicomte, in his wounded state, and
+embarrassed with the coach, could proceed but slowly, I let them
+have seven hours' sleep, and in the meantime hired fresh horses
+for them; and we rode that day to Aubusson, and this morning moved
+down to within five miles of Felletin. I left a man on the road to
+Pont Gibaut, and he brought us word that you had left the main
+road, and were travelling through Croc, so we moved at once to
+intercept you; and you know the rest."
+
+
+
+Chapter 7: In Paris Again.
+
+
+"You have indeed done well, Monsieur Kennedy," the baron said,
+when Desmond finished his story.
+
+"Now, let us see to my daughter. Her maid is attending on her. She
+fainted when the fight began. She is not of a fainting sort, but
+the trials of the last few weeks, and her belief that de la Vallee
+was killed, have very much upset her."
+
+"No wonder," Desmond said. "It must have been terrible, indeed, to
+lose her lover, and to know that she was again in the power of
+that villain.
+
+"And you, Baron; how did you escape the fate that befell the rest
+of your convoy?"
+
+"We had ridden close up to the tree, when suddenly there was a
+discharge of firearms. The two men with me fell at once. I was
+unhurt, but as I turned my horse he fell dead, three bullets
+having pierced his chest. Before I could recover my feet, the
+rascals were upon me. They evidently intended to take me alive,
+for they were provided with ropes, and, binding my arms, hurried
+me back to the carriage.
+
+"By the time we got there, all was over. My faithful Eustace and
+the coachman lay dead by the side of the carriage. They had fought
+stoutly, for three of the brigands lay beside them. Six others
+were scattered near, and the brigands were gathered round a fallen
+man, who I guessed was their leader.
+
+"I found Anne in a state of the wildest grief. She told me that
+she had seen Philip shot by the vicomte, just as he was attacking
+him, and that you in turn had cut down the villain.
+
+"For half an hour, nothing was done, and then one, who was
+evidently in authority over the others, left the troop and came up
+to the carriage.
+
+"'Monsieur le Baron,' he said, 'the orders of my chief are that
+you are to be placed in the carriage, with your daughter and her
+maid. If you will give your word of honour that you will not
+attempt to escape, or to give the alarm as you go along, or to
+address a word to anyone whom we may encounter, your arms will be
+freed, and you will be treated with all respect. If, on the
+contrary, you decline to give this promise, my instructions are
+that your feet as well as your hands are to be tied, and that you
+are to be gagged and placed in the bottom of the carriage. You are
+also to answer for your daughter and her maid; that they, too,
+neither by word nor gesture, shall attempt to attract the
+attention of anyone in the villages that we may pass through."
+
+"It was a hard condition, but I had no choice. The idea that I
+should suffer the indignity of being bound and gagged, like a
+common malefactor, made my blood boil. I should, in that case, no
+more be able to give the alarm than if I had been free; therefore
+I gave the promise, for at least it would be a comfort, to Anne,
+that I should be with her and able to talk to her.
+
+"We stopped two nights on the road, being lodged at solitary
+houses on the way. A guard was placed at my chamber door, and
+another at my window, and even had I not given my word I could not
+have escaped.
+
+"And now, Monsieur Kennedy, what do you propose?"
+
+"I think, sir, that it would be best that you should start at
+once, in the carriage, for Pointdexter. Monsieur Philip's
+intendant and his men will ride as your escort, but I do not think
+that there is the slightest probability of your being interfered
+with; for now that the vicomte is dead, these men--who were not, I
+think, his retainers, but a band of robbers whom he had hired for
+the occasion--will have no further motive for attacking you.
+
+"I myself shall return to Aubusson, send back the horse on which I
+rode there, hire another, and make straight for Moulins, where I
+still hope that I may find Monsieur de la Vallee alive.
+
+"Did you see the vicomte, after you were attacked?"
+
+"No. I heard one of the men tell the fellows who were guarding us
+that your stroke had cut off one of his ears, and laid his cheek
+bare from the eye to the chin. I fancy that he was too badly hurt
+to come to us, but in any case he would not have cared to show
+himself, in so terrible a plight."
+
+"We must admit that, with all his faults, he was brave," Desmond
+said; "for, in spite of his pain and weakness, and of the fact
+that his head was enveloped in bandages, he sprang from his
+litter, leapt into one of the saddles we had emptied, and, single
+handed, made for me, until my man cut his career short with a
+bullet.
+
+"As you go through Croc, it might be well that you should send one
+of the villagers off to his castle, to tell them that their master
+is lying dead here, when doubtless they will send out a party to
+fetch in his body."
+
+By this time, Mademoiselle de Pointdexter had recovered from her
+faint. She held out her hand to Desmond, as he stood bareheaded
+beside the door.
+
+"You have rescued me again, Monsieur Kennedy," she said; "for,
+though life seems worthless to me now, you have saved me from far
+worse than death. That you have so saved me, for my father's sake
+as well as my own, I thank you with all my heart."
+
+"I would have you still hope, mademoiselle. We know that Monsieur
+de la Vallee fell, but many men fall from their horses when
+wounded, even when the wound is not vital. I am riding at once to
+Moulins, and trust to find him still alive. Therefore, I pray you
+do not give up all hope."
+
+"I dare not let myself hope," she said. "It would be but to suffer
+another blow. Still, I feel that I have so much to be thankful for
+that, grievous as my sorrow is, I shall try to bear it, with the
+help of the Holy Virgin."
+
+The party now separated. The baron mounted one of the horses left
+behind by the brigands, and with the men from la Vallee started
+for Pointdexter; while Desmond, with Mike Callaghan, rode back to
+Aubusson.
+
+There they slept for a few hours, and then obtained fresh horses
+and started for Moulins, where they arrived late in the evening.
+They alighted at the Soleil, where Desmond had ordered the two
+men, who had gone on from Roanne, to bring the body of Monsieur de
+la Vallee.
+
+"The gentleman is not here, sir," the landlord said, as he came to
+the door. "He was brought into the town by the men sent out by the
+mayor. As, by his dress, he was evidently a gentleman of quality,
+they took him straight to the Couronne."
+
+"Was he alive?"
+
+"Yes, sir; but, as I hear, the surgeons are unable to decide yet
+whether he will live. The men you sent here arrived the day after
+he was brought in. They told me that you would return, and put
+their horses here, but they are now in attendance on the wounded
+gentleman, who, it seems, is their lord."
+
+"Thank God, he is alive!" Desmond exclaimed. "I have news for him
+that will do more than the surgeons can to restore him to
+himself."
+
+Leaving Mike to see the horses stabled, he hurried away to the
+other hotel. He sent up his name, and one of the surgeons came
+down.
+
+"Monsieur de la Vallee is very ill," he said, "although his wound
+is not necessarily mortal. This morning we succeeded in extracting
+the ball, but he is in a terribly weak state. He is unable to
+speak above a whisper, and does not seem to care to make any
+effort. It would appear that he even does not wish to live."
+
+"I have news that will put fresh life into him."
+
+"Then by all means go in and see him, sir. We have thought that he
+is fast sinking; but if the news you bring can rouse him into
+making an effort to live, he may yet recover. I will go in and
+give him a strong restorative, and tell him that you are here."
+
+In three or four minutes, he came to the door of the chamber, and
+beckoned to Desmond to enter.
+
+"The sound of your name has roused him from the lethargy, into
+which he seemed sinking," he whispered. "When I told him that I
+could not allow you to enter, until he had taken the draught that
+I gave him, he swallowed it eagerly."
+
+Desmond went up to the bedside, and took the hand which lay on the
+coverlet. The pressure was slightly returned, and Philip's lips
+moved, but he spoke so faintly that Desmond had to lean over him,
+to hear the words.
+
+"I am glad, indeed, that you are safe and sound. I have been
+reproaching myself, bitterly, that I should have brought you into
+this fatal business. As to the rest of it, I dare not even think
+of it; but I shall die all the easier for knowing that you have
+escaped."
+
+"I escaped for a good purpose, Philip. I have good news for you.
+Monsieur le Baron and mademoiselle are on their way to Pointdexter,
+under the guard of your men."
+
+"Is it possible, Desmond, or are you only saying it to rouse me?"
+
+"Not at all, Philip. You do not suppose that, even for that
+purpose, I would hold out false hopes to you; or tell an untruth
+on a matter so vital to your happiness."
+
+Philip's eyes closed, but his lips moved, and Desmond knew that he
+was returning thanks to God for this unlooked-for news.
+
+"How did it happen?" Philip said, after a silence of some minutes.
+
+His voice was much stronger than before, and there was a faint
+touch of colour in his cheeks. The surgeon nodded approvingly to
+Desmond, and murmured, "I think that he will live."
+
+"It is too long a story to tell you in full, now," Desmond said.
+"Seeing that all was lost, that you were down, and that further
+resistance was absolutely fruitless, Mike and I cut our way out;
+the more easily since I had struck down their leader, de Tulle,
+and most of his band had crowded round him. At Roanne I found your
+men, who had just arrived there. It matters not now why they had
+been detained. I got fresh horses for them and rode for Correze,
+placed an ambush, and turned the tables upon them. Mike shot the
+vicomte, and we easily defeated his followers, and rescued the
+baron and his daughter. I sent them to Pointdexter under charge of
+your intendant and followers, and rode hither, hoping against hope
+that I might find you still alive. Your two men, who came on here,
+could have told you that I had escaped."
+
+"I did not allow them to speak to monsieur," the surgeon said, "or
+even to see him. They are below, greatly grieved at being refused
+entry; but I told them that any agitation might be fatal to their
+master, and that they could do nothing for him if they came up;
+for indeed, up to the time when we extracted the ball, he was
+unconscious.
+
+"And now, monsieur, I think that it were best you should retire. I
+shall give Monsieur de la Vallee a soothing draught. A night's
+rest will be of vital importance to him. And now that you have
+relieved his mind of the load that has evidently weighed upon him,
+I think there is little doubt that he will soon fall asleep."
+
+"I will go and have supper," Desmond said, "for I have ridden
+fifty miles since I last ate, and then it was but a piece of bread
+with a draught of wine. After that I will, with your permission,
+return here, and if you tell me that he sleeps, will take my place
+by his bedside till morning."
+
+"To that I have no objection," the surgeon said. "I and a
+colleague have, one or other, been with him since he was brought
+in; and I shall be glad of a rest, myself."
+
+Desmond returned to the Soleil, where he had left Mike. The
+latter, who had just finished his supper, was delighted to hear
+that de la Vallee was likely to recover. After satisfying his own
+hunger, Desmond returned to the Couronne. He went upstairs, and,
+taking off his riding boots, stole to the door of his friend's
+chamber. It stood a little ajar, and, pushing it open noiselessly,
+he entered.
+
+The surgeon, who was sitting at the bedside, rose at once.
+
+"He is asleep already," he whispered, "and is breathing quietly. I
+think it likely that he will not stir until tomorrow morning. I
+shall be here at six. If he wakes, and there is any change, send
+for me at once."
+
+After he had left the room, Desmond took his place on the fauteuil
+by the bedside. For a time, he thought over the singular chain of
+adventures that he had gone through. Gradually, in spite of his
+efforts, his eyelids drooped. De la Vallee had not moved, and,
+being dead tired by the exertions of the past four days, he fell
+into a deep sleep, from which he did not awake until daylight
+streamed into the room.
+
+Shocked at having thus given way, he looked anxiously at de la
+Vallee, and was relieved to find that he was lying exactly in the
+same position, and had evidently slept without once waking. Half
+an hour later, Philip opened his eyes, looked wonderingly at him,
+and then said:
+
+"So, it was not all a good dream, Desmond! You are really here,
+and your news is true?"
+
+"Certainly, it is true, Philip. By this time Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter and her father are far on the way home. They were to
+have travelled on to Argentan, and then through Aurillac, striking
+the Lozere at Entraigues and proceeding along its banks to Mende,
+and thence by a road over the hills to Villefort, where they would
+be twenty miles from Pointdexter. The carriage was to be left
+behind at their first halting place. Mademoiselle was then to
+ride, and her maid to be carried behind one of your men, by which
+means they would travel more than twice as fast as they would do,
+if encumbered by the carriage. The baron said that he would spare
+no pains to get home as quickly as possible, and would send a man
+on, some hours ahead of him, to see that fresh horses were in
+readiness for the whole party at each town they came to."
+
+"Now tell me all about it, Desmond. I feel another man. Your good
+news, and a long night's sleep, have done wonders for me. Now,
+please tell me all about the affair."
+
+Seeing that Philip was so much stronger that he could hear,
+without being overexcited, the story of the rescue, Desmond
+related all the details to him.
+
+"You have indeed done wonders," Philip said. "You do not seem to
+know what fatigue is. How strange that you, whose name I had never
+heard until ten days back, should have rendered to Baron
+Pointdexter and myself two such inestimable services.
+
+"And so, after all your exertions and fatigue, you have been
+keeping watch at my bedside all night?"
+
+"I am ashamed to say that I have not been keeping watch, Philip,"
+Desmond replied with a smile. "I had intended to, but you were
+sleeping so quietly, and everything was so still, that I went off
+and slept, as soundly as you have done, until within half an hour
+of the time when you opened your eyes; but I am sure that I should
+have awoke at once, had you moved."
+
+"Then I am glad that I did not move, Desmond, for you must sorely
+need a long sleep, after having passed three days and almost three
+nights in the saddle."
+
+The surgeons now arrived, and were delighted at the change that
+had taken place in their patient.
+
+"And when shall I be fit to travel, doctor?"
+
+"Ah, well, we will talk of that in another fortnight's time. You
+need absolute quiet, for were you to move, before your wound is
+fairly healed, inflammation might set in, and that would throw you
+back for a very long time. You have had a very narrow escape, and
+you are fortunate, indeed, to have got off with only a trifling
+detention."
+
+"But I might be carried in a horse litter?"
+
+"Certainly not, at present," the surgeon said decidedly.
+"Possibly, in ten days, you might without danger be so carried,
+providing they take you in short stages and with easy-paced
+horses; but I should say that it would be still better, were you
+to be carried on men's shoulders. There is never any difficulty in
+hiring men, and you could get relays every eight or ten miles,
+while it would be difficult to get horses accustomed to such
+work."
+
+"You don't think that I should be able to ride, doctor?"
+
+"Certainly not in less than a month, probably not in six weeks."
+
+"Then I must be carried," Philip said. "I should work myself into
+the fever you talk of, if I were to be kept here.
+
+"What are your plans, Desmond?"
+
+"I have not thought of them, yet. At any rate, I shall stay with
+you till you are well enough to start."
+
+"I could not think of that, Desmond."
+
+"You have no say in the matter, Philip. In the first place, you
+will get on all the faster for my being with you. In the next
+place, ten days of my leave are already expired, and were we to go
+on straight to Pointdexter, I should only have a few days there
+before starting back for Paris, and I must therefore postpone my
+visit to some future time. I can stay here ten days, accompany you
+some four days on your journey, and then turn back again."
+
+"A nice way of spending a month's holiday!" Philip grumbled.
+
+"It will be a holiday that I shall long look back to," Desmond
+said quietly, "and with pleasure. I do not say that I should not
+have enjoyed myself at the baron's chateau, for that I should have
+done; but the adventures that I have gone through will remain in
+my mind, all my life, as having gained the friendship of yourself,
+the baron, and his daughter."
+
+"Friendship seems to me too mild a word for it, Desmond. You have
+earned a gratitude so deep that it will be a pain to us, if we
+cannot show it in deeds."
+
+"And now, Philip," Desmond said, changing the subject abruptly, "I
+suppose that you will be, at once, sending off one of your men
+with the news that you are in a fair way towards recovery.
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter is suffering at the thought that you
+were probably killed. I did my best to give her hope, but without
+much success. Your two retainers have been fretting greatly that
+they were not allowed to see you, but I think that now they can be
+brought up, and you can choose one of them to act as your
+messenger. He will, of course, ride post, and can arrive at
+Pointdexter very soon after the baron, if indeed he does not get
+there first. If he starts at once, and changes horses at each
+place, he may be there by tomorrow at noon, if not earlier; for it
+is not more, I believe, than a hundred and twenty miles to
+Pointdexter. If you will dictate a letter for him to take, I will
+write it for you."
+
+"It must be a short one," the surgeon said, "just a few words.
+Monsieur de la Vallee has talked more than is good for him."
+
+Half an hour later the messenger started, carrying a note with a
+few words from Philip to Anne, and a longer letter from Desmond to
+the baron. Four days later answers were received. The messenger
+had arrived at Pointdexter two hours before the travellers reached
+home, and Anne's joy at the news that, not only was Philip alive,
+but might in a short time be with her, was deep indeed. The baron
+wrote to Desmond, as well as to Philip, again expressing the deep
+gratitude of himself and his daughter, greatly regretting that he
+should not have the opportunity, at present, of thanking him
+personally. With the letter the messenger brought a bag of money,
+concerning which he wrote:
+
+"You have, I know, dear Monsieur Kennedy, expended a considerable
+sum of money in hiring relays of horses, for yourself and Monsieur
+de la Vallee's men; and this, of course, is a debt you cannot
+object to my repaying. Without knowing the exact sum, I have
+roughly calculated the probable amount, and forward it to you by
+the messenger who will bring you this letter."
+
+Desmond had no hesitation in accepting the money. The baron had
+evidently taken considerable pains to calculate the sums that he
+must have laid out, in order not to hurt his feelings by sending a
+larger sum than he had spent, for the amount contained in the bag
+was but a few louis over his disbursements. He at once rode over
+to Roanne and redeemed his ring, which had proved of more value to
+him than he had ever anticipated.
+
+At the end of the ten days, Philip was strong enough to walk
+across the room, and the surgeon gave permission for him to start,
+if, instead of being carried all the way, he would be taken to
+Lyons, which was but twenty miles distant, and there take boat
+down the Rhone to Viviers. Desmond went with him to Lyons, and saw
+him comfortably bestowed on board a craft going down the river,
+and there left him in charge of his own retainers. Then,
+accompanied by Mike, whose wound was now well healed, he rode back
+to Paris by comparatively easy stages, arriving there on the day
+before his leave was up. He reported himself to the colonel.
+
+"So you have not been to Pointdexter after all! I received a long
+letter a week ago from the baron, sent by special messenger,
+giving me a full account of your doings, which reads like a
+chapter of romance. He mentioned that he had also written to the
+king, denouncing the conduct of the Vicomte de Tulle; and stating
+that, in the fight between his own rescuers and the vicomte's
+band, the latter was killed, and doing full justice to the part
+you played in the affair. I had a message from His Majesty
+yesterday, ordering that you should, as soon as you returned, go
+at once to Versailles, in order that he might question you further
+on the affair.
+
+"I have another piece of news for you. We have received orders to
+march in three days' time, which is a fortunate circumstance for
+you, for there can be no doubt that, however gallantly and well
+you have behaved in this affair, and in whatever light His Majesty
+may view it, you have incurred the enmity of de Tulle's family and
+connections, and the air of Paris would not be healthy for you,
+for a time. I need not say that I have read the baron's letter to
+your comrades, and that they fully shared with me the admiration I
+feel at your conduct."
+
+"Had I better start at once for Versailles, sir?"
+
+"I think so. The king is not pleased at being kept waiting. He is
+sure to ask you when you arrived. You had better take one of my
+horses. I will order it to be brought round, and shall be at your
+quarters by the time you have put on your full uniform."
+
+The king had just returned from hunting when Desmond arrived at
+the palace, and gave his name to one of the ushers. Five minutes
+later, he was conducted to the king's dressing room.
+
+"This is a serious business, young sir, in which you have been
+engaged," the king said shortly to Desmond, as he entered.
+
+"I am aware of that, Sire, and yet I am well assured that every
+officer in Your Majesty's service would have acted as I did, under
+similar circumstances."
+
+"The Baron de Pointdexter has written to us fully on the matter,"
+the king said, "but we wish to hear the account from your own
+lips. When did you return to Paris?"
+
+"But two hours since, Sire."
+
+"Then you have lost no time in presenting yourself here. Now, tell
+us the whole matter, omitting no detail."
+
+Desmond told the story fully. He was interrupted once by the king.
+
+"How was it that Monsieur de la Vallee's people were at Roanne?"
+
+Desmond then related the fears that he and Philip had entertained,
+lest the vicomte should make another attempt to carry off
+Mademoiselle Pointdexter, and how, without the baron's knowledge,
+Philip had sent off a messenger to his intendant for a body of his
+men to meet them on the way; how the messenger had been
+intercepted and desperately wounded, and how, in consequence,
+instead of their being met by the party at Nevers, or north of
+that town, they had only reached Roanne after the attack had been
+made on the travellers, near Moulins.
+
+The king asked no more questions, until Desmond finished his
+story.
+
+"You did well, sir," he then said; "and the conduct of the Vicomte
+de Tulle was outrageous, and we should have visited him with our
+heaviest displeasure, had he not already received his deserts. It
+is intolerable that a noble gentleman, with his daughter, cannot
+travel along the highroads of our kingdom without being thus
+assaulted. It was the more scandalous when the vicomte was
+banished from our court for a similar attempt. The fact that he
+had enjoyed our favour would in no degree have mitigated--indeed
+it would have increased--our anger at his conduct, since it would
+have seemed as if he had relied upon it for immunity for his
+action. Surely, such a belief would have been an erroneous one.
+The law must be observed, and the higher placed a man is, the more
+is he bound to set an example of obedience to it.
+
+"We thank you, sir, for having thwarted so daring and villainous a
+scheme. We have not yet sent an answer to the Baron de Pointdexter,
+because we wished your report of the matter before doing so. We
+shall now cause him to be informed of our indignation at the plot
+against his person and that of his daughter, and our satisfaction
+that they have escaped from it.
+
+"You have begun your career well, indeed, young sir. Your regiment
+is about to start for the frontier. We shall direct your colonel
+to report to us, from time to time, as to your conduct, and shall
+see that your promotion is in accordance with your actions, and
+shall request him to offer you any opportunity that may occur for
+distinguishing yourself."
+
+Desmond rode back to Paris well satisfied with the result of the
+interview. He had not been slow in noticing that, although the
+king's approval of his actions had been warmly expressed in words,
+there was a certain coldness in the tone in which they were
+spoken, which showed that, although the king's sense of justice
+constrained him to praise, he was at heart sore at the death of
+one who had been a favoured companion in his sports and
+amusements.
+
+On his return, he found his two friends waiting for him, at his
+quarters. They gave him a hearty greeting.
+
+"You are a perfect paladin, Kennedy," O'Neil said; "and, though we
+are all proud of you, we cannot help feeling a little envious that
+such adventures have all fallen to the lot of our junior ensign.
+It is evident that, if you were not born with a silver spoon in
+your mouth, fortune determined to make up in other ways, by giving
+you such chances as do not fall to the lot of anyone else."
+
+"Yes, I think I have every right to consider myself exceptionally
+fortunate."
+
+"You may have been fortunate, Kennedy," O'Sullivan remarked. "The
+thing is, that you took advantage of the opportunities. You threw
+yourself into the first adventure that came your way, rescued a
+lovely damsel in distress, and her gratitude and that of her
+father attracted the king's notice, and gained that ring on your
+finger. In the next place, after escaping from the ruffians who
+attacked the coach--principally, as it seems, by cutting down
+their leader, and so occupying the attention of his followers--you
+instantly took the resolution to attempt to rescue him and his
+daughter, and succeeded in doing so. Another man might have
+stopped at Moulins, congratulating himself that he had escaped
+from the trap, and lamenting that he could do nothing towards
+again rescuing this damsel from her abductors. Of course, it was a
+piece of good fortune, meeting de la Vallee's men at Roanne; but I
+have no doubt that, if you had not done so, you would still have
+got to Pointdexter, gathered a force, and intercepted the
+vicomte's party."
+
+"It would have been a very near thing, O'Sullivan. Changing horse
+at every post, I might have got to Pointdexter from Roanne in
+twenty-four hours; but I doubt whether, even allowing that no time
+was lost in getting the men together, I could have got to Tulle
+before them. They had but one hundred and fifty miles to travel, I
+should have had still farther; and, as they would have had three
+days' start, they should have been there before me; for I heard
+from the baron that, in addition to the four horses in the coach,
+they had four others, ridden by troopers, fastened to it where the
+road was bad."
+
+"What would you have done if they had got to the vicomte's
+chateau--it is, I believe, a strong place--before you could
+intercept them?"
+
+"I cannot say what I should have done. I thought the matter over
+and over again as we rode. It seemed absurd to think of attacking
+a chateau with only twelve men; and besides, it would have been a
+very serious business to assault a noble in his own castle. There
+would almost certainly be twenty or thirty men there, at the
+least, and the ringing of the alarm bell would have brought all
+his vassals within five miles round to his aid, at once. I have no
+doubt that I should have attempted something, but in what way I
+could form no idea, until I saw the place."
+
+The two young men laughed.
+
+"I believe that you would have succeeded somehow, Kennedy," O'Neil
+said. "After what you have done, I have an almost unlimited faith
+in you, and if you told me you could see no other plan than
+carrying off His Gracious Majesty, and taking him down to Tulle
+and forcing him to order this rascal vicomte to deliver up his
+captives, you would accomplish it."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"The plan might be as good as another, though I own that it had
+not occurred to me; but it would certainly necessitate my having
+him held prisoner until I had got safely out of France, otherwise
+my fate would assuredly be to be broken on the wheel."
+
+"Yes; I don't think His Gracious Majesty would have forgiven such
+an indignity, even if put upon him for a good purpose. It is
+almost treason even to dream of such a thing."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"It was a purely imaginary case; but you see, not having been
+accustomed, as you are, to a country where the king is regarded
+almost as a god, I am afraid I have not that awe of him that is
+generally entertained here. I have, naturally, a great respect for
+the king whom I serve, and whose pay is a matter of the greatest
+importance to me; but after all, although in his service, he is
+not my lawful king."
+
+"Then you would not even imagine such a thing as to take your
+lawful king, James, prisoner, however much the fate of someone in
+whom you were interested was concerned?"
+
+Desmond did not answer at once.
+
+"I don't know," he said at last, "what I should do, in such a
+case. For King James, as lawful king of my country, I have the
+deepest respect, and would freely venture my life in his service;
+but for him as a man, irrespective of his crown, I own that my
+admiration is not extreme, and that I should not hesitate to join
+in any plan for putting pressure upon him, on behalf of anyone in
+whom I was extremely interested, as I certainly am now in
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter and Monsieur de la Vallee."
+
+"You are a curious fellow, Kennedy," O'Neil said, with a smile,
+"and I should be very much puzzled if I were called upon to
+predict what your fate is likely to be. It seems to me that you
+have an equal chance of becoming a French marshal, or being broken
+on the wheel. Here you are, not yet seventeen. You have, as I
+doubt not, somewhat interfered with the king's plans, and caused
+him the loss of one of his personal friends. You have twice
+rescued a noble lady from the hands of her abductors. You have
+brought disgrace and death upon a member of one of the most
+powerful families in France. You have earned the gratitude and
+friendship of one of the leading nobles of Southern France, that
+of the fiance of his daughter, and of the daughter herself. As
+soon as this affair spreads abroad, you will be the object of
+general remark and attention. You have rendered the regiment to
+which you belong proud of you, its junior ensign, and made Paris
+emphatically too hot to hold you.
+
+"If all this is done before you are seventeen, what may we expect
+when another ten years have passed over your head?"
+
+"You had better wait for the ten years to pass, O'Neil," Desmond
+laughed; "by which time, perhaps, you and O'Sullivan will both
+have learned wisdom, and will see that, because a man happens to
+have gone through a very exciting adventure without discredit, it
+by no means proves him to be anything in the smallest degree out
+of the way."
+
+
+
+Chapter 8: To Scotland.
+
+
+Two days later the regiment was paraded, but no order had been
+received for their start, and their destination was still
+uncertain. The officers stood in a group, awaiting the arrival of
+the colonel, who entered, accompanied by Colonel Wauchop and
+several other Irish officers. As there had been no notice of an
+official inspection, there was a general feeling of surprise at
+the appearance of the visitors. The colonel rode up to the group
+of officers.
+
+"Gentlemen," he said, "I must ask you all to accompany me to the
+common room. I have news of importance to give you."
+
+He and those with him dismounted, and, followed by the wondering
+officers of the regiment, went into the large room where they
+gathered in the evening.
+
+"The news that I am about to give you is of an important and happy
+nature. His Most Gracious Majesty has decided to send an
+expedition to Scotland, where the whole country is ready to rise
+in favour of our lawful king."
+
+A cheer broke from his hearers.
+
+"Many Scottish and Irish gentlemen," the colonel went on, "have
+been selected to accompany it. Among them is my friend, Colonel
+Wauchop, and the officers with him. The expedition will consist of
+six thousand French troops. I regret to say that no Irish
+regiments will accompany it."
+
+A groan of disappointment followed this announcement.
+
+"We must hope," the colonel said, "that Irish troops are not
+employed, only because it is intended that another expedition will
+sail to Ireland, in which case we may be sure that some of us will
+have an opportunity of fighting, again, on our own side of the
+water. Moreover, between France and Scotland there has long been a
+close connection and friendship, and the employment of French
+troops would, therefore, better suit the Scots than would be the
+case with Irishmen. Another reason perhaps is, the King of France
+does not like to spare his best troops, when he has sore need of
+them in Flanders and Spain.
+
+"However, a number of Irish officers will accompany the
+expedition, for the purpose of drilling and commanding the new
+levies, for which work they will be far better suited, by their
+knowledge of English, than French officers would be. Therefore,
+the various Irish regiments are all to furnish a certain number of
+lieutenants. Generals Hamilton, Sheldon, Dorrington, and Lords
+Galmoy and Fitzgerald, and our friend Colonel Wauchop will be in
+command of the newly-raised force, having with them many Scotch
+officers now in the service of France.
+
+"The secret of the expedition has been well kept, but I have known
+it for a fortnight, and have prepared a list of the fifteen
+officers who are to go. I may say that, in order to avoid
+partiality, I have, with one exception, selected them by lot.
+Those who are to go will doubtless consider themselves fortunate.
+Those who are to stay are still more lucky, if, as I hope, the
+regiment will form part of a similar expedition sent to Ireland."
+
+He then read out the list of the officers chosen. O'Sullivan and
+O'Neil were both among them, and the name of Desmond Kennedy was
+the last read out.
+
+"You will, gentlemen, start in an hour's time, taking the northern
+road through Montvidier and Arras. In each of these towns you will
+be joined by officers from other regiments. Colonel Wauchop will
+accompany you. I do not name the port from which you are to sail,
+and no word must be said, by you, as to the route you are to
+travel; but you can no doubt judge for yourselves, by the road
+that you are taking, what port is your destination. The French
+troops will be already there, and the fleet is all in readiness.
+
+"You all have horses. You can each take your soldier servant with
+you, but those who do so must either hire or purchase a horse for
+him. All further details you will learn from Colonel Wauchop, and
+the paymaster will have orders to issue two months' pay to each of
+you, in advance. The distance will be about a hundred and fifty
+miles, and you will perform it in five days."
+
+Colonel Wauchop then addressed a few words to the officers, all of
+whom were under the rank of captain.
+
+"Gentlemen," he said, "you have an honourable task before you. For
+years we have been waiting for the day when our swords might aid
+to place our king upon the throne. At last it has come. I need not
+say that the struggle will be a severe one, and that your courage
+will be taxed to the utmost, but you have proved that in a score
+of desperate fights.
+
+"The task before you will need tact to no ordinary degree. The
+Scotch are as peppery a race as the Irish are, and it will be
+necessary in no way to hurt their feelings, or to excite among
+them the smallest degree of discontent at being drilled and led by
+men who are not of their own race.
+
+"And now, as we have much to do before starting, I will leave you
+to make your arrangements. The rendezvous for us all is in your
+barrack yard, and at nine o'clock we shall be here."
+
+The colonel now left the room, and the officers eagerly and
+excitedly talked over the startling news that they had just heard.
+The greater part of those who had been selected for the service
+were delighted to go, while the others were equally pleased, at
+the thought that they might shortly be fighting for King James on
+the soil of Ireland.
+
+"Sure, your honour, I wish it had been in the ould country instead
+of Scotland," Mike said, when he heard the news.
+
+"I cannot say that I agree with you, Mike. In Ireland, we should
+find tens of thousands of brave hearts ready to join us, but they
+are unarmed, undrilled, and undisciplined, and would be of
+comparatively slight assistance to us against the English troops.
+Defeat would bring down fresh persecutions, fresh confiscations,
+and greater misery upon the land."
+
+"Sure we would beat them, your honour."
+
+"We might, Mike; but you must remember that we failed to do so,
+even when the people were armed. No doubt we shall take a certain
+amount of muskets and ammunition with us, but the power of England
+is more assuredly fixed in Ireland now than it was then--the
+influence of the old Irish families is broken, and even if we
+armed all who joined us, it would be but an armed rabble and not
+an army.
+
+"In Scotland it is altogether different. The Scottish clans would
+join us under their chiefs, to whom they give absolute obedience,
+and they would turn out armed and ready for action. Thus, then, I
+think that, allowing that Ireland is as loyal as Scotland, the
+choice has been a wise one."
+
+"Sure, you know best, your honour; but I will warrant that as soon
+as Scotland rises, Ireland will be in a blaze from one end to the
+other."
+
+"That may well be, Mike; but there will then be a chance of
+success, since the English forces will be fully occupied by our
+descent in the north, which will threaten London, while Ireland
+can be left to itself until the main question is settled."
+
+"It is mighty lucky, your honour, that I should have stuck to the
+horse we got when we rescued Miss Pointdexter."
+
+"I am very glad, too, Mike, for otherwise I should have had to buy
+one, and it is likely enough that I may want all the money I have,
+before this campaign that we are starting upon is over."
+
+O'Neil and O'Sullivan, at this moment, burst into the room.
+
+"It is glorious that we three should all be going, Kennedy!" the
+latter exclaimed. "It is just your luck, for you are the only
+ensign named, while the regiment will be left with only four
+lieutenants. Of course, I should be still better pleased if we
+were going to Ireland. Still, for anything we know that expedition
+may not come off, and, so that we are fighting for the king, it's
+all one whether it is in Scotland or at home."
+
+Having seen that all was ready for departure, Desmond went to the
+colonel's quarters to say goodbye. Several of the officers who
+were going were already there, and the colonel motioned to him to
+stay until they had left. When they had done so, he said:
+
+"Perhaps you guessed, Kennedy, that you were the one exception I
+mentioned to the rule I adopted, of fixing by lot upon those who
+were to go."
+
+"No, indeed, sir," Desmond said, in surprise; "I thought it an
+extraordinary piece of good fortune that I should be the only
+ensign to go, when there were so many others all senior to me.
+Indeed, I thought for a moment of saying that I would resign, in
+favour of one who was older and more experienced than myself; but
+then it struck me that if I did, some of the junior lieutenants
+might feel themselves obliged to do the same, in favour of their
+seniors."
+
+"I should not, in any case, have permitted a change to be made. I
+had decided that, in order to avoid jealousy, chance should decide
+the matter. Indeed, you are the only ensign going with the
+expedition. I informed Colonel Wauchop and General Hamilton of the
+reason for which I specially included you.
+
+"So long as it was supposed that the regiment was on the point of
+marching to Spain, I considered that, if you took my advice and
+did not leave the barracks after nightfall, no harm would befall
+you. But the case is altered, now that it may remain here for some
+time, for no doubt it will take part in any expedition sent to
+Ireland. I have heard, within the past forty-eight hours, that the
+friends of de Tulle have made very strong representations to the
+king. They have urged that your proceedings, involving what they
+call the murder of their kinsman, were of the nature of civil war;
+and that, if his conduct had been reprehensible, it was for the
+Baron de Pointdexter to lay the matter before His Majesty and ask
+for redress.
+
+"I hear, however, the king received their remonstrances coldly,
+told them that de Tulle had brought his fate upon himself, that it
+was the duty of every gentleman to endeavour to rescue a lady, so
+feloniously carried off, and that he approved of the readiness and
+energy with which you had taken steps to do so.
+
+"On finding, then, that they have failed in their hope of having
+you sent to one of the royal prisons, from which you would
+probably never have come out alive, I have no doubt whatever that
+these people will endeavour to take the matter into their own
+hands, and that, with the means at their disposal, they will find
+no difficulty in procuring persons who would undertake to
+assassinate you. As I have said, if you had at once started for
+the army, we might have looked after your safety until you crossed
+the frontier, but here in Paris you would not be safe for an hour,
+and could scarce venture between the barracks and your lodging,
+unless under a strong guard. Under such circumstances, I consider
+that I was justified in placing you on the list of the officers
+who would accompany the expedition.
+
+"I explained to General Hamilton and Colonel Wauchop, who both
+happened to be with me, my reasons for wishing to include so young
+an officer in the ranks of those selected for the service. The
+officers heartily agreed with me, having, of course, heard the
+story, or, at any rate, the main facts of your rescues of
+Mademoiselle de Pointdexter."
+
+"I am indeed greatly obliged to you, Colonel. I know that it is a
+dangerous thing to incur the enmity of one of those powerful
+families, and, though I should certainly have taken every
+precaution in my power, I felt that I should be in constant danger
+until we fairly embarked upon a campaign."
+
+At nine o'clock the party started. It numbered some fifty
+officers, Scotch and Irish. The baggage had started half an hour
+before. It was to join the carts, with the baggage of the other
+officers, outside the northern gates; and was under an escort of
+dragoons, whose officer had powers given him to requisition fresh
+horses at each town through which he passed, and so to push on to
+the port with but two halts.
+
+Once off, there was no longer any necessity for keeping their
+destination a secret, and the officers were informed that, as they
+had already guessed, Dunkirk was the harbour from which they were
+to sail.
+
+The journey was a pleasant one. All were in the highest spirits. A
+short distance behind them marched a body of infantry, composed
+entirely of noncommissioned officers, of whom O'Brien's regiment
+furnished thirty. All were picked men, and, marching each day as
+far as the party of officers rode, arrived at Dunkirk on the fifth
+day after starting, and were at once embarked on the ships of war.
+
+Colonel Wauchop and the officers of O'Brien's regiment were told
+off to the Salisbury, which was a ship that had been taken from
+the English, and was now loaded with military stores, arms, and
+munitions for the use of those who were expected to join them on
+landing. After seeing that the officers were all properly
+accommodated, the colonel went ashore, and when he returned it was
+at once seen, by the expression of his face, that something was
+wrong.
+
+"I have very bad news," he said. "King James, who arrived here two
+days ago, has been taken suddenly ill, and until he is partially
+recovered we cannot sail, for it is absolutely necessary that he
+should be with us. This may mean the delay of a week or ten days,
+and may defeat all our arrangements. The English Government have
+spies here, as well as elsewhere; and their fleet has, for the
+last week, been hovering off the coast. They may not have known
+the purpose of the assembly of troops here, for this has been kept
+strictly secret; and few even of the French officers of the
+expedition knew, until they arrived here, for what reason the
+regiments had been ordered to Dunkirk. But the arrival of King
+James, of course, showed what was the intention, and, as soon as
+the news reaches London, you may be sure that the English fleet
+will be sent to intercept us."
+
+It was, indeed, ten days before James was sufficiently recovered
+to be embarked--a delay which probably cost him his kingdom, for
+there can be no doubt that, on landing, he would have been joined
+at once by all the great clans, and by no small proportion of the
+able-bodied men of the country.
+
+The consequences were so evident, to all engaged in the
+expedition, that despondency took the place of the enthusiasm with
+which they had embarked. The fact that the expedition, after being
+so carefully and secretly prepared, should at its outset meet with
+so serious a misfortune, was considered an omen of evil. At last,
+however, James embarked, under a salute by the guns of the ships
+of war; and as the sails were hoisted and the anchors weighed, the
+spirits of all again rose.
+
+They had sailed but a few miles when it became evident that the
+Salisbury was the slowest ship in the fleet, for, although she had
+every stitch of canvas set, she lagged behind the rest, and the
+other vessels were obliged to lower some of their sails, in order
+to allow her to keep up with them.
+
+"I begin to think, Kennedy," O'Neil said, "that the good fortune
+that has hitherto attended you has spent itself. O'Sullivan and I
+both regarded it as a good omen that you should be the one ensign
+selected to go with us, but this miserable delay at Dunkirk, and
+the fact that we are on board the slowest tub in the fleet, seems
+to show that Dame Fortune is no longer going to exercise herself
+in your favour."
+
+"It looks like it, indeed," Desmond agreed. "Still, I can't hold
+myself responsible for either the king's illness, or for our being
+allotted to this heavy-sailing craft; and, perhaps, even if
+fortune should not favour me any longer, she will do something for
+some of the others.
+
+"She has always been favourable to Colonel Wauchop. He has been
+through innumerable engagements. Though many times wounded, he has
+never been seriously so, though scores of other officers have
+fallen in enterprises in which he has taken part. In his case,
+fortune has not been fickle, and, as he is the chief officer on
+board, we must hope that she has not deserted him on this
+occasion. I think there is a certain amount of luck in the fact
+that we carry a large amount of guns and ammunition. If that had
+not been the case, it is likely that, rather than delay, the
+squadron would sail on at full speed, and have left us to follow
+as best we might."
+
+A constant watch was maintained at the masthead of the ship, but
+no signs were seen of the English fleet, until, on the 23rd of
+March, six days after sailing, they reached the mouth of the Firth
+of Forth, and were congratulating themselves that they had brought
+the voyage to a successful termination.
+
+At daybreak next morning, however, just as they were about to
+enter the estuary, they beheld the masts of a great fleet coming
+out to meet them. This was the squadron of Sir George Byng, which
+had for some days been on the coast, having been despatched as
+soon as the news reached London of the gathering of ships and
+troops at Dunkirk, and of the arrival of the Pretender there. The
+French admiral at once signalled to all the ships to put about,
+and he lay off until the English fleet were near enough to discern
+its composition, which was far superior in force to his own.
+Seeing the impossibility of landing the troops and stores, and the
+slight chances of success in giving battle, he hoisted the signal
+for all to make their way back to Dunkirk, keeping as much as
+possible together, in order to defend themselves if overtaken, or
+if intercepted by another hostile fleet.
+
+In vain, James begged that a few boats might be given him, with
+which to land with his chief followers. The French admiral replied
+that his instructions would not justify him in doing so, and that
+he had been ordered to specially protect the person of the young
+king, whose safety was of the highest concern to his sovereign.
+
+It was with the deepest feeling of disappointment, and depression,
+that the Scotch and Irish officers heard that it was determined to
+sail for Dunkirk again. Had the troops on board the ships been of
+their own nationality, they would have ordered them to disobey the
+admiral's commands, and to insist upon the fleet, if it succeeded
+in evading the pursuit of the enemy, making another effort to
+effect a landing. As, however, all the soldiers were French, with
+the exception of the two or three hundred noncommissioned Irish
+officers, they were powerless, and were half mad with rage and
+grief.
+
+"This looks bad for us," O'Sullivan said gravely to his two
+friends. "I think that the French ships will outsail the English,
+but there is little chance that this unwieldy craft will do so; in
+which case, my friends, it is likely that we shall all see the
+inside of an English prison, and that probably not a few of us
+will be executed. The colonel should be safe, for he came over
+with the Brigade after Limerick, and therefore by that treaty was
+allowed to enter the service of France; but it is different with
+the rest of us. We have all joined since those days, and are
+therefore not covered by the treaty, and so are liable to be tried
+as traitors."
+
+O'Neil shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"Well, we knew that when we joined," he said. "However, I hardly
+think they are likely to proceed to such an extremity. Very many
+of our Brigade have been taken prisoners, at Blenheim and other
+places, and they have always had the same treatment as other
+prisoners of war."
+
+"That may be," O'Sullivan replied; "but this is a different
+matter. It is not a question of war on foreign soil. We were going
+to attack the throne of Anne, to promote civil war, and to
+overthrow the Government. The attempt once made can be made again,
+and you may be sure that the news of our sailing has created a
+tremendous scare throughout the country. However, we are in for
+it, and there is no use grumbling against fate. Already, you see,
+the rest of the fleet are leaving us--faster, I think, than the
+English fleet are gaining on us--and I trust they will get safely
+away into Dunkirk.
+
+"The fact that we so nearly succeeded will, perhaps, act as an
+inducement to Louis to renew the expedition; and the loss of a
+colonel, fifteen lieutenants, and thirty noncommissioned officers
+will not seriously affect anyone except ourselves."
+
+"However," Desmond put in, "I think that, after all, things may
+not be as bad as you think. In the first place, our execution
+would have an extremely bad effect in Scotland and Ireland, and
+would add to the general hostility to the present Government. In
+the next place, Louis has many English prisoners in his hands, and
+might threaten reprisals. Lastly, there is always a chance of
+escape."
+
+"Your first two arguments are good, Kennedy," O'Neil said, "but I
+cannot say as much for the last. The chances of escape from an
+English prison must be small indeed."
+
+"Nevertheless there must always be chances," Desmond said. "If you
+will take my advice you will at once go below, and conceal your
+money."
+
+"Where are we going to conceal it?" O'Sullivan said. "You may be
+sure that we shall be searched."
+
+"Well, you took my advice, in changing the silver in which you
+were paid into gold, though you lost pretty heavily by the
+transaction. We did it to prevent lugging about a heavy bag of
+silver. Now, it has its advantages. You could not hope to conceal
+silver, but we may, at least, hide a few pieces of gold. Mike is a
+handy fellow, and I have no doubt will be able to help us. At any
+rate, let us go below and see what can be done."
+
+Mike was summoned to the cabin.
+
+"Now, Mike," Desmond said, "I suppose, in a campaign, a good many
+of you carry what money you may have about you, and I dare say
+some of you hide it so that, if you are taken prisoners, you may
+have means of adding to your prison fare."
+
+"We do, your honour; and, by the same token, I have a score of
+crowns in between the soles of my boots. It does not always
+succeed, for if your boots happen to be good, the chances are that
+someone takes a fancy to them. Still, on the whole, that is the
+best place there is, for they are sure to feel all the lining of
+your clothes."
+
+"Well, we want to hide some gold, Mike. In another hour we shall
+have the English within shot of us, and, of course, fighting is
+out of the question. Do you think that you will have time to hide
+a dozen gold pieces in each of our boots?"
+
+Mike looked doubtful.
+
+"To do the thing properly, your honour, one should take off the
+lower sole, take some leather out of the upper one, put some money
+in, and then sew it up again; but it would take more than an hour
+to do one pair."
+
+He thought for a moment.
+
+"The quickest way would be to get out the inside lining of the
+sole, then to cut out enough leather for the money to lie in, then
+to put in the lining again. It would not be soft walking on a
+twenty-mile march, but I think, if I get the lining in tight, with
+a few little nails to keep it from dropping out, if anyone takes
+the trouble to turn the boots upside down, I might manage it."
+
+"Well, let us commence at once, then, Mike. We have all got riding
+boots, and can put them on before we are taken prisoners. Do you
+take the linings out, as you say, and then we will help to cut out
+some of the leather of the upper sole."
+
+They were quickly at work. Mike cut out enough of the thin lining
+to admit of a hole being made, large enough to hold ten louis in
+each boot, and he and the two officers then set to work, to cut
+out a sufficient depth of leather for the coins to lie side by
+side. Half an hour sufficed for this.
+
+The coins were put in. Mike had, in the meantime, obtained a
+handful of pitch and melted it at the galley fire. This he ran in
+over the gold, and then replaced the pieces of lining with hot
+pitch.
+
+"There, your honours," he said, when he had finished. "I call that
+a neat job, and it would be hard, indeed, if the spalpeens find
+that there is anything amiss. And, with these heavy boots, the
+extra weight won't betray that there is anything hidden.
+
+"Don't put them on till the last moment. Give them time to cool,
+for if any of it oozes out, you will stick your stockings so tight
+to it that you won't get your foot out without laving them
+behind."
+
+Leaving their high boots in the cabin, the three young men went on
+deck. The leading vessel of the British fleet was not more than a
+mile astern, while the French fleet was three miles ahead, having
+gained more than a mile since the chase began. Mike had been given
+four louis, which he said he could hide in his mouth.
+
+Five minutes later, there was a puff of smoke from their pursuer's
+bow. The ball struck the water close to them.
+
+"Shall I hold on, Colonel?" the captain of the ship asked Colonel
+Wauchop.
+
+"There is no use in your doing so. That ship will be alongside in
+an hour, and it might only cause a useless loss of life were we to
+keep on. If she were alone I should say, let her come alongside,
+and with your crew and our officers and men we might, if we had
+luck, take her by boarding; but, with the whole fleet close behind
+us, it would be madness to think of such a thing, as we have but
+twelve guns, and those of small weight."
+
+Accordingly, the topsails were run down, and the courses brailed
+up, and the ship lay motionless till the English frigate came up.
+Signals had been exchanged between the English vessels, and as
+they came along six of them dropped boats, each with some twenty
+men in it. While these rowed towards the prize, the fleet pressed
+on, under all canvas, in pursuit of the French squadron.
+
+The English officer in command of the boats received the swords of
+the French officers, and the noncommissioned officers were all
+sent below into the hold. All sail was at once got on to the
+vessel again, and she followed in the wake of the fleet. The
+English lieutenant then took the names of the prisoners.
+
+"You are all Irish," he said, seriously. "I am sorry, gentlemen,
+that this should be so, for I fear that it will go harder with you
+than if you were French, when, of course, you would be merely
+prisoners of war."
+
+"We should be prisoners of war, now," Colonel Wauchop said. "We
+are in the service of the King of France, and were but obeying his
+orders, along with our French comrades."
+
+"I hope they may see it in that light, in London," the officer
+said courteously; "but I doubt whether, at the present moment,
+they will take a calm view of the subject. However, I hope they
+will do so, especially as no shot has been fired by you, and they
+cannot charge you with resisting capture. At any rate, gentlemen,
+I will do my best to make you comfortable while you are under my
+charge. I must ask a few of you to shift your quarters, so as to
+make room for me and the three officers with me; beyond that you
+will continue, as before, to use the ship as passengers."
+
+When darkness set in, the pursuit was discontinued. The French
+fleet was fully ten miles ahead, and it was evident that there was
+no chance, whatever, of overtaking it; while there was a risk of
+its doubling back during the night, and again making its way
+north. The greater part of the sails of the men-of-war were
+therefore furled, while the frigates and corvettes made off, on
+either hand, to establish themselves as sentries during the night,
+and to give warning should the French fleet be seen returning. An
+hour and a half after the pursuit had ceased, the Salisbury joined
+the fleet, and the officer in command went on board the admiral's
+ship, to report the number of prisoners taken and the nature of
+her cargo.
+
+The officers had, at his invitation, dined with him and his
+officers in the cabin. All political topics had been avoided, and
+no one who had looked in would have supposed that the majority of
+those present were the prisoners of the others. The Irish
+temperament quickly shakes off a feeling of depression, and the
+meal was as lively as it had been during the voyage north.
+
+The lieutenant, however, omitted no precaution. A dozen men kept
+guard over the prisoners below, and as many more, with loaded
+muskets, were always stationed on deck. The Irish officers saw
+that, among many of the sailors, there was a strong feeling of
+sympathy with them. The fleet had been largely recruited by
+impressment; and by the handing over, to the naval authorities, of
+numbers of men imprisoned for comparatively slight offences; and,
+as was natural, these had but small feeling of kindness towards
+the government who had so seized them; while many shared in the
+feeling of loyalty towards the house of Stuart, which was still so
+prevalent among the population.
+
+At daybreak, the cruisers all returned. None had seen any signs of
+the French squadron, and Sir George Byng, leaving the majority of
+the fleet to maintain watch, sailed with his prize for Harwich.
+Here the prisoners were handed over to the military authorities;
+while the admiral started for London, in a post chaise, to carry
+the news of the failure of the French to effect a landing, and of
+their return to Dunkirk,--news that was received with exuberant
+delight by the supporters of Government, and the commercial
+portion of the population, who had been threatened by ruin. The
+run upon the banks had been unprecedented, and although the House
+of Commons had relaxed the regulations of the Bank of England, the
+panic was so great that it could not have kept its doors open
+another twelve hours.
+
+The treatment of the prisoners was now very different from what it
+had been on board ship. Not only were they confined to prison,
+but, to their indignation, irons were placed on their legs, as if
+they had been common malefactors. The only mitigation allowed to
+them was that their servants were permitted to attend upon them.
+Their clothes had been rigorously searched, and their boots taken
+off, but no suspicions had been entertained that coin had been
+hidden in those of Desmond and his friends.
+
+Two days later an order was received from Government, and the
+officers were marched up to town, ironed as they were, under a
+strong guard, and were imprisoned at Newgate. Callaghan and the
+other servants remained in prison at Harwich.
+
+"Things are looking bad, Kennedy," O'Neil said dolefully, for the
+three officers had, at their own request, been allotted a cell
+together.
+
+"They don't look very bright, but we must make allowance for the
+awful fright that, as we hear, has been caused by the expedition.
+Possibly, when they have got over the shock, things may be
+better."
+
+"I will never forgive them for putting irons on us," O'Sullivan
+said passionately. "If they had shot us at once, it was, I
+suppose, what we had a right to expect; but to be treated like
+murderers, or ruffians of the worst kind, is too bad."
+
+"Well, we were rid of the irons as soon as we got here. No doubt
+these were only put on to prevent the possibility of any of us
+escaping. I am sure, by their looks, that some of our escort would
+willingly have aided us, only that it was impossible to do so;
+and, knowing how large a number of persons would sympathize with
+us, I cannot blame them so very much for taking steps to prevent
+our escape."
+
+"I never saw such a fellow as you for finding excuses for people,"
+O'Sullivan said, almost angrily. "You look at things as calmly as
+if they concerned other people, and not ourselves."
+
+Kennedy smiled.
+
+"If an opinion is to be worth anything, O'Sullivan, it must be an
+impartial one; and it is best to look at the matter calmly, and to
+form our plans, whatever they may be, as if they were intended to
+be carried out by other people."
+
+O'Sullivan laughed.
+
+"My dear fellow, if you had not gone through those adventures, I
+should have said that you had mistaken your vocation, and were cut
+out for a philosopher rather than a soldier. However, although
+your luck did not suffice to save the Salisbury from capture, we
+must still hope that it has not altogether deserted you; and
+anyhow, I am convinced that, if it be possible for anyone to
+effect an escape from this dismal place, you are the man."
+
+Newgate, in those days, stood across the street, and constituted
+one of the entrances to the city. Its predecessor had been burnt,
+in the great fire of 1666, and the new one was at this time less
+than forty years old, and, though close and badly ventilated, had
+not yet arrived at the stage of dirt and foulness which afterwards
+brought about the death of numbers of prisoners confined there,
+and in 1750 occasioned an outbreak of jail fever, which not only
+swept away a large proportion of the prisoners, but infected the
+court of the Old Bailey close to it, causing the death of the lord
+mayor, several aldermen, a judge, many of the counsel and jurymen,
+and of the public present at the trials.
+
+The outward appearance of the building was handsome, but the cells
+were, for the most part, small and ill ventilated.
+
+"This place is disgraceful," O'Neil said. "There is barely room
+for our three pallets. The air is close and unwholesome, now, but
+in the heat of summer it must be awful. If their food is as vile
+as their lodging, the lookout is bad, indeed."
+
+"I fancy the cells in the French jails are no better," O'Sullivan
+said. "No doubt, in the state prisons, high-born prisoners are
+made fairly comfortable; but the ordinary prisoners and
+malefactors, I have been told, suffer horribly. Thank goodness I
+have never entered one; but even the barrack cells can scarcely be
+called inviting."
+
+"You are learning philosophy from Kennedy," O'Neil said, with a
+laugh.
+
+"I don't know that I shall feel philosophic, if we are served with
+nothing but bread and water. However, the turnkey told us that,
+until we have been tried and condemned, we are at liberty to get
+our food from outside--certainly a mockery, in most cases,
+considering that we all were relieved of any money found upon us,
+when we arrived in Harwich. It is a comfort that we are, as he
+said, to take our meals together, and the money we have in our
+boots will alleviate our lot for some time. Probably, it will last
+a good deal longer than we are likely to be here."
+
+When they joined their companions, in the room in which they were
+to dine, all were astonished at seeing an excellent dinner on the
+table, with eight bottles of wine.
+
+"Is this the way they treat prisoners here?" Colonel Wauchop asked
+one of the jailers, of whom six remained present.
+
+The man smiled.
+
+"No, indeed. It has been sent in from a tavern outside, and with a
+message that a like meal will be provided, as long as you are
+here. One of us was sent across, to enquire as to the person who
+had given the order. The landlord said that he was a stranger to
+him, but that he had paid him a fortnight in advance, and would
+call in and renew the order, at the end of that time."
+
+"Well, gentlemen," the colonel said, "before we begin to eat, we
+will drink the health of our unknown benefactor. Not only is the
+gift a generous and expensive one, but it cannot be without danger
+to the donor, for none but a strong adherent of King James would
+have thought of thus relieving our necessities."
+
+It was plain that the authorities suspected that some message
+might have been sent in to the prisoners, concealed in the viands.
+The bread had been cut up into small squares, the crust had been
+lifted from two pasties, the meat had evidently been carefully
+searched; and the turnkeys placed themselves round the table so
+that they could narrowly watch every one of the prisoners, as they
+ate, and notice any movement that would seem to indicate that they
+had come across some pellet of paper or other substance.
+
+Every day, the servants at the tavern brought in similar fare, and
+this continued as long as the prisoners were in the jail; and it
+was a matter of deep regret, to all, that they were never able to
+discover the name of the person to whom they were so much
+indebted.
+
+
+
+Chapter 9: An Escape From Newgate.
+
+
+After being allowed to remain an hour at the table, the prisoners
+were again marched off to their cells.
+
+"I wish we had Mike with us," Desmond said, as he and his comrades
+discussed the possibility of escape. "He is a shrewd fellow, and
+would probably be allowed greater freedom in moving about the
+prison than we are; but I was sure that we should see no more of
+him after we left Harwich.
+
+"Of course, the first question is, are we to try bribery, or to
+work our way out of this cell?"
+
+"I think that it would be dangerous to try bribery," O'Sullivan
+remarked. "Our turnkey is a sour-faced rascal. I am convinced
+that, if we were to try to bribe him, he would denounce us at
+once. Not from any principle, you know, but because he would think
+that it would pay him better to do so, and so obtain promotion and
+reward, rather than to accept our money and run the risk of being
+detected and hanged."
+
+"I don't blame him," O'Neil said. "He is, as you say, a
+sour-looking rascal, but I don't think that he is a fool, and none
+but a fool would run that risk for the sake of the money that we
+could give him; for, in any case, we should have to retain a
+portion of our store, in order to obtain disguises and maintain
+ourselves till we could find means of crossing the channel."
+
+"Then let us put that idea altogether aside, O'Neil, and give our
+whole attention to the manner in which we are to escape."
+
+"The manner in which we are to try to make our escape!" O'Neil
+repeated, with a laugh.
+
+"Well, put it that way if you like. Now, in the first place, there
+is the window, in the second the door, and lastly the walls and
+floor."
+
+"The door would withstand a battering ram," O'Sullivan said. "I
+noticed, as I went out, that it was solid oak some four inches
+thick, with two bolts as well as the lock, and, moreover, if we
+could get through it we should be no nearer escaping than we are
+at present. What with the corridors and passages, and the turnkeys
+and the outer gate, that course seems to me impossible.
+
+"Let us come to the second point, the window."
+
+They looked up at it. The sill was fully six feet from the ground.
+The window was a little over a foot wide, with a heavy bar running
+down the centre, and cross bars.
+
+"The first point is to see where it looks out on," Desmond said.
+"I will stand against the wall, and as you are the lighter of the
+two, O'Neil, you can stand on my shoulder and have a good look
+out, and tell us what you see.
+
+"Give him your hand, O'Sullivan.
+
+"Put your foot on that, O'Neil, and then step on my shoulder."
+
+O'Neil was soon in his place.
+
+"You need not hold me," he said. "The wall is very thick, the bars
+are placed in the middle, and there is just room for me to take a
+seat on the edge, then I can see things at my ease."
+
+He sat looking out, for a minute or two, before he spoke.
+
+"Well, what can you see?" O'Sullivan asked, impatiently.
+
+"This room is on the outer side of the prison," he said. "I
+noticed, as we came in, that it was built along on both sides of
+the gate; and, no doubt, this side stands on the city wall."
+
+"Then what do you see?"
+
+"I see the ground, sloping steeply down to a stream that runs
+along the bottom of it. There are a good many small houses,
+scattered about on the slope and along by the stream. Over to the
+left, there is a stone bridge across it. Near this is a large
+building, that looks like another prison, and a marketplace with
+stalls in it. Houses stand thickly on either side of the road, and
+beyond the bridge the opposite side of the slope is covered with
+them. Among these are some large buildings.
+
+"If we were once out, there would not be much chance of our being
+detected, if we had something to put over our uniforms; but, of
+course, they would betray us to the first man we met."
+
+"Yes, of course," O'Sullivan said; "but we might possibly obtain
+plain clothes at one of those small houses you speak of, though
+that would be risky."
+
+"We might leave our coatees behind us, and go only in our shirts
+and breeches; and give out that we had been attacked, and robbed
+of our money and coats by footpads," Desmond said.
+
+"That is a good idea," O'Neil agreed. "Yes, that might do,
+especially as, after dark, they would not be likely to notice that
+our breeches were of a French cut."
+
+"But it seems to me that we are beginning at the wrong end of the
+business. It is of no use discussing what we are to do, when we
+escape, till we have settled upon the manner in which we are to
+get out. Let us talk over that first.
+
+"Are the bars firmly in, O'Neil?"
+
+O'Neil tried, with all his strength, to shake them.
+
+"They are as firm as the walls," he said. "There is no getting
+them out, unless we have tools to cut away all the stonework round
+them."
+
+"I suppose there is no chance of cutting through them?" O'Sullivan
+asked.
+
+"There is not," O'Neil said. "We have not got such a thing as a
+knife about us. If we had, we could never saw through these thick
+bars; it would take a year of Sundays."
+
+"You are rather a Job's comforter. Now, do you get down, and let
+Kennedy and myself have a chance of a breath of fresh air, to say
+nothing of the view."
+
+A few minutes satisfied O'Sullivan, but Desmond, when he took his
+place, sat there considerably longer; while the other two,
+throwing themselves on their pallets, chatted gaily about Paris
+and their friends there.
+
+"Well, what conclusions do you arrive at?" they asked, when he
+leapt down from his seat.
+
+"They are not very cheering," he replied, "and I recognize fully
+that we cannot possibly make our escape, without aid from
+without."
+
+"That is the same as to say that we cannot make our escape at
+all."
+
+"Not exactly. We have found one unknown friend, who supplied us
+with our dinners. There is no absolute reason why we should not
+find one who would supply us with means of escape. There must be a
+great number of people who sympathize with us, and whose hearts
+are with King James. I have seen several men come from the market,
+stand and look up at this prison, and then walk off, slowly, as if
+they were filled with pity for us. Now, I propose that one of us
+shall always be at the window."
+
+"Oh, that is too much!" O'Sullivan said. "That ledge is so narrow
+that I could hardly sit there, even holding on by the bars; and as
+to stopping there half an hour, I would almost as soon be on the
+rack."
+
+"There will be no occasion for that," Desmond said. "We can easily
+move one of the pallets under it, pile the other straw beds upon
+it, and, standing on these, we could look out comfortably, for our
+shoulders would be well above the ledge."
+
+"I don't see that we should be nearer to it, then, Kennedy."
+
+"We should have gained this much: that directly we saw any person
+looking up, with a sympathizing air, especially if of a class who
+could afford to do what is necessary for us, we could wave our
+hands and attract his attention. If disposed to help us, he might
+give some sign. If not, no harm would be done. We might, too, tie
+a handkerchief to the bars, which in itself might be taken for an
+indication that there are followers of the Stuarts here."
+
+"But supposing all this turned out as you suggest it might, how
+could even the best disposed friend do anything to help us?"
+
+"That is for after consideration. Let us first find a friend, and
+we shall find a way to open communication with him. We have no
+paper, but we could write the message on a piece of linen and drop
+it down. As far as we can see, from here, there is nothing to
+prevent anyone coming up to the foot of the wall below us."
+
+For the next four days, nothing whatever happened. They could see
+that the white handkerchief at the bars attracted some attention,
+for people stopped and looked up at it, but continued their way
+without making any gesture that would seem to show that they
+interested themselves, in any way, in the matter.
+
+On the fourth day, Desmond, who was at the window, said in a tone
+of excitement:
+
+"There is a man down there who, after looking fixedly in this
+direction, is making his way towards us. He does not come
+straight, but moves about among the houses; but he continues to
+approach. I can't make out his face yet, but there is something
+about him that reminds me of Mike; though how he could be here,
+when we left him in the prison at Harwich, is more than I can
+say."
+
+O'Neil and O'Sullivan in turn looked through the window. Not being
+so much accustomed as he was to Mike's figure and walk, they could
+not recognize in the man, in the dress of a country peasant, the
+well-set-up soldier who attended on Desmond. Both admitted,
+however, that in point of figure it might well be the man.
+
+"If it is," Desmond said, "all our difficulties are at an end, and
+I will wager that we shall be free in three or four days. Now, how
+are we to communicate with him?"
+
+"I have a piece of paper in my pocket. It is only an old bill, and
+they threw it down, contemptuously, when they searched me," O'Neil
+said. "I picked it up again. I hardly know why, except perhaps
+that the idea occurred to me that, some day, I might get a chance
+of paying it. But as we have no ink, nor pen, nor charcoal, I
+don't see how it can benefit us."
+
+He drew the bill from the pocket of his coatee. Desmond took it,
+and stood looking at it in silence for a minute. Then an idea
+occurred to him.
+
+"I have it!" he exclaimed, presently. "O'Neil, see if you can get
+a piece of this gold wire off my facings. I want it five or six
+inches long, so that when it is doubled up and twisted together,
+so as to be an inch long, it will be stiff enough for our
+purpose."
+
+Somewhat puzzled, O'Neil did as he was requested. Desmond
+straightened out the fine wire wrapped round the centre thread,
+doubled, and again doubled it, and finally twisting it together,
+reduced it to a length of about an inch, and the thickness of a
+pin. The others looked on, wondering what was his intention.
+
+He held the paper out before him, and began pricking small holes
+through it, close together. He continued to work for some time,
+and then held it up to the light. The others understood the nature
+of his work, and they could now read:
+
+Come ten tonight under window. Bring long thin string. Whistle. We
+will lower thread. Tie end of string to it. Will give further
+instructions.
+
+He tore off the portion of the bill on which the message was
+written, twisted off two of the buttons of his coatee, folded them
+in the paper, and took his place at the window again. The man who
+had been watching was standing some sixty feet from the foot of
+the wall. His back was towards them. Presently he turned,
+carelessly looked up at the window, and then, as if undecided what
+to do, took off his cap and scratched his head.
+
+"It is Mike, sure enough," Desmond exclaimed, and, thrusting his
+hand through the bars, waved it for a moment.
+
+Then, taking the little packet, he dropped it. Mike put on his hat
+again, turned round, then looked cautiously to see that no one was
+noticing him, and strolled, in an aimless and leisurely way,
+towards the wall. Desmond could no longer see him, but felt sure
+that he would find the missive.
+
+Presently he came in sight again, walking quietly away. He did not
+look round; but when nearly at the bottom of the hill turned,
+lifted one hand, and disappeared behind some houses.
+
+"He can't read," Desmond said, "but I have no doubt he will get
+someone to do it for him."
+
+A vigilant watch was kept up, but nothing was seen of Mike, till
+late in the afternoon, when he emerged into one of the open
+spaces. They had now taken the handkerchief down from the window,
+and, directly they saw him, Desmond waved it, showing that they
+were watching him. He threw up his arm, turned, and disappeared
+again.
+
+"He has made out my message," Desmond said. "We may expect him
+here at ten o'clock."
+
+While he had been watching, his two comrades had, under his
+instructions, been unravelling a portion of one of their blankets.
+When enough thread had been obtained, the strands were tied
+together and doubled, and Desmond had little doubt that it was
+sufficiently strong to draw up the string Mike would bring with
+him. He now took another portion of the bill, and pricked upon it
+the words:
+
+At nine tomorrow night, bring, if possible, fine steel saw, two
+files, and small bottle of oil. Fasten these to string we will
+lower with further instructions.
+
+He then opened his coatee, took out some of the white wool with
+which it was padded, formed this into a loose ball, in the centre
+of which the note was fastened, and all being in readiness, waited
+patiently, until, just as the city clock struck ten, they heard a
+low whistle. The ball had already been attached to the end of the
+thread, and Desmond at once lowered it down.
+
+Presently, they heard another whistle and, hauling at it again,
+they found that the ball had gone, and attached to the end of the
+thread was a very light silken cord, which they drew in. There was
+another low whistle, and all was silent.
+
+"So far, so good," Desmond said. "We are fairly on our way to
+liberty. How long do you suppose it will take us to cut through
+these bars?"
+
+"It would take us a long while to file through them all," O'Neil
+said, "but with a fine steel saw, I should think that a couple of
+nights' work should do it. But of course that is mere guesswork,
+for I have not the least idea how fast even the best saw could cut
+through iron."
+
+"Well, there is no particular hurry, for we know that no day has
+been fixed yet for our trial. So, whether it is one night or six,
+it does not matter much."
+
+On the following evening at nine o'clock the whistle was heard,
+and another ball lowered down at the end of the string. The
+instructions this time were:
+
+When we are ready, we will show a handkerchief at window. Bring
+with you, at nine that evening, rope strong enough to bear us, and
+have disguises for three ready for us at foot of wall. Herewith
+are ten louis to purchase three disguises.
+
+The cord brought up a small packet, which contained two very fine
+small steel saws, two files, and the oil. They did not lose a
+moment in setting to work, and, oiling the saws, one began to cut
+through the central bar, just above the point where the lowest
+cross bars went through it, as they determined to leave these to
+fasten the rope to. There was not room for two of them to work
+together, and they agreed to take it by turns, changing every
+quarter of an hour.
+
+To their great satisfaction, they found that the saw did its work
+much more quickly than they had expected, and by the time each had
+had a turn the bar was cut through; and by morning the side bars
+had also all been cut. They did not attempt to cut the main bar
+higher up, as, had they done so, it would have been difficult to
+keep the portion cut out in its place.
+
+When it was light, they filled up all the cuts with bread, which
+they had managed to secrete in the palms of their hands at dinner.
+This they kneaded into a sort of putty, rolled it in the dust of
+the floor until black, and then squeezed it into the interstices.
+
+"There is no fear of their noticing it," O'Neil said, when they
+had finished. "I cannot see the cuts myself from the floor, though
+I know where they are; and unless they were to climb up there, and
+examine the place very closely, they would not see anything
+wrong."
+
+"Shall we hang out the flag today, Kennedy?"
+
+"I think we had better wait till tomorrow. He will be hardly
+expecting to see it, today, and may not be ready with the rope and
+disguises."
+
+The next morning the signal was hung out. They saw nothing of
+Mike, but as he would be able to make out the handkerchief from a
+considerable distance, they had no doubt whatever that he had
+observed it, but thought it prudent not to show himself near the
+prison again. As soon as it was dark they recommenced work, and
+had cut through the main bar, and cautiously lowered the grating
+to the ground, before the clock struck nine. Then, on hearing
+Mike's signal, they lowered the cord, and soon brought up a rope
+which, although small, was more than strong enough to support
+them.
+
+"We had better tie some knots in it," Desmond said. "They will
+help us to avoid sliding down too rapidly. If it was a thick rope,
+I think we could manage without them; but, not being sailors, I do
+not think that we could grasp this tightly enough."
+
+"How close shall we put them, Kennedy?"
+
+"About two feet apart. Then we can come down hand over hand,
+helping our arms by twisting our legs round it.
+
+"Now," he went on, when they had finished the knots, "who will go
+down first?"
+
+"You had better do so," O'Sullivan said. "You are the lightest of
+us, and, I fancy, the strongest, too."
+
+"Very well. I don't think that it will make any difference, for
+the rope is strong enough to hold the three of us together.
+However, here goes. We may as well leave our coatees behind us.
+They might get us into difficulties, if we took them."
+
+So saying, he took off his coat, fastened the end of the rope
+securely to the bars that had been left for the purpose, and,
+holding it firmly, made his way through the opening and swung
+himself over. With his muscles strengthened by military exercises
+and sword practice, he found it easier work than he had expected.
+The depth was some sixty feet, and in a couple of minutes his feet
+touched the ground.
+
+Mike had been hanging on by the rope to steady it, and as Desmond
+descended, he seized him by the hand and shook it enthusiastically,
+murmuring brokenly, "My dear master, thank God that you are free!"
+
+"Thanks to you also, my dear fellow. Now, hold on again. My
+friends O'Neil and O'Sullivan shared my cell with me, and are
+following me."
+
+He added his weight to that of Mike, and it was not long before
+O'Neil came down; but not so quietly as Desmond had done, for his
+strength had failed him, and the rope had slipped rapidly through
+his fingers, and Mike and Desmond narrowly escaped being knocked
+down by the suddenness with which the descent was made. He stood
+for a minute, wringing his hand, and swearing in an undertone in
+English, Irish, and French.
+
+"By the powers," he said, "it has taken the skin off the inside of
+my hands, entirely! A red-hot poker could not have done it more
+nately!
+
+"Mike, you rascal, what are you laughing at? I have a mind to
+break your bones before thanking you."
+
+O'Sullivan succeeded better, but was completely exhausted when he
+joined his friends.
+
+"Now, Mike, where are the disguises?"
+
+"Here they are, your honour. They are just like my own. Loose
+coats, rough breeches, white stockings and buckled shoes, and soft
+hats with wide brims. I thought that you would pass better, like
+that, than in any other way; for if you were dressed up as
+citizens, your tongues might betray you, for somehow they don't
+speak English as we do; and whenever I open my mouth, they
+discover that I am an Irishman."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"There would be no difficulty about that. Now, let us put on our
+disguises at once, and be off. Sometimes the turnkeys take it into
+their heads to look in during the night, and we had to keep one on
+watch while we were at work, and take to our beds when we heard a
+footstep approaching.
+
+"I see you have brought shoes. I forgot to mention them. Our jack
+boots would have attracted attention, so we have left them behind
+us, after getting our stores of money from their hiding places."
+
+They were soon dressed.
+
+"What are we supposed to be, Mike?"
+
+"You are sedan chair men, sir. Most of the chairs are carried by
+Irishmen, who seem to be stronger in the leg than these London
+folk. You will have to cut your hair short, and then you will pass
+without observation."
+
+"Where are you taking us to?" Desmond asked, as they descended the
+hill.
+
+"I have got a lodging in a house out in the fields. I said that I
+was an Irishman who had come to London in search of employment,
+and that I expected three friends to join me, and that we intended
+to hire chairs and carry the gentry about, for here they seem too
+lazy to walk, and everyone is carried; though it is small blame to
+them, for dirtier streets I never saw. They are just full of
+holes, where you go in up to the knee in mud and filth of all
+kinds. Faith, there are parts of Paris which we can't say much
+for, but the worst of them are better than any here, except just
+the street they call Cheapside, which goes on past Saint Paul's,
+and along the Strand to Westminster."
+
+"What have you brought these sticks for, Mike?"
+
+For he had handed, to each, a heavy bludgeon.
+
+"Sure, your honour, 'tis not safe to be in the streets after
+nightfall. It is like that part of Paris where no dacent man could
+walk, without being assaulted by thieves and cutthroats. Dressed
+as we are, it is not likely anyone would interfere with us in the
+hope of finding money on us, but they are not particular at all,
+at all, and a party of these rascals might try to roll us in the
+mire, just for fun. So it is as well to be prepared."
+
+However, they met with no interruption, passed out through Holborn
+Bars, and soon arrived at the house where Mike had taken a
+lodging. They were not sorry, however, that they were armed, for,
+several times, they heard outbursts of drunken shouting and the
+sound of frays.
+
+Mike had hired two rooms. In one of these were three straw beds,
+for the officers. He himself slept on a blanket on the floor of
+the other room, which served as kitchen and sitting room.
+
+Now, for the first time, they were able to talk freely.
+
+"Mike, we have not said much to you, yet," Desmond began, "but I
+and these gentlemen are fully conscious that you have saved us
+from death, for we hear that Government is determined to push
+matters to the extremity, and to have all the officers captured
+condemned to be hanged."
+
+"Bad cess to them!" Mike exclaimed, indignantly. "If I had two or
+three of them, it's mighty little they would talk of execution,
+after I and me stick had had a few minutes' converse with them.
+
+"As to the getting you out, I assure you, your honour, there is
+little I have done, except to carry out your orders. When I first
+saw the prison, and the little white flag flying from the window,
+I said to myself that, barring wings, there was no way of getting
+to you; and it was only when I got your first letter that I saw it
+might be managed. Faith, that letter bothered me, entirely. I took
+it to the woman downstairs, and asked her to read it for me,
+saying that I had picked it up in the street, and wondered what it
+was about. She was no great scholar, but she made out that it was
+writ in a foreign language, and seemed to her to be a bit of an
+old bill. When I took it up to my room, I looked at it every way.
+I knew, of course, that it was a message, somehow, but devil a bit
+could I see where it came in.
+
+"I fingered it for an hour, looking at it in every way, and then I
+saw that there were some small holes pricked. Well, I could not
+ask the woman what they meant, as I had told her I picked it up;
+so I went across to an Irishman, whose acquaintance I had made the
+day before, and who had recommended me, if I wanted work, to hire
+one of these chairs and get a comrade to help me carry it. I could
+see that he was a man who had seen better days. I expect he had
+come over in the time of the troubles, and had been forced to earn
+his living as he could; so I went to him.
+
+"'I have got a message,' I said, 'pricked on a piece of paper. I
+picked it up, and am curious-like to know what it is about.'
+
+"So he held it up to the light, and read out your message.
+
+"'I think,' says he, 'it is some colleen who has made an
+appointment with her lover. Maybe she has been shut up by her
+father, and thought it the best way to send him a message.'
+
+"'That is it, no doubt,' says I; 'and it is plain that it never
+came to his hand.'
+
+"The next day, I went to him again with the second letter.
+
+"'It's lying you have been to me,' he said. 'It is some plot you
+are concerned in.'
+
+"'Well,' says I, 'you are not far wrong. I have some friends who
+have suffered for the Stuarts, and who have been laid by the leg,
+and it's myself who is trying to get them out of the hands of
+their persecutors.'
+
+"'In that case, I am with you,' he said, 'for I have suffered for
+the cause myself; and if you want assistance, you can depend upon
+me.'
+
+"'Thank you kindly,' says I. 'Just at present it is a one man job,
+but maybe, if I get them out, you will be able to give us some
+advice as to how we had best manage.'
+
+"So that is how it stands, your honour."
+
+"And now, tell us how you got away, Mike. You may guess how
+surprised we were, when we first made you out, believing that you
+were safe under lock and key at Harwich."
+
+"The matter was easy enough," Mike said. "It took me two or three
+days to get to understand the position of the place, with water
+all round it except on one side; and it was plain that, if I were
+to start running, it is little chance I should have if I did not
+hit upon the right road. Luckily, they were mounting some cannon
+the day after you were taken away. We were ordered to go out and
+lend a hand, so it was not long before I learnt enough to know
+which road I ought to take. I was always a good runner, your
+honour, and many a prize have I carried off, at fairs in the old
+country, before troubles began. So it seemed to me that, if I
+could have anything of a start, I ought to be able to get off.
+
+"There was nearly half a mile betwixt the town and the place where
+the narrow ground, at whose end it stood, widened out into the
+country. If I could only hold my own, as far as that, I could take
+to the woods and lanes and save myself.
+
+"A guard of soldiers, with muskets and bayonets, went out with us,
+and at the end of the second day I managed to slip off, and hide
+behind a pile of cannonballs. The rest assembled at a spot about
+fifty yards away, to be counted before they marched to prison
+again. As soon as the others had got there, and the guards had
+gathered round, I went off as hard as I could tear. And a good
+start I should have got, if it hadn't been that a sentry on a fort
+close by fired his piece at me. Still, I had a good hundred yards'
+start.
+
+"The guards set to, to run after me, and when they got in sight of
+me fired their guns; but they were flurried, and the bullets flew
+past without one of them touching me. Then I felt pretty safe. If
+they stopped to load their muskets, I should get clean away. If,
+as I expected, they would not stop for that, they would not have a
+chance with me, carrying their muskets and cartridge boxes and
+belts. I had taken off my coatee and boots, while I was waiting
+for the start, and went up the hill like a deer.
+
+"I did not look round, till I got to the top. Then I found that I
+had gained a hundred yards of them. I doubled down a lane, at
+once, and then struck through some orchards; and ran, without
+stopping, maybe a couple of miles.
+
+"I never heard any more of the soldiers, and knew that, for the
+present, I was safe, though maybe they would send some dragoons to
+scour the country when the news came in. I went on at a jog trot
+till it was quite dark; then I sat down to think what I should do
+next.
+
+"I had got my four louis with me, for they hadn't found them when
+they searched me. The first thing was to get some duds, and I
+walked along till I saw a light in a cottage, which I entered.
+There were two women there. I told them at once that I wanted
+clothes, and was ready to pay for them; but that, if they would
+not give them to me for money, I should take them without paying.
+Though I could see that they doubted the payment, and regarded me
+as a robber, they brought out the clothes, which belonged, one of
+the women said, to her husband. I took what I wanted.
+
+"'Now,' I said, 'how much shall I pay you for these?'
+
+"They were still terribly frightened, and said that I was welcome.
+However, I put one of my louis down on the table. This was
+certainly more than the clothes ever cost, so I said:
+
+"'Here is a gold piece, but I want a shilling in change, to buy
+food with.'
+
+"At first, they evidently hardly thought that I was in earnest.
+Then at last, when they found that I really intended to give the
+money, they brightened up, and not only gave me a shilling in
+change, but offered me some bread and cheese, which I was glad
+enough to take.
+
+"Then I put the clothes on over my own, not wishing to lave
+anything behind that would show searchers that it was I who had
+been there. I told the woman that the coin was a French one, but
+that it was worth about the same as an English guinea. I advised
+them to put it away, for the present, and not to try and change it
+for a few weeks, as enquiries might be made as to how they had
+obtained it.
+
+"I had no difficulty on my way up to London. I avoided the main
+road till I got to Colchester, and after that walked boldly on,
+having money to pay for victuals. When I got to town, I changed
+another of my louis at a money changer's. He asked me where I had
+got it, and when I said that it was no business of his, but that
+it had been paid me by a French Huguenot gentleman, who had lately
+arrived, and for whom I had been doing some work; and as there are
+many of these Huguenots in London, he was satisfied, and changed
+it for me.
+
+"I then fell across the Irish porter I told you of. He told me
+whereabouts I could get lodgings, and advised me to apply to one
+of the men who let out a number of sedan chairs, to hire one out
+to me by the week.
+
+"Well, your honour, once I had taken the lodging, I thought no
+more of the chair, but went about the business for which I had
+come to London. I had not been an hour in the town before I made
+the acquaintance of half a dozen, at least, of my countrymen, and
+found out which was the prison in which you were kept. At first, I
+thought of going there and giving myself up, on condition that I
+might be employed as your servant. Then I thought, perhaps they
+would not keep their word to me, but would send me back to
+Harwich; and then the thought struck me that I might, some way or
+other, get your honours out of prison.
+
+"When I first saw the place, it seemed to me that it was
+impossible. The place was mighty strong, the windows all barred,
+and I had no means of finding out where you were lodged. I spent a
+whole day in prowling round and round the jail, but sorra an idea
+came into my thick head, though I bate it wid my fists till it was
+sore; for, says I to myself, there is no lock so strong but it can
+be picked, if you do but know the right way. It was the second
+day, when I espied a little bit of white stuff at one of the
+windows. It might be a signal, or it might not, and even if it
+was, there was no reason why it should be yours, except that, I
+said to myself:
+
+"'Mr. Kennedy is not the boy to sit quiet in prison, if he can see
+any possible way of slipping out of it. His head is crammed full
+of ideas. So I will walk near and investigate the matter.'
+
+"As I came close, I could make out that there was someone behind
+the bars, but I could not see who it was. Of course, I did not
+come straight to the spot, but went about promiscuously.
+
+"For anything I could tell, there might be someone in the towers
+watching me. Then I saw a hand drop a little white parcel, and I
+found it without much trouble and went off with it. It was as much
+as I could do, to keep myself from running like a madman, for I
+felt somehow sure that it was you who had dropped it, but of
+course, it was not until I got it read for me that I was certain.
+
+"After that, your honour, it was all easy enough. You told me what
+to do, and I did it. There was a little difficulty about the saw,
+but I got it through one of the chair men, who told me, when I
+asked him, that he had the acquaintance of some cracksmen--more
+shame to him--and that he could get such a thing as I wanted
+through them. I was not surprised, for I had already heard that
+many of the chair men worked in connection with the bad
+characters, letting them know which way they were coming with
+people from an entertainment, and carrying them down lanes where
+there was little chance of the watch interfering.
+
+"It went against the grain to have dealings with such a man, for I
+was born of honest people, but if the ould gentleman himself had
+offered me a couple of saws, and I knew that I would have to give
+him a thousand years extra of purgatory, I would have closed with
+the bargain. Those two saws cost me another louis, and cheap
+enough, too.
+
+"After that, it was all plain sailing, and the money you lowered
+to me was much more than sufficient for all the other things. And
+now, what is your honour going to do next?"
+
+"That is more than I can tell you, Mike. We must talk it over."
+
+This was a matter that they had already discussed, in their cell,
+after they had once made their preparations for flight. Closely
+watched as they were, when with the other officers, it would have
+been impossible to communicate their plans to them; but, even if
+they could have done so, they could see no possible way in which
+the others could share in their escape. Doubtless the doors of
+their cells were also strong and heavy, and, could all these
+difficulties have been overcome, there would have been passages,
+corridors, and staircases to traverse, with the certainty of
+meeting with some of the night watchmen who patrolled them, and
+they would finally have had to force the door into their cell.
+
+They were, therefore, reluctantly obliged to abandon the hope of
+liberating their friends, and decided that, once away, they must
+endeavour to cross to France without delay. The king would
+doubtless have been, before now, informed by his agents in London
+of the determination of the English Government to bring all the
+prisoners to execution, but nevertheless, it would be their duty
+to obtain an audience, and implore him to take steps to save them.
+They would therefore, on their arrival in Paris, at once see
+General Hamilton, and other officers of rank, and beg them to
+accompany them to Versailles to act as spokesmen, and to influence
+the king in their favour.
+
+
+
+Chapter 10: Kidnapping A Minister.
+
+
+In spite of the war between the two countries, communications were
+frequent. Smuggling boats brought over, with their cargoes of wine
+and brandy, Huguenot fugitives; and, by the same means, secret
+agents carried back news of events in Paris to the Government.
+Having decided upon making for the coast without delay, Desmond
+and his friends next discussed the port to which they had best
+travel, and which seemed to offer the fairest opportunities. They
+agreed that Weymouth seemed to be most advantageous, as it was
+from there that the communications with Brittany were chiefly
+maintained.
+
+At the same time, it was evident that considerable difficulty
+would be experienced in discovering the men engaged in such
+traffic, and in making an arrangement with them, and it was
+all-important that no time should be lost, for there was no saying
+when the trial might come on.
+
+"If we could but get hold of Godolphin," Desmond said, next
+morning, "we might get an order, from him, to embark in one of the
+boats that carry his agents."
+
+The others laughed.
+
+"Yes; and if you could get hold of Anne, you might persuade her to
+sign an order for the release of our comrades."
+
+Desmond did not answer, but sat thinking for a few minutes.
+
+"It is not so impossible as you seem to imagine," he said, at
+last. "Doubtless, like everyone else, he goes in a sedan chair to
+the meeting of the council, and returns in the same manner. There
+are two ways in which we could manage the matter. Of course, he
+has his own chair, with his chair men in livery. We might either
+make these men drunk and assume their dress, or attack them
+suddenly on the way; then we should, of course, gag and bind them,
+and carry him here, or to some other place that we might decide
+upon, and force him to give us an order for the boatmen to take us
+across the channel, at once. Of course, we should have horses in
+readiness, and ride for the coast. We should have a twelve hours'
+start, for it would be that time before our landlady came in as
+usual, with our breakfast, when Godolphin would, of course, be
+released."
+
+The two officers looked at each other, astounded at the audacity
+of the scheme that Desmond had quietly propounded. O'Sullivan was
+the first to speak.
+
+"Are you really in earnest, Kennedy?"
+
+"Quite in earnest. I do not see why it should not be done."
+
+"Well, you are certainly the coolest hand I ever came across,"
+O'Neil said. "You are proposing to seize the first minister in
+England, as if it were merely an affair of carrying off a pretty
+girl quite willing to be captured. The idea seems monstrous, and
+yet, as you put it, I do not see why it might not succeed."
+
+"I hardly think that it could fail," Desmond said quietly. "De
+Tulle managed to carry off the Baron de Pointdexter's daughter
+from the court of Versailles, and did so without any hitch or
+difficulty. Surely three Irishmen could arrange an affair of this
+sort as well as a French vicomte."
+
+"If it is to be done," O'Sullivan said, "I think the second plan
+is best. You might fail in making the chair men drunk, or at any
+rate sufficiently drunk to allow them to be despoiled of their
+clothes; whereas you could have no difficulty in silencing a
+couple of chair men by a sudden attack--a sharp rap on the head
+with these bludgeons ought to settle that affair."
+
+"Quite so," Desmond agreed; "and while Mike and one of us were so
+employed, the other two might throw open the doors of the chair,
+and gag Godolphin before he was conscious of what was happening."
+
+"It all seems simple enough, Kennedy, and, if it were a citizen,
+one would think nothing of the undertaking. But it is nothing
+short of high treason for us thus to make free with the person of
+the chief minister of England."
+
+"That is a matter that does not concern me at all, O'Neil. If we
+were captured now, we should be executed for high treason with the
+others; and if we carried off Anne herself, they could not do much
+more to us.
+
+"Now, it seems to me that if you are both agreed that we should
+carry out the plan, the first thing to be done is to arrange for
+horses; or, better still, for a light cart to carry the four of
+us. I should think that Mike would, among his acquaintances, be
+able to hear of a man with a couple of fast horses and such a cart
+as we require, who would agree to drive us to the coast, arranging
+a change of horses on the way. He could offer ten louis, which
+would be a sum that a man of that kind would be well satisfied
+with."
+
+"I will see to that, your honour. I have no doubt that I can find
+such a man without difficulty. When would you want him?"
+
+"Tonight, certainly, with the arrangement that, if we do not come
+to the appointed spot, we shall be there tomorrow night. Recollect
+ten louis is all we can afford, but if he wants any more, he must
+have it.
+
+"Well, we will leave that to you."
+
+Then he went on to the others:
+
+"We had better go down to Saint James's. Mike can go out and buy
+us three shock wigs, with which we can cover our hair and look our
+parts better. We had better separate when we get there, and watch
+the entrances to the palace, gazing about like rustics; then we
+can get into a conversation with any servant that we see, and try
+and find out from which door members of the council usually issue,
+and at about what hour. We could succeed without that, because we
+should notice the chairs waiting for them. Still, it is as well
+that we should get all the information we can. There will be,
+doubtless, personages leaving who have been with the Princess
+Anne. They might go out by another entrance, and therefore we
+should miss our man."
+
+"You will have more than the two chair men to deal with, your
+honour, for there are sure to be two link men with the chair."
+
+"Well, it will be as easy to dispose of four men as of two, Mike."
+
+"Every bit, your honour, and the more of them the more divarsion."
+
+An hour later they set out, now so well disguised that no one
+would have dreamt that the three Irishmen were officers in a
+French regiment; and before noon Desmond succeeded in obtaining,
+from a scullion employed in the palace, the particulars that he
+required. On saying that he had but just come to London, and
+wanted to get a sight of the great people, the present of a
+shilling sufficed to extract the information from the boy; and
+Desmond then rejoined his companions, and they at once returned to
+their lodgings, where they found Mike awaiting them.
+
+"I have managed it, your honour, but it will cost twelve louis. I
+went to the man from whom I got the saws, and he said at once that
+the affair could be managed easily, and, sure enough, he took me
+to the shop of a man who, he said, sometimes acted with cracksmen.
+The fellow was sharp enough to see, at once, that it was something
+special that we wanted the horses for, but after some bargaining
+he agreed to do it for twelve gold pieces, and, if necessary, to
+get a change of horses twice on the road. He will be ready with
+his cart at twelve o'clock, a hundred yards or so outside the last
+houses on the south side of the Old Kent Road. I could not tell
+him which port you would go to, but he said from there he could go
+to Dover, or turn off so as to make for Southampton or Weymouth.
+It is to be twelve pounds if it is to Dover or Southampton;
+fifteen pounds if it is to Weymouth."
+
+"That is satisfactory," Desmond said. "Now we have nothing else to
+do till ten o'clock tonight, when, as the boy said, the council
+generally ends; though we will be there an hour earlier, in case
+they should leave before. Now I think we had better find out where
+Godolphin's house is, and fix upon the best spot for the attack,
+and how we shall each station ourselves."
+
+This part of the business offered no difficulties. They found that
+the minister would probably be carried through Saint James's Park,
+and they fixed upon the spot where they would await his coming.
+
+Mike was to attack the first porter. O'Sullivan was to follow
+close behind him and, at the same moment, fell the rearmost man.
+O'Neil and Desmond, who were to conceal themselves among trees on
+opposite sides of the path, were to spring out and strike down the
+link bearers, and then enter the chair and bind and gag the
+minister.
+
+Mike was sent out to buy a pot of black paint, with which to
+efface the gildings of the chair, and to reduce its appearance to
+that ordinarily used by the citizens. He was ordered to get a
+supply of rope, and some wood, to make gags for the men they were
+to stun.
+
+The others were to post themselves at the spot agreed on, while
+Desmond was to remain at the entrance to the palace by which
+ministers would issue, to note Lord Godolphin's chair, and, when
+he was fairly on his way, to follow it for a short distance to
+make sure that it was being taken through the park, and then to
+run on and warn the others to be in readiness.
+
+On their return to their lodging, they ate the dinner that Mike
+had got in for them, and, as they drank their wine, laughed and
+joked over their enterprise; for, now that they were fairly
+embarked upon the scheme, the two officers were as eager as
+Desmond in the matter, and were much more excited over the
+prospect than he was.
+
+Before nine o'clock, they and Mike were posted in the park, and
+Desmond was at the entrance to the palace. Here seven or eight
+chairs, with their bearers and link men, were assembled. As most
+of the porters were hired men, Desmond readily entered into
+conversation with them, and expressed his desire to see the great
+persons and learn which were their chairs, so that he should know
+them as they entered them.
+
+In half an hour there was a stir, and a servant, coming out,
+shouted:
+
+"His Grace the Duke of Somerset's chair."
+
+This was at once brought up to the door. Next came a call for the
+chair of Mr. Henry Boyle, who was followed by Harcourt, the
+attorney general, then the chair of My Lord Godolphin was
+summoned.
+
+Desmond and three or four others, who had gathered to see the
+members of the council come out, had been ordered off by the
+sentries as soon as the first chair was called, but remained near
+enough to hear the names. To his satisfaction, Godolphin's chair
+was carried off in the direction they had anticipated, and he at
+once ran on and joined his companions.
+
+Presently, the lights carried by the two link men were seen
+approaching, and, as the chair came abreast of him, he shouted:
+
+"Now!"
+
+Almost simultaneously, the four heavy cudgels alighted on the
+heads of the four men, levelling them senseless to the ground; and
+O'Neil and Desmond sprang to the chair, and wrenched the door
+open, while O'Sullivan and Mike bound the four men, and thrust the
+gags into their mouths. Lord Godolphin had been thrown from his
+seat by the sudden fall of his bearers, and was seized and bound
+before he was conscious of what had happened. Then his captors
+assisted the others in carrying the fallen men to some distance
+from the path.
+
+A couple of minutes sufficed to cover the gilding and armorial
+bearings upon the chair. The torches were still burning on the
+ground. One of these was stamped out. Desmond took the other. Mike
+and O'Sullivan went between the poles, and adjusted the leathern
+straps over their shoulders, and started.
+
+Emerging from the park at Charing Cross, past the old church of
+Saint. Martin's in the Fields, and keeping round the walls to
+Holborn Bars, they made their way to their lodging, and Godolphin
+was carried into their room, which was on the ground floor. Mike
+and O'Neil then took the chair away, and left it in a narrow
+alley, where it was not likely to attract attention until the
+morning.
+
+Not until they returned was anything said to their prisoner. It
+had been agreed that O'Neil, as the senior, was to be spokesman of
+the party.
+
+"Lord Godolphin," he said, "I regret that circumstances have
+obliged us to use force towards you, but our necessities compel us
+to leave the country at once, and it has appeared to us that in no
+way could we get away so expeditiously as with the aid of your
+lordship. We will now set you free. I must tell you, beforehand,
+that if you attempt to raise your voice and give the alarm, we
+shall be constrained to blow out your brains."
+
+Mike now released him from the bonds, and removed the gag from his
+mouth, but for a time the minister was incapable of speech, being
+choked by anger at the treatment he had met with.
+
+"You will repent this outrage," he burst out, at last.
+
+"I think not, sir," O'Neil said, quietly. "At any rate, we are
+quite ready to take our chance of that. In order that you may feel
+at ease with us, I have no hesitation in telling you who we are.
+We are the three French officers who, as no doubt you have heard,
+yesterday escaped from Newgate, and we are anxious to get out of
+the country as soon as possible. It will be also a guarantee to
+you that we have no designs on either your pockets or your
+person."
+
+Angry as he still was, it was evident, by the expression of the
+treasurer's face, that the information was a relief to him, for
+indeed he had supposed that he had been carried off by political
+enemies, and was very uncertain as to what would befall him.
+
+"What is it that you require, then?" he asked, after a pause.
+
+"Merely this, sir. That you will give us an order, upon an agent
+through whom you communicate with France, to take us across the
+channel immediately."
+
+"Well, gentlemen," Godolphin said, more calmly, "I must say your
+coolness surprises me. Your escape yesterday was, of course,
+reported to us; and the manner in which you obtained that rope, by
+which you descended, is a mystery that the jail authorities are
+wholly unable to solve.
+
+"If you obtain the order you desire, will you give me your word of
+honour that it shall be used in a manner in no way hostile to the
+interests of this country, but solely, as you say, for the purpose
+of conveying you across the channel?"
+
+"That promise we give willingly. We must ask you to pledge your
+honour, as a gentleman, that the order you give us will be a
+genuine one--a matter that we cannot ascertain until we arrive at
+the address given. We are willing to play fairly with you, sir,
+but if you do not do the same, we shall certainly return to
+London, though in some different guise, and, if so, I warn you
+that no guards will save you from our vengeance."
+
+"You need not threaten, sir," Lord Godolphin said calmly. "I will
+give you the order, to the person to whom such communications are
+addressed, and it shall be couched in the same words as usual."
+
+Desmond placed a sheet of paper, pen, and ink before him. He,
+dating it from the Treasury, wrote:
+
+To John Dawkins, Mariner, High Street, Rye. Urgent.
+
+On the receipt of this, you will at once convey the bearer, and
+three persons with him, and land them in some convenient spot in
+France.
+
+He then added his signature.
+
+"Now, gentlemen, what next?" he said, looking up.
+
+O'Neil looked at his companions, and then they spoke for a moment
+together.
+
+"We are about to start at once, my lord," he said, "and it was our
+intention to have left you bound and gagged, until the morning,
+when the woman of the house would have assuredly found you and
+released you. But, as you have acceded to our request at once, we
+will, if you give us your word of honour that you will raise no
+alarm, and say no word of this business until eight o'clock
+tomorrow morning, let you depart at once."
+
+"Thank you for your courtesy, gentlemen, and for your confidence
+in my honour. I am, indeed, anxious to return home at once. If I
+do not do so, there will be a hue and cry for me, and by the time
+I return in the morning all London will know that I am missing. I
+naturally should not wish this adventure to become a matter of
+common talk: in the first place, because the position in which you
+have placed me can scarcely be called a pleasant one; and
+secondly, because the success of your enterprise might lead others
+to make similar attempts on my person, or that of my colleagues.
+Even now, I fear that my servants, when sufficiently recovered,
+will go to my house and give the alarm."
+
+"I do not think that that is likely to be the case, my lord,"
+O'Neil said, "as we took the precaution of gagging and binding
+them, and laid them down some distance from the roadside. If, on
+your return home, you find they have not arrived, you have but to
+send a couple of your servants out to release them. You can give
+them strict orders that no word is to be said of the affair, and
+make them to understand you were attacked in error, and that the
+ruffians who took part in the outrage at once released you, upon
+discovering your identity."
+
+"Very good, sir," Godolphin said, with a grim smile. "I must
+really compliment you all on your fertility of resource and
+invention. And now, is there anything else that I can do for you?"
+
+"There is one small favour," Desmond said. "Your lordship has
+doubtless twenty guineas in your possession. You would greatly
+oblige us if you would give us them, for so many louis. These you
+will have no difficulty in exchanging, whereas the exhibition of
+French money, on our part, might excite suspicion."
+
+Lord Godolphin placed his hand in his pocket, drew out a heavy
+purse, and, opening it, counted out twenty guineas. O'Neil took
+these up, and handed to him twenty louis pieces.
+
+"One more question, gentlemen. What has become of my sedan chair?"
+
+"It is in an alley, hard by," O'Neil said, "and as we are
+ourselves going in your direction we will carry it to your door."
+
+"You are obliging, indeed, sir. If it had been found, the
+escutcheon on the panels would have shown that it was mine."
+
+"I fear, my lord, that you will have to have it repainted; for,
+before starting with you, we took the precaution to put black
+paint over the gilding and panels. Still, the lining and fittings
+would show that it belonged to some person of wealth and
+importance. As you have been so obliging to us, we will gladly
+escort you, with it, to your door."
+
+"I shall be glad, indeed, of that, gentlemen, for I certainly
+should not care about travelling alone through these lanes and
+alleys, which have by no means a good reputation."
+
+"We are ready to start at once, my lord," O'Neil said. "We have a
+long journey to perform, and, although there is now no need for
+extraordinary speed, we shall be glad to be off."
+
+They were ready at once, having settled with their landlady before
+starting out in the evening, telling her that they had heard of a
+job and should start early in the morning. Mike and Desmond
+fetched the empty chair, and they then started, Godolphin walking
+with the other officers in front.
+
+"This is the most surprising adventure that ever happened to me,"
+Lord Godolphin said; "and it is a pity that officers who possess
+the wit to plan an escape from Newgate, and to ensure a speedy
+flight from the country by carrying me off, are not in the service
+of Her Majesty."
+
+"We may yet be in the British service some day, my lord,"
+O'Sullivan laughed; "but I may tell you that my friend, and
+myself, disclaim any credit in contriving the matter of which you
+spoke, that being solely the work of our young comrade, who is at
+present the youngest ensign in our regiment."
+
+"Then he must be a shrewd fellow, indeed," Godolphin said, "likely
+to do service in any position to which he may attain."
+
+They walked sharply. Several times rough men came and peered at
+them, but Godolphin was wrapped in a cloak, and the appearance of
+those with him showed that hard knocks, rather than booty, would
+be the result of interfering with them. On reaching Lord
+Godolphin's house they placed the sedan chair on the steps.
+
+"Goodnight to you, gentlemen, and good fortune!" Lord Godolphin
+said. "The lesson has not been lost, and I shall take good care,
+in future, to have a strong escort."
+
+They then crossed Westminster Bridge, and made rapidly for the
+spot where the cart was waiting for them.
+
+"You are an hour after your time," the man said. "I had begun to
+think that something had gone wrong with you."
+
+"That is not the case," O'Neil said; "but we have certainly been
+detained longer than we anticipated."
+
+"Where are we going to?"
+
+"To Rye."
+
+"That will suit me very well," the man said. "I have friends along
+that road, and shall have no trouble about horses."
+
+They started at once, at a rattling pace, the animals, though but
+sorry-looking creatures, being speedy and accustomed to long
+journeys. It was evident, from the man's manner, that he believed
+his passengers were cracksmen who had just successfully carried
+out an enterprise of importance. He expressed surprise that they
+had brought no luggage with them.
+
+They did not care to undeceive him. Mike had brought with him a
+bottle of good brandy, and a drink of this soon removed the
+vexation the man had felt at being kept waiting for them.
+
+Twice during the journey they changed horses, each time at small
+wayside inns, where some password, given by the driver, at once
+roused the landlord into activity. But a few minutes were spent in
+the changes, and the fifty miles to Rye were accomplished in seven
+hours--a very unusual rate of speed along the badly kept roads of
+the period. When the car drew up in the High Street of Rye, the
+four occupants were scarce able to stand, so bruised and shaken
+were they by their rapid passage over the rough road.
+
+They handed the twelve pounds agreed upon to the driver, adding
+another as a token of their satisfaction at the speed at which he
+had driven them, and then enquired for the house of William
+Dawkins. It was close by, and upon knocking at the door, it was
+opened by the man himself.
+
+"I have a message to deliver to you, in private," O'Neil said.
+
+The man nodded, and led the way indoors, where the letter was
+handed to him.
+
+"That is all right," he said. "My craft is always ready to set
+sail, at an hour's notice, and if the wind holds fair I will land
+you on the French coast before nightfall. I see that your business
+is urgent, or you would not have put on disguises before leaving
+London. I suppose you have brought other clothes to land in?"
+
+"We have not," O'Neil said. "We came away in such a hurry that we
+did not think of it until on the road, and then we thought that we
+might procure them here."
+
+"There will be no difficulty about that," the sailor said. "I will
+go out, and warn my men that we shall sail in half an hour, and
+then I can get any garments that you desire; for, doubtless, you
+do not wish to attract comment by the purchase of clothes that
+would seem unfitted to your present position."
+
+"That is so," O'Sullivan said, "and we shall gladly embrace your
+offer. We should like three suits, such as are worn by persons of
+fair position in France, and one proper for a serving man."
+
+"I cannot get you quite French fashion, sir, but they do not
+differ much from our own; and with a cloak each, I have no doubt
+that you would pass without attracting attention--that is, of
+course, if you speak French well."
+
+"As well as English," O'Neil said. "Here are seven pounds in gold,
+which will, I should think, be sufficient. If not, we are provided
+with French gold, for use after landing there."
+
+"I have no doubt it will suffice, sir. If not, I will pay what is
+the excess, and you can settle with me afterwards."
+
+In three-quarters of an hour after their arrival at Rye, they were
+dressed in their new disguises and on board the little lugger,
+which at once started down the river, which was at that time much
+more free from shoals and difficulties than it is at present.
+
+"Your boat seems fast," Desmond remarked, as, having cleared the
+mouth of the river, she put out to sea.
+
+"She is fast, sir; the fastest thing that sails out of Rye. She
+needs be, for the gentlemen who come to me are always in a hurry."
+
+"I suppose you have no fear of English cruisers?"
+
+"Not at all. I have the order you brought with you, and have only
+to show it to any English ship of war that overhauls us, for them
+to let us go on at once. I am careful when I get near the French
+coast, for although their big craft never venture out far, there
+are numbers of chasse-maree patrolling the coast. However, even if
+caught by them, it would be but a temporary detention, for I am
+well known at Etaples, which is always my port, unless specially
+directed to land my passengers elsewhere."
+
+The wind was fresh and favourable, and at six o'clock in the
+afternoon they entered the little port. Some gendarmes came down
+to the wharf.
+
+"We need have no fear of them," William Dawkins said. "Their
+lieutenant is paid handsomely for keeping his eyes shut, and
+asking no questions."
+
+"So you are back again," the officer said. "Why, it is not a week
+since you were here!"
+
+"No, it is but six days since I sailed."
+
+"And you have four passengers?"
+
+"That's the number, sir. The Irish gentlemen are desirous of
+entering the service of France."
+
+The officer nodded.
+
+"Well, gentlemen, you will find plenty of your countrymen in
+Paris; and, as everyone knows, there are no better or braver
+soldiers in His Majesty's service."
+
+The friends had already enquired, from William Dawkins, whether
+there was any passage money to pay, saying that they had forgotten
+to ask before starting.
+
+"Not at all. I am well paid by Government. My boat is always
+retained at a price that suits me well, and I get so much extra
+for every voyage I make. No, sir, thank you; I will take nothing
+for myself, but if you like to give half a guinea to the crew, to
+drink success to you, I will not say no."
+
+The party made no stay at Etaples, but at once ordered a chaise
+and post horses. Then, changing at every post house, and suffering
+vastly less discomfort than they experienced in the journey to
+Rye--the roads being better kept in France than they were on the
+English side of the channel--they arrived in Paris at eleven
+o'clock next day.
+
+
+
+Chapter 11: On the Frontier.
+
+
+On entering the barrack yard, they found that the regiment had
+marched, ten days before, for the frontier, and that Lord Galmoy's
+regiment had taken their place. They went at once to his quarters
+and told him that, having effected their escape, they had
+travelled with all speed to inform the king of the determination
+of the English Government to bring the Irish officers to
+execution, and to implore him to intervene in their favour.
+
+"I will go with you to Versailles, at once," Lord Galmoy said;
+"but, as you have no uniforms, and the king is very strict on
+matters of etiquette, three of my officers will lend you their
+suits and swords. While they are being fetched, sit down and share
+my meal, for doubtless you have not waited to eat on the road."
+
+He then gave the necessary instructions, and half an hour later
+the three officers, now in uniform, started with him on horseback
+for Versailles. The king had just returned from hunting, and it
+was an hour before Lord Galmoy could obtain an audience with him.
+He had, on the road, told the others he felt sure that the king,
+who was well served by his agents in London, had already heard of
+the intention of the English Government, but as to whether he had
+sent off a remonstrance he was of course ignorant.
+
+"I shall press the matter strongly upon him, and point out the
+deep feeling that will be excited, throughout his Irish and Scotch
+troops, if nothing is done to save the prisoners.
+
+"Louis is a politic monarch," he said, "and, knowing our worth and
+that of his Scotch soldiers, I think that he will, on my
+representations, bestir himself. Wauchop has many times performed
+brilliant services, and deserves well of France. However, we shall
+see."
+
+When they were admitted to the audience, Lord Galmoy introduced
+the three soldiers of O'Brien's regiment as coming that morning to
+Paris, having effected their escape from Newgate. As he repeated
+their names, the king looked sharply at Desmond.
+
+"Ah, ah!" he said, "so our young ensign is in the thick of
+adventures again. These we will hear presently.
+
+"Well, my lord, why have they come here so hurriedly after their
+arrival?"
+
+"They came to inform Your Majesty that the English Government have
+determined to execute Colonel Francis Wauchop, and the twelve
+officers of their regiment who were on board the Salisbury,
+captured on the coast of Scotland."
+
+Desmond, who was watching the king's face closely, saw that this
+was no news to him, and that he was annoyed by its being now
+brought to his notice; for doubtless the fate of a colonel, and a
+dozen young officers, was a matter that affected him little; and
+that, had the matter not been forced upon him, he would not have
+troubled about it, but, when it was too late, would have professed
+entire ignorance of the intentions of the English Government.
+
+He only said, however, "It is incredible that there can be an
+intention to execute officers in our service, captured upon a
+warlike expedition."
+
+"It is but too true, sir. Against Colonel Wauchop they have no
+ground for severity. By the convention of Limerick, he and all
+other officers were formally permitted to enter Your Majesty's
+service; but the young lieutenants have, of course, joined long
+since that time, and therefore cannot benefit by the terms of the
+convention; and could, with a show of justice, be executed as
+English subjects, traitors serving against their country."
+
+"We are afraid that our remonstrance would have but little effect
+with the English Government."
+
+Lord Galmoy smiled slightly, for it was notorious that
+negotiations had gone on between King James and his councillors,
+and several of the members of the English Ministry, Marlborough
+himself being more than suspected of having a secret understanding
+with the little court at Saint Germain.
+
+He only said, however, "Your Majesty has in your hands the power
+of compelling the English Government to alter their determination
+in this matter."
+
+"How so, my lord?" the king asked, in much surprise.
+
+"You have, sire, many prisoners, Frenchmen of the reformed
+religion, who had entered the service of the Protestant
+princes--your enemies--and who were taken in Dutch and Flemish
+towns we have captured. These stand in the same relation towards
+Your Majesty as the Irish officers towards England. You have,
+then, but to inform the government there that, if they in any way
+harm the Irish officers and noncommissioned officers in their
+hands, you will at once execute a similar number of these French
+Protestant officers, whom you have hitherto treated as prisoners
+of war. Then, possibly, an exchange might be effected.
+
+"Your Majesty will, I think, pardon me for saying that, unless
+steps are taken to save these officers' lives, the matter is
+likely to have a very bad effect on the Irish and Scotch
+regiments, whose ardour will not be improved by the knowledge that
+in case of a reverse they will, if not killed in the field, be
+executed as traitors; for nearly half of the men who are now
+serving have joined since the formation of the Brigade, and are
+not protected by the terms of the Limerick treaty. They are
+devoted to Your Majesty's service, and are ready to lay down their
+lives freely for the cause of France; but it would not be fair
+that they should also run the risk of execution, if they are by
+misfortune made prisoners."
+
+"There is much in what you say, Lord Galmoy, and you certainly
+point out a way by which these officers can be saved. A messenger
+shall start, in an hour's time, with a letter to the English
+Government. It shall be delivered at their headquarters in
+Flanders by noon tomorrow, with a request that it shall be
+forwarded by special messenger to the British minister; and we
+will have a proclamation posted in Paris, and in the various camps
+of the army, saying that we have warned the English Government
+that, unless the officers and men captured off the coast of
+Scotland are treated as prisoners of war, we shall retaliate by
+treating all French officers taken in foreign service in the same
+way; and that we have furthermore offered to exchange an equal
+number of such officers and men, in our hands, for those held by
+the British Government."
+
+"I thank Your Majesty, most respectfully and heartily, in the name
+of all the foreign officers in your service. Even should,
+unfortunately, the English Government refuse to pardon or exchange
+their prisoners, it will be seen that Your Majesty has done all in
+your power to save them, and there will be a general feeling of
+reprobation, throughout Europe, at the conduct of the English
+Ministry."
+
+"We beg these officers to wait in the anteroom, while we dictate
+our despatch and proclamation to our secretary. We would fain
+question them as to how they effected their escape from their
+prison, and how they have made so speedy a journey here."
+
+Lord Galmoy bowed, and retired with the others.
+
+"We have done well," he said, "better indeed than I had hoped.
+Now, having succeeded in saving our countrymen's lives, which I
+doubt not would have been otherwise sacrificed, I shall return at
+once to Paris, for there is an inspection of my regiment this
+afternoon."
+
+"We have been fortunate, indeed," O'Neil said, when Lord Galmoy
+had left. "I have no doubt the king had heard that the English
+Government had resolved to execute the prisoners, but I question
+whether he would have stirred in the matter, had it not been for
+Galmoy's representation."
+
+"I am sure, by his manner, that he had received the news before,"
+Desmond said, "and, as you say, had not intended to interfere. It
+was the suggestion that he might threaten retaliation, and that
+the effect of his not moving in the matter would be very bad among
+his Irish troops, that decided him to interfere. He may have felt
+that any mere protest made by him would have had little effect,
+and it is not his nature to expose himself to a rebuff; but,
+directly he saw that he had an effective weapon in his hands, he
+took the matter up as warmly as we could wish."
+
+In point of fact, the king's threat had the desired effect, and
+two months later the imprisoned officers and men were exchanged
+for an equal number of Huguenots.
+
+In a quarter of an hour, the three officers were again summoned to
+the king's presence. With him was a tall dark officer, of
+distinguished mien, whom O'Neil and O'Sullivan both recognized as
+the Duke of Berwick, one of the most famous generals of the time.
+He had been in command of the French forces in Spain, from which
+he had been recalled suddenly, two days before, in order that the
+king, who had a great confidence in him, might consult him as to
+the general plan of operations, in that country and in the north,
+before despatching him to join the army in Flanders. This was
+commanded by the Duke of Burgundy and the Duke of Vendome jointly;
+and as both were headstrong and obstinate, and by no means agreed
+as to the operations to be undertaken, the king had determined to
+send Berwick there, in order that he might, by his military genius
+and influence, bring matters to a better state between the two
+dukes, and arrange with them some definite plan by which the tide
+of fortune, which had hitherto gone against the French, might be
+arrested.
+
+The king appeared now to be in a good humour.
+
+"And now, young sirs," he said, "I have an hour at leisure, and
+would fain hear a true account of your adventures, omitting
+nothing.
+
+"I have no doubt, Monsieur Kennedy, that your ready wit had no
+small share in the matter."
+
+"With your permission, Sire, I will tell the story," O'Neil said,
+"for Mr. Kennedy is not likely to place his own share of the work
+in its due prominence."
+
+The king nodded, and O'Neil gave a detailed account of the manner
+in which they had made their escape, and succeeded in getting
+themselves conveyed across the channel in a vessel in the
+Government service, explaining that both affairs were due entirely
+to Desmond's initiative and ingenuity. The king listened with
+great interest, and even laughed at the story of the capture of
+Lord Godolphin.
+
+"You have all three behaved extremely well," he said.
+
+"You, Monsieur Kennedy, have again shown that you possess unusual
+shrewdness, as well as daring.
+
+"What think you, Duke, of this young subaltern, who is, we may
+tell you, the hero of whom you have doubtless heard, who twice
+rescued Mademoiselle de Pointdexter from the hands of her
+abductor?"
+
+"I was told the story yesterday, Sire, and was filled with
+admiration at the boldness and resource of her rescuer, who was, I
+heard, an ensign in O'Brien's regiment; but certainly I did not
+expect to find him so young a man. He has, indeed, a fertility of
+invention that fills me with surprise. The other officers deserve
+praise, for having so willingly followed the leadership of their
+junior, and their generosity in assigning to him the whole merit
+of their undertaking is highly commendable. It is no easy thing,
+Sire, to find in young officers--especially, if I may say so,
+among the cadets of good family, who form for the most part the
+staff of your generals--men ready to exercise their own discretion
+when in difficulties, and to carry out with due diligence the
+orders committed to them."
+
+"O'Brien's regiment has marched to the northern frontier. The
+vacancies in the ranks of its officers have been filled up from
+those of other regiments. I should, with Your Majesty's
+permission, be glad to take these three officers on my own staff,
+as, leaving Spain privately in accordance with Your Majesty's
+orders, I have brought with me only Captain Fromart, my secretary,
+and one young aide-de-camp. I should be glad if you would promote
+Mr. Kennedy to the rank of lieutenant."
+
+"We quite approve of both requests," the king said graciously;
+"and indeed," he added with a smile, "shall not be altogether
+sorry to see Lieutenant Kennedy employed outside our kingdom, for,
+after making war on his own account with one of our nobles, and
+kidnapping the first minister of England, there is no saying what
+enterprise he might next undertake. And should he join any of
+those who trouble the country with their plots, we should feel
+compelled to double our guards, in order to hold ourself secure
+from his designs.
+
+"Well, gentlemen, since the Duke of Berwick has appointed you his
+aides-de-camp, the least we can do is to see that you are properly
+fitted out for the expedition. You have, of course, lost your
+uniforms, horses, and money in our service, and it is but just
+that we should see to your being refitted. If you will wait in the
+anteroom, you shall each receive an order on our treasury for a
+hundred louis d'ors."
+
+The three officers bowed deeply in acknowledgment to the king,
+and, bowing also to the Duke of Berwick, returned to the anteroom,
+where presently one of the royal attendants brought to them the
+three orders on the treasury, and also begged them, in the name of
+the Duke of Berwick, to wait until his audience with the king
+should be over.
+
+They were all highly delighted with the change in their position.
+The posts of staff officers were, as the duke had said, considered
+to belong almost of right to members of noble families, and it was
+seldom that officers of the line could aspire to them.
+
+"Did I not tell you, Kennedy, that your luck would bring good
+fortune to us all! And, by the powers, it has done so! Faith, if
+anyone had said a month ago that I should by now be on the Duke of
+Berwick's staff, I should have laughed in his face, if indeed I
+had not quarrelled with him for mocking at me. And now here we
+are, with money to buy horses and outfit, and with no more
+drilling recruits and attending parades."
+
+"But not an end to work, O'Sullivan," Desmond Kennedy said. "You
+won't find much idle time, when you are serving with the duke."
+
+"No. He has the name of being a strict commander, sparing neither
+himself nor his soldiers; and I have heard that his staff have a
+very hard time of it. However, I am not afraid of hard work, when
+it is done on horseback, and there are many more chances of
+promotion on the staff than there are in marching regiments. Well,
+I don't mind being taken prisoner a dozen times if this is what
+comes of it, providing always that you are taken with me, Kennedy,
+and are there to help me out of the scrape."
+
+"We should have to have Mike prisoner, too," Desmond laughed, "for
+without his help we should be in Newgate at present."
+
+"I don't believe it. I am sure that, even if he hadn't turned up,
+you would have managed somehow."
+
+In a short time, the duke came out.
+
+"I am likely to be detained here another week, before I start for
+Flanders. That will give you time to procure your outfit of horses
+and equipments and arms. You will require two horses each, and
+these should be good ones. I doubt whether, if you get proper
+outfits, the sum that His Majesty has given you will suffice to
+buy two horses. I have, however, in my stables here, plenty of
+good animals that have been taken from the enemy, and one will be
+given to each of you. Therefore, it will be only necessary for you
+to purchase one.
+
+"I am staying here, and should be obliged, when you have taken a
+lodging, if you would send me your address. I shall then let you
+know where and when you are to join me. Is there anything else
+that you would ask me?"
+
+"I would ask, sir, that I might take my servant with me," Desmond
+said.
+
+"Certainly; and you can do so without further question. One man,
+more or less, will make no difference to O'Brien's regiment, and
+it would be a pity that you should not have him with you, for it
+is evident that he is at once faithful, and possesses a large
+amount of shrewdness."
+
+After thanking the duke for the present of the horses, the three
+officers, having drawn their money, left the palace and rode back
+to Paris. They went first to the barracks, and returned the horses
+and uniforms, with many thanks, to the officers who had lent them;
+had an interview with Lord Galmoy, and informed him of their new
+appointments.
+
+"You have well won them," he said, "and I wish you every good
+fortune. Assuredly, you are more likely to rise under the Duke of
+Berwick than as subaltern in the Irish Brigade, though promotion
+is not slow there, owing to the vacancies that battle always makes
+in their ranks."
+
+They went out and took a lodging together, and then went to a
+military tailor, who promised them their undress and full dress
+suits in four days. Then they ordered military saddles, bridles,
+and equipments.
+
+On the next day, after visiting half the stables in Paris, they
+purchased three horses for themselves, and Desmond bought, in
+addition, a serviceable animal for Mike, with a cavalry saddle and
+accoutrements, and ordered a uniform for him. Each provided
+himself with a sword and a brace of pistols.
+
+Mike was greatly pleased when Desmond communicated his promotion
+and appointment to him.
+
+"You will look grand, your honour, as a general's aide-de-camp,
+with your handsome uniform and your horses and all that, and 'tis
+glad I am that we are going to Flanders, for, from all I have
+heard from men who have fought in Spain, little pleasure is to be
+had in campaigning there. The food is vile, the roads are bad. You
+are choked with dust and smothered with heat.
+
+"As to their making you lieutenant, if you had your dues, it would
+be a colonel they should have made you, or at any rate a major."
+
+"There is plenty of time, Mike," Desmond laughed. "A nice colonel
+I should look, too, leading a thousand men into battle. If I
+obtain a majority in another fifteen years, I shall consider
+myself lucky."
+
+Desmond did not share Mike's gratification that they were to
+campaign with the army of the north, instead of with that in
+Spain. However, as he would be fighting against English troops in
+either country, he concluded it would not make much difference,
+especially as, being an aide-de-camp, he would not himself have to
+enter into actual conflict with them.
+
+His friends were heartily glad that their destination was not
+Spain, for all had, like Mike, heard much of the hardships
+suffered by the troops in that country.
+
+"I know from what you have said, Kennedy, that if you had had your
+choice you would have taken Spain, but, putting aside the heat
+there, it is but poor work, by all accounts. You are well-nigh
+starved, you can't get at your enemy, who knows all the mountains
+and the paths over them, is as difficult to catch as one of their
+fleas, harasses you while you are on the march, and shirks
+fighting as the old one shirks holy water. There has only been one
+fight which could be called a battle since the war began; and as
+for the sieges, it means that you lose a lot of men, and have
+little credit when you take a place, especially as the moment you
+go out one way the enemy enter on the other side, and there is all
+the work to be done over again."
+
+"I admit that we shall see a great deal more of war in the north,"
+Kennedy said, "and Marlborough and Eugene on the other side, and
+the Dukes of Berwick and Vendome on ours, are such skilful
+commanders that there will be far greater interest in the
+operations, than in carrying on what is little more than a
+partisan war in Spain."
+
+"Not only that," O'Neil put in, "but there will be a possibility
+of getting decent food. While in Spain there are few great towns,
+and these a long distance from each other; in Flanders there are
+towns every few miles, and you are sure of decent quarters and
+good cooking."
+
+"Why, O'Neil, I did not know that you were particular as to your
+food," Desmond laughed.
+
+"I can starve as well as another, Kennedy, but when I get good
+food and good wine and good lodgings, I own that I prefer it
+vastly to the fare that our troops have to put up with, in Spain.
+I can see no reason why, because you are going to risk your life
+in battle, you should put up with all sorts of miseries and
+inconveniences beforehand, if they can be avoided.
+
+"As to fighting against the English, there are English both in
+Spain and Flanders, and in both armies they form but a small
+proportion of the force, though I grant willingly that they are
+the backbone of both armies. If you look at the thing sensibly,
+you will see that we have gained no slight advantage by Berwick's
+going to Flanders, instead of returning to Spain."
+
+Three days after their preparations were completed, an orderly
+brought a note from the Duke of Berwick. It was brief and to the
+point.
+
+The rendezvous is at six o'clock tomorrow morning, in front of La
+Louvre.
+
+(Signed) Berwick.
+
+All were glad that the summons had come. They had discussed the
+future from every point of view, and were already growing
+impatient, short as their stay had been in Paris.
+
+Five minutes before the hour, they were at the rendezvous. As the
+clock struck, the duke rode up with two officers and an escort of
+six troopers. He looked at their accoutrements and horses, and
+nodded his head approvingly.
+
+"You will do very well," he said. "I can tell you that the gloss
+of your uniforms will not last long, in Flanders."
+
+The other officers were Captain Fromart, who acted as the duke's
+secretary, and Lieutenant d'Eyncourt. Mike fell in with the
+escort, behind which also rode the body servant of the duke, and
+the two cavalry men who were the servants of his officers.
+
+Once beyond the limits of the town, the party broke into a trot.
+The duke rode on ahead, evidently in deep thought, and the five
+officers followed in a group.
+
+"I see, messieurs," d'Eyncourt said, "that only one of you has
+brought a servant with him."
+
+"We only arrived in Paris a week ago," O'Neil said. "Our own
+regiment had left, and we did not care to ask for two soldiers
+from another regiment, as these might have turned out badly. We
+thought it better, therefore, to delay until we joined the army,
+and wait till we could obtain a couple of good men from one of the
+cavalry regiments there. As it is, Monsieur Kennedy's servant can
+look after the three of us, and, I have no doubt, two of the
+soldiers of the escort will not object to earn a few livres by
+looking after our horses on the way."
+
+"I think you are right," the other said. "If one gets a good man,
+a soldier servant is invaluable. If, as is often the case, he is a
+bad one, well, one is far better without him. It is curious how
+men who have been smart soldiers, when in the ranks, are apt to go
+to the bad when they become servants. They have more time on their
+hands, are free from most of the parades, have no sentry duty to
+perform, and the consequence is that they become slovenly and
+careless, and in nine cases out of ten give way to drink at every
+opportunity. If Mr. Kennedy's servant is really a good one, you
+will be better off, with a third of his services, than you would
+be with the whole of that of an ordinary soldier servant.
+
+"You have just returned from England, have you not? The duke told
+Captain Fromart that you were among those who were captured in the
+Salisbury, but that you had made your escape. He gave no
+particulars, for indeed, the duke is not given to much speech. As
+a general he is splendid, but it would be more pleasant for his
+staff if he were to unbend a little."
+
+"Yes, we managed to give them the slip," O'Neil said, "thanks to
+Monsieur Kennedy and his servant. Did you return from Spain with
+the general, Captain Fromart?"
+
+"Yes. There was nothing doing at the moment, and he gave us the
+option of accompanying him or staying behind. We vastly preferred
+the trip, as we considered it, for of course we had no idea that
+the duke was about to be sent to Flanders. You hear a good deal of
+the climate of Spain. It is said to be lovely. I vow that it is
+detestable. The heat, when it is hot, is terrible, and when it is
+not hot, there is a bitter wind that chills you to the bone. A
+great portion of the country is but half populated, and you can go
+a day's march without coming to a village. The roads are
+villainous. There is nothing to buy, and it is as much as the
+transport can do to get, I will not say enough bread, but a bare
+sufficiency to maintain the troops. Moreover, the duke has been
+constantly thwarted in his plans by the Spaniards, who are ready
+enough to make promises, but never take a single step towards
+their fulfilment. The duke's temper is of the shortest, and he has
+quarrelled openly with most of the leading Spaniards, and has
+threatened, four or five times, to throw up his command and return
+to France. He did do so a year ago, but affairs went so badly,
+without him, that the cause of France was seriously imperilled by
+his absence, and it was at the urgent request of Philip that he
+returned; for at that time the English general, Peterborough, was
+striking dismay all over the country, and if the duke's advice had
+not been taken, all our officers acknowledge that we should
+speedily have crossed the Pyrenees."
+
+"And do the population incline towards Philip or the Austrian?"
+
+"As a rule, they incline towards the party which seems likely to
+win. They would shout in Madrid as loudly for the Archduke Charles
+as for Philip. Catalonia and Valencia are the exceptions. There
+the balance of feeling is certainly in favour of the Austrian, but
+this is principally because they are afraid of Peterborough, whom
+they regard as almost supernatural, and fear he would take
+vengeance upon those who deserted his cause. But there is no
+accounting for them; cities have held out as stoutly for one
+candidate as for the other, without any apparent reason, so far as
+we can observe.
+
+"We fight for Philip because he is Louis's grandson, and it is
+important in the interest of France to stand closely allied with
+his party. But as for the Spaniards with us, I can tell you that
+we have but little trust in them."
+
+"But some of them are good, are they not?"
+
+"We do not consider any of them of much account. But then the
+Spaniards on the other side are no better. They seem to have lost
+all their military virtues, ever since their best troops were
+demolished at Rocroi by Conde. That and the destruction of their
+fleet by the English, and the drain of their resources both in men
+and money, entailed by the long war in Holland, altogether
+deprived the people of their martial spirit. The war is to some
+extent between the English and us, because, of the allies England,
+Holland, and Austria, neither the Austrians nor the Dutch take any
+great share in the struggle. The Dutch are wholly engrossed with
+the defence of their fens, the Austrians are fully occupied in
+Italy and on the Rhine frontier, and it is only the English, who,
+fortunately, are not very numerous, who are against us, for the
+Portuguese can scarcely be counted in the business, being, if
+anything, slower and more stupid than the Spaniards themselves.
+
+"However, at present the prospect is good. Peterborough has gone.
+Galway's army has been almost destroyed; though, to do them
+justice, the English regiments fought magnificently, and if they
+had been seconded by the Portuguese the result might have been
+altogether different."
+
+"Then you found Spain much less rich than France?"
+
+"There is no comparison," Captain Fromart said. "It ought to be
+fully as rich, but the plains lie almost uncultivated. The people
+seem wholly without energy, and the ruling class are always
+intriguing, and seem to pay little attention to their estates. You
+see but few castles and chateaux, such as are dotted over France.
+I do not say that, at the present moment, France can be considered
+a prosperous country in material matters. The expenses of the wars
+have been enormous, to say nothing of the Court. The people are
+ground down by taxation, and the misery in some parts of the
+country is extreme; but left to themselves the people will work,
+and work hard. Our soil will grow anything, and after twenty years
+of peace, France would altogether recover herself."
+
+"And yet the alliance of Spain is considered as of vital
+importance to France!"
+
+"Of great importance, certainly. Spain has still soldiers who can
+fight well, as they have proved in Italy; and were the levies at
+home equally well drilled and disciplined, they would no doubt
+turn out good soldiers. But these are, at present, almost
+undrilled. They desert in numbers and return to their homes, after
+the slightest reverse, and prefer to act as partisans under
+leaders of their own choosing. But with Philip once firmly seated
+on the throne, with French advisers and officers to assist him,
+and a few regiments to serve as a nucleus to his army, Spain could
+turn out a force which would be a very valuable addition to the
+strength of any European power. With Spain as our ally we can, in
+addition to the force that she can put in the field, neglect
+altogether our southern frontier, and employ our whole army
+elsewhere. With her as an ally of Austria or of England, we should
+have to keep an army in the south to guard our borders."
+
+Two days after leaving Paris, the party arrived at Peronne, where
+a considerable body of troops were collected, of which, although
+an aide-de-camp, Desmond now learned for the first time the duke
+was to take the command. No movements of importance had taken
+place in the field, and as the force at Peronne still wanted
+several regiments, to bring it up to the intended strength, some
+weeks passed before it was set in motion.
+
+The four aides-de-camp, however, had a busy time of it. The main
+army was stationed in the neighbourhood of Lille, and frequent
+communications passed between Berwick and Vendome.
+
+The allies were inactive. Eugene had, early in April, met
+Marlborough at the Hague, and had concerted with him the plan for
+the campaign. He had then gone to Vienna to bring up reinforcements,
+and until these arrived Marlborough hardly felt in a position to take
+the offensive, as the French armies were considerably stronger than
+his own, and he had not yet been joined by the troops from Hanover.
+
+Except to receive orders, the aides-de-camp saw little of their
+commander. He was absorbed in the difficult problems of the war,
+and was occasionally absent for two or three days at the camp of
+Vendome. He always spoke kindly to them when on duty, but at other
+times dispensed altogether with their attendance, and as a rule
+took his meals alone.
+
+"You see him at his worst," d'Eyncourt said one day to his new
+comrades, "He is a different man when he is in the field. Then he
+is full of life and activity, looking into every detail himself,
+endeavouring to infuse some of his own energy into others, full of
+care for the comfort of his troops, though ready to endure any
+hardship himself. Then you see the real man; a noble character,
+idolized by the soldiers and loved by us all. You must not judge
+him, in the slightest degree, by what he now is. He has a great
+deal on his mind, and has, so it is whispered, no small trouble in
+keeping the peace between Vendome and Burgundy. The failure, too,
+of the expedition to Scotland must have greatly disappointed him,
+and I have no doubt he expected to be put at the head of any
+French army sent over to place James upon the throne. However, he
+may congratulate himself now that he was not with it, for no
+honour and no gain has been earned by any concerned in it."
+
+"That certainly is so," Desmond agreed. "It was a mismanaged
+affair altogether. To begin with, twenty thousand men should have
+been sent instead of six thousand; and in the next place, the
+fleet should have assembled at Brest or Bordeaux, for in that
+case, although the news of its assembling would assuredly have
+reached England, it would not have been known whether it was
+intended that the landing should be made in Ireland, Scotland, or
+on the English coast, while by gathering at Dunkirk no doubt was
+left as to the destination. This was proved by the fact that, when
+the English fleet watching the port was driven off by a gale, and
+an opportunity was thus given for a start, instead of coming back
+again, as we had hoped, only to find that we had left, it sailed
+straight for the north, making absolutely certain that we were
+bound for Edinburgh."
+
+"Well, we must hope," O'Sullivan said, "that next time the force
+will, as you say, be fully twenty thousand men, will include the
+Irish Brigade, will be led by Berwick, and will land in Ireland."
+
+At this moment an orderly entered.
+
+"The duke requires your attendance, Lieutenant Kennedy."
+
+Desmond at once went to the duke's apartments.
+
+"You will start at once for Lille, Mr. Kennedy, and will report
+yourself to Marshal Vendome. I have arranged with him that one of
+my aides-de-camp shall accompany the force that is about to
+advance, and shall keep me informed of what is being done. I have
+selected you because I know you to be active and shrewd. The
+marshal is too much occupied to send me such full reports as I
+should wish, and I look to you not only to give me facts, but to
+convey to me your impressions of what you see passing around you.
+Do not fear to speak plainly. Your communications will be strictly
+private, and your views will be thus of far more use to me than
+the official expressions of the marshal and his staff.
+
+"You will, of course, take your servant with you, and I have told
+off three troopers to accompany you, for the purpose of bringing
+your reports to me. There is no probability of a general
+engagement at present, and until we obtain some idea of
+Marlborough's plans, no extensive operations will be undertaken."
+
+From the manner in which he spoke, Desmond had no doubt that
+Berwick himself was in favour of taking the initiative without
+delay, but that he had been overruled. It was indeed of importance
+to the French that, before advancing, they should secure
+possession of the towns of west Flanders, so that the great roads
+would all be open to them.
+
+Half an hour after leaving the duke, Desmond was in the saddle,
+and, followed by the four soldiers, rode for Vendome's camp.
+According to instructions he halted for the night at Arras, and
+reached Lille at ten the next morning. He at once presented
+himself to the marshal, and handed to him the letter from Berwick,
+of which he was the bearer.
+
+The duke glanced through it.
+
+"I have been expecting you, Lieutenant Kennedy, and have arranged
+that you shall mess and ride with the junior officers of my staff.
+I will order a tent to be erected for you, at once. Should any
+portion of my force move without me, I have arranged that you
+shall accompany it. You will find many of your compatriots in
+camp, for we have five battalions of the Irish Brigade with us,
+among them that of O'Brien, to which the Duke of Berwick informed
+me you belonged before you were appointed to his staff, having
+distinguished yourself markedly on several occasions."
+
+The marechal-de-camp coming in, Vendome placed Desmond in his
+charge, requesting him to introduce him to the various officers of
+his staff, with whom he would have to mess, and to see that he was
+well cared for. He was well received by the young French officers,
+all of whom, with scarce an exception, belonged to good families,
+and Desmond was not long in discovering that they regarded their
+occupation rather as a pleasant and exciting diversion, than as a
+matter of duty, and that the greater portion of their time was
+devoted to pleasure. They rode, practised with the pistol and
+rapier, made excursions into the country, dined, and spent their
+evenings as if the army were nonexistent. A few only, and these
+were men who had served as officers, took their profession
+seriously, and divided among themselves what work had to be done,
+the young nobles gladly relinquishing it to them.
+
+
+
+Chapter 12: Oudenarde.
+
+
+Desmond did not remain long at the marshal's camp, but accompanied
+expeditions that were sent to Bruges, Ghent, and Ypres. The
+inhabitants of these towns had, for some time, been in communication
+with the marshal. They were hostile to the English, and had a standing
+feud, of many years' duration, with the Dutch.
+
+As soon, therefore, as the French columns approached, they opened
+their gates. The weak garrisons that had been placed there,
+finding themselves unable to at once control the population and
+defend the walls, evacuated the town before the French arrived.
+
+Beyond writing confidential reports to Berwick, Desmond had had
+little to do, and spent most of his time with his own regiment, by
+whom he was heartily welcomed, and with the other Irish battalions
+encamped near them. He and the other officers captured in the
+Salisbury had been given up as lost by their comrades; and the
+appearance of Desmond, in his staff uniform, was the first
+intimation they had received of his escape, of which he had more
+than once to give a detailed account.
+
+In doing this, he made no mention of the seizure of Lord
+Godolphin. He knew that the minister was anxious that this should
+not get abroad, and, as he had behaved fairly to them, Desmond
+considered that he ought to remain silent on the subject; and
+merely said that, on their arrival at Rye, they had made an
+arrangement with a man who was in the habit of conveying persons
+secretly, to or from France, to take them across the channel.
+
+"You amaze me more and more, Kennedy," the colonel said. "Six
+months ago, when you joined, you seemed to me little more than a
+boy, and yet you have been through adventures that demanded the
+brain and courage of a veteran. We missed you all much; but I hope
+we shall soon get the others back again, for I had news the other
+day, from Paris, that arrangements for their exchange were going
+on, and no doubt they will rejoin as soon as they land.
+
+"There is little chance of you, O'Neil and O'Sullivan coming back
+to the regiment; but, at any rate, as Berwick's force is sure to
+join ours, as soon as operations begin in earnest, we shall often
+see you."
+
+It was the end of June before the main army advanced. Desmond had
+returned to Peronne after the capture of the three Flemish towns,
+and was warmly praised by Berwick for the manner in which he had
+carried out the work entrusted to him. On the 6th of July, he
+received orders to accompany the duke.
+
+"There is bad news," Captain Fromart said, entering the room where
+the four aides-de-camp were together. "You know the marshal had
+commenced the siege of Oudenarde. We have news now that the enemy
+has suddenly advanced towards him, and he has been obliged to
+raise the siege, and fall back across the Scheldt. The troops are
+to go forward at once. The duke will ride on, with all speed, in
+accordance with Vendome's urgent request. All four of you are to
+go on with him. I shall accompany the force here.
+
+"There is no time to be lost. The duke's horse is to be at the
+door in a quarter of an hour, and it will not please him to be
+kept waiting. You had better leave your spare horses, for the
+present. I have already warned the escort."
+
+It was a short notice, but by the time named the four
+aides-de-camp were in their saddles, as were their soldier
+servants, for by this time Desmond's two friends had obtained
+servants from a dragoon regiment. They were but just in time, for
+they had scarcely mounted when the duke came out, sprang into his
+saddle, and went off at a canter.
+
+The distance was some fifty miles. They stopped once for two
+hours, to refresh themselves and their horses, and rode into
+Vendome's camp soon after nightfall. A large tent had been already
+erected for Berwick's use, close to that of the marshal; and
+another, close by, for the use of the officers who might come with
+him.
+
+A quarter of an hour later, a soldier entered the aides-de-camp's
+tent, with a large tray.
+
+"The Duke of Berwick bids me say, gentlemen, that he is supping
+with the marshal, who has sent these dishes to you from his own
+table."
+
+"Please to give our thanks to the Duke of Vendome, for his
+kindness," Desmond said; but when the soldier had left the tent,
+he went on, "I have no doubt that this is the result of a
+suggestion on the part of Berwick, and greatly obliged to him we
+must feel. We had just been saying that we supposed we should get
+nothing to eat till tomorrow morning, while here is a supper
+worthy of the marshal, and four flasks of wine, which I doubt not
+are good."
+
+It was ten o'clock before the duke returned to his tent, when he
+at once sent for his aides-de-camp.
+
+"There will be nothing more for you to do, tonight, gentlemen.
+Sleep soundly, for we shall have a hard day's work tomorrow. We
+are to cross the Scheldt again at daybreak. The enemy are on the
+other side of the Dender, and the next day a pitched battle will
+probably be fought. You may be surprised that we do not wait until
+my forces arrive, but we have heard that Eugene's reinforcements
+are within two days' march of Marlborough, and, as they are more
+numerous than those I command, it has been decided to accept
+battle at once. Good night."
+
+"The general is in a good temper," d'Eyncourt said, as they
+reentered their tent. "I expect that his views have been adopted,
+and that there was a warm discussion over them."
+
+This was indeed the case. The Duke of Burgundy, an obstinate man
+without any knowledge of war, had been in favour of pushing
+forward, crossing the Lys as well as the Scheldt, and attacking
+the allies as soon as they met them. Vendome, on the other hand,
+was of opinion that the army which was now collected near Ghent
+had better advance against Oudenarde, which might be carried by a
+coup de main before Marlborough could come to its assistance,
+which he might be some days in doing, seeing that he was in
+command of a mixed force, composed of Dutch, Danes, Hanoverians,
+Prussians, and British. Burgundy then maintained that they should
+retire, and fight near Ypres, where they would be close to the
+frontier, and could retire upon Lille in case matters went against
+them. Berwick, however, at last managed to persuade him to agree
+to Vendome's plan, as the capture of Oudenarde was a matter of the
+utmost importance, and it would be as easy to fall back thence to
+Lille as it would be from Ypres.
+
+This Burgundy had sullenly assented to, and the next morning the
+army marched to the position fixed upon. This was on steeply
+rising ground, with the river Norken running at its foot. Beyond
+this were two other eminences, on each of which stood a windmill.
+That on the west was called the windmill of Oycke, and that on the
+adjoining hill the windmill of Royegham, the latter flanking the
+main position. Oudenarde being found to be strongly garrisoned, it
+was decided, in spite of the opposition of Burgundy, to cross the
+Scheldt at Gavre, and then to give battle to the allies between
+that river and the Dender.
+
+Marlborough had, however, been joined by Prince Eugene, who had,
+like Berwick, hurried on in advance of his army, and the two great
+generals decided, instead of attacking the French by the road from
+Brussels, to sweep round across the Scheldt at Oudenarde, and by
+other bridges across the river, and so to place themselves between
+Vendome and France.
+
+A portion of the French army was already in movement, when the
+news came that the allies were fast coming up. Early the next
+morning their advance guard, composed of twelve battalions of
+infantry and the whole of the cavalry, reached the Scheldt; and,
+having thrown bridges over the river, crossed, and soon came in
+contact with the French advance guard, under Biron. There was some
+severe fighting, in which neither party gained any great
+advantage, the French maintaining possession of the village of
+Eynes.
+
+While this conflict was going on, Marlborough and Eugene, with the
+main body, had reached the river, and were engaged in crossing it;
+and Vendome determined to attack them while carrying out the
+operation. He was, as usual, opposed by Burgundy, who wished to
+continue the march to Ghent. Marshal Vendome pointed out that, in
+a country so broken and interspersed with hedges, an army
+possessing the greatest strength--for the French numbered
+eighty-five thousand, while Marlborough had but eighty thousand
+under him--would lose the advantage of that superiority; and, upon
+Berwick strongly siding with the marshal, Burgundy was forced to
+give way.
+
+The discussion lasted some time, enabling the allies to pass
+bodies of troops across the river, where they were formed up at a
+village a few hundred yards north of Oudenarde; and immediately
+Marlborough felt strong enough to risk an attack, orders were sent
+to Cadogan, who commanded the advance guard, to drive the enemy
+out of Eynes.
+
+Four English battalions attacked the seven French battalions in
+the village, while the cavalry crossed higher up, and came down on
+the back of the village. Three of the French battalions were
+surrounded and made prisoners, while the other four were
+dispersed.
+
+It was now evident, even to Burgundy, that an action could not be
+avoided, but again an angry dispute took place. Vendome would have
+stood on the defensive, with the river Norken to be crossed before
+he could be attacked. He was, however, overruled by Burgundy, who
+had nominally chief command. Marlborough took advantage of the
+delay, and posted his troops in front of the castle of Bevere, and
+sent the twelve battalions at Eynes to reinforce his left, against
+which he saw the main attack of the French would be directed. He
+then lined all the hedges with infantry, and stationed twenty
+British battalions, under Argyle, in reserve.
+
+Crossing the Norken, the French fell upon the Dutch and
+Hanoverians, who constituted the left wing, and who, though
+fighting obstinately, were driven back. Marlborough moved from the
+centre with twenty battalions to reinforce them, and despatched
+Eugene to command on the right.
+
+A desperate fight now took place. On both flanks, the ground was
+broken by enclosures with deep wet ditches, bridges, woods, and
+small villages; and the cavalry were unable to act on such ground.
+The infantry on both sides fought with extreme resolution; every
+hedge, ditch, bridge, and house being defended to the last.
+Seldom, indeed, in modern warfare, has so obstinate and terrible a
+fight taken place. Frequently the combatants were mingled
+together, and fought with bayonets and the butt ends of their
+muskets.
+
+Gradually, however, the Dutch and the Hanoverian battalions won
+their way forward, and drove the French back to the village of
+Diepenbeck, where the latter successfully maintained themselves.
+Marlborough then ordered General Overkirk to move round and seize
+the hill at Oycke, which, although it flanked the enemy's
+position, was not held by them.
+
+This he did, with twenty Dutch and Danish battalions, who had only
+just crossed the river. He then pressed on and seized the mill of
+Royegham, thus cutting the communication between the French at
+Diepenbeck and the troops that still remained on the plateau
+beyond the Norken. Eugene then swung round his right, and,
+pressing forward, surrounded the French on that side, so
+completely enveloping them that his men and those of Overkirk each
+believed the other to be French--for darkness had now fallen--and
+fought for some time before the mistake was discovered.
+
+As, in such a country, it was impossible to move troops in regular
+formation in the darkness, Marlborough gave orders for the troops
+to halt in the positions they held. Had the light lasted two hours
+longer, the whole of the French army would have been slain or
+captured; but, under cover of darkness, the greater portion made
+their way through the intervals of the allied troops. Many fled to
+Ghent, while thousands made for the French frontier. Vendome lost
+in killed and wounded six thousand men, and nine thousand
+prisoners, and his total loss exceeded twenty thousand; while the
+allies lost five thousand, of whom the great majority were Dutch,
+Danes, and Germans.
+
+The French troops on the plateau withdrew, under the direction of
+Vendome, in good order; and before morning a large number of
+fugitives had rallied. Marlborough sent forty squadrons of horse
+in pursuit of them, but the French showed so firm an attitude that
+the cavalry were unable to seriously interfere with their retreat.
+Berwick had remained, during the day, near the marshal; and had
+placed his aides-de-camp at his disposal, for the difficulty of
+the ground, and the distance from the plateau of the various
+points at which the troops were engaged, rendered communication
+much slower than it otherwise would have been, and Desmond and his
+companions were frequently sent off with orders.
+
+It was the first time Desmond had been under fire, and the effect
+of the roar of musketry, the whizzing of bullets, and the shouts
+of the combatants, gave him a much stronger feeling of discomfort
+than he had expected. The roar of cannon was not added to the
+other sounds, for the guns of the day were clumsy and difficult to
+move; and, owing to the rapid marches and countermarches of both
+armies, the greater portion of the artillery had been left behind,
+and only a few guns were on the field, and these, in so close and
+confined a country, were of little use.
+
+Desmond felt now that he would far rather be fighting in the thick
+of it, with O'Brien's regiment, than making his way alone along
+the lanes, impeded constantly by columns advancing to the front,
+while he was met by a stream of wounded men making their way to
+the rear.
+
+At first, all was exultation among the troops, for as the
+Hanoverians and Dutch were forced to give way before the assault
+of the main body of the French, shouts of victory rose; and it was
+confidently believed that they would, this day, avenge the two
+great victories Marlborough and Eugene had gained over them.
+
+Having delivered his orders to the officer in command, Desmond
+rode back. Vendome and Berwick had both dismounted, and were
+standing together, with a few of their staff, at the edge of the
+plateau, examining the field with their telescopes.
+
+"I have delivered your message, sir," he said, riding up and
+saluting. "The general bade me tell you all was going well. The
+enemy were falling back, and will soon be in full flight."
+
+"Very well, Mr. Kennedy. By this time, he will have found out that
+he was a little too sanguine."
+
+The fire had, indeed, for the past few minutes broken out with
+augmented fury. Marlborough had arrived at the threatened point,
+and had placed himself at the head of the Dutch and Hanoverians,
+and, animated by his presence, these had not only ceased to fall
+back, but were in turn advancing.
+
+"The battle is not won yet, Kennedy," O'Sullivan, who had returned
+a few minutes before from the front, said, as he joined him. "On
+our left we are being driven back, for a large force has
+reinforced the enemy there, and unless our main column defeats the
+allied left, and pushes them into Oudenarde, we shall have night
+coming on before we have finished; and, as our cavalry cannot act
+in these cramped fields, Marlborough will be able to draw off
+without any great loss."
+
+For an hour, there was no change. Then Berwick, looking round,
+beckoned to Desmond.
+
+"Mr. Kennedy," he said, "a strong force of the enemy moved, half
+an hour ago, towards their left. I have lost sight of them, owing
+to the high hedges and trees, but it does not seem to me that they
+can have joined in the battle. Our troops are strongly posted at
+Diepenbeck, and should be able to maintain themselves there
+against the whole allied army; but the enemy cannot see our
+dispositions, and would surely have pushed forward and made a
+desperate assault on the village, had they been joined by the
+strong force I saw moving in that direction.
+
+"It may be that this force has been held in reserve, in case our
+line should be reinforced, and again advance. Marlborough may be
+content to hold his own on his left, while Prince Eugene, who, we
+have heard, commands on their right, turns our flank on that side.
+
+"I wish you to ascertain, if possible, what this force is doing,
+and where it is posted. If you ride across to the mill, on the
+eminence behind Diepenbeck, you may be able to get sight of them;
+or, if the smoke renders it impossible to discover matters from
+that point, ride on to the farther hill, and, descending there on
+the enemy's left, you will be able to make your way close enough
+to ascertain what is going on. You are well mounted, and need not
+greatly fear capture, for they would hardly care to divert a party
+of cavalry in pursuit of a single officer. Still, it is as well
+not to push your horse too hard on your way out, for you may
+possibly need all his strength."
+
+A minute later, Desmond was cantering his horse down the declivity
+to the Norken. Crossing by the bridge near Mullen, he turned to
+the right and rode up the hill of Royegham. Here a strong brigade,
+composed of cavalry and infantry, under General Grimaldi, was
+stationed. Desmond rode up to him.
+
+"The Duke of Berwick has sent me to ascertain, sir, the position
+of a strong body of the enemy's troops, whom he observed marching
+from the river towards our right. May I ask if you have noticed
+them?"
+
+"We saw them move away, after crossing the river, but have not
+seen them since. I should fancy they are engaged in front of
+Diepenbeck; but the ground is so undulating, and the view so
+obscured by smoke, that we have not caught sight of them since
+they issued from Oudenarde--indeed, the hill behind Diepenbeck
+prevents our seeing down into the low land beyond."
+
+"I will ride on there, sir," Desmond said. "Certainly a better
+view can be obtained than from this side."
+
+A canter of a mile took him to the summit of the hill at whose
+foot Diepenbeck stood. He could see the masses of French troops,
+gathered in and in front of the village; but beyond that a veil of
+smoke covered the country, and entirely obscured the contending
+parties, whose position could only be guessed by the incessant
+rattle of their musketry fire.
+
+Turning again, he rode down the dip that separated the hill from
+that of Oycke. He had just gained the crest, when he saw a large
+force marching rapidly towards the mill. Seeing at once the
+serious nature of the movement, he turned and galloped, at full
+speed, to the point where the generals were still watching the
+progress of the fight.
+
+"I could learn nothing of the force you spoke of from General
+Grimaldi at Royegham, nor on the heights above Diepenbeck; but,
+riding towards Oycke, I saw them advancing at full speed towards
+the windmill, at which they had already almost arrived."
+
+An exclamation of anger broke from the duke.
+
+"This is what comes," he muttered, "of placing a fool in command
+of the army."
+
+Turning away, he at once communicated the news to Vendome, who
+stamped his foot furiously on the ground.
+
+"Just when victory was in our grasp," he said, and turned his
+glass towards Oycke, which was some four miles distant.
+
+"I can make them out now," he said. "There is a black mass issuing
+from the village of Oycke, and ascending the hill in the direction
+of Royegham. It is too late to reinforce Grimaldi there. They will
+be upon him before we can cross the Norken. But, at any rate, we
+must send a brigade down to Henhelm, where, with Grimaldi's men,
+they can try to keep open the road from Diepenbeck."
+
+Ten minutes later they could hear, by a sudden outburst of fire,
+that Grimaldi was engaged. The sun had already set, but Berwick
+was able to make out, with his glass, that the left was giving way
+before the attack of Eugene, and that the twenty battalions under
+Argyle, which had hitherto remained inactive, were advancing by
+the main road leading, through Mullen, to the plateau on which
+they stood.
+
+"The day is lost," Berwick said bitterly. "The troops at
+Diepenbeck are completely cut off. Darkness alone can save them
+from annihilation. And to think that, if it had not been for
+Burgundy, we could have maintained ourselves here against double
+the force of the allies! So long as the system of giving the
+command of armies to royal incapables continues, we cannot hope
+for success."
+
+Vendome lost no time in issuing orders. The troops still on the
+plateau were brought forward, whence their fire would command its
+approaches. Aides-de-camp were sent in all directions, to order
+the generals of divisions to draw off at once, and to make their
+way up to the plateau; and Berwick's four aides-de-camp were told
+to make their way, if possible, by different routes to Diepenbeck,
+and to give orders for the troops there to maintain themselves, at
+all costs, until darkness had completely fallen; and then to make
+their way as best they could to the plateau; if that was
+impossible, to march for either Ghent or Lille.
+
+"The service is a desperate one, gentlemen," Berwick said, as he
+turned to give the orders to his officers, "but it is necessary,
+for if the force remain there until morning, they are all
+irretrievably lost. It is getting dark already, and you may,
+therefore, hope to pass unnoticed between the intervals of the
+enemy. If you get there safely, do not try to return at once, but,
+like the rest, endeavour to make off during the night."
+
+Without waiting for orders, Mike followed his master. Going down,
+they met the remnants of Biron's division flying in disorder. They
+separated at the bridge of Mullen, and, with a word of adieu to
+his comrades, Desmond turned to the right, and rode for
+Groenvelde.
+
+Suddenly, a volley of musketry was fired from the hill to the
+right. Desmond staggered for a moment in the saddle, and the
+bridle fell from his left hand. Mike was by his side in a moment.
+
+"Where are you hurt, master?"
+
+"In the left wrist, I fancy. By the way the hand hangs down, it
+must have smashed both bones. However, there is no time to wait,
+now. It is a matter of life and death to get to Diepenbeck."
+
+"One moment, your honour. Let me put your hand into the breast of
+your coatee; then, if you keep your elbow tight against your body,
+it will keep it steady."
+
+Although Mike carried out his suggestion as gently as he could,
+Desmond almost fainted with pain.
+
+"Take a drop of brandy from your flask, master. It won't take half
+a minute, and then we will be off."
+
+They continued their journey. The rattle of musketry, ahead of
+them, showed that the combat had already commenced close by;
+between either the advancing troops of Argyle, or those who had
+crossed the hill of Royegham; and Grimaldi's brigade, which was
+probably endeavouring to hold them in check, until the troops at
+Diepenbeck came back.
+
+It was already too dark to distinguish the uniforms, except at a
+distance of a few yards. Dashing on, he saw a dark mass
+ahead--three officers rode out.
+
+"Who are you, sir?" they shouted.
+
+"I am carrying a report from the general," he replied, in English,
+and without drawing rein dashed on, passing within twenty yards of
+the column, and reached Diepenbeck without further interruption.
+
+In the centre of the village, the French general was sitting on
+his horse, surrounded by his staff. The combat beyond raged as
+furiously as before. Desmond rode up, and saluted.
+
+"I am the bearer of orders from Marshal Vendome, sir," he said.
+"He bid me tell you that a large force of the enemy has crossed
+the hills of Oycke and Royegham, and is already in your rear, the
+enemy's right overlapping your left; while the whole British
+reserve is pressing forward, and will ere long effect a junction
+with both these forces. Your retreat, therefore, is entirely cut
+off. The orders are that you shall maintain yourself here as long
+as possible, as in the darkness and confusion, it is unlikely that
+the allies can attack you from the rear before morning.
+
+"The marshal himself holds the plateau, and will continue to do
+so. You are to make your way tonight, if possible, in battalions
+and in good order, through the intervals between the various
+divisions of the enemy; or, if that is not possible, singly. All
+are to endeavour to join him on the plateau. Those who cannot do
+this are to make for Ghent or Lille."
+
+"Your order scarcely comes as a surprise, sir," the general said
+bitterly. "We have heard firing in our rear for some time, and we
+were afraid that things had gone badly with us, after all."
+
+He at once gave orders that the troops behind the village were to
+take up a position to resist any attack made in that direction.
+Desmond dismounted, as did Mike, and the latter took the two
+horses, fastened them to a tree, and then, with Desmond's scarf,
+bound his arm firmly against his side.
+
+"We have made a mess of it entirely, your honour," he said, "and
+have got a terrible bating. Sure we were lucky in getting here.
+Faith, I thought we were caught when you were hailed."
+
+"It was a narrow escape, Mike; and if they had waited till I had
+got a little nearer, and had seen my uniform, I must have
+surrendered."
+
+"It seems to me that we are like rats in a trap, Mr. Kennedy."
+
+"Something like it, Mike; but it is hard if we can't get through
+them, in the dark."
+
+"That we will do, sure enough," Mike said confidently; "but which
+way should we go?"
+
+"That I can't tell you. You see, they are in strength in front,
+Marlborough and Eugene are on the left and partly behind us, and
+the troops you saw come across the hills are somewhere in the
+rear. If it were daylight, not a man of us would escape; but as it
+is, it will be hard if we cannot make our way through.
+
+"What I am thinking about chiefly, at present, is the safety of
+O'Sullivan, O'Neil, and d'Eyncourt. They ought to have been here
+as soon as we were. They may either have lost their way in the
+darkness, or fallen into the hands of the enemy. However, I shall
+not give them up for another half hour."
+
+The firing was now abating, and presently died away completely;
+except for a few scattered shots, showing that the allies had been
+halted where they stood, and were no longer pressing forward.
+Another hour passed, and Desmond's comrades were still absent.
+
+In the meantime, the general had called together the colonels of
+the several regiments, had explained the situation to them, and
+repeated Vendome's orders. The news came like a thunderbolt upon
+them, for the din of firing round the village had completely
+deadened all distant sound, and they were wholly unaware of what
+was passing in other parts of the field.
+
+"I must leave the matter to your individual discretion," the
+general said. "Those of you who think your men can be relied on,
+can try to escape and join the marshal in a body. Those who have
+not that confidence in their regiments--and indeed some of these
+have been almost annihilated--had best tell them to scatter. Those
+who remain here will assuredly be made prisoners in the morning.
+
+"It is possible that that may be the better plan, for it is better
+to surrender than to be cut to pieces. I therefore leave the
+matter entirely in your hands. I myself shall remain here. We have
+done all that men can do in the way of fighting, and, as I was
+told to hold this place till the last, I shall remain at my post."
+
+Desmond was present when this conversation took place.
+
+"We will wait another hour, Mike," he said, as he rejoined his
+follower. "We may be sure that the greater part of the enemy's
+troops will be asleep by that time. They must have made a
+tremendous march, for the news last night was that they were
+twenty miles away; and they have been fighting twelve hours. After
+such work as that, the men will drop down to sleep as soon as they
+have halted."
+
+"Shall we go on horse or on foot, your honour?"
+
+"I think the best plan will be to lead our horses, Mike, across
+this country. It would seem natural to do so, and once through
+them, we could then gallop round and join the troops on the
+plateau."
+
+"I should say, sir, that if I were to steal out to where they have
+been fighting for the last six hours, I might get a couple of
+uniforms to put over our own. They will be lying thick enough
+there, poor chaps. If we had them on, we might pass through any
+troops we might meet, as we both speak English."
+
+"That is a good idea, Mike, if you can carry it out."
+
+"Sure I can do that, and without difficulty, your honour. I expect
+the enemy have drawn back a little, so as to be in some sort of
+order if we were to fall upon them in the night; and I know that
+all our men have been recalled. I will fasten the horses to this
+tree, and perhaps your honour will keep an eye on them."
+
+"I will stay with them, Mike."
+
+The soldier at once made off. The village was now crowded with
+troops. All order was at an end, and the regiments were
+considerably mixed up. The officers went among them, saying that
+an attempt was going to be made to pass through the enemy, and
+join the force on the plateau. They pointed out that there was at
+least as much hope in being able to do so as in making off singly.
+
+Many of the soldiers, not having themselves suffered defeat,
+responded to the call; and several bodies, four or five hundred
+strong, marched out into the darkness. The majority, however,
+decided to shift for themselves, and stole away in threes and
+fours. Of those that remained, some broke into the village wine
+and beer shops and drank to stupefaction; while others, exhausted
+by the efforts of the day, threw themselves down and slept.
+
+Mike was away half an hour.
+
+"I have got an officer's cloak for you, and a helmet with
+feathers. I think he must have been a staff officer, who was
+killed while delivering his orders. I have got a soldier's
+overcoat and shako for myself."
+
+"Capital, Mike! Now I think that we can venture, and we will go
+the shortest way. We might very well lose ourselves among these
+hills, if we were to try to make a circuit."
+
+Having put the Dutch uniforms over their own, they set out, taking
+the way to the left until they came to the main road by which the
+British reserve had advanced. Then they mounted their horses.
+
+"It is no use trying to make our way through the broken ground,
+Mike. There is another road that goes through Huerne. We will
+strike that, and must so get round on the right of the enemy. Even
+if we come upon them, we are not likely to excite suspicion, as we
+shall be on a road leading from Oudenarde.
+
+"I was noticing that road from the height. It runs into this
+again, near Mullen, and the enemy are not likely to have posted
+themselves so near to the river."
+
+They rode on through Huerne. The village was full of wounded. No
+one paid them any attention, and they again went on, until
+suddenly they were challenged with the usual "Who comes there?"
+
+"A staff officer, with despatches," Desmond replied.
+
+He heard the butt of the soldier's musket drop upon the ground,
+and rode forward.
+
+"Can you tell me, my man," he said as he reached the sentinel,
+"where the Duke of Marlborough is to be found?"
+
+"I don't know, sir," the man replied. "Only our regiment is here.
+I know there are a number of cavalry away there on the left, and I
+heard someone say that the duke himself was there. There is a
+crossroad, a hundred yards farther on, which will lead you to
+them."
+
+Thanking the man, Desmond rode on. A few bivouac fires had been
+lighted, and these were already beginning to burn low, the troops
+having dropped asleep almost as soon as they halted.
+
+"I hope we shall meet no more of them, Mike," Desmond said, as
+they went on at a brisk trot. "I sha'n't feel quite safe till we
+get to Mullen."
+
+They met, however, with no further interruption. As they crossed
+the bridge, they halted, took off the borrowed uniforms, threw
+away the headgear and put on their own hats, which they carried
+under their cloaks, and then rode on up the hill, after having
+first satisfied the officer commanding a strong guard placed at
+the bridge that they were friends.
+
+Another ten minutes, and they were upon the plateau. Desmond had
+no difficulty in finding out where the headquarters were
+established at Hayse, and, riding there, he at once went into the
+house occupied by Berwick, and reported his return.
+
+"I am glad to see you back again, Kennedy," the duke said,
+heartily. "It is something to have recovered one friend from the
+wreck. Now, what is your news?"
+
+Desmond related what had happened to him from the time he left,
+and said that a large proportion of the troops at Diepenbeck had
+already left, and, as he heard no outburst of firing, he hoped
+most of them had got safely away.
+
+"I see you are wounded."
+
+"I have had my wrist smashed with a musket ball, fired by a party
+on a hill to the right, belonging, I suppose, to the force that
+came up from Oycke."
+
+"You had a narrow escape of your life," Berwick said. "If you had
+been hit a little farther back, the ball would have gone through
+your body. Sit down at once. I will send for my surgeon."
+
+And he instantly gave orders for the surgeon of the staff to come
+to his tent, and then made Desmond, who was suffering terribly
+from the agony of the wound, drink a tumbler of wine.
+
+"I know you are all busy, doctor," the duke said, as the surgeon
+entered, "but you must do something for Mr. Kennedy, who is badly
+wounded in the arm."
+
+The surgeon examined the wound, and shook his head.
+
+"Both bones are fractured," he said, "and I am afraid that there
+is nothing for it but amputation."
+
+"Then leave it till tomorrow, doctor," Desmond said faintly.
+"There must be a number of poor fellows who want your attention
+much more than I do."
+
+"That would do, if I could make you a cradle, but we are badly off
+for all surgical appliances."
+
+"Could you cut one out of one of my jack boots?"
+
+"A capital idea, Mr. Kennedy. Nothing could be better. And I will
+put it in operation, at once, with some of my other patients."
+
+"Mr. Kennedy is full of expedients, doctor, and it seems to me
+that this may be really a valuable one. All the cavalry men have
+jack boots, and I will give you an order to requisition as many as
+may be required. The men can get new ones from the stores at
+Ghent."
+
+The surgeon at once cut off the foot of one of Desmond's boots,
+and then divided the leg longways. "There," he said, taking up one
+of the halves; "you could not wish for a better cradle."
+
+He took out some lint that he had brought with him, together with
+some flat splints, bound the hand in its proper position, and then
+laid the arm from the elbow to the fingers in the cradle, round
+which he tightly put a few bandages to keep it in position.
+
+"Now for your scarf," he said, and with this made a sling to
+support the arm.
+
+The whole operation did not take five minutes.
+
+"Now, Mr. Kennedy, you had best lie down and get what sleep you
+can. I will take the other half of your boot, and the other boot
+also. It will be no use without its fellow. It will make three
+wounded men comparatively comfortable, and I will send for some
+more from the troopers."
+
+"Yes, lie down at once, Kennedy," Berwick said. "We are going to
+march off at daybreak, and the marshal and I have arranged
+everything between ourselves. You had better try and eat
+something, if it is only a wing of that chicken and a few
+mouthfuls of meat. Your faintness must be due as much to hunger as
+to your wound, for you have been at work since early morning, and
+cannot have had time to eat anything."
+
+This was indeed the case, and Desmond managed to swallow a few
+mouthfuls, and then lay down upon the sofa, where, in spite of the
+pain of his wound, he presently dozed off, being utterly worn out
+with the work and excitement of the day.
+
+Before morning, some five thousand of the troops from Diepenbeck
+had marched into the camp, in good order and with their arms, and
+as soon as it was daylight the whole force started for Ghent. With
+deep regret, Desmond had learned from the marshal, before lying
+down, that none of his comrades had returned; and as they had not
+reached Diepenbeck, he felt sure that they were either killed or
+prisoners.
+
+"D'Eyncourt will, of course, be treated as a prisoner of war; but
+if the identity of O'Sullivan or O'Neil is proved with the
+officers of that name who escaped from Newgate, it is likely to go
+hard with him."
+
+After repulsing the cavalry sent in pursuit, the army marched away
+unmolested, being joined as they went by large numbers of
+fugitives, who had made their way through the allied lines in
+small parties. Marlborough's army remained on the ground they had
+won, collecting and caring for the wounded of both armies.
+
+Two days later, Berwick's corps joined Vendome, and that of Eugene
+marched into Marlborough's camp. In spite of the loss that he had
+suffered at Oudenarde, this reinforcement raised Vendome's army to
+over one hundred and ten thousand men, which was about the same
+force as Marlborough had under his command.
+
+After Eugene had joined him, standing as he did between Vendome's
+army and Paris, Marlborough proposed that the enemy's fortresses
+should be neglected, and that the army should march directly on
+Paris. The movement might have been attended with success, but was
+of so daring a description that even Eugene opposed it, while the
+commanders of the Dutch, Danes, and Prussians were unanimously
+against it; and he consequently decided to lay siege to Lille--a
+tremendous undertaking, for Lille was considered the strongest
+fortress in France, and Vendome, with over a hundred thousand men,
+was within a couple of days' march of it.
+
+His dispositions were made with extreme care, and a tremendous
+convoy of heavy artillery, ammunition, and provisions was brought
+up from Ostend, without the French being able to interfere with
+its progress. Marlborough, with his British contingent and the
+Hanoverians, was to cover the operations of the siege, which was
+to be undertaken by Prince Eugene with the rest of the allied
+army.
+
+Vendome marched at once with his army, and, making a circuit,
+placed himself between Lille and Paris, deserting his recent
+conquests in Ypres, Ghent, and Bruges, all of which fell into the
+hands of the allies.
+
+
+
+Chapter 13: Convalescent.
+
+
+Desmond was not present with the French army, for many hours after
+their arrival at Ghent. He suffered intense pain on the ride
+thither, and was then taken to a hospital that had been hastily
+formed for the reception of wounded officers. Here the surgeons
+had agreed that there was nothing for it, but to amputate the arm
+halfway between the wrist and the elbow. The limb was already
+greatly swollen.
+
+"Under ordinary circumstances," the surgeon said, "we should wait
+until we had reduced the inflammation, but this might be a matter
+of a week or ten days, and there is no time to spare, as the army
+will probably march away in a few days, and travel would increase
+the inflammation to such an extent that your life might be
+sacrificed."
+
+"I would rather have it taken off at once, doctor," Desmond said.
+"The operation cannot hurt very much more than the arm is hurting
+already, and the sooner it is over, the better."
+
+Surgery was in its infancy at that time. Anesthetics were undreamt
+of; but the surgeons of the French army had large experience, and
+the operation was very skilfully performed, for the time. The
+stump was then seared with a hot iron.
+
+"You have stood it well," the surgeon said, for, except when the
+iron was applied to the wound, no groan had issued from Desmond's
+lips. "Now, your servant must keep these dressings continually
+soaked with water, and, in a few days, we may hope that you will
+be able to travel in a waggon without danger."
+
+When the army marched away a week later, Desmond was placed in a
+waggon, half filled with hay, with several other wounded officers.
+At Arras, where there was a large military hospital, he was kept
+for a few days, and then sent on to Amiens, only the most severe
+cases being retained at Arras, as another engagement might take
+place at any moment, and the resources of the town would be taxed
+to the utmost. He gained strength very slowly, and it was six
+weeks before the surgeons pronounced him to be sufficiently
+convalescent to be moved.
+
+"It would," they said, "be probably some months before he would be
+fit to return to active service."
+
+He was sitting, looking listlessly out of the window of the
+chamber that he and three other officers occupied, when Mike came
+in, followed, to Desmond's intense surprise, by Monsieur de la
+Vallee.
+
+"My dear Desmond," the latter exclaimed, hurrying forward and
+grasping his hand, "you must have thought that we had all
+forgotten you."
+
+"Indeed, I never thought anything of the kind, Philip. I did not
+suppose that you had ever heard of me, since we parted at
+Moulins."
+
+"News travels but slowly, but we did hear that fifteen subalterns
+of O'Brien's regiment were captured in the Salisbury. I wrote to a
+friend in Paris, and he told me that you were among the number,
+but that, on making enquiries, he found you had, in some manner or
+other, effected your escape, and that you and two other officers
+had had an audience with the king, and had then gone to the
+northern frontier on the staff of the Duke of Berwick. I wrote
+begging him to get, if possible, a sight of the despatches, and if
+your name appeared, to let us know. Ten days ago, I received a
+letter from him, to say that you had been wounded at Oudenarde.
+The Duke of Berwick had, in his private despatch to the king,
+mentioned your name with very high praise, saying that it was due
+to you, alone, that so many of the troops hemmed in at some
+village or other--I forget its name--managed to make their escape
+during the night, for, although he sent off four aides-de-camp
+with orders, you alone managed to get through the enemy, though
+wounded by a bullet which had caused you the loss of your hand. He
+said he had written to the chief surgeon on Berwick's staff, who
+was a personal friend of his, to ascertain, if possible, where you
+were. Of course, I set out as soon as I received his letter."
+
+"What! Have you ridden all the way from the south of France to
+come to me, Philip?"
+
+"Of course I have, and should have ridden all across Europe, if it
+had been necessary. I went round by Pointdexter. The baron is laid
+up with an attack of gout, or he would have accompanied me. He
+sent all sorts of messages, and so did Anne, and the latter
+informed me that I need not show my face at the chateau again,
+until I came accompanied by you. When I reached Paris my friend
+had learned from the surgeon that you were at Amiens, and so, here
+I am.
+
+"I met your faithful Mike at the gate of the hospital. I was glad,
+indeed, to see that he had come out unharmed from that terrible
+fight. When I told him I had come to take you away, he almost
+cried with joy."
+
+"It will be the saving of him," he said. "He has been going down
+the hill for the last fortnight, and it is change and good nursing
+he wants."
+
+"He will get good nursing, I warrant," I said, "and the soft air
+of the south will soon set him up."
+
+"It is wonderfully kind of you, Philip; but I am sure I am not
+strong enough to ride."
+
+"No one is thinking of your riding, at present, Desmond. I have
+brought down a horse litter with me, and four of my men, with the
+quietest horses on the estate, and all you have to do is to lie
+down in it, and talk with me whenever you are disposed. You have a
+whole batch of adventures to tell me."
+
+"I feel better already, Philip. I own that I have been downhearted
+of late, for it seemed to me that I should be an invalid for
+months, and be living in Paris without a friend except Mike, for
+all the regiments of the Brigade are either with Vendome or in
+Spain. The sight of your face, and the thought of your kindness,
+so cheers me that I feel capable of anything."
+
+"Well, we will start tomorrow morning, Desmond. I shall go at once
+and see the director of the hospital, and get an order for your
+discharge."
+
+The next morning they set out. Desmond had to be assisted
+downstairs. There he was laid on a litter, packed with soft rugs.
+This was raised and placed between two horses, ridden by two of de
+la Vallee's men. De la Vallee himself took his place by the side
+of the litter, Mike rode on ahead leading Desmond's charger, and
+the other two servants fell to the rear, in readiness to change
+with those bearing the litter, when half the day's journey was
+done.
+
+Seeing that the exertion of being moved had exhausted his friend,
+de la Vallee rode for some time in silence. Then, when Desmond
+opened his eyes and smiled at him, he said:
+
+"I hope you are feeling comfortable?"
+
+"Perfectly. I hardly feel any motion."
+
+Every care had been taken to prevent jolting. The poles of the
+litter were unusually long, thus adding to their elasticity. The
+ends passed through leathern loops suspended from the saddle; and
+were, at this point, covered with a thick wrapping of flannel
+bandages, which aided in minimizing the effect of any jar. The
+first day's journey was performed at a walking pace, and they
+reached Beauvais, twenty-five miles being accomplished.
+
+The fresh air and the slight easy motion were beneficial, and in
+the afternoon, Desmond was able to talk cheerfully with his
+friend. There was, however, no continued conversation, Philip
+saying he would ask no questions about Desmond's doings until he
+was stronger. His story had better be told while sitting quietly
+in a room, where it would not be necessary, as it was on the road,
+for the voice to be raised.
+
+In the evening, however, after partaking of supper, Desmond,
+without being asked, related the incidents, so far as he knew
+them, of the battle of Oudenarde, and of the manner in which he
+received his wound.
+
+"The whole disaster was due entirely to the Duke of Burgundy, or
+rather to the king, who placed him in command over two generals of
+the highest skill and reputation. If he had wanted to accompany
+the army, Burgundy should have done so just as our King James did,
+merely as a volunteer.
+
+"I am told that the king showed great courage in the battle. For
+my part, I think his presence was altogether a mistake. He claims
+that the English are his subjects, and yet he takes part with a
+foreign army in battle against them. His being present will
+certainly not add to his popularity in England."
+
+"I agree with you," de la Vallee said. "It would have been much
+wiser for him to have abstained, altogether, from interference in
+the matter. It was, of course, a different thing when he attempted
+to land in Scotland. Then he would have been leading the loyal
+portion of his subjects, against those whom he considers rebels
+against his authority. That was quite a different thing from
+acting, without cause or reason, as a volunteer in the French
+army, against those whom he regards as his countrymen and
+subjects.
+
+"I am afraid, Desmond, that, though it may shock you to think so,
+these Stuart princes of yours are not wise men. Legitimate
+monarchs of England though they may be, they do not possess the
+qualities that endear kings to their people. From what I have
+heard, James was a heavy pedant, a rank coward, essentially not a
+man to be popular among a spirited people. Charles had a noble
+presence and many fine qualities. But, although his ideas of
+kingly power would have suited us well enough in France, his
+arbitrary measures alienated a large proportion of his people, and
+brought ruin upon him.
+
+"Your second Charles, in spite of his numerous indiscretions, was
+not unpopular, because the people were wearied of the stern
+repression of Puritan rule, and were therefore disposed to look
+leniently upon his frailties, while they appreciated his good
+temper and wit. His fatal mistake was allying himself so closely
+with us--a grievous mistake, indeed, when we remember that for
+centuries the two nations had been bitterly opposed to each other.
+As for his brother, he forfeited his throne by his leanings
+towards the Catholic Church, in whose communion he died.
+Decidedly, the Stuart kings were not a success.
+
+"As to James the Third, as you call him, I know nothing beyond the
+fact that he is a protege of the king of France, and has now
+fought against his own people--a blunder, as it seems to me, of
+the worst kind, and one which is certain to alienate many of his
+supporters on the other side of the water. Were he to mount the
+throne, it would be partly due to the aid of French troops and
+French money--men and money, mind you, of a power at war with
+England! He would therefore, necessarily, like Charles the Second,
+be regarded as a protege of France. He would be bound in gratitude
+to Louis, and the position of England would be altogether changed.
+She would become the ally of Spain and France, her ancient
+enemies; and opponent of her present allies, Holland, Austria,
+Protestant Germany, and Denmark."
+
+Desmond was silent. He could not but agree with what his friend
+said, and had himself considered that it was a most unwise step
+for James to appear in the field, fighting against his countrymen.
+
+"I don't think I am strong enough to argue, Philip," he said with
+a smile, after a long pause, "and I don't mean to give you a
+victory, when I am fighting under disadvantages. The Stuarts
+certainly never did any special benefit to Ireland, and assuredly
+brought ruin and misery upon us; and at the present moment, I
+don't seem able to explain why we should be so devoted to the
+cause of these Scottish Stuarts, rather than to that of Anne, who
+is, after all, of the same family and race. However, we will fight
+it out when my brain is not so dull as it is at present."
+
+They slept the next night at Pontoise, having made a somewhat
+short journey, though Desmond protested that he felt quite equal
+to going on to Paris.
+
+"You are a good deal better today, Desmond, but there is no hurry,
+and we will take matters quietly. If you continue to make
+improvement we shall be able, in another day or two, to travel
+faster; and I hope that, before we get to the end of our journey,
+you will be strong enough to sit your horse for a few miles each
+day."
+
+They made no stay in Paris, but proceeded on their way, the
+morning after their arrival. Melun and Montargis were their next
+halting places. Desmond was gaining strength rapidly. His good
+spirits were returning, and at their evening halt, he had been
+able to recite the history of his escape from England. His wound
+had a less angry appearance, and on the day of their leaving
+Montargis the horses, at his request, occasionally broke into a
+trot for a mile or two.
+
+"You are looking paler. I think the motion is too much for you,"
+Philip said after one of these occasions, when they again settled
+down to a walking pace.
+
+"I feel a bit tired, Philip, but one must make a beginning, and I
+shall never get strong unless I begin to use my muscles. At
+present, I acknowledge I feel as if I had been beaten all over
+with sticks, but I have no doubt that I shall shake this off,
+after a bit."
+
+This was indeed the case, and on the last three days of their
+journey to Pointdexter, he sat his horse for two or three hours.
+Philip had, on the last day, sent on one of his men to inform the
+baron that he would arrive that evening with Desmond, and as they
+were seen approaching, the baron and his daughter came out from
+the chateau, and welcomed them as they alighted.
+
+"Do not upset the young fellow by appearing shocked at his
+appearance," the former had said to Anne. "It was certainly a
+blow, this morning, to hear that he had lost his left hand, and
+that the greater portion of the journey had had to be performed in
+a litter, so you must expect to find him greatly pulled down. But
+see, they are breaking into a trot, so he has evidently gained
+strength on the way."
+
+In spite of the warning, the girl's eyes filled with tears as she
+saw Desmond's thin face and wasted figure, and his left arm in a
+sling.
+
+"Welcome to Pointdexter, Monsieur Kennedy! Many have entered here,
+since the old chateau was built, but none who have rendered such
+vital service to our race. Do not try to speak. I see that you are
+shaken with your journey. We will soon put that all right."
+
+"It has been a rather longer journey than we have previously
+made," Desmond said, after dismounting and shaking hands with the
+baron and his daughter, "and we rode somewhat faster than usual,
+as we were both of us anxious to be here. It was good, indeed, of
+Philip to make such a journey to find and bring me to you."
+
+"If he had not done so, assuredly we should. My foot was so bad,
+with this villainous gout, that I could not put it in a stirrup,
+but we should have had out the family coach. I had half a mind to
+do so as it was, and Anne was most anxious to try her powers of
+nursing, but Philip overruled us, and said that he would be with
+you a week earlier than we could reach you in the coach, and that,
+moreover, he was sure the journey in an open horse litter would be
+far better for you than being jolted in a close carriage. So, as
+usual, he had his own way; though I must say that, for once, Anne
+rebelled strongly against his authority."
+
+"You are all very good, Baron," Desmond said; "but, indeed, I
+think that Philip was right. I can assure you that the journey has
+done me an immense deal of good, and he will tell you that I am
+very different, now, from what I was when he found me at Amiens,
+for I had begun to think that I should never get away alive."
+
+"Do not let us stay talking here," the baron said. "Anne has had
+some soup prepared for you, under her own eyes; and that, and a
+glass or two of good Burgundy, will do wonders for you."
+
+Desmond, indeed, was greatly revived, and was able to join in a
+cheerful conversation with his hosts.
+
+"We are both dying to hear your adventures," the baron said, "and
+how you managed to escape from that jail in England, as you did,
+and also how it was that we met with that dreadful disaster at
+Oudenarde. It really seems that those terrible fellows,
+Marlborough and Prince Eugene, are invincible."
+
+"They are good generals, Baron. Beyond troubles with the
+commanders of the forces of their allies, they are able to carry
+out their own plans. The Dukes of Vendome and Berwick are also
+able commanders, but they were hampered by the presence of the
+Duke of Burgundy, who, on several occasions, overruled their
+opinions and ruined their plans. It is to him, alone, that the
+defeat at Oudenarde is due. The French soldiers fought as well as
+ever, and it was the position in which they were placed, and not
+the superior fighting powers of the enemy, that caused their
+defeat."
+
+"But how is it," the baron asked, "that with, as I hear, one
+hundred and ten thousand men, Vendome does not raise the siege of
+Lille? It seems incredible that, with so great a force, he should
+remain inactive while the enemy are carrying out their works for
+the siege."
+
+"That I cannot tell you, sir. We heard all sorts of rumours at
+Amiens, but it seems that Marlborough had taken up a strong
+position, and entrenched himself there with seventy thousand men,
+while Eugene is conducting the siege operations."
+
+"I don't understand it," the baron said, irritably. "There must be
+more ways of marching to Lille than one. If one road is barred,
+why not advance by another? The Duke of Burgundy is not with the
+army now, so the blame cannot be put on him."
+
+"No, sir; but Berwick's army is still, as I hear, under his
+independent command, and the duke, excellent soldier as he is, is
+not one to be easily led. If his opinion differs from that of
+Vendome, he would assuredly maintain it; and as his manner is not
+conciliatory, and his opinions are very strongly expressed, it may
+well be that there are, as was rumoured at Amiens, constant
+dissensions between him and Vendome."
+
+"Well, it seems to me very strange, Monsieur Kennedy, after having
+during the last reign defeated the best infantry of Spain, humbled
+Austria, subdued Bavaria, crushed the enemy in Italy, and shown
+ourselves to be the best soldiers in Europe; that we should now
+suffer defeat after defeat, by an army containing men of half a
+score of nationalities, though led by the greatest general that
+England has ever produced."
+
+"And, Baron, with English troops under him who have, for hundreds
+of years, shown themselves invincible!"
+
+"Yes, yes," the baron said, hastily. "We know all about Crecy,
+Poitiers, and Agincourt; and how well they fought in Holland; but
+I thought, Kennedy, that you were the enemy of the English, and
+were here with your brave countrymen to fight against them."
+
+"Not in my case, assuredly, Baron. I came over here because there
+is no opening for Irish gentlemen at home, and because only by the
+aid of France could our lawful king be placed on the throne. It is
+true that a section of the English people, under Oliver Cromwell,
+not only conquered us, but divided a great portion of our land
+among themselves; and, although we were again defeated by a
+usurping Dutch king, with the Dutch troops under his command, that
+is no reason why I should feel any animosity to the people at
+large, whose qualities I admire, and the majority of whom are, in
+their hearts, attached to the cause of the Stuarts, and hate those
+who are keeping the king from his throne. I own that I would
+rather that it had fallen to my lot to fight for France against
+Spaniards, Germans, and Italians, than against the English."
+
+"Did you lose many friends at Oudenarde, Monsieur Kennedy?" Anne
+asked.
+
+"I lost my two greatest friends," Desmond said. "At least, I fear
+that both are dead. They were the two who escaped with me from the
+English prison. They, with Monsieur d'Eyncourt, another of
+Berwick's aides-de-camp, started with me to carry orders to the
+troops, who were all but surrounded by the enemy. We went by
+different roads, to increase the chances of one of us getting
+there.
+
+"I succeeded with but this comparatively trifling wound," and he
+pointed to his empty sleeve, "but none of the other three got
+through, nor did their names appear when the lists were exchanged
+of the prisoners captured. Therefore, I have no doubt that all
+fell in the performance of their duty. We had been great friends,
+ever since I came out, and their loss has greatly affected me."
+
+"You are young, and will find fresh friends," the baron said,
+briskly. "Do not let us dwell on the past. You have now to apply
+all your energy to getting strong, and if you show as much vigour
+in that, as in other matters, I hope that in a month's time you
+will be well on the road towards complete recovery."
+
+"I mean to try hard, Baron," Desmond said, with a smile. "If I
+continue to gain strength as quickly as I have done during the
+journey, I shall certainly insist, before long, on being
+considered convalescent."
+
+Day by day, indeed, his strength increased. At first he wandered
+about in the park, accompanied by Philip and Anne, for the baron,
+although somewhat recovered from his attack of gout, still walked
+with difficulty. In a week, he again took to horse exercise, and
+was ere long able to join in hunting and hawking parties.
+
+The house was gay, for the baron, as soon as Desmond was able to take
+his share in conversation, invited many of the neighbouring gentry to
+the chateau, and introduced him to them as the man who had done so
+much for his daughter and himself. Several entertainments were given,
+at which the chateau was thrown open to all comers, in honour partly
+of Desmond and partly of the approaching marriage of the baron's
+daughter to Monsieur de la Vallee.
+
+This had been arranged to take place in September. Before that
+time arrived, Desmond had completely recovered his strength, and
+being now fit for service, was anxious to join. But his friends
+would not hear of his departure until after the marriage; and as
+news came that Lille had been captured by the allies, and it was
+certain that both armies would soon go into winter quarters, and
+would fight no more that year, he allowed himself to be persuaded
+to stay.
+
+The siege had been one of the most terrible in history. The place
+was nobly defended, and its conquest cost the allies dearly,
+twelve thousand being killed and wounded, and over seven thousand
+succumbing to diseases; while of the garrison, nearly seventeen
+thousand strong, but four thousand five hundred remained alive at
+the time it capitulated. Its fall caused general consternation
+throughout France, for it opened the road to Paris, and during the
+winter Louis made strenuous efforts to obtain peace; but the terms
+demanded by the allies were so onerous that the negotiations were
+broken off.
+
+In spite of the general distress throughout the country, the
+wedding was a gay one.
+
+Desmond had written to the Duke of Berwick, who was now in Paris,
+saying that he was fit for duty, and would report himself at the
+end of the month; and, on the day before he was about to leave
+Pointdexter, he received a reply from him.
+
+It ran as follows:
+
+Dear Monsieur Kennedy:
+
+I am heartily glad to hear of your restoration to health. I
+mentioned you to His Majesty today, who was pleased to speak very
+highly of you.
+
+The campaign is virtually at an end, for the present year. His
+Majesty has informed me that various changes will be made in the
+spring. Marshal de Villars is to replace the Duke of Vendome in
+the command of the northern army. The latter has been unfortunate,
+and misfortune on the part of a soldier is regarded as next door
+to a crime. Certainly the defeat at Oudenarde was not his fault,
+but had he taken my advice, Lille might have been saved. Doubtless
+he was as much dissatisfied with me as I was with him, and perhaps
+with reason; for, as you know, I am not accustomed to mince my
+phrases. However, as His Majesty was pleased to say, it is evident
+that having two generals acting together, each with an independent
+command, is a mistake, and one that should not be again committed.
+Therefore, next spring I am to take the command of an army in
+Dauphiny, and to check the Austrians and Italians.
+
+He said, "If you can spare him, Duke, I should be glad if you
+would let me have this young Irishman for a time. I shall promote
+him to the rank of captain, for the great service he rendered in
+carrying, as you say, at grievous risk and with the loss of his
+hand, the order to the troops at Diepenbeck to scatter during the
+night, thus saving me at least ten thousand of my soldiers. I
+shall also settle upon him a pension of fifty louis a year, for
+the loss of his hand. I will send him to Spain, having had several
+complaints from the Duke of Orleans" (who, as you know, is now in
+command there) "of the incompetence of many of his staff".
+
+I said that, although I had found you a most zealous and useful
+officer, and had a warm regard for you, I would of course accede
+to His Majesty's wishes in the matter. Enclosed in this letter is
+the order for you to join the Duke of Orleans, and a private
+letter from myself to the duke, giving a sketch of your services
+and exploits, which will doubtless give you, at once, a place in
+his favour.
+
+I do not think that this war will last very much longer. France is
+well-nigh ruined by the sacrifices she has made, and the drain
+upon the allies must be almost as great. Therefore, I trust that
+another campaign will bring it to an end. If not, you may be
+assured that when the duke no longer requires your services--and
+it is probable that, after a year's campaigning, he will be
+heartily tired with the difficulties that he, as I did, will meet
+with from the procrastination and general stupidity of the
+Spanish--you will be free to return to me, and I shall be glad to
+number you again among the members of my staff.
+
+Desmond was sorry to leave the service of the duke, but consoled
+himself with the hope that it would be only temporary; and the
+prospect of a year's campaigning, in a new country, was by no
+means displeasing to him. Therefore, after writing a suitable
+letter to the duke, he took leave of the Baron Pointdexter, with
+many thanks for his kindness, and, attended by Mike, started for
+Spain.
+
+"It's glad I am to be on the move again, Captain Kennedy," the
+soldier said, as they rode away. "Sure, your honour, idleness is
+not good for a man, especially when he has lashings of the best of
+food and drink. When I came to buckle on my sword belt, this
+morning, I found it would not meet within three inches, and the
+coatee is so tight that I feel as if I was suffocated."
+
+"You will soon work it down again, Mike. From what I hear of
+Spain, there is no fear of your getting too much food there. Rough
+work and small rations are, I hear, the rule."
+
+"I am ready for a good spell then, your honour. I hardly know
+myself now, for I am flabby and short of wind. Still, I am sorry
+to leave the chateau, for I have had the best time I ever had, in
+my life. Everyone was mighty kind, and seemed to think that I had
+done great things in helping to rescue Miss Anne, whereas I did
+nothing at all, except to follow you."
+
+
+
+Chapter 14: A Mission.
+
+
+On arriving at Madrid in the first week in December, 1708,
+Desmond, after putting up at an hotel, and changing the uniform in
+which he travelled for his dress suit, proceeded to the
+headquarters of the Duke of Orleans, and sent in his name,
+together with Berwick's letter of introduction. In a few minutes
+he was shown into his room. The duke looked at him in some
+surprise.
+
+"Are you Captain Kennedy?"
+
+"I am, Your Royal Highness."
+
+"The Duke of Berwick has very strongly recommended you to me,
+saying that you had performed excellent service under him, and
+that he parted with you, with regret, at the express wish of His
+Majesty. He speaks of you as a young officer, but I was hardly
+prepared to see one so youthful. He says that you are devoted to
+your work, active and intelligent as well as brave; and as such
+your arrival is very welcome to me, for although excellent in
+battle, I own that my officers are less devoted to the hard work
+and detail that are as necessary as bravery on a general's staff.
+
+"By the way, I seem to have heard your name before. Let me see, it
+was in connection, was it not, with that affair of the Marquis de
+Tulle and Baron de Pointdexter's daughter?"
+
+"I certainly had the good fortune to take part in that affair,
+sir."
+
+"The king himself was pleased to tell me the details of that
+adventure, and to speak very highly of your courage and energy in
+carrying it out. And so, you are really the hero of that affair?
+He said that you were a young ensign in O'Brien's Irish regiment.
+You have risen rapidly, sir, for it is but eighteen months since
+it took place."
+
+"His Majesty graciously promoted me to the rank of lieutenant when
+I was appointed by the Duke of Berwick to his staff. I obtained my
+next step after the battle of Oudenarde, for carrying a despatch
+to the force cut off in the village of Diepenbeck, in which
+service I received a wound which resulted in the loss of my left
+hand. I was several weeks in hospital, and then obtained sick
+leave and went down for two months to Baron de Pointdexter, which
+visit resulted in my complete restoration to health. At the end of
+that time the Duke of Berwick, who had also returned from the
+army, was good enough to recommend me to His Majesty, and he
+thereupon promoted me and appointed me to join your staff."
+
+"If Marshal Berwick spoke approvingly of your conduct, Captain
+Kennedy, it is in itself a sufficient recommendation, for the duke
+is not easily satisfied. I am sure that I shall find you a
+valuable acquisition to my staff."
+
+The duke invited Desmond to dine with him that evening, and
+presented him to several of his staff who were among the company.
+These were, for the most part, personal friends and associates of
+the duke; gallant gentlemen, but wholly ignorant of war, and
+adverse to hard work, and it was not long before Desmond found
+that his services were called into requisition whenever it was
+necessary that a despatch should be carried to a distance. He was
+by no means sorry that this should be the case, for he soon tired
+of the stiffness and ceremony of the Spanish Court, and of the
+conversation (chiefly relating to ladies in Paris, whose very
+names were unknown to him) among the French officers, and it was a
+relief to him, indeed, when he could get away from attendance at
+headquarters, and enjoy an evening's talk with the officers of one
+or other of the four Irish regiments there.
+
+Many of these expeditions were attended by considerable danger,
+for the wars that had for some years devastated the country had
+resulted in general disorder. Armed bands, under the pretence of
+acting in the interest of one claimant or other to the throne,
+traversed the country, pillaging the villages, driving off flocks
+and herds to the mountains, and ruthlessly slaying any who
+ventured to offer the smallest opposition. Catalonia and Valencia
+had been the scene of the greater portion of the conflicts between
+the rival claimants. Throughout the rest of the country the
+population looked on apathetically at the struggle for mastery,
+caring but little which of the two foreign princes reigned over
+them; but, in the out-of-the-way districts, the wilder spirits
+left their homes in numbers, enticed by the prospects of plunder,
+under the leading of one or other of the partisan chiefs.
+
+Desmond had, from the moment of his arrival, spent the greater
+portion of his spare time in the study of Spanish, and, aided much
+by his knowledge of French, had made rapid progress, and in three
+months was able to converse fairly in it. It was, indeed,
+essential for his work, as without it he could not have made his
+way about, and safely delivered the orders of which he was the
+bearer.
+
+In the beginning of March, the duke sent for him.
+
+"I have been greatly pleased, Captain Kennedy, with the activity
+that you have displayed, and am going to make a further call upon
+you. This mission is of greater importance than any on which you
+have hitherto been engaged, and is one which, ordinarily, would be
+entrusted to an officer of higher rank; but I feel that I cannot
+do better than place it in your hands. From what we learn, I
+believe that it is the intention of the enemy to commence the
+campaign by crossing the frontier, near Badajos. By so doing, they
+can either follow the valley of the Guadiana to the sources of the
+river, and then come down into Valencia; or they could cross the
+sierras, come down into the valley of the Tagus, and march on
+Madrid.
+
+"In the first place, I wish a report as to the state of the
+fortifications of Badajos, and the efficiency of its garrison. I
+am, of course, acquainted with the official reports, sent by the
+Spanish commander of the town to his Government, but I have come
+to place no faith whatever in Spanish reports, which, for the most
+part, are a tissue of falsehoods. Your first duty, then, will be
+to give me as complete a report as possible of the state of things
+there; of your impressions of the capacity of the governor, as
+shown by his preparations; also of the morale of the troops. In
+the next place, I shall be glad of any information you can gather
+of the country beyond the frontier, and the state of the roads in
+all that neighbourhood. Here, again, the native reports are
+absolutely untrustworthy. The line of the enemy's advance would be
+either direct from Lisbon through Vicosa, or up the Tagus, which
+offers them great facilities for carriage, and down through
+Portalegre and Alvas.
+
+"During the past four years, there has been a good deal of
+fighting near the frontier, but the reports of the officers
+commanding the Spanish forces there are devoid of any practical
+information as to the roads on our side of the boundary. As it has
+been resolved to give the enemy battle, as soon as he crosses the
+frontier, it is most important that I should know the best lines
+by which troops can move, the state of the bridges, and the
+positions in which a battle on a large scale can best be fought.
+
+"You see, the mission is an important one, and I selected you for
+it as a proof of the confidence I feel in your ability. While
+carrying out this duty you shall have the temporary rank of major,
+as it will less ruffle the susceptibility of the Spaniards, if an
+officer of that rank be employed, than if a captain be sent to
+institute such enquiries.
+
+"You will, of course, be provided with a letter to the Governor of
+Badajos, couched in such terms that he will not consider your
+mission has any reference to himself, its object being to discover
+whether the magazines at Badajos are sufficiently well supplied to
+admit of their being, if necessary, drawn upon for the subsistence
+of the army; also, whether the garrison needs strengthening, in
+case the enemy should lay siege to the town before our army is at
+hand to give battle. Thus you will ostensibly confine your
+enquiries to the amount of provisions and ammunition, and consult
+the governor as to whether he considers the force at his disposal
+sufficient for the defence of the fortress against a vigorous
+attack. Fortunately, the Spanish methods are so slow that, before
+you get these particulars, you will have ample time to ascertain
+the points as to which I am chiefly concerned.
+
+"You will be furnished with a native guide, well acquainted with
+the passes of the sierras between the Tagus and the Guadiana. This
+part of your journey will not be unattended with danger, for the
+mountains swarm with bands of partisans; that is to say, bandits.
+I shall, however, give you an order, to the officer in command of
+the garrison at Toledo, to furnish you with an escort of ten
+troopers under an officer, to conduct you across the mountains.
+Four of these will accompany you to Badajos, and remain with you
+until you return to Toledo. Once in the valley of the Guadiana,
+you should have little chance of falling in with any bands of
+guerrillas, but an escort will add to your weight and importance
+in the eyes of the Spaniards."
+
+"I feel greatly honoured, Your Royal Highness, by your selecting
+me for the mission, and will carry it out to the best of my
+ability."
+
+"In an hour the papers will be ready for you, and you can start at
+daybreak tomorrow."
+
+"We are going on a long trip this time, Mike."
+
+"Back to France, your honour?"
+
+"No; we are going to the western frontier, by Badajos."
+
+"It makes no difference to me, sir, where we are going; but, in
+truth, I shall be glad to go anywhere, for I am mightily sick of
+this town, where the people have no great love for the French, and
+the best part of them seem to look down upon us soldiers, as if we
+were dirt under their feet. It is unsafe to go through the streets
+alone at night. A score of men have, since we came here, been
+found lying dead with a knife between their ribs."
+
+"Yes; the population here is very much divided, Mike, and even those
+who are favourable to Philip have no love for the foreign soldiers
+whose bayonets keep him on the throne. The duke has, many times,
+made formal complaints to the king and the city authorities. Philip
+has given strict orders for the arrest of bad characters, but the
+city civil authorities protest that they cannot lay hands upon them,
+and I believe have never taken the slightest trouble to do so."
+
+"How long shall we be away, your honour?"
+
+"I should say, a month. I am to have temporary rank as major,
+while engaged on this business. Anyone under that grade would
+receive but little courtesy from the Spaniards."
+
+"They are a mighty haughty lot," Mike grumbled. "I believe they
+think that, when the flood came, the Spanish grandees had an ark
+all to themselves, as they could not be expected to put up with a
+conveyance full of animals."
+
+Desmond laughed.
+
+"They haven't yet taken in the fact that Spain is no longer the
+great power she was when she was mistress of half of Europe. They
+were fine fighters then, Mike. For my part, I own that I cannot
+understand how it is they have fallen off in that respect; for
+certainly, without our troops, they would make but a poor stand
+against the Portuguese, backed up by the English and Dutch."
+
+"I have not seen them fighting yet, sir, but to my mind people so
+fond of using their knives are not likely to be of much account,
+when it comes to manly, straightforward fighting.
+
+"Well, your honour, if you are to go as a major, you will need
+some slight alterations in your uniform--more gold lace, and such
+like. So I had best see about it, at once."
+
+"I did not think of that, Mike; but you are right. I don't know
+whether, as I only hold temporary rank, I have a right to wear the
+uniform of a field officer; but, as the duke wishes me to be able
+to speak with some authority, there can be no harm in making the
+change, and the additions can easily be taken off, upon my
+return."
+
+"The duke ought to have given you the full rank, instead of the
+temporary one, sir. You have done more work, since you came here,
+than all the colonels and majors on his staff."
+
+"As far as work goes that may be so, Mike; but as the work
+consisted in carrying despatches about on horseback, it certainly
+affords no claim for promotion. And, indeed, I have no wish
+whatever for it. I am already the youngest captain in the service,
+except the young nobles who got their commissions as colonels,
+without even serving a day in inferior rank. I feel uncomfortable
+now when I go to our regiments, to see men who have been years in
+the service, and gone through many a desperate action, still
+lieutenants; while I, after two years' service, and still under
+nineteen, am a captain."
+
+"Yes, sir; but you know that you saved eight or ten thousand men
+to France at Oudenarde, and you lost a hand in the service of the
+country. That would count for a great deal."
+
+"It counts for something, no doubt, Mike, but many of these
+officers have risked their lives a score of times, and been
+wounded frequently, though they may not have lost a limb."
+
+"Ah well, sir!" Mike said, philosophically, "Luck is everything.
+And who would go soldiering, if it was not so? When going into
+battle, everyone knows that a lot of his comrades will be killed,
+but he trusts to his luck to get through safely. One man gets
+promoted and another doesn't, and he hopes that luck will come his
+way next time. I don't say that your honour's promotion has been
+luck, but you have had luck in being on the staff of the Duke of
+Berwick, and everyone knows that it is the staff officers who get
+the credit and promotion, while the men who do most of the
+fighting get passed over. There would be nothing to say against
+that if, as in your honour's case, a man was chosen for the staff
+because he had done something that showed that he was fit for it.
+But it isn't so here. If a man belongs to a good family, and has
+interest, he gets a good appointment; and it is mighty seldom that
+a man is taken from his regiment, and put on to the staff, because
+he has done something which showed he was a good soldier."
+
+"That is so, Mike. There is no denying it. And I believe it is one
+reason why so many disasters have befallen the French army. The
+generals are, as a rule, good, and the soldiers are excellent, but
+the staff are generally altogether incompetent, and seem to
+consider that the fact that they are nobles renders it unnecessary
+for them to give attention to details, or to be more than
+ornamental figures in the general's train. And when we see the
+authority of Vendome overruled by a young prince, who is grandson
+of the king, and nothing else, one must not be surprised that it
+is the same all through the army."
+
+That evening, Desmond received a packet containing his appointment
+as major while on special service, details of instructions as to
+the points to be attended to, and letters from the duke to the
+commandant of the garrison at Toledo, and from Philip to the
+Governor at Badajos.
+
+The next morning he started at daybreak, accompanied by Mike, and
+arrived that evening at Toledo. Here he presented his letter to
+the commandant.
+
+"Very well, sir," the officer said, when he had read it. "At what
+hour do you wish the escort and guide to be ready in the morning?"
+
+"I should like to start as early as possible, Colonel. I myself,
+being well mounted, might cross the sierra in a day; but the
+troopers' horses could not do that."
+
+"You would not gain anything if they could, Major Kennedy, for
+even if your horse could carry you over sixty or seventy miles of
+mountain roads in a day, you would certainly need a couple of
+days' rest before proceeding farther. If you get as far as
+Enmedio, which is in the heart of the sierra, you will have done
+well. You will then have another long day's ride down to Ciudad
+Real, from which place the officer with six of the troopers will
+return. The general says nothing about a noncommissioned officer,
+but I shall take it upon myself to send one to accompany you, with
+the four men. It will take a good deal of trouble off your hands."
+
+"I am much obliged to you, Colonel."
+
+"Now that we have finished business," the officer said, "we can
+talk of other things. You will, of course, put up here. I have two
+or three spare rooms, and the accommodation at the inns is
+wretched. I am always very glad when an officer rides through,
+because we hear little enough about what is passing, and as there
+is no sort of sociability among the Spaniards, life is very dull
+here, and one is very glad of the change."
+
+"Thank you, Colonel. I will gladly accept your invitation."
+
+The colonel rang a bell, and ordered a servitor, who answered, to
+show Major Kennedy's servant where to put up his master's horses
+and his own, to bring up the officer's valises, and to make the
+soldier comfortable below.
+
+"We shall sup in half an hour," he said to Desmond, when the man
+had left. "Two of my majors are going to share the meal."
+
+As soon as the valises were brought up, Desmond changed his
+uniform, got rid of the dust of the road, and was just ready when
+a servant knocked at the door and said that the supper was served.
+The meal was a pleasant one. The three French officers were
+anxious to hear the last news that had reached Madrid from France.
+The conversation did not flag for a moment during the meal.
+
+After this was over, and cigars were lighted--for the officers had
+all adopted the custom of the country--the colonel said
+courteously, "Would you mind telling us, Major Kennedy, how it is
+that you, who by your name are Irish, although you speak excellent
+French, have made your way so rapidly as to be already a major?"
+
+"Not at all, Colonel. I am, myself, as much surprised at it as you
+may be. But, really, my present rank is only temporary. I am going
+down to Badajos, on a special mission for the Duke of Orleans, and
+as he thought that I should be received better were I a field
+officer, instead of captain, he has given me the temporary rank of
+major while so employed.
+
+"I will briefly tell you how I obtained the other steps. The first
+was given me, by the king, on my appointment as aide-de-camp to
+the Duke of Berwick; His Majesty being good enough to take an
+interest in me, owing to a little adventure in which I had become
+involved. It concerned, I may say, the almost accidental rescue of
+a lady, who had been carried off by a nobleman of the court."
+
+"I remember now," the colonel said. "The lady was Mademoiselle de
+Pointdexter, and her abductor Vicomte de Tulle. It happened a
+month or so before our regiment left Paris for Spain, and was the
+chief topic of talk. I recall your name, now, in connection with
+the affair, and how warmly everyone spoke of your gallantry. Well,
+Major, how did you gain your next step?"
+
+"I had the good fortune to be the only one who survived, of four
+aides-de-camp who were sent off by the Duke of Berwick, at
+Oudenarde, to make their way through the allied lines with orders,
+to the division cut off from the rest of the army in the village
+of Diepenbeck, to disperse and make off across the country, as
+best they could. My comrades were all killed, but I was lucky
+enough to succeed in reaching the village uninjured, with the
+exception of a ball in the wrist, which caused the loss of my
+hand, and, I may say, almost of my life. It was because of the
+favourable report, which the duke was pleased to make of this
+service, that I received my rank as captain."
+
+"It was well earned, too, sir," the colonel said warmly. "I
+confess, I thought when you arrived that, although Irish by name,
+you must have had some very powerful influence at your back to
+have risen so early. Unhappily, promotion often bears no relation
+whatever to merit; and one sees young nobles, with no other
+recommendation than that of their birth, placed over the heads of
+officers of five-and-twenty years service. No one is jealous of a
+man who owes his rise to brilliant deeds of courage, or signal
+ability; but it is galling to see these young popinjays thrust
+forward, simply by family influence."
+
+In passing over the hills the next day, a large party of armed men
+made their appearance, suddenly, on a height above; but, seeing
+that an attack was likely to meet with a stout resistance, and as
+little booty would be obtainable, they did not interfere with
+their passage. Desmond congratulated himself on having an escort,
+for it would have gone hard with him, had he been accompanied only
+by Mike.
+
+On the fifth day after leaving Madrid he arrived at Badajos, with the
+sergeant, the four troopers, and Mike. After some formalities--for
+the town, being close to the frontier, was liable at any moment to be
+suddenly attacked--Desmond was conducted to the governor, a pompous
+Spanish officer.
+
+"Are you yourself Major Kennedy?" he asked, looking with some
+surprise at his young visitor.
+
+"My name is Kennedy, sir, and I have the honour of being major,
+and to serve on the staff of his grace, the Duke of Orleans. I am
+the bearer of a letter to you from His Majesty, King Philip."
+
+The Spaniard took the letter and read it, and Desmond could see,
+by the expression of his countenance, that he was by no means
+pleased.
+
+"I do not understand," he said coldly, "why an officer should have
+been specially despatched to obtain information which I have
+already duly furnished."
+
+"I understood from the Duke of Orleans, sir, that as news has been
+received that the enemy's plans were to cross the frontier near
+this town, it became a matter of special importance to see that it
+was sufficiently supplied with provisions, and munitions of war to
+stand a siege. It has been found more than once that, owing to the
+culpable neglect of subordinates, fortresses when besieged were by
+no means so well supplied with provisions, powder and shot, as had
+been supposed. Naturally, the governor of a fortress like this,
+with a considerable garrison, is too much occupied to personally
+superintend all these matters, and must leave them in the hands of
+his subordinates, who on their part commit them to those of
+sergeants and storekeepers; so that, while everything is reported
+to be ready, there are really deficiencies. A waste often takes
+place in the distribution of stores, and the matter was so
+important that the king requested the duke to send one of his
+staff to give you every assistance, and to receive your
+suggestions, which will be complied with to their full extent. As
+your last report was sent in some three months back, necessarily
+considerable changes have taken place, in that time."
+
+"Well, sir, I will obey His Majesty's orders, and give you every
+facility. My officers shall be instructed to open such magazines
+as you may select, and you will be then able personally to judge
+as to the quantity and condition of the stores. It will, of
+course, be impossible, unless with an immense expenditure of
+labour, to go through the whole of the magazines and to reckon up
+their contents; but as many as you wish shall be opened, and a
+party of soldiers told off to count the bales and cases."
+
+"A very few will suffice, sir. Of course, in the event of a battle
+being fought and a reverse occurring, the enemy might sit down
+before your town. You would be exposed to a long siege, for it
+might be some time before the army was again in a position to
+advance and fight another battle, or raise the siege. I have
+little doubt that everything will be found in excellent order, but
+should there be any deficiencies, the duke assured me that they
+would be at once made good."
+
+"If you will call tomorrow morning, sir," the governor said, "I
+will have some of the officials, in whose charge these matters
+are, placed at your disposal; but I am convinced that you will
+find that my reports on the stores and ammunition in hand are
+fully borne out."
+
+"The governor is, as I expected, a good deal put out, Mike,"
+Desmond said as he rejoined his follower, who was waiting outside
+with the horses. "Now, let us find out the best hotel."
+
+"Didn't he ask you to stay with him, your honour?" Mike asked in
+surprise.
+
+"No. He is much too grand a man for that, and besides, he may have
+his wife and children with him; and however much a Spaniard may
+place his house and all within it at your service, it is very
+seldom that he invites a stranger to enter it. Moreover, glad as
+they may be to have French help in fighting their battles, they
+look with suspicion and dislike upon an individual Frenchman.
+
+"Besides, I fancy I shall find that these stores and magazines by
+no means tally with the report sent in by the governor. I heard
+the Duke of Berwick one day speaking about it, and he said there
+was corruption and dishonesty among their officials, from the
+highest to the lowest. It is probable that both the king and the
+Duke of Orleans have the same opinion, and that it was for this
+reason that they sent me here, in order to assure them that the
+fortress is as well supplied as has been stated. With the other
+papers, I have received a copy of the governor's report, although
+I did not think it necessary to tell him so."
+
+The next morning, on going to the governor's, Desmond found a
+number of officials assembled there.
+
+"These are the officers in charge of the stores and magazines,"
+the governor said. "Colonel Mendez will accompany you, and will
+see that everything is done to facilitate your examination."
+
+The governor bowed formally. Desmond returned his salute, and then
+went down with the Spanish colonel, the other officials following.
+He saw that there was an expression of malicious pleasure in the
+colonel's face, and guessed that he was, by no means, sorry at the
+investigation that was to take place.
+
+"I think, sir," Desmond said, "that it will not be necessary for
+us to have all these officials going round with us. It will be
+impossible, in one day, to do more than examine one department. As
+ammunition is the most important of all stores, I would suggest
+that we take only those in charge of the war material."
+
+"Very good;" and, turning to those behind, he said: "For today,
+all those save the officers in charge of the magazines can be
+relieved from this duty. Their turn will come tomorrow, or next
+day."
+
+With the exception of five or six, all moved away.
+
+"We have three magazines in the town," the colonel went on, "so as
+to lessen the chance of our resources being destroyed by a single
+blow. There is the Central magazine, another that is known as the
+San Juan magazine, and the Western magazine."
+
+"We may as well visit the Central one first, as, no doubt, that is
+the most important one."
+
+As they went on, a party of twenty soldiers, who had been drawn up
+there, fell in behind, while Mike and two troopers of his escort
+also, at his orders, accompanied them. The magazine was formed in
+what had formerly been an old castle, but which was now used for
+another purpose, that of a store, its thick walls affording
+protection against any but very heavy missiles. On entering what
+had been the courtyard, Desmond saw that the greater portion of it
+was occupied by storehouses, massively built, and covered by some
+five or six feet of earth.
+
+"The first of these on the right contains musketry ammunition,"
+Colonel Mendez said, "the next two contain cannonballs; powder is
+stored in the three houses at the farther end, and the three on
+the left side contain hand grenades, fuses for mines, signal
+rockets, and other miscellanies, such as brimstone."
+
+"We will examine number one first," Desmond said. "Which is the
+officer in charge?"
+
+One of the officials stepped forward, with a key. Desmond saw that
+his face was pale, and that he had a sullen look.
+
+"I will ask you, before we enter," he said, "how often do you take
+stock of your stores? I suppose when the governor sends in his
+half-yearly report?"
+
+"We do not do it that way at all," the man said. "I have a book.
+It was given to me by the officer I succeeded. Here it is. You
+will see that he handed over so many barrels of cartridges. On one
+side of the page I put down the number of barrels issued, and on
+the other the number I receive, and thus, at any time, without
+disturbing the contents of the store, I can state the number of
+barrels it contains."
+
+"Then how long have you held this position, sir?"
+
+"I have been in charge of this store, and of those used for powder
+in the cellars underneath the castle, for ten years."
+
+"The man whom you succeeded--how long had he been here?"
+
+"I believe he had been here for twenty years, or more."
+
+"And his system of keeping account was the same as yours?"
+
+"Precisely. He handed his books to me, and I have kept mine in the
+same way."
+
+"Then it is a fact, if I understand you rightly, that there has
+been no taking of stock for the past thirty years?"
+
+"It was not necessary," the officer said, in a surly tone. "There
+can be no mistake possible, considering the way in which we made
+our entries."
+
+They now entered the store. It was some sixty feet long and forty
+feet wide, with pillars of masonry along the centre to support the
+weight of the roof. It was lighted only by small loopholes in the
+thick walls. Four of the soldiers carried lanterns, and they were
+about to enter, when Desmond said:
+
+"There is no loose powder lying about, I suppose?"
+
+"None," the officer replied. "The barrels were all carefully
+examined before being taken into the store. They are, as you can
+see, strongly made. A leakage is out of the question, unless by
+any accident one should fall off the pile and burst; but such a
+thing has never happened, as far as I know."
+
+"I see, by your book, that there should be three thousand four
+hundred and eighty-two barrels, each containing five hundred
+cartridges. Certainly an ample supply, even for a prolonged
+siege."
+
+The barrels were piled in four tiers, one above another, forming a
+wall on each side of a central path, seven feet wide.
+
+"Give me your hand, Mike," Desmond said to his follower, and,
+standing upon it, he was able to scramble on to the top.
+
+"Twelve barrels deep," he said, as he descended. "Now, let us
+count the number in each line."
+
+The wall of barrels extended only some two-thirds of the length of
+the stores, and there were thirty barrels in each line. He made a
+rapid calculation.
+
+"That is three thousand two hundred, but I see that, in addition,
+there is a small pile on each side, beyond the others, which would
+about make up the correct total. Your record is strictly
+accurate."
+
+The official took up the lantern, as if the matter was now
+finished, but Desmond said:
+
+"No, sir. I have but begun; and my instructions were to see how
+much musket ammunition there was here, at present. I only know how
+many barrels there are.
+
+"And now, Colonel, I will ask you to call your men in, and set
+them to work. I wish two passages made through each of these piles
+of barrels. Three feet wide will be sufficient."
+
+"It would be very dangerous to move them," the official said
+hastily.
+
+"Not if it is carefully done. You tell me the barrels are strong,
+and that there is no leakage. Even if this should not be the case,
+there is little fear of the powder coming in contact with the
+candles in these lanterns; and besides, as the powder is in
+cartridges, it would not leak out even if one of the barrels were
+to burst."
+
+The soldiers had set to work at four points, chosen at hazard by
+Desmond. The barrels, as they were taken down, were ranged along
+on each side of the central path. When three lines had been
+cleared out, one of the soldiers gave an exclamation.
+
+"This is lighter than the one I carried out last!" he said.
+
+"Carry it out into the courtyard," Desmond said. "I should like to
+look at the contents."
+
+It was taken out to the courtyard, and one end carefully taken
+out.
+
+"You see, Colonel," Desmond said, as he looked at its contents,
+"you would have been reduced to great straits, long before you
+expected it."
+
+The colonel, who belonged to the artillery, looked into the
+barrel, which was full of earth.
+
+"Empty it out!" Desmond ordered.
+
+They did so. There was not a single cartridge in it.
+
+"This is scandalous!" the colonel exclaimed. "I did not expect
+that everything would be found right, but I had no idea of such
+villainy as this!"
+
+He turned to the men.
+
+"Arrest the commissary, at once," he said.
+
+But that official was nowhere to be found. He had slipped away, as
+soon as the men began to take down the barrels. Some soldiers were
+at once sent off in search of him.
+
+"We will continue the work," Desmond said, "and see how
+extensively this fraud has been carried on."
+
+The same result was met with in each of the openings. The first
+three lines consisted of barrels filled with cartridges; the seven
+lines behind contained nothing but earth.
+
+"You see, Colonel, instead of having over three thousand two
+hundred barrels of cartridges, you have less than a thousand. It
+is almost beyond belief! It is clear that this fellow, and
+probably the man who was in charge before him, have been in
+collusion with the contractors for these cartridges, and allowed
+them to send in seven barrels of earth for every three of
+cartridges. No doubt, they calculated that there was little chance
+of the fraud being detected--never, indeed, until there was a
+prolonged siege--for they would naturally serve out the barrels
+from the front row, as they were required, filling their places
+with fresh ones as supplies came in."
+
+The other storehouses were now examined. The number of cannonball
+alone tallied with the account. There were large deficiencies in
+the store of powder, and, indeed, among almost all the other
+munitions.
+
+"It is infinitely worse than I thought," the colonel said, "and I
+fear that the storekeepers are not the only people concerned in
+these frauds."
+
+"Now, Colonel, if you do not mind, I should like to go to one of
+the provision stores at once. Possibly, after what we have
+discovered, some pretext to stop further examination may be
+invented, if we wait till tomorrow."
+
+Great as had been the fraud in the magazines, that in the supplies
+of provisions was even greater. There was a deficiency of many
+hundreds of sacks of flour and beans. The meat stores were
+entirely empty, although they should have contained a large number
+of tierces of salted beef. This was a matter of minor importance,
+for in case of the approach of an enemy, the people of the country
+round would drive their cattle into the town, and, indeed, the
+allowance of meat to a Spanish soldier was so small that he could
+do well without it, existing entirely upon bread and fried beans.
+Of wine there was scarce half the amount indicated. A great number
+of the barrels had been filled only with water.
+
+It was late in the afternoon when the work ceased.
+
+"I should require a fortnight," Desmond said, "to get accurate
+figures. This, however, is comparatively unimportant. It is quite
+sufficient to know that in no case is there half the amount,
+either of ammunition or of provisions, given in the governor's
+last report, and that fraud on a large scale has been carried on;
+and I cannot but think that some men, at least, of higher rank
+than these storekeepers must have been privy to the affair."
+
+"There has certainly been something wrong in the supply of
+clothes, Major Kennedy. My men have had no new ones served out to
+them for the past year and a half, although I have made repeated
+applications during the past two months."
+
+"Yes; I noticed when I walked about in the town, yesterday, that
+many of the troops were almost in rags, and I have no doubt there
+has been fraud in the clothing department, as well as in all the
+others."
+
+"Well, sir, as a Spaniard I lament this terrible exposure. Blame,
+however, must not be laid entirely upon the military. The supply
+of provisions of all kinds, of cloth for clothing, and, indeed, of
+everything but guns and ammunition, is in the hands of the junta
+of the province, and of the civil authority here. Many of the
+members must be concerned in the matter, and I have no doubt that
+the officials here are heavily bribed to shut their eyes, and to
+arrange matters so that the frauds may escape attention.
+
+"I know that once, when I proposed to the governor to examine some
+of the barrels of cartridges as they came in, he answered me very
+sharply, and told me that my business was to work the guns, and
+not to meddle with the duties of the storekeeper."
+
+"Then do you think, Colonel?--"
+
+"I think nothing," the officer replied. "The governor is the
+governor, and it is not for me to discuss his conduct in any way,
+nor even to admit the possibility of his knowing of this affair."
+
+Only two or three of the storekeepers had been arrested. The rest
+had slunk away, as soon as they saw how matters were going.
+
+
+
+Chapter 15: Treachery.
+
+
+At this moment an officer came down, and said that the governor
+wished to see Colonel Mendez and Major Kennedy, at once. As they
+entered the room, they saw the governor walking up and down in a
+state of great agitation.
+
+"I hear, Colonel Mendez," he said, stopping before that officer,
+"that you have, on your own authority, placed several of the
+commissariat storekeepers under arrest. What does this mean, sir?"
+
+"It means, sir, that Major Kennedy has discovered enormous
+deficiencies in the stores, and there can be little doubt that a
+number of persons must have been concerned in the matter, besides
+those in charge of the storehouses. Wholesale bribery must have
+been practised, by those who supplied the goods to those whose
+duty it was to receive them."
+
+"I shall order a commission of enquiry to sit at once, and beg
+that you, Colonel Mendez, will send me in a detailed report of the
+matter, which is, I need hardly say, one of extreme gravity."
+
+"I was right," Colonel Mendez said, as they left the governor's
+house. "I suspected that something was wrong, ever since he
+refused to allow me access to the magazines. I have no doubt that
+he has been acting in collusion with the contractors, though he
+may not have been aware of the extent of their rascality, for his
+subordinates may not only have accepted bribes from the
+contractors to carry out the frauds to which the governor may have
+consented, but may also have taken money from these to allow of
+still greater ones to be perpetrated."
+
+"What will he do, do you think, Colonel?"
+
+"He will endeavour, by every means in his power, to prevent any
+word of your discovery from leaking out. And, if I may advise you,
+I should say it would be well that you should take every
+precaution for your own safety. His position is a desperate one,
+for one cannot doubt that your report will be followed by his
+removal from his post, his dismissal from the army, and the
+confiscation of everything of which he is possessed. Therefore, it
+is almost a matter of life and death to him to prevent your report
+from being sent to headquarters, and to have you removed
+altogether. This done, the facts might not leak out. It would be
+supposed, at Madrid, that you had been stabbed by some street
+ruffian. And, although another officer might be sent down to
+report, it is by no means likely that he would go so rigorously
+into matters as you did, but would be contented merely to count
+barrels and bales, without troubling to investigate their
+contents."
+
+"But your evidence would be as strong against him as mine."
+
+"Yes; but that evidence is not yet given. He can, in the first
+place, and I have no doubt will, suppress my report to him. In the
+second place, he would consider it unlikely that I should venture
+to make the matter public, for he has powerful friends at court.
+He is connected with many of the leading families in the province,
+and might rely upon being able to hush the matter up, so long as
+it was known only to the heads of our army, who are not unaware
+that, although the pay of a commander of a fortress is not more
+than sufficient to maintain his position, they, like most other of
+our officials, generally retire with considerable fortunes.
+Therefore, any interference on my part would be more disastrous to
+my prospects than to his.
+
+"It is humiliating to say so, Major Kennedy, but both our civil
+and military systems are rotten to the core. There are, of course,
+honest men in both services, but as a rule corruption is almost
+universal. Still, although he cannot fear me as he must fear you,
+it is possible he may endeavour to make himself safe by removing
+me also from his path; and for a time I shall take good care to
+remain in my own barracks, as much as possible."
+
+"I will be careful also," Desmond said, "and I thank you much for
+the warning, which was needed, for it would never have struck me
+that he would even attempt to suppress the information that I have
+gained; but I see that it will be necessary to be very careful,
+especially in the manner of sending off my reports."
+
+"If I were in your place, I should mount my horse at once, and
+with the troopers of the escort ride straight for Madrid."
+
+"I cannot do that, Colonel, for the examination into the state of
+the stores here was only a part of my instructions, and I must, if
+possible, carry these out to the letter before leaving for Madrid.
+I might, however, send off my despatch by two of the troopers with
+me."
+
+"I think you may take my word for it, Major, that they would never
+reach their destination. Even while we are speaking, a messenger
+may be sent off either to one of these bands in the mountains, or
+to two or three of the contractors--who are, of course, as deeply
+involved as the governor, for there is no doubt of their guilt,
+while no proof can be given to his being a party to it--telling
+them that it is a matter of life and death to them to prevent you
+or your messengers from reaching Madrid."
+
+"The lookout is certainly far from comfortable," Desmond admitted,
+"and I must, tonight, think it over in every way, and decide upon
+what course I had best pursue."
+
+When he reached the hotel, he told Mike what Colonel Mendez had
+said.
+
+"By the powers, your honour, it is a nasty scrape that we seem to
+be in, almost as bad as when you were shut up in that prison in
+London."
+
+"Worse, Mike; for then we knew that we should be tried, but hoped
+that Louis would interfere in our favour, and by threatening
+reprisals obtain our liberty; whereas here we have only ourselves
+to depend upon, and the blow may come at any moment."
+
+"Well, at any rate, your honour, we will see that none get at you
+unbeknown. I will lie down in your room against the door, and if
+the sergeant places a man on guard outside, it is hard if anyone
+gets at you."
+
+"I hardly think the precaution necessary; but there is no saying
+what this man might not do in so desperate a situation, so I will
+tell the sergeant to place a sentry at the door, and to relieve
+him every two hours. I shall think the matter over, and by
+tomorrow morning shall decide whether I had best remain here and
+complete my work, or ride at once to Madrid."
+
+At about two o'clock in the morning Desmond, who had but just
+dropped off to sleep, was aroused by hearing the sentry outside
+his door challenge. There was no answer. All remained quiet. Mike
+leapt to his feet and opened the door.
+
+"What is it?" he asked the sentry.
+
+"I saw two or three men at the end of the corridor. It was too
+dark to make them out clearly. They were coming this way. I
+levelled my carbine and cried, 'Who comes there?' and at once they
+stole away. They could have been after no good, for their steps
+were noiseless, and they must have come up without boots."
+
+"Keep a sharp lookout, sentry," Desmond said, "and see that they
+don't steal up to you, for if they do, you may be stabbed before
+you have time to turn round.
+
+"It is lucky that I carried out your suggestion, Mike, and posted
+a sentry at the door. Of course, these men the sentry saw may not
+have been coming here, but at any rate their conduct was
+suspicious."
+
+In a few minutes Desmond was again asleep. He had had a long day's
+work, and believing that the affair was over, at least for the
+night, he did not even try to keep awake.
+
+As soon as Mike heard, by his breathing, that he was asleep, he
+got up noiselessly and seated himself near the open window, with a
+loaded pistol. An hour passed, and then he heard a slight stir in
+the street. He did not look out, but grasped his pistol tightly.
+
+Their room was on the first floor. Presently, he heard a grating
+sound against the window. It was very dark, and he knelt down so
+that he would be able to make out any figure that showed above the
+windowsill. He thought first of rousing his master, but as he had
+another pistol in his belt, and his sword leaned against the wall,
+ready to his hand, he thought it better to let matters take their
+course.
+
+He had heard no further sound, but presently a round object
+appeared in sight. Stretching out his arm, he fired without a
+moment's hesitation. There was a sound of a heavy fall below,
+followed by some muttered exclamations. In a moment, Desmond was
+on his feet, a pistol which he had laid by his pillow in his
+grasp.
+
+"What is it, Mike?"
+
+"It is only a gentleman who had a fancy for looking in at the
+window, your honour, and I have no doubt would have come in,
+without saying by your leave, if I had not cut the matter short by
+putting a bullet into his forehead. He had some friends down
+below. He came up on a ladder."
+
+He looked out of the window.
+
+"They are taking it down now, your honour. Shall I give them
+another shot?"
+
+"No, Mike; let them go. The lesson has been good enough."
+
+The sentry had also run into the room, on hearing the shot.
+
+"It is all over," Desmond said. "Seeing that you prevented them
+from getting in at the door, they tried the window. Mike has shot
+one of them."
+
+There was a sound of feet and loud talking in the passage, and as
+Desmond went out, the landlord, two of the serving men, and
+several of those staying at the hotel ran up.
+
+"What is it, senor? We heard a shot."
+
+"Yes; a fellow tried to enter my window, by means of a ladder; but
+fortunately my man heard him, and shot him before he came in. No
+doubt it was some prowling marauder, who, seeing my window open,
+thought that there was a chance of plunder."
+
+"Carrambo!" the landlord exclaimed, "then we shall have enquiries,
+and all sorts of trouble."
+
+"I don't think you will," Desmond said quietly. "I fancy he had
+some friends down below, and they will probably carry his body and
+the ladder away, and, if you hold your tongues, nothing more will
+be heard of it.
+
+"Mike, do you and the sentry take a lantern and go down and see."
+
+The landlord looked out of the window.
+
+"As far as I can see, everything is quiet there," he said. "Are
+you sure that your servant was not dreaming?"
+
+"That you will soon ascertain, if you go down with him," Desmond
+said. "I fancy that you will find some traces of the affair
+there."
+
+The landlord, followed by his two servants, went down with the
+soldiers, and then, lighting a lantern and handing it to them,
+went out, keeping carefully behind them.
+
+"There," Mike said, when he stopped under Desmond's window; "does
+that look like a dream?" and he pointed to a patch of blood on the
+pavement.
+
+"It is true enough," the landlord said.
+
+"Pedro and Lopez, fetch pails of water and brooms, and get rid of
+this blood, otherwise we shall be having enquiries made in the
+morning."
+
+Mike returned to his master, at whose door the sergeant and the
+other troopers were standing.
+
+"There is no occasion, sergeant," Desmond had just said, "to keep
+a sentry at the door any longer. We can be quite sure that we
+shall not be disturbed again before morning, and indeed, I am not
+likely to sleep after this."
+
+"Very well, sir; but if you don't mind, I will keep a sentry on
+watch."
+
+"Just as you like, sergeant, but I feel sure there is no occasion
+for it. Still, after what has happened, it may perhaps be wise to
+do so."
+
+"Well, Mike," Desmond said, when they were again alone, "the
+campaign has opened with spirit. This is something like that
+journey with the Baron de Pointdexter, when we expected to be
+attacked every minute."
+
+"Well, we got through that all right, your honour, and it is hard
+if we don't get through this."
+
+At six o'clock, a volley of musketry was fired.
+
+"They are practising early, sir," Mike said.
+
+"It can't be that, Mike. It is too close. They would go beyond the
+outer works to practise, and, by the sound, it is certainly much
+nearer than that, though possibly just outside the walls."
+
+"I will go out and enquire, your honour. When one is at war, it is
+as well to know exactly what the enemy are doing."
+
+"Take one of the troopers with you, Mike. Pierre speaks Spanish
+well."
+
+Mike returned in an hour.
+
+"They have shot all the prisoners we took yesterday," he said. "I
+hear they held a sort of court martial in the evening, at the
+governor's. It did not sit more than ten minutes. They were all
+found guilty of fraud and treachery, and were shot this morning."
+
+"Worse and worse, Mike! Evidently, the governor is determined to
+get rid of all whose evidence might throw any light on this
+matter. After what has happened here, and these summary
+executions, I feel very uncomfortable as to Colonel Mendez. Will
+you go to the artillery barracks with a message from me that, as I
+have my first report to write out, I shall not continue the
+investigations today? Take Pierre with you again."
+
+When Mike returned, Desmond saw that his news was bad.
+
+"The colonel had not been seen when I got there, and his servant
+went up to his room and found him lying dead, stabbed to the
+heart."
+
+"Another witness gone," Desmond said. "An honourable gentleman,
+and a pleasant one. Well, Mike, the matter becomes more and more
+serious. After this there is but one thing open to me, and that is
+to return to Madrid at once. When I relate the circumstances to
+the duke, he will see that, had I endeavoured to carry out the
+rest of his instructions, the chance of my report ever coming to
+hand would have been slight indeed, and it is all important that
+he should get it.
+
+"The question is, shall we mount and ride at once, or shall I go
+and take leave of the governor?"
+
+"Of course, your honour, you can do as you like, but I should say
+that the sooner we are out of this, the better. The longer we stay
+here, the more time he will have to take care we don't get back
+alive.
+
+"There was another thing I did not tell you, sir. As we went to
+the barracks, we passed some cavalry men talking. They were
+arguing that the enemy must be marching this way, for at two
+o'clock last night ten troopers were suddenly called up and sent
+off, the gates being opened for them by order of the governor."
+
+"Just what I expected, Mike. He has written to warn the various
+contractors that the frauds have been discovered, and, no doubt,
+telling them that all messengers from here must be stopped and
+searched, and all reports and documents taken from them; that if I
+come myself, I am to be put out of the way; and that if this can
+be done the matter can be hushed up, as he has taken measures to
+silence all those who know anything about the affair.
+
+"Well, I think you are right. We need not mind saying goodbye to
+this scoundrel, as it would only give him time to perfect his
+arrangements. I have no doubt that he would pretend to be ill, or
+to be engaged in some business that would detain him, and manage
+to keep me waiting some hours before he saw me. Order the sergeant
+to saddle up at once. Let the men eat a meal as quickly as
+possible, and let each put a bottle of wine and a loaf of bread
+into his valise, so that we shall be able to ride without stopping
+anywhere. Say that we shall mount in twenty minutes, and they must
+not wait to polish up their accoutrements. Tell them to put plenty
+of forage before the horses, and not to put the bridles in their
+mouths until the last thing. Let each pour four or five feeds of
+corn into his forage bag.
+
+"When you have given the orders, have your own breakfast. I will
+go downstairs and get something there. I packed my valises while
+you were away."
+
+Exactly twenty minutes later the little troop started. The men
+had, at Desmond's orders, loaded their pistols and short guns.
+Avoiding the principal streets, they rode by narrow lanes until
+they emerged close to the eastern gate. Through this he and his
+followers rode, without question, at a quiet pace until beyond the
+exterior fortifications, across the bridge over the Guadiana, and
+then broke into a canter.
+
+The sergeant and men were not a little surprised at the sudden
+departure, for they had supposed that they would remain for some
+time at Badajos. Desmond called the sergeant up to his side.
+
+"I dare say you are surprised at this sudden move, but you know
+that two attempts were made upon my life last night, and I have no
+doubt that these would be repeated, and perhaps with greater
+success, had I stayed there. You were present yesterday, with two
+of your men, when we discovered that large portions of the stores
+were mere dummies filled with earth. Whether or not the governor
+was a party to the fraud I cannot say, but this morning he had all
+the storekeepers who were arrested shot, and Colonel Mendez, who
+was present at the investigation, was murdered during the night.
+It is evident, therefore, that many people are interested in
+preventing the discovery we made from getting known. Of course,
+the soldiers who assisted would be aware of it, but they would not
+venture to speak, and it is only I and your men and my servant who
+have still to be silenced.
+
+"I tell you this, in order that you may impress upon the men the
+necessity for the greatest vigilance, such as they would use if
+travelling through an enemy's country. Messengers were, I hear,
+sent off yesterday evening in various directions, and I have no
+doubt that these were to the various contractors concerned in the
+plot, urging upon them the necessity of preventing the news from
+reaching Madrid; and perhaps to some of the robber bands in the
+sierra. Therefore, instead of keeping the main road up the valley,
+we will ride by country tracks and avoid all large towns. We will
+not put up anywhere, but will bivouac in the open. In this way I
+hope that we shall yet avoid any parties of men who may be lying
+in wait for us.
+
+"The most dangerous part of the journey will, of course, be the
+passage of the mountains. We must there travel by one or other of
+the roads through the defiles, and it is possible all these may be
+watched. If we are attacked, we must endeavour to ride through
+them. If this is impossible, we will sell our lives as dearly as
+we can."
+
+"You may trust us for that, Major," the sergeant said. "I have no
+love for these Spaniards, and we are all discontented at being
+kept down here to fight the King of Spain's battles, instead of
+being up in the north, where every man is wanted to prevent the
+enemy marching to Paris."
+
+They struck off from the road when nearing Merida, and followed a
+country track until they came upon the road between that town and
+Torre Mocha. Avoiding the latter place, they took the road to
+Truxillo, and, late in the afternoon, approached that town and
+halted in a wood two miles distant from it.
+
+Here Desmond consulted his map. There were two roads from
+Truxillo. Crossing the sierra, the main and shorter road came down
+upon the Tagus at Almarez. The other passed through Deleytoza, and
+came down upon the bridge at Condo. Beyond Deleytoza it appeared
+to be a mere mule track.
+
+"If there are any parties watching," he said to Mike, "they will
+expect that my messenger, or I myself, will travel by the main
+road to Almarez, for not only is it better, but it is shorter. But
+again, they might think that, if I suspected we might be attacked,
+I should take the road through Deleytoza, and would, at any rate,
+make matters safe by watching both roads. It is a difficult
+question which to choose."
+
+"Well, your honour, if you have got to fight, it would be best to
+do so on a good road. Our horses would be of no use to us, if we
+were going single file along a bad road; while on a good road we
+could charge the spalpeens, and cut our way through."
+
+"You are quite right, Mike, and we will take the main road. They
+will not be mounted, and I don't think they would stand before a
+charge of seven men; but they may shoot some of us as we come down
+upon them.
+
+"See here, Mike, this is my report that I wrote out yesterday
+evening;" and he took a packet from the inside of his coat. "When
+we start tomorrow morning I shall put it in my left holster. If I
+am shot, you will not wait for a moment, but will snatch it out
+and ride on to Madrid, and deliver it to the duke there. I have,
+this morning, added a few lines relating the murder of Colonel
+Mendez, the hurried trial and execution of the storekeepers, and
+the attempts upon my life, and said I have not the least doubt
+that the governor is at the bottom of it all."
+
+"If your honour is killed, I will carry out your orders, but if it
+is only wounded you are, I will try to take you off with me."
+
+"You must do as I order you."
+
+"I obey your honour's orders when they are reasonable," Mike said
+doggedly; "but leave you behind, to have your throat cut by those
+villains! I would not do such a thing, so there is an end of it."
+
+Desmond smiled at the earnestness of his faithful follower.
+
+"Well, Mike, you must be guided by circumstances; but remember, it
+is of extreme importance that this report should reach the Duke of
+Orleans. Unless he has it we may lose Badajos, and the cause
+suffer irreparable injury."
+
+"To the devil wid the cause," Mike said. "The cause doesn't
+trouble me one way or the other. I don't care a brass farthing
+whether Philip or Charles reigns over the Spaniards. It is not a
+nice job they will be taking on, any way, and not worth a drop of
+Irish blood. Well, if your honour should have the bad fortune to
+be hit, I shall either carry you off, though there's not a breath
+in your body, or else go down with you."
+
+As there was no doubt that Mike meant what he said, Desmond did
+not press the matter further.
+
+The next day they set out at daybreak, and, in two hours, were
+mounting the slope of the sierra. There were no signs of any men
+being about, until they reached a point where the road ran between
+steep hills.
+
+"There they are," Desmond exclaimed, reining in his horse. "There
+are some thirty or forty of them on the road.
+
+"Now, my men, we will ride forward to those boulders you see, a
+hundred yards this side of them, and then we will dismount and
+give them a volley. If you keep that up, it will soon be too hot
+for them to remain on the road; while we, sheltered behind the
+rocks, will be safe from their shot. It is certain that your guns
+will carry farther and shoot straighter than theirs, as the
+Spanish powder is so much inferior to the French."
+
+Accordingly, they rode forward at a canter to the heap of
+boulders, then suddenly left the road, dismounted, and took cover
+among the rocks.
+
+"Take steady aim, men," Desmond said, "then you can hardly miss
+hitting some of them, standing close together as they do."
+
+The bandits had waited, undecided, at the sudden disappearance of
+those whom they had regarded as a certain prey; and before they
+could form any plans, five muskets flashed out, and four of their
+number fell. A cry of rage burst from them, and there was a
+general discharge of their guns, the balls pattering thickly
+against the stones.
+
+The soldiers now fired as quickly as they could load, doing
+considerable execution. Their foes left the road, and imitated
+them by taking shelter behind stones. For ten minutes the combat
+continued, and then a party of men were seen, mounting the hill on
+either side.
+
+"That is just what I hoped for," Desmond said. "Fire at them, so
+as to force them to climb a little higher up the hill. As soon as
+they are pretty well out of gunshot, we will mount and charge down
+the road. There cannot be many men left there."
+
+His orders were followed. Some of the men on the hillside dropped,
+and the others continued to mount the slopes. When, as they
+believed, out of fire, they moved forward so as to take the
+defenders of the rocks in flank.
+
+"Now, fire a volley among the men in front of us," Desmond said.
+"We are not likely to hit any of them, but it is sure to draw
+their fire, and there will not be many unemptied guns as we pass
+them."
+
+As he expected, the volley was answered by a general fire from
+their hidden foes. Then the party leapt into their saddles, and,
+pistol in hand, galloped up the road. Several hurried shots were
+fired from the front, and then, at a shout from their leader, some
+twenty men leapt from their hiding places and ran down into the
+road.
+
+Desmond was supported on one side by Mike, and on the other by the
+sergeant. He dropped his reins--the horse had learned to obey the
+motions of his knees--and, drawing his sword, rode straight at the
+bandits. Only a few muskets were discharged, and these so
+hurriedly that the balls missed their aim, and, with a shout, the
+party fell upon the brigands. The pistols of the troopers and Mike
+cracked out, but they had no need to draw their swords, for the
+rush of the horses struck such a panic into the Spaniards that
+they sprang from the road, leaving the path clear, and the party
+thundered past them without a check.
+
+"Is anyone wounded?" Desmond asked, when they had passed beyond
+gunshot of their assailants.
+
+"I have a ball in my shoulder, Major," one of the troopers said.
+The rest were silent.
+
+"Well, we have been fortunate," Desmond said. "I will see to your
+wound, my man, when we get a little farther. If those fellows had
+not been so scared with our sudden charge that they fired almost
+at random, we might have lost half our number."
+
+They stopped half a mile farther, and Desmond examined the
+trooper's arm.
+
+"The ball has gone through the flesh," he said, "without touching
+the bone, so you will soon have the use of it again."
+
+He bound the wound tightly up with the soldier's sash; and then
+made, with his own, a sling.
+
+"You may as well put the other arm in your jacket," he said, "and
+I will tie it round your neck. The air is cold upon the hills."
+
+"We did that well, sir," the sergeant said, as they rode on again.
+"If you had not thought of taking shelter, and shaking them up, we
+should all have been shot down before we reached them.
+
+"Is there any chance of another attack, sir?"
+
+"None at all. I should think a messenger was sent to them,
+yesterday, telling them our strength; and no doubt they thought
+that, with sixty men, they would be certain to overpower us. That
+is probably the whole of the band, and in any case, as they would
+not imagine that we could pass them, they are not likely to have
+set another ambush."
+
+They slept that night at Almarez, made a short journey to Oropesa,
+and a long one on the following day to Toledo, where Desmond
+dismissed his escort, with a handsome reward for their services,
+and upon the next afternoon rode with Mike into Madrid. The Duke
+of Orleans looked astonished when he entered the room.
+
+"What! Back already, Major Kennedy? Surely you cannot have carried
+out all the work that I entrusted to you?"
+
+"By no means, Your Royal Highness; but what I did carry out was so
+important that I deemed it my duty to ride back at once, to
+acquaint you with what I have discovered. There is the report,
+sir."
+
+The duke took it.
+
+"It is a bulky one," he said. "Tell me its purport in as few words
+as possible."
+
+"I have discovered, sir, that the report sent by the governor of
+the supply of provisions and stores in Badajos is altogether
+inaccurate, that frauds to an enormous extent have been
+perpetrated, that the supply of powder and cartridges is less by
+two-thirds than was represented, and that similar deficiencies
+exist in every department."
+
+"This is indeed serious," the duke said. "The possession of
+Badajos is essential to us. It blocks the way to an enemy's
+advance, and indeed, they can scarce move forward until it is
+captured. Now, tell me more about it; or no, I will read your
+report, and then question you concerning it."
+
+A heavy frown settled on the duke's brow, as he perused the
+document.
+
+"Infamous!" he exclaimed, when he had finished. "And you say that
+two attempts were made to murder you that night, and that the
+Spanish colonel who gave you so much assistance was assassinated,
+and the commissaries shot the next morning? It shows how anxious
+the governor was to remove from his path all those who could
+inculpate him.
+
+"And how did you manage to get out of the toils? For it was
+clearly of no use killing the minor witnesses, and allowing you to
+ride here to report the facts."
+
+"I saw that, sir; and as I learned that eight or ten troopers had
+been sent off, late the night before, I concluded that the road
+would be sure to be beset, for doubtless some of the contractors
+would feel it as essential as the governor did, that my mouth
+should be silenced and my report suppressed. I therefore started
+early. Keeping by byroads, we were not molested until we had
+nearly reached the summit of the sierra, when we found a party of
+some sixty men barring the road. We had a fight with them, and
+succeeded in getting through with no further damage than a ball
+through the arm of one of my escort, and that, fortunately, was
+only a flesh wound."
+
+"But tell me how it was that so small a party escaped so easily?"
+
+Desmond then recounted the incidents of the fight.
+
+"Admirably contrived, sir!" the duke said warmly. "Excellent
+generalship! You first attack their centre and drive them off the
+road, then you compel them to weaken themselves by throwing out
+flanking parties. You keep these out of musket shot, and then
+charge on their weakened centre after drawing their fire. I am not
+surprised that, with such generalship, you got off almost
+scatheless.
+
+"And now, sir, I must ask you to come with me to the king. The
+matter is too serious for a moment's delay. I must lay the whole
+case before His Majesty."
+
+Leaving Desmond in the antechamber, he went in to the king, read
+the full report to him, and added the details he had heard from
+Desmond.
+
+"I have met with many bad cases of Spanish corruption and
+peculation," the king said, when he had finished, "but this is by
+far the worst. Steps must be taken instantly to secure the
+governor, arrest the contractors, and fill up the magazines. What
+do you propose?"
+
+"I think, sir, that if we send forward, at once, a regiment of
+French soldiers from Toledo, accompanied by Colonel Crofton's
+regiment of dragoons, there is no likelihood that any resistance
+will be offered--indeed, I should imagine that the governor will
+have taken to flight, as soon as he learns that his plans for the
+assassination of Major Kennedy have failed."
+
+"So I should think," the king said; "and certainly he will have
+warned his accomplices, the contractors; and probably, by this
+time, they are all on their way either into Andalusia or to the
+north. Any that are found shall certainly be hanged.
+
+"This young officer of yours must be a wonderfully shrewd fellow.
+I should like to question him as to how he discovered these
+frauds."
+
+Desmond was called in.
+
+"This is Major Kennedy, Your Majesty," the duke said. "That is his
+temporary rank, which I bestowed upon him in order to add weight
+to his mission."
+
+"I have noticed him before, cousin," Philip said, "when I had gone
+to your quarters, and wondered to see so young a man in the
+uniform of a captain.
+
+"Now, sir, will you give me an account of how you discovered these
+frauds?"
+
+Desmond then related how he had caused the piles of barrels to be
+opened out, so that he could examine those next to the wall as
+well as those in front; and how he had similarly examined the
+other stores.
+
+"Very good, indeed, sir," the king said. "Most officers would have
+contented themselves with, at most, counting the number of barrels
+and sacks; and that you should have so thoroughly investigated the
+matter shows both zeal and shrewdness."
+
+"He has shown that on various occasions," the duke said, "as you
+may judge from the promotion that he has received. As you see, by
+the loss of his hand, he has suffered as well as fought on behalf
+of France. When Your Majesty is at leisure I will, some evening,
+relate to you a story which I heard from the king himself, of the
+manner in which he, twice, rescued a fair damsel from an
+evil-minded noble who carried her off."
+
+"I shall hear it with pleasure, cousin. You say he holds only
+temporary rank. I think that, after the signal service he has
+rendered, it should be made substantial."
+
+"I certainly intend to make it so," the duke said.
+
+"Pardon, sir," Desmond said, "but, while thanking you for your
+kindness, I would beg to be allowed to remain a captain. Already I
+have obtained more promotion than others have done, after many
+years of good service, and I should regret very much passing over
+the heads of so many of my old companions."
+
+"It is the first time that I have had promotion declined," the
+duke said, smiling. "However, for the present, at least, I will
+let the matter remain so."
+
+With an expression of warm thanks, Desmond retired.
+
+"We must lose no time over this matter," the king said. "For aught
+we know, this scoundrel may be in communication with the enemy,
+and may be prepared to open the gates of the fortress at the first
+summons."
+
+"I will act at once," the duke replied. "I will, this evening,
+send orders to Toledo for a regiment to march at nine o'clock
+tomorrow morning, and, if you will send a similar order to Colonel
+Crofton, he will overtake the infantry before they get to
+Almarez."
+
+"I will do so, and will also send with them three field officers,
+with full power to arrest, try, and execute all those who have
+taken part in this treacherous fraud."
+
+On the duke leaving the king, Desmond joined him in the
+antechamber, and as they walked towards the French headquarters,
+said:
+
+"I hope, sir, that you will permit me to start tomorrow with any
+force you may be sending, as I wish to carry out the rest of the
+mission with which you entrusted me."
+
+"By all means, do so if you wish it," the duke said. "Colonel
+Crofton's regiment will start at nine o'clock tomorrow morning,
+and you may accompany it. On the road it will overtake one of our
+regiments from Toledo."
+
+
+
+Chapter 16: Captured.
+
+
+"I have a job for you, Mike."
+
+"What is it, your honour?"
+
+"I want you to take off all the marks of a field officer from my
+clothes. I am going to be a captain again."
+
+Mike looked with surprise at his master.
+
+"Well, your honour, it is ungrateful bastes they must be. Sure I
+thought that the least they could do was to make you a full major,
+though if they had made you a colonel, it would be no more than
+you deserve."
+
+"I was offered the majority, Mike, but I declined it. It would be
+absurd, at my age, to have such a rank, and I should be ashamed to
+look officers of our brigade, who have done nigh twenty years of
+good service and are still only captains, in the face. I would
+much rather remain as I am."
+
+"Well, it may be you are right, sir, but it is disappointed I am,
+entirely."
+
+"You will get over it, Mike," Desmond laughed.
+
+"That may be," Mike said doubtfully, "but I should have felt
+mighty proud of being a colonel's servant."
+
+"I don't suppose you will ever be that, Mike. You know that, after
+the last war was over, several of the Irish regiments were
+disbanded, and no doubt it will be the same when this war is
+finished, so you could not count upon seeing me a colonel, at any
+rate not for another twenty years."
+
+"Ah, your honour, I hope we shall be back in old Ireland years
+before that!"
+
+"I hope so, too, Mike. I have only been out here for two years,
+and yet I am beginning to feel that I should like a quieter life.
+No doubt the loss of my hand has something to do with that, but I
+would give up, willingly, all chance of ever becoming a colonel,
+if I could but settle down in the old country, though I fear there
+is very little chance of that."
+
+"But sure there may be fighting there, too, your honour," Mike
+said; "and if King James goes across the water, there is sure to
+be divarsion that way."
+
+"I hope not, Mike. It is not that I do not feel as loyal as ever
+to the cause of the Stuarts, but if they cannot come to their own
+without Ireland being again deluged with blood, I would rather
+they would stay away. Twice Ireland has suffered for the Stuarts:
+first, when Cromwell came over, carrying fire and sword through
+the land, and divided half the country among his followers; next,
+when Dutch William did the same. I am loyal to the Stuarts, as I
+said, but I am still more loyal to Ireland, and would rather that
+King James remained all his life at Saint Germain, than that those
+scenes should ever come again."
+
+"That's true for you, sir; and when I come to think of it, I
+should be just as easy and comfortable in a snug little cot in
+Killarney, which is my county, whether King James or Queen Anne
+was ruling it in England."
+
+"Quite so, Mike; and if I had, as you say, a snug little cot to go
+to, and an income to live comfortably in it, and no fear of being
+hauled off to prison and hanged for joining the brigade, I should
+not be sorry to settle down.
+
+"We start back for Badajos tomorrow morning."
+
+"Faith, your honour, it has been so hard getting away from there,
+that I should not have thought you wished to put your foot inside
+the place again. You might not be so lucky in getting off, next
+time."
+
+"We are going in a different way, Mike. Colonel Crofton's regiment
+of Irish dragoons is going with us, and a French infantry regiment
+from Toledo."
+
+"Then I am well content to go back, your honour, and I hope we
+shall see that murthering governor hung."
+
+"I think you have a good chance of seeing that, Mike, if he has
+not taken himself off before we arrive there; which I think he is
+pretty sure to do, directly he hears we have got through safely;
+for he will know that, as soon as my report is handed in, he is a
+lost man."
+
+"Bad cess to him! At any rate, I hope I shall light upon him some
+day, sir, and pay him out for sending those fellows to kill you at
+night, and to hinder us in the hills. As to his cheating the
+Spaniards, that is their business, and they can reckon with him
+for it; but I should like to pay our debt myself."
+
+"I don't suppose there is much chance of your having an
+opportunity of doing that."
+
+"Then why are we going back, your honour?"
+
+"To carry out my original orders, Mike--survey the roads, and
+passes, and bridges. The duke cannot rely upon Spanish testimony
+in these matters, and it is most important that we should
+ascertain, accurately, how good are the roads by which he would
+advance with the army into Portugal, or where best to oppose the
+enemy if they cross the Guadiana."
+
+"I am glad to hear you say so, sir, for I was afraid that we were
+going to have a long stay here again, and I would rather be on
+horseback, riding all over the country, than walking up and down
+these streets till my feet fairly ache."
+
+"That is my opinion, too, Mike. We have had a good many rides with
+despatches, but between times it is stupid work, hanging about the
+general's quarters waiting for orders."
+
+The next morning, Desmond joined Colonel Crofton's regiment as it
+was on the point of starting from the barracks. It was in the
+service of Spain, and had taken a brilliant part in several
+engagements. Desmond was acquainted with the colonel and his
+officers.
+
+"Good morning, Kennedy!" Crofton said, as he rode up and saluted
+him. "I had a note from the Duke of Orleans, last night, saying
+you were going on special service, and would travel with us as far
+as Badajos. King Philip sent for me, later on, and himself gave me
+instructions, besides handing me the written orders. It seems you
+have discovered that the governor is mixed up, with a lot of
+contractors, in swindling the state by supplying earth instead of
+powder and flour."
+
+"So far as the governor goes, Colonel, there is no absolute proof.
+I have not the smallest doubt that he was the prime mover in the
+matter, and that the commissaries only received a small portion of
+the bribes paid to him. It is hardly possible that every one of
+them should have betrayed his trust, unless sure of the governor's
+protection. I cannot prove that he had all these men shot in order
+to silence them, employed men to assassinate Colonel Mendez, or
+set men to murder me in my hotel and afterwards to intercept us in
+crossing the sierra. Still, I have no shadow of doubt in my mind
+that it was so.
+
+"However, I do not think you will find him at Badajos. No doubt,
+as soon as he heard I had got safely down into the valley of the
+Tagus, he made off. There is just a possibility that the
+contractors, knowing that their lives will be forfeited by the
+discovery of the frauds, might at once have sent in supplies of
+powder, flour, and other things, to take the place of the casks
+and sacks of earth; in which case he would probably deny the truth
+of my statement altogether, and declare that I had simply invented
+it in order to do credit to myself. But I hardly think that
+possible. In the first place, there are the soldiers both of my
+escort and of Colonel Mendez, who assisted in the work of
+examination; besides which more than half the commissaries escaped
+while this was taking place, and, on an offer of pardon, would no
+doubt gladly come forward and give evidence, especially as the
+execution of their comrades will have shown them that the governor
+is determined to throw them over."
+
+"Yes; I don't suppose we shall find the arch-scoundrel there,
+unless, indeed, he can rely upon the support of his garrison; in
+which case he may have ridden to Portugal, offering to surrender
+the place at once to them, and will close his gates against us."
+
+"I don't think there is any chance of that, Colonel. In the short
+time during which I was there, I was able to see that the troops
+were deeply discontented. They were almost in rags, and the
+landlord of the inn told me that they were kept on the scantiest
+rations, and those of a very inferior kind. So I do not think, for
+a moment, he could trust them to act against a royal force."
+
+Desmond's anticipation proved to be correct. As they descended
+into the valley of the Guadiana, they met an officer of the
+garrison, who was bearing a despatch from the senior military
+officer, saying that the governor and his family had suddenly left
+without issuing any orders, and, as he had taken all his portable
+property with him, it was supposed that he did not intend to
+return. Under these circumstances he wrote to ask for orders.
+
+Colonel Crofton sent him back with instructions, to the colonel
+commanding the troops, that he was coming with a regiment of
+dragoons and one of infantry, and had full authority from the king
+to take all measures that seemed to him desirable. Accordingly,
+when they arrived at Badajos they were met, at the gate, by the
+colonel commanding the troops, and a party of his officers.
+
+"I have the king's authority," Colonel Crofton said to him, "to
+act as temporary governor until another may be appointed. I do not
+know whether you are aware of the circumstances that led to the
+flight of Don Juan de Munos?"
+
+"No, sir, we have heard nothing. Rumours were current, among the
+men, that some strange discoveries were made when the stores were
+examined, but beyond that I know nothing. In fact, at the time,
+the assassination of Colonel Mendez of the artillery created such
+an excitement that nothing else was spoken of."
+
+"Well, Colonel, if you will accompany me to the governor's house,
+I will enter into the matter fully with you. You may well believe
+that it is serious, as I have been despatched here with my
+regiment, and with one of French infantry, for both of whom
+quarters must be found at once."
+
+"There is plenty of room, sir. The barracks will contain ten
+thousand men, and at present we have but four thousand here."
+
+"Then I beg, Colonel, that instead of coming at once to my
+quarters, you will tell off officers to conduct the troops to the
+most convenient of the buildings now empty. After that, I shall be
+glad to see you and the commanding officers of the other
+regiments.
+
+"You will, of course, take up your quarters at the governor's
+house, Captain Kennedy," he went on, as he rode forward. "As you
+are going to be employed in surveying duties, you will naturally
+be a good deal away. But your presence here will be absolutely
+necessary, as a witness against any of these rascally contractors
+we can lay our hands on."
+
+When the four colonels arrived, after seeing that the troops were
+housed, Colonel Crofton obtained from them the names and addresses
+of the various contractors; and, half an hour later, parties of
+the cavalry regiment in garrison were despatched, under officers,
+with orders to arrest and bring them into Badajos. During the
+meal, Colonel Crofton explained to the four colonels the discovery
+of the frauds, which naturally excited the greatest indignation
+among them. He then requested them and Desmond to accompany him to
+the stores. This they did, after sending to the barracks for a
+party of fifty men for fatigue duty.
+
+The gaps made during Desmond's explorations had been carefully
+filled up again, but upon fresh openings being made, his reports
+were fully borne out. Some hours were spent at the central
+magazine, and orders given that the other magazines should be
+opened and examined on the following day.
+
+Desmond did not join in this search, but started early, with Mike,
+to carry out his own mission. He had been furnished with reports,
+sent in by the provincial and local juntas, as to the state of the
+roads, but, as he had expected, he soon found these to be grossly
+inaccurate. The roads marked as excellent, and fit for the passage
+of artillery and trains, were found to be mere bridle roads.
+Others, marked as highroads, were almost impassable lanes. The
+bridges across the streams were, for the most part, in such a bad
+condition as to be unsafe for a country cart and, until repaired,
+impossible for the passage of artillery.
+
+He carefully noted all the points at which work was required to
+render them in any degree practicable for the passage of troops,
+and reported fully to Colonel Crofton. The latter, who was
+provided with full authority, despatched the greater portion of
+his troops, with a large number of peasants, with materials to
+fill up the deep ruts, repair the bridges, and make the roads, as
+far as possible, fit for the passage of an army.
+
+In ten days, Desmond had surveyed all the roads down both the
+valley of the Guadiana and that of the Tagus, and had sent off his
+report to Madrid, together with his observations as to the points
+at which a defensive position could, in his opinion, be best taken
+up. Having done this, he prepared to undertake the second part of
+his mission, and to investigate the roads on the Portuguese side
+of the frontier.
+
+"Now we shall have to keep our eyes open, Mike," he said. "So far
+as we have heard, there are no bodies of the enemy's troops
+anywhere in this neighbourhood, but there is a bitter enmity
+between the Spanish and Portuguese, and we shall be liable to be
+attacked by the peasants."
+
+"Are we to ride in our uniforms, your honour?"
+
+"Certainly we are, Mike. If we are captured in uniform, we should
+be dealt with as prisoners of war and have a right to fair
+treatment. If we are taken in disguise, we shall be shot as
+spies."
+
+"Faith, your honour, the alternative is not a pleasant one. If we
+go as civilians, we may be shot as spies; if we go in uniform, we
+may be murdered by the peasants."
+
+"That is so, Mike. But, you see, we are not likely to fall into
+the hands of the peasants. We are both well mounted, and the
+peasants will be on foot, and a great proportion of them unarmed;
+so that, beyond the chance of being hit by a ball, the risk is not
+great."
+
+Accordingly, on the following day they rode out, and for nearly a
+week examined the lines of route across the frontier. They
+followed the roads between the foot of the mountains and the
+frontier, as far as Portalegre, but avoided the towns of Campo
+Mayor and Arronches; crossed the hills, and struck upwards by the
+bank of the Zarina to Frontiera, and thence west as far as Lavre.
+They met with no interference by such peasants as they saw working
+in the fields, or by those in the small villages through which
+they passed, these supposing the uniforms to be those of English
+or Dutch officers.
+
+They found that the roads were fully as bad as those of Spain, and
+would present great difficulty to any army with artillery and a
+long train of waggons. In one of the places they heard from a
+peasant, with whom they conversed, that there was another pass
+over the mountains from Elvas. Of course, the man spoke in
+Portuguese, but the language sufficiently resembled Spanish for
+Desmond to understand its meaning.
+
+"We must investigate that road, Mike, for, if it is practicable,
+it would be the most direct for an army coming from Lisbon. Of
+course, we shall have to make a wide circle round Elvas, as there
+is sure to be a strong garrison there, and any soldiers riding
+about the country would be certain to know that our uniform was
+French. When we have done that road, we shall have finished our
+work."
+
+Accordingly, they passed round the fortress at a distance, and
+presently came upon the road. It showed signs of having lately
+been repaired, in some parts, but these were so badly done that
+they increased rather than diminished the difficulties it
+presented to the passage of troops. They had ridden some ten
+miles, and were already among the mountains, when they dismounted
+to rest their horses and to eat the food they carried with them.
+
+Suddenly, looking down the road behind them, they saw a squadron
+of cavalry coming along.
+
+"This is awkward, Mike. There is nothing for it, now, but to ride
+on, and when we have reached the foot of the mountains on the
+other side, strike across country until we come upon the road
+running direct to Badajos. They are a good two miles behind us, so
+we need not blow our horses."
+
+Mounting, they proceeded at a trot up the road. As far as they
+could see, the cavalry behind them did not quicken their pace,
+which showed that they were on some ordinary duty and not, as
+Desmond at first supposed, in pursuit of them, some peasant
+having, perhaps, taken word that an officer and soldier in strange
+uniform had been seen riding round the town. They therefore took
+matters quietly, and indeed, sometimes the road was so steep that
+it would have been impossible for the horses to go beyond a quick
+walk.
+
+Suddenly, on reaching the crest of the rise, they saw, at a
+distance of a hundred yards ahead of them, a party of officers,
+followed by an escort of dragoons.
+
+"We are caught this time, Mike!" Desmond exclaimed. "Escape is
+impossible. I will ride straight up and surrender. Fortunately
+they are English uniforms, so we are certain to get fair
+treatment, which we could not be sure of, had they been
+Portuguese."
+
+So saying, he rode forward at a trot. The party had drawn rein at
+his approach, and he rode up to one who was evidently a general
+officer.
+
+"Sir, I surrender as a prisoner of war. My name is Kennedy, and I
+am a captain on the staff of the Duke of Orleans."
+
+"And what are you doing here, sir?"
+
+"I am surveying the road, General, by which the allied army is
+likely to advance. Our information on that score is very
+defective, and I believe the duke wishes to ascertain, from my
+report, the state of the roads by which the advance would most
+probably be made."
+
+The general's question had been in French, and he replied in the
+same language.
+
+"You do not bear a French name, sir," the general said.
+
+"No, sir, I am an Irishman," Kennedy replied, in English. "I
+belonged, before I received a staff appointment, to one of the
+regiments of the Irish Brigade."
+
+"You are a daring fellow, thus to venture so far across the
+frontier."
+
+"I simply obeyed my orders, sir; and, had I been ordered to
+reconnoitre Lisbon, I should have attempted to do so."
+
+"Well, sir, I shall have an opportunity of talking to you, later
+on. I, as you see, am engaged in precisely the same work as you
+are; namely, in ascertaining, for myself, the state of the roads
+across these mountains."
+
+"Then, General," Desmond said, with a smile, "I should say that
+your investigations are hardly satisfactory."
+
+The general also smiled.
+
+"Not so much so as I could wish," he said. "And now, may I ask
+why, seeing that you are well mounted, you did not turn and ride
+for it, when you first perceived us?"
+
+"The reason is simple, General. A squadron of cavalry were coming
+up behind me, and there was evidently no possibility of escape."
+
+"No doubt they were sent out to meet me. Well, sir, if you will
+give me your word not to attempt to escape, you can retain your
+sword, and ride with us."
+
+"I give my parole, sir, with many thanks for your courtesy."
+
+"And now, Captain Kennedy," the other went on, "it is probable
+that you have, about you, the result of your investigations along
+these roads, which I must request you to hand to me; as it may be
+as useful, to me, as it would have been to the Duke of Orleans,
+and may save me a good deal of trouble."
+
+Desmond took out the notebook in which he had, each day, jotted
+down the result of his observations, with suggestions as to the
+points where repairs were most needed. He had each night, on his
+return to Badajos, written up his reports from these, intending,
+when he had completed the work, to take it himself to Madrid.
+
+The general glanced through the notebook.
+
+"You have done your work very thoroughly, Captain Kennedy, and
+have rendered me considerable service. Now, we will move forward
+again. Please follow with my aides-de-camp."
+
+These were two pleasant young men, who were glad of a talk with an
+officer from the other side.
+
+"How long have you been riding about here, if it is fair to put
+the question?" one said.
+
+As the notebook contained all the particulars of his journeys on
+that side of the frontier, Desmond replied at once:
+
+"Eight days, I think. I have been up the road to Portalegre, and
+by that to Lavre; and if I had not, unfortunately, accidentally
+heard of this road over the mountains, I should now be on my way
+to Madrid; but luck has been against me."
+
+"Promotion must be very rapid in your army," the other
+aide-de-camp said, "or you would hardly be a captain already."
+
+"I was fortunate enough to attract the notice of the King of
+France, and the Duke of Berwick, on various occasions, and when
+one has such a piece of good fortune as that, promotion is rapid."
+
+"It is lucky for you that you fell into the hands of the Earl of
+Galway, instead of into those of the Portuguese generals, who
+would probably, in spite of your uniform, have made short work of
+you."
+
+"I did not know that the general was the Earl of Galway," Desmond
+said. "Certainly, it was lucky that I fell into his hands. Indeed,
+if I had not seen the English uniforms, I should have turned and
+charged the squadron behind us; preferring very much to be killed
+fighting, than to be hanged or shot like a dog."
+
+In a few minutes they met the squadron of cavalry, who had, as the
+general supposed, been sent out by the Governor of Elvas to meet
+him. Half of these now took their place in front, and the
+remainder, drawing aside to let the party pass, fell in behind.
+Mike had, without orders, fallen in with the earl's escort; and
+more than once Desmond heard his laugh, as he chatted with the
+troopers. On arriving at Elvas, the general directed his
+aides-de-camp to obtain a room, for Desmond, in the house in which
+they were quartered; and as no one attended to him, Mike undertook
+his usual duties as his servant.
+
+The next morning, one of the aides-de-camp came in, and said:
+
+"The general wishes to speak to you, Captain Kennedy."
+
+On entering the general's apartment, the earl asked him to take a
+seat.
+
+"I could not see you yesterday evening," he began, "as I was learning
+from the Governor the state of the stores here. I should like to have
+a talk with you. May I ask you, in the first place, how you have so
+early attained the rank of captain? My aide-de-camp tells me that you
+said you had attracted the notice of the King of France. It must have
+been by some singular action, and as I have an hour to spare, before
+I ride out, I shall be glad if you can tell me some particulars about
+yourself; unless, indeed, they are of a private nature."
+
+"Not at all, sir. The story is generally known to members of the
+court at Versailles, and indeed to all Paris;" and he then related
+to the earl the story of his release of Anne de Pointdexter from
+her imprisonment, the journey to the south, the attack on the
+party by the Vicomte de Tulle, and her second rescue from him.
+
+"Thank you, sir," the general said, when he had concluded. "I am
+not surprised that, after so romantic an adventure, the King of
+France took notice of an officer who had shown such courage and
+intelligence. You see, sir, that you and I are, to a certain
+extent, in a similar position. From motives of religion,
+principally, you Irish have left your country, and are fighting
+for a foreign monarch. I, as you are doubtless aware, belong to a
+French Huguenot family, and, being forced to leave France by the
+severe edicts, entered the service of Holland, and followed the
+fortunes of King William, and am now fighting against the troops
+of the country of my birth. In other respects, there is a
+similarity. We have both lost a hand in the service of our adopted
+countries; I at the siege of Badajos, and you at--?"
+
+"Oudenarde, sir."
+
+"I have been thinking it over," the general went on. "I might, of
+course, send you to Lisbon as a prisoner, but one extra prisoner
+would not largely benefit my government. You have not been taken
+in action. Your papers have saved me an immense deal of trouble,
+for we are no more able to rely upon the information given by the
+Portuguese than, I should think, the Duke of Orleans can upon that
+of the Spaniards.
+
+"Therefore, sir, I think that, in the present case, I can make an
+exception to the rule. In an hour I shall mount and ride down the
+road to Badajos, and I shall there restore your liberty to you,
+and permit you to recross the frontier. It would be a thousand
+pities that so young and gallant an officer should waste, perhaps,
+some years of his life in an English prison, for the number of
+prisoners taken in Flanders is so great that it is impossible for
+the French to find officers to exchange for them. You will
+understand that, dealing with allies so jealous and susceptible as
+the Portuguese, I can hardly take the step of releasing you, as it
+would be at once rumoured that I had been in communication with a
+French officer, doubtless from some sinister motive.
+
+"I think, Captain Kennedy, that it would be as well," he said with
+a smile, "that you should withdraw your parole, and do so before
+we start, in the presence of the officers of my staff. Of course,
+you must be placed under a very strict guard, and although so near
+the frontier, you will find it very difficult to escape. Still,
+such things are managed."
+
+"I thank you most deeply, sir," Desmond said, understanding the
+tone in which the earl spoke, "and I shall ever retain a deep
+feeling of gratitude for your generosity."
+
+When the party assembled, in readiness to mount, Desmond walked up
+to the earl, and said in a tone that could be heard by the
+officers round:
+
+"Sir, I have changed my mind, and beg to be allowed to withdraw my
+parole."
+
+"You are at liberty to do so, Captain Kennedy; but nevertheless I
+shall take you with us today. I shall not, of course, ask you to
+give any information as to matters on the other side of the
+frontier, but there are points on which you could inform me,
+without detriment to your friends."
+
+"That I shall be happy to do, sir."
+
+The earl called up four troopers.
+
+"You will place this officer and his servant between you," he
+said, "and keep a vigilant lookout upon their movements."
+
+Desmond had not even told Mike of the conversation with the earl,
+thinking it better that he should remain in ignorance that this
+escape was connived at by an English general, and his follower was
+therefore greatly astonished when he heard that his master had
+withdrawn his parole, and that they were henceforth to be strictly
+guarded. The party rode until they reached a rise from which they
+could obtain a view of Badajos, and of the country extending far
+up the valley of the Guadiana. The ground in front of them sloped
+gradually.
+
+The earl took his place with two or three officers of his staff,
+fifty yards in front of the rest, and, dismounting, examined
+Badajos with his telescope. Then he asked one of his aides-de-camp
+to bring Captain Kennedy to him.
+
+"You may as well bring his servant, too," he added. "No doubt he
+knows the country as well as his master does, and may not be so
+unwilling to answer questions."
+
+The order was carried out, and Desmond and Mike rode up with the
+aide-de-camp, followed closely by the four troopers. The earl at
+once began to question Desmond as to the names of the villages
+visible up the valley. He had remounted now, but his staff, who
+had dismounted when he did, remained on their feet, as it was
+evident that he had no intention of moving forward for some time.
+
+While they were speaking, the earl, accompanied by Desmond, rode
+forward some twenty yards, as if to obtain a better view. Mike had
+followed him, but the four troopers remained behind the group of
+officers, having no orders to follow the general so closely.
+
+"This is good ground for galloping, Captain Kennedy," the earl
+said quietly. "You are within two miles of Badajos."
+
+"Thank you deeply, sir.
+
+"Now, Mike, ride for it!" and, spurring his horse, he dashed off
+at a headlong gallop.
+
+There was a shout of surprise, the officers of the staff ran to
+their horses, which were being held by the orderlies, and the four
+troopers at once galloped forward, snatching their carbines from
+the slings.
+
+"Do not fire," the earl shouted as they passed. "Take them alive."
+
+As the officers came up, the general signalled to them to stop.
+
+"Don't go farther, gentlemen," he said. "The troopers will
+doubtless overtake them; but for aught we know, there may be a
+Spanish force in the village just on the other side of the
+frontier, and, instead of capturing two prisoners, you might be
+taken or shot yourself; and I am not disposed to lose any of my
+staff, just as we are about to commence operations in earnest."
+
+Desmond looked back. He saw that only the four dragoons were
+following.
+
+"They will not overtake us, Mike," he said, "our horses are
+certainly better than theirs."
+
+Indeed, they had increased their lead fast. A few minutes later,
+they heard a trumpet call in their rear, and their pursuers at
+once checked their horses, and rode back in answer to the recall.
+
+"Tare an' ages," Mike exclaimed, "but that was nately managed. Who
+would have thought that they would have let us give them the slip
+so easily!"
+
+"Well, Mike--but this you must never mention to a soul--the earl
+gave us this chance of escape, I believe. He had, you know, a long
+talk with me, and said that they had so many French officers
+captured in Flanders, that one more or less would make little
+difference. He had asked about my adventures, and seemed much
+interested in them, and remarked that our positions were somewhat
+similar, both being exiles on account of our religion, and so
+serving in foreign armies against our own countrymen. At any rate,
+it was on his suggestion that I withdrew my parole not to attempt
+to escape."
+
+"Then he is a rale gintleman, sir, and mighty obliged I feel to
+him, for I have had enough of English prisons, though indeed, it
+was only three or four days that I stopped at Harwich."
+
+The party on the hill had watched the pursuit, until the earl
+said:
+
+"Well, gentlemen, I fancy he has slipped from our hands. I admit
+that I am hardly sorry, for he was a very fine young fellow, and
+it would have been a pity for him to be spending, perhaps some
+years of the best part of his life, in prison.
+
+"Captain Chetwynde, will you order the trumpeter to sound the
+recall? They are leaving our men behind fast. It is no use losing
+four troopers as well as two prisoners."
+
+More than one quiet smile was exchanged between the English
+officers, for, from the tone in which the earl spoke, they had no
+doubt that he was by no means sorry at Desmond's escape, and that
+possibly he had even taken him forward with him to afford him a
+chance of making it. They had, indeed, been a little surprised
+that, when Desmond withdrew his parole, the earl had not ordered
+him into strict confinement, instead of taking him with him on his
+reconnaissance.
+
+The pursuit over, Desmond rode on at a canter to Badajos, and
+reported to Colonel Crofton that he had been taken prisoner, but
+had managed to effect his escape, as he was but carelessly
+guarded.
+
+"I shall now, sir, return to Madrid. I have completed the work I
+was told to carry out, and shall finish writing up my report this
+afternoon, and start tomorrow morning."
+
+"I congratulate you on your escape. The Portuguese are not very
+particular, and might, as likely as not, have paid small regard to
+the fact that you were in uniform."
+
+"Fortunately, sir, it was not by them that I was captured, but by
+a small party of English dragoons, who were, I fancy, like myself,
+investigating the state of the roads."
+
+Desmond had not been called upon to give evidence before the
+commission of enquiry, it being found that all the contractors had
+left their homes, a week before the troops arrived at Badajos,
+taking all portable property with them. Some had apparently gone
+to Andalusia, while others had made for Catalonia. All had
+unquestionably made a considerable sum of money by their frauds,
+and would take good care not to fall into the hands of the French.
+
+"They will never be able to return here," Desmond remarked to
+Colonel Crofton.
+
+The latter smiled.
+
+"You do not know these people yet, Captain Kennedy, or you would
+not say so. Some of these fellows are certainly among the richest
+men in the province, and we may be quite sure that, in a very
+short time, when the affair has blown over, they will, partly by
+influence and more by bribery, obtain from the central junta an
+order that no proceedings shall be taken against them. Anything
+can be done with money in Spain. There are many upright and
+honourable Spaniards, but very few of them take any part in public
+affairs, and would not associate with such men as those who are in
+the ascendant in all the provincial juntas, and even in the
+central body in Madrid.
+
+"In France there is distress enough, and no doubt the men who farm
+the taxes are no more scrupulous than they are in Spain, but there
+is not the same general corruption, and the French nobility,
+haughty and despotic to their tenants as they may be, are not
+corrupt, and would scorn to take a bribe. Now that there is a
+French king on the throne here, there may be, when matters have
+settled down, some improvement; but it will be a long time,
+indeed, before the nation can be regenerated, and even the king
+will soon find that, if he is to reign peaceably, he must not
+interfere too violently with methods that are so common that they
+have come to be accepted as inevitable, even by the people who
+suffer by them.
+
+"I can assure you that I, myself, have been many times approached
+by men who supply forage and other things to the regiment, and
+when I have indignantly refused to entertain any proposals
+whatever, they have not been at all abashed, but have said boldly
+that it was the general custom. I do not believe they thought any
+the better of me for refusing even to listen to their offers, but
+regarded me as a sort of Don Quixote, with ridiculously
+exaggerated ideas of honour."
+
+On the morning following his return to Badajos, Desmond started on his
+way to Madrid. Although this time he had no apprehension whatever of a
+planned attack, he thought it safer and better to travel north from
+Badajos, and skirt the foot of the sierras until he reached the banks
+of the Tagus, where there was a strong garrison in each of the towns,
+and the country was, in consequence, free from the incursions of bands
+from the hills. The journey passed without an incident, and on reaching
+Madrid and presenting his report, he received high commendation from
+the Duke of Orleans, and spent a long day with the general's staff,
+explaining his report, and going into details as to the nature of the
+roads, the repairs necessary, and the positions which were, in his
+opinion, most suitable for battle.
+
+On the following day, the members of the staff were all summoned
+to meet him by the Duke of Orleans, who informed them that he had
+received a sudden summons to return to Paris, and that Marshal de
+Bay would, in his absence, be in command of the French troops. The
+announcement came as a great surprise to Desmond, but was not
+unexpected by the other officers.
+
+During the winter, the King of France had been engaged in efforts
+to bring about a general peace, and had offered terms that showed
+he was ready to make any sacrifices to procure it. The allies, on
+the contrary, were bent upon continuing the war. The victory of
+Oudenarde, the capture of Lille, Namur, and other fortresses,
+opened the way to Paris, and knowing the general distress that
+prevailed in France, they raised their demands higher and higher,
+as they perceived the anxiety of Louis for peace.
+
+One of the obstacles to this was the situation in Spain, and it was
+reported that Louis was ready to yield on this point also, and not
+only to consent to the cession of the Spanish dominion in Spain,
+but to his grandson Philip surrendering the crown to the Archduke
+Charles; and that, ere long, the French troops would be withdrawn
+altogether. While, during the month that had elapsed since Desmond
+first left Madrid, these rumours had increased in strength, it was
+known that couriers were constantly passing to and fro, between
+Madrid and Versailles, with private communications between Louis and
+Philip; and there was great excitement, in Madrid, at the rumour of
+this desertion of their king by France.
+
+The rumours were indeed correct. The king had informed Philip
+that, great as was the affection he bore for him, the state of
+France, which was necessarily his chief care, would compel him,
+ere long, to recall his troops from Spain. Philip had entreated
+him not to desert him, and declared that, in any case, he would
+remain in Spain, confiding in the support of the people who had
+selected him as their monarch. At present, however, the
+communications were proceeding, and nothing definite had been
+arranged.
+
+The whole of the staff were to remain with Marshal de Bay, in the
+same position as they had held under the duke, and, except for the
+departure of the prince, matters went on as before.
+
+
+
+Chapter 17: An Old Friend.
+
+
+The command had been effected so suddenly that Desmond had not
+been able to make up his mind to request the Duke of Orleans, to
+whom he had been attached personally, rather than to the French
+army in Spain, to allow him to return with him to France, in order
+that he might again join the Duke of Berwick. Before, however, he
+could decide whether to do so or not, the duke had taken his
+departure.
+
+Desmond spoke to the head of the staff, with whom he had been
+constantly thrown in contact before he left Madrid, and whilst
+explaining to him, on his return, the details of his report, asked
+him for his advice.
+
+"I should think you had better remain here, Captain Kennedy. There
+is likely to be a great battle fought, in a few weeks; but if the
+rumours we hear are correct, we may not be here very much longer.
+Certainly I hope there will be no change until then, for if we win
+the battle, and so relieve Spain from the risk of invasion for a
+time, we can leave the country with a better grace, as Philip
+would then only have to battle with his rebellious subjects in
+Catalonia."
+
+"I should certainly not wish to leave when a great battle is about
+to be fought," Desmond said, "and will, therefore, continue to
+serve under the Marshal de Bay until it is certain what is going
+to be done."
+
+In a short time a general movement of the troops, both Spanish and
+French, began. Desmond and the other aides-de-camp were actively
+employed in keeping up communication between the various columns,
+which were to assemble near Badajos. Moving forward at the same
+rate as the troops, the march was a pleasant one. It was April
+now, the country looked bright, and the heat was not too great for
+marching.
+
+The marshal had gone on with the greater portion of his staff,
+Desmond having been detailed to accompany the division from
+Toledo. When within two days' march of Badajos, an orderly brought
+a note from the marshal, requesting him to ride forward at once.
+This he did without loss of time.
+
+Marshal de Bay had taken up his quarters at Badajos, and on
+arriving in the town, Desmond alighted at the governor's house.
+
+"It was a stupid mistake of mine," the head of the staff said, "in
+sending you on detached duty. I forgot at the moment, when I
+nominated you, that your knowledge of the locality would be
+invaluable to us. I only thought of it yesterday when, on the
+marshal asking for some information on this matter, I pulled out
+your report. He examined it and said, 'This is very complete and
+valuable, Colonel. Whom is it made by?'
+
+"'By an officer of your staff, sir, Captain Kennedy.'
+
+"'Where is he?'
+
+"'He is coming down with the Toledo column, sir.'
+
+"'Please send for him at once,' he said. 'One of the others should
+have been detached for that service. He is just the man we want
+here.'
+
+"Accordingly we sent for you, and here you are."
+
+"This is an excellent report of yours, sir," the duke said, when
+the colonel introduced Desmond to him. "As we came down, I noticed
+that the roads had, in many cases, been thoroughly repaired at the
+points mentioned in your report as being particularly bad, and the
+bridges in many places greatly strengthened. Had it not been for
+that, I do not know how I should have got my guns along.
+
+"And now, sir, I want to ask you a few questions as to the road on
+the other side. By your report, I see that you consider the road
+through Campo Mayor to be the only one by which an army could
+move, and that a large body of workmen must be employed to make
+the other road fit for the passage of cannon."
+
+He then asked a number of questions concerning this road.
+
+"I see," he said, "you have marked several places, in your report,
+where an enemy coming down that road could post themselves
+strongly, and others which might be defended to advantage by us."
+
+"Yes, sir; but of course, the suitability of those places would
+depend largely upon the respective strength of the armies."
+
+The marshal nodded approvingly.
+
+"From all I hear from our agents in Lisbon," he said, "the enemy's
+forces will be superior to our own in numbers, but the main
+portion are Portuguese, who have shown very little fight,
+hitherto. Their cavalry are almost entirely Portuguese. The only
+really fighting portion of their forces are the English and Dutch,
+who are most formidable foes; but against these we have our French
+regiments, on whose bravery we can rely. Were it not that I think
+the Portuguese will probably, as at the battle of Almanza, fly as
+soon as the engagement begins, I should fall back and take up a
+strongly defensive position. As it is, in spite of their superior
+numbers, I think we can meet them on an equal field."
+
+The conversation lasted over an hour, and then Desmond retired,
+leaving Colonel Villeroy with the marshal. As he left the house,
+an officer standing at the door seized his hand.
+
+"My dear Kennedy," he said, "who would have thought that we should
+have met again here!"
+
+Desmond staggered back. He could not, for a moment, believe the
+evidence of his eyes and ears.
+
+"Why, O'Neil, I thought you were dead."
+
+"I am worth a good many dead men, yet," the other one laughed.
+"Let us go into this wine shop and crack a bottle. We can then
+talk over matters quietly."
+
+"And O'Sullivan, is he alive too?" Desmond asked.
+
+"No, poor fellow. He has never been heard of since that tremendous
+licking we got. There is not a shadow of hope."
+
+Then many questions were asked, on both sides; and when these were
+answered, Desmond said:
+
+"Now about yourself, O'Neil. I thought I was the only one that got
+through safe."
+
+"So you were, for the other three of us were all on our backs."
+
+"But we did not hear of you as among the prisoners, of whom a list
+was furnished by Marlborough."
+
+"No; the name of Patrick O'Neil did not appear. I was shot through
+the body, and during the night I lay insensible, but in the
+morning I opened my eyes and began to think. It seemed to me that
+the name was not one that would be likely to please. In the first
+place, because it was evident, by my age, that I was not one of
+the Limerick men; in the next place, because of that little matter
+of my escape from the jail in London. I had no fear of being shot.
+I should be a prisoner of war, but I should not be likely to be
+over kindly treated, and when they exchanged prisoners I should
+certainly not be one of those sent back. You see, what with
+Blenheim and Ramillies and Oudenarde, they had taken ten of our
+officers for every one of their officers captured by us, so I
+thought it best to pass as a French officer.
+
+"It was easy to do so, as my French was good enough to pass
+anywhere, and, you see, I had on a French staff uniform. Luckily
+my horse had been shot at the same time as I was. He was lying
+dead beside me, and within reach of my arm, so that I was able to
+lean over and get my flask from one of the holsters. I had a
+terrible thirst on me, and could have drunk a barrel.
+
+"As I heard no firing, I knew that the fighting was over; and in
+two or three hours a party came along with a stretcher, having a
+doctor with them. When he saw that my eyes were open, and that I
+was alive, he examined my wound and shook his head.
+
+"'He is badly hit,' he said, 'but you may as well carry him in.'
+
+"So they took me into Oudenarde, which had been turned into a big
+hospital.
+
+"'You are not to speak,' the doctor said to me, before they lifted
+me up. 'You must keep yourself perfectly quiet.'
+
+"When they got me into the hospital, they found a hole behind as
+well as in front, which I heard one of the doctors say was a good
+thing. They dressed the wounds and left me. I could see by their
+faces, the next time they came, that they were surprised to see me
+alive. One of them said to the other:
+
+"'The bullet must have passed through him without touching any
+vital point. He may do yet.'
+
+"He bent down, and asked me in French what my name was, and I said
+'Victor Dubosc, lieutenant;' so they stuck a card with my name
+over my bed, and asked me no more questions. I lay there for six
+weeks, and then I was well enough to get up and walk about.
+
+"Three weeks later, I went down with some other convalescents to
+Ostend, and there we were embarked, and taken to Portsmouth. Then
+we were put in boats and rowed to Porchester, which is a place at
+the end of a sort of lake behind Portsmouth. There was an old
+castle there, with a mighty high wall, enclosing a lot of ground,
+where there were huts--rows of them--all filled with our
+prisoners. Some of the huts were a little better than others, and
+these were for the use of officers. A regiment of soldiers was in
+tents outside the walls, and a hundred men were always on guard
+with loaded muskets.
+
+"I said to myself, often and often, 'If Kennedy were here, he
+would soon hit upon some plan for getting away;' but for the life
+of me, I could not see how it was to be managed. It was a dull
+time, I can tell you. The food was bad, and the cooking was worse.
+Only a few officers were there, most of them being sent to some
+place a long distance inland; but, as we were all wounded, I
+suppose they thought that the loss of blood would keep us quiet.
+
+"One of the officers, having a little money hidden about him,
+bought a pack of cards from an English soldier, and we passed most
+of our time playing; but it was poor work, for we had nothing to
+play for. At last, I said to myself, 'Patrick O'Neil, there must
+be an end of this or your brain will go altogether. It is not
+worth much at the best of times, or it would have thought of some
+plan for getting out of this place before now.'
+
+"At last, I hit on a plan. It was a dangerous one, there was no
+doubt of that; but as I was desperate, I did not think much of the
+danger. The worst they could do was to shoot me, which I suppose
+is what they would have done. My idea was to pounce suddenly on
+one of the sentries, who kept guard all night; to gag him, and tie
+him up, before he could give the alarm; and then to dress up in
+his clothes, and take his matchlock.
+
+"But the difficulty was, what was I to do next. The soldiers came
+on duty for twelve hours, coming in at six in the morning and
+going out at six in the evening.
+
+"It was clear to me that it could only be done in the dark, and I
+had to wait for nearly two months. It was the beginning of October
+before it was dark enough, at six in the morning, for me to fall
+in with the others and march out without being noticed.
+
+"At last, the time came. I stole out of my hut an hour before the
+change would be made, and crept along quietly, till I heard a
+sentry marching up and down between our huts and those of the
+soldiers. I had torn up a blanket into strips, and twisted them
+together to make ropes; and with these in one hand, and a big
+piece ready to shove into his mouth in the other, I stole up close
+to him; and when he turned his back to me, I jumped upon him.
+Luckily, instead of carrying the musket on his shoulder, he had it
+under his arm, so that I was able to seize the lock with one hand,
+and clutch him by the throat with the other. I gripped pretty
+hard, and the man, in half a minute, slipped down to the ground.
+
+"Before he could recover, I had stripped off his coatee and cloak;
+then I tied his hands and feet, fastened the gag firmly in his
+mouth, and dragged him in between two huts, where he would not be
+found till morning. Then I took off my own coat and threw it over
+him, for the night was chilly, and put on his cloak and shako, and
+took his place.
+
+"In half an hour I heard a tramp of men, and knew the relief had
+entered. Then there was a bugle call, and two or three sentries
+passed towards the entrance. I ran on, too. When they fell in, I
+managed to get in the last section. Some sergeants ran down the
+line counting the men, and reported that all were present. The
+gates were opened, and we marched out.
+
+"As soon as we got among the tents, we fell out, and I had no
+difficulty whatever in getting off without being observed. Leaving
+my musket and shako behind me, I went up a long lane which brought
+me on to the main road, crossed that, climbed a hill beyond, and
+came down into a wooded country.
+
+"At the first cottage I came to, I stopped. A man and woman came
+out on my knocking. They looked kindly and good tempered, and I
+told them a pitiful story, about how I had been unjustly accused
+of striking an officer, and had been sentenced to two hundred
+lashes; and that I had managed, in the night, to cut a slit in the
+back of the guard tent and escape.
+
+"As I had been walking along, a sudden thought had struck me. At
+Oudenarde, I was wearing the same boots I had worn when we were
+captured together. When we took the money out, we each left, if
+you remember, five pieces of gold in one of our boots, which I had
+never thought of till that day; and, as I came along, I opened the
+sole and took them out. It was a perfect godsend, as you may
+guess.
+
+"The man and his wife expressed such sympathy that I did not
+hesitate to say: 'I want to get rid of my coatee, and of this
+cloak. The coatee would be of no use to you, and you had best burn
+it, but the cloak, if you alter it, might be useful; or, if you cut
+it up, will make a cover for your bed. I will give you that and a
+gold piece--it is a French one I got in the wars, but you can change
+it easily enough, when you go into the town marketing--if you will
+give me a suit of your clothes.'
+
+"This the man readily consented to do, and the woman set before me
+a large bowl of milk, and some bread, which I ate as soon as I had
+put on a pair of breeches, smock, and broad hat. Now I felt
+perfectly safe. They might send news all over the country of the
+escape of a French officer, but as I had never spoken a word of
+English, from the time that I was taken, no one would suspect a
+countryman speaking English to be the man whom they were in search
+of.
+
+"After leaving the cottage, I travelled quietly to Rye. I thought
+it best to go there, for it was likely that it would be difficult,
+elsewhere, for an unknown man to get a passage to France, and it
+struck me that the man who took us across before, would carry me
+over the first time he was going with despatches. I found him
+easily enough, and though I was not dressed quite in the same way
+as I was when we called on him before, he recognized me at once.
+
+"'Another job for me?' he asked.
+
+"'Not a special one,' I said. 'I am going across again, but there
+is no occasion for you to make a special trip, and indeed my
+employer forgot to give me an order upon you. I should have gone
+back, if I had remembered it, but I thought you would not mind
+giving me a passage the next time you sailed across.'
+
+"As the man remembered that we had made ourselves pleasant on
+board, he agreed at once to take me, next time the boat should be
+going. I laid out a pound in getting a coat more suitable for
+travelling in France than the peasant's smock. Then I took a
+lodging in a small inn.
+
+"Three days later, a messenger came down with an order for the man
+to take him across at once, and as the captain charged me nothing
+for my passage, I had enough left to pay for my place in a
+diligence, and on arriving in Paris duly reported myself, at the
+barracks, as having returned.
+
+"My first enquiry, of course, was about you and O'Sullivan. I
+found that he had never been heard of, but that you had lost a
+hand, and had been promoted to a captaincy; had been very ill, and
+had gone to the south of France on sick leave.
+
+"After I heard that, I remained for two or three months at the
+depot, and then learned that the Duke of Berwick had just arrived
+from Dauphiny. I at once went to see him. He told me he could not
+put me on his staff again, as his numbers were complete, but would
+give me a letter to the Duke of Orleans, asking him to employ me
+in that capacity. When I got down here, I found that the duke had
+left, and that the Marshal de Bay was in command.
+
+"On reading Berwick's letter, he at once appointed me one of his
+aides-de-camp. You were away, I found to my great disappointment,
+and I was sent off into Catalonia, with orders for four battalions
+to be sent at once to Badajos. I arrived here yesterday, in time
+for the shindy."
+
+"Fortunately, O'Neil, I do not think there is much fear of another
+Oudenarde. There is no royal duke here, to interfere with our
+general; and the Portuguese are not to be compared with the
+Hanoverians, and Dutch, and the other allies that fought against
+us there."
+
+"I hear, from the others, that you have been occupied in
+reconnoitring the country."
+
+"Yes, and I was captured, but was fortunately able to give them
+the slip."
+
+Desmond did not care to tell even his friend that his escape was
+due to the kindness of the British general.
+
+The next morning, Desmond was sent off to hurry up a body of
+troops which was still some seven or eight marches away. The news
+had come that the allied army was in motion, and would probably
+concentrate near Portalegre. This seemed to show that they
+intended to invade Spain by Badajos, and the valley of the
+Guadiana; for, had their aim been to advance up the valley of the
+Tagus, to Madrid, they would have marched towards Montalvao, and
+so on by Alcantara to Almarez.
+
+After two days' hard riding he met the column, which, on receiving
+the order from the marshal to hasten forward with all speed,
+performed double marches until they arrived at Badajos. Desmond
+found that the allies had not wasted their time, and that their
+advance guard was already at Campo Mayor. The Spanish army were
+posted on the Caya river, a stream that flowed down from the
+sierra, and fell into the Guadiana at Badajos.
+
+Their position was a defensive one. The army of the allies was
+known to be some twenty-two thousand strong, of whom some five
+thousand were cavalry. The Spanish had about the same strength of
+cavalry, but were inferior in infantry. The number of guns also
+was about equal, both sides having about forty cannon.
+
+On the 7th of May, the two armies faced each other on opposite
+sides of the river Caya. As neither party made any movement of
+advance, Marshal de Bay determined to force on an engagement, and
+sent orders to the cavalry to cross the river, and to place
+themselves on the road between the enemy and Campo Mayor.
+
+The allies suffered, as the French had done at Oudenarde, by
+conflicting counsels. The Earl of Galway was in command of the
+British, and of two or three Dutch regiments. The Marquis de
+Frontiera was in command of the Portuguese, who formed by far the
+greater portion of the force, and, as soon as the movement was
+seen on the other side of the river, he determined to cross and
+attack the Spaniards.
+
+The Earl of Galway was strongly of opinion that it would not be
+wise to take the offensive, but that the army should remain in its
+present position, until the intentions of the enemy were clearly
+ascertained. Their cavalry, he urged, could do little by
+themselves, and it was evident that the infantry could not be
+attacked while they remained under the shelter of the guns of the
+fortress. The Marquis de Frontiera, however, and the other
+Portuguese generals, were unanimous in insisting that battle
+should be given at once, and the former gave orders for the
+Portuguese cavalry, with a body of foot and five field pieces, to
+march immediately.
+
+Seeing that, if unsupported, this force must meet with disaster,
+the Earl of Galway reluctantly ordered the troops under his
+command to advance. The river was fordable, and they met with no
+opposition, until they crossed it and formed up in order of
+battle. The Portuguese horse were now divided on each wing, the
+British were in the centre; a portion of the Portuguese infantry
+were on either flank, the rest were in the rear.
+
+"Captain Kennedy, you will carry my orders at once, to our
+cavalry, to charge the Portuguese horse on the right wing."
+
+Desmond saluted, and was about to ride off, when he paused a
+moment and asked:
+
+"May I charge with Brigadier Crofton's dragoons, sir?"
+
+The marshal nodded, and Desmond galloped off. Crofton was in
+command of the first line of cavalry. His own regiment, which was
+composed partly of Irishmen and partly of Spaniards, was in the
+centre of the line.
+
+After delivering his orders to the general commanding the cavalry,
+Desmond rode on to Crofton.
+
+"The cavalry are going to charge, sir," he said, "and I have
+permission to ride with you."
+
+Crofton waited until the order from the general arrived, and then,
+drawing his sword, shouted, "The first brigade will charge," and,
+riding forward, led the way against the Portuguese horse, whose
+cannon had already opened fire. The Portuguese fell into disorder
+as soon as they saw the long line of horsemen charging down on
+them like a torrent, and when it neared them broke and fled. They
+were soon overtaken, great numbers were cut down, and the
+remainder galloped off, a panic-stricken mob, and did not draw
+rein until they reached Campo Mayor.
+
+The Spaniards at once turned the five cannon the fugitives had
+left behind them upon the allied infantry, and then, after a few
+rounds had been fired, the cavalry charged the British infantry.
+But they had now foes of a different metal to reckon with, and
+although, three times, the horsemen reformed their ranks and
+hurled themselves against the infantry, they were each time
+repulsed with heavy loss.
+
+Then, swerving round, they fell on the Portuguese infantry in the
+second line, whom they dispersed as easily as they had defeated
+the cavalry.
+
+The Earl of Galway now brought up the brigade of Brigadier General
+Pierce, which consisted of the two British regiments of Barrimore
+and Stanwix, and a Spanish regiment which had been recently raised
+and named after himself. These charged the enemy with great
+bravery, drove back their infantry for some distance, recovered
+the five guns the cavalry had lost, and, still pressing forward,
+fought their way deep into the centre of the Spanish ranks.
+
+Had they been supported by the Portuguese infantry, on their
+flank, the battle might still have been won. But the latter, in
+spite of the persuasions and orders of their officers, refused to
+advance, and, turning their backs, made off in confusion, although
+not yet attacked by the enemy. Orders were then sent to the
+Portuguese horse on the left to charge to the assistance of
+Pierce's brigade. But instead of doing this, they also galloped
+off the field, and after defending themselves with desperate
+valour for some time, the little brigade, being unsupported, and
+being surrounded by the whole strength of the Spaniards, was
+forced to surrender.
+
+In the meantime the Earl of Galway, seeing that the battle was
+lost, through the cowardice of the Portuguese, was preparing to
+withdraw his men, and had only despatched Pierce's brigade to
+check the advance of the enemy while he did so. Seeing that these,
+by their ardour, were irretrievably cut off, he gave the order to
+the Marquis Montandre to draw off the British infantry, who alone
+remained firm, and against whom the whole of the French and
+Spanish forces now advanced; while he himself with a small body of
+cavalry, charged into the midst of the enemy in hopes of reaching
+Pierce's brigade and drawing it off.
+
+Although weakened by the loss of that brigade, attacked on both
+flanks as well as in front, and frequently charged by the Spanish
+horse, among which Crofton's dragoons were conspicuous for their
+bravery, the retreating British maintained admirable order.
+Occasionally, when severely pressed, they charged the enemy and
+beat them back; till they were able to withdraw from the field
+with comparatively trifling loss, thus saving the flying
+Portuguese from annihilation. As at Almanza, the whole of the
+fighting, and almost all the loss, fell upon the English, although
+a considerable number of the Portuguese were cut down in their
+flight, before the Spanish cavalry returned to join in the attack
+on the retiring English. The allies had, altogether, seventeen
+hundred men killed or wounded, and two thousand three hundred
+taken prisoners, of whom fifteen hundred were Pierce's brigade;
+and eight hundred Portuguese, who were cut off by the cavalry.
+
+Among the prisoners were the Earl of Barrimore, all the officers
+of Pierce's brigade, Lord Pawlet, one of the earl's aides-de-camp,
+two of his pages, and his master of horse.
+
+After the battle was over, and Desmond had rejoined the marshal,
+he was sent to ride over the field, and ascertain who had fallen
+and what prisoners had been taken. Night was already coming on,
+and, after fulfilling his mission as far as was possible in the
+confusion, he came upon two Spanish soldiers, with a prisoner.
+
+"Whom have you there?" he asked, in Spanish.
+
+"I don't know, sir. We found him lying under his horse, which, in
+its fall, had so pinned down his leg that he could not escape.
+Several others had fallen round him, and it was only when we heard
+a cry for help that we turned the dead horse over, and found him
+under it, and then got him out."
+
+Standing close, there was light enough for Desmond to distinguish
+the prisoner's features. He gave a slight start of surprise, then
+he said:
+
+"You have done well, my men. Here is a doubloon, to get some drink
+with your comrades when you get into the town. I will look after
+the prisoner."
+
+The men saluted and went off, well pleased to have got rid of the
+trouble of marching their prisoner into the town. Mike, rather
+surprised, moved up to take charge of the captive.
+
+"My lord," Desmond said, "I will now endeavour to repay the
+kindness you showed me.
+
+"Do you see that little hut, Mike, just at the edge of those
+trees? You must hide the earl there. Our cavalry are still all
+over the country, hunting down fugitives."
+
+The earl, who was scarcely able to walk, his leg having been
+injured by the weight of the horse upon it, murmured his thanks,
+but did not speak again until they had entered the shed, when
+Desmond said:
+
+"Now, General, I will first cut down your riding boot, to ease
+your leg. Then, if you will lie down in that corner, we will pile
+this firewood over you. It will not be safe for you to attempt to
+go forward for two or three hours yet. I have a report to make to
+Marshal de Bay. When I have handed it in, I will return at once.
+
+"Mike, do you stay near the hut, and if any searching party should
+come along, which is scarcely likely, for they have all gone
+farther afield, you can say there is no need to search the hut, as
+you, with an officer, have already examined it."
+
+In a few minutes, the earl was completely hidden. Desmond then
+rode into Badajos, and delivered his report to the marshal. He
+then went to the stables, took out his spare horse, and, leading
+it, rode out to the hut again.
+
+"Has anyone been here?" he asked Mike.
+
+"Not a soul, sir."
+
+"Take the horses into the wood, then, and stay with them for the
+present. It will not be safe for the earl to move for a couple of
+hours.
+
+"Now, General," he went on, as he removed the firewood, "I fear
+that you have been very uncomfortable."
+
+"I can hardly say that I have been comfortable, sir, but that is
+of no consequence. The pain in my leg has abated, since you cut
+the boot open.
+
+"And now, how can I express my gratitude to you, for thus
+sheltering me?"
+
+"It is but a fair return of services, sir. You gave me my liberty,
+and I am doing my best to restore yours to you."
+
+"It is all very well to say that, Captain Kennedy. I am the
+general in command of the British forces in Portugal, and had I
+chosen to openly release you, none could have questioned me. It
+was only because some magnified report of the affair might have
+reached the ears of the Portuguese Government, and given rise to
+rumours hostile to me, that I thought it best to let it appear to
+be an accidental escape. You see, I am by no means popular with
+the Portuguese. In the first place, I am a Protestant; and in the
+next place, I am constantly bringing pressure to bear upon them,
+as to the supply of provisions, the making of roads, the proper
+feeding and arming of their own troops, and other matters of the
+same kind; and they would be only too glad to have some cause of
+complaint against me.
+
+"But your case is altogether different, for you are risking even
+your life in thus aiding me to escape."
+
+"That may be, General, but it was nevertheless my duty, as a
+matter of conscience, to endeavour to return the kindness that you
+showed me; and as, at present, your army will hardly be in a state
+to take the field against us for a long time, I do not feel that I
+am seriously injuring our cause."
+
+"Well, sir, I shall be your debtor for life.
+
+"Do you intend to remain always an exile, Captain Kennedy?" the
+Earl of Galway went on. "It seems to me little short of madness
+that so many gallant gentlemen should cut themselves altogether
+adrift from their native country, and pass their lives fighting as
+mercenaries. I do not use the word offensively, but only in its
+proper meaning, of foreigners serving in the army of a nation not
+their own. Nor do I mean to insult Irish gentlemen, by even
+hinting that they serve simply for pay. They fight for France
+mainly in the hope that France will some day aid in setting James
+Stuart on the British throne; a forlorn hope, for although Louis
+may encourage the hopes of the Stuarts and their followers, by
+patronizing their cause, which it suits him to do because it gives
+him the means of striking at England, by effecting a landing in
+Scotland or Ireland; it is yet a matter upon which he must be
+indifferent, save in his own interest, and in the advantage it
+gives him of keeping in his service some dozen or so splendid
+regiments, on whose valour he can always rely."
+
+"That is true, sir," Desmond replied; "and I own I have no great
+hope that, by the means of French assistance, the Stuarts will
+regain their throne. But what could I do if I were to return to
+Ireland? Beyond the fact that my name is Kennedy, I am in absolute
+ignorance as to what branch of that family I belong to, and have
+practically not a friend in the country. Were I to land in
+Ireland, I have no means of earning my living, and should
+doubtless be denounced as one who had served in the Irish Brigade.
+I own that I should be glad to return there, for a time, in order
+to make enquiries as to my family. I was but sixteen when I left,
+and was kept, as it seems to me, purposely, in total ignorance on
+the subject. It may be that I was the son of a brave officer of
+that name, who certainly came over to France soon after I was
+born, and fell fighting some years before I came out; but I have
+no proof that it was so, and would give a great deal to be able to
+ascertain it.
+
+"In Ireland they think a great deal of genealogy, and I am often
+questioned, by Irishmen of old descent, as to my family; and find
+it extremely awkward to be obliged to own that I know nothing of
+it, with any certainty. I have no desire to pass my life in
+battles and sieges, and, if I survive the risks and perils, to
+settle down as a Frenchman with an Irish name."
+
+"That I can well understand," the earl said. "'Tis a life that no
+man could desire, for it would certainly be a wasted one. I can
+assure you that I think the chance of James Stuart, or his
+descendants, gaining the throne of England is remote in the
+extreme. When William of Orange came over, there was no standing
+army, and as James the Second had rendered himself extremely
+unpopular by his Catholic leanings, he became possessed of England
+without opposition, and of Ireland by means of his Dutch troops.
+The matter is entirely changed, now. England has a strong army,
+against which a gathering, however strong, of undisciplined men
+could have but little chance. I conceive it possible that a
+Catholic Stuart might regain the throne of Ireland, if backed by a
+French army, and if the people were supplied with French arms and
+money. But that he would retain the throne, after the French were
+withdrawn, I regard as next to impossible."
+
+"I cannot but think the same, sir. However, as I see no chance of
+my being able to go to Ireland, even to push my enquiries as to my
+family, there is nothing for it but to remain a soldier of
+France."
+
+"In that matter, I might assist you, Captain Kennedy. I have no
+doubt that my influence, and that of my friends in England, would
+without difficulty suffice to gain permission for you to visit
+Ireland on private business, on my undertaking that you have no
+political object whatever in desiring to do so, and that you
+engage yourself to enter into no plots or schemes for a rising.
+Furthermore, I think I can promise that, if you succeed in your
+researches, and find that you have relations and friends there, I
+could, if you desire it, obtain a revocation of any pains and
+penalties you may have incurred, and a restoration of all your
+rights as an Irishman. That is certainly the least I can do, after
+the vital service that you have rendered me--a service that, in
+itself, shows you do not share in the bitter enmity so many of
+your countrymen, unfortunately, feel against England."
+
+"I have no such enmity, assuredly," Desmond said. "The choice of
+coming out here, to enter the service of France, was not of my own
+making; but was made, for some reason which I have never been able
+to understand, by the gentleman who had borne the expenses of my
+bringing up, but who was himself a strong supporter of the English
+rule, and therefore would have been expected to place every
+obstacle in the way of my entering the Irish Brigade."
+
+
+
+Chapter 18: War.
+
+
+After hearing Desmond's story the earl asked several questions,
+and obtained further details of his life when a boy, and of his
+interview with John O'Carroll.
+
+"It is certainly strange," he said thoughtfully, "and worth
+enquiring into, for it would seem that he must have some interest
+in thus getting you out of the way, and in your entering a service
+that would render it next to impossible that you should ever
+return to your native land."
+
+"I don't see any possible interest that he could have had in that,
+sir; but, certainly, I have never been able to account for his
+conduct."
+
+"It is clear that there is some mystery about it," the earl said
+warmly, "and were I you, I should certainly take leave of absence,
+for a time, and go over and get to the bottom of the matter. At
+any rate, I will at once write to London and obtain a safe conduct
+for you. This you can use, or not, as you may decide, and can
+then, if you so please, return and continue your service here.
+
+"Methinks that the war will not last very much longer. France is
+impoverished, the disasters which have befallen her arms in
+Flanders have rendered the war unpopular, and in England, in spite
+of the success gained by their arms, the heavy taxation is making
+men ask why a war should be continued which may benefit Holland,
+and the German allies, but can result in no good to England.
+
+"And now, Captain Kennedy, I will be making my way to join the
+remains of my army. I thank you again, most heartily, for your
+generous conduct; and, believe me, you may always command my
+services in any direction. I only regret that these unhappy
+political difficulties should drive you, and so many of your brave
+countrymen, into the service of a power that has always been, and
+so far as I can see is likely to remain, an enemy of England."
+
+"I may say, sir, that Lord Godolphin has, for a certain reason,
+promised to befriend me; and that, if you write to him on the
+subject of a safe conduct, I think I could rely upon his taking a
+favourable view of the matter."
+
+"I will do so, certainly," the earl said. "His power is great. If
+he is favourably disposed towards you, you may consider the matter
+as done."
+
+They chatted for some time longer, and then Desmond said:
+
+"I think now, sir, that it would be safe to move. Everything is
+perfectly quiet without, and I have no doubt that, by this time,
+the cavalry have all returned to Badajos. However, I will
+accompany you for a short distance, for you may be stopped by some
+of our advance posts. You had best take the cloak and hat of my
+follower, and, as I am well known, no questions will then be
+asked."
+
+"By the way," Lord Galway added as, Mike having brought up the
+horses, he mounted; "where shall I send a letter to you, with your
+safe conduct? We are in communication with many persons at Madrid,
+and can pass a letter through the lines at any time."
+
+"When there, I lodge at the house of Don Pedro Sarasta, in the
+Calle del Retiro. I will request him to forward any letters to me,
+should I be absent."
+
+The earl made a note of the address in his pocketbook, and then,
+putting on Mike's cloak and hat, started with Desmond, who passed
+him without question through the lines of outposts; which were
+indeed but carelessly kept, as it was certain that, after the
+signal victory that had been gained, it would be a long time
+before any enemy would venture to attack them.
+
+Two days after the fight, the Marquis de Bay moved forward with
+his army, with the intention of fighting another battle; but
+Galway and Frontiera had, by this time, reorganized their forces,
+and occupied so strong a position, near Elvas, that he could not
+venture to attack them. However, he occupied the country for a
+considerable distance beyond the frontier, subsisting his army
+upon the provisions and forage collected by his cavalry in the
+villages and small towns. As it was evident that, after the proof
+given of the inability of the Portuguese to withstand any attack,
+there was no probability of offensive operations being renewed by
+the allies; and, the heat becoming intense, the force was
+withdrawn across the frontier and went into quarters, the general
+returning to Madrid, where he received an enthusiastic welcome
+from the inhabitants.
+
+By this time, however, the knowledge that the king of France was
+entering into negotiations, which would necessitate his desertion
+of Spain, greatly excited the population against the French
+stationed in the capital. They were hissed and hooted when they
+appeared in the streets, and for a time, the indignation was so
+great that the troops were ordered to remain in their barracks.
+The king himself, however, gained rather than lost popularity, as
+he issued a proclamation to the people, saying that, having
+accepted their invitation to be their king, he would remain with
+them until driven from his throne by force; and he confided
+absolutely in their affection, and aid, to enable him to withstand
+any foes who might attempt to dethrone him.
+
+In the autumn another change occurred. Although, in order to
+obtain peace, he had granted all the demands, however exorbitant,
+of the allies, and had undertaken to withdraw his troops from
+Spain, Louis stood firm when to these conditions they added
+another, namely, that he should himself undertake, by force, to
+dethrone his grandson. This monstrous demand united, at once, both
+those who wished to continue the war rather than grant such
+humiliating terms as those which had been insisted upon, and the
+party who were in favour of peace, even at that cost. The
+negotiations were abruptly broken off, and the French troops, who
+were already on the march towards the frontier, received orders to
+remain in Spain.
+
+Now that he had O'Neil with him, the time in Madrid passed more
+pleasantly for Desmond than before. He was frequently away for several
+days, carrying despatches to the commanders of the forces in Valencia
+and Barcelona. In the capital the French were again regarded as
+friends, and as several successes had been gained and places captured,
+in Catalonia, the hope that the civil war that had so long been waged
+was approaching its end, and the confidence engendered by the victory
+on the Caya, made the people doubt whether any attempt at invasion
+from the west would be contemplated, and they gave themselves up to
+gaiety. Balls and fetes were frequently organized, and at these the
+French were among the most honoured guests.
+
+Early in the spring preparations were made for active operations.
+Lieutenant General O'Mahony had just returned from Sicily, where
+he had rendered distinguished service. In the previous year,
+Crofton had been made a major general, and two new regiments of
+Irish infantry had been formed, of deserters from the enemy in
+Catalonia and Portugal. These were commanded by Colonel Dermond
+M'Auliffe and Colonel John Comerford. These two regiments, with
+another under Colonel Macdonald, marched from Madrid in April.
+
+As the Marquis de Bay was not yet moving he offered O'Mahony, who
+had the command of the force, the services of Desmond and O'Neil
+as aides-de-camp. The offer was a welcome one, for, as none of the
+men in the newly raised regiments was acquainted with the
+language, Desmond, who now spoke Spanish well, would be far more
+valuable to him than Spanish officers could be.
+
+For two months the little force moved about in Catalonia, the
+rapidity of its marches baffling the attempts of the archduke's
+forces to interfere with its operations. These were principally
+directed against various small fortresses, held by partisans of
+Charles. Several of these were captured, thus clearing the roads
+they guarded, and opening the country for the more important
+operations that Philip himself was about to undertake.
+
+It was not until July that the royal army approached Lerida, where
+O'Mahony's force joined it. General Stanhope marched, with the
+troops under his command, and encamped at Balaguer; where he was
+joined by Baron de Wetzel, with some troops which had been brought
+from Italy. As Stanhope's force was insufficient to give battle
+until joined by the main army of Charles, he marched, on the 31st
+of July, headed by two English and two Dutch regiments of
+dragoons, to secure the passes near Alfaro, and so check the
+advance of the Spaniards.
+
+After performing a long and difficult march, they took up a
+defensive position. Stanhope found, however, that the river in
+front of him was so low that cavalry and artillery could pass
+easily, and even infantry could cross without difficulty. Scarcely
+had he taken up his position when two brigades of infantry and
+nineteen squadrons of cavalry were seen approaching, having been
+detached from the Spanish army to occupy the position which had
+been secured by the rapidity of Stanhope's march. They therefore
+waited for their main army to come up, but before it did so, the
+whole of Stanhope's force had arrived, and was prepared for
+battle.
+
+Although it was past six o'clock in the evening, Charles, on his
+arrival, decided to fall upon the enemy before they could encamp,
+which they might do in a position in which it would be difficult
+to attack them. Fourteen cannon at once opened fire from an
+eminence, whence they commanded the position taken up by the
+advance force of the Spaniards. This position was on low ground in
+front of the ridge upon which the village of Almenara stood, and
+nothing could be seen of the force that lay behind this ridge.
+
+The advanced force of Spaniards ascended this ridge, as soon as
+the artillery opened upon them, and General Stanhope obtained
+leave from Marshal Staremberg, who commanded the archduke's army,
+to charge them. With ten squadrons of horse he rode up the ascent,
+and there, when he gained it, saw to his surprise twenty-two
+squadrons facing him, flanked with infantry, and supported with
+another line of cavalry equally strong. He sent back at once for
+fourteen squadrons from his second line, and when six of these
+came up he advanced against the Spaniards, who at the same time
+moved forward to meet him.
+
+The cavalry on Philip's left at once gave way. The centre and
+right, aided by the fire of the infantry, made a stout fight, but
+were driven back by the English and Dutch cavalry. The fighting
+was severe, for of the six English squadrons who charged, two
+hundred men and twenty-one officers were killed or wounded.
+
+Philip's second line of cavalry gave but feeble support, and
+Stanhope's horse soon had them all in confusion, and, driving them
+from the field, pursued them hotly. The fugitives dashed into
+their own infantry, who were just arriving in force, and their
+panic communicated itself to them, and a total rout took place.
+The pursuit was kept up until it was so dark that the troopers
+were unable to see each other's faces, and they then halted,
+having defeated the Spanish without the aid of their infantry,
+which had not come up in time to take any part in the fight. Much
+of the baggage, together with tents, many cannon, and a quantity
+of ammunition, fell into the hands of the victors. Owing to the
+darkness, the number of prisoners taken was small.
+
+O'Mahony and his troops had taken no part in the engagement, as,
+having arrived late on the previous evening after a long march,
+they were still at Lerida. It had not been deemed necessary to
+hurry them forward, as no battle was expected to take place for
+some days--as, indeed, would have been the case had the force sent
+forward arrived at the river before Stanhope.
+
+The routed troops arrived under the shelter of the guns of Lerida.
+Charles did not attack them there, but, making a detour, seized
+several places in Aragon, with the intention of cutting the line
+by which Philip would probably retire, and forcing him to fight
+again. Philip, however, on his part, marched from Lerida in order
+to retire into Castile by way of Saragossa. Charles followed
+hotly, and a portion of his cavalry came up to the rear of the
+enemy in the defile of Penalva. Here the Spaniards posted a strong
+force of grenadiers, and the defile being too narrow for the
+cavalry to act, these dismounted, and a hot fight took place, in
+which both parties claimed the victory. However, Philip retired
+the same day in great haste. Charles, arriving three hours later,
+ate the dinner that had been prepared for his rival.
+
+The Spaniards, covered by the defence of the pass, crossed the
+Ebro and posted themselves in a strong position within a mile of
+Saragossa. On the 21st of August Marshal Staremberg, with his
+generals, having reconnoitred their position, gave orders for the
+attack to take place the next morning, and at daybreak the cannon
+on both sides opened fire. General Stanhope, who commanded on the
+left wing, found that the enemy had the greater part of their
+cavalry facing him, and therefore strengthened his force by four
+battalions of foot and six squadrons of Portuguese horse.
+
+The Spanish line ran obliquely, from the river on their left to a
+steep hill on their right, occupied by their cavalry and a battery
+of artillery. These, therefore, were much nearer to the attacking
+force than were those on the plain.
+
+The battle began at twelve o'clock, Charles's force marching in
+two lines, with the exception of Stanhope's cavalry and infantry.
+These, from their situation, were the first to come in contact
+with the enemy. The four battalions first pushed forward up the
+hill, and, driving the Spanish cavalry back, allowed Stanhope's
+horse to ascend the hill and form on its crest. The battle
+speedily ranged along the whole line. The Spaniards, with superior
+numbers, gained ground on their left. Here O'Mahony's corps were
+stationed, and they drove a portion of the allies across the Ebro
+again; but this success was more than counterbalanced on the other
+flank, where Stanhope's cavalry and infantry carried all before
+them. The latter, posted in a hollow, opened so heavy a fire upon
+the Spanish infantry, as they advanced, that they fell into
+disorder; and as their cavalry were driven off, hotly pursued by
+Stanhope, they fell back upon the centre, which they threw into
+disorder. Seeing that the battle was lost, the Marquis de Bay gave
+the order to retire.
+
+Two hours after the first shot was fired, the rout of the Spanish
+centre and right was complete, but a considerable portion of the
+troops were rallied by de Bay at Alagon, three leagues above
+Saragossa. The left wing, under Generals Amezaga and O'Mahony,
+were checked in their course of victory by the disaster which
+befell the centre and right; but, maintaining their discipline,
+they fell back in good order, and rejoined their defeated comrades
+at Alagon.
+
+All the cannon and most of the colours of the regiments forming
+the centre and right fell into the hands of the victors. The loss
+of the allies was about two thousand men, killed or wounded; and
+that of the Spaniards and French three thousand killed and
+wounded, and between five and six thousand prisoners. Philip rode
+at once to Madrid, and on the evening of the battle the archduke
+entered Saragossa; while de Bay retired, with the broken remains
+of his troops, towards Navarre.
+
+Desmond and O'Neil, who had ridden behind O'Mahony, saw the
+Spanish troops of the archduke yield before the impetuous attacks
+of the Irish regiments, who, as they pressed their foes backwards,
+burst into loud cheering, believing the victory already won.
+Presently, O'Mahony stopped the advance.
+
+"We must not push too far forward," he said. "It seems to me that
+things are not going so well in other directions. Our centre is
+being pressed back. What is going on on the right I cannot say,
+but the enemy seems to have gained the top of the hill, for our
+cannon there are silent. If the centre is driven back, those we
+have now beaten will rally, and we shall be taken in flank by the
+fire of their centre. Therefore, let us be content with what we
+have done, and wait and see how things turn out elsewhere."
+
+Even before the rout of the Spanish right, their centre was
+yielding, for opposed to them were the British and Dutch
+regiments, whose attack they were altogether unable to withstand.
+It soon became clear that, at all other points on the field, the
+battle was going against the Spaniards, and an aide-de-camp
+presently rode up, hastily, with orders from Marshal de Bay for
+his left to fall back and retire to Alagon.
+
+Deep was the rage and disappointment among the troops of O'Mahony
+and Amezaga, as they faced about and set out on their march. They
+were unmolested. The troops they had beaten were in no disposition
+to follow them, while the allied cavalry and the infantry of their
+centre were in full pursuit of the rest of Philip's army, the
+remnants of which the little force joined, at Alagon, before
+nightfall.
+
+It was some days before the archduke's army moved forward again.
+The troops were exhausted by the long marches they had made, and
+there was a difference of opinion among the generals as to the
+course that had best be followed. The king wished to pursue the
+beaten enemy and, if possible, to intercept their march towards
+France, but Count Staremberg and Stanhope were of opinion that
+they should first occupy Madrid, and then march into Navarre, so
+as to bar the advance of fresh French troops into Spain, and at
+the same time open communications by sea with England, whence they
+could be supplied with reinforcements and stores of provisions.
+
+Finally, Charles gave way, and the allies marched towards Madrid.
+The main portion of the army halted at Alcala, a day's march from
+the capital, and General Stanhope marched on with his division to
+Madrid, which opened its gates without resistance, Philip having
+retired with his army. Charles entered the city on the 28th of
+September, 1710.
+
+The alarm, in France, at the news of the defeat at Saragossa was
+great, and Louis at once despatched the Duke of Vendome to command
+there. The latter, travelling fast, and gathering up the garrisons
+of the towns through which he passed, crossed the frontier at
+nearly the same time as Charles entered Madrid, and effected a
+junction with de Bay's army; which had, by this time, been
+increased by some fourteen thousand men, drawn from the garrisons
+of towns in Navarre, Castile, Galicia, and Valencia.
+
+Vendome had no doubt that the intention of the allies, in marching
+upon Madrid, was to open communication with the Portuguese, and
+determined to throw himself between the capital and the frontier.
+Marching with all speed, he encamped near Salamanca on the 6th of
+October, and thence moved to Plasencia, thereby securing the
+bridge of Almarez, and preventing the Portuguese from joining
+Charles.
+
+Had it not been for the usual indecision and want of energy on the
+part of the Portuguese Government, the junction might have been
+effected before Vendome arrived at Plasencia, for both Charles and
+Stanhope had, after the victory of Saragossa, written urgently,
+begging that the Portuguese army should at once advance and join
+them at Madrid; and that, at any rate, if the whole army could not
+move, at least the troops in the pay of England should push
+forward instantly. Stanhope, indeed had marched with his division
+to the bridge of Almarez to facilitate the junction, and had
+defeated a Spanish force guarding the bridge. However, the
+Portuguese did not arrive; and when a messenger brought the
+alarming news that a Spanish and French army had occupied
+Plasencia, Stanhope fell back towards Madrid.
+
+As large French reinforcements were known to be approaching the
+frontier, and Philip's army was already much superior in numbers
+to that of the allies, it was decided, in a council of war, to
+evacuate Madrid. The forces which had occupied Toledo and other
+towns were recalled, and, early in December, the army left the
+capital; the archduke riding at once to Barcelona, while the army,
+of which Stanhope's division formed the rear guard, followed in
+the same direction.
+
+The movement had been delayed too long. Vendome and Philip were
+already at hand, and on the 9th fell upon Stanhope's division at
+Brihuega. This force, consisting of eight English battalions and the
+same number of Portuguese horse, defended themselves desperately, and
+although the town was wholly without fortifications, they repulsed
+every attack until their ammunition was exhausted, and they were then
+forced to surrender. Staremberg, on hearing that Stanhope was attacked
+and surrounded, turned back and marched with all speed to relieve him,
+but on arriving within three hours' march of the town, heard that he
+had surrendered.
+
+The Duke of Vendome, hearing of his coming, drew his troops out
+and formed them in line of battle, and the next morning attacked
+him vigorously. The allied right held their ground, but the left
+fled, and Vendome swept his right round and took the centre and
+right of the allies in the rear. Three battalions of the second
+line, however, fell in turn upon the French rear and repulsed
+them, and the left wing, rallying again, renewed the battle.
+
+The combat was indecisive, both parties claiming the victory.
+Staremberg wrote to Charles that he had captured all the enemy's
+guns, and had killed six thousand of them; while the French
+claimed that they had totally defeated the allies, and captured
+all their cannon, killed four thousand, and taken nine thousand
+prisoners. The balance of probability lies to some extent with the
+French, for the day after the battle, Staremberg retired and
+marched to Barcelona; but the fact that he was not at once pursued
+shows that the French and Spaniards must have suffered very
+heavily.
+
+Desmond had passed unscathed through the battle of Saragossa.
+O'Neil had been severely wounded, but had managed to sit his horse
+until the division effected its junction with the Marquis de Bay's
+shattered forces. Great was the wrath among the two Irish
+regiments at the issue of the battle.
+
+"What is the use," an officer said to Desmond, "of our throwing
+away our lives, fighting for these Spaniards, when they themselves
+are useless, save when they meet the Portuguese, who are still
+more contemptible? Here have we, on level ground, fairly beaten
+the enemy, while the right and centre, although having a great
+advantage in position, allow themselves to be scattered like a
+flock of sheep."
+
+"They had stouter foes to meet than we had," Desmond said. "We had
+only Spaniards opposed to us, while they had English and Dutch to
+fight; and as the best French troops have found, in Flanders, that
+these were at least a match for them, we must not blame the
+Spanish too severely for giving way before they were attacked."
+
+"There is something in that, I admit, Kennedy. It seems to me
+that, in this war, it would be much better if the Spaniards and
+Portuguese had both remained at home, and allowed the French and
+us fight it out with the English and Dutch. The battles would have
+been small, but at least they would have been desperately fought."
+
+"But it would be absurd, Moore, for us to lay down our lives in a
+struggle in which those principally concerned took no part
+whatever, and which was of no great interest either to us or to
+the English. After the way in which Louis was ready to throw over
+Spain and Philip at the beginning of the year, the Spanish
+alliance can be of no great advantage to him, and I do not think
+that even Philip's orders would induce a Spanish army to march
+across the frontier to assist France. Therefore, as Louis can gain
+nothing by the Spanish alliance, why should he weaken himself by
+sending forces here to maintain Philip on the throne?"
+
+"But with the Archduke Charles here, he would have an enemy on his
+frontier. Philip might not assist him, but Charles would be
+actively hostile. The English and Dutch troops would be pouring
+into the peninsula, and we should have another Flanders in the
+south of France."
+
+"Well," Desmond said, after a pause; "the best way I can see out
+of it is for both Philip and Charles to withdraw, and allow the
+Spanish to elect a Spaniard for their king; or, if they could not
+agree to that, which I don't suppose they could do, choose some
+foreign prince belonging to a petty state which stands altogether
+aloof from European affairs, and seat him on the throne. If,
+again, they would not accept him, England and France should
+mutually agree not to interfere in the affair, and let the
+Spaniards indulge in civil war as long as it pleases them."
+
+Moore laughed.
+
+"It might be a good solution, Kennedy, but there is no more chance
+of Philip or Charles renouncing their pretensions, or indeed of
+the French on one side and the allies on the other permitting them
+to do so, than there is of the world becoming an utopia, where war
+shall be unknown, and all peoples live together in peace and
+amity."
+
+"Well," Desmond said, "for my part, I am sick of fighting in
+quarrels that do not concern me, and when this campaign comes to
+an end I shall, if possible, rejoin Berwick. The cause of the
+Stuarts is not advanced, in the slightest, by what is taking place
+in Spain, and if I am to fight, I would rather do so where victory
+would benefit us."
+
+"I don't know that you are not right," the other assented. "It
+certainly seems a pity that the best blood of Ireland should be
+spilled, in Flanders and Spain, in the service of a foreign
+country. To my mind, the terms of the surrender of Limerick were
+disadvantageous both to Ireland and England. England has gained a
+number of inveterate foes who, with good and wise treatment, might
+now be fighting in her own ranks. Ireland has lost her best blood,
+men who were her natural leaders, and belonged to the old
+families, whom all respected."
+
+"I am sure it was a mistake," Desmond said. "If the terms had been
+an absolute equality in all matters of religion, and the free
+pardon of all, without confiscation of their property or other
+disability, it would have gone far to reconcile our people to
+defeat; for they would have seen that they could not hope for more
+than the right of free exercise of their religion, if the Stuarts
+came to the throne again."
+
+"Perhaps you are right, Kennedy. I know that I myself, had it not
+been for the persecutions and the priest hunting, and the closing
+of our chapels, should never have thought of leaving Ireland and
+taking foreign service. But now there is no going back."
+
+"No, I suppose not," Desmond said, gloomily. "Nothing short of an
+amnesty, ensuring freedom of worship, and perfect civil equality
+to all, would induce the majority of us to return to Ireland; and,
+indeed, it is not easy to see what we could do if we got there.
+The estates of our fathers are in the hands of strangers. We
+should soon be altogether without resources, and we should be
+almost driven to conspire again, even though success would in no
+way mend the matter.
+
+"However, there is no chance of such an act being passed, for,
+even if the English Ministry desired to do so, the Protestant
+feeling in England and Scotland would be too strong for them; and
+Parliament, which strongly represents that feeling, would reject
+the bill by an immense majority."
+
+"Then there is nothing to do but to go on fighting," Moore said.
+
+"I see nothing else for it, Moore, but I own that I do not care
+for the life. I have had three years of it now, and don't like the
+prospect of another thirty."
+
+"You have been fortunate, too, Kennedy!"
+
+"Yes, I have been fortunate in the way of getting promotion;
+fortunate that I was not, long before this, put under the sod; but
+it is no great gratification to be a captain, and though in
+another thirty years, if I live, I may be a general, I don't think
+even that would reconcile me to the life. It is just as hard, and
+a good deal more responsible; and if thirty years passed over, and
+the Stuarts were not restored, they assuredly never would be, and
+I should have wasted my life for nothing."
+
+"Well, I am very glad," Moore laughed, "that all our fellows do
+not look at it in the same light as you do, but take things as
+they come. I don't bother myself about the future."
+
+"It is a good thing," Desmond said, "and it is the national
+character to take things as they come. I dare say I shall get into
+the same way, some day, but just at present, I suppose partly
+because we have got a thrashing, I feel rather down in the dumps."
+
+Desmond continued his duties as aide-de-camp to O'Mahony, and took
+his share in the various operations, that ended with the army
+going into winter quarters and Philip making a triumphant entry
+into Madrid. Then he went to the general.
+
+"General, I wish to ask leave to return to France, at any rate for
+a time. The Duke of Berwick, when he despatched me to join the
+staff of the Duke of Orleans, said he would reinstate me on his
+staff as soon as the duke no longer required my services. When the
+Duke of Orleans left, I was handed over with the rest of the staff
+to the Marshal de Bay, under whom I served in the battle of the
+Guadiana, and until, as you know, I was detailed to accompany your
+brigade. Now that the campaign is over, I should, at any rate,
+like to pay a visit to the Duke of Berwick, under whom I served at
+Oudenarde. I have, therefore, come to ask you to dispense with my
+services, and to permit me to return to France."
+
+"Certainly, Captain Kennedy. Your assistance has been of great
+value to me, but there is no chance of anything being done during
+the winter; and, as many of my officers are now beginning to speak
+Spanish, they will, should they remain here till the spring, be
+able to get on very fairly. I shall be pleased, before you start,
+to furnish you with a testimonial stating the services you have
+rendered me. Indeed, I have, more than once, mentioned them in my
+reports."
+
+
+
+Chapter 19: In Search of a Family.
+
+
+On the following day, Desmond left the brigade, and, followed by
+Mike, rode for Madrid, where was still lying a letter which had
+arrived, some months before, from England. He had not asked for it
+to be forwarded, for if he had been killed, and it had been found
+on him, it might do his memory a great disservice, as it would
+seem that he had been in correspondence with the British. The
+letter, which contained an enclosure, was, to his surprise, from
+Lord Godolphin. It ran:
+
+Dear Captain Kennedy:
+
+Partly at the request of the Earl of Galway, and still more from
+my own remembrance of your conduct, in that affair you know of,
+and of the silence that you maintained concerning it, I have
+pleasure in sending you a safe conduct to visit Ireland on private
+affairs. The earl tells me that you have rendered him the greatest
+of services, and this alone should cancel the fact that you have
+been serving against us in Flanders and Spain. For this, and your
+conduct to myself, I can promise you that should you, at any time
+while I am in power, decide to remain in Ireland, I will obtain
+for you a full and complete pardon, and a restoration to all your
+rights as an Irish subject of the queen. I will also obtain a
+reversal of any attainders or acts of confiscation that may have
+been passed against your family, on your giving your promise that
+you will not take part in any secret plots or conspiracies against
+the reigning family, though, in the event of a general rising in
+Ireland, with the assistance perhaps of a French army, you would
+be at liberty to choose your own course of action, without
+incurring more pains and penalties than those which might befall
+any native of Ireland waging war against the queen.
+
+As both Godolphin and Marlborough were known to be by no means
+unfavourably disposed to the cause of the Stuarts, Desmond was
+hardly surprised at the latter part of this intimation. Though he
+had but small hopes of being enabled to remain permanently at
+home, it was yet very welcome to him. Certainly, if he remained in
+Ireland he would consider himself bound to hold himself aloof from
+all Jacobite plots, although, if the country rose and a French
+army landed, he would, unless he considered the cause a hopeless
+one, draw his sword on behalf of him whom he considered as his
+lawful sovereign.
+
+"It is not sorry I am, your honour, to be turning my back on this
+country," Mike said, as they rode out from the gate. "The wine is
+good, which is more than I can say for anything else in it, except
+that the people are good Catholics."
+
+"I am starting a longer journey than you think, Mike. I am only
+going to the duke, now, to ask for a year's leave; though I do not
+think that I shall be absent more than a few months."
+
+"And where are you going, your honour, if I may make so bold as to
+ask?"
+
+"I am going to Ireland, Mike."
+
+Mike looked at him with astonishment.
+
+"To Ireland, your honour? Sure they will hang you, before you set
+your foot a week in the country."
+
+"I have obtained a safe conduct, Mike, from Lord Godolphin. You
+remember him, the nobleman we kidnapped?"
+
+"Sure I remember him, your honour; and he has given you a safe
+conduct? It is in luck you are, to be going back to Ireland
+again."
+
+"It is not a visit of pleasure, Mike. I am going over to try to
+ascertain to which branch of my family I belong."
+
+"And what can it matter, your honour? It's a good name you have
+made for yourself out here."
+
+"I have done well enough, Mike, but I am tired of being asked, by
+almost every officer I meet, about my family, when in fact I know
+nothing myself."
+
+"Well, Captain, it does not seem to me worth troubling about, for
+if you don't know who they are, it is little they can have done
+for you."
+
+"It would seem so, Mike. There is a mystery about the whole
+affair, and I want to get to the bottom of it."
+
+He rode silently for some distance. He knew that Mike would go
+through fire and water for him, and that, simple as he seemed, he
+had no ordinary amount of shrewdness; and he determined to tell
+him all he knew, especially as he intended to take him to Ireland
+with him.
+
+"Mike," he said at last, "I suppose you would like to pay a visit
+to Ireland, also?"
+
+"I should that," Mike said, emphatically. "I was but eighteen when
+I came out here to enlist in the brigade--that is twelve years ago
+now, and it is few people would be likely to know me again."
+
+"Well, I am thinking of taking you with me, Mike; and, as possibly
+you may be of use in my search, I will tell you my story."
+
+And he related the history of his youth.
+
+"He must be an unfeeling baste, to treat you like that," Mike
+exclaimed indignantly. "Sure I know the name, and have heard him
+spoken of as a traitor who had gone over to the enemy, and turned
+Protestant to save his estate."
+
+"That is how you would hear him spoken of, Mike, for it is true;
+but as to his treatment of me, it all depends whether I was forced
+upon him by threats, or was taken by him out of friendship to my
+father. If it were the first of these reasons, he cannot be blamed
+for keeping me at a distance. If the second, he certainly ought to
+have behaved differently. But neither explains why he, a supporter
+of the usurper, should have sent me out to France to fight against
+the English. It is a hard nut to crack."
+
+Mike agreed. "Mighty hard; but your honour will get to the bottom
+of it, never fear. And why are we going to the duke, master?"
+
+"To get leave of absence. I cannot disappear suddenly, without
+asking for leave. I shall, of course, tell the Duke of Berwick
+exactly why I am going, and I feel sure he will grant my request,
+without hesitation. There is no fighting to be done, just at
+present, and even if there were, one officer more or less would
+make no difference.
+
+"Have you any relations in Ireland, Mike?"
+
+"None that I know of, sir, barring a sister, who was twelve years
+older than myself; and it is little I saw of her, for she married
+when I was a bit of a gossoon. Her husband was killed in the siege
+of Limerick, and I heard that after it was over, she went to
+settle with some cousins in Cork. Whether she is there now, is
+married again, or is dead years ago, is more than I can say,
+seeing that I have never heard of her since."
+
+"Was she with her husband in the siege of Limerick?"
+
+"She was that. I heard about her from some men who knew her
+husband. They said, after he was killed, she went as a servant in
+the family of an officer and his wife for a bit, but the officer
+was killed, and the lady died of grief and trouble; and it was
+hard work she had to live till the place surrendered. That is all
+I know about it, your honour. It might have been true, and it
+might not. I was but a boy, and maybe I bothered the man with
+questions, and he just told me what came into his head to keep me
+quiet."
+
+"Well, at any rate, Mike, as we shall most likely land at Cork,
+you might try to find your sister out. If she went through the
+siege, she will know the names of many of the officers. She may
+have heard of a Kennedy."
+
+"Maybe of half a dozen, your honour. As loyal gentlemen, they
+would be sure to be there."
+
+"What was her name, Mike?"
+
+"Sure it was the same as my own before she married, just Norah
+Callaghan."
+
+"So I suppose, Mike," Desmond said with a laugh; "but what was the
+name of the husband?"
+
+"Rooney. I have not thought of it this many a year, but it is sure
+I am that it was Rooney; and now I think of it, a message came to
+me from her, just before I left the country, saying that should I
+ever be in the neighbourhood, it is glad she would be to see me;
+and I was to ask for Mrs. Rooney, who lived with her cousin, Larry
+Callaghan, a ship's carpenter, in Middle Lane, which I should find
+by the river bank."
+
+"Well, that is something to go by, Mike. Of course, she may have
+moved away long since; but if her cousin is a ship's carpenter, it
+is not likely that he would have left the neighbourhood."
+
+"I wonder your honour never asked about the Kennedys from some of
+the officers who were at the siege?"
+
+"I did not like to do so. The colonel came to the conclusion that
+I must be the son of Murroch Kennedy, who came out soon after
+Limerick surrendered, and was killed at Breda two or three months
+after he joined the brigade. The officers agreed with the colonel
+that this gentleman was probably my father, and of course I was
+contented that it should be supposed so, and therefore I asked no
+questions about other Kennedys. Of late, however, I have been
+worried over the matter. In the Irish regiments in Spain, as
+elsewhere, were a number of officers belonging to good old Irish
+families, and though I have got on well enough with them--in the
+first place as Berwick's aide-de-camp, and afterwards as on the
+staff of the generals here--I could see that when, in answer to
+their question, it was evident I knew little or nothing of my
+family, there was a sort of coolness in their manner which I could
+quite understand, counting back their ancestors, as they did,
+pretty nearly to the flood. At present, it does not make any
+difference to me personally, one way or the other, but I am
+convinced that if, by chance, when I get older, I should fall in
+love with the daughter of an officer of one of these old families,
+he would not for a moment listen to me, until I could give him
+some proofs that I had a right to the name I bear, or at any rate
+came of a good family. Certainly, at present, I could not assure
+him on either point. I only know that I have always been called
+Kennedy, and that it was under that name that I was committed to
+the care of Father O'Leary. That proves nothing more than that it
+is the name by which John O'Carroll wished me to be called; and it
+is as likely as not--indeed a good deal more likely--that it was
+not the true one."
+
+"Well, at any rate, your honour, you have made the name of Desmond
+Kennedy well known and liked, both among the Irish and French
+officers, for it is no slight thing that an officer in an infantry
+regiment should be taken on the staff of the Duke of Berwick."
+
+"All that is very well, Mike; but it will not satisfy me more than
+it satisfies others. So I am resolved to try to get to the bottom
+of the affair, even if I have to go direct to John O'Carroll,
+though I know that the chance of his telling me anything is but
+slight. The only way, indeed, that seems likely to lead to
+anything is to call upon as many of the Kennedys as I can
+discover, and ask whether Murroch Kennedy, who left Ireland after
+the siege of Limerick, married and left a child of two years old
+behind him. If so, and that child suddenly disappeared when his
+father left for France, there would be every reason for assuming
+that I was the child in question; though why he should have
+committed me to the charge of John O'Carroll, instead of to one of
+his own family, is not easily seen; unless the whole of the
+Kennedys were in such ill favour, with the English Government,
+that he thought it better to trust me to one who was in good odour
+with the supporters of Dutch William, and was therefore safe from
+disturbance in his estates."
+
+"Sure, your honour, you are arguing it out like a counsellor, and
+there is no gainsaying what you have spoken. I have no doubt you
+will ferret it out. With such a head as you have on your
+shoulders, it is hard if you cannot circumvent that ould rascal at
+Kilkargan."
+
+"At any rate we will try, you and I. While I am visiting the
+Kennedys, you can be finding out people who were at Limerick
+during the siege, and gather all they can remember about the
+Kennedys there."
+
+As Desmond had expected, the duke, as soon as he heard his story,
+at once granted him leave of absence.
+
+"I hope you may succeed, Kennedy," he said. "It is a poor lookout
+to be risking death continually in the service of a foreign king.
+I grant that we have the knack of making ourselves at home,
+wherever we may be, and there are Irish officers in every army in
+Europe; but, however successful Irishmen may be, they cannot but
+long to be among their own people in their own land. And if, as
+you tell me, Lord Godolphin will befriend you, I for one shall
+think no worse of you if you settle down at home when you have
+found your family. I know that if the sword should be again drawn,
+with a fair prospect of success, you will declare for the rightful
+king."
+
+"That I should certainly do, sir; and will assuredly give no
+promise, or undertaking, to abstain from joining any royal army
+that may be raised in Ireland. But it is not with any intention of
+settling at home that I am going there, but simply, as I have told
+you, to discover to what family I belong, so that I can have a
+right to the name I bear."
+
+"At what port will you embark?"
+
+"I intend to pay a visit, for a few days, to the Baron de
+Pointdexter and Monsieur de la Vallee, after which I shall cross
+into Italy. I have no doubt that I shall be able to find some
+fishermen, at Toulon, who will undertake to land me somewhere near
+Genoa, where I shall be able to take a passage in a ship bound for
+England."
+
+"And I suppose you take your servant with you?"
+
+"With your permission, Duke. He has been my companion for three
+years. He is shrewd as well as brave, and will give me valuable
+help in my enquiries."
+
+After remaining a couple of days with Berwick's army, Desmond
+started with Mike, and received the warmest welcome from the Baron
+de Pointdexter, and afterwards from Philip and his wife. Then they
+travelled on to Toulon, where Desmond sold the horses and
+equipments. He left his uniform and Mike's there, and procured two
+civilian suits. As he anticipated, he experienced no difficulty in
+arranging to be landed near Genoa. There he found several ships
+bound for England or Ireland, and took a passage in one that would
+touch at Cork, on its way to Dublin. The voyage was uneventful,
+and the ship, which had no great draught of water, proceeded up
+the river to the city.
+
+"The first thing to do, Mike," Desmond said, as they stepped
+ashore, "is to get rid of these clothes, whose French cut will at
+once attract attention. I shall get a suit such as is worn by an
+Irish gentleman. You had better equip yourself as my servant. No
+livery is worn here, but any quiet dress will be suitable."
+
+They put up at a small inn, and remained there until a suit such
+as Desmond desired was made for him, and Mike found no difficulty
+in purchasing ready-made clothes suitable to his new position.
+Desmond had taken rooms as Mr. Kennedy, and had asked carelessly
+if there were any families of that name living in the neighbourhood.
+
+"There is one who lives a short distance out of the town. It is a
+small house, and shame it is that one of the old family should
+come down so; but most of their estates were stolen from them
+after the war. Still, the old man holds his head as if he was
+still lord of broad acres, and he is mightily respected among the
+gentry."
+
+The next day, Desmond hired a horse and rode out to the house of
+Mr. Kennedy, which was some three miles from the town. He sent in
+his name, and was shown into a room, where a tall man, with a
+somewhat haughty air, received him not unkindly.
+
+"Your name is the same as my own," he said, "though I do not
+recognize the name of Desmond Kennedy among such members of the
+family as I am acquainted with."
+
+"I have but just landed from France, and my object in coming here
+is to obtain some information as to my father's family. Hearing
+that a gentleman of the name lived here, I came first to you. May
+I ask if you were acquainted with a Murroch Kennedy?"
+
+"Surely I was. He was my first cousin. We fought side by side at
+Limerick. I was not one of those who cared to enter foreign
+service. My estates were confiscated, and I have ever since lived
+here on the wreck of my fortune, taking no part in politics.
+
+"My cousin was of a different mind. He did not, indeed, go out at
+once with the greater part of the army of Limerick, but still,
+hoping that the cause was not altogether lost, he lived for some
+months among the mountains, and took part in a rising which was
+promptly suppressed, and then joined the Irish Brigade; and I
+received a notification, from one of his brother officers, that he
+had fallen at the battle of Breda. And now may I ask, in turn,
+what Murroch Kennedy's relationship was to you?"
+
+"I will tell you, sir. But first, will you kindly inform me
+whether your cousin left a child about a year old behind him?"
+
+"Certainly not, sir. My cousin was an unmarried man, at any rate
+up to the time when he left Ireland."
+
+"Then, sir, my questions are at an end. I may tell you that, about
+the time your cousin left Ireland, I was sent as an infant to the
+care of John O'Carroll, the traitor, of Kilkargan, and was brought
+up under the name of Desmond Kennedy. He showed me but little
+kindness, and, nearly three years ago, I went abroad and obtained
+a commission in one of the regiments in the Irish Brigade, and now
+hold the rank of captain. For many reasons, I am anxious to find
+out what family I belong to. It was assumed, by my colonel and
+fellow officers, that I was the son of Murroch Kennedy, and I
+wished to ascertain whether this was true, and with that object
+obtained leave of absence, and made my way back."
+
+"I am sorry that I can give you no assistance, sir. Assuredly you
+are not the son of my cousin, Murroch Kennedy; and had you been,
+John O'Carroll, the traitor, would have been the last man to whom
+he would have entrusted you. I know well the history of all the
+members of my branch of the family, and can answer, with
+certainty, that no child was lost, or missing, or unaccounted for
+at the time he went out; and as all were loyal gentlemen, none
+would have had any dealings with John O'Carroll, who betrayed the
+cause for which his brother died fighting at Limerick. I will,
+however, jot down, for your information, the other branches of the
+family of Kennedy and their places of residence, though I fear
+that there is but little probability of your search being
+successful, as, during the years that have elapsed since the late
+war, many must have died. Others, like my cousin, have taken
+service in one or other of the continental armies. Moreover, there
+is also a possibility that the name by which you are known is not
+your own."
+
+"I feel that myself, sir, and fear that my enquiries will not meet
+with success. Still, I shall pursue them until I have at least
+proved that I cannot belong to any well-known branch of the
+family. I am much obliged to you, for having so courteously
+answered my questions, and for your offer to give me a list of the
+various branches of the family."
+
+For the next few minutes, Mr. Kennedy was engaged in making out
+the list, which he then handed to Desmond.
+
+"And now, sir," the former went on, "that we have finished what we
+may consider business, will you tell me a little more about
+yourself? Your story naturally interests me, and I own that I am
+surprised that a young gentleman who, from what you have told me,
+cannot be much more than twenty years old, has risen to the rank
+of captain, in a brigade where so many officers have signally
+distinguished themselves. Your story, too, is an interesting one,
+and seems to me in many respects remarkable; and possibly, when I
+hear more of how you came to be brought up by John O'Carroll, it
+may throw some light upon the subject."
+
+Desmond gave a detailed account of his life as a boy, and a short
+sketch of his subsequent adventures.
+
+"A romantic story, young sir," Mr. Kennedy said, when he had
+finished, "and to whatever family you belong, they should be proud
+of possessing so gallant a member. You tell me that you have a
+safe conduct, but you did not mention how you obtained it."
+
+Desmond had abstained from making any allusion, either to the
+affair with Lord Godolphin, or to that with the Earl of Galway,
+and he replied:
+
+"Sir, this is a secret that concerns other people, as well as
+myself, consequently I am not at liberty to explain it. I may say,
+however, that it was given to me on my engagement that my visit to
+Ireland was one of a private nature only, and that I would in no
+way meddle with politics. When I tell you that the Duke of
+Berwick, himself, granted me the necessary leave of absence, it
+will prove to you that he, on his part, was well satisfied that
+the safe conduct had been issued to me without any unworthy
+offers, on my part, to the Princess Anne's ministers."
+
+After chatting for some time longer, Desmond took his leave and
+returned to Cork.
+
+Mike was standing at the door of the inn.
+
+"I have had no success, Mike. Have you fared better?"
+
+"I have not found her yet, your honour, but I have great hopes of
+doing so. Larry Callaghan died four years ago, and the woman of
+the house she occupied said that Mrs. Rooney moved, with his widow
+and children, to some other part of the town. She knew little
+about them, seeing that she only went into the house after they
+had left; but her husband worked in the same yard as Larry did,
+and she thought that he would be able to find out, from some of
+the old hands, where the widow Callaghan had moved to. She said
+she would ask her husband when he came home to his dinner, and
+maybe he would be able to give her some news.
+
+"And so, your honour has learned nothing about yourself?"
+
+"Nothing, Mike, except that I am certainly not the son of Murroch
+Kennedy, who was a cousin of the gentleman I called on. I was
+assured that he was a single man, when he went to France. However,
+he gave me a list of the principal branches of the Kennedy family,
+but there is no hurry about starting to see them, and I will
+certainly wait here till you find your sister, which should not be
+many days, for some of Callaghan's fellow workmen are almost sure
+to know where his widow lives."
+
+Mike went out, at seven o'clock that evening, and returned half an
+hour later.
+
+"I have got the address, your honour. She and the widow Callaghan
+have got a little place outside the town, and take in washing
+there, and are going on nicely."
+
+"I am pleased to hear it, I am sure, Mike. I have but small hope
+that she will be able to give any useful information, but for your
+sake, I am glad that you have found a sister whom you have not
+seen for so many years. I suppose you will go up there, at once."
+
+"I will that. They will have done their work, and we shall have a
+comfortable talk, whereas she would not thank me if I were to drop
+in when she was busy at the washtub."
+
+"Well, you might ask her to come down, tomorrow morning, to see
+me. Of course, she shall not be a loser by giving up her morning's
+work."
+
+"Whisht, your honour! When she knows how much you have done for
+me, and how you have treated me, she would willingly lose a week's
+work to give you pleasure. Well, I will be off at once."
+
+It was eleven o'clock before Mike returned.
+
+"We have had a great talk, your honour, me and Norah. She would
+not believe at first that I was her brother, and in truth, I found
+it hard to credit that she was Norah, who was a purty colleen when
+I saw her last; but when we had convinced each other that we were
+both who we said we were, matters went on pleasantly. I told her
+some of my adventures with you, and that, by the same token, I had
+a hundred gold pieces that the Baron of Pointdexter had given me,
+sewn up in a belt round my waist, where it has been ever since I
+got it, except when we went into battle, or on that expedition to
+Scotland, when, as your honour knows, I always put it in with the
+agent in your name, seeing that I would rather, if I was killed,
+know that your honour would have it, instead of its being taken by
+some villain searching the dead. I told her that, if she and Mrs.
+Callaghan wanted to take a bigger place, I would share it with
+her, and that quite settled the matter, in her mind, that I was
+her brother. She said, as I knew she would, that she would come
+and talk to you for a week, if you wanted it; and she will be here
+tomorrow, at nine o'clock."
+
+"That is very satisfactory. I am afraid nothing will come of our
+talk; but still, one may get a clue to other Kennedys who were
+present at the siege of Limerick."
+
+Punctually at nine o'clock, Mike ushered his sister into Desmond's
+sitting room.
+
+"I am glad to see you, Mrs. Rooney. Your brother has been with me
+for three years, and has rendered me very many services, and I
+regard him as a friend, rather than as a servant. I am glad that
+he has found his sister, from whom he had been so long parted."
+
+"Mike has been telling me how good you have been to him, and that
+he would go through fire and water for you, and that you have had
+some wonderful adventures together. He said you wanted to speak to
+me about the siege of Limerick. If there is anything that I can
+tell you, your honour, I will do so gladly."
+
+"What I want to know is, what Kennedys were at the siege?"
+
+"There was Murroch Kennedy, and Phelim, who was always called 'Red
+Kennedy', on account of his colour; and James and Fergus. I knew
+all those, because they were friends of my master's. It may be
+that there were many others, but they were unbeknown to me."
+
+"Am I like any of them?"
+
+The woman looked at him searchingly.
+
+"You are not, sir; but you are mighty like my master, barring, of
+course, that he was a man ten years older than yourself. But the
+more I look at you, the more I see the likeness."
+
+"I did not know that you had a master, Mrs. Rooney. I thought that
+you were there with your husband."
+
+"So I was, your honour; but when he was kilt I was left alone,
+saving for a child that had been born a fortnight before; and what
+with the bad smells of the place, and the sound of the cannon, and
+the fact of my grief, he pined away all at once, and died a week
+after me husband. It is well-nigh starving we all were. Even the
+fighting men had scarce enough food to keep their strength up, and
+a lone woman would have died from hunger. So I was mighty glad,
+when a friend of mine told me that there was an officer's lady who
+had had a baby, and, being but weak and ailing, wanted a foster
+mother for it; so I went at once and got the place, and was with
+her for a month.
+
+"Her husband was killed three weeks after I went there, and the
+blow was too much for her, and she died a week later. A fortnight
+after that came the peace, and as everything was in confusion,
+what wid our soldiers all going away to France, and the
+persecutions and slaughterings, I took the child with me and went
+down to my cousin Larry's here. Av course, I could not part with
+it, and I could not make my way alone across the country, so I
+came down here with the troops. I was not strong myself, and it
+was a year later before I was able to take it to its friends."
+
+"What was the name of your master?" Desmond asked eagerly, for her
+last words had excited a sudden train of ideas in his mind.
+
+"He was Mr. James O'Carroll, a great gentleman, and the head of
+his family."
+
+Desmond sprang to his feet.
+
+"That explains it all!" he exclaimed. "Mrs. Rooney, I have no
+doubt that I am your foster child."
+
+"Why, how can that be, your honour, seeing as your name is
+Kennedy? Though, except for that, you might well be so, seeing
+that you are so like my master."
+
+"At any rate, Mrs. Rooney, I was reared at Kilkargan, at the
+expense of John O'Carroll, and was, as I heard, brought there by a
+woman when I was a year old. O'Carroll said that my name was
+Desmond Kennedy, but I had only his word for it."
+
+"Then how is it that you are not master of Kilkargan, for if you
+are Mr. James O'Carroll's son, it is you that ought to be? I have
+always thought of you as there. I have not been in the way of
+getting news. I left my address with Mr. John, but I never heard
+from him, or you. I thought, perhaps, that he might have lost the
+address, but I never dreamt that you had been kept out of your
+own."
+
+"I don't know that I can say that, altogether," Desmond said;
+"for, if it had been known that James O'Carroll had left an heir,
+his estates would certainly have been confiscated; whereas, owing
+to his brother's turning Protestant, and joining the Williamites,
+he was allowed to keep possession of them. I can understand now
+what seemed so strange, namely, that he feared I might somehow
+learn that I was his nephew, and heir to the estates. Therefore,
+he behaved as if I was the son of a stranger, and when I was old
+enough, sent me off to join the Irish Brigade, in hopes that he
+had seen the last of me; for, even if not killed, I should never
+be able to set foot in Ireland again after fighting for France.
+'Tis strange that none of my father's brother officers ever made
+any enquiries about it."
+
+"They all went with the army to France, sir. They knew, of course,
+that the child was born, though they may never have seen you, for
+the mistress never left her bed after you were born. Naturally,
+after her death they lost sight of me, and might well have
+believed that the child had died."
+
+"You must give me the names of all the officers who came to the
+house, Mrs. Rooney. Many of them may be alive still, and their
+testimony that a child was born would be most important, for at
+present there is only your word against John O'Carroll's."
+
+"There is more than that, sir. You were baptized on the day she
+died. My mistress gave me the paper the priest had given to her,
+saying that it was of the greatest importance to you, and that I
+was to give it to Mr. John O'Carroll when, as I promised, I took
+the child to him."
+
+"And did you give it him?" Desmond asked eagerly.
+
+"No, your honour. I took it with me to the castle, but from the
+reception I got, I thought it best to say nothing about it, but to
+give it to yourself when you were old enough. I have got it at
+home now. There it is, certifying that Gerald O'Carroll, the son
+of James O'Carroll and his wife Elizabeth, was baptized by him on
+the 6th of September, 1692."
+
+"That is fortunate, indeed," Desmond exclaimed. "And now, tell me
+how this uncle of mine received you."
+
+"Faith, your honour, he was mightily put out, at first. He said
+that I was an impostor, and that he would have me given in charge.
+I told him that I had proofs that what I said was true, and that
+there were many gentlemen, brother officers of Mr. James, who
+would speak for me, and say in court that a son was born to his
+brother before he died. He wanted to get out of me what proofs I
+had, and who were the officers; but I told him that was my
+business. Then he cooled down, and after a time he said that, if
+he were to let it be known that Mr. James had left a son, the
+estate would surely be confiscated, seeing that his father died as
+a rebel fighting against the king; but that, as soon as the
+persecutions had ceased, and it would be safe to do so, he would
+say who the child was, and give him his rightful place. That
+seemed reasonable enough, and so I left you with him, and have
+always supposed that he kept his word; and that, as soon as it was
+safe, he acknowledged you to be master of your father's estate."
+
+"And now, Mrs. Rooney, I must think matters over, and see how I
+had best proceed. I feel how much I owe to you, and, if I recover
+my estates, you shall see that I am not ungrateful. Will you come
+again tomorrow morning, and bring with you the certificate of my
+baptism, and all the names that you can recollect of the officers
+who were intimate with my father?"
+
+
+
+Chapter 20: Gerald O'Carroll.
+
+
+Mike, who had remained silent during the conversation between his
+sister and Desmond, returned to the room after seeing her out.
+
+"Well, Mike, you have rendered me many services, but this is the
+greatest of all. Little did I think, when you said you had found
+your sister, and that she was coming to me this morning, that she
+would be able to clear up the mystery of my birth, and to place me
+in a position to prove myself a son of James O'Carroll. I do not
+say that I shall regain the estates. My having been in the Brigade
+will certainly render it difficult for me to do so, though
+possibly, with the patronage of Lord Godolphin, I may succeed. For
+that, however, I care comparatively little. My object, in coming
+here, was to obtain proof that I belong to a good Irish family,
+and that I have no doubt I shall be able to establish."
+
+"And what am I to call you, your honour, now that I know you are
+Captain Gerald O'Carroll, and not Desmond Kennedy, at all?"
+
+"At any rate, I must remain Desmond Kennedy at present, Mike. It
+is under that name that my safe conduct was made out, and if I
+were arrested as Gerald O'Carroll, it would be no protection to
+me. However, I shall not want to use it long, for it seems to me
+that my first step must be to return to France, and to see some of
+the officers who knew my father, and were aware of my birth. Their
+testimony would be of great value, and without it there would be
+little chance of your sister's evidence being believed."
+
+"But there is the paper, your honour."
+
+"Yes; that will show that a child was born, but the proof that I
+am that child rests entirely with your sister. It might have died
+when its mother did, and they would say that your sister was
+trying to palm off her own child, or someone else's, as his. Of
+course, Mrs. Callaghan would be able to prove that your sister
+arrived immediately after the surrender of Limerick, bringing a
+child with her, and that she said it was the son of James
+O'Carroll; and that she went a year later to Kilkargan, and left
+it there with John O'Carroll. Moreover, I could get plenty of
+evidence, from those on the estate, that I was the child so left."
+
+"The likeness that Norah saw between you and your father might be
+taken as a proof, sir."
+
+"I did not think of that, Mike. Yes, if some of these officers
+will also testify to the likeness, it will greatly strengthen my
+case. The chain of evidence seems pretty strong. First, there is
+the certificate of my baptism, your sister's declaration that I
+was entrusted to her by my mother on her deathbed, supported by
+Mrs. Callaghan's declaration that three weeks later she arrived in
+Cork with the child, which she told her was that of James
+O'Carroll; your sister's declaration that she took me to Kilkargan
+and handed me over to my uncle, which would be supported by the
+evidence of the woman he first placed me with; while the servants
+of the castle could prove that I was brought by a woman who, an
+hour later, left the castle without speaking to anyone but my
+uncle.
+
+"John O'Carroll will find it difficult to explain why he took me
+in, and who is the Kennedy of whom I was the son, and what service
+he had rendered for him, a Protestant and a Williamite, to have
+undertaken the charge of the child of a rebel. There is no doubt
+that the weight of evidence is all on my side, but whether the
+judges would decide in favour of the son of a rebel, as against a
+friend of the English party, is doubtful. Possibly Lord
+Godolphin's influence might be exerted in my favour. He promised
+in his letter to me to do me any service in his power. Still, even
+if I lose the estate, which I may well do on the ground of my
+father having fought and died for the cause of James the Second, I
+should still have the satisfaction of establishing my name, which
+I consider of more importance than the estates."
+
+"Sure, your honour, it's a grand thing to belong to a good old
+Irish stock; but for myself, I would rather be Mike Callaghan and
+have a fine estate, than Mike O'Neil without an acre of land."
+
+Desmond smiled.
+
+"There is common sense in what you say, Mike, but there is nothing
+more unpleasant than, when you are with a number of Irish
+gentlemen or Spanish grandees, who are equally proud of their
+ancestors, to be unable to give any account of your family, or
+even to be sure that you have a right to the name that you bear."
+
+"Well, your honour, it is a matter of taste. As for myself, if the
+whisky is good, it makes no differ to me whether they call it Cork
+or Dublin, or whether it is made up in the mountains and has sorra
+a name at all."
+
+The next morning, Mrs. Rooney returned with the certificate of
+baptism, and a list containing some twenty names of officers who
+had been frequent visitors at James O'Carroll's. Among these
+Desmond, to his satisfaction, found Arthur Dillon, Walter Burke,
+Nicholas Fitzgerald, and Dominic Sheldon, all of whom now held the
+rank of general in the French service, and to all of whom he was
+personally known, having met them either when with Berwick or in
+Spain.
+
+"Those names are good enough," he said. "And if they can testify
+to my likeness to my father, it will go a long way towards
+furnishing proof, when required. All of them entered the service
+under the provisions of the treaty of Limerick, and therefore
+their testimony cannot be treated as that of traitors; and their
+names must be as well known in England as in France.
+
+"Now, Mike, our business here is, for the present, concluded. I
+shall at once return to France, see all these officers who are
+still alive, and obtain, if possible, their recognition. As I have
+a year's leave, I can travel about as I choose. Then I shall
+decide whether I shall commence an action in the courts, or
+whether I shall first go over to England, see Lord Godolphin,
+explain the circumstances to him, and ask for his protection and
+patronage.
+
+"I suppose the case would be tried at Dublin, where the judges are
+all creatures of England, and there can be no doubt that a
+notification, from Godolphin, that he considered my claim to be a
+good one, and was favourable to it, would have no slight influence
+with them; and would counteract, to some extent, the fact of my
+uncle's being a Protestant, and what they would consider a loyal
+man. Before beginning an action, I should certainly communicate
+with my uncle, and call upon him to resign in my favour; for I
+would avoid the scandal of proving an O'Carroll to be a scoundrel,
+as well as a traitor. As it has turned out, the step which he
+thought would disembarrass him of me has had the other effect,
+for, if I had not gone out to France, I should never have been
+troubled by questions about my family; and should not have met
+you, Mike, or known of the existence of your sister, the only
+person who could clear up the matter.
+
+"I shall begin to think what O'Neil and O'Sullivan used to say,
+that my luck would carry me through anything; and certainly, at
+present, it has been marvellous."
+
+"Which way will we go back, your honour?"
+
+"Not the way we came, if we can help it. We were nearly a month
+coming from Genoa, and might have been twice as long, if the wind
+had not been fairly favourable. I think our best plan will be to
+take passage by sea to London. There we shall have no difficulty
+in finding a vessel bound for Rotterdam, or the Hague. Then we
+will buy horses, and ride along by the Rhine. If we can get
+through Luxembourg into France we will do so, but I think it will
+perhaps be best to go on through Switzerland, and pass the
+frontier somewhere near Lyons, where we shall be but a short
+distance from Berwick's headquarters in Dauphiny."
+
+A month later, they rode into the duke's camp. They had, on
+leaving Toulon, packed up their uniforms and sent them to the care
+of a friend on the general's staff. To his quarters they first
+went, and having changed his civilian costume for a military one,
+Desmond waited on the duke.
+
+"Why, Captain Kennedy," the duke said, in surprise; "I did not
+look to see you again, so soon. Have you been over to Ireland?"
+
+"I have, sir, and though there only a few days, gained information
+that necessitated my return here. I have found out that the name I
+go by is not mine, and that my proper name is Gerald O'Carroll."
+
+"The son of Major James O'Carroll, who fought by my side at the
+Boyne, and was through the first siege of Limerick with me! That
+explains it. Your face has often puzzled me. It seemed to me that
+I recognized it, and yet I could not recall whose face it was that
+it resembled so strongly. Now you tell me, I know at once. Your
+father, when I first knew him, was a few years older than you are;
+but he had the same figure, face, and expression.
+
+"And so, you are his son! By what miracle have you discovered your
+relationship to him?"
+
+Desmond, or as he should now be called, Gerald, related as briefly
+as possible the manner in which he had discovered his parentage.
+
+"Your uncle must be a thorough villain," the duke said, hotly.
+"That he was a traitor we all knew, but that he should thus rob
+his brother's son of his inheritance is monstrous and unnatural."
+
+"I am glad, indeed, sir, that you have thus recognized me. Your
+testimony will go for much, even in an English court, and I hope
+to receive a similar recognition from the officers who were
+intimate with my father in the second siege, and whose names I
+have here."
+
+The duke glanced down the list.
+
+"Well-nigh half of them are still alive," he said, "and all of
+them are men of rank and repute, whose word would be taken even by
+an enemy. How do you mean to proceed? Because I am afraid that,
+even if we could spare them, there would be some difficulty about
+their making their appearance in a court, in either England or
+Ireland."
+
+"I quite see that that is out of the question. All I can hope for
+is, that such of them as recognize my likeness to my father will
+draw up a paper saying so, and will attest it before a notary,
+having as witnesses men of weight and honour equal to their own.
+The production of such certificates could not but have a strong
+influence in my favour."
+
+"I will most willingly sign such a document," the duke said, "and
+four of my best-known generals can sign as witnesses to my
+signature."
+
+"I thank you most heartily, sir. Such a document should, in
+itself, be considered as ample proof of my strong resemblance to
+my father."
+
+"That may or may not be," the duke said, "but do not be content
+with that. Get as many of the others as possible to make similar
+declarations. One man may see a likeness where another does not,
+but if a dozen men agree in recognizing it, their declarations
+must have a great weight. Certainly no Irish judge would doubt the
+testimony of so many men, whose families and whose deeds are so
+well known to them."
+
+From Dauphiny, Gerald travelled first into Spain, and the three
+Irish officers there whose names were on his list all recognized
+the likeness, even before he told them his name. He put the
+question to them in a general way.
+
+"I have learned, sir, that the name I bear is not my own, that I
+am the son of an officer who was killed in the siege of Limerick.
+May I ask you if you can recognize any likeness between myself and
+any officer with whom you were well acquainted there?"
+
+In each case, after a little consideration, they declared that he
+must be the son of James O'Carroll. All remembered that their
+comrade's wife had borne a son, shortly before the end of the
+siege. They remembered her death, but none had heard what became
+of the child, for in the excitement of the closing scenes, and of
+the preparation for the march immediately afterwards, they had had
+little time on their hands, and it was hitherto supposed that it
+had, like so many other infants, perished miserably. They
+willingly signed documents, similar to that which he had received
+from Berwick.
+
+He met with almost equal success on the northern frontier, only
+two out of eight officers failing to identify him by his likeness;
+until he mentioned his name, when they, too, acknowledged that,
+now they recalled James O'Carroll's face, they saw that the
+likeness was a striking one.
+
+Having obtained these documents, he resumed civilian attire, and,
+riding by crossroads, passed through Flanders to Sluys, without
+coming in contact with any body of the allied troops. There he had
+no difficulty in obtaining a passage to London, and on his arrival
+called upon Lord Godolphin, who received him cordially.
+
+"So you have utilized your safe conduct, Captain Kennedy. I am
+glad to see my former captor, and I am as grateful as ever to you
+for the silence you maintained as to that affair. If it had been
+known to my enemies, I should never have heard the last of it.
+They would have made me such a laughingstock that I could scarcely
+have retained office.
+
+"Now, what can I do for you?"
+
+"It is a long story, my lord."
+
+"Then I cannot listen to it now; but if you will sup with me here,
+at nine o'clock this evening, I shall be glad to hear it. I am so
+harassed by the backstair intrigues of my enemies, that it would
+be a relief to me to have something else to think of."
+
+Gerald returned at the appointed time. Nothing was said as to his
+affairs while supper was served, but after the table had been
+cleared, decanters of port placed on the table, and the servants
+had retired, Godolphin said:
+
+"Now, Captain Kennedy, let us hear all about it."
+
+Gerald related the history of his younger days, and of the manner
+in which he had discovered his real parentage, producing the
+certificate of his baptism, a statement which had been drawn up at
+Cork and signed by Norah Rooney, and the testimony of the Duke of
+Berwick and the other Irish officers.
+
+"There can be no doubt whatever, in the mind of any fair man,"
+Lord Godolphin said, after listening attentively to the whole
+story, and examining the documents, "that your uncle, John
+O'Carroll, is a villain, and that you have been most unjustly
+deprived of your rights. I know him by name, and from the reports
+of our agents in Ireland, as one of the men who turned his coat
+and changed his religion to save his estates. Those men I heartily
+despise; while those who gave up all, and went into exile in
+order, as they believed, there to serve the cause of their
+rightful sovereign, are men to be admired and respected. Be
+assured that justice shall be done you. Of course, you will take
+action in the courts?"
+
+"I shall first summon him to give up the estate, shall let him
+know that I have indisputable evidence to prove that I am the son
+of his elder brother, and shall say that, if he will give up
+possession peaceably, I will take no further steps in the matter,
+for the sake of the family name. If he refuses, as I fear is
+probable, I must then employ a lawyer."
+
+"Yes, and a good one. I will furnish you with letters to the lord
+lieutenant, and to Lord Chief Justice Cox, strongly recommending
+you to them, and requesting the latter to appoint one of the law
+officers of the crown to take up your case. I should say that,
+when this John O'Carroll sees that you have such powerful friends,
+he will perceive that it is hopeless for him to struggle in so bad
+a cause, and will very speedily accept your terms, though methinks
+it is hard that so great a villain should go unpunished.
+
+"Now, it will be as well that you should have something stronger
+than the safe conduct that I sent you. I will therefore draw out a
+document for Her Majesty to sign, granting you a full and free
+pardon for any offences that you may have committed against her
+and the realm, and also settling upon you the estates to which you
+are the rightful heir, in and about the barony of Kilkargan; being
+influenced in so doing by the great services rendered by you, both
+to Her Majesty's well-beloved and faithful minister and
+counsellor, myself, and to her trusty general, the Earl of Galway.
+
+"The queen is not very likely to ask the nature of the service.
+Unless it be something that concerns herself, she asks but few
+questions, and signs readily enough the documents laid before her.
+If she asks what are the offences for which she grants her pardon,
+I shall say, when but a boy you were maliciously sent abroad to
+join the Irish Brigade by your uncle, who wished thus to rid
+himself of you altogether, and who had foully wronged you by
+withholding your name, from you and all others. I shall also add
+that you have distinguished yourself much, and have gained the
+friendship of her half brother, the Duke of Berwick; and you know
+that the queen, in her heart of hearts, would rather that her
+brother, whom you Jacobites call James the Third, should succeed
+her than the Elector of Hanover, for whom she has no love."
+
+"I thank you greatly, indeed, my lord. Never was a man so amply
+rewarded for merely holding his tongue."
+
+"It was not only that, sir. It was your conduct in general to me.
+You might have left me tied up in that house, to be found in the
+morning, and to be made the jest of the town; instead of which,
+you yourself conducted and guarded me hither, and so contrived it
+that no whisper spread abroad that I had been carried off between
+Saint James's and my own house. You trusted to my honour, in not
+causing a pursuit of you to be set on foot, and behaved in all
+ways as a gallant young gentleman, and certainly gained my high
+esteem, both for the daring and ingenuity with which you carried
+out your plans for obtaining a passage to France, and for your
+personal conduct towards myself.
+
+"Where are you lodging?"
+
+"At the Eagle, hard by the Abbey."
+
+"Remain there, until you hear from me. Do not be impatient. I must
+choose my time, when either the queen is in a good temper, or is
+in such a hurry to get rid of me, in order to plot and gossip with
+Mistress Harley, who is now her prime favourite, that she is ready
+to sign any document I may lay before her."
+
+Feeling that his cause was as good as won, Gerald returned in high
+spirits to his inn, where he delighted Mike by relating how the
+great minister had promised to forward his suit.
+
+"Ah, your honour, it will be a grand day when you take possession
+of Kilkargan--bonfires and rejoicing of all sorts, and lashings of
+drink. Won't all the boys in the barony be glad to be free from
+the traitor, and to have the true heir come to be their master.
+None the less glad will be my sister."
+
+"You must fetch her from Cork, Mike. It is owing to her that I am
+alive, and it will be owing to her if I recover the estate. She
+shall have the place of honour on the occasion, though all the
+gentry in the neighbourhood are there. When I tell them what she
+has done for me, they will say that she well deserves the honour!"
+
+"And you will go no more to the wars, Captain O'Carroll?"
+
+"No, Mike. I have been but three years in the French army, but I
+have seen enough of fighting, and, worse still, of fighting
+against men of our own nation. Besides, if the queen grants me the
+estates of my father, I shall consider myself bound in honour not
+to draw my sword against her, or to mix myself up in any plot or
+conspiracy, but to remain strictly neutral whatever may be going
+on. Indeed, the more I think of it, the more I doubt whether it
+would be for the good of Ireland did the Stuarts return to the
+throne. It could only be done at a further cost of blood and
+misery. The old religious quarrels would break out more fiercely
+than ever, there would be risings and civil wars, confiscations
+and massacres, whichever side happened to get the upper hand. That
+James the Third is the lawful sovereign of the three kingdoms, I
+shall always uphold, but there are cases when it is to the benefit
+of the country, at large, that there should be a change in the
+succession."
+
+"Sure that may be so, your honour; and yet, it is hard that a man
+should be kept out of his own."
+
+"No doubt it is hard; but it is far harder that thousands of
+people should be killed, and tens of thousands ruined, for the
+sake of one man."
+
+"So it is, sir. So it is, sure enough, when one comes to think of
+it. Ireland has suffered mightily in the cause of the Stuarts, and
+I don't suppose that, if King James succeeded to the throne, his
+English ministers would let him turn out all the men who have
+taken the places and lands of the old families."
+
+"That they certainly would not, Mike. When Charles the Second
+returned from exile, all those who had fought and suffered for him
+thought that they would recover their estates, and turn out
+Cromwell's men, to whom they had been granted. But they were
+disappointed. The king found that he could not make so great a
+change, without upsetting the whole country, and that an attempt
+to do so would cost him his crown; and you may be sure that James
+would find an equal difficulty, were he to come to the throne."
+
+"Well, well, your honour, you know more of such matters than I do;
+but I have no doubt that you are right. I am sure we don't want
+the bad times to come over again, in Ireland."
+
+Three days later, Gerald received a message from Lord Godolphin,
+saying that he wished to see him; and, on going to his house, the
+minister handed to him the paper with the full pardon, and the
+confirmation of his ownership in his father's estates; together
+with a letter to the lord lieutenant, and the Lord Chief Justice
+Cox.
+
+The next day, he took ship for Dublin, and on arriving there
+presented his letters, and was well received by those to whom they
+were directed.
+
+The lord lieutenant said:
+
+"It is enough for me, Mr. O'Carroll, that Lord Godolphin speaks of
+you in such high terms, and I question not that he has thoroughly
+satisfied himself as to your right to these estates. At the same
+time, I should be glad if you will give me a brief outline of how
+it is that you never claimed them before, though perhaps it is as
+well that you did not do so, for, until the passions excited by
+the war had somewhat subsided, a friend of the Government would
+hardly have interposed for the benefit of the son of one who had
+died fighting for James."
+
+Gerald had drawn up three copies of a statement containing a
+precis of the case, and he handed one of these to the lord
+lieutenant, saying:
+
+"As the story is a somewhat long one, my lord, I have written it
+down, in order that you might read it at your leisure."
+
+"I will certainly do so, Mr. O'Carroll. I should like to be
+personally acquainted with the details of the matter. It will
+doubtless excite a considerable stir. It is, I believe, the first
+time that a supporter of the Government has had to defend his
+title against one of the family that fought on the other side."
+
+"It is hardly a case of royalist and rebel, sir, but the
+deliberate action of a man suppressing all knowledge of the
+existence of his own nephew, in order that he might himself obtain
+the property of his dead brother.
+
+"I have no doubt that, had it been known that I was in existence,
+I should still have been thrust aside in order to reward his
+adhesion to the cause of William, but that would have made his
+position intolerable. As one who has changed his religion and his
+politics, he is regarded as a traitor by the people of the barony,
+and avoided by all the gentry round; but the feeling would have
+been infinitely stronger, if it had been known that he was keeping
+his own nephew out of his inheritance. My father was, as I
+understand, immensely popular, and I doubt whether his brother
+would have dared to show his face within fifty miles of Kilkargan,
+had it been known that not only was he a traitor, but a usurper."
+
+The lord lieutenant smiled.
+
+"I am not surprised at your warmth, Mr. O'Carroll; but,
+unfortunately, your case is not a solitary one. There are
+thousands of men in Ireland who have suffered for the deeds of
+their fathers. However, I shall understand the case better when I
+have read your statement."
+
+It was evident to Gerald that the lord chief justice, who had
+taken a leading part in the prosecution and punishment of persons
+known to be favourable to the Jacobite cause, was not altogether
+pleased with Lord Godolphin's letter.
+
+"A strange affair," he said. "A strange and, as it appears to me,
+an unfortunate business.
+
+"However, sir," he went on, with a changed tone; "I shall
+certainly do my best to see justice done, in accordance with his
+lordship's request. I will read carefully through this statement
+of your claim, and, after considering it, place it in the hands of
+the crown lawyers.
+
+"But it seems to me that your own position here is a strange one,
+and that you yourself are liable to arrest, as a member of a
+family whose head was one of the late king's strongest adherents."
+
+"My own position, sir, is regulated by this document, bearing the
+signature of the queen and her chief minister;" and he laid the
+official paper before Cox.
+
+"That certainly settles that question," the latter said, after
+perusing it. "Of course I shall, for my own satisfaction, read
+your statement; but I do not wish to see any documents or proofs
+you may possess in the matter. These you must, of course, lay
+before your counsel. I think I can't do better than give you a
+letter to Mr. Counsellor Fergusson, with whom you can go into all
+particulars, and who will advise you as to the course that you had
+best take."
+
+Mr. Fergusson, although one of the crown lawyers, enjoyed a wide
+reputation, even among the Jacobite party, for the moderation and
+the fairness with which he conducted the crown cases placed in his
+hands. He had less employment than his colleagues, for only cases
+in which the evidence of acts of hostility to the crown were
+indisputable were committed to him, it having been found that he
+was unwilling to be a party to calling doubtful witnesses, or to
+using the means that were, in the majority of cases, employed to
+obtain convictions.
+
+The lord chief justice's letter to him was as follows:
+
+Dear Mr. Counsellor Fergusson:
+
+I have been requested, by Lord Godolphin, to place the case of the
+bearer of this letter in good hands, and cannot better carry out
+his request than by asking you to act in the matter. Lord
+Godolphin has expressed himself most strongly as to the justness
+of his claim. The bearer's father was, he states, James O'Carroll,
+a noted rebel who was killed at the siege of Limerick. This alone
+would, it might have been thought, have proved a bar to any action
+on his part against the present possessor of the property; but he
+is the bearer of a document, signed by the queen herself,
+reinstating him in all rights he may possess, notwithstanding the
+actions of his father or of himself. It is not for me to make any
+comment upon the royal document, though I may say that I fear it
+may give rise to other suits, and alarm many loyal subjects who
+have become possessed of confiscated estates. However, we must
+hope that this will not be so, as it is expressly stated that, in
+this instance, the pardon and restoration of rights are given in
+consideration of services rendered by this young gentleman to Lord
+Godolphin himself, and to the Earl of Galway. What the nature of
+these services may have been does not concern me.
+
+Gerald carried this letter to the address indicated, and on saying
+that he was the bearer of a letter from the lord chief justice, he
+was at once shown into the counsellor's room. The latter, a man of
+some fifty-five years old, with features that told of his Scottish
+extraction, with keen eyes and a kindly face, took the letter
+which Gerald presented to him, and begged him to be seated while
+he read it. As he glanced through it, a look of surprise came
+across his face, and he read the letter carefully, and then looked
+at Gerald keenly.
+
+"You are fortunate in having such good friends, Mr. O'Carroll," he
+said. "Before I go into the case, will you let me know something
+about yourself? You are, I take it, some twenty years of age?"
+
+"I am but a few months past nineteen."
+
+"By your figure, I should have put you as three years older; by
+your face, two years. You must have been fortunate, indeed, to
+have gained the protection both of Lord Godolphin and the Earl of
+Galway. No less than this would have sufficed to gain for you this
+rescript of Her Majesty.
+
+"And now, sir, please to give me an outline of your case, as to
+the nature of which I am, at present, entirely ignorant."
+
+"I have put it down in writing, sir," Gerald said, handing him the
+third copy of his statement.
+
+"It will take me some time to read this, Mr. O'Carroll, and I
+would rather do so alone, and ask you any question that may occur
+to me afterwards. Will you therefore call upon me again, in an
+hour's time?"
+
+Upon Gerald's return, the counsellor said:
+
+"It is a strange story, Mr. O'Carroll, and a very disgraceful one.
+You allude, I see, to testimonies of Irish officers in the French
+service as to your likeness to the late Mr. James O'Carroll. Will
+you please let me see them?"
+
+"Here they are, sir, together with a sworn statement by my nurse."
+
+The lawyer read the documents through carefully.
+
+"The testimony of the Duke of Berwick, and of the other honourable
+and well-known Irish gentlemen, as to the striking likeness
+between yourself and Mr. James O'Carroll, cannot but carry immense
+weight in the minds of all unprejudiced persons. They prove too,
+conclusively, that James O'Carroll left an infant boy behind him,
+and the statement of the nurse goes a long way to prove you are
+that son; and I think that this is substantiated by the conduct of
+John O'Carroll; first in receiving you and undertaking your care;
+secondly, in the neglect, and I should almost say the dislike, he
+manifested towards the child he had sheltered; and thirdly, in the
+extraordinary step that he, a professedly loyal subject of Her
+Majesty, took in sending you off to enlist in the brigade composed
+of the devoted adherents of the son of James the Second.
+
+"No doubt, at any rate, can arise that you are the child brought
+by this Mrs. Rooney to Kilkargan. That can be proved beyond all
+question; and the fact that your nurse was sent off without having
+any conversation save with John O'Carroll himself, would show how
+anxious he was that no one but himself should know her errand.
+
+"I must say that you have shown great acumen in mustering
+evidence, of all kinds, that would bear upon the question. I say
+frankly that, without this royal rescript, and the influence of
+these two noblemen, your chance, as James O'Carroll's son, of
+wresting your patrimony from the hands of your uncle would be
+small indeed. Politics have, much more than facts, to do with
+decisions here; but with such powerful credentials, and with the
+chief minister of England interfering on your behalf, I think that
+there is no great doubt that you will secure a judgment in your
+favour. When the facts are known, the feeling of the greater
+portion of the population will run strongly with you, and against
+this unnatural uncle of yours."
+
+"I should be desirous, if possible, sir, of avoiding a public
+trial that would bring discredit upon the name of my family, and
+would, in the eyes of the supporters of the present Government,
+act prejudicially to myself."
+
+"You are quite right. How do you propose to proceed?"
+
+"I was thinking, sir, of sending a statement to my uncle, similar
+to that which I laid before you, going somewhat further into
+details, and promising that, if he would surrender the property to
+me and publicly acknowledge me as his nephew, giving what reason
+he chose for having so long concealed his knowledge of the fact, I
+would take no proceedings against him, and would do my best to
+prevent any discredit falling upon him."
+
+"That would do very well," the lawyer said, "but I should abstain
+from making any allusion to the protectors you have gained. He
+will learn that soon enough, and it will be well to see what his
+first impulse is. Do not mention the names of the Duke of Berwick
+and the others, who have testified to your likeness to your late
+father. Simply say that many of his comrades have recognized your
+likeness to him. It is of no use showing him all the cards we have
+to play. I should not send the letter by post, but by hand. If you
+like, I will despatch one of my own messengers down with it, with
+instructions to bring back an answer, but not to say anything, if
+questioned, as to his being in my employment."
+
+The next morning, the messenger started by coach for Kilkargan. He
+returned four days later, bearing John O'Carroll's answer. It read
+as follows:
+
+Sir:
+
+I have received your audacious letter, and proclaim you to be an
+impostor, worthy of the severest punishment for attempting to
+personate a son of my late brother. However, for the sake of my
+friendship for Mr. Kennedy, your father, I give you twenty-four
+hours to leave the country, before laying any information against
+you, both as an impostor and as a rebel who has served against the
+armies of Her Majesty. I shall, however, at once apply for a writ
+ordering your arrest, which will be served upon you within
+twenty-four hours of your receipt of this communication. I shall
+also have this woman, your pretended nurse, arrested for perjury
+and conspiracy.
+
+Gerald took this letter to the counsellor.
+
+"That is exactly what I expected," he said, after reading it. "It
+shows the man in his true colours. We shall see what he says when
+he learns who are employed against him, and what protection you
+have obtained. My opinion is that, before many hours have passed,
+you will receive a letter in a different strain. I consider it by
+no means improbable that the lord chief justice will have written
+to him privately, warning him that you have received a full
+pardon, and are restored to all your rights, and that you are
+strongly supported by Lord Godolphin, who has written to him and
+the lord lieutenant in your favour; that you have also the
+protection of the Earl of Galway, an officer who possesses the
+confidence of Her Majesty; and that the Duke of Berwick, and many
+of the best-known Irish officers in the service of France, have
+all given their testimony, in the most positive manner, of your
+likeness to James O'Carroll, whom they knew intimately; and will
+say that, at the request of Lord Godolphin that the matter should
+be placed in the hands of one of the crown lawyers, it has been
+submitted to me; and that in my opinion, which I wrote him after
+our interview, a decision in your favour is inevitable; and
+strongly advising him to make the best compromise with you in his
+power."
+
+The same evening, indeed, a mounted messenger, who had ridden
+posthaste from Kilkargan, arrived with another letter from John
+O'Carroll. It began:
+
+My Dear Nephew:
+
+I wrote yesterday in haste, on the receipt of your communication.
+It seemed to me that you were rushing on destruction, by avowing
+yourself to be the son of my brother James; and that you would be
+liable to be arrested as a Jacobite agent in the service of
+France. Therefore, I wrote the letter that I did in hopes that you
+would leave the country, for the time had not yet arrived when you
+could safely be recognized by me as the rightful owner of
+Kilkargan. I have heard, however, that you have received a full
+pardon for past offences, and a restitution of your rights, and I
+am only too glad to be able to retire from the false position in
+which I was placed, and by which I incurred the hostility and
+dislike of my neighbours and tenants. As you know, I have lived an
+almost solitary life here, and have spent far less than the income
+of the estate. I am well aware that, acting as I have done as your
+trustee, you have a right to demand from me an account of the
+rents I have received; but I trust that you will not press this
+matter, as you'll at once come in for the receipt of the rents;
+and I shall be enabled to live in comfort, in Dublin, upon the
+savings I have effected, and a small property I received as a
+younger brother's portion.
+
+You will, of course, understand why, during your stay here, I
+refrained from any outward demonstrations of affection for you. I
+felt that suspicions might have arisen, had I not done so, that
+you were my brother's son, in which case the estate would surely
+have been confiscated. Seeing that the bent of your inclinations
+was for an active and stirring life, and as the English army was
+barred to you, I thought it best that you should go abroad, and so
+be out of the way until the time should come when matters would so
+quieten down, in Ireland, that my influence might avail to secure
+an indemnity for you for serving in France, and enable me to hand
+over your estate to you.
+
+Your affectionate uncle, John O'Carroll.
+
+Gerald laughed aloud as he read the letter.
+
+"Is it good news, your honour?" Mike, who happened to be busy in
+the room, asked.
+
+"Nothing could be better. My dear uncle has heard that Lord
+Godolphin and the Earl of Galway have become my patrons, that the
+queen has restored to me my rights, and Mr. Counsellor Fergusson
+has taken up my case. He therefore declares that, as it was always
+his intention to restore the estate to me, as soon as I could
+safely return, he is now ready to do so, and only hopes that I
+will not insist upon his handing over the back rents; which,
+indeed, I question whether I could do, as the estate was granted
+to him, personally, by the Government.
+
+"However, of course I shall not press that. I shall be only too
+glad to obtain possession without the scandal of having to show,
+in the public courts, that my father's brother was a villain."
+
+"The ould fox!" Mike exclaimed indignantly. "I felt sure, when you
+told me what the counsellor had said, that he would wriggle out of
+it somehow. I would give all the gold pieces I have in my belt for
+half an hour's talk with him, with a good shillelah!"
+
+"Well, we can afford to let bygones be bygones, Mike. And after
+all, he did me a service, unwittingly, in sending me over to
+France. In the first place, I had three years of stirring life; in
+the next, I have made many good friends, and have gained the
+patronage of two powerful noblemen, without which I should have
+assuredly never come in for Kilkargan at all."
+
+"That is true for you, your honour. And without it, I might be
+still a private in O'Brien's regiment, instead of being your
+honour's body servant."
+
+"And friend, Mike."
+
+"Yes, sir, as you are good enough to say so."
+
+Mr. Fergusson put John O'Carroll's letter down, with a gesture of
+disgust, after he had read it.
+
+"It is what might have been expected from such a man," he said. "A
+traitor to the cause he once adhered to, false to his religion,
+and a usurper of his nephew's rights.
+
+"At any rate, Mr. O'Carroll, I congratulate you. It has prevented
+a grievous scandal from being made public, and the large
+expenditure entailed by such a case. You have now only to go down
+and take possession."
+
+"I shall write to my uncle, and give him a week to clear out, and
+to make what explanation he chooses of the change."
+
+Gerald wrote at once to his uncle. It was coldly worded, and
+showed unmistakably that he was, in no way, deceived by the
+professions in his letter. He told him that he considered it fair
+that he should retain the savings he had made, as he had
+personally been confirmed in the ownership of Kilkargan, the
+Government being ignorant that his brother had left a son. He said
+that he thought it would be more pleasant, for both of them, that
+they should not meet, and wished, therefore, that he would leave,
+before his arrival to take possession.
+
+John O'Carroll at once summoned the tenants, and astonished them
+by informing them that, he was glad to say, he was free at last to
+lay down the position he had held as owner of Kilkargan. That his
+brother James had left a son, whom they all knew as Desmond
+Kennedy, but whom he had been obliged to treat with coldness, lest
+suspicions should be excited as to his identity. Had this been
+known, he would assuredly have been proscribed as the son of a
+rebel, and debarred by law from any inheritance. He was delighted
+to say that the time had come when he could publicly acknowledge
+him, and place him in possession of the estate, as Her Majesty had
+granted him a special indemnity against the pains and penalties
+incurred by his father's act of rebellion and treason, and had
+restored to him his full rights.
+
+A burst of cheering, such as had not been heard in Kilkargan since
+James O'Carroll rode out, at the head of a troop raised among his
+tenantry, to fight for King James, greeted the announcement; and,
+for the first time since that event, John O'Carroll was, for the
+moment, popular. Subsequent reflection, and their knowledge of his
+character, soon dissipated that feeling; but in their joy at the
+announced approaching arrival of their new master, John O'Carroll
+rode away, with his followers, without the manifestation of
+hostility that would otherwise have attended his departure.
+
+Bonfires blazed all over the barony when Gerald rode in,
+accompanied by Mike. The tenants, and a number of the gentry who
+had known him when a boy, assembled at the castle to meet him; and
+even his father could not have met with a more enthusiastic
+welcome than that which was given him.
+
+The next day, Gerald wrote to the Duke of Berwick, telling him
+what had taken place, and resigning his commission in the Irish
+Brigade.
+
+"I intend," he said, "to abstain from all part in politics.
+Although no condition was made, in my pardon for serving abroad
+and in the restoration of my estate, I feel that, having accepted
+these favours, I must hold myself aloof from all plots against
+Queen Anne, though my heart will still be with him whom I hold to
+be my lawful sovereign. Unless a large army from France was landed
+here, I believe that any attempt at his restoration would only
+bring down fresh misery upon Ireland. But, should a force land
+that would render success almost a certainty, I should then, with
+the great bulk of my countrymen, join it."
+
+In due time he received an answer, approving the course he had
+taken.
+
+"I myself," the Duke said, "am under no delusions. With the ten
+regiments of the Irish Brigade, twenty thousand French troops, and
+arms sufficient to distribute to the whole country, I believe that
+Ireland and Scotland might again come under the rule of the
+Stuarts; but nothing short of such a force would be of any avail.
+So convinced was I of this that, in 1691, after the successful
+defence of Limerick, I saw that the cause was for the time lost,
+and that further resistance would only prove disastrous to
+Ireland. I therefore resigned my command, and went over to France
+to serve as a volunteer, and took no part in the war at home.
+Therefore, I think that you are fully justified in the course you
+have taken. When the present war, which I think is approaching its
+end, terminates, and you can again visit France, I trust that I
+shall see you; and I am sure that you will receive the heartiest
+of welcomes from your comrades in the Brigade."
+
+Gerald followed out strictly the line he had laid down for
+himself, and kept aloof from the plots and conspiracies that, for
+years, agitated the country, entailing disaster upon all concerned
+in them. Mike was installed as his body servant, and majordomo of
+his household; and Norah Rooney as housekeeper at the castle.
+
+Three years later, in 1713, the treaty of Utrecht brought the war
+to an end. Communications being restored between the two
+countries, Gerald wrote to the Baron de Pointdexter, and told him
+of the changes which had taken place in his position. He received
+a warm letter in reply, urging him to go over and pay him and his
+son-in-law a visit.
+
+But Gerald had had enough of travelling, and wrote to say that he
+could not leave his estate, as there was much to look after.
+Letters were, however, frequently exchanged between them, and
+when, three years later, Gerald married the daughter of the Mr.
+Kennedy he had visited near Cork, a present of a superb set of
+jewels, the joint gift of the baron and Monsieur de la Vallee,
+arrived for the bride.
+
+After the conclusion of the peace, some of the Irish regiments
+were disbanded, and as the British Government, wiser than before,
+offered a free pardon to all men and officers who would return,
+many availed themselves of it; and among these was O'Neil, who
+delighted Gerald by riding up, one day, to the castle.
+
+"You did not expect to see me again, Kennedy; or, as I hear we
+ought to call you, O'Carroll. Not knowing where I should find you,
+I took the liberty of writing to Baron de Pointdexter, and he
+informed me of your good luck, and your change of name."
+
+"And you have left the French service altogether, O'Neill?"
+
+"Yes, and glad enough I am that I shall be able to end my days at
+home."
+
+"And what are you thinking of doing?"
+
+"Anything I can get."
+
+"Well, O'Neil, I have some interest with the lord lieutenant. As I
+am no longer regarded as one likely to join in plots, I think
+that, were I to ride with you to Dublin after you have been here
+for a time; and speak to him for you, as one who had seen the
+errors of his ways, and was anxious to live peacefully, he would
+procure you some appointment."
+
+O'Neil stayed there for three weeks, and they then rode to Dublin.
+The lord lieutenant granted Gerald's request, and gave O'Neil an
+appointment which would enable him to live in comfort; knowing
+that there is nothing, for keeping a man peaceable, like giving
+him something to do; and that an idle man is a dangerous man,
+while one who has a comfortable position can be trusted to hold
+himself aloof from any business that might imperil his place.
+
+O'Neil thoroughly justified Gerald's recommendation of him, and, a
+couple of years after his return, married a young and well-endowed
+widow; and, to the end of his life, abstained carefully from
+mixing himself up, in any way, in politics.
+
+Gerald saw the failure of Prince Charlie's expedition to Scotland;
+and the terrible disasters, that befell all who had taken part in
+the movement, showed him the wisdom of the course he had
+adopted--of standing aloof from all intrigues in favour of the
+descendants of James the Second.
+
+THE END.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of In the Irish Brigade, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE IRISH BRIGADE ***
+
+***** This file should be named 18349.txt or 18349.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/1/8/3/4/18349/
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+*** END: FULL LICENSE ***
+
diff --git a/18349.zip b/18349.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48ab4a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/18349.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dda76c1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #18349 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/18349)